Anda di halaman 1dari 496

Sibelius

User Guide

Sibelius
User Guide

Contents
Start here
5
Welcomer. ............................................................................................ 6
The story of Sibelius .........................................................................7
About this User Guide.. ....................................................................8
Before you install.. .......................................................................... 10
Installing Sibelius for Mac.. ........................................................... 1 1
Installing Sibelius for Windows ................................................... 1 4
Registering Sibelius.. ...................................................................... 18
Transferring Sibelius ...................................................................... 2 1
Quick tour
23
What Sibelius does for you .......................................................... 24
Running for the first time ............................................................. 25
Look and feel.. ................................................................................. 28
Playback.. .......................................................................................... 33
Basic editing..................................................................................... 36
Printing.............................................................................................. 40
Starting a new score ...................................................................... 41
Creating notes ................................................................................. 45
Mouse input.. .................................................................................. 46
Alphabetic input.............................................................................. 50
Step-time input ............................................................................... 60
Flexi-timeTM input............................................................................ 62
Basic formatting.. ............................................................................ 64
Finishing touches ............................................................................ 68
A little arranging ............................................................................. 70
More fun things.. ............................................................................ 73
What to do next.. ............................................................................ 76
How to
79
Introduction ..................................................................................... 8 1
Basic notation.. ................................................................................ 82
Advanced notation.. ....................................................................... 84
Band .................................................................................................. 86
Choir .................................................................................................. 88
Early music.. ..................................................................................... 92
Extracted parts.. ............................................................................... 94
Guitar ................................................................................................ 96
Jazz ................................................................................................... 98
Lead sheets.. .................................................................................. 100
Music examples ............................................................................ 1 0 2
Orchestra.. ...................................................................................... 104
Percussion.. .................................................................................... 106
Piano, organ and harp ................................................................ 108
Voice and keyboard ..................................................................... 1 1 1
Worksheets.. .................................................................................. 1 14
Reference
117
Accidentals..................................................................................... 1 18
Arra ngeTM ........................................................................................ 1 2 1
Articulations.. ................................................................................. 129

Attachment ..................................................................................... 133


Bar numbers .................................................................................. 135
Barlines ............................................................................................ 138
Bars and bar rests.. .......................................................................142
Beams .............................................................................................. 1 4 5
Brackets and braces ..................................................................... 150
Breaks .............................................................................................. 152
Chord symbols.. ............................................................................154
Clefs.. ...............................................................................................158
Default Positions ........................................................................... 161
Document Setup ........................................................................... 164
Edit Arrange Styles.. ......................................................................167
Edit Lines ........................................................................................ 171
Edit Noteheads .............................................................................. 173
Edit Staff Types .............................................................................. 175
Edit Symbols.. ................................................................................177
Edit Text Styles ............................................................................... 179
Extracting parts .............................................................................. 185
Fifes.. ................................................................................................189
Filters and Find .............................................................................. 194
Flexi-timeTM.. ...................................................................................199
Free rhythm ...................................................................................203
Grace notes and cue notes ........................................................205
Grove Music ...................................................................................209
Guitar frames.. ...............................................................................2 10
Guitar tab........................................................................................212
Help .................................................................................................219
Hiding objects ................................................................................221
Highlight.. ........................................................................................223
House Style. ................................................................................225
Importing graphics .......................................................................228
Instruments.. ..................................................................................230
Internet publishing.. .....................................................................238
Keyboard shortcuts ......................................................................244
Key signatures ...............................................................................254
Layout and formatting.. ...............................................................257
Lines .................................................................................................260
Lyrics ................................................................................................266
Manuscript paper.. ........................................................................273
MIDI devices ..................................................................................275
MIDI for beginners.. .....................................................................279
MIDI messages.. ............................................................................282
MIDI setup for Mac ......................................................................289
MIDI setup for Windows.. ...........................................................297
Mixer ................................................................................................299
Multirests ........................................................................................306
Music engraving............................................................................308
Music fonts.. ...................................................................................3 13
Noteheads ......................................................................................316
Note input ......................................................................................3 19
3

Note spacing.. ................................................................................324


Opening Acorn Sibelius files.. ....................................................327
Opening Finale, Allegro and PrintMusic files.. ......................330
Opening MIDI files ....................................................................... 334
Opening SCORE files...................................................................338
Page numbers.. .............................................................................341
Percussion.. ....................................................................................342
Performance.. ................................................................................348
Playback .......................................................................................... 35 1
Playback dictionary ...................................................................... 356
Plug-ins.. .........................................................................................359
Preferences ....................................................................................372
Printing.. ..........................................................................................373
Properties.......................................................................................378
Publishing.. .....................................................................................383
Rehearsal marks ...........................................................................385
Saving graphics files.. ...................................................................387
Saving MIDI files.. .........................................................................392
Scanning.. .......................................................................................394
Selections and passages.. ...........................................................410

Slurs.. ..............................................................................................,415
Staff spacing.. ................................................................................,418
Staves.. .............................................................................................42 1
Stems ...............................................................................................426
Symbols .........................................................................................,428
Text .................................................................................................,432
Timecode.. ......................................................................................443
Time signatures.............................................................................446
Transposing.. ..................................................................................450
Tremolos.. .......................................................................................452
Triplets and other tuplets.. ..........................................................454
Undo nd Redo.. ...........................................................................458
lew menu .....................................................................................459
Va
Voices ..............................................................................................463
Window menu.. .............................................................................468

Glossary

469

Index
479
License Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 497

--

_-- _____ __..______ _ -. ..___ .__ ~- ~_

~ _~~ _.

Start

here

F
1

Start here

Welcome!
Welcome to Sibelius - an idea we dreamed up while at school, which has since become the worlds best-selling music
notation program.
We created Sibelius to help people write music far more easily and quickly than with pen and paper. As musicians
ourselves, our aim was to design a program so elegant and intuitive that anyone could use it - yet sophisticated
enough for the worlds leading composers, universities and publishers.
Sibelius 2 is the very latest incarnation of the program, with a huge number of new features suggested by users like
YOU.
We hope you enjoy using it as much as we do.

Jonathan & Ben Finn


Sbelius creators

The story of Sibelius

The story of Sibelius


The Finns first began work on Sibelius when they were students in 1987, and spent six years of their spare time
developing a vast range of sophisticated features, with an intuitive user interface and built-in intelligence which had
never been seen in previous music programs.
No-one else was interested in marketing Sibelius, so in 1993, after graduating from Oxford and Cambridge
Universities, the Finns started their own company to sell the program themselves.
Sibelius proved to be an instant success - and the Finns software business has since grown out of all recognition, with
off ices across the USA and UK, and customers in 100 countries worldwide.
who uses Sibelius?
Sibelius is designed for every kind of musician - including you! Sibelius users range from students, teachers, schools
and universities to composers, arrangers, performers and the worlds leading publishers. It handles every kind of
music, too - from early music to jazz, from rock to avant garde, from synth to symphony orchestra.
Its perhaps a tribute to the ease of use and sophistication of Sibelius that one and the same program is used both by
elementary schools and top professionals.
Famous Sibelius users include conductor Michael Tilson Thomas, choral composer John Rutter, rock guitarist Andy
Summers, film/jazz composer Lalo Schifrin (lvlisslon Impossible) and the Royal Academy of Music, London. Top
publishers such as Hal Leonard, Music Sales and Boosey & Hawkes use Sibelius both for traditional publishing and to
deliver music via the Internet straight to a customers printer.
Sibelius has also won extraordinary acclaim including Keyboard magazines Key Buy award, Elecfronlc Muslcl~u~s
Editors Choice award, MacWorlds Five Star rating, and an unbeatable lO/lO score from the UKs best-selling
Computer Music magazine.

Start here

About this User Guide


Stern warning
However much you may dislike manuals, you must read the 3 whole of this Start here section in order to get started
with the program.
You are then very strongly advised to read all of the Quick tour section before embarking on any serious work with
Sibelius. Sibelius is easy to learn and mostly self-explanatory,I but if you dont read the Quick tour you will run a risk
* * I I r
I I-.
II
OT never arscovenng some basic Teatures, par-trcurany IT you are used to notation programs which work in different
ways. When youve gone through this section you wme able to input, edit, play back and print out straightforward
music, and youll know how to get going on more complicated music too.
The How to section which follows the Quick tour summarizes how to use Sibelius to produce particular types of
music - such as band, orchestral, choral, jazz and so on - and which Reference topics will be most relevant.
More advanced topics are covered one by one in the Reference section that makes up most of this User Guide
explains every feature in complete detail. This is not meant to be read from start to finish, because most people only
use quite a small proportion of music notation anyway. You can flick through relevant parts of the Reference
section at your leisure - treat it as bedtime reading.
Near the back of this User Guide is a Glossary, which explains the musical and technical jargon used, and a useful
Index.
This User Guide assumes a basic understanding of how to use your computer (such as the mouse, keyboard, menus
and files).
Boxes in the
Reference section
Youll find boxes like these
scattered throughout the
Reference
section,
explaining various notation
and music engraving rules.

Names of computer keys, menus and dialogs are written like this.
Items in menus and sub-menus are denoted with ), so choose File b Open means
choose Open from the File menu.
iLIZ!! Accidentals means see the Accidentals topic (within the Reference
\ section,
,
unless otherwise stated).

0 Pearl of wisdom denotes something well worth remembering - try looking up wisdom in the index. (The 0
is a lovely picture of a pearl.)
Basic terminology
This terminology will be understood by almost all readers, but as this User Guide will be incomprehensible without it,
here goes anyway:
l

Some keys are labeled differently on different keyboards, particularly on Mac. For the purposes of this User
Guide, these are the conventions:

About this User Guide

Mac symbol
x
4
71
,7

Mac name
Command
Shift
Option
Return
Enter

Windows equivalent
Ctrl (Control)
Shift
Ak
Return (on main keyboard)
Enter (on main keyboard)

Sibelius is almost identical on Mac and Windows, but where there are differences, mainly in keyboard shortcuts,
the Mac convention is listed first. For more information on the differences between Mac and Windows keyboard
shortcuts, see Keyboard shortcuts in the Reference section, which lists all keyboard shortcuts available.
Keyboard shortcuts are also shown in menus.
Type B%A or Ctrl+A means hold down the 8% (Mac) or Ctrl (Windows) key and type A. (Even though A is
written as a capital letter, dont type Shift unless explicitly told to do so.)
Similarly, x-click or Alt+click means hold down the x (Mac) or Alt (Windows) key and click.
On Windows, to click something means to point at it with the mouse and click the lefi mouse button. To rightclick something means to point at it with the mouse and click (not surprisingly) the right mouse button.
To drag something means to point at it with the mouse, and then click and hold the left mouse button (or the
only mouse button on Mac) while moving the mouse. To finish dragging, just let go of the mouse button.
A dialog is a window with buttons on. Some dialogs are divided into several pages and have a pop-up combo
box (Mac), labeled tabs at the top, or a list box, which you can click to switch between pages of the dialog.
The numeric keypad is the rectangle of numbers and other characters at the very right-hand side of your
computer keyboard. (Laptop computers usually dont have a separate numeric keypad - see Keyboard
shortcuts in the Reference section for more information.)
Return is the large key to the right of the letter keys. On some keyboards it is labeled with Enter or a special
arrow symbol, but we always call it Return.
Enter is the large key at the bottom right of the numeric keypad. On some keyboards it is unlabeled, but it still
means Enter.
Less well-known terminology is in the Glossary.
American and British English
Sibelius and this User Guide use American English, but for the benefit of British readers some un-American terms such
as crotchet are included in parentheses.
British readers may be interested to know that in America, both bar and measure are used (so for universality weve
opted for bar), and staff means British stave. Any British readers who are offended by the American spelling of
center, color and so on in the User Guide and program will just have to use a pen to amend the spelling in the User
Guide or (less effectively) on the screen.
Suggestions
We are always happy to receive reports of errors or misprints, and suggested improvements to this User Guide. Please
email userguide@sibelius.com. We would also like to hear your suggestions for improvements to the Sibelius
program itself. Please post these suggestions to the chat page on the Sibelius web site, or contact technical help.
9

Start here

Before you install


whats in the box
Unless you have X-ray vision, youve already managed to open the box to get at this User Guide. You should also find:
l

Installation CD-ROM in a CD case. Your programs serial number is on the back of the case, so dont lose it!
A sheet entitled Technical Help, with details of how to get help if you get stuck
Form for faxing your registration information to-uc(or you can provide this information by phone or the Internet
- explained later)
Keyboard shortcut mouse pad - this lists the most important of Sibeliuss keyboard shortcuts
If youve purchased a network site license, youll also find a second CD-ROM (in the same case as the Sibelius
CD-ROM) and a separate booklet entitled Installing network site licenses.

Before you start to install, make sure you have read the license agreement at the back of this User Guide. By insta lling
the software you are indicating that you agree to the terms of the license.
Single copies
If you have bought just a single copy of Sibelius (as opposed to a s-pack or educational site license), skin P to
Installing Sibelius for Mac (page 11) or Installing Sbelius for windows (page 14) as appropriate.
Stand-alone site licenses
Stand-alone site licenses let you run Sibelius on five or more non-networked computers simultaneously. If youve
bought five copies, you will have received one installation CD-ROM. If youve bought more than five copies, you may
have been sent a combination of 5packs (each containing a single CD-ROM) and single copies, or a single CD which
you can install on a specified number of computers. If you have two or more s-packs, use each CD-ROM and serial
number to install on five of your computers.
Whatever size of site license you have purchased, you must install and register Sibelius on each stand-alone machine
separately, following the instructions in Installing Sibelius for Mac (page 11) or Installing Sbelius for
Windows (page 14).
All copies of the site license must be installed on a single site of an educational institution. You may\not install site
license copies on laptops, teachers home computers or elsewhere (unless authorized by Sibelius).
If you want to use Sibelius on a network but you have bought a stand-alone site license, please contact technical help.
Network site licenses
If you have bought a network site license, please refer to the enclosed Installing network site licenses
booklet for details on installing and registering Sibelius.

10

Installing Sibelius for Mac

installing Sibelius for Mac

VIii!

Minimum hardware requirements


Check that your computer and other equipment match the minimum hardware requirements:
l

G4 / G3/ iMac / fast PowerMac, Mac OS 8.6 to 10.1 or later, 15Mb+ free RAM @Mb+ recommended, 32Mb+
for scanning), CD-ROM drive (any speed), 80Mb+ free hard disk space.
Some features require printer, MIDI keyboard, Internet access, TWAIN-compatible scanner. Sibelius 2 is
carbonized for Mac OS X; Mac OS X users must have version 10.1 or later.

Mac OS 7.1 to 8.5


With Mac OS 7.1 to 8.5, only the Sibelius 1.4 feature set can be used, but you can access all Sibelius 2 features if you
subsequently get Mac OS 8.6 or later. You may want to update your Mac OS now:
l

If you run Mac OS 8.5, you can update to Mac OS 8.6 free of charge; see wwvv.apple.com for details
For versions of Mac OS earlier than 8.5, the update to OS 9.1 or OS X will incur an upgrade fee; see
www.apple.com for details.

If you do not update your Mac to run OS 8.6 or later, you can install Sibelius 1 A, which is included on the enclosed
Sibelius 2 CD-ROM. You should also contact Sibelius technical support and ask to be sent a copy of the Sibelius 1.4
User Guide free of charge.
For instructions on installing Sibelius 1.4, consult the documentation inside the Sibelius 1.4 folder inside the English
folder on your Sibelius 2 CD-ROM.
Classic Mac OS and Mac OS X

Well be referring to versions of Mac OS between 8.6 and 9.x as Classic Mac OS, in contrast to Mac OS X. Although
Sibelius is identical in operation on Classic Mac OS and Mac OS X, the process of setting up MIDI devices is different
on these two different operating systems.
Connecting MIDI devices
Before you install Sibelius, you might want to connect up any external MIDI devices you plan to use. Detailed
instructions for how to do this are provided in MIDI setup for Mac in the Reference section.
However, you can do this at any time, so if you dont feel like grappling with MIDI cables at the moment, go ahead
and install Sibelius now.
Introductory movie
You can double-click the Introductory Movie folder on your Sibelius CD-ROM to watch a useful video
demonstrating Sibeliuss main features - you dont have to do this now, but we recommend that you watch it at some
point. This uses QuickTime, which is probably installed on your Mac already but is also provided on the CD-ROM.
Installing Sibelius (on Mac OS 8.6 or later)
Take the Sibelius CD-ROM out of its case, put it (labeled side up) in the CD-ROM drive of the computer, and
close the drive slot
l

--11

Start here
l

Wait for a few seconds. An icon for the CD, labeled Sibelius 2, should appear on your desktop, and a window
containing icons should open automatically; if it doesnt, double-click the Sibelius 2 icon
To install Sibelius, drag the folder called Sibelius 2 to a suitable location on your Macs hard disk; we
recommend you drag it into the Applications folder
A progress bar will appear as the folder is copied to your hard disk; when it disappears, Sibelius has been
successfully installed
Eject the CD-ROM (by dragging its icon o to the Trash icon), put it back in its case, and into a safe (or at least,
into a safe place). The case is just as imp
ortant as the CD-ROM, as it has your serial number printed on it.

Installing Adobe Acrobat Reader 5


This is required in order to read Sibeliuss on-screen help.
On the Sibelius CD-ROM, double-click the Acrobat Reader 5 folder, then double-click the Install Acrobat
Reader icon to install the program.
Installing Neuratron PhotoScore Lite
/Vote: if you have bought PhotoScore Professional along with Sibelius, you should not install PhotoScore Lite - refer to
the PhotoScore Professional manual for instructions on installing PhotoScore Professional.
l

(If the Sibelius CD-ROM isnt in the CD-ROM drive, insert it. A window full of icons should appear within a few
seconds; if it doesnt, double-click the Sibelius 2 CD icon.
Double-click the PhotoScore Lite folder
Double-click the Photoscore Lite Installer icon; a splash-screen appears. Click Continue.
Read the license agreement, and click Continue when youre finished
Check the Install Location in the dialog that appears; it will default to the root folder of your hard disk
(usually called Macintosh HD), but if you like you can change this using the pop-up control to choose
Select folder
Click Install
A progress bar shows the number of files remaining to be installed; this takes only a few seconds. You will be
\
told that installation was successful; click Quit.
There is no need to run PhotoScore Lite now, but the first time you do run the program, youI, will be prompted
to enter your name (and the company/organization you work for).

Installing OMS and FreeMlDl (Classic Mac OS only)


For versions of Mac OS between 8.6 and 9.x, Sibelius supports both OMS and FreeMIDI. You have to use one of these
programs to specify your MIDI devices before playing/recording, in the same way that you have to use the Chooser
to specify your printer before printing.
Both OMS and FreeMlDl are included on CD-ROM. For more information on which, if either, of these packages you
need to install, see MIDI setup for Mac in the Reference section.
Installing Scorch
(If your Sibelius CD-ROM is not already in the CD-ROM drive, insert it. A window full of icons should appear
within a few seconds; if it doesnt, double-click the Sibelius 2 CD icon.)
l

12

--~-

---

Installing Sibelius for Mac

Double-click the Scorch folder, then double-click the Scorch Installer icon
Read the license agreement, and click Continue when youre finished
The installer will prompt you for the Install Location in the dialog that appears; just ignore this and click
Install
You will be prompted that it is recommended you restart your computer after installing. Click Continue.
If both Netscape Navigator and Microsoft Internet Explorer are installed on your computer, you will be asked
with which one you wish to use Scorch. Click the name of the web browser you normally use. (You can run the
installer again later to install in another browser as well.)
After a few seconds, you will be told that installation was successful. Click Restart to restart your computer and
finish the installation.
New versions of Scorch are available from the Sibelius website from time to time, so check it regularly! Alternatively,
click the rightmost button on the Scorch toolbar itself to be taken to our website for updates.
Memory problems (Classic Mac OS only)
You may need to increase the memory allocated to Sibelius when opening very large scores or large numbers of
smaller scores.
l

Ensure that Sibelius is not running, and locate the Sibelius program icon within the Sibelius 2 folder by
navigating to it through your hard disk (the icon on your desktop usually called Macintosh HD)
Click the icon once to select it, then type #I, which will bring up the File info dialog.
Using the pop-up combo control (labeled Show:), select Memory, and increase the value of Preferred
Size (under Memory Requirements). Dont change the value of Minimum Size, though.

Reinstalling Sibelius
If you need to reinstall Sibelius for any reason, insert the CD-ROM into your computer, then simply drag the Sibelius
2 folder into the folder where you originally installed the program; it should ask you if you want to overwrite the
existing folder - click Yes.
Uninstalling Sibelius
Uninstalling means taking your copy of Sibelius off your computer, probably so that you can instal it on another
computer. Do nof do this if saving is enabled on your copy - you will lose the saving feature; instead, install another
copy on another computer and transfer saving to it (see above) before uninstalling the original copy. Ilternatively, if
your copy of Sibelius becomes corrupted for some reason, you can normally just install it again in the same place
without uninstalling it first.
Do not attempt to move or rename the Sibelius program folder or the folder of any other program, as the operating
system doesnt like this.
To uninstall Sibelius for Mac, simply delete the Sibelius 2 folder on your computer. Likewise, to uninstall
PhotoScore Lite, just delete the Neuratron PhotoScore Lite folder.
what next?
Now turn to page 18 - Registering Sbelius.
13

Start here

hstalling Sbelius for windows


Minimum hardware reqtiments
Check that your computer and other equipment meet the minimum hardware requirements:
l

Pentium or fast 486 (Pentium II or faster recommended), Windows 95 / 98 / Me / NT4 / 2000 / XP or later,
32Mb+ RAM (64Mb+ recommended for scanning), CD-ROM drive (any speed), 40Mb+ free hard disk space.
Some features require a soundcard, printer, MIDI keyboard, Internet access, and a scanner.

Connecting MIDI devices


Before you install Sibelius, you might want to connect up any external MIDI devices you plan to use. Detailed
instructions for how to do this are provided in MIDI setup for Windows in the Reference section.
However, you can do this at any time, so if you dont feel like grappling with MIDI cables at the moment, go ahead
and install Sibelius now.
installing Sibelius
It is traditional for manuals to gloss over the crucial installation process, and say something like: follow the instructions
on the screen. What this really means is that the author isnt quite sure what will happen next. For all he knows, the
programmers might have changed the installation procedure at the last minute.
However, well go out on a limb and tell you what actually happens when installing Sibelius.
l

Exit any programs that are running. Its a particularly good idea to exit any anti-virus programs loaded
automatically at start-up (for example, McAfee Virus Scan or Norton AntiVirus).
Take the Sibelius CD-ROM out of its case, put it (labeled side up) in the CD-ROM drive of tt le computer, and
close the drive slot
Wait for a few seconds. The CD-ROM drive should start up and a dialog will appear on the screen
(If theres no sign of activity after a while, click the Start menu, choose Run and type D:\autorun, then hit
Return on the main keyboard.)

14

You may be invited to choose a language - if so, click English, and youll be shown another dialog
You can click Play introductory movie to watch a useful video demonstrating Sibeliuss main features you dont have to do this now, but we recommend that you watch it at some point
Otherwise, click Install Sibelius 2 to start installing Sibelius
The installer warns you to close any programs which may be running (which you should already have done).
Click Next.
You are given the opportunity to read the Sibelius license agreement (which is also printed at the back of this
User Guide). Click Next.
Then youre asked to type in your serial number - this is on the back of the CD case, and starts with the letters
SC. Type in the serial number carefully - though you neednt type spaces, or capitals for the letters.
Click Next. (If you typed the number in wrong, youll be given an error message and youll have to try again.)
The installer suggests a folder to install Sibelius into. Click Next (unless you have strong feelings about where
you want Sibelius to go and you know how to alter it, in which case by all means do so).

Installing Sibelius for Windows

It tells you youre now ready to install Sibelius. Click Next.


Things flash and zoom past on the screen as Sibelius is installed. This takes a few seconds.
Now it gives you the opportunity to install some additional components. You are encouraged to accept the
default options, which are to install Acrobat Reader 5.0 (required for using Sibeliuss on-screen help - earlier
versions will not work), Scorch (which allows you to view, play, transpose and print Sibelius scores on the
Internet), and PhotoScore Lite (which you can use to scan printed music into Sibelius).
If you have bought PhotoScore Professional along with Sibelius: switch off the option to install PhotoScore Lite
here, and install PhotoScore Professional (by following the instructions in its separate manual) after you have
finished installing Sibelius.
If youre using Windows 95 and have never installed Internet Liplorer 4.0 or above on your machine, you
should switch on the final option to install the Microsoft Common Controls Upgrade. If youre not sure, just
switch the option on anyway.
Normally you should just click Next.
Now Acrobat Reader 5.0 will start to install. Click Next.
It will ask you where you want to install Acrobat Reader - just click Next
You will be thanked for choosing Acrobat Reader - click OK
Next, Scorch will install. Click Next and youll be presented with Scorchs license agreement. Read it and then
click Next.
l

Scorch installs to the by-now customary accompaniment of progress bars and estimated time remaining
Click Finish; if you are using Windows NT/2OOO/XP, the installer will tell you that you may need to restart your
computer before using Scorch. Dont worry about this, since we may be restarting the computer in a minute
anyway. If you see this message, just click OK.
Now PhotoScore Lite will start to install. If your screen resolution is set to smaller than 1024 x 768, a message
will pop up recommending you increase it. Just click OK.

Click Next to see the license agreement for PhotoScore Lite. Read it and click Next.
Youre asked to fill in a few details: type in your Name and Company (if the copy is for your personal use,
type your name into the Company field, since you wont be able to go any further unless you type
something); the Product ID field is filled in for you. When youve filled in the form, click Next.
PhotoScore Lite tells you where it will be installed; again, you can change this if you have strong feelings about it.
Otherwise, click Next.
Click Next once more and PhotoScore Lite will be installed
Click Finish
If you switched on the option to install the Microsoft Common Controls Upgrade, youll now be asked if you
want to install them. Click Yes; click Yes again to accept the license agreement; and when told that the
common controls have been installed, click OK.

Now the installer will do one of two things:


l

You may be asked if you want to start your copy of Sibelius 2 now; click Yes if you like.
You may be told that your computer needs to be restarted, in which case click OK and wait for the computer
to restart.

r
l

Eject the CD-ROM, put it back in its case, and into a safe (or at least, into a safe place). The case is just as

important as the CD-ROM, as it has your serial nur tber printed on it.
Now turn to Registering Sibelius on page 18.
Installing Neuratron PhotoScore Lite
IVote: if you bought PhotoScore Professional along with Sibelius, you should not install PhotoScore Lite - refer to the
PhotoScore Professional manual for instructions on insta ling PhotoScore Professional.
If you want to use Sibeliuss scanning functions and didnt install PhotoScore Lite when you installed Sibelius, you can
install it later from your Sibelius CD-ROM:
l

Insert your Sibelius CD-ROM


After a few seconds, a menu will appear; you may be asked to choose your language; if so, click English
Next click Install PhotoScore Lite
If your screen resolution is set to smaller than 1024 x 768, a message will pop up recommending you increase
it. Just click OK
Click Next to see the license agreement for PhotoScore Lite. Read it and click Next
Youre asked to fill in a few details: type in your Name and Company (if the copy is for your personal use,
type your name into the Company field); the Product ID field is filled in for you. When youve filled in the
form, click Next
PhotoScore Lite tells you where it will be installed; again, you can change this if you have strong feelings about it.
Otherwise, click Next
Click Next once more and PhotoScore Lite will be installed
Click Finish

Once the plug-in is installed, see the Scanning section in the User Guide for instructions on using it.
Installing Scorch
If you chose not to install Scorch when you first installed Sibelius, you can install it from your Sibelius CD-ROM at any
time:
l

Insert your Sibelius CD-ROM


After a few seconds, a menu appears; you may be asked to choose your language; if so, click English
Next click Install Scorch
First it asks you to choose your language - select U.S. English and click OK
Click Next and youll be presented with Scorchs license agreement. Read it and then click Next
Scorch installs; then click Finish. If you are using Windows NT/2000/XP, the installer will tell you that you may
need to restart your computer before using Scorch.

New versions of Scorch are available from the Sibelius website from time to time, so check it regularly! Alternatively,
click the right most button on the Scorch toolbar itself to be taken to our website for updates.

16

-- installing Sibehs for Windows

Installing Adobe Acrobat Reader 5


If you chose not to install Acrobat Reader when you first installed Sibelius, you can install it from your Sibelius CDROM at any time:
l

Insert your Sibelius CD-ROM


After a few seconds, a menu appears; you may be asked to choose your language; if so, click English
Next click Install Acrobat Reader
It will ask you where you want to install Acrobat Reader - just click Next and the program will be installed
You will be thanked for choosing Acrobat Reader - click OK.

Reinstalling Sibelius
If you need to reinstall Sibelius, simply insert the CD-ROM into your computer and proceed as if you were installing
Sibelius for the first time. The installer will detect that Sibelius is already installed on your computer and simply
reinstall the program for you - just follow the instructions on the screen.
Uninstalling Sibelius
Uninstalling means taking your copy of Sibelius off your computer, probably so that you can install it on another
computer. Do nof do this if saving is enabled on your copy - you will lose the saving feature; instead, install another
copy on another computer and transfer saving to it (see above) before uninstalling the original copy. Alternatively, if
your copy of Sibelius becomes corrupted for some reason, you can normally just install it again in the same place
without uninstalling it first.
Do not attempt to move or rename the Sibelius program folder or the folder of any other program, as the operating
system doesnt like this.
l

To uninstall Sibelius for Mac, simply delete the Sibelius 2 folder on your computer.
If you have installed PhotoScore Lite, uninstall it first. Its listed as Neuratron PhotoScore Lite in
Add/Remove programs (click Start, then within Settings click Control panel, then double-click
Add/Remove programs).
To uninstall Sibelius itself, choose Start ) Programs ) Sibelius Software ) Uninstall Sibelius, or use
the standard Add/Remove programs. Then follow the instructions on the screen.

17

Start here

Registering Sibelius
You should register your copy of Sibelius in the first few days of using it. This is quick and easy to do, and once you
have registered, you will be eligible for technical help, future upgrades, and access to the Help Center on the Sibelius
website (www.sibelius.com).
Note that to protect us against piracy, and to protect you against having your software stolen, unregistered copies of
Sibelks will not save. But so you can use Sibelius before you get around to registering it, you will be able to save for
the first five days without registering.
You dont have to register in the first five days, but if you dont, saving will be temporarily disabled; when you
subsequently get round to registering, it will be re-enabled. (Please dont try altering your computers date or
reinstalling Sibelius in order to extend the five days; fhls will not work and will instead cause saving to be disabled until
you register.)
How to register
You are given the opportunity to register Sibelius each time you run it, but if you dont want to register immediately,
just click Register Later to leave it unregistered. You can get this dialog again at any time by choosing File h
Register/Transfer ) Register Sibelius.
When you do want to register, you can do so over the Internet, or by fax or phone (details below) - theres no
registration card to return.
Registering s-packs and site licenses
If you are registering 5 or more copies, you cannot currently register on the Internet, although you can register by
phone or fax. For each computer you register you will need a separate Computer Number (beginning with the letter
C), given when you run Sibelius on that computer. You can register any number of copies at the same time (for
instance, if you have a s-pack, you could register two to start with and three later).
If you are registering several copies at once, it may be easiest if you write down on a piece of paper the Sibelius serial
number and Computer Number for each computer, together with the name of the computer. You can then get all the
Registration Numbers at once by phone or fax.
Note: registering by fax or phone may not be available between 24 December and 2 January.
Running Sibelius on more than one computer
You can only register a single copy of Sibelius for use on a single computer.
You can easily move the saving feature of Sibelius from one computer to another (such as to a laptop), and between a
Mac and a PC - see Transferring Sibelius on page 21 for how to do this.
You are also permitted to install an unregistered (non-saving) copy of Sibelius on a second computer for printing
purposes. This is useful if you mainly write music on one computer and print it from another.

Registering Sibelius

Registering on the Internet


If you have an Internet connection, you can register your copy of Sibelius through the Sibelius website
(www.sibelius.com). When you are prompted to register, click Register on the Internet, and your web
browser will be launched. You will be taken to a page on the Sibelius website including a form for you to fill out with
your details.
You will need to type in your serial number (on the back of the Sibelius CD case), Computer Number (shown on the
screen when you run Sibelius, and beginning with the letter C), name, address, and other contact details.
Please fill out all the fields, and make sure that your email address is entered correctly. When you are sure you have all
the information correct, click the Register Now button. You will instantly receive your Registration Number
(beginning with the letter R), which you can then type into the white box on the screen when you start Sibelius. Once
youve typed it in, your program will be registered (and will continue to be able to save). Theres no need to keep a
record of the Registration Number after you have registered.
/Vote for users in I\lorth, Central & South America: if you are registering an educational copy (with a serial number
beginning SCEE) on the Internet, you will not receive your Registration Number instantly; each registration request
must be verified, and you will be advised of your Registration Number via email, phone or fax if you are qualified to
register an educational copy.
Registering by fax
Please fill in and fax the form included in the Sibelius box to the fax number given on the form.
We will fax you back (normally within one working day) with a Registration Number (beginning with the letter R) for
you to type into the white box on the screen when you start Sibelius. Once you have typed in the Registration
Number, your program will be registered (and will continue to be able to save). Theres no need to keep a record of
the Registration Number after you have registered.
Registering by phone
You will need to quote your serial number (on the back of the CD-ROM case, beginning with the letters SC)
and the Computer Number (beginning with the letter C) shown on the screen when you run Sibelius
l

We will also ask for your name, address, and other general information
You will be given a Registration Number (beginning with the letter R) to type into the white box on the screen.
You can type this straight in if you are in front of your computer, or else write it down and type it in later. When
you have typed in the Registration Number, your program will be registered (and will continue to be able to
save). Theres no need to keep a record of the Registration Number after you have registered.

Users who purchased in North, Central & South America: Monday to Friday Tarn-4pm PST, except holidays. Call
l-888-280-9995 toll-free (outside the USA, call l-925-280-0600).
Users who purchased in the UK or any other country.
Monday-Friday (except public holidays) gam-5pm
Saturday

- - - -

call 0 1 2 2 3 707 105 (+44 1223 707105)

5pm-7pm

call 0 1 2 2 3 707 103 (+44 1223 707103)

11 am-4pm

call 0 1 2 2 3 7 0 7 1 0 5 (+44 1223 707105)


19

St rt here
Problems registering Sibelius?
If you have problems registering Sibelius, or experience difficulties transferring the saving function of your copy of
Sibelius to another computer, contact technical help.
Piracy
Thank you for buying your copy of Sibelius legitimately. Please respect our efforts in developing Sibelius by ensuring
that no-one attempts to make illegal copies of it.
Piracy deprives software companies of the revenue needed to improve their programs and develop new products. In
some countries, piracy is so widespread that some companies are unable to justify distributing software at all.
We offer a reward of $1600 or f 1000 for information leading to the successful prosecution of anyone who distributes
illegal copies of Sibelius. If you know of anyone copying Sibelius, please contact Sibelius Software or email
piracy@si belius.com with full details.

20

--

.~_--_.-_--- _._.-.- ~.

Transferring Sibelius

Transferring Sbelius
Transferring the saving feature to another computer
You can only register Sibelius once, so you will only be able to save from one copy of the program. Any further copies
you install will not be able to save (after five days grace) because they are not registered. Fortunately theres a simple
process to transfer the saving feature from one copy of Sibelius to another copy on a different computer.
This means that you could install Sibelius on your desktop computer and your laptop, and transfer saving between the
two copies depending on which one youre using. Theres no need to uninstall Sibelius from either computer or to
re-register - only the saving feature is transferred.
Taking this scenario as an example:
l

Do not uninstall Sibelius from the desktop computer!


Install Sibelius on your laptop (if it isnt already installed), run it, and type in your serial number just as you did
when you first installed Sibelius on your desktop computer
The Sibelius program on the laptop is not registered and so will not save (after the first five days). However,
were now going to transfer saving across from the desktop computer
Choose Transfer Saving Out from Sibeliuss File b Register/Transfer menu on the desktop computer.
It asks for a Computer Number.
Choose Transfer Saving In from the File b Register/Transfer menu on the laptop. Make a note of the
Computer Number given in the dialog.
On the desktop computer, type in this Computer Number (which starts with a C) twice where indicated. It
doesnt matter if you dont type the spaces.
Click OK and youre given a Transfer Number (which starts with a T). Make a note of it very carefully (and check
it). Saving is disabled on the desktop computer. If possible, dont close this dialog until you have successfully
entered the Transfer Number into the other machine in case you wrote it down incorrectly.
Type the Transfer Number into the File b Register/Transfer b Transfer Saving In dialog on the laptop
computer. Saving is now enabled.

The desktop computer copy will still have Sibelius on it but this copy will no longer save. Later you can transfer saving
back to it from the laptop in exactly the same way.
When transferring Sibelius between computers, dont contact us to re-register - its only necessary to register Sibelius
once.
The Computer Number for each installation of Sibelius normally stays the same, so you can transfer saving between
two computers miles apart without having to keep checking the Computer Number. If you make any major change to
your computer, such as installing new memory or hardware, updating the operating system, or reinstalling Sibelius,
the Computer Number may change - if in doubt, look it up in the File b Register/Transfer b Transfer Saving
In dialog.

21

Start here

Dos and Donts


Although the Transfer Saving feature is straightforward, if youre careless theres the danger that you may lose the
ability to save. So:
Dont just delete your copy of Sibelius and think you can just reinstall it - you will have lost the saving feature.
For instance you might want to delete Sibelius to reformat your hard drive. Instead...
Install Sibelius on a different computer, and use Transfer Saving Out to transfer saving to it temporarily. Later you
can transfer it back again.
If you regularly transfer saving between two computers, such as at home and at work, all you need to do is make
a note of the CDs Serial Number and each computers Computer Number. But watch out that the Computer
Numbers may change if you make big changes to the computer or to the copy of Sibelius.
You cant transfer saving between two copies of Sibelius on the same computer. You have to transfer to another
computer, then back again.
You can only transfer saving between copies of Sibelius which were installed with the SOme ser;u/ number (on
the back of the Sibelius CD).
You can only transfer saving between computers running fhe sume version of Sibehs (e.g. both must be
running version 2). Dont try and transfer saving between a computer running Sibelius 1 .x and a computer
running Sibelius 2.

Problems?
We dont want transferring saving to be a hassle for you. If Sibelius becomes corrupted in some way, or if you have
other problems moving Sibelius, please contact technical help for a solution (see the enclosed Technical Help
sheet).

Quick tour

what Sibelius does for you


Sibelius is the state-of-the-art music notation software - a fast, intelligent, easy-to-learn and (not least) fun-to-use
professional program which helps you write, play back and print music.
Sibelius includes sophisticated features for playing in music from a MIDI keyboard (Flexi-time), playing it back with
extraordinary realism (EspressivoTM and RubatoTM), customizing the complete appearance of your scores (house
styles), checking your music for mistakes, and handling the complexities of notations such as guitar tab, microtones,
tuplets and percussion. With a normal printer you can produce truly professional scores, rivaling the highest quality of
the worlds leading publishers.
Sibelius even lets you scan in printed music, publish your scores on the Internet, automatically arrange and orchestrate
for any instruments, convert files from other music programs (such as Finale), and write your own new plug-in
features to do virtually anything you want.
When youre proficient with Sibelius, you will realize that a great deal of the time spent writing music was doing
literally that - physically writing it out. Mechanical tasks like repeating music, transposing it and extracting parts are
done far faster and more accurately if left to Sibelius. Sibelius is like having an intelligent assistant at your side, doing
all the tedious work for you while you provide the creative input - which is, after all, the most enjoyable bit.
We like to say that using Sibelius is 99% inspiration, lo/o perspiration.
About this Quick tour
The Quick tour section will take you through all of Sibeliuss main features - such as printing, playing back and
starting a new score - and introduce all the important concepts you need to understand to make full use of the
program. By the time youve worked through this section, youll have copied out a short piece for piano and arranged
it for orchestral instruments, and youll be ready to get started on your own music.
Most people find that they can learn Sibeliuss main features in a few hours by working through the Quick tour.
After that, the best advice is just to begin writing music. Start with something modest if you like, but you will find that
Sibelius is very accommodating of any mistakes or changes of mind you may make. Theres no need to plan your
score in advance - you could start by writing a piano piece, then gradually add instruments until it is scored for gopiece symphony orchestra with off-stage chorus.
You will probably find it helpful to read to the How to section after the Quick tour, which is a useful quick
summary of how to notate common styles of music in Sibelius.

24

Running for the first time

Running for the first time


On Mac OS, double-click your hard disk icon (by default called Macintosh HD), navigate to the Sibelius 2
folder, probably inside your Applications folder, then double-click the Sibelius for Classic Mac OS
program icon. If you are running Mac OS X, double-click the Sibelius for Mac OS X program icon.

On Windows, click Start at the bottom left of the screen, go into Programs, then into Sibelius Software,
then click Sibelius 2. You may also have a shortcut to Sibelius on your desktop, in which case, just doubleclick the icon.
:e
1
g
-e

If your program is an educational or other special copy, Sibelius will tell you this the first time you run it. Click OK;
Sibelius wont bother you with this again.
Mac users only
On Mac OS, Sibelius isnt fully installed until after it has been run for the first time.
l

g
l

rd
le
><d
lr.
at
ur

On Classic Mac OS, Sibelius will check that the required system software (such as the Carbon library) and the
Sibelius fonts are correctly installed. If system software needs to be installed, you may be prompted to restart
your Mac; after it has restarted, double-click the Sibelius for Classic Mac OS icon again.
On Mac OS X, Sibelius will check that the Sibelius fonts are correctly installed; if they are not, it will install them
for you.

You will then be asked if a previous version of Sibelius is already installed on your machine; click No. Sibelius will
then ask for your serial number, which is printed on the back of your CD-ROM case and begins with the letters SC.
Type it in carefully; it doesnt matter whether or not you type the spaces.
Once you have typed in your serial number, Sibelius will run.

O-

Registering Sibelius
If youve not yet registered your program, youll be given the chance to do so every time you start Sibelius. You
neednt do this now, but its preferable to register within the first five days of using Sibelius, as after this time the
program will not save until you register. To register Sibelius, see Registering Sibelius on page 18.

ck

If you dont want to register now, ignore the stuff at the top of the dialog and just click Register Later. Sibelius
reminds you that saving will be enabled for only five days; click OK.
If you forget to register during the first five days, dont worry - you can learn to use Sibelius without saving, and when
you do get round to registering, saving will be re-enabled.
Splash screen
A pretty Sibelius graphic appears for a few seconds, accompanied by a brief musical excerpt. The excerpt is from
Sibeliuss 7th Symphony, played, appropriately enough, by Finlands Lahti Symphony Orchestra.
(Should you want to silence this music at a later date, switch off Play music at start in the File )
Preferences ) General dialog.)

25

Quick tour

The Devices dialog


When Sibelius has finished loading, a big dialog called Devices appears:

The top half of the dialog, labeled Playback Devices, lists any playback devices you have.
There may well be two or more things listed - such as an internal soundcard and an external MIDI device.
External MIDI devices are normally referred to by the port, and so include the words MIDI Out.
Click Test on each device listed to see how it sounds. You may get no sound if the device is not properly
connected, e.g. if your speakers are not connected to your soundcard or are not switched on.
If more than device is listed, you probably just want to play back through the best-sounding one of them. To do
this, click in the Use column on the other devices, to turn them into No.
The bottom half of the dialog, labeled Input Devices, lists any MIDI input devices you have - i.e. MIDI keyboards.
l

In the unlikely event that you have two or more input devices, you can select the one you want to use in the
small panel on the right of the dialog
Switch on MIDI Thru if and only if your keyboard has no built-in sounds - this will make Sibelius play back
notes played on your keyboard using your soundcard or other playback device
There is a useful indicator which lights up when you play on a MIDI keyboard or other input device. Use this to
check that your keyboard is plugged in correctly.

Now click OK. If you need to change any of these settings again in future, you can see this dialog again by choosing
Play ) Devices from Sibeliuss menus.
For help on connecting external devices to your computer, L!2! MIDI devices in the Reference section.

26

Running for the first time

Tip of the Day


The next (and final) thing that appears is the Tip of the Day dialog, which hopefully tells you something useful you
didnt know already:

If this sort of thing annoys you, switch off Show tip next time, so Sibelius wont trouble you with tips again, then
click OK. (Should you decide that you want to get tips back again after youve switched them off, choose Help b Tip
of the Day, and switch Show tip next time back on.)
When youve dismissed the Tip of the Day, you should see Sibeliuss main window, ready for you to open a score
or start a new one.

27

Quick tour

Look and feel


Opening a file
To help get you started, we have provided some example scores to demonstrate various aspects of Sibelius. You can
modify these without fear of retribution, as the originals remain unaltered on your installation CD-ROM. Lets open
one now.
From Sibelius, click the toolbar button shown to the left, or choose File b Open (shortcut x0 or
Ctrl+O).
A standard Open dialog appears. You should find that you are inside a folder called Scores, which will contain a
number of other folders. Go into the Other folder, select the score called Quick tour, and then click Open. This is
a single-page excerpt from a rag by Scott Joplin called Something Doing.
(On Mac, the Scores folder is inside your Sibelius program folder; on Windows, the Scores folder is inside your
My Documents folder.)
As an aside, you can also open scorgs when Sibelius isnt running - just find the file on your computer and
double-click it to open it in Sibelius (automatically starting Sibelius if it isnt already running). Sibelius scores
have icons which look like the one pictured on the right.
When youve opened the score, the music appears, looking somewhat like this:

I
Toolbc

-7 Navigator

28

Keypad & Properties

1 ook and fee/

Moving around the score


At the bottom left-hand corner of the screen is a gray rectangle called the
navigator. This shows a miniature view of some of the pages. The white rectangle
on the navigator shows which portion of the music is shown on the screen.
l

Click the navigator, and the window will instantaneously jump to that part of
the score
Alternatively, click the white rectangle and drag it around, which pans the window smoothly around the score.
This effect is very striking and enhances the disconcerting impression that you are moving a video camera
around a real score. On a typical computer the screen redraw time is just l/lath of a second or less!
In long scores, if you drag the white rectangle off the right-hand side of the navigator, the view of the score will
continue to move rightwards, and the navigator will display one page further on. This allows you to move
continuously across any number of pages.
You can also move the paper without using the navigator, by clicking a blank part of the paper and dragging it
around.

By moving around the score with the navigator, you can see that pages are laid side-by-side on a black marble desk.
With long scores, pages are joined in pairs as if in a score opened flat, so you can see where page-turns will occur.
By default, there are no scroll bars, because the navigator is a much quicker and easier way of moving around the
music though you can switch on scroll bars if you want them, from the View menu.
Notice that the paper on the screen is textured, which makes it easier on the eye. As well show you later on, you can
choose between a wide range of different paper and desk colors, textures and materials - even parchment or wood! In
Sibelius, the whole experience of music on the screen is so realistic that we call it Virtual Manuscript Paper.
If moving around the score is slow, try setting the paper and/or background textures to plain colors (by choosing Use
color not texture in the View b Textures dialog) - see Customizing the screen below.
Keyboard shortcuts
Sibelius is full of keyboard shortcuts which let you perform an action by typing a key rather than using the mouse. Its
a good idea to learn keyboard shortcuts at least for the most common operations - these are listed on the mouse pad
which comes with Sibelius. When you are able to use Sibelius using all available shortcuts and almost entirely without
the mouse, you will have attained the privileged status of power user!
The first shortcuts to learn are for the navigator:
0

Page Up (T on some Mac keyboards) and Page Down (a on Mac) move up or down a screenful
Home (K on Mac) and End (Y on Mac) move left or right a screenful. 8%K or Ctrl+Home and 8%Y or
Ctrl+End go to the first or last page. (Some Mac keyboards do not have a Y (End) key, in which case you can
use 6f~ instead to go right a screenful, and 6%~ to go to the last page.)

0 Pearl of wisdom Avoid using the mouse - learn and use as many keyboard shortcuts as you can! The
mouse is only absolutely required for a very limited number of operations. There are many keyboard shortcuts, some
of which are not obvious but work wonders (e.g. creating and positioning slurs using just the letter S and space).

29

Quick tour

The toolbar
At the top of the screen, below the menus, you will see the Sibelius toolbar. This gives you quick access to important
functions such as saving, printing and playback. The buttons are as follows:

If its not obvious what some of these buttons actually do, dont worry - well come to them again later on.
Zooming
To adjust the magnification of the score, click the Zoom magnifying glass on the toolbar, then click on the score to
zoom in and x-click or right-click to zoom out. Hold Shift to zoom repeatedly. Its even quicker to use the keyboard
shortcuts: type #+ or Ctrl++ to zoom in, or 8%- or Ctrl+- to
zoom out. You can also select a particular zoom factor from the
toolbar, or type in your own.
Zoom in very close on a note, or onto the top right-hand corner of
the first page - notice how you can see a whole stack of pages.
Try zooming out so that you can see the whole page of music on
your screen. Then zoom back in to loo%, which is a convenient size
for doing most things in Sibelius.
The keypad
The keypad at the bottom right of the screen is where you choose note values, accidentals, articulations, ties and
other markings for creating and editing notes. (Articulations are symbols above or below a note such as staccato,
tenuto and accent. Note value means the length of a note. These and other musical and technical terminology are in
the Glossary.)

30

Look and fee/

The keypad is just one panel of the Properties window, which has seven panels in all. You can
open and close each panel by clicking on its title, e.g. General. Youll be using the keypad most
often, but the other panels allow you to perform a variety of editing operations on your score;
dont worry about these other panels now.
The numeric keys at the right of your computer keyboard correspond to the buttons on the
keypad. Typing these keys does exactly the same as clicking the buttons with the mouse, and is
quicker. (If you like you could put little stickers on your keyboard showing you what these keys do,
although a glance at the keypad on the screen shows you.)
The five little tabs just below the bar that says Keypad choose between five different layouts of
musical symbols on the keypad, which well call the first layout, second layout, etc. To change
layout, you can either click the tabs with the mouse, hit F8-F12, or click the
+) to cycle through the layouts; the button (shortcut - on Mac, F8 on Windows) goes back to the first layout.
Have a quick look through to see whats in the other layouts - fairly obscure stuff. The first layout is the one youll be
using most of the time.
Note that, because the numeric keypad is used for specific functions in Sibelius, you cant switch off Num Lock to
use the number keys as alternative arrow keys etc. while using Sibelius, as you can with other programs,
Well explain more about the keypad shortly.
The menus
At the top of the screen are Sibeliuss menus (you will be startled to hear). Well explain everything on them in due
course, but for the time being take a quick look through them now.
The menu youll be using the most is Create, which is used to obtain any musical marking not on the keypad, such
as time signatures, clefs, text, etc.
Customizing the screen
You can easily change how your Sibelius program looks on screen, Try switching off View h Toolbar, Window h
Properties and Window ) Navigator to free up more space on the screer . (On Mac, you can also turn off the
Navigator and Properties windows by clicking on their close boxes). Now, this realI<y is Virtual Manuscript Paper!
When youre proficient with Sibelius and have learned more keyboard shortcuts, you will be able to use the program
entirely like this. Turn these three options back on again from the View and Window menus in the same way.
Incidentally, on Windows, you can go one step further towards Virtual Manuscript Paper - switch on View h Full
Screen (shortcut Ctrl+U) and your entire screen will be taken up by the music. This makes the menus disappear to
save space, but you can reveal them again by moving your mouse to the very top of the screen.
Note that there is no View h Full Screen option on the Mac, because it is considered impolite to hide the menus!
Windows has no such qualms.
Textures and translucent windows
You can further customize the appearance of your screen by changing the textures used for the virtual paper and desk
you work on. On some computers, using textures may slow Sibelius down a bit, so if you find navigating around the
31

Quick tour

score sluggish, first choose View b Textures and try switching on Alternative texture drawing, which may
speed things up. If not, set both Paper and Desk to Use color not texture, which will speed things up
significantly.
On Windows 2000 and XP, the navigator, Mixer and Properties window are all translucent by default. If you dont
like the effect, switch it off by choosing Window b Translucent Windows.
Display settings
Its worth spending a few moments finding the best display settings for your monitor. It helps to set a fairly high
resolution (e.g. 1024 x 768 pixels or higher) so that you can see more music on the screen.
Generally, Sibelius is faster the fewer colors your display is set to, particularly on older hardware, although many
newer graphics cards are optimized to display higher color depths more quickly. Experiment with different color
depths and see which works best for you.
To change display settings on Mac, use the Monitors & Sound Control Panel (within the Apple menu), or use the
control strip at the bottom of your desktop. To change display settings on Windows, choose Start b Settings b
Control Panel and double-click on Display.
Its also a good idea to switch on font smoothing (or anti-aliasing, as its officially known). This makes text and things
like clefs and noteheads look better. Font smoothing is switched on by default in Mac OS, but if for some reason it has
been switched off, turn it on in the Fonts page of the Appearance control panel. On Windows, font smoothing is
controlled from the Effects tab of the Display Control Panel applet; it is switched off by default, so we recommend
you switch it on. Windows XP includes an improved font smoothing system called ClearType, which you can switch on
in the same way.
Speed tips
Lets just summarize a few of the ways you can improve the speed at which Sibelius runi on your computer:
l

If dragging the paper seems slow, switch off the paper and desk textures (see Textures and translucent
windows above). You could also try switching your screen display to use fewer colors (see Display
settings above) and, if youre using Windows 2000 or XP, switch off Window b Translucent
Windows.
If selecting objects seems slow, close up any open panels on the Properties window youre not specifically
using, or hide it completely by choosing View b Properties (shortcut #I or Ctrl+l). You may also find that
switching off rulers in the View menu speeds things up too (IQZI View menu in the Reference section).
On Windows, using Adobe Type 1 (PostScript) versions of the Opus and Inkpen fonts can also slow down the
time it takes to redraw the screen - so wherever possible use TrueType fonts. (These are installed by default, so
unless youve specifically changed the fonts Sibelius should use, you dont need to worry about this.)

Multiple monitors
You can run Sibelius with more than one monitor attached to your computer. This is very useful as you can open a
different score on each monitor, or have your music on one screen and the navigator and keypad on the other. Note
that on Mac, the navigator and keypad always go on the same monitor as the menu bar, but you can use the
Monitors & Sound control panel (within the Apple menu) to specify which monitor the menu bar appears on.
32

__ _____~ -

Playback

Playback
Now you are familiar with the look and feel of Sibelius, lets play back some music.
Click the Play toolbar button or type P (not B%P or Ctrl+P, just plain P) to start the music, which should
begin to play back. You can also find this function in the Play menu, but who needs menus?
If you get no sound at all, EL!! MIDI devices in the Reference section to configure your playback devices.
Youll see a vertical line passing through the music to indicate the position as it plays. The score moves around to
follow the music. If there are several instruments, Sibelius tracks those that were on the screen when you started
playback.
Playback tools
During playback, the following tools appear:

Click the appropriate buttons to pause, fast-forward or rewind. Rewinding plays the music backwards (or kind of
backwards). Alternatively, use the one-key shortcuts Esc (stop), P (play or pause), t (rewind) and 3 (fast-forward).
The fast-forward and rewind toolbar buttons accelerate in speed if you hold them down.
You can drag the tempo slider to alter the speed, which is displayed at the right-hand side of the toolbar. When the
sliders in the middle, Sibelius precisely follows any metronome marks written in the score.
Sibelius multitasks while playing back, so you can drag the paper (directly or with the navigator) to get a better view
while its playing, or zoom in and out with the x+/- or Ctrl++/- shortcuts. Its often useful to zoom out to 50% or
75% when playing back I so you can see most or all of a page while still being able to read the music.
You can even go and work on another score while the first one continues playing back!
When youve had enough of playback, hit Esc to stop. If your computer or playback device isnt fast enough to cope
with rewinding or fast-forwarding at high speed, it may occasionally leave a note hanging on when you stop, but
should this happen you can choose Play b AlI Notes Off (shortcut Shift-O).
Performance
You will have noticed that Sibelius takes notice of more than just the notes and accidentals as it plays back: it follows
the metronome marking (J = 80); it plays the written dynamics and hairpins; and it plays the accents too.
We like to think that Sibeliuss playback is so life-like that it doesnt just play back your score - it performs it!
33

Quick tour

Some of the more advanced playback effects Sibelius knows about are trills, glissando lines, ritjaccel. markings,
tempos like Andante, Fast and Poco allargando, and even text like FI. to change to a flute sound, plzz. to
change to a pizzicato string sound, and mute to make, say, a trumpet play with a muted sound.
Whats more, you can alter the effect of musical text, and even add your own new words to Sibeliuss playback
dictionary. Advanced users can type MIDI messages (such as control changes) directly into the score using text
commands.
More details of all of this is in the Reference section, but for now lets look briefly at perhaps the three most
exciting of all Sibeliuss playback features: Espressivo (Italian for expressively), Rubato (meaning varying the tempo),
and rhythmic feel.
EspressivoTM
Music notation programs normally play back only whats explicitly written in the score. They get the notes and some
other markings right, but nothing else. This way of playing may get you a pass mark in your music exam, but is not
enough to produce an award-winning performance - it sounds just too mechanical and lifeless.
However, Sibeliuss unique Espressivo feature uses artificial intelligence to produce a human-like performance of your
music. When you switch Espressivo on, Sibelius analyzes the music as it plays it back, and adds phrasing and
expression just as a human performer would.
Lets try Espressivo out:
Open the file called Boogie Meccanico (in the Performance Style folder inside the Scores folder).
This has Espressivo switched to Meccanico (mechanically) which tells Sibelius to play back the score literally,
without adding any extra expression.
Play the score back, and note how it sounds
Next, open Boogie Espressivo, which has exactly the same mu c but with Espressivo set to Molto
espressivo (very expressively), plus the swing rhythmic feel switc Ked on, some reverb, and SoundStage
(which spreads instruments in 3D space)
Now play back the score, and hear the difference! Even though no dynamics or expression are marked, Sibelius
invents a realistic performance as it plays, just like a human musician.
To change the Espressivo setting in your score, choose Play ) Performance (shortcut Shift-P).
RubatoTM
Rubato is the rhythmic counterpart to Espressivo. Sibelius can subtly vary the tempo of your score to add greater
expression, in much the same way as a human performer would.
Open the Chopin Meccanico score from the Performance Style folder within the Scores folder, and play it
back. Then open the Chopin Rubato score (in the same folder) and play it back to hear the effect of Rubato.
Rubato isnt suitable for all types of music, but it can produce a very striking effect - to add Rubato to your score,
choose Play ) Performance (shortcut Shift-P).

34

I
~~

----r------ --- --____

__~_ -- --.---- -

-~ --- ____ __ ___


Playback

Rhythmic feel
You can further adjust the playback of your score using one of Sibeliuss built-in rhythmic feel settings. Lets give this
a try, Close any other scores you might have open, so that youre just looking at the Scott Joplin Quick tour score.
Choose Play b Performance (shortcut Shift-P) and from the Rhythmic feel drop-down menu, choose
Swing 1 Gths. Click OK, then hit P to play back the score and hear the effect.
(Purists may argue that it is a cardinal sin to play ragtime with a swing. We do this purely for illustrative purposes!)
Mixer
You may also have noticed during playback that the instruments sound like they are at different stereo positions - this
is Sibeliuss unique SoundStage feature at work, which positions instruments in 3-D space as if set out on a concert
stage.
You can also adjust the position, volume, sound etc. of each instrument yourself from Sibeliuss Mixer window. For a
glimpse of this power at your fingertips, choose Play b Mixer or type the shortcut M.

Type M again to close the Mixer.


Specifying what to play back
If nothing is selected in your score, Sibelius will play back the full score from the beginning. To ensure nothing is
selected, click on a blank part of the paper, or hit Est.
l

To play from a particular place in the score rather than the start, select a note before hitting P.
You can also play any instrument on its own - click a blank part of a bar in the instrument so the bar is enclosed
in a blue box, then hit P.
You can even play any combination of instruments - simply click a blank part of a bar in the first instrument, and
X-click or Ctrl+click in the other staves you want to play back. They dont have to be adjacent, so in an
orchestral score you could play back, say, just the flutes, horns and cellos.

Further information
E!2 Playback in the Reference section for more about playback. Q2 Performance has more details about
Espressivo, Rubato and rhythmic feel. Q2 Mixer tells you how to use the Mixer window.

35

Quick tour

Basic editing
Before creating any music of your own, lets try out some basic techniques by editing our Quick tour score.
One-key shortcuts
An aside: Sibelius makes full use of one-key shortcuts - that is, shortcuts which dont require you to hold Shift or
other funny keys. Some examples weve already met are the playback controls (Esc P t +), and in this section
well be introduced to the numeric keypad in detail.
The clear benefit of one-key shortcuts is that you can type them quickly with one hand, without adopting awkward
claw-Ii ke hand positions.
Selecting objects
Almost everything that Sibelius can do can be done using the mouse, so lets try that before using keys. Click a note in
the score (you have to point at the oval notehead itself). It turns blue. If the color doesnt show up clearly, adjust the
controls on your monitor.
Anything you can click on like this is called an object, and choosing an object is called selecting it. Once an object is
selected, you can do things to it such as delete it, edit (change) it, copy it or move it.
When you select a note, notice how Sibelius plays it with the correct instrumental sound - instant feedback in case
you made a mistake.
Try selecting all sorts of different objects in the score - selectable objects include notes, rests, text, barlines, time
signatures, slurs and so on. To deselect an object, click an empty part of the paper or hit Est. However, theres no
need to deselect an object when youve finished doing something to it.
As we mentioned, you can also select objects with the keyboard - hit Tab to select the first object on the page, then
use the arrow keys to move around the score. -\I+/$ or AIt++/+ moves up and down through noteheads of a
chord (if any) and then onto the staff above or below; $I%/+ or Ctrl+t/+ moves left and right a bar at a time.
There are lots of other keyboard shortcuts for moving around the score - LQ Keyboard shortcuts in the
Reference section for a complete list!
Moving objects
Go back to the start of the Quick tour score, and click the notehead of the first note, which looks like this:

Drag the note up to look like this:

36

-----------

______~ _~___ - ____. -- - _~~~_

_ __ --_. ..-.. -

-Basic editing

Notice how, as you drag, leger lines appear and disappear, the slur leaps about and t .he stems of the first two notes
change direction - always ensuring that the music is correctly notated.
Now try dragging other notes up and down at random. If you drag a note up or down a long way onto lots of leger
lines, the note turns red. This warns you that the note is too high or low for the instrument (here, a piano) to play.
Sibelius knows the ranges of all instruments, and you can alter them yourself for performers of different abilities if you
like.
Instead of dragging, you can move notes up and down with + and \L, or type #+/$ or Ctrl++/\l/ to move by
an octave. Try this, too.
Notes out of range (i.e. colored red) dont go blue when you select them because you need to see theyre red when
you drag a note out of range. But you can turn the option off by choosing View 1 Note Colors b None if you
want to see them clearly when they are selected.
Moving staves
Something you may have just discovered by accident is that Sibelius lets you drag any staff up and down. This
powerful feature is invaluable in helping you to produce clear layout.
Zoom out to 500/o, click a staff (away from any notes) and drag it up and down - the whole score will instantly
reformat as you drag. This glimpse of Sibeliuss hidden power is enough for now - more about formatting later.
Zoom back in to lOOo/o.
Deleting and cutting
Try selecting various objects, then deleting them with the Delete key:
l

delete a slur (from the lower half of the page)


delete a piece of text (from the top of the page)
delete a note: it turns into a rest, to ensure that the rhythm is still correct.

You can delete a rest, which hides it, and leaves the rest of the rhythm still aligned as if the rest were still there. You
shouldnt normally hide rests but it can sometimes be useful for special notations. Other objects can also be hidden.
Hidden objects are shown in gray (by default) but not printed at all.
You can also use Backspace to delete objects, or choose Edit b Delete.
Edit b Cut (shortcut XX or Ctrl+X) is similar to Delete, but cuts objects to the clipboard so that you can re-paste
them elsewhere with Edit b Paste (shortcut 8%V or Ctrl+V). This is not used much in Sibelius, so theres no need
to try it now.
37

Quick tour

Undo and Redo


After deleting something, click the left-arrow toolbar button, or choose Edit ) Undo
(shortcut 6t%Z or Ctrl+Z). This undoes the last operation you did, and should make the
deleted object miraculously reappear. This is a whole lot easier than going back and correcting
a mistake. Sibelius supports multi-level undo - try typing 6t%Z or Ctrl+Z a number of times to see your score rebuild
itself. Click the right-arrow toolbar button or choose Edit ) Redo (shortcut 8%Y or Ctrl+Y) to redo whatever you
just undid.
,

Sibelius even includes an undo history which lists all the operations youve recently done, and lets you jump back to
any earlier point in time. More details are in Q2 Undo and Redo in the Reference section.
Copying
There are three ways to copy objects, which you should try:
l

x-click or Alt+click: select a note, point at a rest somewhere else on the screen and do x-click or Alt+click
(i.e. hold down 71 or Alt and then click). The note is copied to where you clicked, and ends up identical other
than the pitch, which is taken from how high up on the staff you clicked.
You can copy any other object with x-click or Alt+click, too - this is the recommended method of copying
objects. You can even copy many bars of music at once - something well come onto later.
On Windows, if you have a third (i.e. middle) mouse button, you can use it instead of Alt+click to do a copy and
paste in a single action - switch on Enable pasting with mouse in File ) Preferences ) General. If
you only have a two-button mouse, turning on this option allows you to perform a chord-click, that is, clicking
the left and right mouse buttons simultaneously, to duplicate the function of the middle mouse button.
Edit ) Repeat (shortcut R): select a note, passage or other object and hit R. This repeats any note, chord, text
or various other objects after itself.
Edit ) Copy (shortcut %C or Ctrl+C): this is the traditional way to copy music to the clipboard, followed by
Edit ) Paste (shortcut B%V or Ctrl+V) to paste it elsewhere. This method is slower than the previous ones
and so is not recommended, except for copying music between different scores (because x-click or Alt+click
only copies within the same score).
These Edit menu functions are also available on the context-sensitive menu you get by Control-click or rightclicking when one or more objects is selected.

Editing notes with the keypad


All of the keypad keys instantly modify the selected note - e.g. to add/remove an accidental, articulation or tie. Just
select a note, then choose a keypad button to add an object to the note, or remove it again.
Lets try it:
Select the B flat just before the B natural at the end of the third full bar of Quick tour
Click the > button on the keypad, or hit the corresponding key on the numeric keypad. This adds an accent to
the note.
Drag the note up to E in the staff - notice that the accent moves with the note, and ends up
back down again,
38

it. Drag it

Basic editing
l

Click the natural sign, or hit 7 (on the numeric keypad) to add a natural. Notice how Sibelius then removes the
redundant accidental from the next note - but it will still play back as a B natural. To test this, retype 7, which
removes the natural from the first note. The second notes natural is now no longer redundant, so it reappears.
Hit 7 once more to reinstate the natural on the first note.
Click the tie button or hit Enter. This puts a tie after the first note. Well show you how to edit the actual note
value of a note later.

You should end up with:

If none of this seems to work properly then you probably werent in the first keypad layout, in which case just click the
first layout tab (or hit F8) and try again.
Note that keys on the numeric keypad appear to be the same as keys on the main keyboard, but in fact do different
things. For instance, 8 on the numeric keypad produces a sharp, but 8 on the main keyboard doesnt. From now on,
when were talking about the keypad, assume youll be typing any keys on the numeric keypad unless told otherwise.
0 Pearl of wisdom As with other keyboard shortcuts, learn to use the numeric keys to choose things from the
keypad rather than using the mouse. The best way to learn (which you neednt try just ye0 is to put your mouse in
an inconvenient place such as on the floor, then see how long you can survive without if!
Brief recap
Youve learned about the navigator, toolbar and keypad
l

Youve learned how to zoom, play back, and undo


Select any object just by clicking it, then move, copy, edit or delete it
Copy objects with x-click or Alt+click or R (Edit b Repeat)
Youve learned how to move notes with the mouse or arrows, and how to edit their accidentals and articulations
with the keypad
You should gradually learn to use keyboard shortcuts wherever possible, particularly the numeric keys and other
one-key shortcuts. Each time your hand instinctively reaches for the mouse, read the Sibelius mouse pad for the
shortcut instead!

Quick tour

Printing
Before we start to write our first score, lets print out our Joplin Quick tour example which came from the Other
folder (inside your Scores folder). If its still littered with changes from the editing youve just been doing, close it
(clicking No when asked if you want to save the changes) and then open it again.
Printing a score
To print, just click the button on the toolbar shown on the left, or choose File b Print (shortcut B%P or
Ctrl+P). A fairly standard dialog box appears. Dont worry about all the options - just click Print on Mac
or OK on Windows to print your score.
(As an aside, when dialogs like Print are open you can also just hit Return on the main keyboard instead of clicking
OK, Print, Create or whatever; hitting Esc does the same as clicking the Cancel button.
Within a few moments, a high-quality printout of the Quick tour score should emerge from your printer,
If you ran into any problems, refer to EQ Printing in the Reference section for help.
Advanced printing
Sibelius can handle a lot of complex printing operations for you: it can automatically create booklets or spreads of your
scores; it can automatically scale down music written on, say, Tabloid or A3 paper to fit onto Letter or A4 paper; and it
can even print in color, assuming, of course, that you have a color printer!
Try this out - open the Graphics & Color example score, from
the Education folder, and print it. It doesnt matter too much if
you dont have a color printer - it will produce shades of gray
instead. When you print, make sure that you switch on Print
View menu options in the File b Print dialog.
This example score shows off two of Sibeliuss useful advanced
features: importing color graphics (I&Q! Importing graphics
in the Reference section), and the pitch spectrum option to
color notes @!!I View menu in the Reference section).

40

Starting a new score

Starting a new score


You can get rid of the example score now, so close it by choosing File b Close (shortcut %W or Ctrl+W), or by
clicking the close box in the top corner of the editing window. If you are asked if you want to save the changes, click
No.
If you want to open this score again quickly, the File menu contains a I ist of the five scores youve worked on most
recently.
To start a new score, click the icon on the toolbar shown on tl le left, or choose File b New (shortcut B%N
or Ctd+N). A dialog headed New Score appears.
Manuscript paper
This dialog lists many types of manuscript paper in alphabetical order. Just like selecting
real manuscript paper in a store, you can choose between different shapes and sizes, or
pick paper which is pre-printed with standard groups of instruments.
If youre writing for a standard ensemble, its a good idea to use one of Sibeliuss built-in
manuscript papers rather than defining your own, because the supplied templates have
numerous helpful defaults, such as special instrument name formats, optimal staff sizes
and so on, already set up for you. Later you can create your own manuscript papers. To
start a piano score its quickest to use Piano Letter or Piano A4 manuscript paper,
but for the moment just click Letter (a blank manuscript paper) followed by OK. (Letter
and Tabloid are standard US paper sizes, A4 and A3 are standard European sizes.)

Letter [larger notesl


Marching Band Letter
M rlitary Band Tabloid

R & B Band Tabloid


Strrng Quartet A4
Stung Quartet Letter
Tabloid
Wrnd Quartet A4
Wind Quartet Letter

A page of white blank paper appears, with a dialog headed Instruments.


Creating instruments
You can create new instruments whenever you like - you dont need to decide them all at the start - but you do have
to pick at least one instrument initially otherwise youll have nothing to write music for!
$x&n:

Instrument:

!nstrumsnts to creakee;

41

Quick tour
Click the different types of instruments in the Section list at the left. By default, Sibelius shows you the common
instruments, which number around 150; however, if youre itching to write for more obscure instruments such as
Quint Bassoon, Ondes Martenot or Hurdy-Gurdy, click AlI instruments to display the complete set of more than
300 instruments. Dont worry if you cant find a particularly unusual instrument - Sibelius also lets you design your
own.
The instruments are listed in the standard order in which they would appear in a score, but again you can customize
the order if you want to.
Were going to input the Scott Joplin score we printed out earlier, so the only instrument we need for now is the
piano. You should find that, by default, Keyboards is selected in the Section list, and Piano is selected in the
instruments list, which means that you just need to click Add to put the piano in the rightmost Instruments to
create list. Then click OK.
Two piano staves will appear instantly, with the correct names, clefs, and a few empty bars ready for you to start
writing music in:

To enable you to see the next developments more clearly, zoom out to 25% so you can see the whole page very
small.
Adding more bars
The easiest way to add bars to your score is using %fB or Ctrl+B (the shortcut for Create h Bar h At End), which
adds an extra bar at the end of the score.
Type %fB or Ctrl+B slowly a few times, and watch carefully what happens.
Then tap #B or Ctrl+B lots of times to put in a stream of bars. (If your computer is fairly slow, it may continue
adding bars for a few seconds after you release the keys.)
When you have three or four pages, survey the scene with the zoom tool and navigator, then zoom back in to 1000/o.
In case you werent paying attention, in the course of adding bars Sibelius was continuously reformatting the score to
produce the best possible result - it spread the music onto new systems (staves joined together which are played
42

____-_...--- __ ---... - ~_
Starting a new score

simultaneously) when the first system got too full, and created more pages when the first page got too full. Also,
Sibelius juggled the bars around to distribute them evenly through the score, and wrote bar numbers at the start of
each system.
The only problem now is filling up all that blank space with notes.
0 Pearl of wisdom Noneed to plan in advance! You can add extra instruments or extra bars at any time. Its
fine to start writing a score with just one instrument and a few bars - you dont have to create lots of bars at the
outset. As you add more music later, Sibelius will instantly reformat if for you!
Key signatures and time signatures
You can add or change key and time signatures at any point while working on your score, but we only need a simple
time signature and key at the beginning:
If youve just added some bars, hit Esc to deselect the last bar you added,
and go back to the start of your score by typing %& or Ctrl+Home
l

Choose Create k Key Signature, or just type the one-key shortcut K


A dialog appears, showing pictures of the sharp and flat key signatures.

If you want to switch between major and minor keys, click the buttons on the
left
l

For now, just click F major in the Flats list, then click OK

The mouse pointer turns blue, showing that its carrying an object which
can be clicked down onto your score
l

[-.--T--J
Cericef J
l

Click just to the right of the clef on either staff at the start of the score

A key signature of one flat appears at the start of every staff, throughout the score.

Creating a time signature is very similar:


l

Lets go straight for the shortcut this time - just type T (or choose
Create ) Time Signature if you want to use the menus)
We want a 2/4 time signature with a pick-up (upbeat) bar of a single
eighth note (quaver), so first click 2/4, then switch on Start with
bar of length and choose the eighth note from the drop-down
menu
Click OK or hit Return
Click at the start of the score, just to the right of the key signature.

Most objects in Sibelius can be created using this very simple method. Sibelius uses its built-in music engraving rules
to ensure that the objects go in a sensible musical place and continue to look right, whatever changes you make to the
score.
0 Pear/ of wisdom Control-click (Mac) or right-click (Windows) any blank part of the paper to get the
Create menu - much quicker than moving your mouse to the menu at the top of the screen. (But using the onekey shortcuts to create objects is quicker still!)

.---__- -- Inputting notes

Creating notes
Before we get started on creating notes, a little background information. There are no fewer than five ways to get
music into Sibelius, as follows:
Mouse input - using only the mouse to create notes, add markings, move and copy things
Alphabetic and step-time input - using either the computer keyboard alone, or in conjunction with your MIDI
keyboard, to input the music
Flex;-time input - recording the music directly into Sibelius in real time from your MIDI keyboard
Scanning - turn printed music into a Sibelius score using the scanning program PhotoScore Lite
Opening music files from other programs - convert music in other formats, including MIDI, Finale and SCORE,
into Sibelius.
Well concentrate on the first three methods listed above. If youre interested in scanning sheet music, see
QJ Scanning in the Reference section. If you want to find out more about opening music files from other
programs, there are a number of relevant topics in the Reference section, such as Q2 Opening MIDI files
and Q2l Opening Finale, Allegro and PrintMusic files.

45

_I
n
3F

You should be looking at the start of your new piano score. If youre not, zoom in to 100% and move to the first bar
of the score.
Creating some notes
Well choose our first note from the keypad. First, ensure nothing in your score is selected, by hitting Est. Click the
sixteenth note (semiquaver) symbol on the keypad with the mouse, or type 2 on the numeric keypad (which does the
same thing). The mouse pointer turns blue, to show that it is carrying a sixteenth note.
Now click the mouse pointer near the start of the right-hand piano staff, pointing at the F space, first space up:

Piano

If you clicked in the wrong place, you can use /t\ and J/ to adjust the pitch of the note after youve inputted it.
Notice that Sibelius has helpfully padded out the pick-up (upbeat) bar with a rest, so that the bar still adds up. Notice
also that the note you just added is blue, and a vertical blue line - called the caret - is just on the right of it.
The caret
The caret means that Sibelius is ready for you to input more notes. You should think of the caret
like the flashing caret familiar from word processing software.
The caret is especially useful for alphabetic input, which well come on to a little later, so well
explain exactly what it does then.
Adding more notes
The sixteenth note (semiquaver) button on the keypad stays selected, so you can carry on creating more notes by
clicking with the mouse - you dont need to re-choose the sixteenth note button. Input the first few notes of the righthand part, shown below (or read off the page you printed earlier); when you need to add an eighth note (quaver),
simply click the appropriate button on the keypad (or type 3 on the numeric keypad) before you click in the score to
add the note. You should end up with:

The next note is a sixteenth note tied to a quarter note (crotchet). Add the sixteenth note as normal, then
click the tie button on the keypad (shown on the right), or type Enter on the numeric keypad, which does
the same thing. Now click the quarter note on the keypa d (or type 4) and click in the score to input it:
46

-- --

Mouse input

Piano
t
If at any point you make a mistake, you can just click the left-arrow toolbar button or choose Edit b
Undo (shortcut B%Z or Ctrl+Z) one or more times to undo what you just did.
Accidentals
In the second full bar we need to write a C#. To do this with the mouse, simply choose the sharp button (or type 8
on the numeric keypad) before you click in the score to add the note:

Piano

You can also add accidentals to notes after youve inputted them. Lets try this. If you can see the caret, hit Esc once
to stop creating notes (Esc stops creating notes, playback, etc., or deselects the selected object). You can now change
(edit) the characteristics of notes and other objects already in your score. Click on one of the other notes in the first
couple of bars so that it turns blue, then click the accidental buttons on the keypad - try clicking the flat button
(shortcut 9), then click it again to remove the accidental. You can also add and remove articulations and even change
the note length in exactly the same way.
Continue creating the notes in the right-hand staff: first hit Esc to deselect the note youve just been adding
accidentals to, then click the sixteenth note (semiquaver) button on the keypad, and click in the score to input more
notes.
Rests
In the fourth full bar we encounter our first rest. Creating a rest during mouse input is simple: select the value of the
rest as normal using the keypad, then click the button with the rest symbols on it (shortcut 0) to tell Sibelius you want
to input a rest, and click in the score.
Articulations
Also in the fourth full bar we need to write a chord, and we also need to add our first articulation. Remember that if
we want to add attributes to notes, such as accidentals or articulations, its best to choose them before creating the
note, rather than going back and adding them afterwards.
Articulations can be found on the first and fourth keypad layouts. The marcato (or hat if you prefer) articulation we
need is on the fourth layout. If youre not familiar with how the keypad works, skip back to Look and feel for an
introduction.

Having chosen the marcato articulation on the fourth keypad layout (shortcut Fl 1 ), choose the eighth note (quaver)
button on the first keypad layout (shortcut F8) if its no longer highlighted, then use the mouse to input the four
notes of the chords one above the other, like this:
47

Quick tour

When creating notes with accidentals or articulations, it doesnt matter in what order you choose the accidental,
articulation and note value on the keypad, so long as you choose them all before you actually input the note by
clicking on the staff.
A little copying
It wont have escaped your notice that the music in the first couple of bars of the score is doubled in octaves between
the hands. Rather than input the same music twice, lets copy the right-hand music into the left-hand staff.
First, if you can see the caret, hit Esc to get rid of it. Now click on the very first note in the right-hand staff, and
carefully Shift-click (i.e. hold down the Shift key and click the left mouse button) on the second of the tied G
sixteenth notes (semiquavers) in the third full bar. You should see a single blue box surrounding all the intervening
notes:

Now x-click or Alt+click at the start of the left-hand staff to copy the notes across, and youll see this:

Now type %?\L/ or Ctrl+J/ to transpose the notes down an octave to the correct pitch.
Incidentally, this is the first time youve selected a passage of music. A passage is a group of one or more bars, maybe
running over many pages. You can select any group of bars, either along one staff or several. Youll most often select a
passage in order to copy music from one instrument to another, perhaps because theyre doubling each other.
Passages allow you to edit, copy or delete lots of notes at once. Well come on to them in more detail a little later.
This is also the first time youve encountered the %% or Ctrl key when editing. In Sibelius, X or Ctrl with an arrow
key generally means move in big steps - for example, to change the pitch of a note by a single step, you use /t/$,
and to change the pitch of a note by an octave, you use #+/$ or Ctrl++/& Many operations in Sibelius conform
to this principle, such as moving other objects (such as text), increasing or decreasing note spacing, and so on.
48

Mouse input

Finishing creating notes


Finish writing the first four full bars using the mouse (reading off the page you printed earlier). When youve finished,
hit Esc twice: the first time dismisses the caret, which tells Sibelius that you dont want to create any more notes, and
the second time deselects the last note you created (you can also achieve this by clicking on a blank bit of paper).
If you forget to do this, then Sibelius will continue creating notes wherever you click - though you can spot that this
will happen because a blue mouse pointer always tells you that Sibelius is about to create an object.
Brief recap
To create notes with the mouse, select the note value and any other attributes such as accidentals and
articulations before clicking in the score. Only ties and triplets (or other tuplets, which well come onto later)
need to be added after the note has been inputted
If you can see the caret, Sibelius is ready for you to create notes
Often, the quickest way of creating music is to copy it using x-click or Alt+click
Passages allow you to copy, delete or edit whole stretches of music at once.
dt% or Ctrl with the arrow keys means move in big steps.
You can move through existing notes/rests using t/3 (%I%/+ or Ctrl+t/+ to jump whole bars)
You can select any number of note value, articulation, accidental, tie, beam, tremolo, notehead etc. buttons on
any combination of keypad /uyouts before creating a note, and all of them will apply to the note you input. (It
doesnt matter if you cant see all the highlighted buttons spread across different layouts when you input the
note)
When creating notes, the note value and articulation buttons (and most other keypad buttons) stay pressed
down so you can carry on creating fermata (pause) notes. To stop putting fermatas (pauses) on notes, click the
fermata button again, or retype 1 on the fourth keypad layout.

Quick tour

Alphabetic input
You should now be ready to start writing the music from bar 5 of the Scott Joplin score. But before you do.. .

Save your work!


You should always save your work regularly, and keep backups, preferably on a floppy or Zip disk.
To save, choose File b Save (shortcut %gS or Ctrl+S), find a suitable location (e.g. your Scores folder or the
Desktop), give your score a name - such as Jopiin - then click OK.
Sibelius also automatically saves a copy of your score into a special folder every few minutes. If your computer should
suffer a power failure or crash, the next time you start Sibelius you will be given the opportunity to restore any lost
work.
Furthermore, every time you save your score using File b Save, Sibelius makes a numbered backup and puts it into
the Backup scores folder inside your Scores folder. If, say, your score gets deleted by accident, or if you make a
major change that you later decide you dont want, check inside the Backup scores folder for a recent version.
For more information on these useful features, I&II Files in the Reference section.

Alphabetic input
As another quick way of creating notes, you can also type pitches using the letters A-G directly from the computer
keyboard, and make chords using the numbers l-9 on the main keyboard (not the numeric keypad). This can be
very quick.
Try adding the right-hand music from bar 5:

Pno.
i
l

50

Click the little bar rest rectangle in bar 5 of the right hand, so that it goes blue - this tells Sibelius where to begin.
From now on, do not touch the mouse - however tempted you are!
Hit F8 to see the first keypad layout, then type 2 on the numeric keypad to choose a sixteenth note
(semiquaver). You must choose a note value, so that Sibelius knows how long you want the notes to be.
Type A C F A Enter (on the keypad) A F C A. When you type Enter, Sibelius adds a tie. Notice that the
caret moves after every note you input, showing you where the next note will be added.
Type 3 on the keypad to choose an eighth note (quaver) - it wont appear in the score just yet
Type C 3 (use the 3 on the main keyboard, not the numeric keypad). This inputs a C eighth note and adds a
note a third above it to make a two-note chord

Alphabetic input

Type D Shift-3 (again, use the 3 key on the main keyboard, this time while holding down Shift). This inputs a
D eighth note and adds a note a third below it, again to make a two-note chord. (You could instead have typed
B 3 to input the B first and then the D above it.)
Type 4 on the keypad to select a quarter note (crotchet)
Type A Shift-C. This inputs an A quarter note and then adds a C above it, once again making a two-note chord
Hit Esc twice to stop creating notes and clear the keypad, as weve stopped adding notes for the moment.
I nough

not touching the mouse is initially disconcerting, you can see how fast this is once youre used to the
keypresses.
Just as notes are only created with the mouse when you actually click in the score, with alphabetic input, a note is
only actually created in the score when you type the letter A-G. Any buttons chosen on the keypad are merely
preparing what will happen when you type A-G or click the mouse. So you need to type any accidentals, articulations,
or other markings before typing the letter. (If you forget, you can always go back afterwards and edit the note.)
There are only three exceptions to this:
l

adding ties (by hitting Enter), done after creating the note (just because it feels more natural as the tie is after
the note);
changing the octave of the note (by typing %g+/+ or Ctrl++/+); and
creating a triplet or other tuplet (which well come on to later).

Chords in alphabetic input


Weve just been using two simple ways of building chords in alphabetic input. Input one of the notes in the chord as
normal, then:
l

Type a number l-9 on the main keyboard (not the numeric keypad) to add a note above, or type a number
Shift-1 -9 to add a note below; e.g. 1 adds a unison note, 3 adds a note a third above, Shift-6 adds a note a
sixth below
Type Shift-A-G to add a note of that pitch above the current note.

You can keep adding further notes to a chord by typing numbers one after another.
Especially usefully, you can select passages of notes and add notes above/below all of them at once using l-9 or
Shift-1 -9. Try selecting bar 5 so that it is enclosed by a single blue box, then type 8 to add notes an octave above.
More detail
Now that youve understood the principle of alphabetic input, heres a bit more detail to take in. Its probably best to
try each of these points out in the score:
How does Sibelius know which octave you want? Answer: it writes the note nearest in pitch to the preceding
note. So if you type a repeating scale C D E F G A B C D E F G . . ., Sibelius will carry on up and up. When
necessary, you can alter the octave of a note after creating it by typing X+/& or Ctrl+/r\/\L
Dont forget that you can still use Edit b Repeat (shortcut R) to repeat notes, chords, other objects or even
passages if you like
You can edit the pitch of any note youve previously input by selecting it and typing A-G
51

Quick tour
l

To input a rest during alphabetic input, just hit space. (The rests length is as specified on the keypad, as for
notes)
To input a rest with the mouse, choose a note value on the keypad, click the rest key at the bottom left of the
first layout (or type 0), then click in the score.

You cun switch between alphabetic input and mouse input at any point - you dont have to input all the notes
with one method or the other.

If you look at your computers keyboard, youll see that all the letters A-G, R, the numbers l-9, and space are
easily accessible by your left hand, and your right hand can easily reach all the numeric keypad and arrow keys (as
well as Delete, Page Up and so on). So a proficient user can touch-type notes very, very quickly, with minimal
hand movement!
Adding text and lines
With alphabetic input you can add lines such as slurs and hairpins to your music as you input the notes. Before we get
onto this more advanced technique, lets experiment with adding some text and lines independently of creating notes.
Metronome marks
Sibelius follows metronome marks during playback. If you hit P to hear the first few bars of the score, youll notice that
it plays back a little too quickly. Try dragging the tempo slider with the mouse to find the right tempo - notice how the
tempo readout to the right of the slider changes as you drag the slider, giving you an easy way to find the exact tempo
that you want. When youve worked out the desired tempo, drag the slider back to the middle (you can tell when it
gets to the middle because itll stick there) and hit Esc to stop playback.
Lets now add a metronome mark to the start of the score:
l

Type 8%K OI- Ctrl+Home to go back to the start of the score, and select the first note (this tells Sibelius where
to put the metronome mark)
Choose Create b Text b Metronome mark (shortcut ~dt%M or Ctd+Alt+M)
A small flashing caret (or insertion point) appears above the note - Sibelius knows that this kind of text should
go above the staff, so it automatically puts it there
Now Control-click (Mac) or right-click (Windows) - a menu of useful words appears. This menu is
appropriately called a word menu.
Choose the quarter note (crotchet) from the menu and click it. The menu disappears, and the quarter note
appears in your score.
Hit space, then type = 80 to complete the metronome mark
Finally, hit Esc to stop creating text (another use of Esc to stop things).

You should now see:

52

- ._ _~_________ _ _-____

- ------ - --Alphabetic input

Piano i

Try playing back the score at the new tempo - make sure the tempo slider is set to its middle position to hear exactly
the right speed.
Incidentally, the concept of selecting a note before creating a new object (such as this metronome mark) in order to
tell Sibelius where it should go is an important one and applies to just about every object youll ever create in your
score, so well come across this much more later.
A word about text
Other than the notes, many instructions for musicians playing from a score take the form of text. A lot of the text in the
score is entirely automatic so you dont have to think about it, e.g. page numbers, bar numbers and instrument
names. Youll also want to add all kinds of other text yourself, from dynamics and lyrics to metronome marks and
tempo text. Most text instructions play back, so when you create dynamics or tempo markings, Sibelius understands
them and plays back accordingly.
Each type of text you can create in Sibelius has its own so-called text style, which is preset with a suitable font, size,
position and other characteristics. Text styles are called obvious things like Title, Lyrics and Tempo. If you want to
change the font or size of some text, its best to do so by editing the text style, which will instantly change all similar
text throughout the score.
All kinds of text are created in the same way:
l

Select a note or other object at the position where you want the text to be created
Choose the text style you want from the Create ) Text submenu
A flashing caret (or insertion point) appears at a sensible position
Now you can either type directly into your score, or Control-click (Mac) or right-click (Windows) to see a word
menu containing a list of useful words
When youve finished creating text, hit Est.
To edit text thats already in your score, double-click it, or select it and hit Return (on the main keyboard).

As an aside, you can also create text without selecting an object in your score, although if you do, Sibelius wont know
where to put it, so it waits for you to place the object with the mouse (just like mouse input of notes). The mouse
pointer will change color to show its carrying an object (as in mouse note input), and you can then click in the score
where you want the text to go.
Unsurprisingly, you can find out more about text in l!QZ! Text in the Reference section.

53

Quick tour

Dynamics
Well use the term dynamics to mean both text instructions like mp and hairpins (cress/dim. lines). Text dynamics
are written in a text style called Expression, First, lets create a dynamic at the start of the piece:
l

Select the first note in the right hand of the score


Choose Create b Text b Expression (shortcut #E or Ctrl+E)
A flashing caret appears below the first note
Hold down 8% or Ctrl and type mp - holding down 8% or Ctrl tells Sibelius to write the letters using the
special bold characters which should be used for dynamics. You could instead Control-click (Mac) or right-click
(Windows) to choose the dynamic from the word menu.
Hit Esc to stop creating text.

You should now see:

Now lets add a hairpin in the third full bar.


l

Select the first note in the right hand of the third full bar.
Type H and a crescendo hairpin appears beneath the note. (You could instead type Shift-H for a diminuendo
hairpin.)
Hit space to extend the hairpin a note at a time; if you go too far, use Shift-space to retract it again.

You should now see:

Attachment
Note that dynamics only apply to one staff (the right-hand staff in this case). Most instruments only have a single staff,
so no problem arises, but keyboard and other two-staff instruments are an exception. Well solve this problem a little
later on.
For now, its useful for you to understand that every object in your score is attached to a particular staff, and belongs
to a particular voice within that staff.
54

- - -.____

--_-. -_

--7-----

Alphabetic input

You can see the attachment of any object by selecting it - a dotted gray line appears, showing which staff and where
on the staff its attached to. You can attach an object to a different staff by dragging it - watch how the gray line
stretches and eventually snaps onto another staff. For more information about attachment, EQ Attachment in the
Reference section.
Sibelius allows you to write up to four independent voices, or lines of notes or chords, on a single staff (called layers
in some music notation programs). Well come on to voices in more detail later on. For now, all you need to know is
that each voice is color-coded; voice 1 (the voice weve used so far) is blue, which shows when you select notes etc. in
voice 1.
Slurs and phrase-marks
Along with hairpins, the most common line-like objects in your scores will be slurs and phrase-marks. Sibelius treats
these identically, and calls them all slurs, since a phrase-mark is actually just drawn as a big slur. Lets add a slur in
bar 8:
l

First input the bar 8 notes, then select the second note of the bar
Type S and the slur is created, automatically slurring to the next note
Type space until the slur extends to the end of the bar; use Shift-space to retract it if you go too far.

You should now see:

Try selecting the note at either end of the slur and moving it up and down - notice how the slur is magnetic, sticking
as neatly as possible to the notes at either end.
Now try selecting the slur and choosing Edit b Flip (shortcut X) - this flips the slur to the other side of the notes.
This is another one-key shortcut worth remembering: you can use Edit b Flip to change the stem direction of a note
or group of beamed notes, flip the curvature of ties, flip slurs and tuplets to the other side of notes, and so on.
A few lines about lines
There are various musical markings consisting of straight, curved, wiggly or dashed lines, including hairpins, slurs, trills,
pedal marks, first and second endings (1 s@nd-time bars), and 8~1.s. In Sibelius, these kinds of object are called lines.
All lines can be created in the same way:
l

Select a note or object in your score to tell Sibelius where you want the line to start
Choose Create b Line (shortcut L)
The dialog is divided into two panels: Staff lines and System Lines. Staff lines apply only to a single staff,
and include things like slurs, trills and hairpins; 5ystem lines apply to all staves in the score, and include things
like ritjaccel. lines and I st- and 2nd-endings.
Select the line you want and click OK (or hit Return)
55

Quick tour
l

The line appears in the score; hit space to extend it rightwards a note at a time, and Shift-space to retract it
leftwards again.

Some lines have direct shortcuts, such as hairpins (H for a crescendo, Shift-H for a diminuendo), and slurs (S for an
upward-arching slur, Shift-S for a downward-arching slur).
Should you want to, you can also place lines with the mouse. Make sure nothing is selected (hit Esc to do this) before
you choose Create b Line; once youve chosen your line, your mouse pointer will change color, telling you that its
carrying an object, so that you can click in the score to place the line. Generally when you place lines using the f
mouse, you should click and drag nightwards to extend the line as far as you want it to go, before releasing the mouse 3
button.
You can always adjust the length of lines after creating them by selecting either end and using space/Shift-space,
the +/+ arrow keys (with 8% or Ctrl for big steps), or dragging with the mouse.
You can also customize lines and design new ones using the House Style b Edit Lines dialog.
For more information about lines, l!E!ZIl Lines in the Reference section.

Adding objects as you go along


Lets add a dynamic at the beginning of bar 9 using just the keyboard:
l

Select the little bar rest rectangle in the right hand of bar 9, then type 2 (on the numeric keypad) A
Type 6t%E or Ctrl+E; a flashing caret appears below the staff
Hold down 8% or Ctrl and type p, which inserts ap dynamic
Hit Esc to stop creating text
Type C F A Enter (on the keypad) A F C A to input the notes in the rest of the bar

You can add any object during note input in this way. Try some of these:
l

Type K (or choose Create b Key Signature) and create a key signature change. Sibelius automatically
places the new key signature after the note you last inputted.
Type T (or choose Create b Time Signature) and create a time signature change. Sibelius automatically
places the new time signature at the start of the next bar.
Type XR or Ctrl+R (or choose Create b Rehearsal Mark). Sibelius adds a rehearsal mark at the
beginning of the next bar.

As you will see, being able to create objects from the keyboard alone can greatly reduce the amount of time you need
to spend writing your music.
Voices
As we mentioned earlier, Sibelius can write up to four independent voices or lines of notes and chords on a single
staff. Although you dont need to write anything in the extra voices to copy out the Scott Joplin score were working
on, you should learn how to use them. The voices are color-coded: voice 1 is blue, voice 2 is green, and so on.

56

Alphabetic input

Bsn.

To start an extra voice:


Select a note or other object in the score where you want the new voice to start
Hit V; the caret appears
The shortcuts for the four voices are x l/2/3/4 O/ Ctd+ l/2/3/4; well assume we want voice 2, so type 712
or AIt+
Now choose the note value, any articulations, accidentals and so on required, then simply type the name of the
note on the keyboard. Note that voice 2 is color-coded green
Now you can continue to input notes with the mouse, keyboard or step-time input.
There are lots of voice-related operations which we wont cover here, but just to whet your appetite:
l

You can select particular notes from chords, then split them into another voice simply by typing, say, ~2 or
Ak+2. Its especially useful to do this to whole passages of chords at once - LI2 Filters and find in the
Reference section
Merge a passage of music in multiple voices into a single voice by selecting it and typing Y 1 or Ak+ 1
View b Note Colors b Voice Colors colors the notes in your score according to the voice to which they
belong (e.g. blue for voice 1, green for voice 2, and so on) so you can see at a glance which voice theyre in.

For lots more detail about voices, LIJ Voices in the Reference section.
Triplets and other tuplets
Hopefully you will remember the simple rule about creating notes in Sibelius: for the quickest note input, you should
choose all the notes properties (such as articulations, accidentals and so on) before you input if. The only properties
of a note that you need to change after creating it are to change its octave (if you inputted it using alphabetic input),
add a tie, or make it into a so-called tuplet.
Tuplets are rhythms which are played at some fraction of their normal speed - most commonly they are triplets, which
you create like this:
Go to (for example) a blank bar in a staff in your score
Input an eighth note (quaver)
l

Now type 83 or Ctrl+3; a tuplet bracket and number appear:

Piano ( I

_ ---

\
-+

Input two more notes to complete the tuplet; notice how the bracket disappears automatically (which is the
correct notation for this case):
57

10
C
;FZ*

7--

Quick tour

Piano

As you might expect, tuplets in Sibelius are intelligent: brackets are automatically hidden if the notes within the tuplet
are joined by a continuous beam, and the tuplet brackets (when they are shown) are magnetic, sticking to the notes
if they change pitch - try creating three triplet quarter notes (crotchets) in another bar, and then move the notes at
either end up and down to see this.
You can type St% OI- Ctrl with any number, e.g. 5 or 6 for a quintuplet or sextuplet; or for more complex tuplets such
as 7~1 you can use the slower method to create tuplets, using the Create b Tuplet dialog.
For more information, GQ Triplets and other tuplets in the Reference section.
Editing notes
You should recall that you can edit an existing notes articulations, accidentals and other attributes just by selecting the
note and choosing the appropriate button on the keypad. Lets try this again to remind you:
Select a note somewhere in the right hand staff of our Scott Joplin score
If the keypad isnt showing the first layout, click the first keypad layout tab (or hit F8)
Click the - button or type the corresponding key on the keypad to add a tenuto to the note
Click the natural button or type 7 to add a natural.
Remember, you can remove or replace the natural or tenuto just by retyping the key - try this. You can also add any
number of articulations to the same note - Sibelius will stack them up in the correct order.
Now try changing the note value of the selected note. Just click the quarter note (crotchet) button, or type 4 - and the
note becomes a quarter. Notice, incidentally, that Sibelius either deletes notes or creates rests to keep the bar length
correct.
Changing the pitch of a note is just as simple: select the note and type the new pitch using the letters A-G.
Repitching music
Sibelius lets you rewrite the pitches of existing notes while retaining their current rhythm. This is very useful when
writing for several instruments which use the same rhythm - you can just copy the music of one instrument into
another, then re-input the pitches without altering or re-inputting the rhythm.
Try this out: select the first note, switch off the selected note value on the keypad; a dotted caret appears, which tells
you that Sibelius will now simply repitch the following notes without changing their note value, automatically selecting
the next note after you play a new pitch or chord. Simply type the letter-name of the pitch, or play the note or chord
on your MIDI keyboard to repitch each note or chord. When you come to a rest, Sibelius automatically skips over it
and selects the next note, ready to be repitched.
If you type pitches using the letters A-G on your keyboard, note that the pitch will be in the octave nearest the octave
of the note you are repitching, not the previous pitch as in alphabetic input.
58
_
-

Alphabetic input

When you want to stop repitc:hing, either hit Esc or reselect a note value on the keypad, which will make the caret
turn solid again so that you can create new notes.
If you want to change a note already in your score into a rest, when it is selected, just choose the rest button (shortcut
0) on the first keypad layout (shortcut F8).
IQA Note input in the Reference section for more detail about repitching.
Brief recap
l

You can input notes or change their pitch later by typing A-G

R repeats a note, and the numbers l-9 above the letter keys add a notehead above the selected note to make
a chord (Shift- l-9 for notes below); Shift-A-G adds a notehead of that pitch above the selected note
Its best to select a note or other object in your score before creating lines, text and other objects, so that Sibelius
knows where the new one should go
You can create text, lines and other markings as you create notes, making it very quick to go from a blank

manuscript to a finished score


l

You can have up to four independent voices on each staff

Triplets and other tuplets are easily created by typing, say, 893 or Ctrl+3

Quick tour

Step-time input
If you dont have a MIDI keyboard, skip on to Basic formatting.
Step-time input is exactly analogous to alphabetic input, and is somewhat faster. All you do is:
l

Select a rest to start creating notes from

Choose a note value on the keypad (you must remember to do this)


Start playing notes on the keyboard. As with alphabetic input, choose any articulations or other markings on thi
keypad before creating a note. These keypad keys remain pressed down until you re-choose them.

To change the note value, choose a new note value from the keypad before creating the note

To input a rest, hit space, which inputs a rest of the duration selected on the keypad.

I ne

-t-l

only two differences from alphabetic input are:


You dont need to input accidentals, as Sibelius can of course tell when youre playing a black note. Sibeliu
makes an intelligent guess as to how you want black notes spelled - e.g. as F# or Gb - on the basis of the ke
signature and the musical context. However, you can ask Sibelius to respell a note after creating it just by hittin;
Return (on the main keyboard).
You can input chords instantly just by playing them (you dont have to input one note and then add fur-the
notes to it).

These differences make step-time input somewhat faster than alphabetic input.
Try writing the left-hand of the piano part from bar 5, which is all in eighth notes (quavers), using step-time input:
First select the bar rest in bar 5 in the left-hand staff (so it goes blue)

Then choose eighth notes (quavers) from the keypad

Then play in the notes.

You can always go back with the arrow keys if you made a mistake, or want to change something. As with alphabeti
input, to correct a note or chords pitch you can just select it and re-play it on your MIDI keyboard. Or theres alway
Undo!
You should end up with:

u-

I-

n-

II

I
rJ

When the left-hand part is perfect, type P to play the whole lot back. (Youll need to stop playback with Esc after thl
last note otherwise Sibelius will carry on through the score for ages, playing the rests!)

60

Step-time input

Summary of note input


For a pithy summary of the input methods weve covered so far, LQ Note input in the Reference section.
0 Pearl of wisdom Mouse input, alphabetic input and step-time input are not three alternative modes of
writing music which you have to switch on or off - you can change input methods whenever you like. You dont have
to do anything to tell Sibelius youve finished with one method and want to start using another. So feel free to input
one note with the mouse, the next one alphabetically, and the third from your MIDI keyboard!

Quick tour

Flexi-time input
If you dont have a MIDI keyboard, or if youre not much of a keyboard player, skip on to Basic formatting.
Weve seen how using mouse, alphabetic and step-time input gives you a whole range of options for note entry. Do
try them all and see which one feels most comfortable for you - or mix and match. Many people compose large works
on Sibelius using just these methods, but you should also look at Sibeliuss unique real-time note input system, which
is called Flexi-time.
Real-time input simply means that you can play into a computer program and it will write down the pitches and the
rhythm you play. Thats the theory, anyway. In practice, it is very difficult for any program to understand what rhythm
you are playing without either analyzing the music after your performance, or being given a lot of help. This usually
means you have to play along as exactly as possible with a metronome click, and then quantize the music afterwards
in an attempt to clean up any inaccuracies in your rhythm.
However, Sibelius takes a unique approach which enables you to play in a rather freer style, and still gets good results.
Trying it out
The easiest thing to do is to try playing in a single melodic line. Lets do this first - you should still be looking at the
Scott Joplin score weve been working on. Well start playing in notes using Flexi-time from bar I 3:
Select bar 13 in the right-hand piano staff so that it is enclosed in a single blue box (or select the little bar rest
rectangle itself); this tells Sibelius where to start recording from.
Now brace yourself, because as soon as you choose Notes b Flexi-time (shortcut d&F or Ctrl+Shift+F)
or click the circular record button on the toolbar, Sibelius will give you one bar count-in, then start recording what
you play. Try it now:
Flexi-time gives you a single bars count-in by default - so in this case you should hear two clicks count-in, (If
you do not hear a metronome click, check your playback device is switched on, then LQ Flexi-time or
Playback in the Reference section)
At the end of the count-in, try playing the next few bars smoothly, following the speed of the clicks
Keep going for as long as you like to get a feel for how Sibelius displays the notes on the screen (it will be
usually be several notes behind you)
Once youre used to following the clicks, try gently slowing down and speeding up - the clicks should follow
you. This feels quite strange at first, so make your tempo fluctuations gradual before testing the limits!
When you want to stop recording, type 4&F or Ctrl+Shift+F again, or hit Esc (yet another use of Esc to
stop or cancel things).
Use the navigator to have a look at what Sibelius has transcribed. If there are any mistakes, you can use the editing
techniques you have already learned to correct the note lengths and pitches.
Flexi-time in the Reference section describes how to play on two staves simultaneously. You can also change
other options such as rubato (the flexibility of your tempo), the speed, sound and count-in of the metronome click,
and the way in which triplets and other tuplets are recognized.

62

Flexi-time input

Playing the keyboard without creating notes


If you have a master (silent) keyboard, its often useful to be able to play on it and hear what youre playing without
creating notes in your score.
To do this, click on an empty part of a staff so that a bar is enclosed in a blue box, then hit Esc to cancel the selection.
Now play on your keyboard. No notes will be inputted, but the sound of the staff you selected will be used as you
Play-

Quick tour

Basic formatting
Sibelius continually rearranges the bars and staves of your music as you input it. To anyone who has used a word
processor this idea should be familiar - its just that in music the consequences are much more dramatic. This process
of laying out music onto pages is called formatting.
Reformatting
Whether youre composing, arranging or just copying out music, you will always want to go back and change things,
such as creating bars in the middle of music youve already written. Sibelius has to react properly by reformatting the
music that follows - which it does instantly.
One advantage of this instant reformatting is that theres no command to add a new page - this just happens as you
go along. Another advantage is that you can make massive changes to music youve already inputted - such as
changing the page shape - and Sibelius will instantly update the layout of the whole score accordingly.
To show an extreme example of the kind of formatting that happens the whole time, open the Quick tour score
again, which is on Letter-sized paper. It looks like this:

Something Doing
A rag-time two step

Now lets change the orientation of the paper from portrait (upright) to landscape (sideways) format. Choose
Layout b Document Setup (shortcut %%D or Ctrl+D) to see this dialog:

64

Basic formatting

Staff t&q&s ~-~11111


This is tt?e default distartce of the staves inside the page
margins.

Switch the orientation from Portrait to Landscape, see how it char lges in the score preview on the right of the
dialog, and click OK. The score now looks like this:

The score, which previously fit on a single page, now runs onto a second page. Notice how the number of bars on
each system is different from the original score, with the exception of the first system, because it ends with a system
break, explained below.
If you like, open the Layout b Document Setup dialog again and try changing the Page size option on the
left-hand side. Watch what happens in the preview on the right. Try increasing and reducing the Staff size option
and notice how Sibelius reflows the music.
(for full details about this dialog, LL! Document Setup in the Reference section.)
Controlling the layout
As well as changing the page and staff size, there are various other ways you can control the way your score is
formatted, including creating breaks, changing the note spacing, and changing the stuff spacing.
65

c
Quick tour

Rulers
h

Before we start a ltering t:he layout of the score, lets switch on Sibeliuss rulers. These are useful
for making fine adjustments to score layout, as they show the precise distance between objects
and staves, and staves and the page.

Choose View ) Selection Rulers, and then select (say) a dynamic in the score. A blue ruler
appears next to the gray attachment line, showing you the distance of the object from the staff to
which it is attached. Move the object up and down with the arrow keys, and the ruler updates to show the new
distance.
You can specify different measurement units. There are two other kinds of ruler you can switch on as well - L!2 View
menu in the Reference section for more details.
Breaks
Sometimes you need a system or a page to end at a particular point - for example, in our Quick tour score, the first
system ends at the double barline, because a system break has been added after the fourth full bar.
To add a system break, select a barline and choose Layout ) Break ) System Break, or use the shortcut
Return (on the main keyboard) - notice the analogy with starting a new paragraph in a word processor.
You can also lock passages of music -ELI Breaks and layout and formatting in the Reference section for
more details.
Note spacing
Occasionally you will want to adjust the horizontal note spacing of a note or passage. Give this a try: click in a blank
part of any bar in your score so that it is surrounded by a single blue box, then type OX+/+ or Shift+Alt+t/+
to expand and condense the note spacing within that bar (with x or Ctrl for big steps). To reset the bar back to its
default spacing, select it and choose Layout ) Reset Note Spacing (shortcut O%%N or Ctrl+Shift+N).
You can also modify Sibeliuss note spacing rule if you like - LQ Note spacing in the Reference section.
Staff spacing
Sometimes it is necessary to increase the distance between staves within a system in order to avoid collisions involving
especially high or low notes. Try this out: select a bar in the left-hand piano staff and drag it up and down - or use the
shortcuts x/t/& or Alt+I\/&. Notice how Sibelius reformats the music as you move the staff.
You can change the spacing between staves throughout your score, or for a single system, or indeed for any other
passage. If you make a mistake, you can also use the Layout ) Reset Space Above/Below Staff options to
reset the spacing to its default.
For further details on these and other sophisticated tools for altering staff spacing, L!2 Staff spacing in the
Reference section.
Hiding empty staves
In music for larger ensembles, it is common to hide the staves of instruments which are not playing. This saves space
and can make the score easier to follow for the conductor. Sibelius automatically hides empty staves as it reformats
66

Basic formatting

your score to keep it as clear as possible - but, of course, you can control whether empty staves are shown or hidden
yourself if you want. For more details, LQ Staves in the Reference section.
Uniform layout
In some kinds of music, such as lead sheets or educational studies, its sometimes desirable to have a uniform number
of bars per system and systems per page. By default, Sibelius will normally put different numbers of bars per system
and systems per page, because the layout of music isnt normally governed so tightly.
If you need to make the layout of your score uniform in this way, you can use one of Sibeliuss plug-ins to do the job
for you. Plug-ins are extra features written in Sibeliuss built-in programming language, Manuscript, and they generally
automate tedious procedures such as adding chord symbols or proof-reading your music. Sibelius comes supplied
with a wide range of useful plug-ins, and if youre that way inclined, you can even write your own.
Choose File b Plug-ins b Notation b Make Layout Uniform to use this straightforward plug-in.
Formatting tips
A useful tip is not to bother too much about the layout of your score when youre just inputting the notes. The spacing
will change as you add more instruments and especially if you add lyrics, so its best not to tinker with it until the score
is fairly complete. Otherwise your adjustments may have to be undone.
Another tip is always to keep several empty bars at the end of the score when youre inputting music. These act as a
buffer so that Sibelius can space the music naturally as you are going along. Obviously you can delete them when
youve finished.
Brief recap
Trust Sibelius to format your music attractively without you having to intervene, but if you need to alter the layout. . .
l

You can change the page and staff size of your score at any time, and Sibelius will automatically reformat your
score instantly to reflect the changes
Use page and system breaks if you need to force particular bars onto a page or system (but dont do this
routinely)
Increase or decrease the note spacing with 67:t/+ or Shift+Alt+t/+
Move staves to increase or decrease the space between them - use keyboard shortcuts and rulers for greater
control and precision.

67

Quick tour

Finishing touches
Weve almost finished inputting and formatting our copy of the Scott Joplin Quick tour score, but before we move
on to some of the other fun things Sibelius can do, lets just put the final touches to it.
Instrument names
In music for small ensembles where all staves are always shown, its generally not necessary for instrument names to
be stated at the start of every system. To stop instrument names appearing after the first system, choose House
Style ) Engraving Rules (shortcut 68%E or Ctrl+Shift+E). This dialog has a number of pages which are
accessible using the list on the left-hand side; click Instruments.
In the Instrument names section at the top of the dialog, set Subsequently to None, then click OK; the
instrument names after the first system disappear.
In keyboard music, its conventional not to have an instrument name at the start of the score either, instead indenting
the first system a little. To achieve this, switch off instrument names altogether on the Instruments page of the
House Style b Engraving Rules dialog, then select the initial barline of the first system and drag it rightwards
with the mouse. These kinds of things are done automatically for you if you start with a suitable manuscript paper, e.g.
Piano Letter or Piano A4.
When youre feeling adventurous, or very bored, you might want to investigate the House Style ) Engraving
Rules dialog more closely; although for the most part the options it contains are rather advanced, some of the pages
you will probably find useful are Bar numbers, Page numbers, Rehearsal marks and Staves.
Title text
To create a title in your score, select the first note, then choose Create b Text b Title. Sibelius automatically centers
the title on the top of the page. You can also add further titles later in the score in the same way (e.g. if it is divided
into several movements of songs).
Most manuscript papers have a provisional title, composer and metronome mark already created for you, reading e.g.
Title; turn this into your real title/composer/metronome mark by selecting the text, hitting Return (on the main
keyboard) and editing it.
Composer text
To write the name of the composer, select the first note, then choose Create ) Text ) Composer. Sibelius
automatically aligns the text to the right margin. Note that the name of the composer is usually written in capital
letters,
Where text can go
This demonstrates the principle that with some text styles there are constraints on where you can move them - the
title youve just created is defined to be centered on the page, so you can only move it up and down, not left and
right Similarly, Tempo text (used for writing directions like Allegro) is defined to go only above a system, although
in large scores it can also be duplicated lower down. By contrast, Expression text can go more or less anywhere in the

68

Fishing touches

But all text you create is attached to a particular rhythmic point in the music and apply to a particular staff (or to all the
staves). For instance, you will find that you can put text in the left-hand margin of the page, but it still attaches to the
start of the bar its next to - if the bar moves, the text will move with it instead of staying stuck meaninglessly on the
spot.
Keyboard dynamics
All the dynamics we created in our Scott Joplin score are attached to the right-hand staff, which looks correct but
doesnt play back correctly (since the dynamics are attached to the right-hand staff and so do not affect the playback of
the left-hand staff).
This is easily solved, however, using another of Sibeliuss plug-ins. First, switch on View h Hidden Objects
(shortcut x%9H or Ctrl+Alt+H), then choose Edit ) Select ) Select All (shortcut B%A or Ctrl+A), which
selects everything in your score - all the music will be surrounded by a double blue box. Now choose File h Plugins h Playback h Copy Dynamics; a dialog appears - just click OK.
You should now see that the dynamics have been copied to the left-hand staff, and are colored gray rather than black.
This means that the dynamics are hidden - they will play back, but will not print. If you dont want to see hidden
objects in your score, switch off View h Hidden Objects.
For more information about the plug-ins supplied with Sibelius, L!2 Plug-ins in the Reference section. For
further details about hidden objects, Q2 Hiding objects in the Reference section.
Deleting unwanted bars
If you find you have a lot of empty bars at the end of your score, you can easily delete them: #-click or Ctrl+click
inside the first bar that you dont need (you should get a double blue box around that bar), then go to the final bar of
your score (make sure you dont click on any actual music while youre doing this) and Shift-click inside the final bar
you want to delete. This should give you a double blue box around all the offending bars. Then hit Delete!

69

Quick tour

A little arranging
So far weve just been tinkering with a short piano score. Were going to use this as a basis for creating an orchestral
score to give you a quick look through some more advanced techniques.
Adding more instruments
Lets expand the score from piano to full orchestra. This is very quick and straightforward:
l

Open Quick tour from the Scores folder


Choose Create b Instruments (shortcut letter I)

In the dialog that appears, choose a selection of woodwind, brass and string instruments to fill out the orchestra. i
(Flick back to earlier in the Quick tour if youve forgotten how.)

You can add as many instruments as you like - theres no limit in Sibelius - but to help fit them on this page size, pick
no more than about 10 or so for the moment. It doesnt matter in what order you pick them - Sibelius will reorganize
them into standard orchestral order.
l

Click Create. Youll see your full score appear instantly!


Zoom out to see a whole page, which will look something like this:

Notice all the adjustments Sibelius has made to your score:


l

Listed the instruments in the correct order and grouped them with brackets and barlines into sections
Written correct instrumental names on the first page
Written the correct clef for each instrument
Formatted the score to fit a comfortable number of bars on each page.

When you drag the little white rectangle off the right of the navigator, it hops onto the next pair of pages so that you
can move continuously right to the end of the score.

70

A little arranging

Transposing instruments
(You will only need to deal with transposing instruments if you write for certain instruments such as clarinets,
saxophones and brass. Skip this bit if it doesnt apply to you.)
By default, your score is shown at sounding pitch. To switch to transposing pitch, simply choose Notes )
Transposing Score (shortcut 6%BT or Ctrl+Shift+T) or click the button shown at the left on the
toolbar - try this now. If the score contains any transposing instruments, all of their music and key signatures
will instantly be transposed.
Sibelius automatically handles all other complications produced by transposing instruments. When playing back a
transposing score, Sibelius reads transposing instruments correctly to produce the correct pitch. Sibelius transposes
music when you copy it between transposing instruments, When extracting parts from a sounding pitch score, Sibelius
automatically transposes transposing instruments for you.
Selections and passages
Throughout the Quick tour weve introduced some of the concepts of selecting objects and passages. Heres a
brief reminder of what weve covered so far:
Click an object with the mouse to select it, or use the t,+ and Tab keys to move through objects (usefully, if
nothing is selected, Tab selects the first object on the page, so you dont need to use your mouse at all)
To select a bar (so that it is surrounded by a single blue box), click on a blank bit of staff; or select the first note
in the bar and type 6x3 or Ctrl+Shift++
To select a passage of bars, select a bar, then Shift-click on another bar, either in the same staff or another one
to make a larger rectangle of music; or select a note or a bar and type 6%g+ or Ctrl+Shift++ to extend
the passage rightwards a bar at a time (just like selecting words in a word processor), or Shift-+/+ to extend it
upwards or downwards a staff at a time.
Selecting parts of bars
Two other ways of selecting which you should experiment with:
l

To select a passage which doesnt just consist of whole bars, select any note and then Shift-click another note
later on. This selects the rectangle of music which has the notes you clicked at its corners - the passage can
include multiple staves.
If you start with a single note selected, you can extend the selection to form a passage by typing Shift-+. This
works just like selecting letters in a word processor.
Try selecting a group of three or four notes this way, then copy it around. You can see how useful this is for
creating arrangements, orchestrations and ostinato sections.

There are various other ways to select passages, plus other kinds of selections, too - L!2 Selections and
passages and Filters and Find in the Reference section.
Play around with this score until you are comfortable with copying music about. You can hit P to hear the result at any
time.
0 Pearl of wisdom Copy, dont re-input! Its almost always faster to copy existing music than to input it afresh.
You can use -c-click or Alt-click to copy any object or passage in your score.
71

Quick tour

Arrange
Well now use Sibeliuss unique Arrange feature to orchestrate our piano music instantly for our new instruments.
Arrange is designed to assist with arranging and orchestration, and can save you lots of time. Youll see the potential
for writing any kind of music right away:
l

Triple-click one of the piano staves, which selects it throughout the score. Then Shift-click on the other piano
staff, so that both piano staves are enclosed within a single blue box:

Choose Edit b Copy (shortcut 6t%C or Ctrl+C) to copy the music to the clipboard, then hit Esc to clear the
selection
Now X-click or Ctrl+click the first bar in any instrument: all the staves in your score should now be enclosed in
a double blue box. X-click or Ctrl+click on each of the piano staves in turn to remove them from the selection,
so that all the instruments on either side of the piano staves are still enclosed by a single blue box:

-1

J=

au

Choose Notes b Arrange (shortcut 48% or Ctrl+Shift+V)


From the dialog which appears, choose Standard Arrangement, and click OK
Sibelius arranges the piano music onto the selected staves in your score, intelligently splitting the music ur
between the instruments and transposing it by octaves where necessary.
l-lit P to hear the arrangement.

Arrange intelligently copies music from any number of staves into any other number of staves. It can be used tc
produce piano reductions, and to explode chords onto multiple staves. Most importantly of all, this sophisticatec
feature even helps you arrange and orchestrate for a wide variety of styles and ensembles.
For more details, EL!! ArrangeTM in the Reference section.
72

More fun things

More fun things


Can there really be more fun things, besides all the features weve seen already? Why, yes, there can! (And still more
can be found scattered rather sparsely around the Reference section.)
Further example files
Weve barely scratched the surface of the kinds of music you can write in Sibelius. For more examples of the variety of
music Sibelius handles, try taking a look at the following (inside your Scores folder):
Advanced Notation 1 and Advanced Notation 2, in the Notation folder, for a whirlwind tour of
Sibeliuss many advanced notation features
Early Music, in the Notation folder, for an example of vocal music using Sibeliuss special early music
barlines, incipits and prefatory staves
Lead Sheet, in the Notation folder, for a score using the Inkpen handwritten font
Hebrides, in the Orchestral folder, to listen to Mendelssohns famous overture
Big Band, in the Other folder, for a big band score that features advanced playback such as instruments
playing during a second repeat
Guitar, in the Other folder, for a score showing off some of Sibeliuss special guitar notations
Exam Paper, in the Education folder, to see how easy it is to create worksheets and exam papers in
Sibelius
Jazz, in the Other folder, includes special guitar tab notations such as bends and slides, and also features
percussion, guitar frames, rhythm slashes, and so on
Graphics examples, in the Graphics files folder, shows how imported graphics can be used to great
effect, particularly in worksheets and coursework projects.
You should also look through the How to section of this User Guide, which is a useful visual reference to how to
notate common styles of music in Sibelius.
Internet publishing
Sibelius helps you to publish your music directly onto your own web site, or onto our self-publishing web site,
SibeliusMusic.com. Visit the site and take a look at the thousands of scores already there - and when youre ready to
publish your own music on the Internet, I&! Internet publishing in the Reference section.
Scanning
Sibelius comes with a free scanning program called PhotoScore Lite, which scans and reads printed music into
Sibelius. Once the music is read, you can edit or transpose the score in Sibelius, play it back, extract parts and print just as if youd inputted it yourself. Q2! Scanning in the Reference section.
Clef changes
Putting a simple clef change into a score provides a glimpse of some of Sibeliuss hidden power:
l

Select the note after which you want the new clef to go
73

Quick tour
l

Choose Create ) Clef (shortcut Q for qlef) and in the dialog that appears click, say, a bass clef (the most
common ones are near the top of the list), then click OK or hit Return
The clef appears, and all the music after it shifts so that it still sounds the same. The new clef appears at the start
of all subsequent systems, and any key signatures will shift, too.

But now lets try something more sophisticated: click the clef with the mouse, and drag it left and right along the staff.
As the clef passes over notes, it shifts them so that they continue to sound correct. You can even drag the clef from
one staff to another - try it.
You might like to think of the clef as acting a bit like looking through sunglasses - it transforms the appearance of the
music without actually affecting how it really is (i.e. how it really sounds).

(If this intrigues you, you may like to investigate in the Reference section the analogous behavior of guitar tab, and
of transposition changes in transposing instruments.)
Extracting parts
Open the score Sax concerto (in the Orchestral folder within your Scores folder), and choose File )
l

Extract Parts (shortcut &8%X or Ctrl+Shift+X)


l

Click just Alto Saxophone Solo , near the bottom of the list at the left
Click Dont save now on the right of the dialog
Click OK.

After a few moments, the extracted part will appear on the screen. Sibelius has included all relevant markings,
collected multiple bars rest together into multirests, and reformatted it to produce a clean result. You can toggle
whether or not Sibelius shows multirests with a single keypress - try typing 4B%M or Ctrl+Shift+M a couple of
times.
The original score is still open - you can get back to it from the bottom of the Window menu.
Importing files
A further method of inputting music into Sibelius is to open files from other music programs. Sibelius can import files
from Finale, SCORE, Allegro, PrintMusic, the Acorn Sibelius programs, and, by far the most standard format, MIDI files
(or Standard MIDI File).
Try importing the example MIDI file, imaginatively called MIDI file, which is in the File Converters folder within
the Scores folder - open it like a normal Sibelius file, by clicking Open on the toolbar. Since there are quite a few
instruments in this score, set the Manuscript Paper to Inkpen Tabloid (1 1 x 17), but ignore all the other
options - then click OK.
Sibelius does some extremely intelligent guess-work to make any imported MIDI file look as clean as possible, working
out which instruments are playing, giving them the correct names and clefs, and grouping them correctly. It also cleans
up the rhythm using the same algorithm used by Flexi-time - rather more sophisticated than ordinary quantization.
It can even work out if there are transposing instruments in the MIDI file - after youve opened the MIDI file, switch on
Notes ) Transposing Score (shortcut U%BT or Ctrl+Shift+T), keeping an eye on the baritone sax part. To
improve the playback of this file instantly, select the first note of the score, choose Create ) Text ) Tempo
74

More fun things

(shortcut 7189T or Ctrl+Ak+T) and type Swing. Now play the score again - Sibelius creates an authentic swing
sound.

Sibelius can also save MIDI files, which is one way of giving yoc jr music to people who dont trave Sibelius themselves,
and when you save the MIDI file, advanced playback options like rubato and rhythmic feel are included, so Sibelius
acts as an instant MIDI file improver!
For more details, I!!22 Opening MIDI files and Saving MIDI files in the Reference section.
Now try opening the file called, equally imaginatively, Finale file. When prompted for further options, just click OK,
and seconds later Sibelius opens the file, automatically converting notes, text markings, articulations and so on.
The end result is that once youve imported a file from another music program, its virtually ready to print right away.
You can also of course edit or re-arrange the music, play it back, extract parts and so on.
For further information on importing files from other music programs, refer to LQ Opening Finale, Allegro
and PrintMusic files, Opening SCORE files and Opening Acorn Sibelius files in the
Reference section.

83
C

Quick tour

what to do next
Before you lose all interest, at this point well perform a rapid accelerando and race through all of Sibelius remaining
features. Hold onto your hats!
Most of the rest of this User Guide is the Reference section, covering Sibeliuss features in more detail under
numerous different topics. Even subjects already covered in this Quick tour are dealt with in greater depth, often
with useful tips you might otherwise never find out for yourself.
You wont need to read all of the Reference section, so to tell you which bits are relevant to you, see the How to
section. This takes the most common kinds of music and shows you how to create them in Sibelius, along with which
parts of the Reference section to read for more details.
The following summary mentions all the Reference topics in turn:
Standard notations
Things youve already met are covered further in Clefs, Instruments, Key signatures, Lines, Slurs,
Staves and Time signatures. You can learn how to edit existing lines and staff types and create new ones in
Edit lines and Edit Staff Types.
Special notations
Barlines covers double barlines, repeats, dotted barlines, early music barlines, and so on
Brackets and braces tells you how to adjust the grouping of instruments at the left of each system
Guitar frames and Guitar tab tell you about notating music for fretted instruments
Free rhythm describes cadenzas, aleatory music and music with no meter
Symbols and Music fonts tell you how to change the design of Sibeliuss music symbols, and how to
create unusual symbols in your score. Edit Symbols tells you how to create new symbols and modify
existing ones.
Percussion covers percussion notation, including drum sets (drum kits) and orchestral percussion
Hiding objects reveals the possibilities of having objects in your score which you cannot see
Importing graphics tells you how to add logos, pictures, graphic notations and even photos to your scores
Timecode tells you how to write time positions in your music for film/TV scoring, and how to calculate the
duration of your score automatically.
I ne How to section also details numerous unusual notations, including harp pedal diagrams, codas, incipits, and
more.

Notes and rests


These are covered in Note input, Noteheads, Accidentals, Articulations, Beams, Stems, Voices.
Irrational rhythms are covered in Triplets and other tuplets, and youll also want to know how to write
Grace notes and cue notes and Tremolos. Find out how to modify existing noteheads and create new
ones in Edit Noteheads.
Sibelius can even scan printed music for you - see Scanning.
76

What to do next

Text
For when and how to use the various types of text, see Text, Lyrics and Chord symbols. To choose different
text fonts, sizes, characters and positioning see Edit Text Styles.
See also Bar numbers, Page numbers and Rehearsal marks for these automatic types of text.
MIDI and playback
For an introduction to MIDI, read MIDI for beginners To fine-tune how your music plays see Playback,
Mixer, and Performance. For advanced tweaking of playback, see MIDI messages and Playback
dictionary.
MIDI devices will help you set up your computer for MIDI input and playback.
Flexi-time is about Sibeliuss intelligent real-time input system.
I

Croups of bars
To edit bars or groups of bars at once, see Bars and bar rests, Selections and passages, and
Multirests. Filters and Find shows you how to quickly find, select, edit or delete notes or other objects (such
as text, lines, and so on) with particular characteristics.
Printing and publishing
See Printing and also Publishing, which tells you how to set about getting a score printed at very high quality.
House Style describes how to set up your own look for different kinds of music.
Even more exciting are Sibeliuss Internet publishing features.

Transposing and extracting parts


See Extracting parts and Transposing. Also check the Arrange topic for details on automatic keyboard
reduction,
Formatting and layout
For an introduction to some important principles, see Music engraving. Attachment, Document Setup
and Layout and formatting are the main topics to read for Sibeliuss layout features. Specific formatting
controls are in Note spacing, Staff spacing, Default Positions, View menu and Breaks.
Useful tips
Keyboard shortcuts give many ways to work faster - you should definitely read this section. Preferences
explains how to change various general program settings that could make working with Sibelius easier and quicker.
Undo and redo shows you how to turn back the clock. View menu and window menu cover options for
Sibeliuss screen display. Manuscript paper tells you how you can set up standard ensembles, paper sizes and
other options you can use over and over again. Properties lets you in on the hidden secrets of all the notes, text,
symbols and other objects you will encounter when using Sibelius. Highlight tells you how to highlight music in
fluorescent yellow.

Quick tour

File operations
For basic information on saving, auto-save, backups, transferring Sibelius files between Mac and Windows, and
emailing Sibelius files, see Files.
Sibelius can convert files from a number of different music programs: see Opening MIDI files, Opening
Finale, Allegro and PrintMusic files, Opening SCORE files, and Opening Acorn Sibelius
files.
Sibelius can also save MIDI files which can be played back on any computer - see Saving MIDI files.
You can also use Sibelius to export graphics in a wide variety of formats for use in other programs such as word
processors - see Saving graphics files.
Plug-ins
let Sibelius do the hard work for you with its built-in Plug-ins (including adding automatic chord symbols, checking
for parallel fifths and octaves) - and you can even write your own.
when all else fails
If you get stuck while using Sibelius, ELI Help in the Start here section.
And if youre looking for more general musical information not covered by this User Guide, LQ Grove Music.

How to

How to

80

Introduction

Sibelius can be used to notate every kind of music, from solo violin to large-scale orchestral works. This section of the
User Guide, as its name implies, takes some of the most common kinds of music notation and shows you how to
create them in Sibelius, and which parts of the Reference section to read for more details.
Although Sibelius does most of the hard work for you, theres no substitute for knowledge of some of the standard
notation and engraving conventions. This section will also show you how to improve the clarity, legibility and
professionalism of your scores with some simple tips and tricks.
How to use this section
The section begins with Basic notation, which is a useful reference to the elements of notation that are common
to all kinds of music. You should begin by taking a look at this topic, which serves as a visual reminder of the material
covered in the Quick tour earlier in this User Guide (exciting things like time signatures, key signatures, various
kinds of text, repeat barlines, and so on).
From there, the section is mostly concerned with ensembles of different kinds (e.g. choir, band, orchestra), and music
of different genres (e.g. jazz, early music). There is also some advice on how to prepare music examples for use in
other documents (such as essays and theses), and how to prepare worksheets for use in education.
Each section consists of one or more annotated music examples, designed to illustrate particular notations or functions
of Sibelius. In many cases, you will also find details of simple procedures to achieve particular effects, such as hiding
parts of staves, and general advice about techniques used when scoring for a particular kind of ensemble.
In some cases, youll also find advice on the recommended input method for music of that kind - e.g. in band music,
where many instruments play similar rhythms, its a lot quicker to input the notes onto, say, a piano staff, then use the
Arrange feature (LLJ Arrange in the Reference section) to explode them to multiple staves.
We recommend that you take a look at all of the examples in this section, since many of the tips and tricks apply
equally to other kinds of music. Even if youre not particularly interested in, say, choral music, you should still take a
look at the Choir section, because it contains some useful hints on hiding staves, modifying text styles, creating piano
reductions, and so on.

81

How to

Almost everything shown in this topic is covered in the Quick tour at the start of this User Guide, so if you havent
already worked your way through that section, you should do so now - if you dont, you will run a risk of never
discovering some basic features, particularly if you are used to notation programs which work in different ways.
Dont forget!
While were tackling the basic principles of working with Sibelius, its worth reiterating some key points:
l

Save reg&rly, and make backups. Theres nothing more frustrating than losing work because you didnt keep
any backups - LQ Files in the Reference section
Copvb don? remput! The quickest way of writing music in Sibelius is usually to copy using x-click or Alt+click LQ Selections and passages in the Reference section
learn keyboard shorfc~fs. Nearly every operation in Sibelius can be performed without ever touching the
mouse. Keep your keyboard shortcuts mouse pad handy and learn the most common key combinations.

Layout and formatting


In the example on the facing page, notice how the distance between the clarinet staff and the right-hand piano staff is
wider than normal on the final two systems, in order to accommodate objects between the staves, such as repeat bars
and notes with many leger lines. You can simply move staves to increase the distance between them - ILL!! Staff
spacing in the Reference section.

82

Basic notation

iCU

Page
numbers

Tempo and metronome


mark - LUI Text

Title - Lm Text

Composer - @ii!l Text

DUNCAN J. GOOSEBERRY (b. 1922)

Clarinet

Two voices - @I

oi

Voices

I ~

l!LQ Bars and


bar rests

Accent tiLlI Articulations

Fermata (pause) kL!l Articulations

83

How to

Advanced notation
Sibelius can notate some very advanced notations, including nested tuplets, microtones, cut-away scores, and so on.
The example on the facing page shows some of these techniques in action - take a look at the Advanced
notation 1 and 2 example scores for more examples.
Free rhythm
Some avant garde music has no meter, or has different simultaneous time signatures - LQ Free rhythm in the
Reference section.
Key signatures
In some scores, different staves in the same system have different key signatures - EL3 Key signatures in the
Reference section.
Graphic scores
If your music has more graphic elements than staff notation elements, you might consider exporting your music from
Sibelius and completing the score in a graphics package - LQ Saving graphics files in the Reference
section.
If your music is largely in staff notation but includes some graphic elements, import them into Sibelius
(IQJ Importing graphics in the Reference section) or define new symbols as appropriate (LQ Symbols in
the Reference section).

84

Advanced notation

Large time signatures I&! Time signatures

Micro tones lL!l Accidentals

Conducting symbols @2 Symbols

A. FI

Cl

Tba

p-r

r rrrr r

-kLJ
. ..truth falls...

Feathered beams a Beams

j flutter-tongue, any pitc+

reaal maru IQ2 Lines

A. FI.

-1

Staff type change -

LQ Staves

. . . of untorglveness..

a Tremolos

ILLI Importing graphics

El2

Symbols

How to

Band
L!2 Extracted parts, Jazz (for big band etc.), Orchestra, Percussion in How to.
Well use band as an umbrella term to refer to a number of different ensembles consisting of combinations of brass,
woodwind and percussion instruments, both marching (e.g. military bands, drum and bugle corps) and non-marching
(e.g. wind bands, concert bands).
Distinct from the above ensembles, the brass band does not contain any woodwind instruments at all, and the
instrumentation (like that of drum corps) is fixed by competition regulations.
Manuscript paper
Sibelius includes a wide variety of band manuscript papers for all kinds of ensembles including Concert band,
Drum corps, Brass band, Wind band, etc. - and you can always create your own; /!LQ Manuscript paper
in the Reference section.
Input method
The golden rule is copy, dont reinput! A glance at the example on the facing page shows how much doubling is
inherent in this kind of music - so input the music once, and copy it to the necessary staves, or use the Arrange
feature (LQI ArrangeTM in the Reference section).
Techniques
Brass players in bands often use a wide variety of mutes, including: harmon mute, cup mute, bucket mute, straight
mute, and less commonly, fiber mute and metal mute. To direct the players, its normal to write the name of the mute
(e.g. straight mute) in Technique text, but sometimes composers use more generic directions such as mute in or
mute out.
Other techniques in band music include:
l

HOB: hand over bell


CulrP: hand grasps bell
I on/y

and 2 on/y: equivalent to I ., 2., a 2 etc. in orchestral music

Example score
An excerpt from the score shown on the facing page, called Wind band, is in the Other folder within your Scores
folder - open it for a closer look.

86

Band

Input once, then copy and


transpose by an octave

I&! Key signatures,


Time signatures

r-

LLbl Rehearsal marks

Alto (I

4 %#
a

Players sharing a single staff -

A sax
I + II

ii

~b

J-J

bb

I Sax

rl#
Rir Snx

4
e

Separate staves for players IU Instruments

Bsna
I tll

ijJ
f
zr
f

~8;
.F

r-r
if

Boxed text a Text

Hn,
Ill I IV

Tpt II

Ipt Ill

Ihn I

Thn II

L!LLJl Percussion in How


to and Reference

Start repeat bar-line L&l Barlines

Toccata copynght 0 2000 Glen Jones. All nghts reserved. For further information, email gvd.jones@virgin.net

How to

Choir
Manuscript paper
A variety of choral manuscript papers is supplied with Sibelius, some with one voice per staff (e.g. Choir SATB), and
some with two voices per staff (e.g. Choir reduction), some with organ or piano accompaniment, and some with
ready-made title pages. !LQ Manuscript paper in the Reference section.
Short score vs. full score
In choral music, its often desirable to condense the vocal lines onto a pair of staves (a format sometimes called short
score), particularly when the rhythms are similar between pairs of voices, so that only one set of lyrics is required.
When the parts become more independent, you may need to expand them into four separate staves. To achieve this
for an SATB choir:
Create six vocal staves (choose Create b Instruments, shortcut I) in your score (two for the short score,
which should be e.g. soprano and bass, and four for the individual parts)
Edit the names of the short score staves by double-clicking on them; note that you need to edit the long and
short forms of the names separately
Input the music in short score using two voices where necessary (LQ Voices in the Reference section)
When you need to split into individual staves, create a system break (ILL! Breaks in the Reference section)
and add divide arrows (ILLI Symbols in the Reference section)
Use the Layout b Hide Empty Staves function (shortcut bx8gH or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+H) to hide the
short score staves from that point on, and also to hide the individual staves before that point (LQ Layout
and formatting in the Reference section).
Piano reduction
Create a piano instrument in your score, and set it to use small staves from the Staves panel of the
Properties window (LQ Properties in the Reference section)
l

Edit its name, by double-clicking on it, to read e.g. Piano (for rehearsal only)
Copy the choir music to the clipboard, then select the two piano staves, and choose Notes b Arrange
(shortcut 0%%V or Ctrl+Shift+V). Choose an appropriate Arrange style (e.g. one of the Reduction styles)
and click OK.

After producing the reduction, you may need to remove lyrics from the piano staves (select a single lyric item,
then choose Edit b Select b Select More, shortcut bB%A or Ctrl+Shift+A, and press Delete).

You can also use the Arrange feature to, say, reduce four separate vocal staves down onto two staves to save space, or
vice versa. For more information on arranging, LQ ArrangeTM in the Reference section.
continued on page 90

88

Choir

Title and sub-title - @2 Text

Missa SpztriZ
A simple mass
Inc@it - see page 90

on fictional plainsong tones

1. Nine-fold Kyrie

1 in capitals- /T>
Ky

- vi -

e - lei

- son.
JOHN DOE (1797-1833)

- ri-e

e -

into full score - see

Slurring to show
different underlay
- %LI Lines

s. II

clef - ILLI Clefs

L------

Piano reduction see page 88

have_
ri
-

mer
e__

lei

cy,

mer - cy, mer - cy


e-lei
-

SOiT,

on-

US.

son.

Two verses of lyrics,


using a custom text
style - see page 90

Creating an incipit
Add an extra instrument to your score (e.g. [treble staff] in the Keyboards family)
See below to find out how to write plainsong-style stemless notes
Write the required music for the incipit, then add a couple of extra bars and a system break
Choose Create ) Staff Type Change ) Pitched ) Hidden (no lines) and click in the score to hide
the empty bars on the first system
Select the barline at the end of the first bar, open the Bars panel of the Properties window, and set the Gap
before bar to, say, 20 to indent the staff. Try different settings to get the incipit as central as possible
Use Layout k Hide Empty Staves (shortcut 4x%%H or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+H) to hide all the other staves
on the first system
Create a Create ) Bar Number Change to bar 1 at the start of the second system so that the piece itself
starts with the correct bar number.
Add the English lyrics as normal - QZI Lyrics in the Reference section
For the Latin lyrics, create a new text style based on Lyrics (verse 2) - since this has the correct vertical
positioning already set up - and set it to use an italic font by default, or just edit the Lyrics (verse 2) text style
if all the second-line lyrics are italics - Q3 Edit Text Styles in the Reference section
If necessary, use dotted slurs (from the Create ) Line dialog) to make the underlay for the Latin words clearer
(see the alto part in the second system of the example above).
Dont forget the useful function for selecting a line of lyrics at once: Edit ) Select ) Select More (shortcut
4%gA or Ctrl+Shift+A); after this you could use the arrow keys to move them up and down, or use Layout )
Align in a Row (shortcut O%%R or Ctrl+Shift+R) to line them up.
You can also copy a line of lyrics to the clipboard and then paste them into another staff, which
for choral music much quicker - IZQ! lyrics in the Reference section for more details.

creating lyrics

Input method
The most straightforward input method for choral music is simply to input each voice separately.
In some cases where the rhythms are very similar, you could input e.g. the soprano part, copy it into the other staves
using x-click or Alt+click, and then repitch each staff (either via step-time, or using alphabetic input) - KQ Note
input in the Reference section.
When working with a short score, you could input, say, the soprano and alto voices together using Flexi-time, and then
swap the alto notes into voice 2 (e.g. use a filter to select the lower note and then type 722 or Alt+2 to swap them
into voice 2).
Double choir
Simply create the instruments with the Create in default order option off, so you can keep the second choir
separate from the first, The two sets of instruments can have identical names - this may confuse you, but it wont
confuse the all-knowing Sibelius.
90
-~-~-

_.__.________

-___ -_____

Choir

Scores for double choir sometimes alternate between writing the two choirs separately and having them interleaved.
Write the interleaved sections by adding an extra staff to each singer in the first choir so each singer has a pair of
staves, and hide these staves when the choirs split. You should put a system break at the points where one format
changes into the other, or you may get systems with a mixture of both.
Stemless notes
Non-metrical music such as plainchant often requires notes without stems. Simply select the notes you want to make
stemless, and type 6x8 or Shift+Alt+8 (or use the drop-down menu on the Notes panel of the Properties
window).

!r

91

How to

Early music
Vocal music
LQ Choir how to on page 86.
Sibelius also includes some special barlines (lLL!2I Barlines in the Reference section) particularly appropriate for
early vocal music editions, such as:
l

mensurstrich (barlines between the staves, but not bisecting the staves), as used in editions of polyphonic music
of composers such as Palestrina and Tye
tick and short barlines, as used in plainsong.

For examples of these barlines, open the Early music score in the Notation folder inside your Scores folder.
Prolation
Prolation is the medieval mensural notation, and represents the division of the whole-note (semibreve) either into
three smaller time-units (major prolation) or two (minor prolation).
Major prolation is represented by a circle, and minor prolation is represented by a circle bisected by a vertical line. You
can create these using the Create ) Symbol dialog - LQ Symbols in the Reference section.
Prefatory staves
Input the prefatory music into the first bar of the score (which you will probably need to input as an irregular bar),
using notes and/or symbols.
Then select the barline at the end of the incipit, and click Layout ) Break ) Split System. This repeats the clefs,
bracketing and so on at the start of the second bar. To close up the gap after the incipit, select the barline after the gap
and choose Layout ) Reset Position (shortcut U%%P or Ctrl+Shift+P).
By selecting the barline before or after the incipit and opening the Bars panel of the Properties window
(/IL!2 Properties in the Reference section), you can adjust whether clefs, key signatures, brackets and the barline
itself will appear. You can also adjust the size of the gap after the incipit numerically from this panel. When creating
the new clefs and key signatures in the first bar proper, remember to switch on Hide, and for time signatures,
remember to switch off Allow cautionary.
See the example score called Early Church Music for an illustration of this.
To join any divided system back together, select the first barline after the gap, open the Bars panel of the
Properties window, and set the Gap before barline to 0 spaces.

92

Early music

C/et key and time signature


changes, with no cautionaries

Ornament symbols -

ILL! Symbols

Edited by DR. HELMUT BRO

GERONIMO ANONIMO (c. 1690- 1703)

Treble Viol

Con

:
-

Prefatory staves see page 92

b9
h

Slur crossed by notch staccato


symbol- I!LU Lines, Symb

Cue-sized notes 7

LPI

EDITORIAL COMMENTARY:

1 note-values (d ) have been halved; markings in brackets (and dashed slurs) are editorial additions.
Editorial footnote, with notes in text !!&I Text

How to

Extracted parts
n

Q2 Band, Jazz, Orchestra in How to.


Sibelius takes care of the layout and formatting of extracted parts automatical ly. For more details, Q2l Extracting
parts in the Reference section.
Extracting multiple players
In some full scores two players may share the same staff, e.g. Flutes 1 & 2. To extract parts for these two players,
extract the Flutes I 8 2 staff from the score, then use filters (l!!LI Filters and Find in the Reference section) to
remove, say, the Flute 2 music (which are in voice 2). This produces a Flute 1 extracted part.
Then extract the Flutes 1 & 2 staff again; this time, filter all the voice 1 notes and rests only (thus leaving all the text
directions unselected), and delete them to produce a Flute 2 part.
For details on scoring for multiple players, IL!2 Instruments in the Reference section.
Extracting parts for doubling instruments
In some situations a player may switch instruments in the course of a piece (e.g. alto saxophone and flute) LQ Extracting parts in the Reference section.
Change control
If you make a change in an extracted part, that change will not automatically be reflected in the score. You should try
and make all changes in the score, and then re-extract those parts which are affected.
Cues and other directions
Parts often contain instructions and cue passages which would not be displayed in the score. You should enter these
into the full score and set them to be hidden in the score but to show in the extracted parts - !I2 Extracting
parts in the Reference section.

Extracted parts

Instrument name automatically


added when part extracted

Title - ITElI Text

for bassoon and orchestra, Op. 75

16

29
A

Cue passage, hidden in the


full score - UJ Cue notes

and grace notes

I
I
f
I

If/_!

I \
$

I
I

Page turn made at multirest

How to

Guitar
Staff notation

iLLid! Text

iL!JI Triplets..

ILLI Symbols

Beam across rests -

!!l.U Beams

.
ILLI Lines

Arpeggio line -

UlJ lines

Tablature

Excerpt from Ordinary World copyright 0 2001 Ryan Maziarz and Philip DeStieger. All rights reserved. For further InformatIon, visit www progrewvetranscnptions.com.

96
\

- -___

Guitar

Lute tablature
Lute tablature staff type with
initial bat-line switched off

hi

ILL!! staves

Do wland mordent % 1 1 Symbols

Ornamentation dots -

Sibelius is supplied with a manuscript paper for lute tablature which is set up with appropriate extra staves for the
rhythm notation above the staff. I!LLJ Guitar tab for specific details on creating lute tablature.
Rhythm notation
Sometimes you might want to notate a rhythm on a staff without using any noteheads at
l-ml
n
-3-3
all. To achieve this:

I
l

Enter the rhythm as normal notes


Flip the stems of the notes if necessary - select the notes and choose Edit b Flip (shortcut X) to flip their stems
Select the notes and type 6717 or Shift+Alt+7 to choose the headless notehead style.

This kind of notation is easiest to read when it is above the staff, so its a good idea to place your notes on the top
space of the staff, as shown above.
Manuscript paper
Various guitar and guitar tab manuscript papers are supplied for you to use, and you can always create your own IL!2 Manuscript paper in the Reference section.
Example scores
Take a look at the Guitar score from the Other folder within your Scores folder for examples of special guitar
notations, including slides and string indications.

97

How to

Jazz
L!2 Band, Extracted parts, Orchestra in How to.
Input method
The example opposite is largely homophonic in texture. It was prepared in short score on four staves (one staff each
for the saxophones, trumpets, and trombones, plus another for the bass), and then each staff exploded onto the
appropriate staves of the big band score using the Arrange feature.
You can also use the Arrange feature to create an entire arrangement in a number of styles. For more details,
ILL!/ ArrangeTM in the Reference section.
Manuscript paper
Start with one of the Inkpen manuscript papers, as the handwritten appearance of the Inkpen font is ideal for jazz
and big band scores - EL!/ Manuscript paper in the Reference section.
Speed tips
Select a row of chord symbols using Edit ) Select ) Select More (shortcut &#A or Ctrl+Shift+A) to
move them all at the same time with the arrow keys, or align them with Layout ) Align in a Row (shortcut
l

4%%R or Ctrl+Shift+R)
l

To write slash notation for, say, piano or guitar parts, input a single bar, select it and type 6x3 or
Shift+Alt+3 for the appropriate notehead, and then use multicopy to copy that bar along the rest of the staff in
a single operation - ELI Selections and passages in the Reference section.
Repitching can be a really fast way of inputting music with identical rhythms on different instruments LL!II Note input in the Reference section.

Improving playback
Jazz scores often sound quite empty when played back because large sections of the score are left open for
improvised solos. Why not try playing in a solo using Flexi-time into an unused voice, and then use Sibeliuss Edit )
Hide or Show ) Hide function to hide everything in that voice throughout the solo passage?
Your score will look the same when printed out, but itll sound much better!
Example scores
Take a look at the Jazz and Big band scores in the Other folder within your Scores folder for more ideas.

98

l Ll Rehearsal marks

Bar numbers on every bar -

~~~- LQBarnumbers

Imw PETE HILLI~AN

f G-r tf
J - ff
ALTO

Cn e /

Py
> t
d - ff

TENOR

Srw 1

f q-f

Ij

d - ff
TENG~

Srw E J

Open and closed mute &JJ Articulations


I

s,?J$
>ti - ff
f

ri q

Boxed text for instructions -

Marcato (hat7 EliI Articulations

MUTEO 1

tJJJ,:f
3 -ff
i
s-

--

l!Q Percussion _-

How to

Lead sheets
Lead sheets are scores consisting of a single staff showing only the melody, the basic harmonic structure (i.e. chord
symbols), and the lyrics (if any) of a song or composition, most popularly in jazz but also in other commercial idioms
(e-g. POP).
Because they are traditionally hand-copied, they use somewhat different conventions than other engraving; for
example, they typically show the clef and key signature at the beginning of the first system only, and each system may
begin with a closed staff, i.e. with a initial barline.
Manuscript paper
Use the Lead sheet manuscript papers to write your lead sheet, as it is already set up for you with suitable options.
Hiding clefs and key signatures
To hide clefs and key signatures after the first system, simply create an appropriate staff type change somewhere on
the first system:
l

In House Style ) Edit Staff Types, choose the Pitched category, select 5 lines, then click New
Click Yes to confirm that you want to create a new staff type based on the 5 lines type, and give it an
appropriate name, say, 5 lines (lead sheet)
Switch off Initial clefs and Key signatures, then click OK
From the Create ) Staff Type Change submenu, choose your new staff type, and then click in your score
to create a staff type change.

The clefs and key signatures will disappear from subsequent systems; note that this has the effect of canceling the key
signature altogether, so you may find that unnecessary accidentals appear.
Initial barlines on single-staff systems
Because this is unconventional engraving practice, it isnt an automatic Sibelius feature, but it can be achieved easily
enough:
l

Add an extra blank staff beneath the single real staff


On the Staves page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut 0#E or Ctrl+Shift+E),
set Distance between staves to -2. (Yes, a negative number: at this point, the staves should partially
overlap.)
In House Style ) Edit Staff Types, modify the No lines (hidden) staff type by ticking the Initial
barline box, and then click the Create button.
Apply the modified staff type to the extra staff, right from the beginning.

Note that this method is not particularly resilient to reformatting, especially moving staves up and down; if you find
that the initial barline is either too long or too short after reformatting your score, change the Distance between
staves value.

100

Lead sheets

Text in Instrument
name at top left

text sty/e

Staff vpe change with no clef or key


signature - see page 96

CONCEQT

I/

"kCHY' PETE MILLI~AN

system - see page 100

fsus4

Four bars per system, with

Make Layout Uniform


plug-in - %U Plug-ins

F$O

LLl Chord symbols


4M SUS4 oM%

qA

Staves stopping early

- laL4 Staves

How to

Music examples
You can use Sibelius to prepare music examples for inclusion in documents created in other programs quickly and
easily.
All of the music examples in this User Guide were produced in t:tiis way!
Margins
Because staves always extend fully across the page from the left- to the right-hand margin, short examples can end up
with very wide note spacing. To squeeze the note spacing of single system examples closer together for a better visual
result, set a very wide right-hand margin in the Layout b Document Setup dialog (shortcut #D or Ctrl+D) l!Z!A Document Setup in the Reference section.
Special considerations
When preparing music examples, you may want to switch off page and bar numbers (i1!!221 Styles in the
Reference section), make barlines invisible (LQ Barlines in the Reference section), or perhaps hide the
initial barline by modifying the staff type (LQ Staves in the Reference section).
You may also want to use bars of no fixed length (L!2 Bars and bars rest and Free rhythm in the
Reference section), or unusual noteheads (KQ Noteheads in the Reference section).
Saving graphics files
Sibelius can export music examples in a variety of different graphics formats, including bitmap and EPS. Which format
you should use depends on the program to which you want to export the music example - LQ Saving graphics
files in the Reference section for more information.

Music examples

A comparitiue analysis of Beethoven slow m&&&s and Brahmss Ein deutsches Requiem
adipiscing elit, sed diam nonummy nibh euismod tincidunt ut laoreet dolore magna aliquam
erat volutpat. Ut wisi enim ad minim veniam, quis nostrud exerci tation ullamcorper suscipit
lobortis nisl ut aliquip ex ea commode consequat. Duis autem vel eum iriure dolor in hendrerit

-------- _____ ---

8-7-6-5

I
narten: F dur

II v I IVC dur

(I

V-(1 IV II)- V-(1 IV V)

molestie consequat, vel


m vel eum iriure dolor in hendrerit in vu Bracketed text sto odio dignissim qui
re eu feugiat nulla facilisis at vero eros
QA Text
blandit praesent luptatum zzril delenit augue duis; I
1 nulla facilisi. Lorem ipsum
dolor sit amet, consectetuer adipiscing elit, sed diam nonummy nibh euismod tincidunt ut
laoreet dolore magna aliquam erat volutpat. Ut wisi enim ad minim veniam, quis nostrud
exerci tation ullamcorper suscipit lobortis nisl ut aliquip ex ea commode conseq

lLLL!l

Cue notes

ILLI Document Setup


giat nulla facilisis at vero
eros et accumsan et iusto odio dignissim qui blandit praesent luptatum zzril delenit augue
duis dolore te feugait nulla facilisi. Lorem ipsum dolor sit amet, consectetuer adipiscing elit,
sed diam nonummy nibh euismod tincidunt ut laoreet dolore magna aliquam erat volutpat.

84

How to

Orchestra
IL!2 Band, Extracted parts in How to.
Manuscript paper
Use one of Sibeliuss orchestra manuscript papers (such as Orchestra, symphony, Orchestra, small or
Orchestra, film) when you start your score; these templates have many useful default settings which you would
otherwise have to remember to change yourself. Dont forget that you can easily add or remove instruments from
these manuscript papers if you need a slightly different instrumentation. LQ Manuscript paper in the
Reference section.
Transposing score
You can switch the music between written pitch and sounding pitch at any time by choosing Notes b Transposing
Score (shortcut UXT or Ctrl+Shift+T) - EL! Transposing in the Reference section.
Page and staff size
Orchestral music is typically printed on Tabloid or A3 paper. The ideal staff size will depend on the number of staves
on the page, but its easy to change at any time - LQI Document Setup in the Reference section.
Arrange
Sibeliuss Arrange functions can provide useful assistance in realizing an arc :hestra I work from, say, a piano score IlLI! ArrangeTM in the Reference section.
Input method
In the example on the facing page, the first few bars in the woodwind instruments are doubled at the octave: so input
them once, copy and then transpose by an octave.
As ever with large ensembles, the key to creating your music efficiently is to do the minimum of reinputting. Use
7-,-click or Alt+click to copy rhythmic figures or passages, and then repitch them (ELI Notes input in the
Reference section).
Doubling instruments
Doubling instruments are two (or more) instruments played by the same person, e.g. flute 3 and piccolo LQ! Instruments in the Reference section.
Example scores
Take a look at the example scores in the Orchestral folder inside your Scores folder for more ideas.

104

_.___

-_.A

Orchestra

_ l!ldl Rehearsal marks

Hairpins - f&l lines

r Technique text -

LID IQ1 Text

ZJJ
f

One voice -

i-

Custom transpositions IU Instruments

0:) 9l

Rehearsal marks and tempo text


automatically repeated - 10 101 Style

Instrument names in German -

IO 1 Dl Instruments

I I

Two voices -

How to

Percussion
EL!! Band in How to.
Noteheads
A wide variety of noteheads is used in percussion notation, and Sibelius includes all the most commonly-required
types - LQ Noteheads in the Reference section.
Symbols
The Create ) Symbol dialog contains a wide range of percussion symbols, including most symbols provided in the
well-known ChentTM font, symbols for various (mainly pitched) percussion instruments, and for sticks and beaters L!2 Symbols in the Reference section.
Flams, drags, ruffs and rolls
All of these common drum notations are achieved using grace notes (ELII Grace notes and cue notes in the
Reference section) and tremolos (LQ Tremolos in the Reference section). You might also find it useful to
use a staff type where notes on single-line staves always have stems pointing up - ILL! Percussion in the
Reference section.
Defining drum sets
You can change Sibeliuss default drum set (kit) mapping - L!2 Percussion in the Reference section.
Example scores
Take a look at the Big band and Jazz scores in the Other folder within your Scores folder for examples of drum
set (drum kit) notation, and the Sax concerto score in the Orchestral folder uses a variety of unpitched and
pitched percussion instruments.

106

Percussion

Snare ruff - llL-1 Cue notes


and grace notes

Lu Rehearsal
marks

Repeat barlines -

iLLGIl Barlines

4
4

T i m p . 9 :I: 4,

I - IUB Stems

III

cA

Boxed text -

I
s(

L
V

Xyl.

Two voices Q2 Voices

WI Percussion

Mar.

f&l!

lines

How to

Piano, organ and harp


Piano
Extra staff above Header - a Text

LQ Page numbers

l!LLl Staves

Cautionary naturals a Key signatures

simile

+ Chords split between


staves - I!!&! Beams

Line showing
voice-leading l!UJll Lines

Harp
Plectric sounds (play with
fingernails) - !LQ Symbols

Pedal diagrams see page 7 74

108

Harmonics a Articulations

Glissandi -

Two-chord tremolo (bisbigliando)

U2l Lines

- l&l Tremolos

Metallic sound, holding


pedal between notches -

i!Ll Symbols

\
Technique text

- l!=a Text

Piano, organ and harp

Organ
Registration in Technique

Tous Its clav~crs accouplCs sur G.

CLAUDE LE BRUIT (b. 1 9

Avec intensitk (J = 140)

Organ 1

Ped.

crest. poco a poco

Clef changes - - Double barline UJ! Clefs


ELI Barlines

109

How to

Harp pedal diagrams


Harp music often includes indications of which position the various pedals are in; typically, these are either written as
boxed text (LQ Text in the Reference section), or as harp pedal diagrams.
To input harp pedal diagrams, create some Technique text (type B%T or Ctrl+T and click in your score) then type
0x7/8/9/+ or Ctrl+Alt+7/8/9/+ on the numeric keypad to obtain, respectively, the symbol for
natural/sharp/flat/vertical line. These are also available from the Technique text word menu (Control-click or rightclick when creating text).
The symbols represent the positions of the pedals in the order D C B E F G A with a vertical ine after B.
Thus a diagram consists of typing 8 symbols. A notch above the horizontal line means flat; below
means sharp. The pedal diagram on the left denotes D flat, C, B sharp, E sharp, F flat, G flat, A.

+i=+

For harp pedal text like C# Db E#..., use Technique or Boxed text and type the accidentals using x or Ctrl plus the
accidentals on the numeric keypad.
You can also check your score to make sure that you dont write any notes which cant be played with particular pedal
configurations - choose File ) Plug-ins ) Proof-reading ) Proof-read (GOI Plug-ins in the Reference
section).
Manuscript paper
Use the supplied Piano A4 or Piano Letter manuscript papers, as these have a number of useful options, such as
appropriate playback settings and instrument name formats, set up for you. L!2 Manuscript paper in the
Reference section for more details.
Example scores
There are a number of piano scores included with Sibelius: try Piano study from the Other folder inside your
Scores folder, and Chopin Espressivo and Liszt Espressivo from the Performance Style folder.
For an example of organ music - including hidden notes that play back - open the Organ score from the Other
folder inside your Scores folder.
For some examples of how harp pedal diagrams are used, try opening the Sax Concerto score from the
Orchestral folder inside your Scores folder, which also features glissandos. The Plug-ins score (in the
Education folder) shows how the Proof-read plug-in checks for errors in pedal diagrams.

110

s--- ~ -~

--_I.___--- __.-. .~ _- __- ____


Voice and keyboard

Voice and keyboard


Manuscript paper
Start your score using one of the supplied Voice + keyboard or Voice + keybd (title page) manuscript
papers, as these have useful options set up for you. LQ Manuscript paper in the Reference section.
Codas
Codas are often written at the end of a score or part following a division in the system - the final system breaks off
halfway across the page, then restarts after a gap, with a new clef and key signature.
to coda -e

D.C. al $

-@- CODA

Sibelius automatically handles this for you. Simply select the barline where you want the coda to start, and choose
Layout ) Break ) Split System.
You can drag the barline at the start of the second half of the system in order to increase or decrease the gap (to
remove the gap entirely, select the barline after the gap and choose Layout ) Reset Position). To control
whether the clef, key signature etc. are repeated after the gap, select the first barline after the gap and open the Bars
panel of the Properties window (ELI Properties in the Reference section).
To add the coda symbol to your score, the best way is to use Tempo text. The symbol can be chosen from the word
menu (or you can type 6tgO or Ctrl+O - this is a zero, not a letter 0) and when created in your score, will be
duplicated in all parts. The segno symbol is also most conveniently created as tempo text from the word menu or by
typing %84 or Ctrl+Shift+A. This is not the only way of creating these symbols - but it is the easiest! Note that da
cape (D.C.) and dal segno (D.S.) text, used for instructions such as D.S. a/fine, is also found in the Tempo text word
menu.

111

.-

How to

Instrument names unnecessary,.


indent staff by dragging initial
barlin e

Custom fonts U Edit Text Styles

_-+
_

Hanging verse number -

IU Lyrics
Dm

Am

F~/D

11.
C/G

67

I
,

F/C

bbcayar

ILLI lyrics

172

Voice and keyboard


Tempo text - IEQI Text
78

Ad

C/E F~/D

67

F/C

Double barline IEQ Barlines


Codas - see page I

15
=+ coo9

Block lyrics LQ Lyrics

113

How to

worksheets
Manuscript paper
Sibelius is supplied with a wide range of manuscript papers (L!ZI Manuscript paper in the Reference section)
already set up for you with standard options and layout to aid in the creation of worksheets. These include:
l

Treble c/et bass c/et keyboard and handouf worksheets: set up with empty staves, ready for text to be added.
MAered worksheefs: ideal for short questions, e.g. aural tests etc.

Input method
In general, to create a worksheet you should:
l

Create the bars of music you want and position them;


Hide bars you dont want to see;
Finally, add text.

Positioning staves
Creating worksheets requires a working knowledge of the layout tools available in Sibelius, chiefly staff spacing
(usually by moving staves up and down the page), creating system or page breaks (LQ Breaks in the Reference
section), and hiding bits of staff that arent required.
To give you complete control over the positioning of staves, on the Staves page of the House Style )
Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut 6#E or Ctrl+Shift+E), set Justify staves when page is

x0/0

full to

100%.

For more information, E! Layout and formatting in the Reference section.


Hiding staves
To hide e.g. part of a system, use a Create ) Staff Type Change to No lines (hidden) - for an example of
this, !!LJJ Advanced notation topic earlier in this How to section.
Free-form text
Using Create F Text ) Other Staff Text ) Plain Text, you can type anywhere on the page. Simply drag the
text to the desired position with the mouse.
Example scores
Try opening the Exam paper score in the Education folder within the Scores folder for an example of another
kind of worksheet.
The Education folder also includes some blank manuscript papers for printing, and, Teaching Tools, an example
of an exercise from the Sibelius Teaching Tools resource pack - choose Help ) Sibelius Teaching Tools for
more information.

114

Worksheets

Based on supplied worksheet


manuscript paper

Plain text - L!2! Text

T\

larmony &

Counterpoint

Name:

orksheet 12

Date:

System break - ILLI Breaks

1. Complete the harmonic analysis of the following chorale by J.S. Bach:

No instrument names
- U!

Instruments
2. Complete the missing voices in the following two phrases:
@6nd tenor

Alto and bass

3. Continue the following two-part invention texture for 8 bars:

System break -EQ Breaks


I

iU Bar numbers

LLOJ Bars and bars rest

/ TJ

_I

1I
I

~_ ____ -__- -. ___-___ _ ~ _

Reference

Reference

Accidentals
L!2 Notes, chords and rests.
Creating an accidental with a note
When you create a note using mouse or keystrokes, you can give it an accidental at the same time by choosing one
from the first or fifth keypad layout (shortcut F12) before putting the note into the score. (You can also add
articulations, rhythm dots, tremolos and non-standard beaming from the keypad at the same time.)
Accidentals are automatically created when you input from a MIDI keyboard.
Adding accidentals to existing notes
Select the note(s) in question, then choose an accidental from the first or fifth keypad layout.
To add accidentals to all the notes in a chord at once, double-click one of the notes in the chord and then choose an
accidental.
Removing particular accidentals
Select the note(s) in question, then choose the accidental from the keypad again, to toggle it off.
l

Alternatively, the slow and fiddly way is to select the accidental(s) with the mouse (taking care not to select the
associated note(s) at the same time), then hit Delete.

Removing lots of accidentals


Select the notes in question, then, from the fifth keypad layout (shortcut F12), choose the button
that corresponds to the 0 key on the numeric keypad, shown on the right.
Bracketed accidentals
Accidentals are sometimes written in round brackets to show that they are cautionary or editorial. To add brackets to
an accidental on a selected note (or group of notes), choose the brackets button from the fifth keypad layout (shortcut
F12).
To add a bracketed cautionary accidental to a selected note with no accidental, you can just choose the bracket button
- Sibelius will fill in the implied accidental for you.
There is also a plug-in supplied with Sibelius which checks your score and adds cautionary accidentals as necessary LQ! Plug-ins.
Editorial accidentals are sometimes written in square brackets. To notate these, type the brackets as Technique text.
(2Idvanced users: if you need to use square-bracketed accidentals frequently, you can easily create new symbols for
common accidentals in brackets. Round-bracketed accidentals are already available as symbols.)
Small accidentals
Accidentals automatically go small on cue notes and grace notes. But if you want a small accidental on a normal-sized
note, create the accidental from the Create b Symbol dialog and choose Cue size or Grace note size before
clicking OK. Beware that accidental symbols will not automatically play back or transpose.
118

__~-~___~_____.-~___. ..-__ ~_

~____ ______._____ ___

Accidentals

Double accidentals
Double accidentals are used in
obscure keys such as G# minor in
order to avoid using too many
naturals. For instance, the sixth
note of Db minor is Bbb, which
means the same as A.

Double accidentals and quarter-tones


Obtain these from the fifth keypad layout just like normal accidentals.
Quarter-tones transpose automatically - try transposing E quarter-flat up a major
7th in your head - the answers overleaf. (Then write out the scale of E quarter-flat
melodic minor.) Whats more, Sibelius will respell quarter-tones (see below).
There is also a plug-in to make quarter-tones play back - LLI Plug-ins.

The symbols bb and b# are


occasionally used instead of b and
# when canceling a double-flat or
sharp earlier in the bar.

Other microtones
You can obtain and design further microtones using symbols, but these will not
automatically play back or transpose. You can change the design of the symbols by
editing them - for instance, if you prefer your quarter-tone flats to be filled in in
black, replace the backwards-flat in the fourth column in the Edit ) Symbols
dialog with a filled-in backwards-flat character - see Changing existing symbols in LLI Edit Symbols for
more details.

Spelling of accidentals
When inputting from MIDI (Flexi-time, step-time or MIDI file), Sibelius guesses whether to spell black notes as a sharp
or flat, based on the key signature and context.
To respell notes enharmonically (e.g. from F# to Gb), select the note(s) and choose Notes ) Respell
Accidental (shortcut Return on the main keyboard).
Return respells a double accidental (e.g. Ebb) as a natural (A) but not vice versa, as youre much more likely to want
to eliminate double accidentals than to introduce them. Obscurely, Return even respells quarter-tones. (Most
quarter-tones can be written in three ways, e.g. C quarter-sharp is the same as D three-quarters flat and B threequarters sharp.)
Sibelius also includes two plug-ins for respelling accidentals - L!2 Plug-ins.
Simplifying double accidentals
In the none-too-likely eventuality that your score contains double accidentals that you want to eliminate, simply select
the whole score (choose Edit ) Select ) Select All, shortcut #A or Ctrl+A), then from the Notes )
Transpose dialog (shortcut Shift-T) transpose it up by a Major/Perfect Unison with Double sharps/flats
switched off. All double accidentals will then be replaced with simpler equivalents.
Altered unisons
Altered unisons are two noteheads in a chord with the same pitch but different accidentals, e.g. Cb and G#.
Some composers such as Messiaen notate this as two noteheads side-by-side preceded by two
accidentals, rather like the interval of a second (see left-hand picture). Sibelius handles this
notation automatically in the obvious way: create a chord with two noteheads of the same pitch,
then add an accidental to each as normal.
Other composers add the second notehead on a diagonal stem called a stalk (see right-hand picture). To write this,
add the stalked notehead using one of the stalk symbols provided on the Create ) Symbol dialog (shortcut Z).

____

Reference

(However, the disadvantage of this notation is that the extra notehead will not transpose or play back, as it is a
symbol.)
Typing accidentals in text
You might want to add accidentals into text objects in your score - for example, if you wanted the title to include the
key of the piece.
To type accidentals in text, type # or Ctrl and the keypad key that corresponds to the accidental on the first keypad
layout (shortcut F8), e.g. 8g8 or Ctrl+8 produces a sharp sign, and x9 or Ctrl+S a flat sign. Note that Num
Lock must be switched on in order for this to work.
Moving accidentals
Accidentals are automatically positioned. For instance,, if you add an accidental to a chord which already has some, the
. .
accidentals will shift positions if necessary to avoid col lrdrng .
In the unlikely event that you want to move an accidental, drag it horizontally with the mouse, or nudge it by typing
OX+/-_) or Shift+Alt+t/+. To move in large steps, use a~%&/+ or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+t/+.
If you need accidentals above the staff (e.g. for ficta) then you can use a symbol from the Create ) Symbol dialog,
or if you want the ficta to play back, use the Add Ficta Above Note plug-in - &Q Plug-ins.
Engraving Rules options
In the even more unlikely event that you want to change the spacing between or around accidentals throughout a
score, there are excitingly obscure options for this available on the Notes and Clefs and Key Signatures pages
of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut &@E or Ctrl+Shift+E).
(Answer to transposing question.. D quarter-sharp. Well leave the scale for you to work out.)

Sur

AP
mu:
120

-- _._._

_____ ----

ArrangeTM

ArrangeTM
LQ Edit Arrange Styles.
Summary
Using Arrange musically
How Arrange arranges
Arrange styles
Block and Mixed styles
Explode
Reduction
Arranging for families of instruments
Arranging for orchestra

Arranging for band


Arranging for mixed ensembles
Arranging for choir
Arranging for jazz ensembles
Arranging for rock and pop ensembles
Arranging for solo instrument(s)
Arranging for other ensembles
Preparing music to be arranged
After arranging music

Arrange is designed to assist students with arranging and orchestration, and to save time for professionals who already
know what they want to do.
It intelligently copies music from any number of staves into any other number of staves. It can be used to produce
piano reductions, and to explode chords onto multiple staves. Most importantly of all, this sophisticated feature even
helps you arrange and orchestrate for a wide variety of styles and ensembles, from choral music to band and
orchestral scoring.
You can be as specific or unspecific as you like as to how you want to arrange. For example, if you already know which
instruments you want to use, you can use Arrange just as a quick way to copy music onto them, e.g. to split up chords
onto brass intelligently. However, students and others can use the numerous ready-made Arrange styles to experiment
with arrangement and orchestration at any level.
4
k

Summary
Arrange is, in effect, a special kind of copy and paste operation:
Copy the music you want to arrange to the clipboard using Edit b Copy (shortcut B%C or Ctrl+C). (Dont
copy unpitched percussion staves as Arrange only handles pitched material.)
Select the staves into which you want to paste the resulting music, either elsewhere in the same score or in
another score. (Note that you dont have to select the right number of bars in the destination staves - its
sufficient just to select a single bar.)
If you want to arrange a passage starting mid-bar, create suitable rests in all the destination staves so that you
can select the precise point at which you want the arranged music to be pasted.
Choose Notes b Arrange (shortcut U%%V or Ctrl+Shift+v)
The Arrange Style dialog appears; choose the desired style from the drop-down list, and click OK.
A progress bar appears, and within a few seconds, Sibelius has completed the arrangement for you, choosing which
music is best suited to which instruments, and transposing the music as necessary to suit their ranges.
121

Reference

If you havent already done so, try out Arrange by opening the example score Arrange in the Other folder within
the Scores folder and following the instructions at the top of the score. This should give you a flavor of what Arrange
can do.
The above is just a brief summary of Arrange - keep reading to understand the different ways to use this feature
before you try it out in practice.
Using Arrange musically
Like composing, arranging and orchestration are advanced musical skills that inevitably require human involvement.
Hence the Arrange feature is not intended to produce a completely finished result all by itself.
It is up to you to:
l

Choose the passage you arrange carefully - a phrase or less is usually best (more detail below). You dont have
to arrange all the source staves at once - you could arrange the right hand of a piano piece onto woodwind and
the left hand onto strings, if you know thats what you want.
Consider adapting your source music before arranging to make it more suitable for the instruments you are
using - Arrange never alters your basic material, and something which suits a piano may not be suitable for
arranging onto a wind band or string section without adaptation. See Styles on page 123 for advise on
how to improve your basic material, and After arranging music for some tips on what to do after arranging.
Choose the Arrange style and the staves you select carefully; Arrange styles to use for different ensembles are
detailed later. If you dont like the arrangement, choose Edit ) Undo and try again with a different Arrange
style and/or selected staves.
Vary the Arrange style and selected staves often to produce an interesting arrangement - dont always arrange
onto all instruments at once!
You should also modify the results of Arrange as appropriate, such as adjusting octaves or applying orchestration
techniques such as dovetailing music from one instrument to another.

Its important for you to understand that Arrange keeps the same instrumentation and pitch throughout each passage
you arrange - for example, if a line of notes starts very high and goes very low or vice versa, Sibelius wont dovetail
(jump) it from one instrument to another, or change its octave mid-passage. Arrange will however vary the
instrumentation between each passage you arrange as it sees fit.

Bl

Because of this, you should normally arrange no more than (say) a phrase of music at a time, otherwise the results
may force some instruments into difficult or unplayable ranges. Arranging short passages allows Sibelius to change the
instrumentation and pitch, to keep the music within the range of the instruments (and also to keep the arrangement
sounding interesting). Sibelius warns you if the passage you arrange is probably too long.
How Arrange arranges
Specifically, Arrange does this following (except for the special Explode and Reduction styles, explained later):
l

122

Chooses appropriate instruments to arrange onto from the destination staves you selected. Most or all of the
selected staves are normally used, unless the Arrange style is for a specific choice of instruments (e.g. the
Family and Mixed Ensemble styles described below) in which case any others youve selected are ignored.
Sibelius divides the music up among the instruments, normally with a single line of notes per staff if possible

Ex,

ArrangeTM

Some of the music may be transposed by octaves to get it into an instruments comfortable playing range or for
coloristic effect. (You can set playing ranges yourself, which will affect how Sibelius arranges music LQI Instruments.)
Sibelius may put different kinds of material onto different kinds of instrument (e.g. fast music on woodwind,
slow music on strings), depending on the Arrange style you choose. In particular there are Block and Mixed
styles of orchestration, explained below.
Sibelius may orchestrate using appropriate doublings, e.g. piccolo an octave above flute. Again this depends on
the Arrange style.
Other than splitting it up and transposing it, Arrange will not change the source music.
Arrange styles
The specific way in which Sibelius arranges your music is determined by the Arrange style. The Arrange style specifies
which instruments can be used, instrumental doublings, and which kinds of material go onto different instruments.
A wide-ranging list of over 130 Arrange styles is supplied, and you can even create your own (IL!2 Edit Arrange
Styles). In basic terms, the styles encompass explode and reduction operations, and arranging/orchestrating for a
wide variety of ensembles, from choir to band.
The Arrange styles are named as follows:
firstly, they specify the kind of ensemble or instruments they will arrange onto (e.g. Orchestra, Band,1
Family: Brass);
secondly, they may name the particular style of arrangement (e.g. Impressionist or Film);
thirdly, they specify any particular instruments that are included or omitted (e.g. no trumpets, or solo
woodwind and strings);
and fourthly, some styles state whether they will use a Block or Mixed orchestration (see below).
Each Arrange style also has a more detailed description on the right-hand side of the Arrange dialog when you select
the style; this gives useful information and advice about what the style does and how best to use it.
Block and Mixed styles
Arrange styles designed for orchestration are of two types - Block and Mixed:
Block puts different kinds of musical material onto different families of instruments. The material is split up
according to its speed - so in an orchestral arrangement, the woodwinds could play, say, the fastest music, and
the brass could play the slowest. Typically the tune is faster than the accompaniment, but by no means always.
In many cases we have provided two styles for the same families, e.g. one with woodwind playing the faster
music, and an alternative one with woodwind playing the slower music.
Mixed styles allow instruments in different families to double each other, so instruments with similar ranges,
such as violins and flutes, play the same material.
Where neither Block nor Mixed is stated, the Arrange style will produce a Mixed orchestration.
Explode
To explode chords (i.e. separate out their notes) onto a larger number of staves:
123

Reference

<
Flute

Oboe

Clarinet in Bb

Bassoon

v
l

.
&
---

Select the material you want to explode (which can be in one or more staves), and copy it to the clipboard by
choosing Edit b Copy (shortcut 6t%C or Ctrl+C)
Select the staves you want to explode onto (either elsewhere in the same score, or in a different score). Choose
Notes b Arrange (shortcut U%%V or ctrl+Shift+V)
Choose the Explode Arrange style, and click OK. Sibelius will then instantly explode the music onto the
destination staves.

If there are fewer staves than notes, Sibelius will put two notes on a staff in separate voices. If you subsequently want
to merge these two voices into chords in a single voice, simply select the passage and choose, say, Edit h Voice h 1
(shortcut x 1 or Alt+ 1).
Sibelius will also transpose notes by octaves if necessary to make them playable on the destination instruments.
If you explode a long passage, Sibelius may warn you saying We recommend you arrange no more than a few bars at
a time - ignore this and click Yes.
Reduction
To reduce music from multiple staves onto a smaller number of staves (sometimes called imploding as the
counterpart of exploding):
Flute

Oboe

Clarinet In J3

Bassoon

Select the material you want to reduce and copy it to the clipboard using Edit h Copy (shortcut 6t%C or
Ctrl+C)
Select the staves you want to reduce onto (either elsewhere in the same score, or in a different score). Choose
Notes b Arrange (shortcut U%%V or ctrl+Shift+V)
Choose one of the Reduction Arrange styles, and click OK.

A number of Reduction styles is provided which are intended for slightly different uses; read the description of each
style to find out which one is most suitable for the result you are looking for.
For keyboard reduction, the most suitable style will depend on the complexity of the source material. For most
purposes we recommend the Keyboard reduction: Up to 2 voices per staff style, but if you find the
124

Arr

Arrange

resultant reduction too complex, try the 1 voice per staff style instead; you should also consider omitting any
staves in the source passage which would be too hard to play on a keyboard instrument.
If you reduce a long passage, Sibelius may warn you saying We recommend you arrange no more than a few bars at
a time - ignore this and click Yes.
After using one of the Reduction styles, you may find a number of redundant dynamics are placed on top of one
another in the resulting music; if so, select the music as a passage and choose Edit ) Filter ) Dynamics (shortcut
~T:D or Shift+Alt+D), then hit Delete to remove them. (In rare cases you may also find redundant slurs after
making a reduction, in which case use filters to remove them too.)
Arranging for families of instruments
The 1 Family and 2 Families styles will only arrange onto the instruments specified in the name of the style - so,
for example, you could choose all the staves in an orchestral or band score and then use the 1 Family:
Woodwind Arrange style, and music will only be arranged onto the woodwind instruments. However, if you select
(say) all woodwind staves except flutes, flutes will not be used.
These styles are also suitable for arranging music for smaller ensembles, e.g. wind quartet, brass quintet or string
orchestra.
The 2 Families styles are provided in both Block and Mixed configurations, to give different textures and colors.
Arranging for orchestra
The Orchestra styles are grouped according to musical style. There is a variety of styles for music ranging from
Baroque to Modern, with Impressionist and Film along the way.
Most of the Orchestra styles produce tuttis if you select all the staves, although you can select any number of
destination staves; hence if you select only, say, the flute, clarinet and viola staves as the destination passage, only
those instruments will be used when you Arrange. To avoid getting tutti orchestration throughout, we recommend you
vary the staves you select and the Arrange style you use!
Other styles, such as the Family and Mixed Ensemble styles, only use smaller groups of instruments to produce
particular coloristic effects. You dont have to select particular staves when using these styles - you can just select all of
them, and the style will only use the instruments its designed for. Read the description of each Arrange style carefully
to see which instruments it expects to use.
Try out some of the more exotic styles - you may find some very attractive results with more unusual instruments.
Note that none of the styles include unpitched percussion, although a few styles do use pitched percussion
instruments for added color (e.g. timpani in the Romantic styles, and mallet percussion in the Modern styles).
You can of course omit pitched percussion by not selecting any pitched percussion destination staves.
Arranging for band
The Band styles are equally suitable for wind bands, concert bands, symphonic bands, school bands, marching
bands and drum corps. Read the descriptions: some of the styles produce tuttis, and some use combinations of fewer
instruments. Many of the styles include mallet percussion, but unpitched percussion instruments are not included.
The Brass Band styles, as the name suggests, are designed for arranging onto standard brass bands.
125

Reference

Read Arranging for orchestra above for general advice about using a variety of instruments and Arrange styles
(including Family and Mixed Ensemble styles) to produce the most interesting arrangement possible.
Arranging for mixed ensembles
The Mixed Ensemble styles are mainly provided as ready-made orchestrations for use with orchestra, band or
other large ensembles. They use just a few instruments each. As with the Family styles, use them for variety to avoid
arranging onto all the instruments too much of the time!
Arranging for choir
The Choir styles produce various standard choral effects, such as sopranos doubled by tenors at the octave, or the
melody on one of the inner voices with the other parts providing an accompaniment, and so on. The styles can be
used to arrange onto any combination of voices, so you can create arrangements for SSAA or TBB choirs just as easily
as SATB settings.
If you want to create a piano reduction of choral music, simply use the appropriate Keyboard reduction Arrange
style.
Arranging for jazz ensembles
There are different Jazz styles for a variety of ensembles, including quintet (which can also be used to arrange for
quartet and trio), big band, and trad jazz band. The Family styles are also suitable for big band and jazz band. Again,
vary the style and the staves you select, to produce an interesting arrangement.
Arranging for rock and pop ensembles
The Rock and Pop styles include standard guitar/bass/keys combinations (although note that they dont arrange
onto drums). Give the styles that include an orchestra a try!
Arranging for solo instrument(s)
The Solo with accompaniment styles put the melody onto a solo instrument and the remaining music onto
other instruments. To use the styles, you must select the accompanying instruments as specified by the style (guitar,
harp, keyboard or strings) and also select the solo instrument staff. You can select more than one solo instrument staff
(e.g. Flute and Clarinet), in which case they will end up doubling each other.
The plain Solo styles are provided as a quick way of putting the melody onto a single specified instrument. The
accompanying music is not used (and can be arranged separately onto any other instruments using other Arrange
styles).
All of these styles assume that the melody is the fastest music in the source material, which is typically but by no
means always the case; if not, you can use filters instead, e.g. to select the topmost line of notes from the source
music (EL! Filters and Find).
Arranging for other ensembles
If the ensemble you want to arrange for is not listed, e.g. cello sextet, simply choose the Standard Arrangement
style, which produces reasonable results on any combination of instruments.
Preparing music to be arranged
Its worth spending a little time optimizing your music before you use the Arrange feature to improve the results.
126

ArrangeTM

Sibelius doesnt change the source music (other than transposing it by octaves to suit the destination instruments), so
you should make any other adjustments required to make it more appropriate to the instruments you want to arrange
onto. Though you can do this after arranging, its better to do it beforehand so you dont have to make the same
changes on several different instruments. Some things to bear in mind:
l

Try to make the source music have a constant number of voices on each staff. (It can change number of voices
between different passages which youre arranging separately.) For example, in this case:

where voice 2 is only used occasionally in the right hand, you should separate off the bottom notes of the voice
I chords into voice 2. To do this, select the affected passage (here, in the upper staff) and choose Edit b
Filter b Bottom Note and then swap the music into voice 2 by choosing Edit b Voice b 2 (shortcut x2
or Alt+2), which will leave you with:

This ensures that Sibelius will put the new voice 2 line of notes into the same instrument(s). If you dont do this
then Sibelius will first warn you, and will then put the two notes originally in voice 2 into a separate instrument
with rests on either side. This is because Sibelius treats voice 2 as running throughout the passage, and it will
add rests where there are no voice 2 notes to create a continuous line of notes.
l

The Arrange styles such as Orchestra: Baroque are designed for music of that period - you cant make jazz
music sound Baroque just by orchestrating it onto Baroque instruments!
You may wish to split existing music into different voices to make it more suitable for the instruments youre
arranging for. For example, an oom-pah-pah bass figure works best if the oom lasts for the duration of the bar
in, say, voice 2, while the pah-pah chords are in voice I :
Strings
Piano

Piano

two voices

Before arranging
l

After

Arrange copies dynamics and other staff objects (such as symbols, lines and so on) - but it doesnt copy system
objects (such as key signatures and time signatures). If the music you are arranging contains changes in time
127

signature, you should create the time signature changes in the destination point (preferably before rather than
after arranging)
l

Delete unnecessary objects. For example, if youre arranging piano music for wind instruments, you should
delete any pedal lines before you start - but dont delete things like dynamics, slurs and trills, which youll want
copied to the destination staves
Delete any octave (8va) lines in your score and make them explicit - in other words, by transposing the music
by the appropriate number of octaves - before you arrange. This is because octave lines are rarely used for most
non-keyboard instruments, and Sibelius ignores octave lines when trying to decide which instruments best suits
the range of the notes

After arranging music


Arrange tries to keep music within each instruments range, but in some cases this isnt possible: so if you end
up with some notes out of range, you should either dovetail those notes onto another instrument with a more
suitable range, or change the octave of the notes out of range.
l

/
r

If you end up with a lot of notes out of range, youre probably trying to arrange too much music at once. Try
arranging a phrase at a time, as this will reduce the amount of cleaning up you will have to do afterwards.
l

If a particular staff requires two voices, after arranging you will find that Sibelius has written the music in two
voices throughout the destination passage (even if the voices are mostly in unison). Voice 2 may be above voice
1 for all or part of it, so you may need to swap the voices using Edit b Voice b Swap 1 and 2 (shortcut
Shift-V). If the voices are in unison or homophony, you may want to make it look cleaner by merging most or
all of the music on that staff into a single voice; just select the music as a passage and choose Edit b Voice b
1 (shortcut x 1 or Ak+ 1).

If you try arranging some music and find that some instruments end up playing unsuitable material (e.g. fast low
notes on Horn), Undo it and arrange again, either omitting those instruments from the selection so they wont
be used, or else using a different style. For example, with the styles for 2 families of instruments in blocks, there
are alternative versions provided with (say) the brass playing the faster notes or the slower notes.

r
0
t

<

128

Articulations

Articulations
LQ Notes, chords and rests.
Articulations are symbols above or below a note, chord or rest which indicate a playing technique, such as staccato,
accent and down-bow. You can create and delete articulations much like accidentals.
Unusual articulation marks
You may not be familiar with the
followina articulation marks..
J

Staccatissimo (very short)


Marcato
Medium pause
Short pause
Up-bow (for stringed instruments)
Down-bow
Harmonic, open hi-hat
Closed hi-hat (percussion),
muted or hand-stopped (brass),
left-hand pizzicato, trill (some
Baroque music)
Jg?,, >,
l

Creating articulations with a note


When you create a note, you can create articulations with it at the same time by
choosing one or more articulations from the first or fourth keypad layout before
putting the note into the score. (You can also add accidentals, ties, rhythm dots,
special noteheads, tremolos and non-standard beaming from the keypad at the
same time.)
Adding articulations to existing notes
To add articulations to a selected note or notes, simply choose the articulation(s)
from the first or fourth keypad layout.
When adding articulations to a chord, it doesnt matter which of the noteheads is
selected, as articulations apply to all notes in a chord.
Removing particular articulations
Select the note(s) in question, then choose the articulation(s) from the keypad,
to toggle them off.
l

Alternatively, the slow and fiddly way is to select the articulation(s) with the mouse (taking care not to select the
associated note(s) at the same time), then hit Delete.
To remove all articulations at once, choose the note(s) in question, then choose the fourth
keypad layout (Fl 1) and hit 0, which corresponds to the button shown on the right.

Moving articulations
Articulations are automatically positioned. For instance, if you add an articulation to a note which already has one, they
will shift positions to remain in the correct order and allow room for the new one.
Occasionally you might want to move an articulation. For example, an articulation is sometimes put at the wrong end
if all articulations in the vicinity are at that end; for example, if there are six notes with staccatos, five of which should
have the staccato above the note, you can move the remaining staccato above the note to follow the pattern even if it
should otherwise go below.
To move an articulation, select it and then:
l

choose Edit b Flip (shortcut X) to flip it to the other side of the note.
use the arrow keys (or drag with the mouse) to move the articulation vertically. (As usual, X/t/& or
Ctrl++/+ moves in larger steps.)

Note that when you flip or drag articulations, the operation applies to a// articulations attached to a note, and cannot

be applied to one articulation individually. (Should you need to do this, delete the articulation you want to use and
create a new one as a symbol. Beware that articulations created as symbols have no effect in playback.)
If you wish to reposition articulations throughout the score, EL!!l Engraving Rules options (below). *
Copying articulations
When you copy a note or chord with x-click or Alt+click or Edit h Repeat (shortcut R), the articulations are
copied too, which saves time.
Articulations on rests
The three types of fermata (pause) are the only articulations you can add to a rest, because the others dont make a
lot of sense. In the unlikely event that you should want some other articulation on a rest, obtain it using a symbol. (For
instance, in scores by Stockhausen and other contemporary composers, accents on rests have occasionally been
sighted, which apparently represent the sharp intake of breath induced by unexpected syncopation.)
When you add a fermata to a bar rest, it applies to all staves, and as a result is copied to all staves (and any extracted
Pans)*
Redefining articulations
If you want to change the appearance of articulations, edit them in the Edit ) Symbols dialog - EIJZI Symbols.
There are three unused spaces on the fourth keypad layout to which you can assign further articulations if desired.
Add symbols to the empty spaces in the Articulations row of the Create h Symbols dialog.
Your choice of which of the 3 empty slots to use depends on the order in which you want your new articulation to
stack when combined with other articulations. The order is the same as the order they are listed in the Edit 1
Symbols dialog. Maybe also mention that they have to define an above and below symbol for every articulation,
though often these are actually the same symbol instead of inverted versions.
I
Fermatas on barlines
You might want to place a fermata (pause) above or below a barline; to do this, simply create it from the Create h
Symbol dialog (shortcut Z). If you find yourself creating a lot of fermatas, and want them to extract into all parts, try
this:
l

Create a new system text style based on the Tempo text style called, for example, Fermata, with font Opus,
size 19.8pt and a suitable default vertical position - Ul Edit Text Styles
To input a fermata (pause) above a barline, type the letter capital U in Fermata text. The fermatas will then
extract into all parts.

Articulations above the staff


In music for some instruments - for instance, percussion and singers - it is preferable to have articulations always
above the staff. Sibelius does this automatically for certain instruments, although you can still flip articulations with
Edit ) Flip (shortcut X).

130

Articulations

If you need to force articulations to appear above the staff in other staff types, switch on the option Always
position articulations above the staff on the General tab of the Staff Type dialog (accessible from
House Style ) Edit Staff Types).
Engraving Rules options
The Articulations page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut U6t%E or Ctrl+Shift+E) has
various options:

f &Her on stem
r Cettisr cm n&#md
t/i&ical F&on

_-._- . . . . . . . . . .._..._.....
.
- ._.._.._....__ -_- . . -.- .._. ----__.-.- _._..-... - .__. -----...------105 spaces tmrl~c+kAmd
)05E- ?-pM,?M k#rn@m
F s;pacis ktwem7 ar$3_4l&ions

Fstmatas [pauass] on bai r&s


I Sm3C@Z &ova at&f

Always above: normally, articulations go below most notes which have stems up. This option is for jazz and
session musicians, who usually prefer articulations to go above as this makes them more visible.
Allowed in staff: most publishers draw staccatos and tenutos in the staff, some draw harmonics, a few draw
accents. We wouldnt recommend putting other articulations in the staff as they wouldnt fit between two staff lines
and so would be illegible.
The Position of articulation when near the stem options are:
Auto-position: this, the default option, horizontally positions any articulations that are at the stem end of the
note automatically: it centers the articulations halfway between the stem and the middle of the notehead, if the
nearest articulation to the stem is a staccato, staccatissimo or wedge. If the articulations are at the notehead end,
they are positioned as normal
Center on stem: fairly obviously makes articulations center on the stem rather than the notehead when at
the stem end
Center on notehead: makes articulations at the stem end centered on the notehead, to one side of the
stem.
The Vertical position options are:
l

spaces from notehead: when articulations go at the notehead end of a note/chord, this is the distance of
the nearest articulation. If the articulation is forced outside the staff it will be further away than this

Reference
l

spaces from stem: the corresponding distance when articulations go at the stem end
spaces between articulations: determines, funnily enough, the distance between artig_dations when
more than one is attached to a note.

Ve

132

Attachment

In Sibelius, every object in a score, including notes, lines, text and so on, is attached both horizontally and vertically to
the music so that it moves correctly when the format of the score changes.
This makes the music immune to any layout changes that may occur in future, which means you dont have to go
around cleaning everything up after making a major change to a score, such as adding a new instrument.
Viewing attachment
When an object is selected, you can see what its attached to as a dotted gray line. This indicates the staff the object is
attached to and the rhythmic point on the staff. If you find the dotted line irritating, switch off View b Attachment.
On the other hand, if you want to see all attachments in your score, type %A or Ctrl+A to select all the objects in
the score. Likewise, if you want to see all the objects attached to a single staff, simply triple-click it.
Sibelius can also draw rulers to show the precise distances between staves and attached objects - L!2! View menu.
Horizontal attachment
All objects are attached horizontally to a rhythmic position in the music. If you move a note left or right, all notes at the
same rhythmic position will move with it.
If an object is attached to a note, its attachment line will point to the note (or to the notes horizontal position).
Anything you put directly over or near a note will remain attached to that note, so if (say) a slur starts or ends at a
note, the whole slur will stretch or contract in the future if necessary to follow the note around.
If an object is in between two notes, it will attach to an in-between rhythmic position. This means that an object
halfway between two notes will always stay halfway in between, even if the size of the gap changes. Heres a classic
case, where the ends of the hairpins and thef stay proportionally positioned between the notes even when the
spacing changes:

<

-f P

Because Sibelius copes with this itself, it saves you a large amount of cleaning up when making major changes to the
layout, such as creating bars or extracting parts.
Vertical attachment
Most objects apply to a particular staff and are vertically positioned relative to it. For instance, a trumpet trill applies
only to the trumpets staff, and should stay above the trumpet staff if that staff moves. Objects which belong to a
particular staff are called staff objects.
If you move a staff up or down, all the attached objects follow it. Most importantly, if you extract a part, all the objects
attached to the appropriate staves go into the part. So its important that every staff object is attached to the correct
staff.
133

Reference

To ensure this, keep an eye on the dashed attachment line - particularly when text is in an ambiguous position
between two staves and could be attached to either.
Attaching to another staff
If an object between two staves is attached to the wrong staff, drag it to touch the other staff and it will re-attach itself
to that one instead - the dotted line jumps to show this. Then drag the object back to its original position.
A word of warning: dont put objects between two separate instruments meaning them to apply to both. This is a
convention sometimes used in manuscript but never in publishing, as it is incorrect notation. Any staff object will only
attach to one staff, so if you extract parts from the score the object will be left off one of the parts.
But its fine to write an object applying to both staves of fhe sclme msfrument, such as dynamics between keyboard
staves, because they will end up in the same part.
System objects
Some objects apply to all the staves in a system, not any particular staff, and are called system objects. Typical
examples of system objects are titles, tempo marks, rehearsal marks and 1 st and 2nd endings (1 st-/2nd-time bars).
Although these objects appear at the top of a system (and are sometimes duplicated lower down as well), they really
refer to every staff in the system. For instance, they should go into every instrumental part you extract, not just the
instrument at the top of the score.
Some menus and dialogs distinguish between staff and system objects. For instance, on the Create b Text menu,
the text styles which are system objects are listed below the staff objects.
To adjust which staves system objects appear above, LIZ! layout and formatting.
Note that system objects are the only objects that cannot be moved using the keyboard - if you need to move a
system object (such as some Title or Tempo text), you should drag it with the mouse.
Putting objects in weird places
Occasionally you may want to put a piece of text or other object somewhere far from the music, such as off into a
margin. It is fine to do this so long as you bear in mind that all objects are attached to the music, rather than being
fixed to a particular point on the paper. For example, staff objects in the margin are usually attached to the nearest bar
in the nearest staff, and will stay a fixed distance from that bar.
If the music reformats, the bar will move somewhere else and so the object could end up in an even weirder place
than you anticipated. So you may want to lock the format of the system or page to stop it from reformatting;
LQ Layout and formatting.

I
FI

134

Bar numbers

Bar numbers
Scores can have bar numbers which appear automatically. You can adjust their appearance in various ways described
below.
Frequency
The Bar numbers page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut 4B%E or Ctrl+Shift+E) lets
you specify how often you want bar numbers to appear - every fifth or tenth bar, or every bar, or at the start of every
system, or you can switch them off altogether,
Writing bar numbers on every bar is useful when inputting a score so you can easily see where you are. Its also a
convention used in music examples, handbell music, music for children (who may be reluctant or unable to count),
and parts for session musicians (who may be reluctant or unable to count).
Go to Bar
To jump quickly to any bar, choose Edit ) Go to Bar (shortcut x%C or Ctrl+Alt+G), type in the bar number
and click OK.
Bar number changes
To make bar numbers re-start at a particular number, you can put in a so-called bar number change. Bar number
changes enable you to restart bar numbers at new sections, to repeat sequences of numbers in 2nd endings Qndtime bars), and so on.
To create a bar number change, choose a note or rest in the bar whose number you want to change, choose
Create ) Bar Number Change, type in the bar number you want, and click OK. (Alternatively, make sure
nothing is selected, then choose Create ) Bar Number Change and click in the right bar.)
You can copy and delete bar number changes (unlike normal bar numbers), and you can also move a bar number
change horizontally and vertically up to three spaces away from the barline to which it belongs - if you move it
further, it will snap to the nearest bar, so you can move bar number changes by dragging them (but note that the
number will not change and attach to a new bar until it is within three spaces of the new barline).
By default a bar number change will always be visible. To hide it, simply select it and choose Edit ) Hide or
Show ) Hide (shortcut 08%H or Ctrl+Shift+H).
To write a special bar number that includes letters, such as 766 in a 2nd ending (&d-time bar) or film score, choose
Create ) Text ) Special Text ) Bar number. Now click in your score and create your weird number, Bear in
mind that this number wont automatically update itself if you add more bars - it may look just like the real thing, but
its just text.
First bar number
If you are inputting a section from a longer score, you may want to start with a bar number other than 1. To do this,
input a bar number change at the start (see above).

135

Reference

Bar 1
By default, bar number 1 is omitted (as are bar numbers on the first bar of any subsequent sections). If you want the
1 to appear, switch on Show at start of sections on the Bar numbers page of the House Style )
Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut &%%E or Ctrl+Shift+E).
Pick-up (upbeat) bars
If your music starts with a pick-up (upbeat) bar, its normal to number the first complete bar as bar 1, rather than bar 2
as it would otherwise be. Achieve this nicety by putting a bar number change to 1 on the first complete bar and then
hiding it (see below).
Moving bar numbers
Bar numbers can be moved horizontally or vertically - just select it and then drag it with the mouse. To reset a bar
number to its original position, select it and choose Layout ) Reset Position (shortcut 4%%P or Ctrl+Shift+P).
If your barlines are also shown above or below other staves in your score, note that dragging one bar number also
changes the position of all the repetitions of that bar number vertically in your score.
To move a// bar numbers vertically, read Text style below.
Hiding bar numbers
To hide a particular bar number, use Create ) Bar Number Change to put a bar number change there, using
the same bar number, then choose Edit ) Hide or Show ) Hide (shortcut 4%%H or Ctrl+Shift+H) to remove
it (or click Hide in score on the General panel of the Properties window).
For more information about hiding objects, LQ Hiding objects.
Text style
To change the style of bar numbers including their font, size and position, click Edit Text Style on the Bar
numbers page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut 4#E or Ctrl+Shift+E), then
proceed as for a normal text style (I!22 Edit Text Styles).
You can change the distance of the numbers above the staff by adjusting Default position (Vertical Posn tab).
By putting them below the top staff, you can position bar numbers between two keyboard staves.
Placing bar numbers on every staff
It can be useful when working on a large score to put bar numbers on every staff so you dont have to keep checking
the top staff to see where you are. On the Bar numbers page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog,
switch on All staves.
Youll probably want to switch this option off again before printing the score, as the bar numbers can collide with
barlines.
Placing bar numbers below the bottom staff
In some kinds of music, such as film scores, it is common for bar numbers to appear below the staff. To achieve this,
choose House Style ) System Object Positions and select Below bottom staff.

Bar numbers

Bar numbers are positioned the same distance below the staff as they are above the top staff; in other words, the
distance above the staff is mirrored below the staff.
(If you want other system objects to appear beneath the bottom staff, but not bar numbers, choose the Bar
numbers page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut 4%gE or Ctrl+Shift+E). Click Edit
Text Style and choose the Vertical Posn tab; under Multiple Positions, switch off Bottom staff and click
OK.)
Centering bar numbers on the bar
For film scores, you may want bar numbers to appear in the center of the bar (rather than over the barline). Choose
House Style ) Engraving Rules (shortcut &@?E or Ctrl+Shift+E), and select the Bar numbers page of the
dialog that appears. Switch on Center in bar and click OK. Note that this affects automatic bar numbers only, so
bar number changes (created via the Create ) Bar Number Change dialog) are not centered, but you can drag
them to the center manually.

Reference

Barlines
Sibelius supports a variety of bat-lines, suitable for various kinds of music, which you can put at the end or in the
middle of a bar.

Normal

Double

Start repeat
(winged)

End repeat

Dashed

In visible

Between
staves

Tick

Short

Final

Default barline style


By default, Sibelius uses normal barlines (a straight line), but you can change the default barline to any of the other
designs, which is useful for scores where you want most or all barlines to be invisible, or dotted, or in between the
staves, and so on.
To change the default, simply choose the required barline from the list under Default Barline Type on the
Barlines page of the House Style b Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut U%%E or Ctrl+Shift+E).
Normal barlines
You never need to put normal barlines into the score: just add bars, and barlines appear at the end of every bar.
You can move barlines by dragging them left and right. This changes the gap after the last note/rest.
You cant delete a barline in order to join two bars together; instead, you should double the length of the time
signature to fit the music into one bar. Similarly, to split a bar into two, shorten the time signature instead of trying to
draw a new barline.
Double barlines
Double barlines are used to denote
new sections.
A double barline should appear at a
key signature change, but not at a
time signature change or to coincide
with rehearsal marks (unless these
occur at the beginning of a new
section).

Other barlines
These include double barlines, dotted barlines, repeat barlines, early music
barlines, and so on. To create one, choose the type of barline you want from
Create b Barline, then click on an existing barline in the score or in the
middle of a bar. (If you have, say, a note selected when you choose the barline
you want, Sibelius will automatically put the barline at the start of that bar, which
saves time.)

When putting a barline in the middle of a bar, input the music in the bar first;
then add the barline between two specific notes or rests. (If you inputted the
barline first, it wouldnt be clear exactly where in the bar it was meant to go.) The barline may attach to the bar too
close to the following note; if this happens, select the barline and change the X parameter on the General panel of
the Properties window to change its offset.
If a barline occurs in the middle of a bar which has a bar rest in it, then in the interests of good notation you should
split the bar rest into separate rests on either side of the barline.

138

Barlines

Barline joins
For clarity staves are normally
joined by bar-lines to group similar
instruments together. These groups
often, but by no means always,
reflect the way staves are grouped
with brackets (see Brackets

and Braces).
In orchestral scores, staves with the
woodwind brass, percussion and
string sections are normally joined
by barlines but separated from
adjacent sections.
Vocal staves are never joined to
each
other,
nor
to other
instruments. Staves for the same
keyboard instrument are joined
together but separated from
a@acen t instruments.
When a score uses just a few
instruments (such as a wind
quintet), an unbroken barline is
used to avoid looking fussy.

Its common to split a bar between systems at a double barline or repeat bar-lines
(e.g. at the end of a line of a hymn). To do this in Sibelius, create two shorter
(irregular) bars and use a system break to split them between systems - L!2! Bars
and bar rests and Breaks.
You can copy, drag and delete barlines; deleting any of these other barlines at the
end of a bar (even an invisible barline) turns it back into a normal barline.
Final double barline
When you start a new score you are given a final double barline at the end, but you
can delete it if you dont want it.
Youre entirely permitted to put more than one final double barline into a score, for
instance if it consists of more than one movement, song or piece.
Repeat barlines
Create start and end repeat barlines in the same way as other special barlines. To
create lst- and 2nd-time bar markings, IELI Lines.
If you want to create winged repeat barlines, common in handwritten and jazz
music, switch on Wings on repeat barlines on the Barlines page of the
House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog.
To create a double-repeat barline, which goes between two repeated sections,

put an End repeat barline at the end of the first bar and a Start repeat at the start of the second bar. You can
drag the two repeat barlines further apart or closer together if you really want to.
Early music barlines
Sibelius includes barlines suitable for preparing editions of early music. In vocal music predating the convention of
time signatures, one method used by editors to help present-day performers understand the metrical divisions of the
music is to add barlines between the staves (sometimes called mensurstriche).
To use these barlines in your score, set the Default Barline Type to Between Staves on the Barlines page
of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut 4gE or Ctrl+Shift+E).
Some editors prefer the convention that the music should behave as if the barlines are present, with notes over
barlines being tied (as shown below on the left), and others prefer the opposite convention, with the music written as
if there are no barlines at all (as shown below on the right):
/

Reference
tied across the barline

dotted quarter-note

1 bar

I bar

I bar

Sibelius automatically ties notes across barlines, so your music will, by default, look like the left-hand example above. If
you prefer the other convention, use irregular bars where appropriate to create a single bar of twice the normal length
(L!2 Bars and bar rests), then add the barline in the correct place yourself.
You can also create Tick and Short barlines, which are useful for notating plainsong:

Sal

ve

Re

gi

na,_

ma-ter

mi

- se- ri -

car-di

ae.

These barlines are most useful in passages of music for a single instrument (or voice), but you can use them in music
for multiple instruments if you want.
Barline joins
Sibelius automatically joins staves into groups of similar instruments with barl ines (see box). However, you may want
to change this, as follows:
l

Preferably find a point in the score where there are no hidden staves, so you can check all barline joins at once
Click carefully at the top or bottom of a normal barline (you cant use special barlines to change barline joins) in
the score; a blue square handle will appear
Drag the handle up or down the system to extend or contract the barline. This affects every system in the score
simultaneously.
Youll find that by extending or contracting the barlines down the system you can reorganize the way staves are
joined by barlines any way you like.

Invisible barline
You can hide a barline at the end of a bar by replacing it with an invisible barline from the Barline menu. The
invisible barline appears light gray when View ) Hidden Objects is switched on (shortcut 71xH or
Ctrl+Alt+H), but disappears when this option is switched off.
The main use of an invisible barline is to notate a bar split between two systems (see Split bars, below).
Because the bars on either side are still really separate, there are three inevitable side-effects: some rhythms cant run
over the invisible barline (you may have to use tied notes); bar numbering will apparently get a bar out after the
barline (but you can correct this with a bar number change - EQ Bar numbers); and bar rests will appear as two
bar rests, one on either side. So use invisible barlines with care.
If you want to hide a// the barlines in your score, change the Default Barline Type to Invisible on the Barlines
page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut c)%gE or Ctrl+Shift+E).
140

L ----

Barlines

If you want to hide all the bar-lines in, say, a single staff, or all the staves belonging to an instrumental family, see
Barlines on some staves only below.
Barlines on some staves only
To hide all the barlines in a particular staff, or in an instrumental family (where the staves are all joined by a
continuous barline), click the top or bottom of the barline so that the blue handle appears, then hit Delete.
To restore barlines to those staves, click the top or bottom of the barline on an adjacent staff, and drag it across the
staves with no barlines.
Split bars
It is sometimes desirable to split a bar into two halves, the first half at the end of one system and the second at the
start of the next system. To do this:
l

Create two empty bars where you want the split bar to go
Input the music before the split into the first empty bar, and the music after the split into the second bar. To do
this the two bars will need to be of irregular lengths; LLD Free rhythm
Replace the normal barline with an invisible barline (or another special barline if you want)
If necessary, force a system break at the barline where the split occurs &!A Breaks). You should also rewrite
any bar rests appearing on either side of the split as normal rests.

Because split bars are still really two bars, they have the same three drawbacks as invisible barlines (see above).
Engraving Rules options
The options on the Barlines page of the House Style b Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut UB%E or
Ctrl+Shift+E) allow you to adjust the thickness of normal and special barlines, and the separation of double barlines,
should you be struck by an irrepressible urge to do this.
Perhaps more usefully, you can also set the default appearance of barlines in your score to use any of the options
Sibelius provides, and also choose whether or not to use winged repeat barlines in your score.

Reference

Bars and bar rests


ELI Notes, chords and rests, Multirests. To copy or delete several bars at once, LQ Selections and
passages.
Adding bars to the end of the score
Choose Create ) Bar ) At End (shortcut 61%B or Ctrl+B).
To add lots of bars, hold %B or Ctrl+B down. Alternatively, select the point in your score where you want to add
more bars, choose Create ) Bar ) Other (shortcut xB or Alt+B); type in the Number of bars you want,
click OK, and Sibelius creates the bars. If you had nothing selected when you chose Create ) Bar ) Other, the
mouse pointer will change color to show it is loaded with the empty bars, and you can click in your score to place
them.
Adding bars in the middle of a score
Choose Create ) Bar ) Single (shortcut 0%gB or Ctrl+Shift+B), then click in the score where you want to
create the bar.
Create ) Bar ) Single with an object selected (such as a note, rest, text object and so on) also adds a bar after the
selected bar.
To add lots of bars, use Create ) Bar ) Other (see Adding bars to the end of the score above).
Changing the length of bars
To change the length of bars because you are changing the time signature they are in, I!LLI Time signatures.
To change the length of an individual bar (i.e. create/delete notes from it) while retaining the music:
l

Create an irregular bar of the desired length (see below), just before or after the bar in question
Copy across the music you want to keep, as a passage (ILL! Selections and passages)
Delete the original bar.

Deleting a bar entirely


#-click or Ctrl-click an empty part of the bar, which should end up with a double-box around it
l

Hit Delete.

This deletes everything in the bar and removes the bar itself. You can delete several bars at once by selecting them as
a system passage first - EL! Selections and passages.
Deleting a bar in one staff
Click an empty part of the bar, which ends up with a blue box around it
l

Hit Delete to turn it into a bar rest. This also deletes other objects in the bar attached to that staff (e.g. text).

You can empty several bars at once, or a bar in several staves, by selecting them first - LQI Selections and
passages.
142

I___
Bars and bar rests

Creating a bar rest in one voice


Choose the voice number from the General panel of the Properties window
l

Choose the bar rest symbol from the second keypad layout (or type F9 followed by 0)
Click in the score where you want it to go.

This can be used either to create a bar rest in a voice which didnt previously exist, or to turn notes back into a bar rest
in one voice only. However, this only deletes notes or rests and leaves other objects alone. This gives you a choice: if
you want to delete text, lines and other objects too, select the bar and hit Delete.
Note that a bar rest is not the same as a whole-note (semibreve) rest. Bar rests are centered, while whole-note rests
go at the left of the bar, in the same place a whole-note itself would go, as shown below:
Whole-note rest
0
!

fJ

Bar rest

Deleting a bar rest symbol


Select the bar rest symbol and hit Delete. If the music was in two voices, this will turn it back into one voice. If the
music was in one voice, the bar becomes blank. Blank bars are useful if you want to put something else in the bar,
such as a funny symbol.
If you want blank bars throughout a score, as in some contemporary music, I22 Repeat bars and double
whole note (breve)/blank bar rests below.
Pick-up (upbeat) bars
Scores often start with a short bar, known as a pick-up bar (upbeat bar) or anacrusis. These are most easily created
at the same time as creating the time signature (LQ Time signatures). However, if you need to add a pick-up
(upbeat) bar later, input it as an irregular bar (see below).
If there is a pick-up (upbeat) bar at the start of the score, Sibelius will by default number it as bar 1. To make it
number the first complete bar as bar 1 instead, start that bar with a bar number change to bar 1 (LQ Bar
numbers).
Creating irregular bars
An irregular bar is one which is not the length specified by the previous time signature. Pick-up (upbeat) bars are a
common example. To create an irregular bar:
l

Choose Create ) Bar ) Other (or type xB or Ait+B)


In the dialog that appears, click Irregular
From the drop-down menu, choose one or more note values adding up to the length you want, or type them on
the keypad (with Num Lock on)
You can also specify a Number of bars if you want several irregular bars of the same length
143

Reference
l

Click in the score where you want to create the bar(s).

Changing a bar rests width


Just drag the bat-line at the end.
Repeat bars and double whole note (breve)/blank bar rests
To change a bar rest symbol to a repeat bar, double whole note (breve) bar rest or blank (missing) bar rest: select the
bar rest symbol and choose the design from the Bars panel of the Properties window. You can change bar rests
down all staves at once by first selecting the bar with #-click or Ctrl-click.
If you want blank bar rests throughout the score, switch off Show bar rests on the Bar rests page of the House
Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut &#E or Ctrl+Shift+E).
Moving a bar rest symbol
(Only really required when using two or more voices.)
Simply select the bar rest symbol and type /t\ or \L. Sibelius wont let you move a bar rest left or right because - lets
face it - its not all that useful.
If you type x-/t/& or Ctrl+/t\/& the bar rest moves by one and a half spaces, which is the right distance for the
slightly larger guitar tab staves.

Beams

Beams are the thick lines used to join eighth notes (quavers) and shorter notes into groups. Sibelius beams notes
together into groups for you automatically, though you may sometimes want to adjust beaming yourself.
Editing beams
You can adjust the way beams are grouped from the third keypad layout (shortcut Fl 0). Simply select the note(s) or
grace note(s) you want to adjust, then choose the appropriate button:
Breaks the beam from the previous note

Joins to the previous and next notes

Ends the current beam (i.e. breaks the beam from the next note)

Separates the note from those on either side

Joins to the previous note with just a single (primary) beam. Used for dividing a group of, say, 6 or more
notes into sub-groups.
If you want to adjust lots of similar beat patterns at once, input the music, then use Edit b Filter b Advanced
Filter (shortcut x6t%F or Ctrl+Ak+F) to select appropriate notes by rhythmic position before choosing the
appropriate beaming button.
Beams across rests and barlines
These work in just the same way as for notes For instance, to make a rest
beam to the previous note, or a note beam to the note before the previous
barline, type 8 on the numeric keypad. By default, rests do not beam - so to
beam a rest you should edit the rest itself, not just the notes on either side.
Reset beam groups
To regroup notes with beams using the default grouping, simply select the notes as a passage, then choose Notes b
Reset Beam Groups.
Beam angles
Occasionally you may want to adjust a beams angle or position, either to prevent it hitting a grace note or other
obstacle, or because you are a music engraver and have your own views on where beams should go.
To move a beam, zoom in close on it so you can see what youre doing, and simply drag either end up or down with
the mouse. Alternatively, select either end, then move it by typing /f\ or J/. dtg+/$ or Ctrl+/f\/J/ moves the beam
745

Reference

by whole spaces, You can also make quick adjustments to the angle of a beam by selecting the beam itself and
dragging up and down; this moves the left-hand end of the beam.
To set a beam back to its normal position, choose Notes b Reset Stems and Beam Angles, which you can
also do to a selected passage or multiple selection.
Note that adjusting a beams angle is exactly the same thing as adjusting the lengths of the stems the beam is attached
to.
You can also adjust beam angles throughout a score - see Engraving rules options below.
Reversing beams
To move a beam from above a group of notes to below it - that is, to flip the stem-directions of all the notes along the
beam - select any note in the group (just one note will do) and flip it by choosing Edit b Flip (shortcut X) L!2 Stems if youre not clear how. To restore the stem direction, flip the sOme note back, or select the group of
notes and choose Notes b Reset Stems and Beam Angles.
Cross-staff beams
Music for keyboard instruments often contains beamed notes flowing between the hands, like this:

To obtain this result:


l

Input all of the music onto the staff which uses most of the music which crosses between the hands - in this
case, the top staff:

Select the notes which should cross over to the bottom staff - in this case, the B and Gs with leger lines
Cross them to the staff below by choosing Notes b Cross-Staff Notes b Move Down a Staff (shortcut
68%+ or Ctrl+Shift++).
Unsurprisingly, Notes b Cross-Staff Notes b Move Up a Staff (shortcut O%%+ or Ctrl+Shift++)
crosses notes to the staff above.

746

Beams
l

You can put beams above both staves (as in the first beamed group in the first picture above) or between the
staves (as in the last beamed group) simply by flipping the directions of the stems as appropriate simply by
choosing Edit b Flip (shortcut X).
Dont do this by dragging the stems to the other side of the notes - this wont have the effect you intended!
In the first picture above, the last three low notes in the left hand were also flipped to avoid colliding with the
notes crossing from the right hand.

Note also that:


Notes do not have to have beams to be crossed to an adjacent staff - the I3 in our example is a quarter note
(crotchet). You can even cross rests over.
Notes can only cross over to another staff in the same instrument.
You can beam across three staves by inputting the notes onto the middle staff, then crossing notes to the staves
above and below. (It is not necessary for any notes to remain on the middle staff!)
Notes crossing onto another staff do not affect that staffs voices at all. A staff can even have four voices plus
further notes crossing onto it from adjacent staves!
Notes are in many respects treated as being on the original staff - for example, if you transpose a passage on the
original staff, then any notes which were crossed from that staff will also transpose.
Beams between notes on the same staff
In older scores, particularly for violin music, if a group of notes is very low, then very high (or
vice versa), you will sometimes see the beam running through the middle of the notes, with
some stems pointing up and some pointing down, as shown on the left.
To achieve this in Sibelius:
l

Create the notes, then select them and click the start of beam button ( I%)on the third keypad layout (Fl 0) to
unbeam them
Hide the flags on each of the notes by selecting them and hitting Delete
Create a fake beam line from the Create b Line dialog (shortcut L) and adjust the length of the upward and
downward stems to make them fit.

Note that the beam line may become displaced if you reformat your score, so you should only do this after you have
finished formatting your score.
Chords split between staves
It is common in keyboard music to split the notes of some chords between the two staves:
To achieve this, write each note of the split chord onto the staff it appears on,
using a suitable voice; for example, in the case illustrated, put the treble notes
of the split chords into voice 2 on the upper staff, and the bass notes in voice
1 on the lower staff. Then use Edit b Flip (shortcut X) to point the stems of
the notes on the lower staff downward. Finally, drag the end of each stem in
the right hand downwards so that it meets the stem of the left-hand note.
147

Reference

In the case of chords using notes shorter than a quarter note (crotchet) in value, hide the flags or beams by selecting
them and hitting Delete, then extend their stems, flipping them if necessary using Edit ) Flip, to meet the rest of
the chord.
Feathered beams
In contemporary music, extra beams sometimes splay out from a single beam to indicate an
accelerando. To notate this, add beam lines from Staff lines in the Create ) Line dialog
to a group of eighth notes (quavers). If its necessary to fit the notes into a short duration, start
with even shorter notes and hide the beams (see below) before adding the beam lines.
Hiding beams, flags and tails
To hide any beam, select it (not the note) and hit Delete. As with other objects, hidden beams are displayed in light
gray if View ) Hidden Objects is switched on (shortcut xB%H or Ctrl+Alt+H), and invisible if it is switched off.
To unhide a beam, select one of the beamed notes, and choose Layout ) Reset Design (shortcut 4%%D or
Ctrl+Shift+D).
You can also hide flags and tails, e.g. on single eighth notes (quavers), in the same way: select the flag or tail and hit
Delete. If you have beamed notes with rhythmic flags (say, a dotted eighth note (quaver) followed by a sixteenth
note (semiquaver)), you can even hide the flag independently of the main beam. Dots and other objects attached to
notes, such as articulations, are not hidden by hiding beams.
Note that hiding, say, the beam on a pair of eighth notes (quavers) doesnt actually turn them into quarter notes
(crotchets) - it just makes them look like quarter notes!
Beaming eighth notes (quavers) in 4s
By default, Sibelius beams eighth notes (quavers) in pairs in simple duple (e.g. 2/4, 4/4, 2/2) time signatures. If you
want to change this behavior, select the Beam eighths (quavers) in 4s option in the Create ) Time
Signature dialog when creating the time signature. For more information on beat groupings, LQ Time
signatures.
Engraving Rules options
The exciting range of beam options on the Notes 2 page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog
(shortcut 4%%E or Ctrl+Shift+E) consists of:
spaces thick: for scores with very small staves you may want to choose thinner beams and proportionately wider
gaps (see below) to stop them from filling in. Note that Sibeliuss beam-positioning rules are optimized for the
standard thickness (half a space), so if you change the thickness a lot, some beams may need their position adjusted.
spaces concavity forces flat: for concave groups of notes like this:
where the notes curve towards the beam and out again, it is normal to use a horizontal beam. This
parameter controls just how far the notes have to curve in to make the beam go horizontal. Increase the
value to give this example a diagonal beam.
maximum gradient: controls the maximum angle beams can have. Smaller values produce steeper beams. Some
US publishers prefer steep gradients such as 4 or 5; European publishers tend to prefer flatter angles such as 9.
148

Beams

Type a very large value such as 99 to make all beams horizontal, a convention occasionally used.
O/O of thickness apart: controls the gap between beams. Again, because Sibeliuss beam positioning rules are
based on the standard 50% gap, adjusting this value may mean you have to adjust the position of some beams.
spaces wide for fractional beams: controls the width of fractional beams (also called flags), as in the
r II
tolrowrng example:

where the fractional beam is the lower beam on the sixteenth-note (semiquaver).

Brackets and braces are used at the left-hand side of systems to group similar instruments together. Sibelius chooses
where they go by default, but you can change it if you like.
Brackets and braces
Normally, instruments of the same family
(e.g. woodwind brass, percussion) are
bracketed together. Percussion instruments
and solo instruments are not normally
bracketed
Instruments divide onto two or more
staves, such as divisi strings, are joined by
a sub-bracket (a thin bracket to the left of
the normal one). Sub-brackets are also
sometimes used to group similar
instruments, e.g. Flute and Piccolo, violin I
and II. In older orchestral scores, curly
braces are sometimes used instead of subbrackets, particularly to group horns.
Keyboard staves are joined with a brace,
but an organ pedal staff is not braced to
the organ manuals.
Small groups of instruments are usually
not bracketed at all.
Instruments bracketed sub-bracketed or
braced together normally also have their
staves joined by barlines.

Moving brackets and braces


You can adjust which staves in a score are bracketed or braced together:
Preferably find a point in the score where there are no hidden staves, so
you can see all brackets and braces at once
l

Click on the end of an existing bracket, sub-bracket or brace, so it turns


blue
Drag it up or down to extend or contract it

To remove a selected bracket, sub-bracket or brace, simply hit Delete.

Adding a bracket, sub-bracket or brace


From the Create ) Bracket or Brace menu, click Bracket, Subbracket or Brace
l

Click to the left of a staff to put the bracket, sub-bracket or brace there
Click and drag the top or bottom of it to extend it onto other staves.

Hiding a brace
Occasionally it might be necessary to hide a brace, for example if you need
to reduce a piano part in your score to just a right- or left-hand staff. To
achieve this, click on the barline after the brace you want to hide, then open
the Bars panel of the Properties window and switch off Brackets. For
more information on properties of objects, L!!! Properties.

Style of brackets and braces


There are various reassuringly obscure Engraving Rules options on the Brackets page of the House Style )
Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut G%E or Ctrl+Shift+E), which allow you to adjust the thickness and position
of brackets, sub-brackets and braces. These options are fairly self-explanatory, except that the Draw as brace
option for sub-brackets is for the old-fashioned style in which (for example) Violin I and II are joined by a brace rather
than a sub-bracket.
To create a bracket without hooks, used occasionally by composers such as Penderecki, modify a suitable bracket in
the House Style ) Edit Lines dialog; simply set the Cap to None. Note that youll have to create this manually
in your score, so it wont automatically appear at the start of every system.
Braces are drawn by scaling a { symbol, found in the General row of the Create ) Symbol dialog. To change the
brace design, substitute a brace character f rom a different music or text font (Q2 Symbols). Note that some printers
cant print the brace as a stretched symbo I; if you find that you can only print braces with the Substitute Braces

150

-_-______-- ____- _~. ~ Brackets and braces

option in the File b Print dialog switched on, then your printer suffers from this limitation and you will not be able to
change the design of braces in Sibelius.

151

Reference

Breaks
System breaks are points in the music where you force a system to end, such as at the end of a section. Page breaks
force the page to end at a particular point. System and page breaks are like typing a new line or a new page in a word
processor - and in fact, the keyboard shortcut for a system break is Return (on the main keyboard), just to
emphasize the analogy.
Because Sibelius takes care of layout automatically, you should only force system and page breaks in special
circumstances, such as those listed below.
For general advice on the layout of your score, L!2 Layout and formatting.
Where to put page breaks
Its a good idea to force page breaks:
l

at a convenient point on right-hand pages in extracted parts, so that the performer doesnt have to turn the page
while playing;
at the end of sections, especially when the next section has a new title at the start.

However, do not routinely put page breaks at the end of every page, as this will be likely to impair the formatting if
you change the music in any way. If in doubt, dont use a page break.
where to put system breaks
Its a good idea to force system breaks:
l

at the end of sections of music (e.g. at a repeat barline)


at the end of sections in extracted parts, especially when the next section has a new title at the start. When
extracting, Sibelius normally turns all page breaks into system breaks for you, so you dont get huge gaps in the
Par-t
where instruments divide onto two staves or rejoin onto one, so you dont get sequences of bar rests which
arent performed by anyone.

As with page breaks, do nof routinely put system breaks at the end of normal systems as this will cause formatting
problems if you change the music. If in doubt, dont use a system break.
Forcing/removing a system or page break
Select the barline at which you want to break
l

In Layout b Break, choose System Break (shortcut Return, on the main keyboard) or Page Break
(shortcut #-Return or Ctrl+Return).

The music will spread out so it ends at the specified point - more specifically, Sibelius spreads out the two systems
leading up to the break. Thereafter, the bar ending with the break will always go at the end of a system or page.
To remove a break which you previously created, do exactly the same as for forcing a break.

152

Breaks

Viewing breaks
The View ) Breaks and Locks option (on by default) shows system and page breaks in the score as blue
symbols, like this:

System break

Page break

Locked bar-line

Split mu/tires t

Removing lots of breaks


To remove all breaks in the score or in a passage of bars:
l

Select the bars in question (or type XA or Ctrl+A to select the whole score)
Choose Layout ) Format ) Unlock Format (or type 4%%U or Ctrl+Shift+U).

The music will reformat back to how it was before. This also removes formatting produced by the Layout ) Format
options.
Using breaks to create blank pages
Sometimes it is useful to begin your score with a blank page, usually so you can place text on it. Sibelius includes
manuscript papers with title pages already created for you, so unless you are working with an unusual ensemble you
wont need to do this yourself.
Should you need to create a blank page, do so as follows:
Create an extra bar at the beginning of your score
Click the barline at the end of the extra bar, and force a page break there
Use Create ) Staff Type Change ) Pitched ) Hidden (no lines) to create this staff type change at
the beginning of the extra bar. Note that you will have to hide each staff in turn, but this is quickly done if you
copy the staff type change using x-click or Alt-click (staff type changes appear as gray rectangles if you switch
on View ) Hidden Objects)
On the second page, where your music now begins, create the necessary staff type changes to restore the staff
lines
You may wish to clean up some other things, like correcting bar numbers with a Create ) Bar Number
Change, or removing any cautionary time or key signatures that may appear on the blank first page.
Once you have created your blank page, you can add a title or other text to it - LQ Text.

153

Reference

Chord symbols
Chord symbols - sometimes called chord names, lead sheet symbols, among other things - are text objects which go
above the staff and describe the harmony at that point in the music in terms of chords.
There is a wide variety of chord symbol conventions in use, with different conventions most appropriate to, say, jazz
and pop/rock. For example, the Nashville convention names chords according to their number relative to the root of
the prevailing key signature, while most other conventions use the note name as the basis of the chord symbol.
Thankfully all of these chord symbols are created in more or less the same way.
Creating chord symbols
If you want to input a chord symbol along with a guitar frame, !!LLI Guitar frames.
If you want to add chord symbols to your music automatically, LLJ Plug-ins.
However, if you want to input chord symbols manually, you do it using text, as follows:
l

Input the notes first, then select the first note above which you want a chord symbol to appear
Choose Create ) Text ) Chord Symbol (shortcut %gK or Ctrl+K for kord)
You can either type the chord symbol as ordinary text, or Control-click (Mac) or right-click (Windows) to
choose from a menu of standard chord symbol bits, such as Bband m7
Hit space to advance to the next beat.

If you want to write a space within a chord symbol, type X-space or Ctrl+space (as an ordinary space would
advance to the next note instead).
If you want to type the chord yourself, the word menu lists keyboard shortcuts for all the bits of chord symbol. For
example, to add a flat sign, type a lowercase b; to add a sharp sign, type #; to add superscript numbers, just type l-9;
and so on.
Here are a couple of other useful keyboard shortcuts:
Diminished symbol (O)

XB or Ctrl+O

Half-diminished (flat 5th) symbol <o)

XU followed by Y or Ctrl+Shift+O

Augmented symbol (+)

Shift-7

Major alteration (h> for e.g. major 7ths

Shift-6

Other symbols on the word menu include N.C. for no chord, add to specify an added alteration, omit to specify that
a particular note should be omitted, 96 for chords with added sixths and ninths, and so on.
You can change the entries for these in the Chords word menu if you use them frequently - LQ Text.
Standard chord symbols
Some examples of standard chord symbols are as follows:
154

m-_-_ __
Chord symbols
F

Eb

Cm

F#m

I Major triads 2 I Minor triads 2


Eb/G

ET b/G

Dm7(bs)

F#o7

Minor seventh
with flat fifth

Major triad Major seventh in


Diminished
seventh
in first inversion first inversion
with flat fifth

E0

G+

Diminished
triad

Augmented
triad

G7/B

Seventh triad in Triad with flat fifth


and sharp ninth
first in version

Some chords, such as the last chord in the above example, are conventionally written with stackable alterations, e.g.
C7(cz). To write this chord symbol:
l

Type %?K or Ctrl+K to input a chord symbol.


Type C7 to produce C7
Type [ to produce (
Control-click (Mac) or right-click (Windows) to see the word menu; first choose the symbol for 1, then choose
the symbol for z.

Type ] to produce ).

Chords in inversion, e.g. C/E, which denotes a C major chord with E in the bass, are sometimes written like fractions.
To achieve this convention, create each element of the chord symbol as a separate text object and then move them
into the correct positions.
Plain chord symbols
Some engravers prefer the numerals in chord symbols not to be superscript. Sibelius is supplied with a special font,
Opus PlainChords, for this purpose. To use it:
l

Choose House Style ) Edit Text Styles (shortcut ~x%%T or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+T)


Double-click the Chord symbols text style to edit it
On the General tab, change the font to Opus PlainChords.
Click OK.

Note that this will affect chord symbols both as text alone, and when combined with guitar frames.
6randt Roemer notation
Messrs Brandt and Roemer have devised a chord symbol notation which has the merit of being unambiguous to any
/
reader, regardless of what convention they are used to.
/
Standard Brandt Roemer notation uses small capital letters for things like MA (major), which is not to everyones
taste, so we have also provided a lower case alternative.
To obtain Brandt Roemer notation:

Reference

Choose House Style ) Edit Text Styles (shortcut 471%%T or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+T)


Click Chord Symbol, then Edit
At the bottom of the G e n e r a l tab, click Chords (Brandt/Roemer capitals) or C h o r d s
(Brandt/Roemer small) from the Word menu list
Click OK, then OK again to close the Edit Text Styles dialog.

From now on, the word menu produced by Control-clicking (Mac) or right-clicking (Windows) when youre creating
chord symbols will list Brandt Roemer notation.
To change it back, repeat the procedure but choose Chords (standard) instead.
Nashville chord numbers
Nashville chord numbers are a much simpler convention than note name-based systems. Chords are designated by
numbers representing the degree of the scale in the present key, so in the key of C major, a chord of F major is simply
represented by the number 4.
Where a chord is inverted, or has a different note in the bass, the bass note is written after a slash, again as a number,
so in C major, a chord of G major with the third in the bass is written 5/3.
Nashville chords are usually represented by normal numbers, but in some cases Roman numerals (e.g. IV for 4) are
used.
To write Nashville chord symbols in Sibelius, choose Create ) Text ) Other Staff Text ) Nashville Chord
Numbers. If you need to put in accidental symbols, just use the word menu (Control-click or right-click).
Transposing chord symbols
Chord symbols are automatically transposed when you transpose music or switch a score between conce t and
transposing pitch. (They dont transpose if you just change the pitch of the note under the chord symbol.)
Aligning a row of chord symbols
If youve input chord symbols along a staff and have had to move some to avoid collisions with notes, its usefu to be
able to line them all up again.
To do this, select any chord symbol, choose Edit ) Select ) Select More (shortcut U#A or Ctrl+Shift+A),
which selects all chord symbols along that staff. Then you can:
l

Align them in a row by choosing Layout ) Align in a Row (shortcut 48gR or Ctrl+Shift+R), after which
you can move them all up or down with the arrow keys; or
Choose Layout ) Reset Position (shortcut 0%gP or Ctrl+Shift+P) to snap the chord symbols to their
default vertical position.

The same tricks work for other text styles such as lyrics and figured bass.
Frequency of chord symbols
By default, hitting space while creating chord symbols moves to the next beat, or to the next note, whichever occurs
sooner. This means that you can write more than one chord symbol over a note lasting longer than a single beat. This
156

Chord symbols

may not always be the most desirable behavior, so if you would prefer space always to move to the next note,
change the appropriate option in the House Style b Default Positions dialog -!L!2 Default Positions.
Style of chord symbols
You can edit the size and default vertical position of chord symbols just like other text styles - LQ Edit Text
Styles.
The font used is a specially-designed one called Opus Chords, which includes superscripts and other special characters
(as listed above). You can change it to Inkpen Chords to produce a handwritten effect, though we recommend you
use one of the manuscript papers set up with the Inkpen font as these also have the notes and various other things
set to simulate handwriting.
Don t, however, change the font to a standard text font unless you are only using simple chord symbols, as doing so
gets rid of the special chord symbol characters.
Hiding chord symbols
To hide a chord symbol, select it and choose Edit b Hide or Show b Hide (shortcut 6%gH or Ctrl+Shift+H).
For more information about hiding objects, UL!! Hiding objects.

Reference

Clefs
The clefs at the start of every system are drawn automatically by Sibelius. It puts in the standard clefs for you when you
create instruments. You only need to think about clefs if you want to change them.
Creating clef changes
If you want the clef to change mid-bar, input the music for the bar where the clef change is to go, so you can
create it between the right notes
l

Select the note after which you want the clef to be created and choose Create ) Clef (shortcut Q for qlef),
and click the clef you want from the bewildering list provided. (The most common clefs are at the top.)
Click OK and the clef is created in your score. All the music after the clef will shift up or down to ensure that it
sounds the same as before.

The Draw on subsequent staves option, as its name suggests, draws the new clef on all subsequent systems;
switching this off is useful for special kinds of music such as lead sheets, but normally you should leave it switched on.
You can also input a clef change with the mouse. Make sure that nothing is selected in your score (hit Esc), choose
the clef you want from the Create h Clef dialog, then point where you want the clef to go and click. For instance, to
change the clef of an entire instrument, put the clef youve chosen on top of the existing clef at the very start of the
score.
You can copy clef changes (e.g. with x-click or Alt+click), though you cant copy the full-size clefs at the start of
staves.
Moving clefs
If you drag a clef change around, youll see that Sibelius automatically shifts the music up or down as the clef passes
over it to keep the notes sounding the same.
Try this out - create a clef change somewhere, then drag it left and right along the staff, or up and down onto other
staves, and watch the music instantly leap around. When you have nothing better to do, this can provide hours of
harmless (if rather limited) enjoyment.
Deleting clefs
Clef changes can be removed with Delete. If the clef you want to delete changes at the start of a system, delete the
clef change which appears at the end of the previous system. (Thats because - if you think about it - the small clef on
the end of the previous system is the actual change point; the big clef on the next system is really no more than the
standard indication of what the current clef is.)
For unpitched percussion instruments you may want to use the blank clef (the one that consists of a bit of empty
staff). Although this just makes the staff start with a gap instead of a clef, you position the blank clef just like any other
clef instead of trying to delete the clef thats already there.
Once you have put a blank clef change somewhere, you cant select it and delete it - theres nothing there to select.
Instead, put a different clef on top and hit Delete.

158

C/e fs

Hiding clefs at the start of a system


If you want a clef to appear on the first system but not on subsequent systems - for example, if youre working on a
lead sheet - simply switch on Hide on subsequent systems when you create the clef; dont try and delete the
clef at the beginning of each system!
If you dont want clefs to appear at all on a particular staff, switch off Clefs on the Bars panel of the Properties
window (LIZI Properties).
Hiding cautionary clef changes
If a score contains several movements or songs, you may want to change clef at the start of one section without a
cautionary clef appearing at the end of the previous section. To do this, select the cautionary clef, and choose Edit )
Hide or Show ) Hide (shortcut &dt%H or Ctrl+Shift+H).
For more information about hiding objects, !LLI Hiding objects.
Available c l e f s
The following clefs are available in the Clefs dialog box (each shows a pitch of C).

ve
Treble clef

Alto clel: for


viola

*
Standard
tab clef

Treble clef up
two 8ves, for
glockenspiel
in modern
scores

Tenor clef for


high bassoon,
trombone and
cello music

&=

Treble clef up
one 8ve, for
piccolo etc. in
modern scores

Bass clef

Unpitched
percussion
clef

Treble clef down Treble clef optone 8ve, for


ionally down
tenor and guitar one 8ve for
female or male
vorce

Unpitched
percussion
clef

Double treble
clet old version
of treble clef
down one 8ve

3 1:

French violin
clet
occasionally
used pre- 1800

Soprano clef
used pre- 1800

Mezzo-soprano
clef
occasionally
used pre- 1800

Tenor clef
down one 8ve,
for high double
bass parts in
modern scores

Baritone clef
occasionally
used pre- 1800

Bass clef up
one 8ve, for the
left hand of
celesta and bass
recorder

Inputting notes into a


percussion clef
You can input notes into a percussion
clef from a MIDI keyboard or using
letters A-G if you pretend the staff is a
normal s-line one with a treble clef. A
l-line staff is treated as the middle line
of a 5-line staff (i.e. pitch B4), a z-line
staff is the 2nd and 4th lines (i.e.
pitches G4 and D5), a S-line staff is the
lst, 3rd and 5th lines (i.e. pitches E4,
B4, and F5), and a J-line staff is the
spaces (F4, A4, C5, and E5). Hence a
note on the line of a l-line staff can be
inputted by playing the B above middle
C.

Octave clefs
Some people write (say) piccolo with a
normal treble clef, some with an 8
above - this is a matter of taste. A realBass clef down
Bass clef down
Baritone clef
Unpitched
Bass guitar
Larger
life piccolo playing music with a treble
one 8ve, for
two 8ves
occasionally
percussion
tab clef
tab clef
8 clef would not sound an octave
double bass
used pre- 1800
clef
parts in modern
higher than a piccolo playing the same
scores
music with a plain treble clef - they
,, ,
sound at&actly the same pitch. In
other words, the 8 is just a hint or reminder to the reader that this is a transposing instrument.
Therefore in Sibelius clefs with or without 8s (or 15s) on them are all precisely equivalent. The fact that a piccolo
sounds an octave higher than a flute playing the same notes is an attribute of the instrument, not of the clef (after all,

Reference

they could both be playing from a plain treble clef). This is indicated in Sibelius by the fact that a piccolo has a
transposition change by default, namely it transposes up an octave both in a non-transposing score and in a
transposing score. You can create a transposition like this yourself using the Create b Transposition Change
dialog which has options both for transposing and for non-transposing scores (of course, most transposing
instruments transpose in transposing scores only).
A tenor voice instrument in Sibelius is similar - it has a transposition change to make it transpose down an octave
both in a non-transposing score and in a transposing score. The treble 8 clef for a tenor is again just a hint to the
reader - its an alternative to a treble clef and has no direct effect on the sounding pitch of the notes.

160

Default Positions

Default Positions
For advanced users only
The House Style ) Default Positions dialog allows you to change the positioning behavior of text, lines, and
various other objects, when creating and moving them and resetting their position. Sibeliuss default settings are
sensible, and you wont usually need to change them, but should you be overcome by the urge to do so, this topic
will tell you how.
The dialog looks like this:

To change the default positions of an object, choose the category in the top-left corner (either Text styles, Lines or
Other objects), and then select the desired text style or object from the list. You can even select multiple styles or
objects to modify their common properties at the same time.
Note that options which are not applicable to the selected text style or object are grayed out, as you might expect (so
for text styles, you wont be able to set the Creating Lines options, and vice versa). Likewise, if you select multiple
lines (say), then values that all the selected objects have in common are shown on the dialog, and values that are not
in common are shown blank.
The options on the dialog are as follows:
Creating Object
Note that there are separate options for creating objects with the mouse and keyboard. When you create objects with
the mouse, you can click precisely where you intend them to go; when you create objects with the keyboard, you cant
indicate precisely where you want the object to be created, so they appear at a sensible position near to the caret (if
creating notes) or selected object.
The With Keyboard options control the rules for positiotjng of the object when it is created via the keyboard, or
when you select it and choose Layout ) Reset Positiok(shortcut U8%P or Ctrl+Shift+P).

161

Reference
l

Horizontal position x spaces right of note sets the default horizontal position; enter negative numbers
if you want to position objects to the left of the note to which they are attached (for, say, dynamics)
Vertical position x spaces above staff automatically positions the text vertically for you, relative to the
top line of the staff. Most text styles do this - for instance, technique text and titles should go above the staff,
expression text and lyrics should go below. You can drag the text away from the default position if you like.

The with Mouse options simply determine whether the object should be created at its default horizontal and/or
vertical position (as determined in the with Keyboard settings above) instead of at the mouse position, for
example:
l

Text such as chord symbols, figured bass, fingering, and lyrics, are all most usefully created at their default
horizontal and vertical positions;
System text such as title, composer, copyright, footnote and so on are all most usefully created at their default
vertical positions;
Some other text styles, such as tempo and metronome mark text, are best created at the position you click with
your mouse - in this case, simply switch off both of the with Mouse options.

Moving Object
Although all objects can be dragged using the mouse, a finer degree of control is possible by moving objects with the
arrow keys and their modifiers (e.g. t/+ or t/+ for small steps and #t/3 or Ctrl+t/+ for large steps). The
Moving Object options allow you control over the behavior of these operations:
l

Arrows move is the distance an object moves when moved with the arrow keys
Command-arrows/Ctrl+arrows move is the distance an object moves when moved with the arrow keys
in conjunction with the # OI- Ctrl key
Mouse drag threshold is how far you have to drag an object with the mouse before it moves from its
present position; set this to a large number if you want to make objects stickier and more difficult to drag.

There is one set of these parameters for text objects and another for lines, so any change you make to these settings
will affect a// similar objects (e.g. change the drag threshold for Technique text and you also change it for all other text
styles). The Moving Object options (unlike the others on this dialog) are global preferences and are thus not
associated with any particular score - they apply to every score you work on in Sibelius.
Creating Lines
Horizontal position of right hand end does what the name suggests: it determines how many spaces to the
right of the end of the line the right-hand end will appear by default.
Creating Text
The following options are available:
l

spaces above/below staff specifies the position of the baseline (i.e. bottom of the capital letters), relative
to the top or bottom staff line.
spaces above/below middle of staff is self-explanatory.

Some text styles, such as lyrics, figured bass and chord symbols, are created by jumping from note to note using the
space bar (Q2 Lyrics, Text). The options under Lyric-style input control this behavior:
162

------___
Default Positions
l

Snap to note is for text which is normally aligned with notes, such as lyrics and chord symbols; the remaining
options relate to this
Space / Hyphen moves to next note do what they say
Space moves to next beat is used by chord symbols, so that you can write different chord symbols on
each beat of the bar, even if the note is several beats long.

If both of the latter two options are switched on, hitting space while creating text will move to either the next note or
the next beat, whichever occurs sooner.
Special cases
There are a few special considerations to bear in mind when using the House Style F Default Positions dialog,
as follows:
The Creating Object options have no effect on clefs, key signatures, special barlines, time signatures or
transpositions. To reset the position of any of these, make a system selection around the object and choose
Layout ) Reset Note Spacing (shortcut 6#N or Ctrl+Shift+N).
For system text styles (e.g. Title, Tempo), the default vertical position and Above/Below bottom/middle
of staff settings are retrospective - in other words, any change you make to these settings will automatically
change all system text objects in your score.
However, for staff text styles (e.g. Chord Symbols, Lyrics) the changes affect only newly-created objects -if you
have, say, some Expression text in your score and then change the Expression text styles default position, the
existing Expression text in your score will not automatically change position.
So if you want to change the position of some or all existing objects too, use filters to select them (QI Filters
and find), then choose Layout ) Reset Position (shortcut 4xP or Ctrl+Shift+P).
The settings in the House Style ) Edit Text Style dialog for aligning text relative to the page take
precedence over the settings in the House Style ) Default Positions dialog.
For slurs, if neither of the Create at default horizontal/vertical position options are switched on,
creating slurs with the mouse produces non-magnetic slurs.
If you switch on either or both of these options, the mouse creates magnetic slurs. Creating magnetic slurs with
the mouse can be a little confusing - for example, if you want to input an up-arching slur (shortcut S) and try to
put it over some notes whose stems point upwards using the mouse, the slur will appear below the noteheads
instead. However, if youre married to your mouse, this could be a useful feature for you!
For rehearsal marks, their horizontal position is determined by the settings in the Other objects section, and
their vertical position is determined by the settings in the Text styles section.
Some other objects with complex positioning rules (such as magnetic slurs and tuplets) are defined via the
House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog, rather than the House Style ) Default Positions dialog.

163

Reference

Document Setup
LQ Layout and formatting.
f fwhes

r i%i&-

p j$imeh3s

Sk!!5

fl zQ#n-@
f Miprad

Leg Paps

Ri@$ Page*

~/=-J--E

/---q-J~

? Qi~fareM
r-i?
r
Staff bbrgins i
ftk is ths &fault disianw af tha &we8 in&h the pqp
KlWgi~.

&4ll twrw: /zz- rQprt names: 115.0

tl

&3names-*I--~
3 83

Cksltngts pqp: (cm

*A

The Layout b Document Setup dialog (shortcut B%D or Ctrl+D) allows you to set up the page size, staff size
and margins of your score. Sibelius will reformat your score instantly for the new settings, so you can try out different
sizes or shapes of paper, or different staff sizes, to see what looks best.
Since this affects the amount of music per page and the number of pages in the score, you can use Layout b
Document Setup to fit your score onto any number of pages you want. L!2 Layout and formatting for
general advice on layout.
Changing the page settings
Choose Layout b Document Setup (shortcut #D or Ctrl+D). You can then adjust the page size, page shape
and staff size, as detailed below.
The preview shows how the first page will look with the settings youve chosen; click the arrows to look through
subsequent pages.
When you click OK, the score will be instantly reformatted using the new measurements. (If you dont like how it
ends up, just choose Edit b Undo!)
Paper sizes
The Paper size list includes standard US and European paper sizes. Choose Custom to type in any width or
height you like.
Common and not-so-common paper sizes are:

164

.______~_

-----

__ _-

-________--- ---.-- ---___


Document Setup

Letter
Tabloid
A5
B5
A4
B4
A3
Band
Statement
Hymn
Octave
Executive
Quart0
Concert
Folio
Legal

8.5 x 1 1
1 1 x 17
5.9 x 8.3
6.9 x 9.8
8.3 x 1 1.7
9.8 x 13.9
1 1.7 x 16.5
5 x 7
5.5 x 8.5
5.75 x 8.25
6.75 x 10.5
7.25 x 10.5
8.46 x 10.8
9 x 12
8.5 x 13
8.5 x 14

216x279mm
279 x 432mm (also known as B size)
149 x 21 Omm (A4 folded in half)
177 x 250mm
21Ox297mm
250 x 354mm
297 x 420mm (twice as big as A4)
127 x 178mm (usually landscape format)
14Ox216mm
146 x 205mm
171 x 267mm
184 x 267mm
215 x 275mm
229 x 305mm
216x330mm
216x356mm

(Note that Octave and Quarto paper is available in a variety of other sizes too.)
You can switch between inches, millimeters and points using the buttons provided. I inch = 25.4mm (absolutely
exactly), 1 mm = 0.0397 inches (almost exactly), and 1 point = exactly l/72 inch = 0.353mm (approximately).
Here are some recommended paper and staff sizes:
Keyboard, songs, solo instrument: Letter/A4 0.3/7mm staves
Orchestral/band scores: Letter/Tabloid/A4/A3, O.l -0.2"/3-5mm staves
Parts: Letter/9x12/A4/B4, 0.25-0.3"/6-7mm staves
Choral music: Letter/A4 or smaller, 0.2/5mm staves
Books for beginners: Letter/A+ 0.3-0.4/8-1 Omm staves
All these page sizes are portrait format; landscape format is seldom used, except for organ, marching band and brass
band music. Youll find that published music often doesnt correspond exactly to any standard paper size.

Staff size
The staff size is the distance from the center of the top staff line to the center of the bottom staff line. Everything in a
score is scaled to be in proportion to the staff size - notes, clefs, text, etc.
You can either type in a staff size or click the little arrows to change it in small steps. Click and hold the little arrows
and watch the preview to see the effect of the staves growing and shrinking.
Although staff sizes vary considerably, you should take care to set one appropriate to the kind of music you are
writing. In general, if you set the staff size too small the performers will feel uncomfortable without necessarily
knowing quite why. See above for recommended paper and staff sizes.
Sibelius wont change the staff size without your permission, so with lots of instruments on a small page the staves
may have to squash very close together (or even over1 / p!). To alleviate this, simply pick a smaller staff size (or a larger
page size).

165

Reference

Page margins
You can also set the page margins on the Layout b Document Setup dialog. Music can go right up to the page
margins, but not outside.
Your score can have the Same margins on left- and right-facing pages (recommended for single-sided printing),
Mirrored margins (sometimes called inside and outside margins), or Different margins on left- and right-facing
pages, Note that the top and bottom margins are always identical on left- and right-facing pages.
Specifically, the margins are defined as follows (if Same is chosen):
l

Top margin: where the top of the page number normally goes, if its at the top of the page
Boftom margin: where the bottom of the page number normally goes, if its at the bottom of the page
lefimargln: the left-hand side of the leftmost instrument name
Right margin: the right-hand end of the staves.

To make these margins visible in the score (as dotted blue lines), choose View b Page Margins.
Staff margins
Staff margins control the distance between the top and bottom staves on a page and the top and bottom page
margins, and also the distance between instrument names and the left-hand page margin. This allows you to set the
default position of the staves on the page.
For the left-hand margin there are three different values, depending on whether the staves have full instrument
names, short instrument names (e.g. after the first page) or no instrument names. (Settings for instrument names may
be found on the Instruments page of the House Style b Engraving Rules dialog - LL! Instruments.)
These values update automatically if you change the length of the instrument names themselves (e.g. by editing an
existing name or adding new instruments).

166

Edit Arrange Styles

Edit Arrange Styles


l!LQl ArrangeTM.
For advanced users only

More than 130 predefined Arrange styles are supplied with Sibelius, but should you want to define your own, this
topic will tell you how. In order to create effective Arrange styles, you first need to understand how Sibeliuss Arrange
feature works.
How it works
Sibeliuss Arrange algorithm is complex, but it basically involves splitting the selected music into separate monophonic
lines of notes, each consisting of single notes and rests. These are then distributed among the chosen destination
staves, transposing, doubling (in unison or octaves), and using multiple voices as necessary.
Sibelius determines the lines of notes as follows:
l

Any voice on any staff which contains one or more note (or rest, or bar rest) is treated as one or more lines of
notes
If the number of notes in the voice is not constant (for example, if there is a passage of thirds followed by a
passage of single notes), Sibelius puts upper notes of chords into more lines than lower notes
Each line of notes also includes all other objects attached to that staff or voice, so all notes retain any
articulations, ties, notehead types, etc., plus objects such as text and lines.

These lines of notes are then arranged to fit the destination staves according to the selected Arrange style. Arrange
styles specify groups of instruments into which similar music will be arranged.
These general principles apply:
Sibelius will try to put all of the source music into the selected staves, which may result either in a lot of doubling
(if there are too few lines of notes for the number of staves selected) or many staves with multiple voices (if
there are too many lines of notes for the number of staves).
Sibelius will only assign one line of notes to each group, unless there are fewer lines than groups - for example,
in an extreme case, if the source music consists of a single monophonic line, which is subsequently arranged for
full orchestra, Sibelius will not compose music to accompany the single line; it will simply double it across all the
staves
Sibelius adjusts the pitch of each line of notes to fit the comfortable range of the destination instrument.
(Optionally, the user can also specify that Sibelius should stretch the source music across a determined range of
pitches - see below.)
When arranging, Sibelius sorts the lines of notes in four basic ways, determined by the Arrange style:
l

Fastest to slowest: the lines of notes with the s II or-test average note values are given to the first listed group of
instruments, with the last listed group getting the lines of notes with the longest average note values
167

Reference
l

Highest fo lowest: the lines of notes with the highest average pitch are given to the first group of instruments,
etc.
Buslest (p/uy;ng fhe most notes): the lines of notes with the most notes are given to the first listed group of
instruments, and the lines with the fewest notes to the last listed group
Busiest @hying most of the time): the lines of notes which play for the longest proportion of the total duration
of the source material are given to the first listed group of instruments, etc.

Editing Arrange styles


Choose Notes b Edit Arrange Styles:
l

To edit an existing style, select it from the drop-down list and click Edit

To create a new style, select the most suitable existing style on which to base your new style, then click New
This dialog appears:
l

At the top of the dialog you can edit the Name for the style and write a suitable Description if you like. The
lower half of the dialog lists the groups of instruments into which Sibelius will arrange the music.
l

Remove an existing group of instruments by selecting its name and clicking Delete; change the ordering of the
groups by selecting one and clicking Move Up or Move Down
To add a new group of instruments, click New, and choose the instruments to include in the group:

There is a variety of approaches to this; you migtit place melodic instruments (e.g. high woodwinds and strings)
in one group, and supporting instruments (e.g. br-ass, horns and lower strings) in another.

-_. ---~_-.- .-..


Edit Arrange Styles

You can also specify that an instrument should double the instrument isted above at a specified interval (e.g. if
you want your flute doubled at the octave by a piccolo, or if you want particular instruments to play in thirds).
If you want to have two instruments doubling a single instrument, for example, if you want your flutes doubled
by piccolo and clarinet, the instruments would be listed in the Instruments in Group field as follows:
Flute

not set to double

Piccolo

doubles up one octave

Clarinet

doubles at the unison

In other words, you can have multiple instruments doubling the same instrument. The instrument that will be
doubled when you switch on the Double the instrument above this option will be the first instrument
above the selected instrument that is not set to double another instrument.
Even if you dont specify instruments to double each other, they may end up doubling anyway (if you arrange
lines of notes onto a larger number of staves).
When youve finished adding instruments to the group, click OK
Give the group a name (e.g. Vln 1 +FI) by double-clicking the blank space in the Name column
If you want to specify a range of pitches into which Sibelius should arrange the music for that group, set
Stretch to Yes and then choose the Min Pitch and Max Pitch as appropriate. Sibelius will then transpose
the music by octaves so that its in the stated range, and so that the different instruments in the group
collectively fill the entire range.
Stretch is useful if, say, your source material is a piano piece, which of necessity uses a narrow range for
chords (generally a compass of less than a tenth in each hand), and you want the music to be played by a string
section across its entire range; or to ensure that the material ends up in a particular range, e.g. high woodwind,
even if the instruments could play it at other pitches.
Min Lines d etermines the minimum number of lines of notes that may be assigned to the selected group. The
default setting of 0 is recommended; this means that the group does not have to play at all times.
Max Lines determines the maximum number of lines of notes that may be assigned to the selected group.
The default setting (blank) allows any number of lines to be assigned to the group.
You should only change this setting if you want particular effects: setting Max Lines to 1 forces all the
instruments in the group to double the same material.
Max Lines per Staff and Max Voices per Staff control the distribution of lines of notes among the
instruments within the group. The default settings (of 2 and 2 respectively) are suitable for most kinds of music.
Generally, Sibelius will only use multiple voices on the same staff if it has to, for example if there are more lines
of notes assigned to a particular group than there are staves within the group.
If Max Lines per Staff is set to a greater number than Max Voices, then Sibelius will merge lines of notes
into chords in the same voice. (Obviously, theres little point in setting Max Lines per Staff to a smaller
number than Max Voices.) If you only want single notes on each staff, set both these options to 1.
Some useful settings for these options:
Keyboard:

Max Lines per Staff = 4, Max Voices = 2

Single woodwind:

Max Lines pe Staff = 1, Max Voices = 1


i

Double woodwind: Max Lines per Staff = 2, Max Voices = 2


169

Reference

Brass.

Max Lines per Staff = 2, Max Voices = 2

Singers.

Max Lines per Staff = 1, Max Voices = 1

All the instruments in a group are assigned similar music. The way in which lines of notes are assigned to groups
is defined by the which lines go into the first group option; for example, if this is set to Highest, the
highest lines go to the first listed group, the second highest to the next listed group, and so on. Change the order
of the groups of instruments by clicking Move Up or Move Down. (See below for more detail on this.)
When you have finished defining your Arrange style, click OK.

Arrange styles are automatically saved in the Arrange Styles folder within your Sibelius program folder, so if you
like, you can share them with other users simply by sending them the appropriate .sar files from that folder.
Note that if you are creating styles for other people to use, you should include a//possible appropra~e instruments in
each style (weve done this in the predefined styles). For example, a brass Arrange style should preferably include rare
instruments like piccolo trumpet and horns with crooks, in case someone else wants to arrange for these.
which lines go into the first group
The Arrange styles provided are suitable for most kinds of arrangement, but should you need to define your own, its
important to understand how the distribution of lines of notes affects the resulting arrangement.
The four methods of sorting the lines of notes - which are determined by the Which lines go into the first
group option - give rise to very different distributions of the music. In general terms:
l

170

If sorting by pitch (i.e. Highest), the groups should be disposed such that the instruments in each group
should be able to play in the correct register, e.g. the first group would be high instruments (such as violins and
flutes), a second group medium instruments (e.g. violas, clarinets, horns), and a third group bass instruments
(e.g. cellos, bassoons, trombones). Sorting by pitch allows conventional doublings in a mixed orchestration (e.g.
violins doubled by flutes and clarinets, violas doubled by oboes, cellos doubled by bassoons, etc.) to be set up
most easily. Typically this kind of Arrange style should contain three or four groups. The Mixed styles are
defined like this.
If sorting by speed (i.e. Fastest or Busiest), each group should contain a spread of instruments able to play
across the entire range of pitches, such as instruments from the standard instrumental families (woodwind, brass
and strings). This allows for a block orchestration, in which each family plays a particular kind of material (e.g.
woodwinds play the fastest music, brass play the slowest music). Typically this kind of Arrange style should
contain two or three groups. The Block styles are defined like this, sorting by Fastest, which is our
recommended setting for block orchestration.
If in doubt about which method of sorting to use, Highest (i.e. mixed orchestration) generally gives the best
default results.

Edit Lines

Edit Lines
L!2! lines, Slurs, House Style.
For advanced users
Sibelius lets you edit the design of lines and create your own new ones.
Editing a line
To edit a line, choose House Style b Edit Lines. Once youve selected a line from the list, you can Edit it,
Delete it (if its one youve defined yourself), or click New to create a new line based on it.
When creating a new line, base it on one with similar playback and positioning characteristics; for instance, to create a
line which you want to play back like a trill, base it on a trill.
Clicking Edit brings up a dialog where you can change the lines characteristics:

In all its generality, a line consists of five bits:


An optional start - either a symbol (such as Ped) or item of text (such as 1. 2.7, plus an optional arrowhead or
a short line at right angles called a hook such as on a 1 st ending (1 St-time bar), or an arrowhead
The actual line itself - this can be continuous, dotted, dashed or wiggly, of various possible widths, and can be
horizontal or diagonal
Some optional text running along the line, e.g. g/&s.
An optional continuation symbol - this is what appears at the start of the system when a line continues on from
an earlier system, such as (s) for an 8va line
An optional end bit - like the start, this can be a symbol, a hook or an arrowhead.
Its reasonably self-explanatory how you modify these five bits from the dialog, but lets spell it out anyway:
l

Line options control the appearance of the line itself:


l

Style: specifies whether the line is continuous, dotted, dashed or wiggly


177

Reference
l

Dash: the length of the dashes for dashed lines


Gap: the size of the gap between dashes/dots in dashed/dotted lines
Horizontal: forces the line to be horizontal (e.g. a trill)
Smooth on screen: anti-aliases (smoothes) the line as it appears on the screen, but doesnt affect how it
prints (Sibelius always prints smoothly!) - you should leave this option switched on
Right of symbols/text: puts the left-hand end of the line after the start bit.

Start options define whether the line begins with a cap, symbol or text object:
l

None/Symbol/Text: its obvious what these do. Clicking the Text radio button brings up a dialog from
which you can choose the text that should appear, the text style to use, and the position of the text relative to
the line.
To position the text so the line appears mid-way up, change the x spaces up parameter; using the Small
Text style, a value of 0.5 spaces is ideal.

spaces right/up: used to adjust the position of the symbol, text or hook
Cap allows you to choose a hook (and define its offset from the line) or an arrowhead from a defined list.

Continuation options determine what the line does if it continues over a system or page break:
l

Symbol: allows you to start the continuation with a symbol


spaces right/up: used to adjust the position of the optional symbol
The Text button sets any text running along the line.

End options are similar to the Start options, except that you cant end a line with text.
The preview shows the line as it would appear when split over two systems, so you can see the continuation bit as
well as the start, middle and end.
As an example of using this dialog, to change the symbol at the beginning of a standard 8vu line (as in the screenshot
above) to, say, just 8, click Select in the Start section of the Edit Line dialog to choose a new symbol. You can
change the Continuation symbols in the same way.

172

Edit /Voteheads

Edit Noteheads
LQ Noteheads.
To modify a notehead design or define a new one:
l

Choose House Style ) Edit Noteheads, which will bring up a dialog


On the dialog that appears, click New to create a new type of notehead, or click one of the listed types and click
Edit to change it. (You can also click and Delete notehead types youve defined.)

The Notehead dialog that appears allows you to configure every aspect of the notehead style:

Name: oddly enough, this is the name of the notehead style ( although you dont really need to know what its
called)
Plays: determines whether the notehead style plays back. So me noteheads (e.g. slashes) dont play back by
default
Accidental: switch this off if you want he noteheads not to have accidentals (e.g. for slashes)
Transposes: determines whether the noteheads transpose (e.g. if you toggle Notes F Transposing
Score, if you transpose your music, or if you extract parts). Some noteheads (e.g. slashes) dont transpose by
default
Leger lines: determines whether the notehead style should use leger lines.
Stem: determines whether the notehead style should use stems.
To change the symbol used by a notehead, select one of the note values, click Change symbol and select
the symbol to use for it from the Symbols dialog which appears (LQ Symbols). The quarter note (crotchet)
notehead is also used for eighths (quavers) and shorter note values.
773

Reference

Below the notehead symbols there are separate options for the positioning of stems and noteheads when stems are
pointing up and down:
l

Shorten stem by: lets you make a neater join between the stem and certain noteheads such as crosses (this
option is only available if Stem is switched on above)
Move notehead x spaces right/left: moves the notehead the specified number of spaces right or left
from the stem
Move notehead x spaces up/down: moves the notehead the specified number of spaces up or down
from the stem

When youre done, click OK followed by OK again to close the Edit Noteheads dialog.
One subtlety of these functions is that the Leger lines and Stem options take effect based on the notehead style of
the top note of a chord; so if you have, say, a chord with two notes that would normally be written on leger lines, but
you set the top notehead to use a notehead which doesnt use leger lines, neither note will have leger lines.
Conversely, if, in the same situation, you set the lower of the two notes on leger lines to use a notehead which doesnt
use leger lines, both notes will be printed with leger lines (because the notehead at the top of the chord does use
leger lines).
If you created a new notehead type, it will appear at the bottom of the House Style ) Edit Noteheads dialog
and the notehead list in the Notes panel of the Properties window, and can be typed as a numerical shortcut like
other noteheads.

174

Edit Staff Types

Edit Staff Types


LQ Staves, Instruments.
Should you need to create a staff type that isnt built into Sibelius, you can do so from the House Style ) Edit
Staff Types dialog.
You can choose to Edit an existing staff type, or create a New one based on an existing staff type, in one of the three
categories (Pitched, Tab or Percussion). Whatever you opt for, you will see this dialog:

The options are as follows:


Name, unsurprisingly, is the name of the staff type
Sibelius helpfully tells you how many times the current staff type is being used in your score - just in case you
didnt realize that the changes youre about to make might affect staves already in your score
Initial clef refers to the clef at the start of each system, not just the initial clef at the very start of the staff
Bracket controls whether brackets and/or braces are drawn at the beginning of the staff
Initial barline determines whether the initial barline is drawn at the start of each system. Note that you
cannot switch on an initial barline for a system consisting of only one staff (although if you need to do this,
L!2 Lead sheet in How to).
Barlines controls whether or not barlines are drawn in that staff
Leger lines determines whether leger lines will appear above or below the staff
Bar rests can be switched off if you dont want bar rests to appear in a particular staff (you can make bar rests
not appear in all staves from the House Style F Engraving Rules dialog - LQ Bars and bar rests)
Key signatures toggles whether key signatures are shown on the staff
Rhythms controls stems, flags, and rhythm dots. You could switch this off if you want to draw stemless notes
on a staff, but its better to use stemless notes instead (L!2 Noteheads)
Stems point up for notes on mid-line is useful for vocal and single-line percussion staves; it is
conventional for the stems of notes on the middle line of the staff to point upwards
775

Reference

Always position articulations above the staff is also useful for vocal and single-line percussion staves;
positioning articulations above the staff avoids collisions with e.g. lyrics, which have to go below the staff
Number of staff lines allows you to choose any number of staff lines
Barline half-height (l/32 spaces) allows you to change the height of barlines in a particular staff. Note
that barlines originate in the middle of the staff, so if you set this parameter to, say, 32 (the default is 64), the
barlines will touch the second and fourth staff lines.
Staff line separation (l/32 spaces) allows you to change the distance between staff lines, and thus the
height of the staff. Note, however, that changing this parameter does nof make other objects larger or smaller to
match the new staff height, so theres no reason to change this unless youre after a particularly strange effect. If
what youre actually trying to do is change the staff size, you should either make it a small staff &!A Staves) or
change the staff size in the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut &%%E or Ctrl+Shift+E).
Used for Ossias is a special option which is only switched on for the No lines (hidden) staff type
Used as default staff is a special option which is only switched on for the 5 lines staff type.

176

Edit Symbols

Edit symbols
LQ Symbols, Music fonts.
Editing existing symbols
Choose House Style h Edit Symbols
Click the symbol you want to modify, and click Edit
To change the symbol to a different character, click on a new symbol in the table at the left of the dialog or type
a character number into Number. (If you are using a mixture of music fonts you can also choose which font to
use from the Music font list, though this is explained in detail later)
To make the symbol blank, or to make it just a composite of existing symbols (without also having a character
chosen directly from a music font), set Number to 0
You can also change the Name of the symbol; this name is useful for identification when including this symbol
in a composite symbol
To move the symbol with respect to its origin, click the arrow buttons to the right of the dialog
To add another symbol to make a composite, click Add, then click another symbol and click Add Symbol.
You can move these extra symbols independently using the arrow buttons.
Changing existing symbols
Not surprisingly, those symbols which Sibelius uses for standard objects such as noteheads, clefs and articulations
have particular meanings. If you change the sharp symbol to a dollar sign, Sibelius will still treat it as a sharp (e.g.
when playing back or transposing).
It will even treat it as a sharp if you change the symbol design to look like a flat (because it interprets the symbols
based on where they are in the grid, not what they look like). This causes Sibelius no conceptual difficulties, but it may
cause you some, so to avoid confusion only change existing symbols to designs which look like they mean the same
thing as the previous design.
One use for this might be to change the symbols used for microtonal accidentals. The first nine symbols on the
Accidentals row of the Create ) Symbols dialog (shortcut Z) correspond to the symbols on the fifth keypad
layout (shortcut F12). See the table of notable symbols above for a list of the various alternative symbols. Note that if
you change a symbol in the House Style h Edit Symbols dialog, the keypad will still show the original symbol.
New symbols
If, however, you want a new symbol which isnt just a different design of an existing one, there are various convenient
gaps in the House Style h Edit Symbols table you can put the new symbol into. Use a gap in an appropriatelynamed row, or in the User-defined row at the bottom.
If you use up all the gaps in the User-defined row, click New on the House Style h Edit Symbols dialog to
create a new symbol on a new row.
Composite symbols
Some symbols include one or more other symbols. This has two benefits:
1

177

Reference
l

It means you can create a new symbol even if it is not available in a music font, by piecing together other
symbols. For instance, the symbol for a tenor voice clef (treble clef with an 8 below) is made up from a treble
clef plus an 8.
It means that if you change the font, size or design of a symbol (such as a treble clef), then all symbols based on
this will also change, to ensure a consistent appearance and to avoid your having to change lots of other
symbols at the same time.

Creating a new symbol text style


This important but rather abstract concept is best described by example.
Lets suppose you want all of your clefs to use a special music font of their own which youve obtained from
somewhere, called TrebleFont. (For more information on music fonts, IQ Music fonts.)
To make this happen, you cant just change the font of Common symbols, as that would change notes,
accidentals and so on, too. Instead, you should create a new text style called (say) Clefs, set this to TrebleFont, and
set all clef symbols to use the Clefs text style so that they all use this font.
To do this:
In the Music fonts dialog, select an existing text style (say, Common symbols) to base your new one on,
click New, then click Yes
In the dialog which appears, type Clefs as the name for your new text style, and change the font to
TrebleFont
Click OK, then OK again to close the Music fonts dialog.
Then, for each clef in the Edit h Symbols dialog, select the clef, click Edit, change Music Font (meaning
the text style) to Clefs, and click OK.
You should follow the same procedure even if you just want a single symbol in a special font or size.

178
.

_P_____

_ - __~_____

Edit Text Styles

Edit Text Styles


lZ!l Text,
Edit Text Styles dialog
General tab
Border tab
Horizontal position tab
Vertical position tab

Repeat tab
Setting the style
Creating new text styles
Deleting text styles
Tasteful fonts

This topic tells you how to change a text styles font, size, alignment and other features.
You can redefine not only the styles on the Create b Text menu, but also things like rehearsal marks, tuplet
numbers, bar numbers, page numbers and instrument names. Any change you make is instantly reflected in all text of
that style wherever it appears in your score.
Edit Text Styles dialog
To redefine any text style, choose House Style b Edit Text Styles (shortcut 71u%gT or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+T) to
get this dialog.
The list of text styles may seem bewilderingly long, but you can narrow it down from
the Category menu at the top; e.g. choose System styles to list all the system
text styles.

36

Lets assume you want to modify an existing Staff style, such as Technique; click
Technique in the list, then click Edit.
If, on the other hand, you want to create a new text style based on Technique, select
it in the list, then click New. Youll be asked if you really want to create a new text
style based on this existing style; click Yes.

Whether youre editing an existing text style or creating a new one, youll get a tabbed dialog looking rather like this:

/79
A

Reference

General tab
Name is the name of the style, which you can change if you like. Changing it does not create a new style, it just
renames the current one. Youd want to do this if you were putting one of the styles to a new use; for instance, if you
dont want to use Technique at all but you do want a similar style called Stage directions, you can just edit the name
of Technique to describe the new purpose. Otherwise, you should create a new style based on Technique, as
described above. Special styles such as Bar numbers will still behave in their special ways even if you change the
name.
Point sizes
In all typesetting, text sizes are
specified in points (pt), which are
equal to l/72 inch (approx.
0.35mm). Since letters vary in size
- even capital letters vary in
height slightly - the measurement
used to speciv the size is the
distance from the top of the
highest letter to the bottom of the
lowest. This is about one-and-ahalf-times the height of capital
letters. The size of text in books is
normally around 10 points.

Attached to says whether this text style is a staff or a system object


(ELI! Attachment). You cant change this setting for existing styles (and wouldnt
want to), though if you create a new style based on an existing one, this attribute is
taken from the existing style.
Font and Style allow you to choose the font and style, surprisingly. Click on a
font in the list to change font. Underlining is exceedingly rare in music, so dont do
it unless you really mean it. See below for advice on fonts and styles to use in
music.
Angle lets you write text at an angle, which is again a very rare requirement. Note
that some printer drivers have a bug which makes angled text print at the wrong
angle; if this happens, click Substitute Arpeggios, gliss., etc. on the Print
dialog.

Size is the point size of the text. Text in music is always proportional to the staff size: if the staff size is large, so are all
dynamics, lyrics and so on. So the left-hand number is a relative size: its the size the text would appear if the staff size
were 0.28 (Tmm), which is the size used by, for example, the A4 and Letter manuscript papers. It is normally
easiest to specify text sizes in music for a standard staff size like this. The right-hand number is the absolute size, that
is, how large the text will actually turn out for the current staff size. You can change either number, and the other will
change automatically.
Word menu lets you choose the list of useful words which will appear when you Control-click (Mac) or right-click
(Windows) while typing text in the style. L!2 Text.
180

Edit Text Styles

Transpose chord names is only used by chord symbols, and tells Sibelil s to change them when the music is
transposed.
Border tab
Circled draws a circle around the text. Text in circles is very rare in music (ot ler than for specifying guitar strings),
though it is occasionally used for bar numbers and even rehearsal marks.
Boxed draws a box around the text. This is more common than circles, and is used for rehearsal marks, and less
commonly for bar numbers and for important instructions to players.
Sibelius even lets you have text inside a circle and a box - though this is a very, very, very rare requirement.
The thickness of the line used to draw the box and circle is controlled by Text borders on the Text page of the
House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut &#E or Ctrl+Shift+E).
Erase background is for text which falls over staff lines or barlines. It is primarily intended for guitar tab numerals,
but you could switch this option on for (say) dynamics, if you sometimes need them to go across a barline.
Position specifies where and how big the circle or box is to be, and the size of the area erased by Erase
background. Sibelius fills in sensible default values for you.
Horizontal Position tab
Left / Centered / Right specifies how the text is to be positioned relative to where it is created. It also affects the
alignment of multiple lines of text in the same text object. Left alignment is the usual setting. However, you may want
to align certain types of text differently - such as fingerings, which are often centered above notes.
To set the distance of the text from where it is created, L!2 Default Positions.
Align to page (available only for system text) aligns the text to the left/center/right of the page - for instance, the
title of a piece is almost always centered on the page. Note that page aligned text always attaches to the first bar in a
system (e.g. Title text), or the first bar on the page if the text is aligned to the page vertically (e.g. Footer). This helps to
eliminate multirests being broken by attached text in extracted parts.
Aligning to page also offers two further options:
Inside / Outside edge are used for double-sided printing, and are best explained by an example: when printing
single-sided, page numbers are usually put at the right-hand side; but when printing double-sided, page numbers
usually go on the right of right-hand pages and the left of left-hand pages - that is, on the outside edge. These options
provide this facility for your delectation, but are only available when the mm from top/bottom of page option
is selected on the Vertical position tab (see below).
Hint: you can set each text style to snap to a fixed horizontal position (relative to a note) as well as a fixed vertical
position. This works not only when you create some text, but also when you select the text and choose Layout )
Reset Position (shortcut &%%P or Ctrl+Shift+P). This is only predefined for a few text styles, e.g. Lyrics, Chord
symbols and Figured bass, but you can switch it on for any other style simply by switching on the Snap to note
option and altering the spaces from left of note parameter.
Having set up these values, its quick to reset the position of all the text in a single style along a single staff: just select
one of the text objects and choose Edit ) Select F Select More (shortcut U%%A or Ctrl+Shift+A) to select all
181

Reference

text in that style on the staff, then choose Layout ) Reset Position (shortcut 4%%P or Ctrl+Shift+P) to reset
all objects on that system. Note that only text attached to a note or rest will have its position reset. If you want to reset
the position of all objects of a particular style throughout the score, use filters to select them before choosing
Layout ) Reset Position - Q2 Filters and find.
Vertical Position tab
Line spacing sets the distance between lines of text when you hit Return (on the main keyboard) at the end of a
line. It is expressed as a percentage of the point size. lOOo/o means that bottom of the lowest letters in one line can just
touch the tops of the highest in the next line (under some circumstances). 120% is a normal setting for books, but a
bit wide for text in music.
Incidentally, line spacing is known in printers jargon as leading (to rhyme with heading), from the time when extra
little bits of lead had to be put in between lines of text to space them out. Those were the days.
Draw at top/bottom of page is useful for positioning text which is in a fixed position on the page, such as page
numbers, headers, footers and footnotes. If you switch this on, you can then set the mm from top/bottom
margin for the text style (1 inch = 25.4mm).
Titles, rehearsal marks, bar numbers, composer name and so on should normally be specified relative to the top staff
rather than the page margin.
Multiple positions, available only for system text, lets you write the text above more than one staff. For instance,
titles only go above the top staff (so click just Top staff), whereas rehearsal marks in orchestral scores normally go
both above the top staff and also above the strings (so click Top staff and 2nd position). You can set which
staves constitute the 2nd, 3rd and 4th positions with the House Style ) System Object Positions dialog L!2 Layout and formatting.
Bottom staff is occasionally required for rehearsal marks. To use this, youll also need to switch on Below
bottom staff in the House Style ) System Object Positions dialog.
Repeat tab
This is only available for system text, and is useful only for headers, footers, copyright lines and the like. It makes the
text you type appear on multiple pages.
Its quite common for publishers to have different headers or footers on left and right pages - for instance, you might
have the name of an anthology or album on each top left page and the name of the current piece or song on each
top right page.
Setting the style
When youre satisfied with the style settings, click OK and it will apply instantly to your score, changing all text in that
style.
Creating new text styles
To create a new text style, on the original House Style ) Edit Text Styles dialog click an existing style to base the
new one on, then click New. The new style will have all the settings of the old one, which you can then modify as
detailed above.
182

- -- -- ---- -~

__A-_ __ .- - - - _-

Edit Text Styles

Note that you cant change whether a text style is a staff or system object, so create a new staff text style by basing it
on an existing staff text style, and create a new system text style by basing it on an existing system text style.
Deleting text styles
The Delete button on the House Style ) Edit Text Styles dialog deletes the selected text style, youll be
startled to hear. Predefined text styles cannot be deleted.
Tasteful fonts
In music its usual to use just one font family for all text, with the possible exception of titles and instrument names. A
font family consists of variants on one basic font - normally bold, italic and bold italic versions, though some font
families also have heavier (thicker-lined) and lighter (thinner-lined) fonts, and/or condensed (squashed) fonts. You
should use only two or at most three font families in any one score.
By default, all the text styles use the Times (Mac) or Times New Roman (Windows) font family (unless you use
manuscript paper based on the Inkpen font), because Times looks good and will already be installed on your
computer. If you substitute another family, you are very strongly advised to use serif fonts, with the possible exception
of one or two text styles specified below. Serif fonts have pointed cross-strokes called serifs at the tips of the letters,
unlike sans serif fonts (such as this one). Serif fonts are used in most books and newspapers for most of the text
whereas sans serif fonts are mainly used for titles, if at all.
You are recommended to keep approximately the same print size for text style as Sibeliuss defaults (unless otherwise
stated below). When changing font you may want to adjust the point size slightly because some fonts look a bit larger
or smaller than others of the same point size.
Heres some advice on redesigning the main text styles in good taste:
Expression: you must use an italic non-bold font.
Technique: you must use a non-italic non-bold font.
Lyrics: Times and Times New Roman have the virtue of being unusually narrow, so using them for lyrics causes least
disruption to the note spacing. Another classic font for lyrics is Plantin, used by Oxford University Press.
If youre writing a second line of lyrics for a translation or a chorus, its normal to use italics. For second, third etc.
verses, use non-italics.
Chord Symbol: by default this uses the specially-designed font Opus Chords (or Inkpen Chords). You could
substitute another medium font, possibly a sans serif one, but beware that some chord symbols require special
characters not provided in ordinary text fonts.
Title, Subtitle, Composer, Lyricist, Dedication: for the main title and perhaps subtitle, you can set the font
and size to almost anything you like. For the composer, lyricist and dedication, you should normally use the same font
and similar size to Technique, but with the dedication normally in italics,
Tempo and Metronome mark: the sizes of these styles vary quite widely from score to score. Tempo
always in a bold font and larger than Metronome mark, which is usually in a non-bold font.

is almost

Instruments: you may just be able to get away with a tasteful sans serif font, but proceed with caution.
183

Reference

Bar numbers: usually in italics. You can add a box to draw attention to the numbers, but in this case use a nonitalic font. (Italics would crash into the box.)
Page numbers: use a non-bold non-italic font. ILL!! Page numbers for advice on positioning.
Rehearsal marks: preferably use a bold font for clarity, but not italics (they would collide with the box). It often
looks good to use the same font as the main title, even if it is an unusual font. You can omit the box, but to do so is
outdated for the very good reason that rehearsal marks without a box are not visible enough.
Time signatures: by default these use the Opus or Inkpen font. You could substitute another standard music font,
or even a bold text font. If you try this, you may need to adjust the line spacing in the Vertical posn tab of the
House Style ) Edit Text Styles dialog.
Tuplets: an italic serif font is normal, though non-italic and/or sans serif are sometimes seen in modern scores which
use lots of tuplets.
Other text styles: preferably match similar text styles above, e.g. you should make Boxed text and Footnote
identical or similar to Technique.
Symbols styles (e.g. Common symbols, Percussion instruments): these styles specify the font used for
music symbols, so theyre not like other text. L!2 Music fonts for advice, and dont change these styles unless you
know what youre doing.

184

htracting parts

Ion-

ften
0 is
mt,
the
lich
)te
for
OU

Extracting parts
Music for several instruments is normally produced both in a full score and in separate parts which each contain the
music of just one (or sometimes several) instruments. Parts are rather different than a full score: they only contain
notation relevant to the instrument, they are sometimes written at a different pitch from the full score, and the music is
laid out differently, often on paper of a different size.
Fortunately, Sibelius takes care of all of this for you.
Extract Parts dialog
Choose File ) Extract Parts (shortcut 6xX or Ctrl+Shift+X). The following dialog will appear:
At the left you can select which staves to extract; by default, all are
selected. You can click one staff to extract just that one, add
individual staves to the selection with %-click or Ctrl-click, or add
consecutive staves with Shift-click.
Save to folder saves the parts as they extract (explained
below). Alternatively, click Dont save now if you dont want
the parts saved yet.
Ignoring the remaining options (which well deal with in a
minute), click OK, and in just seconds the part(s) will appear,

pretty much ready to print.


The parts are new files, which you can edit independently of the
full score. Normally, youd just want to do a small amount of
cleaning up to each part, such as adding the occasio nal page break, and then print it.
Save to folder
When saving to folder, by default Sibelius creates a new folder to put the parts in. For example, if your score is called
MyScore, Sibelius helpfully creates a folder in the same place called MyScore parts. Alternatively, you can click
Browse to tell Sibelius where to save.
By default, Sibelius names the parts after the instruments involved, and puts a number at the start according to the
order in the score - e.g. 1 Flute, 2 Oboe, 3 Clarinet. This makes the folder list the parts in the same order as the
score, and also serves to distinguish between separate parts for two instruments with the same name. If you feel
strongly about how your extracted parts should be named, you can choose another convention by clicking Options
when extracting parts (see below).
View part
If you switch this option off, you can extract and save a set of parts without having them appear on the screen. If you
leave this option switched on, you will have to close all of the parts (using e.g. File ) Close All) after they have
been generated.

185

Reference

Further options
Normally you want several separate parts each containing one instrument, but by choosing AlI selected staves
you can extract any combination of staves into the same part. You can use this to extract two doubling instruments
into the same part (e.g. Flute and Piccolo), or to produce a vocal score from the full score of a musical or opera.
One staff lets you extract separate staves of multi-staff instruments into separate parts - you might want this if the
score had one Oboe instrument with two staves, one for Oboe 1 and the other for Oboe 2.
Click Options to get a dialog of further options, which govern how Sibelius alters the format and other settings
during extraction. This saves you from having to change options for each part after you extract it. As youd expect, the
options are set up intelligently for you so you can normally ignore them; however, notable ones are:
Unlock format is desirable if you did lots of manual formatting in the score (which can adversely affect the
layout of the parts), such as using Lock Format, Make Into System, Make Into Page and page
breaks.
Conversely the Adjust format settings let you retain the gist of the original formatting. For instance, Turn
page breaks into system breaks ensures that ends of pieces/movements, which are normally heralded
by a page break in the score, still produce a system break in parts without wasting a whole page.
Reset note spacing resets the note spacing to the default
Transpose if necessary transposes the music if a transposing instrument is extracted from a sounding pitch
score
Document Setup: if you switch off these options, the page and staff sizes will be as for the score
Instrument names: On staves writes names in the normal place to the left of systems; On first
page/subsequent pages writes the names as a header
Rehearsal mark size is for shrinking rehearsal marks, as they are usually smaller in parts than in the score.
what extraction involves
Although you wont have to remember the details, when Sibelius extracts a part it...
Picks out the music and other objects applying to the instrument(s)
Alters the page and staff sizes, layout, transposition, rehearsal marks, instrument name and note spacing
according to the settings on the Options dialog
Optionally resets tempo text, metronome marks, titles and rehearsal marks to their default vertical positions
Consolidates bar rests into multirests, splitting them at time signatures, key changes, rehearsal marks and so on
Shows hidden objects (such as cue passages) which are set to Show in Parts
Saves the file if you requested this.
Page turns
You will probably want to put page turns into the part at convenient points - EL! Breaks.
If the pat-t is going to be printed double-sided, you will only need to put convenient turns on right-hand (i.e. oddnumbered) pages. The screen shows double-page spreads so that you can see which pages are left- and right-handed.

186

Extracting parts

Cues
Cues can be included hidden in the full score and automatically appear in extracted parts. See Working with cue
passages in EQ Grace notes and cue notes.
Extracting individual players
As described in Instruments, sometimes you will have separately numbered players in the score for which you
need to extract individual parts - e.g. Trumpets 1,2 and 3. How this is done depends on the case:
0

If the score consistently has each trumpet on its own staff, you can just extract the trumpets as separate staves.
If the players jump from staff to staff, youll need to extract more than one staff into the same part. For instance,
if your score has instruments called Trumpets 1.2.3, Trumpets 1.2 and Trumpet 3, and you want to get the
Trumpet 3 part, you should extract Trumpets 1.2.3 and Trumpet 3 into the same part, then delete any notes not
played by Trumpet 3. You can use filters to help with this last stage (Q Filters and Find). As in the score,
you may need to put system breaks in the part where a player jumps from one staff to another, so that you can
hide the unused staves on either side of the changeover point.
If there are just two players (e.g. Flutes I and 2) which sometimes or always share the same staff, you can extract
both players into the same part and then remove the unwanted notes using filters - read on.

me most common of the above cases is the last one, where two players share the same staff, as in the example below
for two flutes:

l-l

In this example, the music is sometimes in two-note chords, sometimes in unison (a 2) and sometimes in two voices.
Sibelius has built-in filters to make extracting individual players as simple as a few mouse clicks. The Edit b Filter b
Player 1 (For Deletion) and Player 2 (For Deletion) filters are specifically designed for this purpose.
First, extract the Flute 1 & 2 staff or staves from the full score. You should at this point make any changes that
you know you will need to make to both players, such as removing collisions between objects, or adding cues.
Make a copy of the combined part using File b Save As, calling it, say, Flute 2
To make the Flute 1 part, select in turn each section which is for both flutes as a passage, choose Edit b
Filter b Player 2 (For Deletion), then hit Delete twice to delete the flute 2 music - the first Delete
turns unwanted notes in extra voices into rests, and the second Delete hides these rests. If your music
contained sections of chords in one voice, as in the example above, you will need to filter for the rests
specifically, as simply hitting Delete again will also delete some of the Flute 1 notes, which remain selected
after you hit Delete for the first time.
Leave any sections of music where only Flute 1 is playing, as indicated by e.g.7 . above the staff. But any
sections where one flute plays and the other has explicit rests (using two voices) can be handled with the
Player 2 (For Deletion) filter.

187

Reference
l

1
You'll be left with the Flute 1 part, all dynamics, text and so on intact. Edit the instrument name to read Flute 1';

note that you may also have to recreate the odd articulation (such as, in this example, the fermata on the last
note):
rall.
Flute 1

To make the Flute 2 part, open the copy of the combined part and follow the same procedure, using Edit b
Filter b Player 1 (For Deletion). After adjusting the instrument name and checking articulations and so
on, you should have:
rall.
Flute 2

One case which these filters cannot automatically deal with is where a mixture of two-note chords and multiple voices
occur in the same bar, such as:
In this instance, filtering, say, Player 2 (For Deletion) would leave the two eighth
notes (quavers) at the end of the bar unselected. Sibelius always assumes that, within a
single bar, if there are multiple voices, each voice constitutes a player; so to get the
correct results, you should ensure that voices are used consistently within the same bar. In this particular case, simply
selecting the lower pair of eighth notes and swapping them into voice 2 (shortcut ~2 or Ak+2) would do the trick.
Note that these Player filters can only cope with separating two players, not three (such as our three trumpets
described above).
Dont try to use the Player filters to select the particular player and then copy it - this may well not copy all the music
you intended. For further details about filters, Q2 Filters and Find.

188

LQ Importing graphics, Opening Acorn Sibelius files, Opening Finale, Allegro and
PrintMusic files, Opening MIDI files, Opening SCORE files, Saving MIDI files, Saving
graphics files.

This section explains saving scores in Sibelius format, moving files between Mac and PC, joining scores together, and
sending files to other people via email or the Internet.
File size
Sibelius files typically occupy around 15K plus l-2K per page (excluding any imported graphics), even for band or
orchestral music. This means you can fit hundreds of thousands of pages on your hard disk, and even large scores can
fit on a single floppy disk. So even if your name is J.S. Bach, disk space is unlikely ever to present a problem when
using Sibelius.
Saving
Saving works just like in any other program, using File h Save As and File b Save (8%S or Ctrl+S). When you
get round to saving, a convenient place to save is the Scores folder which Sibelius has helpfully created for you. On
Windows, the Scores folder is created inside your My Documents folder; on Mac, the Scores folder is inside
your Sibelius program folder.
windows on/y; you can change which folder is chosen as the default for saving scores from the File b
Preferences b General dialog.
When you next open the score after saving, it will open at the point at which you were working on it when you saved,
even at the same zoom factor - so if youre working on page 23 of your score at a zoom factor of 125% and then save
it, when you next open that score, Sibelius will go straight to page 23 at 125% so you can keep right on going.
If youd prefer Sibelius to open the score at a default zoom level rather than the last zoom level you were working at,
switch on Open at default zoom level in the File b Preferences b General dialog.
Auto-save
Sibelius can automatically save your score at timed intervals so that, should your computer crash, the most work you
can lose is a few minutes worth. Rather than saving your actual file, Sibelius makes a copy of your score and saves it
into a folder called Autosave within the Backup Scores folder (see below).
If Sibelius doesnt shut down correctly (for example, if your co nputer crashes or there is an interruption in power), the
next time you start the program, it checks the Autosave folI der, and if it finds any scores in that folder, you will be
asked if you want to restore them.
When you close Sibelius normally, it deletes all the files in the Autosave folder - so its essential that you dont save
any files in there yourself!

189

Reference

Auto-save is switched on by default, but if for some reason you want to switch it off, do so from the File 1
Preferences ) General dialog. You can also specify in this dialog how often Sibelius automatically saves your
score; the default is 10 minutes.
I

Backups
Each time you save, the score (with a version number added to the name) is also saved in Backup Scores in your
Scores folder. If you ever accidentally delete or mess up a score, look in this backup folder to get the latest version
you saved, or earlier versions too. This folder stores the last 40 scores you saved; older copies are progressively
deleted to stop your disk from filling up, so dont use this folder to store your own backups!
Backup scores are created when you save manually, not each time Sibelius auto-saves; but unlike auto-saved scores,
backup scores are not deleted when you close Sibelius.
Several movements, songs or pieces
Its preferable to put several sections (e.g. movements, songs or pieces of music) into one score instead of having a
separate score for each. If you want any new sections to be on the same page as each other, in the score or in parts,
you must input them in the same file. There are a number of approaches to this.
To write, say, a couple of two-system exercises on the same page:
Input the first exercise as normal
Select the barline at the end of the first exercise and open the Bars panel of the Properties window
Switch on System break - with most manuscript papers this will result in the next exercise starting on a new
system; if you also need full instrument names and an indented staff, switch on Section end too
Create a double- or final barline at the end of the first exercise if desired (Create ) Barline ) Final or
Double)
If the key or time signature is different at the beginning of the second exercise, create new ones in the usual way,
making sure to switch off Allow cautionary in the Time Signature dialog and switch on Hide
cautionary in the Key Signature dialog
Reset the bar number at the beginning of the second exercise if desired (Create ) Bar number change).
tar multi-movement works, the simplest way to join the files is to use the File ) Append Score function - see
below.
Very long scores
If you want to input a score in several files - perhaps if several people are copying or orchestrating it simultaneously you can adjust the first bar number, first page number and first rehearsal mark of each file so that the bars, pages and
rehearsal marks follow on from the previous one.
Beware that if you plan to extract parts, each section into which the full score was divided will start on a new page in
every part, which may produce inconvenient page-turns. So once the score is finished and before extracting parts, its
best to join the files together using the File ) Append Score function - see below.

190

____._~ .---- - -- --

Append Score
You may want to join two scores together if, for example, you are creating songbooks out of separate song files.
Sibelius has a feature to append a score to the end of an existing score, automatically checking that the two scores
have matching staves, and ensuring that the appended score starts on a new page with a layout as close as possible to
before.
To use this feature, open the first score and choose File ) Append Score. A dialog appears from which you can
choose another score to append.
If it doesnt have the same number of staves, Sibelius will tell you (it wont append a score unless the staves match
exactly). If there is the same number of staves but some of the instrument names are different, Sibelius will warn you
but let you continue if you like (the instrument names in the first score will be used).
Note that text styles, symbols, noteheads etc. are merged between the two files; if two text styles have the same name
but are set up differently, the one in the original score is used. Sibelius does several things to make sure the join
between the scores is neat: changes of time signature, key signature, clef, transposition and staff type are created at
the join if necessary. The final barline in the first score is set to be a page break and a section end, so that the
appended score starts on a new page with (typically) full instrument names. Thus the appended scores layout will
normally be identical to before.
You may want to hide the cautionary clef, time and key signature changes at the point of the join between the two
scores, particularly if the join represents a break between two movements or pieces - !LLI Hiding objects.
Sharing files with other users
You may want to send music you have written in Sibelius to other people. If the person to whom you want to send
your music also has Sibelius or even just the free Sibelius demo (which they can download from
www.sibelius.com), then simply send the file by email (see below), or on removable media such as a floppy disk,
zip disk or CD-R.
If the recipient doesnt have Sibelius, there are a number of other means of sharing files with them:
l

Publish the music on SibeliusMusic.com or on your own web site - LQ Internet publishing
Export the music as a graphics file from Sibelius and send it to them - LQ Saving graphics files
Save the music as a Scorch web page and attach both files to an email (see below).

Sending files by email is very simple, but the exact procedure differs according to the email client you use:
Out/oak Express: start a new message, then click the Attach button (with a paperclip icon), find the file and
click Attach to attach it to the message. Then send it as normal.
/Vetscape Messenger: start a new message, then click the Attach button and choose File from the drop down
list. Find the file you want to attach, and double-click its name to attach it to the message, which you can then
send as normal.
Eudora: start a new message, Control-click (Mac) or right-click (Windows) on the message body, and choose
Attach file. Find the file you want to attach, and double-click its name to attach it to the message, which you
can then send as normal.
If you dont use any of the above email clients, consult its documentation for details on sending file attachments.
4

191

Reference

If you are sending a Sibelius file as a Scorch web page to somebody via email:
l

remember to attach both the sib and .htm files to your message
tell the recipient that they will need to have Scorch installed on their computer; tell them to save both files to a
folder on their computer (e.g. the Desktop), and then to double-click the saved .htm file to view the score in
their web browser

File formats
Sibelius for Mac and Sibelius for Windows use exactly the same file format. You can move a Sibelius score between
Mac and Windows without any conversion at all - see below.
Both file formats use Unicode, a standard international character set, which means that special characters (like
accented letters) are automatically translated between Mac and Windows. Music and text fonts are also substituted
intelligently - IQ2 Font equivalents in the Text section for more details.
On Windows, Sibelius files have a .sib extension. On Mac, Sibelius files are of kind Sibelius document (internally the
Creator is SIBE and the Type is SIBL).
Sibelius files are fully backwards compatible. The present version can open files from all previous versions of Sibelius,
but versions up to and including ~1.4 cannot open files saved in the present version. This means that if you know
people who already use Sibelius and want to share files with them, they must update to the present version.
Opening Mac scores on windows
If you are trying to open a score created on the Mac given to you on a floppy or Zip disk, make sure the disk is
formatted for Windows - although the Mac can read Windows disks, Windows cannot read Mac disks.
To open the file in Sibelius for Windows, you will have to add the file extension .sib. These three letters tell Windows
this is a Sibelius file.
You can do this by right-clicking on the file icon (in My Computer or Windows Explorer) and selecting
Rename. Change the extension, and then hit Return (on the main keyboard). You may be prompted that changing
file types can render them unusable, because Windows assumes that you dont know what youre doing. If asked
whether you are sure you wish to proceed, click Yes.
Alternatively, you can add the correct file extension .sib earlier on, when saving the file on the Mac.
Once you have renamed the file, you can open it in the usual way by double-clicking.
Opening windows scores on Mac
The Mac can read Windows disks as long as you have the File Exchange control panel installed. This should be
running by default, but if it isnt, re-enable it from the Extensions Manager (in Control Panels under the
Apple menu).
To open a file created using Sibelius for Windows, simply choose File ) Open and double-click the name of the file
(which will have a sib extension) in the dialog.
Note that you cannot open Windows files in the other way - by double-clicking them in the Finder - unless you use
the supplied utility called Set as Sibelius file which is installed in the folder called Extras within your Sibelius
192

A--

folder. You could drag this utility onto your desktop where its easier to find. To allow a Windows sib file to be
opened by double-clicking, simply drag the Sibelius file (or a group of files) onto Set as Sibelius file.
To open a Windows PhotoScore file on Mac, drag one or more files onto Set as PhotoScore file in the folder
called Extras within your Sibelius folder, then open it from PhotoScore Lite or PhotoScore Professional in the usual
way.
To open a Windows MIDI file on Mac, drag one or more files onto Set as MIDI file in the Extras folder within
your Sibelius folder, then open it from Sibelius in the normal way.

Reference

Filters and Find


One of Sibeliuss smart features is the ability to find objects with particular characteristics - such as all hairpins, or the
top notes only from a passage of chords, or all text in the Expression text style that says crest., or all eighth note
(quaver) middle Cs in voice 2 which have a down-bow and a marcato.
You can either select all the objects which match the characteristics you choose using options from the Edit ) Filter
submenu, or find in turn each matching object using the Edit ) Find (shortcut B%F or Ctrl+F) and Edit ) Find
Next (shortcut B%G or Ctrl+G) functions. Having done that, you can do anything you like with the selection - edit it,
copy it, delete it or whatever.
How to use filters
Select the passage of music you want to select objects from, or the whole score (%%A or Ctrl+A)
l

Choose one of the quick filters set up with standard characteristics from the Edit ) Filter menu, or choose
Advanced Filter (shortcut x%gF or Ctrl+Alt+F) to select more complex characteristics (details below)

You can then do what you like with the selection - e.g. delete it, copy it, move it with the arrow keys, add
articulations, change note value
Alternatively, you may want to choose another characteristic from the Edit ) Filter menu to narrow down the
selection further (see below).

Quick filters
The Edit ) Filter menu contains a selection of standard filters for quick access:
Chord Symbols: selects all chord symbols
Dynamics: selects all Expression text and hairpins (shortcut 67:D or Shift+Alt+D)
Expression Text: selects all text in the Expression style
Guitar Frames: selects all guitar frames
Hairpins: selects all hairpin lines
Lyrics: selects all lyrics
Notes and Chords: selects all notes and chords (along with their accidentals, articulations, etc.), but doesnt
select other objects such as text
Slurs: selects normal slurs (magnetic and non-magnetic), but not dashed or dotted slurs
Tuplets: selects tuplet brackets; useful for hiding, showing, or resetting the position of tuplet brackets in a
single operation
Voice l/2/3/4 (shortcuts 6~%%1/2/3/4 or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+l/2/3/4): selects all objects in that voice
(e.g. notes, rests, text, lines, etc.), including objects which are not exclusively in that voice - for example, if you
filter Voice 1, text objects which apply to, say, both voices 1 and 2 will also be selected. This is particularly
useful for copy&g a single voice onto another staff, since you want associated objects such as dynamics to be
copied with the notes.

Filters and Find

Voice l/2/3/4 Only: selects objects which are on/y in that voice, so it will not select objects which are in
multiple voices - for example, if you filter Voice 2 Only, text objects which apply to both voices 1 and 2 will
nof be selected. This is mainly used for deleting a particular voice from a passage, since you would not generally
want to delete any object that also applies to a remaining voice on that staff.
Tap/2nd/3rd/Bottom Note: selects only the specified notehead from chords; where there is a single note
or rest rather than a chord, nothing will be selected. This is useful if you want to delete notes from chords but
leave, say, the melody intact. 2nd and 3rd mean the second or third notehead counting down from the top,
not up from the bottom.
Tap/2nd/3rd/Bottom Note or Single Notes (shortcuts x8%1/2/3/B or Ctrl+Ak+1/2/3/B): if a
passage contains both chords and single notes, this filter will select the specified notehead from chords and the
single notes, so you end up with a continuous line of music. Useful for arranging from a keyboard sketch, where
you want to copy lines of music onto other staves.
Player l/2 (For Deletion): these filters are designed to make it easy to separate a staff for (say) Flutes 1
and 2 into extracted parts for the individual players. You can also use it to separate two players from one staff
onto separate staves in a score, in complex situations not handled by other filters such as where the music is
sometimes in one voice and sometimes in two. EL! Extracting individual players in Extracting
parts.
Using filters for copying and deleting
The chief uses of filters are for copying and deleting music, which is reflected in the range of quick filters built into
Sibelius. The distinction between them may be less than obvious at first, so lets take a real-world example.
You have a passage for, say, two flutes written on the same staff in two voices, and you decide that what you actually
want is for Flute 2s line to be played by a clarinet. To do this quickly, select the passage in the flute staff, then choose
Edit b Filter b Voice 2, which will select all of Flute 2s notes and any associated dynamics, slurs and so on. Now
simply copy the music into the clarinet staff with -c-click or Alt+click, and swap the new clarinet music into voice 1
with 7= 1 or Ak+l . To delete the Flute 2 music from the flute staff subsequently, select the passage again and choose
Edit b Filter b Voice 2 Only. This selects all the notes, but only the dynamics and so on that apply on/y to voice
2, so when you Delete, you dont lose text (etc.) that should also apply to voice 1.
When you delete a voice, hit Delete twice - the first Delete turns the notes into rests, and the second Delete
deletes these rests.
Advanced Filter dialog
If you want to make a more complex filter, such as one using a combination of characteristics, you should use the
Edit b Filter b Advanced Filter dialog (shortcut x#F or Ctrl+Ak+F).

195

Reference

This dialog allows you to select or deselect any objects in the selected passage or the whole score. It is split into two
halves: on the left are general values that need to be set for the filter operation such as whether to Find in the whole
score or a selected passage, which general object types to include (Text, Lines etc.), and which voices to include; on
the right are detailed values for each general object type -- these are in four pages, selected from the View list box.
The four Voice boxes indicate which voices in your score will be filtered; by default, all four voices are filtered.
If you select a passage or multiple selection before choosing Edit b Filter b Advanced Filter, you will be able to
choose whether your filter applies to the Selection or the Whole score. If you dont select anything before
filtering, it will automatically apply to the whole score.
Build up as complex a filter as you like by using the four pages of options accessed via the View list at the left. Switch
on the Find box for a particular page to add it to the filter; switch it off again to remove it. Obviously enough, at least
one of the Find boxes must be switched on to perform a filter operation!
The four pages contain the following options:
l

Notes and chords: although the options here are more or less self-explanatory, lets take a quick look at
them anyway:
l

Note in chord: filters the specified note in the selection.

Pitch (sounding)/Octave: filters only notes of the specified pitch, and optionally in a specified octave. (C4
is middle C.) Sibelius in fact searches by sounding pitch, so you dont need to worry about transposing
instruments. So that you dont get confused when working with transposing scores, its a good idea to switch off
Notes b Transposing Score before using pitch filters. @VU lines are ignored by this filter when searching
for pitch.)
l

196

Notes/Chords with n noteheads: filters chords with the specified number of notes

Note value: selects only notes/rests of the specified length. Pick note values from the list or type them on
the numeric keypad (with Num Lock on). Ties are ignored for this purpose, so a half note (minim) tied to
an eighth note (quaver) is treated as two separate notes.

Filters and Find

Position in bar: filters notes/rests with the specified position after the start of the bar. So if you choose
quarter note (crotchet), only notes/rests which are one quarter note into the bar (i.e. begin on the second
quarter note) will be filtered. If you also choose Plus multiples, every note/rest on Q quarter nofe
(crotchet) beat will be filtered. Leave the Position in bar box empty to filter just notes/rests at the start of
bars .
Articulation: filters notes/chords according to their articulations. If Any of these is selected then a
note/chord will be filtered if it has any of the selected articulations attached to it; if All required is selected,
a note/chord will only be filtered if it has all of the specified articulations.
Rests and Bar Rests: you can choose whether the filter should operate on normal rests, bar rests, or both,
by ticking the appropriate boxes. The drop-down lists allow you to specify the duration of the rests you want to
filter.
Text: enter a particular word (e.g. legato, mf) to filter all matching text in the selection, but note that this field
is case sensitive (e.g. Legato and legato are different). You can optionally specify one or more text styles to
filter - click on the text style to add it to the selection, and click on it again to remove it from the selection. The
All or None buttons should be fairly self-explanatory!
Lines: if this page is included in the filter, the selected line in the boxes on the right will be selected; note that
you can only filter either all kinds of line (if All lines is switched on) or one kind of line at once. If you want
your filter to ignore lines altogether, ensure that the Lines box under Find is not selected.
Clicking Reset in the dialog sets all the filter options back to their defaults, so you can start afresh.
Once you have set the options you want, check that the appropriate Find boxes are selected, then click Select to
select all objects in the selection or whole score that match the filter characteristics, or Deselect to remove all objects
that match the filter characteristics from the selection.
Selecting objects with characteristics x and y
Lets suppose you want to select all half note (minim) middle Cs in a passage, in order to put an accent on them.
Think of this as selecting everything which is both a half note and a middle C.
To do this, you select all half notes and then filter all middle Cs from those, like this:
l

First, select a passage


Choose Edit ) Filter ) Advanced Filter (shortcut &#F or Ctrl+Alt+F)
From the Pitch (sounding) list choose C, and from the Octave list choose 4
From Note value choose a half note
Click Select, and the filter is performed on your score, leaving only middle C half notes selected.
Add accents using the first keypad layout.

Selecting objects with characteristic x or y


Lets suppose you want (for some unearthly reason) to select all notes in a passage which are either half notes
(minims) or middle Cs, to put an accent on them. This sort of case is rather unlikely, and so there is no direct way to
do it. However, the indirect method is:
l

Select a passage, then using the Edit ) Filter ) Advanced Filter dialog, select all half notes
197

Reference
l

Put an accent on them using the first keypad layout


Select the passage again, then using the Edit b Filter b Advanced Filter dialog select all middle Cs
Put an accent on them, too.

Finding objects
Finding works in much the same way as filtering - and the Edit b Find dialog is very similar to the Advanced
Filter dialog. To find objects:
l

Choose Edit b Find (shortcut B%F or Ctrl+F) and choose the combination of characteristics you want to find
in your score - see Advanced Filter dialog above for details on how to use this dialog
Click Find to find the first object in your score that matches the criteria you have chosen; if no matching objects
are found, Sibelius pops up a message telling you so.

Once youve set up a Find operation, you can use Edit b Find Next (shortcut B%G or Ctrl+G) to find the next
matching object in your score. The search order is as follows:
l

798

The search starts at the beginning of the score, with the first bar in the first staff
Sibelius searches to the end of that staff, then moves down to the next staff and searches to the end of that staff,
and so on.
If the end of the score is reached (in other words, the end of the bottom staff), you are asked if you want to stop
the search, or continue searching from the beginning of the score.

Flexi-time

Flexi-time
LQll Note input.
Flexi-time is Sibeliuss unique intelligent real-time MIDI input system.
Real-time input
Real-time input on other computer programs is when the program tries to work out both the pitch and the rhythm of
music played on a MIDI keyboard, and turn it into clean notation.
The big problem is rhythm: people never play rhythms quite as notated because of unconscious rubafo (variation in
speed), so real-time input can easily end up with notes tied to extra 64th-notes (hemidemisemiquavers) and other
ridiculous things.
A standard improvement is produced by quantization: this is where you tell a program to round all note values to the
nearest sixteenth-note (semiquaver), or whatever unit you specify. The trouble is that this only improves the situation
for relatively simple music - and if you speed up or slow down as you play, the computer will get out of time with you
in any case and produce garbage.
With Flexi-time, however, Sibelius detects if youre doing rubato and compensates accordingly. It quantizes
automatically - theres no need to specify a quantization unit - and uses a smart algorithm which varies the
quantization according to context. For instance, when you play short notes, Sibelius will quantize with a shorter unit
than when you play long notes.
Recording with Flexi-time
Although you can change the time signature after inputting music, we recommend that you put the
correct time signature in first, so that the metronome click indicates beats correctly
Click a bar, note or rest from which to start recording, or:
l

If you want to record into both staves of a piano, E-click or Ctrl+click the top staff
If youre just recording from the start of a score for one instrument, you dont need to select anything first as
its obvious where youre recording from

If you want to record into a voice other than voice 1, either select a note or rest in the voice into which you want
to record, or change the Record to voice setting in Notes b Flexi-time Options (see below)
Click the record button on the toolbar or choose Notes b Flexi-time (shortcut 08gF or Ctrl+Shift+F)
Sibelius will start ticking a metronome to count you in. It gives you one full bar of clicks (by default) - wait for
this before you start playing!
You can adjust the recording speed by dragging the tempo slider; the tempo readout on the toolbar changes as
you drag the slider. (If you want to record more slowly, start recording, adjust the tempo slider to the desired
point, then hit Esc and start recording again - Sibelius will remember your tempo.)
Start playing at the keyboard, following the click (at least approximately). As you play, the music youre playing
will appear in notation on the screen.
If you speed up or slow down, the metronome speeds up or slows down to follow you, as long as youre not too
violent with the tempo.
199

Reference
l

When youve finished recording, hit Est.

If you want to erase the music you recorded and play it in again, Delete the old music first (after selecting it as a
passage).
If you add more music with Flexi-time on a different staff or staves, Sibelius plays back the existing music as you record
(overdubbing).
If you want to add more music to the Same staff/staves as the existing music, just record in exactly the same way as
before - Sibelius will add the new notes to the existing ones to make chords. If you want to add another melody to
the same staff, you can record into one of the other voices - see Voices below.
Click settings
The settings for the metronome click you hear during Flexi-time recording are controlled via the Play b Mixer dialog
(shortcut M). By default, the click marks the first beat of the bar with a high woodblock sound, and then subsequent
beats with a low click. In compound time signatures such as 6/8, it also subdivides the beat into eighth notes
(quavers). For complex time signatures such as 7/8, the default behavior is to emphasize the beginning of each beat
group.
For more information on these settings, QA Mixer.
Hints
0 Listen to Sibeliuss countdown beats, and start in time with them! If you start too soon, or at a different tempo
from the countdown, Sibelius will not understand what youre up to.
If you have difficulty recording two staves of music at once, try recording them one at a time.
Play /egoto (smoothly).
If you want music to be notated with staccatos, make sure the Staccato option is switched on in Notes b
Flexi-Time Options. If this option is switched off then playing staccato will produce short note values with
rests.
People are often sloppy about placing notes simultaneously when playing a chord. If theres a significant gap
between putting down notes of a chord, Sibelius will notate what you played literally. Similarly, if you spread
chords significantly, Sibelius will write out what you played rhythmically rather than adding a vertical wiggly line.
Sibelius can pick up changes of tempo extremely quickly - one beat faster than a human can, in fact! However, if
you make too violent a change of tempo Sibelius wont understand what you mean. So avoid making deliberate
tempo changes during recording.
If Sibeliuss beat gets out with you as youre playing, stop and go back to the point where it got out. If you just
blunder on regardless, Sibelius may well get back in time again, but correcting the rhythm will take far longer
than just playing it again (Sam).
Inputting into two instruments
You can input into two staves of different instruments if you like - such as Flute and Bassoon - so long as theyre
adjacent (and there are no staves in between that have merely been hidden from the system in question). First click
the upper staff, then Shift-click the lower staff so both are selected, then start recording as normal.

200

Flexi-time

Flexi-time options
To get the various Flexi-time options, choose Notes ) Flexi-time Options (shortcut 6x0 or Ctrl+Shift+O):

Adjust rhythms makes Sibelius clean up what youre playing. Leave this on!
Minimum note value: this sets the shortest note value Sibelius will write. (Note that this is not a
quantization unit - Sibelius quantizes using a complex algorithm that varies with context.)
Notate: these are options to notate staccato and tenuto; if you are confident of playing the articulation
exactly as you want it to be notated, switch these on. If you find lots of spurious staccato or tenuto
articulations in your score after inputting with Flexi-time, switch them off.
Tuplets: for each of the tuplets listed, you can set Sibelius to detect None/Simple/Moderate/Complex
ones. A simple triplet (say) means one with three equal notes. For tuplets such as a quarter note (crotchet)
followed by a eighth note (quaver), use Moderate, and for tuplets with rests or dotted rhythms, use
Complex. You can also choose whether or not Sibelius should notate triplets with Brackets.
Split points: when inputting onto two staves, the split point determines which notes go into each staff (notes
on or above the split point go into the top staff, and notes below go into the bottom staff). If you choose Autoranging split point, Sibelius will guess where your hands are on the keyboard at any time and assign notes
to staves accordingly. Alternatively, you can specify your own Fixed split point. (Note that in Sibelius, middle C
is reckoned as C4 - which may be different from how it is described in other music programs.)
Flexibility of tempo: controls how Sibelius follows your speed. If youre used to playing to a click, set this to
None (non rubato), and Sibelius will keep a fixed tempo. The higher you set the flexibility, the more
Sibelius is inclined to follow your tempo. If you find Sibelius seems to be changing tempo oddly, its finding you
hard to follow, so reduce the flexibility or set it to None (non rubato).
Introduction . . . bars: determines how many bars introduction will be played when you start recording
Record up to . . . bars: if there arent many bars left in the score for you to record into, this automatically
adds enough bars when you start recording
Record to voice: allows you to choose which voice you record into if you select Q bar before starting Flexitime input - note that if you select a note (or any object belonging to that voice, such as text or a slur), Flexi-time
will record into that voice.
201

Reference

Our recommended Flexi-time options are the default values, as follows: Adjust rhythms on, Minimum note
I
value sixteenth-note (semiquaver), Flexibility of tempo set to Low, Staccato and Tenuto on. For tuplets, set
3 to Simple or Moderate, maybe 6 as well, and the others normally to None unless youre into playing things
Ii ke septuplets.
Recording transposing pitch
In the File ) Preferences ) General dialog, switch on the Record transposing pitch option if youre
recording by sight-reading from a transposing score; otherwise, Sibelius assumes youre playing notes at sounding
pitch.
Spelling of accidentals
As with step-time input, Sibelius guesses how you want to spell black notes (e.g. as F# or Gb), but you can alter the
spelling of any note or selection of notes afterwards just by hitting Return (on the main keyboard).
Voices
If you want to input music with more than one rhythm on each staff (polyphonic music such as a fugue), you will
need to record each voice separately.
As you record, Sibelius inputs all notes into a single voice, using ties where necessary to show different rhythms on the
same staff. Sibelius cant work out the voicings as you go along as there are various ways of notating the same music,
so youll need to go back and edit the music afterwards to separate out the second voice. You could, for example, filter
out the lowest note in each voice 1 chord (ILL2 Filters and Find) and then, say, swap them into voice 2 by typing
~2 or Ak+2.
However, if you prefer to record one voice at a time, this is easy: start by selecting a note/rest in that voice, or else
specify the voice from the Notes ) Flexi-time Options dialog (see Flexi-time options above).

202

Free rhythm

Free rhythm
Music in free rhythm means that there are no time signatures (as in recitative, some avant garde music, or plainchant),
or else the current time signature is ignored (as in a cadenza). Sometimes several instruments can play free rhythms at
different speeds so that the notes dont even line up, as in aleatory music.
Normal free rhythm
For free rhythm in just one instrument, or in several where the rhythms align, create irregular bars of appropriate
lengths (choose Create b Bar b Other, shortcut -cB or Alt+B) into which to put the music.
Depending on the type of music, you can input the music in one long bar or in several shorter bars with invisible
barlines. The latter has the advantage that the music can split at any of the invisible barlines, which will be required for
a long cadenza which wouldnt fit on one system. The downside is that the extra bars will upset the bar numbering,
though you can correct by putting an appropriate bar number change at the end (l!LLl Bar numbers).
Independent free rhythms
Sometimes instruments play completely independent rhythms at the same time, like this:

Notate this in the same way as described above, but choose one of the staves as the fundamental rhythm and input
it first. Then add the other rhythms, but change their apparent speed using tuplets with a suitable ratio - i.e. choose
None and switch off the Bracket in the Create b Tuplet dialog (or change it retrospectively from the Notes
panel of the Properties window). For example, in the music above the first three notes on the lower staff are in a
hidden triplet, so as to fit against two notes on the upper staff.
Sibelius will even play back the rhythms correctly, as if it were reading the spatial notation.
Music with multiple simultaneous time signatures
. ..or with barlines in different places on different staves: EL! Time signatures.
Plainchant
To write plainchant, use irregular bars (choose Create b Bar b Other, shortcut XB or Alt+B) of appropriate
lengths, and use stemless notes (L!2 Choir in How to).
Recitative
Use irregular bars (choose Create b Bar b Other, shortcut -\=B or Alt+B) of appropriate lengths. For help on
lyrics in recitative, Q2l Lyrics.

Reference

Cadenzas
Here are a couple of approaches to creating cadenzas in Sibelius. Note that it is helpful if you calculate the length of
your cadenza (in terms of note values) before you start to input it:
l

Create an irregular bar, or a series of them, using Create b Bar b Other (shortcut xB or Ak+B). You can
specify the exact duration of the bar, as complex as you like, and fill them with music as normal. You should
avoid deleting (hiding) any unwanted rests if possible, as they will have an effect on note spacing even if they
are hidden.
If you need to have regular (measured) bars of music and free rhythm simultaneously, see Independent
free rhythm above.

Ac

stc
4r
Pfi

ah
1%
Pal
slittl
not{
grol
Gra4
first
note
mair
or if
legef
shr i!
T@pqq

. . . tl

204

Grace notes and cue notes

Grace notes and cue notes


Grace notes
Grace notes are smaller than normal notes, and are drawn in between them. Unlike cue notes, grace notes dont
count towards the total duration of the bar. This is because the performer is meant to fit them in between the main
notes himself. Grace notes with a diagonal line through the stem are acciaccaturas, and ones without are
appoggiaturas (this is the terminology Sibelius uses, anyway).
Gruce notes
Grace notes are normally drawn with
stems up, regardless of their pitch. They
are only ever drawn with stems down to
avoid colliding with other objects, e.g. in
the second of two voices.
Acciaccaturas (with a line through the
stem) are normally used only for single
grace notes. Single grace notes,
particularly acciaccaturas, are almost
always written as an eighth note (quaver)
regardless of how long they actually last.
Pairs of grace notes are usually written as
skteenth notes (semiquavers), with 32ndnotes (demisemiquavers) being used for
groups of about four or more grace notes.
Grace notes are usually slurred from the
first grace note to the following main
note. The slur normally goes above if the
main note is higher than the grace note,
or if the grace note or main note has
leger lines above the staf( otherwise the
slur is below.

Creating grace notes.. .


Grace notes are always attached to the following normal note in a bar (so you
cannot automatically create grace notes at the very end of a bar - see below).
You can create grace notes in two ways, detailed below.
The quick way is to input the grace notes as you go along during step-time
or alpha betic input;
l

The slow way is to input the normal notes first, then add the grace notes
afterwards.
l

. ..the quick way


To input grace notes as you go along:
l

Start creating notes (ILQ Note input)

When you want to create a grace note, switch to the second keypad layout
(shortcut F9) and switch on the appropriate keypad button:
l

Acciaccatura
Appogglatura
Then create notes as normal, choosing note values from the first keypad
layout (shortcut F8)
l

To stop creating grace notes, switch off the grace note button on the second keypad layout.

. ..the slow way


To add grace notes to an existing passage of music:
Either choose the note value and the kind of grace note from the first and second keypad layouts, or type the
shortcuts: . (period) for an appoggiatura, and / for an acciaccatura (they depict a tiny notehead and a line
through a stem respectively)
The mouse arrow changes color to show which voice youre going to create the grace note into; click where the
grace note is to go
Unless you specified a note value before creating it, the grace note will appear as an eighth note (quaver). You
can modify the note value in the same way as normal notes
Type A-G or use your MIDI keyboard to produce more grace notes after it.
20.5

Reference
l

Type l-9 (or Shift-1 -9 for notes below) to produce grace note chords, or play the chords on your MIDI
keyboard.

Editing grace notes


Most editing operations work for grace notes in exactly the same way as normal notes, including dragging, copying,
deleting, adding/removing accidentals and articulations, beaming, and changing its note value or notehead.
Grace notes at the end of bars
Because grace notes attach to the note or rest following them, if you try to create a grace note at the very end of the
bar, it has nothing to attach to. So to create a grace note at the end of a bar, create it before the final note or rest in
the bar, and then alter its position using the Properties dialog - El2 Properties. (To move the grace note
thereafter, only use the Properties dialog - not the mouse or arrow keys - or the grace note may reattach to a
different note.)
Cue notes
Cue notes are small notes used to write cues in instrumental parts, and also to show optional or editorial notes in
scores. (The other chief uses for small notes are for writing optional keyboard accompaniments in choral and
instrumental music, and the solo part on a keyboard accompaniment, but in these cases you should not use cue
notes, but instead make the relevant staves small, which will make all the notes and other objects on it small too /IL!2 Staves.)
Unlike grace notes, cue notes occupy rhythmic space in the bar, and play back like normal notes. Because a cue can
contain grace notes or special noteheads, any note - whether its a normal note, special notehead or even a grace
note - can be made cue-size. Rests and bar rests can also be cue-size.
Cue notes are also independent of the staff size - normally cue notes go on a normal-size staff, but if you put cue
notes on a small staff they will go even smaller. You can even put cue grace notes on a small staff, to get really, really
tiny notes.
Creating cue notes and cue-size rests
To make a note or rest cue-size, select it and then choose the appropriate button, shown on the right, from
the second keypad layout (shortcut Enter). When creating notes with mouse and keystrokes or step-time,
notes continue to be cue notes until you switch the button off again.
If you want to make a passage of music go cue-size, simply select the music as a passage and choose the
cue button from the second keypad layout.
You can make cue notes and cue-size rests normal size again by re-choosing the cue button in the same way.
Other cue and grace note sized objects
Articulations, accidentals, rhythm dots, tremolos and beams associated with cue- and grace notes are automatically
scaled to match the size of the notes. If you need to add a symbol to a passage of cue or grace notes, switch on Cuesize or Grace note size from the Create ) Symbol dialog to make it smaller too (!L! Symbols). You can
make text smaller by changing the point size (I!LLI Text).

206

Em

Grace notes and cue notes

Working with cues


You can add cues to extracted parts just by adding notes to them and making them cue-size. However, the easiest way
to put cues in a part is to put them into that instrument ;II fhe fullscore prior to extraction.
The advantage of this is that you can just copy the notes you want to cue from the instrument which actually plays
them. Moreover, Sibelius will automatically take care of any headaches involved with shifting the notes between clefs
or transposing instruments. (If you needed to write a Clarinet in A cue into a Horn in F part, you could easily transpose
it by the wrong interval or in the wrong direction, whereas Sibelius will be sure to get it right for you!)
Furthermore, you can hide the cues, so that they dont clutter up the full score, but they will automatically appear in
the parts. Lets take an example of putting, say, a violin 1 cue into a flute part. To do this:
In the full score, select the passage in the violin 1 staff that will provide the flute cue
Copy it into the flute staff with x-click or Alt+click
Make it cue-sized by selecting the cue button on the second keypad layout (shortcut Enter)
Add a suitable text direction, e.g. Vln. I in Technique text, above the cue
Hide the cue passage and the text by selecting it and choosing Edit ) Hide or Show ) Hide (6xH or
Ctrl+Shift+H), or by clicking Hide in score from the General panel of the Properties window. If
View ) Hidden Objects is switched on (shortcut 71xH or Ctrl+Alt+H), the notes and text will turn gray
on the screen; if you dont want to see them at all, switch off View ) Hidden Objects
Finally, hit Esc to make sure nothing is selected, then type ~2 or Alt+2 to choose voice 2, then create a bar
rest from the second keypad layout and move it up to the normal position by typing +. Choose Hide in
parts from the General panel of the Properties window to make certain that the rest isnt included in your
extracted parts.
With View ) Hidden Objects switched on, your Flute staff should look something like this:

One point to consider is that hidden notes play back by default, so the above cue passage will play back with a flute
sound, which might not be what you want. You can make cues not play back by selecting the cue as a passage and
typing 6x9 Shift+Alt+S to give the notes the silent notehead type (D2 Noteheads).
For further details about extracting parts, Q2 Extracting parts.
Engraving Rules options
The Notes 2 page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut 6%gE or Ctrl+Shift+E) lets you
modify the size of grace and cue notes relative to normal notes.
Note that grace notes are normally a bit smaller than cue notes (60% of full size instead of 75%).

207

Reference

Big notes
In the unlikely event that you want extra-large notes on normal staves (a notation used occasionally by Stockhausen to
denote loud notes) and dont also need cue-sized notes, set Cue note size on the Notes 2 page of the House
Style b Engraving Rules dialog to, say, 13Oo/0, and input the big notes as cue notes.

208

1
I

Grove Music

Grove Music
This feature requires an Internet connection.

(b Hameenllnna, 8 Dee 1865, d Jarvenpaa, 20 Sept 1957) Finnish composer.


He was the central figure In creating a Finnish voice in music in the late 19th and
early 20th centunes HIS most srgnrfrcant output was orchestral seven
symphonres, one vrolin concerto, several sets of incrdental musrc and numerous
tone poems, often based on incidents taken from the Kalevala, the Frnnrshlanguage folk epic. HIS work is distinguished by startlrngly original adaptations of
famrlrar elements unorthodox treatments of triadic harmony, orchestral colour
and musrcal process and structure His music evokes a range of characteristic
moods and topics, from celebratory nationalism and political struggle to cold
despair and separatist isolation, from brooding contemplations of neo-primitive
musical ideas or slowly transforming sound textures to meditations on the
mwtorloc ~lr~t-~dot u-s 3rd nrrac~nnaII\/

II v-lclnrl twn-ws

soosd sta&&#

nf

arrhptvnal

fnlk rr-wthc

nr

4&M* )

The Grove Music button on Sibeliuss toolbar will launch your web browser and take you to
www.grovemusic.com, the online version of the New Grove Dictionary of Music and Musicians
(2nd edition).
Exclusive to Sibelius users, you get a free subscription to the site, giving you a total of 30 hours use of the web site
over a six month period, starting from when you first use it. If you have a Sibelius s-pack or other site license, you get
unlimited access to the site for 30 days, starting from when you first use it.
After that time, you can choose to buy a further subscription if you wish.
About the New Grove Dictionary
Published in January 2001, this is the first new edition of this landmark music reference work in over 20 years - it also
marks the first time in Grove history that The /Vew Grove has been available in both print and electronic formats,
making it more accessible than ever before.
The fully searchable web site features nearly 30,000 articles and more than 25 million words, covering the entire
history of Western music, from Albinoni to Xenakis and beyond.

Reference

Guitar frames
Guitar frames illustrate how to play a particular chord by showing which fingers need to be on which fret on each
string. They are usually accompanied by chord symbols, which Sibelius can include for you.
Adding guitar frames
To create a guitar frame above the selected note, choose Create ) Guitar Frame (shortcut U) to get this
dialog:
l

210

From the Key and Type lists, choose the chord you want; you can also change the Bass note
Max. stretch x frets allows you to choose the maximum distance between the frets used in a particular
chord, affecting how easy or hard the chord is to play; the default is 3.
Sibelius will instantly work out all possible fingerings of this chord and display them at the left. Click on one of
these to choose it and display it large at the right. The smaller Preview window shows at actual size how the
frame will appear in your score.
You can directly edit the name of the chord symbol, if you like, by typing in the box. There are special keys which
produce particular characters - L!2 chord symbols. If you do not want a chord symbol to appear with the
frame, switch off Show chord symbol.
If you dont want a standard guitar tuning, or if you want a chord for another instrument such as a mandolin,
change the Tuning option and Sibelius will recalculate all possible frames for the chosen chord. (If the tuning
or instrument you want is not listed, you can create custom ones - 1!22! Guitar tab.)
You can also directly edit the chord frame by clicking on the big picture. To move a dot, click on the grid where
you want it to go. Similarly, to write a circle or cross above the grid, click there. To turn a circle into a cross or
vice versa, click on it. Click the Fret arrows to change the fret number.

Guitar frames

To draw a slur-shaped bar or barre, click one of the frets and drag sideways to another one. Dots will be drawn
on all the frets in between, with a bar/barre above. (While dragging, the frame may shift up or down to be based
on a different fret.)
When youre happy with the guitar frame, click OK and the frame is added above the selected note.
To place a guitar frame with the mouse, ensure nothing in your score is selected - hit Esc - and choose
Create ) Guitar Frame; pick the frame you want as above, click OK, and then click in your score to place
the frame.
Note that if the Max. stretch number is increased, the Number of frets parameter on the Guitar page of the
House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog is also increased if necessary. However, when the Max. stretch
parameter is reduced again, the Number of frets doesnt change - it must be altered directly in the House
Style ) Engraving Rules dialog if required.
Copying, editing and deleting guitar frames
Guitar frames can of course be copied, moved and deleted in the usual ways. Once created in your score, you can edit
a guitar frame simply by double-clicking it.
Note that guitar frames do not transpose.
Hiding guitar frames
To hide a guitar frame, select it and choose Edit ) Hide or Show ) Hide (shortcut O%%H or Ctrl+Shift+H).
For more information about hiding objects, L!2 Hiding objects.
Engraving Rules options
The Guitar frames page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut 48gE or Ctrl+Shift+E)
contains numerous self-explanatory options controlling the design of guitar frames.
Default Positions
The default position of guitar frames is controlled from the House Style ) Default Positions dialog. Click the
Other objects radio button, and then choose Guitar frames from the list - LQ Default Positions for more
details.

211

Reference

Guitar tab
IQ2 Guitar frames.
This also covers tab for other fret instruments, such as lute tablature.
Sibelius automatically writes music as notation or as tab in any tuning. It doesnt have to do anything to convert
between them - it treats tab just as a different way of displaying the underlying music. This means that with Sibelius
you can do pretty much anything with tab that you can do with notation - you can play it back, transpose it, copy it
(onto tab or notation staves) and so on.
This also means you can input music in tab and turn it into notation, or input it into notation and turn it into tab, or
even change standard guitar tab to a different string tuning, or to bass guitar, mandolin, banjo or dobro. Or ?-course
lute. Or bass theorbo.
Creating a tab instrument
Guitar and other fret instruments are available from the Create ) Instruments dialog (shortcut I) with a tab staff
created automatically. On the dialog they are called e.g. Guitar [tab].
Alternatively, you can turn a notation staff into a tab staff: select the first bar of the staff so that it is enclosed in a blue
box and open the Staves panel of the Properties window. Then use the drop-down box to change the staff type
to, say, Guitar modal D. You can also use this method to produce tab with rhythms indicated by stems.
Turning notation into tab or tab into notation
Often you will want to have two staves - a notation staff and a tab staff, both showing the same music - or you may
want to turn notation into tab or vice versa. This is done simply by copying the music between the staves:
Create two guitars, one with notation and one with tab, or just use the Guitar + Tab manuscript paper
Input all of the music onto (say) the notation staff
Select all of this music as a passage by triple-clicking the notation staff
Copy it onto the tab staff by x-clicking or Alt+clicking onto the first bar. It will all turn magically into tab:

You can then edit the tab staff to, for example, move some of the notes onto different strings.
You can also do this the other way around - input the tab, then copy it to the notation staff. Then if you dont need
both staves (and just wanted to convert between notation and tab) you can delete the original one.

Guitar tab

Creating and editing tab


Instead of creating music as notation and turning it into tab afterwards, you can create tab directly. This works exactly
like normal notation, and you can input either using the keypad, step-time or Flexi-time. You can even type notenames using the letters A-G.
The only significant differences are that when a fret number is selected:
0 /1\ and J/ change the string but keep the same sounding pitch (and hence change the fret number). %%+/&
or Ctrl+/t/+ changes to the top or bottom string.
l

Hold down 67: or Shift+Alt and type using the numbers along the top of the main keyboard (not the
numeric keypad) to change the fret number (and hence the pitch).

Notes out of range


IO see if a note is too low to be played on a given string, switch on View ) Note Colors ) Notes out of
l-

Range (shortcut 6xN or Shift+Alt+N). If a note is too low, it is shown in red, by analogy with notes out of range
on other instruments. The note is given a negative fret number, which reflects the fact that the fretboard and hence
string would need to be longer to play the note.
Special tab notations
There is a number of special tab notations such as bends, pre-bends, slides, hammer-ons and pull-offs, and so on,
which can all be produced easily in Sibelius. The most common ones are listed below.
You can create these in either tab or notation staves, and they come out automatically when copied between tab and
notation staves (with a few minor exceptions stated below).
Some of the tab notations involve hidden notes on the tab staff, which can be viewed and edited when View )
Hidden Objects (shortcut 716t%H or Ctrl+Alt+H) is switched on.
Bend
Bends are produced by fretting a string and then pushing the string sideways to bend the note after
playing it. Bends are normally either a half-step (semitone) or a whole step (tone) up or down, but
its possible to bend microtonal intervals too if you want.
On notation staves, a bend is drawn as an angled line between two notes, a bit like a crooked slur.
On tab staves, it is drawn as an arrow which curves upwards if the second note is higher than the
first, or downwards if the second note is lower than the first; additionally, for upward bends the
second note is not notated on the tab staff, the interval for the bend instead being given above the
curved arrow, in half-steps. A whole step bend is usually written as full rather than '1' (although you can change this
in Sibelius from the Guitar page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog by switching off the Use full
on tab bends option).
To create a bend, select the first note and type J (which looks a little like a bend on a tab staff); the bend line will
automatically be positioned between it and the next note (or will snap to the next note when you create it). You can
also create a bend with the mouse: first ensure that nothing is selected in your score, choose Create ) Line
(shortcut L) and select the bend line (shown as if on a notation staff) from the Staff lines panel. The mouse pointer
changes color and you can click in the score to place the line.
213

Reference

Bend lines behave similarly to slurs: type space to extend the bend to the next note, or Shift-space to retract it; on
notation staves, you can choose Edit ) Flip (shortcut X) to move the bend to the other side of the note. You can
also adjust the position of either end of the bend line using the mouse or arrow keys.
To change the bend interval on a notation staff, simply change the pitch of the second note. On a tab staff, make sure
View ) Hidden Objects (shortcut xB%H or Ctrl+Ak+H) is switched on, then select the hidden second note
and change its pitch (either by playing a note on your MIDI keyboard, or by holding &# or Ctrl+Shift and typing
the fret number on the main keyboard).
To create a slight or microtonal bend, create a bend on a note and type Shift-space to retract the right-hand end so
that it attaches to the same note as the left-hand end. A slight bend is drawn as a curved line on a notation staff, and
as a quarter-tone bend on a tab staff.
To create microtonal notes on a tab staff, create the note as normal and then (with the note selected) type =, which
toggles the microtonal interval. A microtone appears on a tab staff as a fret number followed by 5.
Should you need to change the font or point size used by the numbers above bends on a tab staff, simply edit the
Guitar frame fret text style - L!2 Edit text styles.
If you prefer bends on a tab staff to be written without an arrowhead, switch off Use arrows in guitar bends on
he Guitar page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog.
Bend and release
A bend and release is a bend upwards followed by a release back to the original note. To
notate this, simply create an upward bend followed by a downward one.
When written on a tab staff, the second note is usually bracketed (because it isnt actually
played); to bracket the note, select it and choose the bracket button (m , shortcut 1) on the
second keypad layout (shortcut F9).
Grace note bends and pre-bends
Both these kinds of bends are notated in the same way: first, from the second keypad layout
(shortcut F9), create the grace note ( , shortcut *) or pre-bend note (
J to create a bend; then create the second note.
On a tab staff, a pre-bend is renresented bv a vertical arrow.
I

Pre-bend and release


A pre-bend and release is created in much the same way as grace-note bends and pre-bends, as
above; as you would expect, create a pre-bend note followed by a grace note, create a bend, then
create a full-size note, and create another bend between the grace note and the full-size note.
Remember to bracket the final note on the tab staff (see Bend and release above).

214

Guitar tab

Unison bend
A unison bend is when you strike the two notes simultaneously, and bend the lower note up to the
pitch of the higher. On a notation staff, the unison bend is written in a similar way to a pre-bend
(see above), with two noteheads for the upper note.
On the tab staff, you will need to add the higher of the two initial notes as text; choose Create h
Text h Special Text h Tablature numbers and type the number.
Slide
A slide is achieved by striking the first note than then sliding the same finger up or down to the
second note, which is struck if the slide is a shift slide, and not struck if the slide is a legato
slide.
On both notation staves and tab staves, shift slides are notated as a straight line (as shown on
the left). Legato slides are notated as a line together with a slur. If the second note of the slide
is higher, the line points upwards; if the second note is lower, the line points downwards. On
tab staves, the line is at a fixed angle, but on notation staves, the line is angled according to the position of the notes
to which it is attached.
To create a slide, input the first note of the slide and click the slide button ( ifl/, shortcut .) on the second keypad
layout (shortcut F9), then input the second note. You can also input the slide after creating both notes - just select
the first of the two notes and click the slide button. To make a legato slide, just add a slur in the normal way (EN
Slurs).
You can adjust the position of slides by selecting either end and moving the handle with the mouse or the arrow keys.
Where there are several notes in a chord with slides, it is assumed that they are all sliding in the same direction.
Should this not be the case, you should use straight lines from the Create h Line dialog (shortcut L) to create the
slides going in the opposite direction.
Vibrato bar dive and return
The pitch of the note or chord is dropped a specified number of whole-steps (tones), then
returned to the original pitch.
On a notation staff, a bar dive and return is written with two bend lines (see Bend above)
and the w/bar line from the Create k Line dialog (shortcut L).
On a tab staff, delete the middle note and bracket the last note. Use two separate straight
lines from the Create ) Line dialog for the V (because bends would appear as arrows).
Type the number below the tab staff at the point of the V using Create h Text h Special Text ) Tablature
numbers.

215

Reference

w/bar_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _I

44

Vibrato bar scoop


A vibrato bar scoop is played by depressing the bar just before striking the note, then quickly
I * a_
releasing It.
To write this, use the symbol from the Guitar row of the Create k Symbol dialog
(shortcut Z). On a notation staff, you should also add a w/bar line from the Create ) Line
dialog (shortcut L); to extend the line rightwards, hit space.

Vibrato bar dip


A vibrato bar dip is played by striking the note, then dropping a specified number of steps,
then releasing back to the original pitch.
To notate this, use the V symbol from the Guitar row of the Create ) Symbol dialog,
typing the numbers above using Create ) Text ) Other staff text F Small text,
then, on a notation staff, add a w/bar line from the Create ) Line dialog.
Other notations
Other tab notations are easily created as follows:
Hammer-on andpull-off. use a slur - L!2 Slurs
Tapp;ng: use a slur, with a + articulation on the first note if appropriate (E!2 Articulations); for left-hand
tapping, use the CD symbol on the Techniques row of the Create ) Symbol dialog (LQ Symbols)
vibrato and wide vibrufo: suitable lines are provided near the bottom of the list in the Create F Line dialog LQ Lines
Trill. use a trill line - I!!L!I! Lines
Arpeggke: use an arpeggio line - I!!22 Lines
Tremolo pick;~g.- use a tremolo - ELI! Tremolos
Shake: use a shake symbol - L!2! Symbols
Harmonics: on notation staves, use a diamond notehead (Q.2 Noteheads), and on tab staves, write Harm.,
H.H. (for a harp harmonic), or P.H. (for a pinched harmonic) above the note in Small text
.S@: write T above the note in Small text
Pop: write P above the note in Small text
Xnofehead: select a note and choose the X notehead from the Notes panel of the Properties window
pick scrape: use an angled wiggly gliss. line from the Create ) Line dialog and write P.S. above the tab staff
with Small text; on a notation staff, use a cross notehead
Mufledsfrijngs: use cross noteheads - EL!/ Noteheads

Rake: on a notation staff, create grace notes with cross noteheads; on a tab staff, either copy the music from a
notation staff (in which case the noteheads are automatically copied as crosses) or change the noteheads after
creating the notes, and then add a suitable Rake line from the Create F Line dialog.
The Create ) Line dialog (shortcut L) contains lines for most of the common guitar techniques, such as w/bar,
P.M. (for palm muting), and so on. Should you need to create additional lines for guitar techniques, Q2 Lines.
216

Guitar tab

Tab can be fun


Oh yes, it can!
In Sibelius, guitar tab is treated as a special type of staff (rather like a percussion staff), and just as Sibelius lets you
change the number of staff lines mid-score, you can change from notation to tab mid-score, or even mid-staff - or for
that matter, change the string tunings mid-score.
Try this out: from Create ) Staff Type Change ) Tab, choose a tuning, then click in the middle of a notation
staff which has music on it. From there onwards, the notation will turn into tab, and youll find that the changeover
point is in fact an object (a bit like a clef), which shows as a blue rectangle when selected (and as a gray rectangle
when unselected if View ) Hidden Objects is switched on). Now try dragging this rectangle left and right, or up
and down from staff to staff, and youll see that Sibelius instantly converts all the following notation to tab. Most
excellent!
Banjo tablature
Although the banjo has five strings, only four are notated, so Sibelius regards it as a four-stringed instrument (the fifth
string is a drone).
Lute tablature
This works much like inputting guitar tab, except that if youre inputting or editing notes from the keyboard, note that
the keys A-G specify the pitch of the note, not the letter-name of the fret - so type 4x0 or Shift+Alt+O for Q,
6~ 1 or Shift+Alt+l for b, etc.
Sibelius doesnt handle letters beyond i correctly because Sibelius letters the fret after i as j rather than k. So to change
a note to a k (or later), type 67110 or Shift+Alt+l 0 (or later) rather than 9. This will look right but will play back
incorrectly.
Use the Lute tablature manuscript paper when you want to create lute scores:
Input all of the music on the tablature staff, using eighth note (quaver) for rhythms you want to notate with a
single tail on the stem, etc.
Triple-click the tablature staff to select it throughout
7=-click or Alt+click on the first bar of the single-line staff to copy the rhythms there
Choose File ) Plug-ins ) Notation ) Make Pitches Constant
From the single-line staff, press Delete twice on any repeated notes which you want to omit, and Delete once
on all normal rests (but theres no need to delete bar rests). Deleted rests may appear in gray but will not be
printed.
Correct the note beaming if necessary
Triple-click the rhythm staff to select it throughout
Type 6x7 or Shift+Alt+7 to make the noteheads invisible
Choose Edit ) Flip (shortcut X)
Open the Staves panel on the Properties window, and choose the No lines (hidden) staff type from the
list at the top of the panel.
217

Reference

Note that you cannot notate a backwards tail, i.e. half note (minim) - this will appear as a tailless stem, like a quarter
note (crotchet).
You can produce other lute notations and tunings, too - see below.

Customizing tab, tunings and fret instruments


There are various tab customizing options, which even let you design your own tunings and fret instruments. These
options also affect guitar frames.
In the House Style ) Edit Staff Types dialog, choose a staff type from the Tab category, then click New.
(There are also buttons for modifying and deleting existing tab types.)
On the dialog which appears, the General tab has many options, but the two relevant ones are:
l

Rhythms - switching this on adds stems, tails and beams, which are normally omitted when guitar tab is
written alongside normal notation of the same music.
Number of staff lines - controls the number of strings.

The Tab tab is reasonably self-explanatory; to set a strings tuning, select a string, then a pitch, then click Set pitch.
For further details on editing staff types, Q2 Staves.

Te

218

___ __ ____.__

--____--__-____-_I___

Help

Help
If you have problems with Sibelius, the answer is very likely to be in this User Guide - try the Index. A number of
common problems are listed in the index under help.
On-screen help
Sibelius includes an on-screen help system for answering straightforward questions: click the toolbar
button shown on the right, or choose Help k Sibelius Help (shortcut %? on Mac, Fl on Windows).
Note that the on-screen help is a useful quick reference but is not designed to be as comprehensive as
this User Guide.
The on-screen help is in PDF format, and uses the Adobe Acrobat Reader 5.0 software which you should have installed
when you installed Sibelius. (If you havent yet installed Acrobat Reader, check Installing Sibelius for
Mac/Windows in Start here.)
You can also find out what a particular button on the toolbar or keypad does by allowing the mouse pointer to hover
over it for a few moments; this will bring up a help balloon or ToolTip detailing its function. (Switch on Help )
Show Balloons to see these balloons on Mac.)
web links
The Sibelius website (www.sibelius.com) includes valuable resources to help you get the most out of Sibelius,
and you can access these easily from the Help menu:
Help Center: the Help Center of the Sibelius web site contains a database of searchable queries with answers
to frequently asked questions, a discussion forum in which you can share tips and get advice from fellow Sibelius
users, useful downloads and information about program updates
Sibeliuscom: the home page of the Sibelius web site
Sibelius.com Education Area: resources for teachers and students
SibeliusMusic.com Internet Publishing: takes you directly to SibeliusMusiccom, the self-publishing
web site where you can publish your own music securely, or browse through the thousands of scores already
published on the site - Q2 Internet publishing
PhotoScore Professional: details of the advanced version of the PhotoScore Lite scanning program Q2l Scanning
Siblings magazine: the regular on-line magazine for Sibelius users, with news, features, hints and tips for
making Sibelius even faster and easier, and more
Sibelius Teaching Tools: details of Sibelius Teaching Tools, a popular educational resource pack to help
you use Sibelius in classroom music lessons.
Technical help
If your problem isnt solved by checking this User Guide or the Sibelius website, technical help on Sibelius is available
by email, phone, fax and mail - see the enclosed Technical Help sheet for details.

219

Reference

Note that problems with using your hardware (such as computer, printer and soundcard problems) or other software
are probably covered by the equipments manuals or the dealer you bought the equipment from. We will only be able
to give general advice on these kinds of problems, and may be unable to help.
Sibelius version
If you need to find out exactly which version of Sibelius you are using, choose About Sibelius from the Apple
menu on Mac or from the Help menu on Windows,

Vie

220
I

~_ _ ~~ --------~~ ~~----- -

- --

Hiding objects

Hiding objects
It can be useful for certain objects to be present but hidden in your scores. For example, you often want cue passages
to appear in extracted parts, but these should be hidden in the full score; or you may want some music to be played
back that isnt visible in your score, such as a figured bass realization.
Sibelius allows you to hide any object, and to control whether that object should be visible in the score, or in extracted
parts, or in neither.
Hiding an object
To hide an object in your score, select it and choose one of the options in Edit ) Hide or Show, which are as
follows:
l

Hide (shortcut &%gH or Ctrl+Shift+H): hides an object in both full score and parts extracted from it
Show (shortcut 68% or Ctrl+Shift+S): unhides an object in both full score and parts extracted from it
Show in Score: shows an object in the score only
Show in Parts: shows an object only in parts extracted from the score.

The behavior of the latter two options depend on whether House Style ) Use Show in Parts is switched on or
off; this option specifies whether the file is a full score or an extracted part - but Sibelius handles this automatically, so
you dont need to worry about it (see Extracted parts below).
These options are also duplicated on the Properties window; select the object you want to hide or show and
choose the appropriate option from the drop-down menu.
what can be hidden
Any object in your score can be hidden, including notes, rests, text, time and key signatures, lines, and so on. Note that
Sibelius only hides complete objects, e.g. by default, hiding a note also hides any associated accidentals, beams, stems
and articulations, but not, say, a text object attached to that note. (The exception to this is that you can hide flags and
beams independently if necessary - LQ Beams for more details.)
For details on precisely which elements can be hidden, see the relevant topic in the Reference section, so to find
out about hiding lines, LQ lines.
Some uses for hidden objects:
l

Notes: create cue passages which are hidden and silent in the full score, but which extract into parts
(LQ Grace notes and cue notes); have improvised solos that play back but arent visible in the score.
Text: hide metronome marks or other tempo markings without them showing in the score; add technique
directions for players that arent visible in the score but are shown in extracted parts.
lines: add markings, e.g. accel./rit. lines, which play back but are hidden.

Viewing hidden objects


To be able to see hidden objects in your score, switch on View ) Hidden Objects (shortcut x%%H or
Ctrl+Ak+H); this option is switched off by default. Hidden objects will then appear in light gray in your score (but
221

Reference

they do not print - see Playing and printing hidden objects below). Hidden objects can then also be
selected and edited in exactly the same way as unhidden ones.
When View ) Hidden Objects is switched off, hidden objects in your score are completely invisible and cannot
be selected or edited individually (although they do show up if you make a passage or system selection - say, if you
type %gA or Ctrl+A to select all - and you can still move between hidden and visible objects using the arrow keys).
This option also controls whether or not various objects which are not normally notated (i.e. are not printed) are
shown. For example:
l

staff type changes (LQ Staves) are shown as a gray rectangle;


invisible barlines (LB Barlines) are shown as a gray barline;
key changes (LQ Key signatures) and transposition changes (LQ Instruments) which result in no
accidentals appearing are shown as a gray rectangle;
rests and bar rests which are hidden by the staff type, such as the guitar tab staff type Standard guitar (no
rhythms), appear in gray.

Note also that if you delete a rest it is hidden, so that it will appear in light gray if View ) Hidden Objects
(shortcut x8%H or Ctrl+Alt+H) is switched on.
Playing and printing hidden objects
By default, hidden objects dont print and do play back, regardless of whether View ) Hidden Objects is
switched on or off. You might not want certain hidden objects to play back, for example a cue passage that is hidden
in the full score but shown in extracted parts - if so, use a notehead style that is set not to play back
(LQ Noteheads).

If you want to print hidden objects, e.g. to help with proof-reading, switch on View ) Hidden Objects and then
print your score, making sure to switch on Print View menu options in the File ) Print dialog
(LQ Printing).
Extracted parts
When you extract parts from your score, the option House Style ) Use Show in Parts is switched on
automatically. When this is switched on, objects which are set to Show in Parts are shown but objects which are
set to Show in Score are hidden. When this option is switched off (i.e. when you are working on a full score), the
reverse is true.

Vie

For further discussion of t liding cue passages in scores for part extraction, EL! Grace notes and cue notes.
l

Prl

222

Highlight
Sibelius allows you to draw highlights on your music to remind you of sections you are working on, or simply to draw
attention to a particular feature of your score.
Some plug-ins (e.g. Find Motif) highlight parts of the music automatically - LQ Plug-ins.
Creating a highlight
To create a highlight in your score, either:
Choose Create b Highlight or click the Highlight button on the toolbar, then click and drag along the
passage you want to highlight; or
l

Select a passage, then choose Create b Highlight or click the Highlight button on the toolbar to create a
highlight for the duration of that passage. Note that you can only highlight a passage in a single staff, so if you
choose a passage containing multiple staves, the highlight will only appear on the top staff in the selection.
(Though you can highlight the other staves individually.)

Selecting highlights and highlighted objects


You can select, move and delete highlighted notes or other objects just the same as any other. To select the highlight
itself click its edge, so you can move, copy and delete it.
Moving a highlight
To move a highlight left or right, click on the top or bottom edge of the highlight and drag with the mouse, or
use the t/3 keys (with % or Ctrl for larger steps)
l

To adjust the length of a highlight, click on the left or right line of the box around the highlight and drag the
mouse, hit space to extend it by a note (Shift-space retracts by a note), or use the t/3 keys (with %? or
Ctrl for larger steps).

Deleting a highlight
To delete a highlight, click the edge of the highlight and hit Delete.
Viewing highlights
You can toggle whether highlights are displayed in your score by choosing View b Highlights.
Note that if you draw a highlight with View b Highlights switched off, Sibelius automatically switches it on (since
otherwise the highlight would be invisible!).
Printing highlights
You can choose whether or not to print highlights.
l

If you dont want to print them, make sure that the Print View menu options setting in the File b Print
dialog (shortcut 6t%P of Ctrl+P) is switched off when you print your score

223

Reference
l

To print highlights, switch on View b Highlights (and switch off any other View menu options which you
dont want to be printed), then print your score, making sure that the Print View menu options setting in
the File b Print dialog (shortcut %gP or Ctrl+P) is switched on.

For further information about printing, 1!!2 Printing.

224

----_- ----- -

House S!yleTM

House StyleTM
L!A Default Positions, Edit Text Styles, layout and formatting, Manuscript paper, Music
engraving, Publishing, Timecode.
Exactly how a printed score looks is defined by its house style; different publishers have their own house styles, and
Sibelius allows you to modify the house style of your scores to an almost unlimited degree. Aspects of a house style
include:
Engraving Rules options - see below
Text styles - /!!ZQ Edit Text Styles
Symbol fonts and designs - /!&I Symbols, Music fonts, Edit Symbols
Notehead designs - QJl Noteheads, Edit Noteheads
Staff type definitions - 1!22 Staves, Edit Staff Types
Line designs - QZ!I lines, Edit Lines
Note spacing rule - &! Note spacing.
Document setup (e.g. page and staff size) - /!Q2 Document Setup
Playback dictionary words - L!2 Playback dictionary
Most of the these may be edited from the House Style menu.
Engraving Rules
Sibelius incorporates numerous music engraving rules which you can customize to create your own house style, or to
make different house styles for different kinds of music. These rules are all defined in the House Style )
Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut -Q-%%E or Ctrl+Shift+E).
Engraving rules options include preferred positions for articulations, distances between notes and other objects, staff
justification, and so on.
Details of the options are scattered among relevant sections throughout this Reference section. For instance, the
options on the Bar numbers page are detailed in Bar numbers.
Check the Index under Engraving Rules for a list of page references.
Setting house styles for all your scores
The house style settings apply only to the score you are working on, so if you want to use the same settings for all
your files, you have two options:
l

Set up manuscript papers for the instrumentations you most often use, containing your preferred house style
Export your preferred house style using House Style ) Export House Style and import them into other
files.

Export House Style


You can export a house style file to disk so it can be imported into other scores:
225

Reference
l

Choose House Style ) Export House Style


Find a suitable place to save the house style, and click Save.

On Windows, house styles have the Jib file extension.

Import House Style


To import a house style file into another score:
Choose House Style ) Import House Style
Find the house style file you want to import, and click Open
Switch off any options you dont want to import, so that they dont override the existing settings. This allows you
(say) to transfer just text styles from one score to another. (Note that some options are required by others and
so cannot be independently switched off.)
If you are a music publisher, you can send house style files to all of your composers, arrangers and copyists to base
their scores on, or you can import your house style into any scores you receive from them to ensure a consistent
appearance.
A number of predefined house styles are supplied with Sibelius in the House Styles folder in the Extras folder
within your Sibelius program folder - see Predefined house styles below. Sibelius also includes a plug-in
which allows you to import a particular house style file into a folder full of files at once - ELI/ Plug-ins.
If you wish to use a particular house style by default, import it into an empty score and save it as manuscript paper IQ2 Manuscript paper.
If you import a new note spacing rule into a score, the existing spacings are unaffected. The new rule is only used
when you create more notes or use Layout ) Reset Note Spacing (shortcut &8%N or Ctrl+Shift+N). This
means that you can use different spacings for different sections of a score.

Predefined house styles


The House styles folder (within Extras in the Sibelius program folder) contains the following ready-to-use house
styles which you can import into scores to change their appearance:
Standard (English) - the style used by the blank manuscript papers; suitable for most kinds of music
Inkpen (English) - uses the Inkpen handwriting font for all music and text fonts, plus thickened note
stems, leger lines, barlines, slurs, hairpins, etc. as if drawn with an ink pen
Keyboard (English) - for keyboard music. Same as Standard but with dynamics exactly between the
hands, no instruments names, no staff justification.
Vocal (English) - for vocal and choral music. Same as Standard but with dynamics above the staff, no
system separators, centered instrument names
Jazz Opus (English) - as Standard but with winged repeat barlines and all articulations above the staff, as
used in jazz music
Jazz Inkpen (English) - as Inkpen but with winged repeat barlines and all articulations above the staff
Larger notes (English) - as Standard but with an alternative notehead shape which follows the design
recommendations of the US Music Publishers Association.

.- -_--...

_ _____~____._ _.. _ _.

House StyleTM

As these house styles have different House Style ) Engraving Rules settings (particularly the Inkpen ones),
we recommend you make a note of the Layout ) Document Setup (page size, staff size and margins) settings
of your score before importing. Then import the house style lncludijng the Engraving Rules and Document
Setup settings; this will set your score to use A4 paper and ?mm staves, so after importing, change the Layout )
Document Setup settings back to how they were previously.
When you importing a house style which alters the default position of dynamics (or various other objects), any existing
dynamics will not be repositioned unless you select them (e.g. using a filter) and choose Layout ) Reset Position
(shortcut 66t%P or Ctrl+Shift+P)
System Object Positions
In large scores, some system objects such as rehearsal marks and tempo text can appear in several positions down a
system simultaneously, e.g. at the top and above the strings in orchestral music. To edit the positions where these
objects go:
l

Choose House Style ) System Object Positions


Click the staves you want system objects to appear above - up to five in total. The top staff is compulsory.
System objects can also go below the bottom staff.

System objects dont all have to appear at all of these positions. The Vertical posn tab of House Style F Edit
Text Styles (shortcut c)~xT or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+T) lets you specify which of these positions a particular text
style will actually appear at. This allows you (for instance) to have rehearsal marks at the top, above the strings and
below the bottom staff, but tempo text at the top only. LIZ! Edit Text Styles.
You can also delete individual instances of system objects, so, for example, if a Tempo text marking appears three
times down your score, you could Delete the bottom two instances individually - note that deleting the top instance
deletes all other instances. To restore instances of system objects that you have deleted, select the first instance and
choose Layout ) Reset Design (U%D or Ctrl+Shift+D).

227

Reference

Importing graphics
This topic explains how you can add graphical elements to your scores by importing bitmap images in TIFF format into
Si belius.
If you want to turn a graphics file (e.g. a scanned image) into a score, L!2 Scanning.
If you want to turn a score into a graphics file (e.g. an EPS file) for publishing or to add music extracts to a document,
L!2 Saving graphics files.
Importing a graphic
To import a graphics file:
l

Select a note, rest, bar or other object in your score where you want the graphic to appear
Choose Create b Graphic. A dialog box appears prompting you to find the TIFF file you want to import. Once
youve found the file, click Open.
The graphic is created in the score and you can move it, copy it, and so on.
If you want to place the graphic with the mouse, ensure nothing is selected in your score before you choose
Create b Graphic; the mouse pointer will then change color to show that it is loaded with an object: click in
the score to place the graphic.

Imported graphics often look best on the screen with the paper texture set to plain white, so that the white
background around non-rectangular shapes blends in (L!2 Preferences). However graphics will print fine whatever
the screen texture is.
Weve provided a lot of useful ready-made graphics files which you can use if you cant be bothered to create your
own. They are found in the Graphic files folder inside your Scores folder, and include things like:
l

Pictures of instruments
Sibelius toolbar buttons and keypad layouts, for making your own Sibelius worksheets
Handwritten colored rings for circling important text etc. (Due to the way these are drawn they need to be
positioned with care to avoid erasing objects underneath them; they are not suitable for ringing notes as they
will erase the staff.)
Various endlessly useful and amusing graphics such as watch out! specs, hands, tick and cross, smiley face etc.

The folder also includes a Sibelius file called Graphics examples which illustrates many of the graphics.
Copying, editing and deleting graphics
Once the graphic appears in your score, you can manipulate it in much the same way as any other object in your
score:
l

copy it with x-click or Alt+click


move it by clicking on the graphic so that it is shaded blue, then drag the mouse or use the arrow keys (with #
or Ctrl for larger steps)

228

-- -----_.

--

_ _~

~~----~__

_
Importing graphics

scale it, while keeping its aspect ratio, by clicking on the small handle at the bottom right-hand corner, so that it
is surrounded by a blue box, then drag the mouse or use +/\L (with % or Ctrl for larger steps)
scale it, while altering its aspect ratio, by holding # or Ctrl before clicking on the bottom right-hand corner of
the graphic (where the handle appears); release %% or Ctrl, then drag the mouse or use /t/+ (with %% or Ctrl
for larger steps)
delete it with Delete.
To reset a graphic after manipulating it, choose Layout b Reset Design (shortcut U6t%D or Ctrl+Shift+D),
which puts the graphic back at its original size and aspect ratio.
File size
Note that importing a graphic into your score will increase its file size considerably. To keep tt ie file size as small as
possible, Sibelius compresses the TIFF file when it imports it, and if you use the same graphic multiple times in your
score, you can and should just copy it instead of importing it again.
File formats
Sibelius can import graphics files in TIFF format, at any color depth (in other words, it ca 1 be black and white,
grayscale, or full color using any number of colors).
If your graphic is not in TIFF format, you can convert it into a TIFF file using a graphics program such as Graphic
Converter for Mac (available for download from www.lemkesoft.com), Imaging for Windows (included on many
PCs in the Start b Programs b Accessories menu) and Paint Shop Pro for Windows (available for download
from www.jasc.com).

Reference

lnstruments
E! Staves.
Instruments or staves?
Creating instruments
Instrument order
Nameless staves
Deleting instruments
Changing instrument names
Format and style of names
Instrument ranges
Multiple players and divisi...

. ..easy case
. ..more complex case
Doubling instruments
New sections
Transposing instruments
Changing transpositions of transposing instruments
Defining a new instrument

Instruments or staves?
In the slightly technical meaning of instrument used in this User Guide, an instrument is one or more staves with a
single name appearing at the left. So a piano with two staves counts as one instrument because its name only appears
once, between the staves. This also means that Violin 1 counts as one instrument, even though there will typically be
many violinists. Even if the Violin l's divide onto two staves, the name Violin 1 still only appears once between them,
so its still only one instrument as far as Sibelius is concerned. Singers are also instruments. If there is a single
percussion staff, it counts as just one instrument, even though it may be used for snare drum, cymbals, tom-toms etc.
simultaneously.
Creating instruments
At any time you can create an instrument which isnt already in your score - just choose Create b Instruments
(shortcut I).
Choose the instruments you want to add by first selecting a Section at the left, then select the Instrument and
click Add to add it to the Instruments to create list. Likewise, you can remove any instrument from this list by
selecting it and clicking Remove. You can add several adjacent instruments quickly by dragging down the
Instruments list with the mouse.
When you click OK, the instruments are added to your score in the default score order (unless you specify otherwise
- see below).
The Create b Instruments dialog initially shows you a list of Common Instruments, but you can see a much
more comprehensive list by clicking AlI instruments.
Instrument order
If the Create in default order option is on when creating instruments, as it is by default, Sibelius puts newlycreated instruments into the score in the standard order (which is the order given in the Create b Instruments
dialog).
230

Instruments

If Create in default order is off, then once you have chosen an instrument to add to the score, click between two
staves in the score to show where (vertically) you want the instrument created.
Standard instrument order
There is a standard vertical order in which
instruments usually appear. Woodwind goes
at the top, folio wed by brass, percussion,
singers, keyboards and strings. Within each
section the order is standard too, as shown
on Sibeliuss Instruments dialog.
There are a few exceptions to this order:
Music where a soloist is predominant and
so goes on the top staff
l

Percussion.* the order of instruments within


the percussion section can vary from score
to score
l

Chamber music containing keyboard and


strings - the keyboard goes below the
strings, instead of above as in orchestral
music

If creating several instruments in a non-standard order, choose them within


the Instruments dialog in the order you want them in the score, from top
down. If you dont want all the new instruments to be created between the
same pair of existing instruments, create the new instruments one at a time.
If you accidentally create an instrument at the wrong place in the desired
order, choose Edit ) Undo (shortcut 6t%Z or Ctrl+Z) or delete the
instrument (see below) and create it again in a different position.
If you want to change the order of instruments once you have started writing
notes, create a new instrument in the desired place, then copy across your
music (using triple-click to select it throughout the score and x-click or Akclick to copy the music into the new instrument), then delete the original
instrument (see below).

The
default
order
in
Sibeliuss
Instruments dialog suits many but not all
styles of music so the manuscript papers
have standard orders adjusted for particular
styles.

Nameless staves
To create nameless staves, choose the Others section of the Create )
Instruments dialog, which includes [treble staffj, [bass staff], and
[small staff], which are not intended for any particular instrument.
If, however, you simply want to have no instrument names for t:he
instruments in your score, change the options on the Instruments page of
the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (see below).

Deleting instruments
To delete a single-staff instrument entirely, triple-click on a empty part of one of its staves, hit Delete, then click Yes.
If the instrument has two or more staves, you can delete them all at once by triple-clicking on the top staff, Shiftclicking on the bottom one, then hitting Delete.
Changing instrument names
You can change the name of any instrument in your score - to use a foreign language, for instance, or to name a
singing character such as Wozzeck instead of Baritone. Just click the name at the left of one of the systems, and edit it
like any other text.
Editing an instruments name doesnt in itself alter its transposition, so changing Horn in F to Horn in Eb doesnt
make it an Eb instrument. To change the transposition, see Transposing instruments below.
Each instrument has two names - the full name which is normally before the first system and the short name
(abbreviation) which is normally before subsequent systems. If you change one you should adjust the other. The
names will change throughout the score, not just on the system where you make the modification.
You can move an instrument name with the mouse, which will move all instances of the name. However, its normal
to adjust the position of instrument names by changing their alignment - see below.
231

Reference

If you dont want instrument names to be shown at all, switch them off from the House Style b Engraving
Rules dialog (see below). If you want to remove the instrument name for a single instrument, edit it and delete all
the text - note that if you subsequently want to restore the instrument name, you need to click where the name
should be, and the caret will reappear.
Format and style of names
To alter the format of instrument names, choose House Style b Engraving Rules (shortcut U%gE or
Ctrl+Shift+E) and select the Instruments page.
The various options let you choose whether to use the full name, short name or no name at the start of the score, at
subsequent systems, and at any new section (see below). Recommended settings are as follows:
For scores with lots of instruments (e.g. orchestral or band), specify full names at the start (and maybe at new
sections), and full or short names subsequently.

For scores for solo instrument and scores for a few instruments with no hidden staves, specify full names at the
start (and maybe at new sections), and no names subsequently.

For parts, scores for solo instrument, and music examples, you could specify no names throughout. In parts, by
default Sibelius puts no names next to the systems, and instead writes the instrument name at the top of the

page.
Instrument names are governed by a text style, so their font, size, etc. can be adjusted like other text styles by choosing
House Style b Edit Text Styles (shortcut bx%T or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+T). Select Instrument names from
the list on the left, and then click Edit. You can even adjust the horizontal alignment of instrument names from the
Horizontal Posn tab. For more information, LL!!l Edit Text Styles.
Instrument names are traditionally centered in a column, but this can make some names end up far from the staff
they refer to if other names on the system are much wider. So instrument names are sometimes right-aligned instead
(or very occasionally, such as in band music, they are left-aligned). Right-aligned names can look better for scores in
which there is a large variation in the width of instrument names. Sibeliuss manuscript papers are set up with sensible
instrument name settings for you, so you dont need to worry about this.
Here are some slightly unusual instrument name formats:
4 Horns

You can get this effect at the start of your score simply by double-clicking to edit it. (You might also want
to edit the short form of the name on a subsequent page.)

To achieve this, simply double-click the instrument name and hit Return (on the main keyboard)
between each name.
1
Fl .
2
232

Tri.
S.D.
B.D.

In this instance, create a single flute, then add an extra staff below (select a passage, then choose
Create b Extra Staff b Below), and then edit the instrument name: type '1. Return Return FI.
space space Return Return 2.. Note that the 1. and 2. are correctly positioned vertically but will
get slightly mispositioned if you change the gap between staves from the default.

Instruments

1
Clarinet 2

You can get this effect by creating the name in a right-justified text style with line spacing set to 50%;
type 1 Return Clarinet space space space Return 2. Note that if you set the Instrument names
text style to have line-spacing of 500/o, other instrument names that span more than one line will need
an extra Return between lines to space them correctly.

Here Violin I is the instrument name, and dir&i has simply been added by typing Expression text
in the margin. Beware that this d;GG, is attached to the first bar of the staff, so reformatting the
score might move it. For this reason, create a system break at the end of the previous system to
make sure it doesnt get displaced.

Violin I
divis i

In some choral scores, no instrument names are used anywhere except typed in capitals in
Technique text above each staff (starting over the clef) at the start of the piece, and then
wherever the singers used on the system change. This convention is often used in early music
editions and in scores where the same staves occur on most systems. Note that instrument
names for singers (e.g. Soprano, Cantus, and so on) are often written in capitals.
Instrument ranges
Sibelius can draw notes in shades of red if theyre too high or low for an instruments range (switch on View b Note
Colors b Notes out of Range, shortcut 07:N or Shift+Alt+N - L!2!l View menu). Each instrument has
two ranges: the professional range, and the comfortable range, both of which you can adjust.
The professional range, generally speaking, defines the absolute highest and lowest notes playable on a particular
instrument; notes outside this range are colored bright red. The comfortable range defines the highest and lowest
notes that a typical non-professional player routinely uses; notes outside this range but within the professional range
are colored dark red.
Of course, most instruments do not have a clearly-defined range (think of singers, for example). Commonly used
optional adaptations to instruments, such as the double bass low C string, the flute low B and piano high C (as
opposed to A) tend to be included in the professional range but not the comfortable one.
If your music includes weird instruments, or if you know that the performers are beginners or are particularly good or
have special bits stuck onto their instruments (such as the low F on a Bosendorfer piano, or the comical low A
bassoon extension), you can adjust the ranges to suit:
l

Click a bar in the instrument you want to change


Open the Staves panel of the Properties window
Adjust the top/bottom pitches using the drop-down menus at the bottom of the panel. (C4 = middle C.)

Multiple players and divisi...


Wind instruments frequently use two or more numbered players, e.g. Trumpets I, 2 and 3. Strings often divide onto
two staves (divisi) or sometimes onto several staves numbered by string desks, Choral staves frequently divide onto
two staves (semichorus or Dee and Can). There are two ways to handle these situations, depending on the case:

233

Reference

. ..eas y case
If your score is consistent throughout as to which players use which staves, then theres no problem. For instance, if all
three trumpets in a score are always on the same staff, just create a single Trumpet instrument and rename it (say)
Trumpets 1.2.3 at the start.
Similarly, if trumpets 1+2 are always together on one staff and trumpet 3 always has a separate one, just create two
separately-named instruments (called Trumpet 1.2' and Trumpet 37, or else create a single instrument (Trumpets)
and add a second staff to it.

. ..more complex case


Complications only arise if players hop around from staff to staff mid-score, because then youll want to change the
names at the left-hand side mid-score.
For instance, all three trumpets may play in unison on a single Trumpets 1.2.3 staff in some places, they may divide
onto two staves (Trumpets 1.2' and Trumpet 3) elsewhere, and in complex passages they may even split onto three
separate staves.
Because the name at the left-hand side will need to change mid-score, you should create a separate Trumpet
instrument for every djfferenf name that you want fo use - so in a complex score for three trumpets you might create
five instruments called Trumpets 1.2.3, Trumpets 1.2, Trumpet 1, Trumpet 2 and Trumpet 3. Then simply write the
music on the appropriate staff, and hide the spare staves when not in use (L!2 Staves).
Indicate where the staves divide or join, or where the players change, using the Technique text style to write (e.g.) '1.2'
or a 2 or div. or unis.
Indicating doubling
instruments
When writing for doubling instruments,
ensure that the player has sufficient
time to change instrument. During the
bars rest preceding the change, write
Change to [instrument] or Muta in
[instrument] above or below the staff
as soon as the first instrument stops
playing.
If you need to insert a transposition
change because the new instrument
transposes differently, the key change
should be indicated at the beginning
of the bar where the new instrument
starts playing.
The new instrument is often indicated
above the staff as it starts playing.

Where the number of staves changes, you should put a system break,
otherwise you will find partially-used staves appearing, which looks odd.
If you want to extract parts for separate players, L!Jl Extracting parts.

Doubling instruments
Doubling instruments are two or more instruments played by the same
person. Typical kinds of doubling are:
l

Triangle, Snare drum and Bass drum (or other percussion)


Flute and Piccolo (or, frequently, Flute 3 and Piccolo)
Clarinet in A and Clarinet in Bb.

For the first case, you could just use a blanket name like Percussion, or you
could set the instrument name to read Triangle, Snare drum and Bass drum on
three separate lines by hitting Return (on the main keyboard) in between.
However, if you want to be fancier and vary the name at the left-hand side
depending on which percussion instruments are playing at the time, treat this
case like multiple players (see above).

The second case requires two separate Sibelius instruments because two different names appear at different points in
the score. Again, treat this just like multiple players (see above).
234

--- -.Instruments

The third case can be done with an instrument called Clarinet or Clarinets, with a transposition change created
where it changes from A to Bb (LQ Transposing).
New sections
Scores which include several pieces, songs or movements can be regarded as having several sections, each starting
with a new title. At new sections you often write full instrument names, even if short names or no names are used
elsewhere.
To do this:
l

Select the final barline of the preceding section


Choose Properties from the Window menu to get its Properties dialog, then switch on Section end,
then click OK
On the House Style b Engraving Rules dialog, Instruments page, set the behavior of names At new
sections to Full (or maybe Short).

For more information on scores with multiple sections, LQ Files.


Transposing instruments
Sibelius takes care of all the complications surrounding transposing instruments for you:
You can input music either at transposed pitch or at sounding (concert) pitch. To switch instantly between the
two representations at any time, simply choose Notes b Transposing Score (shortcut U%%T or
Ctrl+Shift+T).
When copying music between transposing instruments, Sibelius automatically transposes the music as necessary
so that it always sounds the same. This saves big headaches when copying (say) from Clarinet in A to Horn in F.
When you extract a part for a transposing instrument from a sounding pitch score, you dont even need to think
about transposing the part - Sibelius does it for you automatically.
You can input music from a MIDI keyboard either by playing how it sounds or how its written - e.g. you can
play transposed parts into Sibelius to produce a combined sounding pitch score. Just switch on Record
transposing pitches in File b Preferences b General
Sibelius even lets instruments change transposition mid-score; see below.
Changing transpositions of transposing instruments
You can either create a transposition change at the start of the score to set that instruments key throughout, or you
can change transposition mid-score - useful for doubling instruments such as Clarinet in A/Bb, Tenor/Alto Sax or (if
you live in the nineteenth century) Horn with crooks.
To create a transposition change:
l

Choose Create b Transposition Change


In part or transposing score specifies the transposition, by saying how written notes sound. For instance,
if you are changing to a Clarinet in A, set this to A in octave 3, because written middle C on Clarinet in A sounds
as the A below middle C. Middle C = C4.

235

Reference
l

In non-transposing score: here we descend into profound subtleties which you will almost certainly never
need to understand, so please feel free to leave this option well alone and skip to the next bit.
This option is required only for instruments such as piccolo, double bass and tenor voice which are customarily
notated an octave out even in non-transposing scores. The option lets you specify which octave such an
instrument sounds in. As all such instruments are pre-defined for you, you neednt use or even think about this
option under any normal circumstances.
However (takes big breath): if you do use this option (say, when designing a new instrument), and if you want
to give that instrument a clef with a little 8 or 15 on, bear in mind that Sibelius deliberately ignores the little 8 or
15 because it is optional, and instead takes its information about which octave the instrument plays in from this
dialog instead. This is because the octave transposition is a property of the jnsfrument (e.g. the piccolo), not of
the clef.
Warn;ng: use of this option carries a high risk of brain damage.

Click OK, then click in the score where you want to change transposition - either at the start or mid-score. If
mid-score, dont forget to herald the transposition change to the player with a message such as change to
Clarinet in A, preferably with a moment or two of advance warning.

If you change transposition mid-score in a transposing score, a little key change typically appears at the changeover
point. If the transposition change produces no key change (e.g. if you change transposition by an octave), it is
invisible, but appears as a gray rectangle if View ) Hidden Objects is switched on (shortcut x~%H or
Ctrl+Ak+H). You can drag either the key change or the gray rectangle around like a clef to see the same music
viewed through the wonky glasses of different transpositions.
Defining a new instrument
You may sometimes need to create a new instrument which isnt listed in the Create ) Instruments dialog. To do
this:
l

Choose a similar predefined instrument from the Create ) Instruments dialog, and create it in your score;
you may need to switch off Create in default order if you want the new instrument to go in a particular
place in the instrument order
Select the instrument name to the left of the staff and hit Return (on the main keyboard) to edit it. To change
the short form of the instrument name, create enough bars so that Sibelius adds another page, and then edit the
short name in the same way.
If you want to redefine the range of the new instrument, select one of its bars and open the Staves panel of the
Properties window, from which you can change the lowest and highest notes playable by the instrument
You may need to change the instruments transposition: use Create ) Transposition change to do this see Changing transpositions of transposing instruments above
To change the instruments sound for playback, use the Play ) Mixer dialog - LQ Mixer
To change the instruments clef, use Create ) Clef - l!LL!!l Clefs
To alter whether the instrument is joined to others by barlines, LL3 Barlines.
To alter the bracketing of the instrument, EL!! Brackets and braces.

236
- --

mInstruments

If you frequently use unusual instruments, its useful to save them on manuscript paper so you can reuse them.
L!2l Manuscript paper.

--

237

Reference

Internet publishing

LQ Publishing.
The Internet is the ideal medium for reaching a worldwide audience for your music, at minimal cost. Sibelius is
only music notation program with the Sibelius Scorch plug-in, which lets anyone view, play back, transpose, and I:
Sibelius scores on the Internet.
You can either publish your music on your own web site, or publish it directly at the click of a button on our web
SibeliusMusic.com, where you can even sell your music.
Scorch
Sibelius Scorch is the amazing free web browser plug-in that allows anyone to view, play back, change key
instruments, and even print scores directly from the Internet, whether or not they have Sibelius. Sibelius scores car
viewed, transposed and played from web browsers on both Windows and Mac.
People visiting your site can download Scorch by following a link (to a download page in Sibeliuss web site) whit
automatically included on your web page.
For details of how to install Scorch, see Installing Sibelius in the Start here section at the beginning of
User Guide.
You can use Scorch to view, play and print music from major web sites such as www.sheetmusicdirect.a
(rock/pop songs) and www.boosey.com (classical/educational music).

The Scorch toolbar


Playback controls and tempo slider (Windows only).
Click Play (or type P) to start playback, or click anywhere on
the score to start playback from that point.

Turn pages

Choose which sound

( 3vice you use for playback

Change key*

Save the score


to disk*

Print the scar

Scorch informa
and update!

PubI
* option not available on all scores

238

Inter-net publishing

Recommended settings
To make your score look and sound as good as possible when other people look at your music, you should
standardize before you publish:
l

Fonts - not all fonts can be assumed to be available on all computers


Page size - the score must print acceptably on various kinds of paper
%yback - the score must make minimal assumptions about the computers sound capabilities.

Limit the fonts used for text in the score to common ones, such as Times, Times New Roman, Aria1 and Helvetica
(although Scorch will substitute the nearest equivalent fonts if the person viewing your web page doesnt have the
fonts you have used). Also ensure that the only music fonts you use are Sibeliuss standard Opus and Inkpen fonts,
since these will be available on every computer with Scorch installed.
Optimize your score for playback using the General MIDI sound set (via the Play b Devices dialog - El/l MIDI
When preparing your scores for publishing on SibeliusMusic.com, where they can be printed, use portrait format and
preferably a standard page size (e.g. Letter, Tabloid, A4 or A3). Scorch will scale the music to fit on the printers page
size.

When preparing scores for publishing on your own web site, where you have greater control over how your score will
appear, you might also consider changing the page and staff size of your score to ensure it is as legible as possible.
For portrait format scores for small ensembles, try setting your page size so that only one system fits on each page;
this means that visitors to your web site wont have to scroll up and down the page to see each system of your music.
You should also bear in mind that a score which sounds good on your own soundcard or MIDI devices may not
sound good on different computers with different setups.
So remember these tips for ensuring that your scores sound as good as possible on a wide range of MIDI setups:
l

Only use General MIDI sounds in your score (use the General MIDI sound set - IQ2 MIDI devices).
If your score includes a vocal staff, choose a suitable sound; the General MIDI defaults (Voice Oohs or Choir
Aahs) are poor on most soundcards. We strongly recommend you use the following instead: Flute or Clarinet for
music in the treble register (above middle C, say), and Clarinet for music in the tenor/bass register, since many
soundcards cant play Flute sounds this low.
(Brass, other woodwind, string and organ sounds are unsuitable or poor on many soundcards and so are not
recommended to represent vocal music, even if they sound good on your own MIDI devices. Piano, guitar etc.
are also unsuitable as they do not sustain notes.)

Publishing on SibeliusMusic.com
Composers, arrangers, teachers and anyone else can publish on our self-publishing web site
SibeliusMusic.com - from coursework to orchestral scores, from early music to avant garde and
rock/pop.
Its entirely free to publish scores, plus you can make money from it - if you want to sell your music (rather than
provide it for free) youll be paid a generous 50% of the price!

239

Reference

To get started, open the Sibelius file you would like to publish online, and click the Publish button on the Sibelius
toolbar, shown above (or choose File ) Publish on SibeliusMusic.com).
l

If you havent saved the file recently, you will be prompted to do so first; save it, then click Publish again
Your web browser will open and display a web page for you to specify basic information about your score, such
as its title (this is automatically filled in for you if you have previously filled in the File ) Score Info dialog)
Find on your hard drive the score you wish to publish online - click Browse to find your score
When you have found the score, click Next. Your computer will then connect to the Internet and upload your
score to SibeliusMusic.com
You will be asked to provide further information about yourself and your score - simply follow the instructions
on the screen.

Note that SibeliusMusic.com will only publish music to which you hold the sole music copyright, i.e. original
compositions or arrangements of out-of-copyright music. You are not permitted to publish transcriptions or
arrangements of copyright music, verbatim transcriptions or editions of out-of-copyright music, or scores containing
copyright lyrics that are used without permission. For further details about the copyright restrictions on scores you can
publish, please visit www.sibeliusmusic.com.
If you experience any problems or have any queries about self-publishing on SibeliusMusic.com, please email
info@sibeliusmusic.com.

I
Prr

Publishing on your own web site


If you would prefer to publish your music on your own web site, Sibelius makes this just as easy:
l

First, choose File ) Score Info, click the Composer/Title tab, and enter some information about your
piece - the web page you are about to generate assumes youve filled in the Title and Composer fields so
that it can include them in the web page
Choose File ) Save As (shortcut UXS or Shift+Alt+S)
Set Save as type to Scorch web page, and enter a filename. Sibelius removes any spaces from the
filenames of both the Sibelius (.sib) and HTML (.htm) files and shortens the name to 27 characters plus a 3
character extension to make them safe for all web servers.
If you havent entered anything in the File ) Score Info dialog, you will be warned, for example, that the
Title and Composer fields are blank (this information is used in the standard web template)
You are asked to choose a template web page to insert the score into - you may like to design your own (see
below). You can also adjust the width and height of the score as it will appear within the web page. If you dont
feel ambitious, just leave the default settings and click OK.

SC0
\1
tl
a
F
C
If
0

240

Internet publishing

Setting a larger Width makes the page and hence the music bigger; theres no need to enter a Height value
if you want the page to be the same shape, which is advisable.
You should ensure that Width is set to at least 500 pixels if Scorch printing and saving is switched off, and at
least 570 pixels if it is switched on, in order to fit the Scorch toolbar buttons on the web page.
The Snap Zoom Level option (switched on by default) automatically adjusts the size of the score to ensure
that the staff lines always appear equidistant. Leave this option switched on.
Allow printing & saving, as the name suggests, allows you to choose whether visitors to your web site can
print and save your music, or simply play it back - see Printing from Scorch below.
Sibelius then saves two files in the chosen location: an HTML file (with the file extension .htm), and a Sibelius
score (with the extension sib).
Youre now ready to upload these two files to your web site. Depending on how your web site is hosted, you may
need to use an FTP client or upload them via your web browser.
You must include bofh the actual Sibelius score file and the web page ln fhe Same folder on your web site - the HTML
in the web page refers to the Sibelius file.
Printing from Scorch
If you switch on the Allow printing and saving option when saving your score as a Scorch web page, visitors to
your site will be allowed to print your score to their computers printer, and also save the score as a Sibelius file to
their hard disk so that they can open it in Sibelius themselves.
This makes it easy to share your music with others: teachers can put worksheets on their school web site, and students
can print them out directly from their web browser, or, if they have Sibelius themselves, download the music to their
computer and complete the worksheet in Sibelius.
Note that the Allow printing and saving option does not have some of the benefits of publishing your music on
SibeliusMusic.com:
l

You are not permitted to put Scorch to commercial use on your own web site without a special license from us i.e. you may not charge money for allowing visitors to your site to print and save your music.
Music on your own web site is not securely encrypted, so any visitors who use Sibelius themselves can
download your music to their computers simply by clicking the Save button in Scorch, and they will then be
able to edit it in Sibelius.

Score information
You can include catalog information such as the composer, title and so on in your web site. All you have to do is type
the details into the File b Score Info dialog; then when you save a web page, Sibelius can include this information
automatically as HTML tags, as well as putting the main information as text in the web page.
First you have to design a template web page that displays the kind of catalog information you want to include (see
Customizing your web site below).
If you have a knack for programming, you can write a program to create an on-line catalog (or even a search engine)
of the scores on your website automatically from these tags, with links to the scores.
241

Reference

Customizing your web site


If you dont want to use Sibeliuss provided web page templates, or would like to improve them, you will need a very
basic knowledge of HTML (or an HTML-speaking friend).
The web page produced by Sibelius is very straightforward, and you can make any changes you like to it - you may
want to add your own background or graphics, further information, links, or whatever.
You can design your own template web pages and save them with a .htm extension in the Manuscript paper
folder inside your Sibelius folder. They will then appear in the list of web page templates.
A web page template is a standard HTML file with some special tags where the filename and image size are inserted
when you save as a Scorch web page. There are also optional tags which are replaced by the Title, Composer etc.
fields from the File b Score Info dialog. The full list of tags (not all used in the sample templates) is:
$FILENAME$

Filename + extension of the Sibelius file

$PATHNAME$

Path of the Sibelius file

$WIDTH$,
$HEIGHT$

From Save as Scorch web page dialog

$TITLE$, $COMPOSER$,
$ARRANGER$, $LYRICIST$,
$ARTIST$, $MOREINFO$

From File b Score Info dialog

See the web page templates provided for examples of how to use these tags.
The only required element is the <EMBED> tag, which should look something like this:
<EMBED src=fi/ename.sib width=? height=y type=application/x-sibelius-score
pluginspage=http://www.sibelius.com/cgi/plugin.pl>
where fi/ename.sib is the path to the Sibelius file, x is the width of the Scorch window in pixels, and y is the height of
the Scorch window in pixels. You can get these filled in automatically when you use File b Save as b Scorch web
page in Sibelius if you set them in your web page template to !&FILENAME& $WIDTH$ and $HEIGHT$
respectively.
Dont change the type or pluginspage attributes, as these tell the browser about Scorch and where to get it if it
hasnt been installed yet.
Problems and solutions
Some web servers may not display Scorch web pages, in which case you may be warned by your browser that a
suitable plug-in could not be found. This is because the server doesnt recognize Sibeliuss .sib file extension.
Although you could change the .sib extension to .bin, we dont generally recommend this as the .bin extension
may cause problems on Mats (it normally means MacBinary compressed files).
Instead, if there are problems viewing scores on your website, copy the htaccess file from Sibeliuss Resources
folder to each folder on your website which contains .sib files. Then rename it to .htaccess (which is not a legal
242

Internet publishing

Mac or Windows filename), or if there is a .htaccess file there already, add the contents of htaccess to the end of
it. This should make the server deal with .sib files correctly.
Using CD-ROM and floppy disk
You can equally well use Sibeliuss Internet publishing facility to promote your music via CD-ROM or floppy disk.
Simply save your website to disk - other people can then access it from disk in exactly the same way as over the
Internet.
Note, however, that people will still need to download Scorch from the Internet, which they can do just by following
the link in any Scorch web page on the disk. You are not allowed to distribute Scorch yourself (see Legal notice
below).
Security
One factor to consider when deciding how to publish your music on the Internet is security.
When you view something in your web browser - whether it is text, graphics, or even a Sibelius score using the Scorch
plug-in - it has been downloaded to your computers temporary Internet files folder on your hard disk. This means
that anybody who views your music on your personal web page will potentially be able to edit the original file (if they
have Sibelius). This is of course particularly easy if you enable online saving and printing of your score.
In other words, if you publish your music on your own web site, you wil I be doing so in a totally insecure way.
However, if you publish your music on Sibel usMusic.com, your music is secu re.
SibeliusMusic.com uses an encrypted file format understood only by the Scorch plug-in - this means that even if
somebody were to find the file on their hard disk, they couldnt open it with any program apart from Scorch (not even
Sibelius). This also ensures that even if somebody looks at an encrypted Sibelius file in Scorch, they cant print it out,
because printing from Scorch relies on communication between Scorch and SibeliusMusic.com.
If you want to publish securely on your own web site, contact Sibelius Software about licensing Sibelius Internet
Edition, a special version of Sibelius for commercial Internet publishing.
legal notice
It is illegal to place copyright music on the Internet without permission from the copyright owner. This is usually the
case even if you have made your own arrangement of a copyright piece of music.
Sibeliuss Internet publishing facility is licensed to you for non-commercial use only. (See the Sibelius license
agreement for details.)
You are not allowed to distribute Scorch, e.g. to put it on your own website - peo ple visiting your site must follow the
link supplied in order to download Scorch. Licensing conditions for the plug-in are shown when you install it.

243

Reference

Keyboard shortcuts
Nearly every function of Sibelius can be performed using just the keyboard. Once youve learned the keyboard
shortcuts for the functions you use most often, youll find using Sibelius much quicker and easier.
You can find the shortcuts in Sibeliuss menus; theyre referred to in the User Guide each time we mention a function
that has a shortcut; theres a comprehensive list of shortcuts on the next few pages; and the essential shortcuts are
also listed on the mouse pad you received with Sibelius.
You can even customize most of the keyboard shortcuts if you want - see below.
Shortcut patterns
Here are some general patterns to shortcuts which make them easier to remember:
l

Standard operations common to all programs (e.g. New, Copy, Print, Find, Save, Undo) use standard
shortcuts, which are mostly # or Ctrl plus the initial letter of the operation (the notable exception being
Undo, which is %?Z or Ctrl+Z)
Most Create menu shortcuts (other than text) are a single letter, usually the initial letter (e.g. L for Line, I for
Instruments).
Create b Text menu shortcuts are ,% or Ctrl or XX or Ctrl+Alt plus the initial letter (e.g. 6t%E or Ctrl+E
for Expression, ~6t%T or Ctrl+Alt+T for Tempo)

Play menu shortcuts are a single key (e.g. P, Esc) or Shift-letter (e.g. Shift-P for Play b Performance)
Most Notes, Layout and House Style menu shortcuts are 6% or Ctrl+Shift plus the initial letter. For
Layout b Reset.. . options they use the initial letter of the thing to be reset (e.g. 48%P or Ctrl+Shift+P for
Reset Position)
%f or Ctrl with the arrow keys or Home/End/Page Up/Page Down means large steps, e.g. with a note
selected, 8%/f or Ctrl++ transposes by an octave; with a bar selected, 6~x3 or Ctrl+Shift+Alt++
increases note spacing by a large amount
Shift with arrows or mouse click means extend selection, e.g. with a bar selected, Shift-+ extends the
selection to the staff above.

Mac/Windows differences
Sibelius and the keyboard shortcuts are virtually identical on Mac and Windows. The Command key (8%) on Mac
keyboards is equivalent to the Ctrl key on Windows keyboards, and the Option key (x) on Mac is equivalent to
the Alt key on Windows. As a result, almost all shortcuts are interchangeable as long as, for example, X is substituted
for Ctrl as appropriate. There are a few exceptions, but these are clearly explained where appropriate.
Likewise, the Macs mouse normally only has one button, so Mac users must use Control-click to access the contextsensitive menus, while Windows users use right-click.

244

Re 4.

Keyboard shortcuts

Accessing keypad functions on a laptop


Most laptop computers do not have separate keypads. Keypad functions can be accessed on
many laptops by holding down a key marked Fn and other keys on the keyboard. Sibelius also
has some alternative shortcuts built in: hold down x (Mac) or Ctrl+Ak (Windows) in
conjunction with the keys shown in the diagram on the left,
Note that not all keypad buttons have alternative shortcuts; for those you will need to use the Fn
key (if available) or click the keypad on the screen using your mouse.
Customizing keyboard shortcuts
You can customize the existing shortcuts in Sibelius to your own preference. For instance, if you use lots of triplets and
find x3 or Ctrl+3 a pain to type, you could assign a single key, such as just W. To do this:
l

Choose File ) Preferences ) Keyboard Shortcuts and click New to create a new shortcut
Choose Triplet from the Function list
Click in the Key box and type your own key - in this case, just W.
You can type a single key or a combination (such as -c#U or Ctrl+Ak+U), but single key shortcuts will
reduce your stress levels enormously.

If the shortcut you choose is already used by another function, Sibelius will ask if you want to override it
When you have defined your new shortcut, click the OK button - dont hit Return (on the main keyboard), as
this might cause your new shortcut to be assigned to the Return key!
You can use the Edit and Delete buttons to alter existing shortcuts. You can also use New to assign more
than one shortcut to the same function; this is useful if you want to add a new shortcut but keep the old one as
well, to avoid confusing other people who use your computer.

Here are a few things to bear in mind when customizing shortcuts:


l

You can theoretically reassign keys on the keypad (this could be useful for emulating other music programs), but
the keypad on the screen wont magically rearrange itself to show this: if you make 3 on the keypad the shortcut
for a triplet, you dont get a little triplet drawn there
You should not reassign the space bar to any other function in Sibelius
On Mac, you cant assign the following combinations, since they are intercepted by the operating system:
Ust%O-9, Fl-12,B%H,x%T
On Windows, the main keys that cannot be assigned are Ak+F, Ak+E, Ak+V, Alt+C, Ak+P, Ak+N, Ak+L,
Ak+S, Ak+W, Ak+H - these are the shortcuts for each of Sibeliuss menus.

To customize shortcuts for items in word menus, or to find out how to enter other special characters (such as
accented letters), LLJ Text.
tRestoring default keyboard shortcuts
To restore keyboard shortcuts to their default settings, choose File ) Preferences ) Keyboard Shortcuts, and
click the Reset button. You will be asked if you really want to reset them; if youre sure, click Yes.
Note that this will also remove any new keyboard shortcuts you have defined yourself.
245

Reference
Description/menu item

Mac shortcut

Fl

Sibelius Help

New

B%N

Ctrl+N

Open

Ctrl+O

Close

Ctrl+W

Save

%gS

Ctrl+S

Print

Ctrl+P

Extract Parts

Ctrl+Shift+X

Quit/Exit

Alt+F4

>. - (on/of?)
1 Rhythm dot

l/2/3/4/5/6 (on keypad) or


YZ/X/C/A/S/D

l/2/3/4/5/6 (on keypad)or


Ctrl+Alt+Z/X/C/A/S/D

7/8/9 (on keypad) or xQ/W/E

7/8/9 (on keypad) or


Ctrl+Alt+Q/W/E

=I*

/ *_

) . (period)

1 . (period)

Create note

A/B/C/D/E/F/G or play note/chord


on MIDI keyboard

A/B/C/D/E/F/G or play note/chord


on MIDI keyboard

Create rest

space

space

Add Interval above

246

windows shortcut

1 /ww/6/v8/9

1/2/wwv8/9

(on main keyboard)

(on main keyboard)

Add Interval below

c)-- l/2/3/4/5/6/7/8/9
(on main keyboard)

Shift+ l/2/3/4/5/6/7/8/9
(on main keyboard)

Add Pitch above

4-A-G

Shift+A-G

Tie (on/off)

Enter (on keypad)

Enter (on keypad)

Start a new voice

V x l/2/3/4

V Alt+ l/2/3/4

Flexi-time

4%gF

Ctrl+Shift+F

Stop Flexi-time

Esc / #.

Esc

Flexi-time Options

4Y8gO

Ctrl+Shift+O

Edit pitch

A/B/C/D/E/F/G or play note/chord


on MIDI keyboard

A/B/C/D/E/F/G or play note/chord


on MIDI keyboard

Keyboard shortcuts
Description/menu item
Edit note value: j / P / b / J / d

( Windows shortcut

( Mac shortcut

/o

l/2/3/4/5/6 (on keypad) or


xZ/X/C/A/S/D

l/2/3/4/5/6 (on keypad) or


Ctrl+Alt+Z/X/C/A/S/D

Edit accidental: 4 / # / b (on/off)

7/8/9 (on keypad) or xQ/W/E

7/8/9 (on keypad) or


Ctrl+Alt+Q/W/E

Edit articulation(s): >

=/

/ *_

Turn into rest(s)

Delete or Backspace

Delete or Backspace

Turn into individual rest(s)

0 on first keypad layout

0 on first keypad layout

Respell Accidental

Return (on main keyboard)

Return (on main keyboard)

Cross-staff notes F Move up/down a staff

o%g+/+

Ctrl+Shift+/t\/+

Standard notehead

0~0 (on main keyboard)

Shift+Alt+O (on main keyboard)

Change notehead

0-c O/ l/2/3.

S h ift+Alt+O/ l/2/3
(or two digits)

. - (on/off)

. . (or two digits)

Swap voices I and 2

Shift+V

Transpose

S hift+T

Arrange

Ctrl+Shift+V

Create menu

Control-click
(with nothing selected)

...

Shift+Fl 0 / right-click
(with nothing selected)

I Ctrl+B

Bar at end
Single bar (in mid-score)

GBgB

Ctrl+Shift+B

Other bar (multiple/irregular)

7:B

Alt+B

Guitar frame

Instruments

Key signature

Line

Slur/flipped slur

S/M (then space to extend)

S/Shift+S (then space to extend)

Crescendo/diminuendo hairpin

H/OH (then space to extend)

H/Shift+H
(then space to extend)

Rehearsal mark

%gR

Ctrl+R

Symbol

Time signature

Triplet

8%3 (on main keyboard)

Ctrl+3 (on main keyboard)

Tuplet

X2-9

Ctrl+2-9

247

Reference

l%scr@ion/menu item

Mac shortcut

Windows shortcut

Chord symbol

B%K

Ctrl+K

BgE

Ctrl+E

XL

Ctrl+L

I
Lyrics
Lyrics verse 2
Metronome mark
Technique

Ctrl+T

Tempo

Ctrl+Alt+T

Start editing

Return (on main keyboard) /


double-click

Return (on main keyboard) / F2 /


double-click

Stop editing

Esc

Esc

8%.

1 Move left/right a character

I t+
/

Move left/right a word

none

Ctrl+t/+

Move to start/end of line

none

Home/End

Move to start/end of text

none

Select word

double-click

Select next/previous character

0t/+

Select to end/beginning of word

none

Select to end/beginning of text

none

Select All text

B%A

Ctrl+A

Delete previous/next character

Backspace

Backspace/Delete

Delete previous/next word

none

Replace selected text

type new text

New line

Return / Enter

Return / Enter

#B/l/U

Ctrl+B/l/U

Advance to next note/beat (lyrics/chord symbols/figured


bass/fingering)

space

space

Hyphens to next note (lyrics)

- (hyphen)

Elision (lyrics)

- (underscore)

Non-breaking space/hyphen (lyrics/chord symbols)

X-space/hyphen

Word menu

Control-click

f/m/p/ r/ s/z(Expression)

#F/M/R/R/S, 4#z

Bold/italic/underline

248

XBgM

on/off

Keyboard shortcuts
llescr& tion/menu item
crest. / dim. (Expression)

( mc shortcut
0%/D
8% l/2/3.. . (on keypad)

a/e/i/b/b

91
Ctrl+

1 /z/3.. . (on keypad)

~~

xl followed by letter (e.g. xl A)


x followed by letter
YU followed by letter

1 Alt+number from Character Map

i/@/i/s/a

XI followed by letter

Alt+number from Character Map

Other special characters

use Key Caps utility

/ (smart quotes)
/ (smart single quotes)
0

Alt+ / Shift+Alt+
Ctrl+Shift+C

4GiZC

x (in Lyricist/Title/Copyright text)

-1

Ctrl+Shift+P

% (in Tempo text)

0x4

Ctrl+Shift+4

$ (in Tempo text)

X0 (zero)

Ctrl+O (zero)

- / - (in metric modulations)

WI

Ctrl+[ /

Harp pedal diagrams (Technique text)

xX7/8/9/+ (on keypad)

Ctrl+Alt+7/8/9/+ (on keypad)

% (chord symbols)

0 5

Shift+5

O/O / A (chord symbols)

%%0/0B%O/Q6

Ctrl+O / Ctrl+Shift+O /
Shift+6

add / Ornit (chord symbols)

GB%A / x8%0

Ctrl+Shift+A / Ctrl+Alt+O

( ) (for stackable alterations in chord symbols)

[I

rl

Create notes

see Creating notes above

Change fret

0~ O/

1 y1/2/3...

Move up/down a string

l/2/3. . . (or two digits)

see Creating notes above

Move to top/bottom string

x/l\/+

Bend

J (then space to extend)

Pre-bend / slide / bracket notehead

./I 1
on second keypad layout

-1-P

= (on main keyboard)

= (on main keyboard)

Quarter-tone sharp

on second keypad layout

249

Rofnrnnrn

Uescr@ion/menu item

Mac shmcut

Windows shortcut

Play or Pause

Rewind/fast-forward

+I+

t/-,

stop

Esc / #.

Esc

Mixer (show/hide)

I M

Performance

Shift+P

Undo

Ctrl+Z

Redo

I M

( B%Y

Undo History

4GKZ

I Ctrl+Y

Ctrl+Shift+Y

cut

Ctrl+X

COPY

Ctrl+C

~~

Copy to where you click


Paste

y-click

1 Delete/Clear

Alt+click

I Ctrl-4
R

Repeat (note/chord/passage/text/line/etc.)

1 Backspace (t)

) Backspace or Delete

Put into voice 1/2/3/4/ail voices

x l/2/3/4/5 (on main


keyboard)

Alt+ l/2/3/4/5 (on main


keyboard)

Hide

Ctrl+Shift+H

show

Ctrl+Shift+S

Select next/previous object


1 Select previous/next note/chord/rest

Tab

Tab

Tab/&Tab

Tab/Shift+Tab

I t+

I t+

Ctrl+t/+

Select start of previous/next bar


Select end/mid-point/whole of line

Flip (stem, slur, tuplet, tie, etc.)

Select first object on page (if nothing selected)

Ctrl+Shift+Z

Redo History

I------

Xt/+

Alt+t/+

Select note/rest above/below (in chord or adjacent staff)


Move score

drag navigator/paper

drag navigator/paper

Co up/down a screenful

1 $&or Page Up/Down

I
/ Page Up/Down

Co left/right a screenful

1 K/Y (4NT) or H o m e / E n d

) Home/End

I
I

Keyboard shortcuts
Description/menu item

Mac shortcut

Windows shortcut

Go to top/bottom of page

4%$/z or #-Page Up/Down

Ctrl+Page Up/Down

Go to first/last page

%&%I (6~) or x-Home/End

Ctrl+Home/End

Go to Bar

-c4X

Ctrl+Alt+G

Go to Page

Cr%%G

Ctrl+Shift+G

Zoom in/out

#=/- (or click/x-click with zoom


tool; o holds tool)

Ctrl+=/- (or click/right-click with


zoom tool; Shift holds tool)

Move object(s) (in larger steps; 1 space by default)

WI+/+ (~W/+/+)

W/t/-) (CtrI+/f4/+/+/+)

Move staff/staves up/down


(in larger steps; I space by default)

x+/+ (a%-\:+/\L) or drag

AIt++/&
or drag

Move staff/staves up/down independently


(in larger steps; 1 space by default)

4X/T\/& (a%4%1\/\L)
or a-drag

Shift+Alt++/\l
(Ctrl+Shift+Alt++/\L)
or Shift+drag

Move note/rest/end of tie

(Ctrl+Alt++/\L)

Shift+Alt+t/+

Select all bars in staff (on one system)

double-click staff

double-click staff

Select all bars in all staves (on one system)

%g-double-click staff

Ctrl+double-click staff

Select all bars in staff throughout score

triple-click staff

triple-click staff

Select System Passage

GXA

Shift+Alt+A

Extend passage to object

b-click

Shift+click

Extend passage by a note/rest

4X/+

Shift++/+

Extend passage by a bar

4GXt/+

Ctrl+Shift+t/+

Extend passage by a staff

NV+

Shift++/+

Select All of score

#A

Ctrl+A

Select all noteheads in chord (Select More)

&%A or double-click

Ctrl+Shift+A or double-click

Select all text on staff in same style (Select More)

Og%A

Ctrl+Shift+A

Select objects with marquee

#-drag on paper

Ctrl+drag on paper

Add/remove object to/from selection

8%-click

Ctrl+click

Select None

Esc /8%.

Esc

Reference
Descriptiun/menu item

Muc shortcut

Windows shortcut

Advanced Filter

Ctrl+Alt+F

Filter Dynamics

Shift+Alt+D

Filter Voice

l/2/3/4

Ctrl+Shift+Alt+l/2/3/4

1 ~68% l/2/3/4

Filter Tap/2nd/3rd/Bottom Note or Single


Notes

XX 1/2/3/B

Find

%gF

-7

Find Next

Ctrl+G

Notes out of Range

Ctrl+Alt+N

Pitch Spectrum

-cB%P

Hidden Objects (show/hide)

-\=BgH

Ctrl+Alt+P
~~ -7

Object Rulers (show/hide)


1 Staff Rulers (show/hide)

1 Properties (show/hide)

Ctrl+Alt+H
Shift+Alt+R

I GX%%R

T Ctrl+Shift+Alt+R

Transposing Score

Ctrl+Shift+T

I Xl

1 Ctrl+l

none

Full Screen (Windows only)

Ctrl+U

Document Setup

Ctrl+D

System Break on/off

Return (on main keyboard)

Return (on main keyboard)

Page Break on/off

#-Return (on main keyboard)

Ctrl+Return (on main keyboard)

Lock Format

Ctrl+Shift+L

1 Ctrl+Shift+U

Unlock Format
Make Into System

Shift+Alt+M

7IC)M

Make Into Page


Align in a Row/Column

Ctrl+Shift+Alt+M
I

Ctrl+Shift+R/C

6%X/C

Hide Empty Staves

Ctrl+Shift+Alt+H

Show Empty Staves

Ctrl+Shift+Alt+S

Reset Position

Ctrl+Shift+P

Reset Design
Reset Note Spacing
Condense/expand note spacing
(in larger steps; I space by default)
252

Ctrl+F

T
&.KN

Ctrl+Shift+D
Ctrl+Shift+N
Shift+Alt+t/+
(Ctrl+Shift+Alt+t/+)

Keyboard shortcuts
Descr@tion/menu item

Mac shortcut

Windows shortcut

Engraving Rules

Ctrl+S h ift+E

Edit Text Styles

Ctrl+Shift+Alt+T

Use Multirests on/off

Ctrl+Shift+M

Go into menu

none

Alt+underlined letter

Choose from menu

none

underlined letter

Choose from dialog

none

Alt+underlined

Move to next/previous box in dialog

Tab/&Tab

Tab/Shift-Tab

Select consecutive items from list

letter

1 Shift+click or drag

Select separate items from list

#-click

Ctrl+click

OK (or default button)

Return/Enter

Return/Enter

Cancel

Esc / 8%.

Esc

Keypad layouts

F8-F12

F8-F12

Next keypad layout

+ (on keypad)

+ (on keypad)

Back to first keypad layout

- (on keypad) / F8

F8 (Shift++ on Windows 2000/xp)

Contextual edit menu

Control-click on selected object(s)

Shift+Fl 0 / right-click on selected


object(s)

Change window

%%-

Ctrl+Ta b

Hide window

#H (Mac OS X only)

none

??
3
ii;
3

Minimize window

%gM (Mac OS X only)

none

!G

253

Reference

Key signatures
The key signatures which appear at the start of each system are automatic. They are adjusted to suit the current clef,
transposed for transposing instruments and omitted from those instruments which dont usually have them (e.g. most
percussion).
The only key signatures you have to input are the one at the start plus any key changes which occur in the music.
Creating key signatures
Type K (or choose Create b Key Signature) and click the key
signature you want. Switch between major and minor keys using the radio
buttons to the left of the dialog. (The distinction between major and minor
keys is primarily so Sibelius knows how best to spell accidentals inputted
from MIDI - for instance, in A minor it prefers writing D# to Eb, whereas ir
C major it prefers Eb to D#.)
Note that where the key signature is created depends on whether you havt
selected anything in your score: if you select, say, a note or rest and ther
create a key signature, Sibelius automatically places it after the selectee
object.
If you create a key signature change in the middle of a piece, Sibelius automatically precedes the change with i
double barline, which you can delete if you feel particularly strongly about that kind of thing.
To create a key signature at the beginning of your score, make sure nothing is selected, then choose Create b Key1
Signature, choose the key signature and click at the start of the score. You can also use this method to create a kej
change with the mouse anywhere in the score.
If your score is a transposing score, choose a key signature in sounding pitch - it will automatically be transposed fo
transposing instruments.
Moving and deleting key signature changes
You can move key changes with the mouse or arrow keys.
To delete the key signature at the start of a score, create an Open key/Atonal, C major, or A minor ke
signature and put it on top of the existing one.
To delete a key signature elsewhere (i.e. a key change), select the key change and hit Delete. To delete a change c
key signature which happens at the start of a system, select the cautionary key change at the end of the previou S
system.
Cautionary key signatures
If a new section, song or movement in a score starts in a new key, you often want to omit the cautionary key signature
that would otherwise appear at the end of the preceding system. To hide the cautionary key signature after creating it,
select it and choose Edit b Hide or Show b Hide (shortcut UB%H or Ctrl+Shift+H). For more information
about hiding objects, LQ Hiding objects.
254

Key signatures

Open key/Atonal
Some transposing scores which are apparently in C major have no key signatures in the transposing instruments
either. The composer has omitted all key signatures, because the key changes too often or the music is not really in
any key.
To use this notation, choose Open key/Atonal at the top right of the Create b Key Signature dialog.
You can switch back to music with key signatures later in the score by creating a normal key signature (e.g. C major). A
classic case of this is Stravinskys Rite of spring, which is mostly atonal but partly in keys - mostly the transposing
instruments dont have key signatures, but sometimes they do.
Instruments without key signatures
Unpitched percussion staves never have key signatures, Timpani and Horn usually dont, and Trumpet and Harp
sometimes dont.
To specify whether a staff has key signatures or not:
l

Select a bar and open the Staves panel of the Properties window.
Use the drop-down list to change the staff type: 5 line produces a key signature, 5 line (no keys) is for
pitched instruments without key signatures (e.g. Timpani), and there are also lots of 1 line staff types for
specific unpitched percussion instruments such as cymbals.

Enharmonic key signatures


Occasionally a score will have sharp and flat key signatures simultaneously in order to simplify the keys of transposing
instruments. For example, if a score is in B major (sounding pitch), with 5 sharps, trumpets in Bb will often be written
not in C# major (7 sharps) but in the enharmonically equivalent and easier-to-read Db major (5 flats).
To write this, at the point where you want to start using enharmonic key signatures simply put a transposition change
(IL!2 Transposing) to A# onto the trumpet staff to make it a trumpet in A# (!) rather than Bb. Making the
instruments transposition enharmonic has the same effect on its key signatures.
If you want the key signatures to stop being enharmonic later, put in a transposition change back to trumpet in Bb.
Note that this trick does not work for non-transposing instruments such as harp, because this would require changing
the harp into a B# instrument, which is not currently possible.
(WurGg: this does make perfect harmonic sense, but thinking about it carries a high risk of brain damage.)
Multiple key signatures
In some contemporary scores, different key signatures are used in different instruments. To create a key signature
which only applies to one staff, switch on One staff only in the Create b Key Signature dialog, then click the
desired staff.
Note that the note spacing of other staves in the system may be affected by the rnsertron OT a key sjgnature on a srngje
staff; to correct this, select the bar and choose Layout b Reset Note Spacing (shortcut 68%N or
Ctrl+Shift+N).

255

Reference

Engraving Rules options


The Clefs and Key Signatures page of the House Style b Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut Odl%E 01
Ctrl+Shift+E) has the usual round-up of the arcane and the obscure. The main option you might be interested in is
Cautionary naturals, which adds cautionary naturals to key changes to cancel sharps/flats in the previous key.
With this option off, cautionary naturals appear only when changing to C major, A minor or Open key/Atonal,
since (if you think about it) without cautionary naturals in these cases, the key change would be a bit hard to see.

256

Layout and formatting

LQ Attachment, Breaks, Document Setup, Music engraving, Note spacing, View menu,
Staff spacing.
Layout means how music looks on the page. Formatting is the process of creating a good layout. Sibelius knows so
much about music engraving that it automatically formats music to produce an instant, excellent layout. In most other
music notation programs, formatting is largely left up to the user, which can waste hours of time.
But Sibelius also lets you adjust the layout. Described below is the armory of methods at your disposal; most of these
options are on the Layout menu. For instance, you can put your own page-turns into parts, or force a score to fit into
a convenient number of pages.
Because Sibelius reformats the score in a fraction of a second, you can instantly adjust the layout at any stage, even
when the music is finished, which eliminates the need to plan layout in advance.
The three main weapons in your formatting armory are to adjust the page and staff size, the vertical spacing, and the
horizontal spacing. There are also options to force a passage of music to fit into a system or page, and to lock the
music so that it cant reformat.
Page and staff size
The bluntest tools are changing the staff, margin and/or page sizes in the Layout b Document Setup dialog
(shortcut %gD or Ctrl+D). Altering these is one way to increase or reduce the number of pages in a score, or to free
up some space between the staves.
Adjusting the staff size (the distance between the top and bottom staff lines of a s-line staff) is generally the most
effective. You will find that a tiny adjustment often has a dramatic effect on the amount of music that can fit on a page,
without affecting the legibility of the notes. For instance, in an orchestral score this might tip the balance between
fitting one system per page and fitting two, thus halving the length of the score.
Equally, a small adjustment to the margins or even the page size can have a large effect on the layout. Of course, for
practical reasons altering these may not be options open to you.
For detailed instructions on these options, !!ZJ Document Setup.
Vertical spacing
Changing the vertical spacing means, in effect, moving the staves. The various options open to you are:
l

Moving staves up and down to change the gap between them - !!ZQ! Staff spacing
Moving systems up and down, by dragging the top staff of the system - l!Q2! Staff spacing
Hiding empty staves - IQ2 Staff spacing
Creating a page break; this is an easy way to reduce the number of staves on a page, particularly in parts. The
remaining staves will be spaced out proportionally without you having to drag them - !!Z!ZI! Breaks
Modifying the House Style b Engraving Rules settings for staff and system justification - PJ2 Staff
spacing.
257

Reference

Horizontal spacing
Changing horizontal spacing means changing the distance between notes, rests and bar-lines - LQ Note spacing.
Make Into System/Page
You can force any passage to fit into a system or a page. Simply select the passage, then from the Layout b Format
menu choose Make Into System (shortcut OxM or Shift+Alt+M) or Make Into Page (shortcut
bx%%M or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+M). It will remain locked as a system or page thereafter, even if you reformat the
To undo this, unlock the format (see below).
As with other formatting overrides, you should not routinely make passages into systems/pages. Doing so can produce
undesirable formatting elsewhere if you dont know what youre doing - it is intended for special circumstances only.
Lock Format
If you have input a passage of music that requires very special formatting which you dont want to mess up, you can
lock it. This stops the bars from reflowing onto other systems (though it doesnt prevent spacing changes within a
system, e.g. moving a note left or right). To lock the format, simply select the passage in question and choose
Layout b Format b Lock Format.
When you lock the format or use Layout b Format b Make Into System/Page, invisible elves and pixies place
little blue padlocks and other formatting symbols on each barline to stop the bars moving around. These padlocks are
visible when View b Breaks and Locks is switched on.
Unlock Format
To undo Lock Format, re-select the bars and choose Layout b Format b Unlock Format. This makes the
blue padlocks disappear, and the bars are free to flow from system to system once more.
Unlock Format also removes page breaks, system breaks, and undoes Make Into System/Page.
Reset Position
You can move objects to their default position by making a selection and choosing Layout b Reset Position
(shortcut 4%gP or Ctrl+Shift+P).
The specific effects this has for some particular objects are:
Text and rehearsal marks: aligns with notes, and realigns rows of lyrics and chord symbols
Symbols: aligns with notes - e.g. for putting an ornament over a note
I&es: snaps the ends to notes, and makes any non-magnetic slurs go magnetic. The House Style b Default
Positions dialog (shortcut 68%E or Ctrl+Shift+E) lets you set the exact default position relative to the note.
Tuplets: makes any non-magnetic tuplets (such as any created with Sibelius 1.4 or earlier) go magnetic
Accident&.- resets the horizontal position of accidentals
Beam angles an&em lengths: resets these to the default settings.

258

Layout and formatting

Reset Design
If you make changes to the appearance (rather than the position) of an object, you can reset an items design to its
default using Layout b Reset Design (shortcut 6%%D or Ctrl+Shift+D). The specific effects on particular
objects are as follows:
Unhides hidden beams, flags or hooks
Unhides deleted instances of system text (e.g. Tempo text or rehearsal marks)
Resets the scale factor of imported graphics
Resets the curvature and symmetry of slurs and ties
Resets text objects to their default formatting.
Align objects
To align several selected objects in a row/column, choose Layout b Align in a Row (shortcut b#R or
Ctrl+Shift+R) or Layout b Align in a Column (shortcut 6%%C or Ctrl+Shift+C).
The line the objects end up in is the average of their original horizontal/vertical positions.
This is particularly useful for aligning lyrics, chord symbols, guitar frames, etc. along a staff. Usefully, if you select a
number of objects attached to different staves (e.g. with %-click or Ctrl+click), Layout b Align in a Row aligns
them to the same distance above or below the staff to which they are attached.
IM; to select all similar objects (e.g. all lyrics, or all rehearsal marks) in a system before aligning, select one object and
type OB%A or Ctrl+Shift+A.
(When naming this feature, we originally considered the terms Align Horizontally and Align Vertically. However, we
found a remarkable split of opinion - among people and other software - regarding whether to align horizontally
means to align in a row or in a column, and conversely whether to align vertically means to align in a column or in a
row. This is why weve settled for the unambiguous words row and column.)
Rulers
Sibelius can draw rulers on the screen to help you align objects and make precise adjustments to the layout of your
score - IL!2 View menu.

259

Reference

Lines
I22 Edit Lines, Filters and Find, Hiding objects, Slurs.
Creating lines
Ties
Slurs
Hairpins
Accel. and rit.
Trills
Pedaling
1 st, 2nd and 3rd endings (1 sQnd/3rd-time bars)
Octave (8va) lines

Gliss. and port.


Arpeggio lines
Rectangle
Beam line
Dashed lines
Reset Position
Reformatting of lines
Lines over two or more systems
Hiding lines

The Create b Line dialog (shortcut L) contains special lines used in music such as trills, slurs, hairpins, glissandi and
so on for entry in your score. You can also edit existing lines and design new ones - IKI Edit Lines.
Creating lines
All lines (with the exception of ties) are created in the same way:
l

Lines are either created automatically at the position of the selected note/rest, or can be placed with the mouse:
l

If you want the line to be automatically positioned, either select the note/rest where you want the line to start,
or select a passage of notes over which you want the line to last (i.e. encompassing both the start and end
points of the line)
If you want to place the line with the mouse, make sure nothing is selected - hit Esc

Choose Create b Line (shortcut L). The dialog is split into two halves: sfaff lines (which apply only to a single
staff) on the left, and system lines (which apply to all staves and are extracted into all parts) on the right
Select the line you want to create and click OK. The line will either be placed automatically in the score, or the
mouse pointer will change color to show that it is loaded with an object - click in the score to create the line.
To extend the line rightwards a note at a time, hit space. To retract the line leftwards again, type Shift-space.
You can also drag either end of a line with the mouse.
When either end of a line is selected (shown by a small blue box), you can also make small adjustments to its
position using the arrow keys (with # or Ctrl for larger steps).

Ties
Ties, which are automatically positioned, are unlike other lines in that they are input from the
first keypad layout. Simply select a note and then choose the tie from the keypad (shortcut
Enter). To add a tie to all the notes of a chord, double-click it (or choose Edit b Select b
Select More, shortcut bB%A or Ctrl+Shift+A) before selecting the tie from the keypad.
You can edit the size ana posltlon ot ties In a number ot ways:
260
b

--

--__

._

Sl
HI

___________ _I____________. .__________ __ ___ __ ~~ _

-- ____ _________

-_II_

lines

Positioning ties
Although ties may superficially look
like slurs, the engraving rules
concerning how they are positioned
are not the same.

Selecting either end (use xt/+ or Alt+t/+ to select either end using
the keyboard) and drag the end, or type 6x+/+ or Shift+Alt+t/+;
hold down %g or Ctrl for larger steps. Sibelius always ensures the tie remains
horizontal and symmetrical.
l

You can also adjust the position of the ends of ties from the Notes panel of
the Properties window (E2 Properties).
l

Ties are flatter than slurs, and a/ways


have their ends close to the noteheads
theyre tying - never at the stem end
of a note.
To make ties more visible, the very
ends and the highest or lowest point
of the arch should avoid touching a
staff line.
If ties occur together with slurs, ties
should a/ways be positioned nearest
the notes.

You can also select and drag the middle of the tie (or move it with /T\/$) to
make it more or less arched.

To flip a tie to the other side of the note, select it and choose Edit ) Flip
(shortcut X).

To reset the shape of a tie after dragging or flipping it, choose Layout k
Reset Design (shortcut 4k%%D or Ctrl+Shift+D).

If a tie crosses a page or system break, note that you cannot move the ends of
the tie, or flip each half independently. In rare cases, this can lead to problems
where the tie may collide with note stems. If this occurs, switch on Clip at
end of systems on the Ties page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog.
Never use a slur instead of a tie - slurs looks similar, but wont behave like a tie in playback or if you transpose the
music. Likewise you should never use a tie instead of a slur, as it is then possible to tie notes to nothing (i.e. neither to
another note nor a rest), resulting in problems of notes being held indefinitely during playback.
In percussion and piano music, you can create a laissez vibrer effect by tying a note/chord to a rest in the normal way
(using Enter on the keypad) to indicate that the note/chord is to be held until it dies away. Playback also implements
this (by sending a NoteOn but no NoteOff); the way this sounds (particularly if the note is subsequently re-played)
may depend on the sophistication of your soundcard or MIDI playback device. If you dont like the playback effect this
produces, use the laissez vibrer symbols from the Notes rows of the Create ) Symbol dialog (shortcut Z)
instead.
When notes are tied over into a 2nd ending @d-time bar), you need to draw ties at the very start of the 2nd ending.
To achieve this, you should use the above-mentioned laissez vibrer symbols, or a non-magnetic slur (see below),
although neither of these methods will play back correctly.
The Ties page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog contains various options concerning the
positioning of ties, including an option to make all ties internal (i.e. between the noteheads rather than above or
below them), should you require this.

Slurs
Slurs are a special kind of line - EQ Slurs.
Hairpins
I

1 -1r Hairpins are created quickly by typing H for a crescendo or Shift-H for a diminuendo. As
w o I with slurs and other lines, you can rapidly move either end of a hairpin right/left between
notes using space / Shift-space.
261

Reference

The aperture of hairpins widens slightly the longer the hairpin is, and the Lines page of the House Style)
Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut 6%gE or Ctrl+Shift+E) lets you set the exact size of the aperture under various
circumstances. If you want a particular hairpin to have a non-standard aperture, you can easily draw it yourself using
two thin lines; a line of the correct width is provided on the Create ) Line dialog. The dialog also contains dashed,
dotted and from/to silence hairpins, and the Create ) symbol dialog contains suitable exponential symbols to
add to the end of crescendos if required.
You can change the final dynamic of a hairpin from the Lines panel of the Properties window - LQ Playback.
Positioning hairpins, trills
and Ped
Hairpins should go below the staft
along with other dynamics, unless
they are in voice I or 3 of multiple
voices, or there are lyrics below.
They go between the staves of
keyboard instruments when they
apply to both hands. Hairpins
should not normally be diagonal.
Trills go above the stae except
sometimes when they are in voice 2
or 4.
Pedaling invariably goes below the
lowest piano staff

Accel. and rit.


Various kinds of accel. and rit. lines are available in the System lines pane of the
Create ) Line dialog. To create them in your score, simply click and drag (you
can also extend and retract them using space and Shift-space, like all other
lines). Note that because they are system lines, accel. and rif. lines are repeated in
your score in the same way as other system objects, e.g. Tempo text, and are
extracted into every extracted part.
In keyboard and vocal music, rit. and accel. are normally written in Expression text
(i.e. in italics). In choral music, this is written on each singers staff, rather than just
at the top. To notate this, create an italic rit./acce/. line on the top staff and use text
to write the directions on the other staves. (If Sibelius interprets the text rit/accel. as
well as the line, leading to a more pronounced change in tempo than anticipated,
try deleting the ritjaccel. words from the playback dictionary - ILIZ! Playback
dictionary.)

In solo keyboard music, the rit./acce/. instructions normally go between the staves. To notate this, simply create a
rit./acce/. line above the top staff and drag it down between the staves.
To adjust how rit./acce/. lines affect playback, LQ Playback.
Trills
To create a trill, select it from the Create ) Line dialog, then click and drag in your score to extend the trill line
rightwards from the tr symbol. If you want a trill without a wiggly line, use a symbol from the Create ) Symbol
(shortcut Z) dialog.
To adjust how trills play back, LQ Playback.
Pedaling
In addition to a standard pedal line, the Create ) Line dialog includes various other lines to allow you to write the
notch repedaling notation,
Pedaling plays back. To make it apply to both piano staves, you should ensure that both staves use the same MIDI
channel in the Play k Mixer dialog (shortcut M) - k&! Mixer.
If you want a Ped without a line after it, use the Ped symbol on the Create ) Symbol dialog (LL! Symbols),
which also includes a * to indicate repedaling. Note that pedaling will not play back if notated using symbols.
262

--------

--

_____ _ _____.._ _ _

--~

--~~~-__- ~

--a

Lines

1 st, 2nd and 3rd endings (1 st/znd/Brd-time bars)


The lst, 2nd and 3rd endings (lst/2nd/3rd-time bars) within the System Line pane of the Create b Line dialog
appear at the top of the system and apply to all instruments. In large scores, one or more duplicates appear in the
middle of the system as well (e.g. above the strings in orchestral scores) for clarity, as happens with tempo text and
rehearsal marks. You can adjust the positions where these duplicates appear or delete the duplicates individually &QI Layout and formatting.
Additionally, a I 2 ending line is also included (although note that it only repeats once, not twice, in playback). You
can create arbitrary nth-ending lines simply by creating a new line based on an existing one and changing the text at
the start of the line - LQ Edit lines.
Positioning octave lines
8va and 15va lines are on/y ever
positioned above a treble clef staft
while Svb and l5vb lines are only
ever positioned below a bass clef
stati
The alignment of the 8va text itself
should be centered on the
notehead, and the end of the 8va
bracket should extend slightly past
the last affected note.

Octave (8va) lines


These lines are predominantly used to avoid multiple leger lines on a staff. While
frequently used in keyboard music, these lines seldom occur in music for other
instruments. 8va and PWO (for one and two octaves upwards, respectively) and
8vb and 1.M (for one and two octaves downwards, respectively) are included in
the Staff lines pane of the Create b Line dialog.
If you prefer not to use Italianate terminology, you can modify the line so that it
simply says 8 rather than 8va, or you could modify the 8vb line to say 8va bassa !I22 Edit Lines.

Accidentals must be repeated for


the notes included within 8va or
Svb octave alterations.

Gliss. and port.


Sometimes a gliss. line is straight and includes the word gliss. at an angle along its
length (although Sibelius automatically omits the word if the line isnt long
enough), and sometimes the line is wiggly. Portamento (port) is similar but is
usually only represented by a straight line.
If you want to change the thickness of the wiggles used by the wavy gliss. line, edit the line (LQ Edit Lines) and
choose another kind of line from the Style drop-down menu.
In some scores you may need a g/&s. line that does not include any text along the line, even where the line is long
enough for the text to be included; for example, if you have many glissandos in your score but only want to mark the
first few explicitly with the text. To do this, edit the port. line and remove the text, and use that as a textless g/&s. line GQ Edit lines.
To adjust how these lines affect playback, E!J! Playback.

263

Reference

Some printer drivers have a bug which makes non-horizontal text or wiggly lines print at t
this happens, IL!2 Printing.
Arpeggio lines
In keyboard, harp and guitar music, its common to see a vertical wiggly line denoting that the notes of the adjacent
chord should be spread from bottom to top (or in the direction implied by an arrowhead on the line).
A variety of arpeggio lines is available from the Create b Line dialog. If you want, you can change the thickness of
the wiggles used by these lines - LL!! Edit Lines.
Some printer drivers have a bug which makes non-horizontal text or wiggly lines print at the wrong angle; if you find
this happens, L!2/ Printing.
Rectangle
A rectangle, which is required for the frame notation used by modern classical composers such as Lutoslawski, is
included in the Staff Line pane of the Create b Line dialog. (To the uninitiated, a rectangle or frame drawn
around a group of notes usually indicates that they should be repeated over and over again in free rhythm.)
To input a rectangle, first ensure nothing is selected in your score (hit Esc), then simply select the rather squat
rectangle from the Create b Line dialog, click in the score where one corner of the rectangle is to go, and drag out
the opposite corner.
If you draw the rectangle around some notes, it will ingeniously expand and contract to enclose the notes if the note
spacing changes.
Beam line
The Staff Line pane of the Create b Line dialog includes a beam which you can draw onto notes to create special
effects such as feathered accelerandos. LQ!l Beams.
Dashed lines
These are for showing the extent of a marking such as crest. Use these lines instead of typing a row of hyphens, since
the lines will automatically stretch or contract if the spacing of the score changes, whereas a row of hyphens will stay a
fixed length.
Reset Position
Layout b Reset Position (shortcut b%%P or Ctrl+Shift+P) aligns the ends of lines with notes, and moves
them to their default vertical position. LLI Layout and formatting.
Reformatting of lines
As youve probably learned to expect by now, lines behave themselves very intelligently if the note spacing changes or
if the music reformats. Basically, both ends of a line are independently attached to a note or other rhythmic position,
so if you change the spacing of notes then any lines in the vicinity will expand or contract accordingly.
Try this yourself: simply put a slur over some notes, and try dragging one of the notes left and right to see what
happens.

264

---- ----. -- --_ -.--. .______~_

__ ___

Lines

Moreover, Sibelius will automatically split lines across two or more systems, or join the bits back together again, if the
music reformats more drastically. See below for further details about this.
A side-effect of lines smart behavior is that you dont need to spend ages cleaning up lines in extracted parts Sibelius will already have taken care of it for you.
Lines over two or more systems
To input a line which splits across two or more systems using the mouse, such as this slur:

30

0GO

do not input two separate lines! Instead, simply input one line as normal, selecting the note and typing S at point 1,
and then hitting space until the slur extends to point 2. Even when creating lines with the mouse, you dont need to
drag horizontally along the upper staff - just go straight to point 2 without passing GO and Sibelius will take care of
the rest.
Sibelius in fact does lots of clever stuff here - if you draw an 8va across more than one system, Sibelius will put a
cautionary (s) at the start of the second system. You can modify what it writes as a cautionary by editing the lines
(U22 Edit Lines). Similarly, a crescendo hairpin split between systems will have an open end at the left-hand side of
the second system.
With horizontal lines such as 8vu, Sibelius also lets you move the second half of the line up and down independently
of the upper half, which is useful in case you need to avoid a high note. Simply select the portion of the line you wish
to adjust and move it up and down, or alter the X and Y parameters on the Line panel of the Properties window
(LB Properties). Note that this does not apply to hairpins; if a hairpin goes over more than one system, you
cannot adjust the vertical position of the hairpin on subsequent systems.
Note that if a line goes over more than two systems, you can only adjust the vertical position of the portion on the
original system, and all subsequent systems together (in other words, you cannot adjust each subsequent system
independently).
Hiding lines
To hide a line, mainly required for adding hidden hairpins to tweak playback, select the line and choose Edit b Hide
or Show b Hide (shortcut G%H or Ctrl+Shift+H). For more information about hiding objects, LQ Hiding
objects.

265

Reference

Lyrics
LQ Edit Text Styles, Text.
Typing lyrics
Editing lyrics
Verses, choruses and translations
Copying lyrics into Sibelius
Copying a whole line of lyrics
Copying lyrics from Sibelius
Sharing lyrics
Lyrics in two voices
Splitting words into syllables

Several words per note and elisions


Hanging punctuation
Horizontal position
Vertical position
Text style
Blocks of lyrics
Stem directions
Engraving Rules options
VI
SC

S/d

stc

Lyrics are the words sung by a singer. There are two ways of creating lyrics:
l

S/l

PC

typing lyrics in directly;

wt

copying lyrics into Sibelius from a word processor or other program.

PO

shr

Lyrics in a block, for extra verses at the end of a song or hymn, are created differently because they dont align with
the notes - see Blocks of lyrics below.

In
sytl

to
wit

Typing lyrics
To type lyrics directly into Sibelius:

bui
ha/

1ng

c o m e _

un - to thee,

Input the notes for which you want to write lyrics


Select the note where you want the lyrics to start and choose Create b Text b Lyrics (shortcut XL or
Ctrl+L)
Start typing lyrics
Hit space at the end of each word
Type hyphen at the end of each syllable within a word
If a syllable lasts for two or more notes, hit space or hyphen once for each note
If a word is followed by a comma, period or other punctuation, type it before hitting space.
If you need more than one word per note or an elision, see Several words per note and elisions below

266

Lyrics

Some engraving rules for


lyrics
Lyrics normally go beneath the staff
They are only written above a staff it
two staves are sharing the same set of
lyrics (e.g. in a hymn), or if a staff has
two voices with different lyrics.
Syllables sung to different notes are
separated by multiple hyphens. If the
last syllable of a word continues over
several notes, a lyric line is drawn after
the final syllable along the notes sung
to that syllable.

Where multiple notes are sung to the


same syllable, you can join them with a
slur to make it clearer where syllables
start and end. Because unnecessary
slurs can clutter the music a good
policy is only to put slurs in places
where the word-setting is complex or
potentially confusing Phrase-marks
should not be used in vocal music.
In older scores, notes sung to separate
syllables were never beamed together,
to make it clearer which syllable went
with which note. This convention has all
but died out because it makes rhythms
harder to read

Editing lyrics
You can edit lyrics much like other text. You can alter them, move them, copy them
and delete them.
To edit a lyric, select it and double-click, or hit Return (on the main keyboard).
You can use the arrow keys and Backspace to move between words and
syllables.
If you delete a syllable, this also deletes any lyric line or hyphens to the right of it
(which are attached to the syllable).
You can move a syllable left/right a note by selecting it (so it goes blue, not so the
caret appears) and hitting space or Shift-space. Similarly you can extend or
retract a lyric line or row of lyric hyphens by selecting the right-hand end and hitting
Space or Shift-space.
Verses, choruses and translations
It is common for vocal music to have two or more verses of lyrics under the same
music. Usually this is denoted by the verse number being written before the first
word or syllable of each verse, e.g. 1. The.
In this example, you would type '1. The as a single text object using a nonbreakable space (see Several words per note and elisions below).
To input a second verse of lyrics, simply choose Create b Text b Lyrics verse
2 (shortcut x%L or Ctrl+Alt+L) and create them in the same way as other
lyrics; they will automatically appear beneath the verse 1 lyrics.

For translations which require a second line of lyrics, use Lyrics verse 2 and edit
its text style to use italics (E!2 Edit Text Styles). For choruses, use italics by
clicking I in the Text panel of the Properties window (shortcut xl or Ctrl+l) while creating the lyrics.

Sibelius has predefined text styles for five verses of text. Lyrics for verses 3, 4 and 5 can be obtained from the
Create b Text b Other Staff Text submenu. You can create even more verses of lyrics using House Style b
Edit Text Styles (shortcut ~x%T or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+T) - D2l Edit Text Styles.
Copying lyrics into Sibelius
You can copy and paste lyrics between other programs (such as word processors) and Sibelius, from one part of a
score to another in Sibelius, or from one score to a different one.
To copy text from another program successfully, the text you are copying must have a hyphen between syllables in the
same word, e.g.:
Ma-ry had a little lamb,
its fleece was white as snow.
To copy lyrics text into Sibelius:
l

Select the text you want to copy:


267

Reference

If you are copying within Sibelius, select the lyrics you want to copy: either use a lasso selection
(Q2 Selections and passages) or select a single syllable and choose Edit b Select b Select More

co

(or type bB%A or Ctrl+Shift+A) to select a line of lyrics, then choose Edit b Copy (shortcut 6t%C or
Ctrl+C)
l

If you are copying from another program, select the text you want to copy and choose Edit b Copy (shortcut
normally B%C or Ctrl+C) to copy it to the clipboard

Select the note where you want to start pasting lyrics, then choose Create b Text b Lyrics (shortcut B%L or
Ctrl+L); a flashing caret appears

Punctuation in lyrics
When using a poem for lyrics,
include capitals (at the start of

;:

lines) and punctuation (at the i


end of lines and elsewhere) :
:
exactly as in the original text. _
Punctuation at the end of words i.,
goes before the lyricline.

I.

If you repeat part of a sentence ir


which isnt repeated in the ;
original text, put a comma before :
the repetition, e.g. My sister, my \
sister, my sister is a thistle-siffer:
t.%
Verse numbers should be typed
at the start of the first word of
lyrics, followed by a period and a

To paste a syllable, type XV or Ctrl+V, which pastes text up to the next space or
hyphen (i.e. one notes worth)

;
i
j+ .
..

You can then edit the pasted text as if you typed it in yourself or hit space or
hyphen to extend the word or syllable over more than one note
l

When you want to input the next word or syllable, type dt%V or Ctrl+V again

If you make a mistake, you can choose Edit b Undo (shortcut B%Z or Ctrl+Z),
which will remove the last pasted word or syllable from the score and put it back on the
clipboard so that you can paste it again.
l

Note that if the text you had copied had extra hyphens or spaces between words or
syllables, or had syllables lasting more than one note, this is ignored when pasting. This
is useful if, say, youre copying lyrics from one staff to another in Sibelius and the
rhythms are different.

At this point you may be wondering why its best for lyrics to be pasted in a syllable at a
time rather than doing the whole lot in a single operation. The answer is two-fold: firstly,
youd have to mark up the original text with multiple hyphens and spaces to show how
the underlay goes, and its easy to do this wrong if youre not creating the text into the
music as you do it; and secondly, because it wouldnt work if different singers have different numbers of notes on
some syllables, which is almost always the case.

Copying a whole line of lyrics


A quick way of copying a whole line of lyrics to somewhere else in your score where the rhythm of the words is fhe
same:
l

Select the original row of lyrics by selecting one word or syllable, then choosing Edit b Select b Select
More (shortcut OB%A or Ctrl+Shift+A)

Choose Edit b Copy (shortcut EC or Ctrl+C)


Select the first note of the destination passage, where you want to paste the lyrics
Choose Edit b Paste (shortcut dt%V or Ctrl+V) to paste all the lyrics at once
The destination lyrics may collide, in which case select the destination notes as a passage, and choose Layout b
Reset Note Spacing (shortcut &%N or Ctrl+Shift+N).

268

LY

Aection
More
KC or

_-_- __ -

---

---

Copying lyrics from Sibelius


It can be useful to copy and paste lyrics from Sibelius, either into a different program (e.g. a word processor) or into,
say, a block of lyrics at the end of the score in Sibelius (see Blocks of lyrics below). To do this:
Select the lyrics you want to copy (select a passage or the whole score and then choose Edit ) Filter ) Lyrics)

iortcut

and choose Edit ) Copy (shortcut XC or Ctrl+C) to copy them to the clipboard
Now paste the lyrics to the desired location:

tgL or

To paste the lyrics in Sibelius, create a suitable text caret, e.g. for a block of lyrics, choose Create ) Text )

3ce or

Other Staff Text ) Plain Text and click in the score, then choose Edit ) Paste (shortcut %gV or Ctrl+V)
to paste the lyrics

ce or

To paste the lyrics into another program, switch to it and choose Edit ) Paste (shortcut normally XV or
Ctrl+V)
Note that the pasted text will contain hyphens between syllables, so you should remove these.

z>

+
1
I the

Is or
This
the
at a
QlY,
IOW
the
on

Glo

ry

be to

God on high,

Sharing lyrics
If two staves have identical or near-identical rhythms, you can write a
single line of lyrics between them applying to both; where the rhythms
differ slightly you should position syllables horizontally between the two
notes (as in t-y and on in the illustration).

lyrics in two voices


In choral music it is common for two vocal lines to share the same staff (e.g. soprano and alto on a single staff). Often
only one set of lyrics is required for music of this kind since the rhythms of the two lines tend to be similar; if the
rhythms are dissimilar for extended passages, it is clearer to write each vocal line on a separate staff.
On the other hand, if a staff has two singers with significantly different rhythms or lyrics for only a few bars, you should
write an extra line of lyrics above for voice 1 and a separate line of lyrics below for voice 2. The extra line of lyrics can
appear just for a few notes, though if it isnt present for the whole system, then its clearest if the extra line of lyrics
occurs only where the music splits into two voices:

he
To

ct

be

light_

to

light - en____

the

gen- tiles,

When adding lyrics to music in two voices, you can choose the voice into which you want to create lyrics before you
stat-t:
Create all the notes (both voices 1 and 2)
To create the lyrics for voice 1 above the staff, choose Create ) Text ) Other staff text ) Lyrics above
To add lyrics in voice 2, first choose Edit ) Voice ) 2 (shortcut 712 or Alt+2)
Select the first note in voice 2 to which you want to add lyrics, then choose Create ) Text ) Lyrics (shortcut
XL or Ctrl+L).
269

Reference

Splitting words into syllables


When splitting a word of lyrics with hyphens its important to split between the correct letters, otherwise the syllables
can be hard to read. A rule of thumb (though there are exceptions) is as follows:
l

Put standard prefixes and suffixes (e.g. un-, -ing, -ed, -Iv> as separate syllables
If there is a single consonant between two syllables (e.g. baton), split before it (ba-ton)
If there are two consonants between two syllables (e.g. better, Batman), split between them (bet-ter, Bat-man).

As there are exceptions, if in doubt, ensure that each syllable can be read and pronounced correctly on its own; for
example, laughter should be split laugh-ter rather than laug-hter because laug doesnt produce the right sound
when read on its own.
Several words per note and elisions
In sung dialog (such as recitative) you often find several words sung to one long note. If you type a space or hyphen
after the first syllable, the caret would immediately move onto the next note.
So instead use the special keypresses x-space or Ctrl+space and x-hyphen or Ctrl+hyphen, which produce
a space and hyphen without moving onto the next note, known as a non-breaking space. (These keypresses are also
occasionally useful in other text styles such as Chord Symbols.)
Similarly, in Italian and some other languages, two elided syllables are often written on the same note with an elision
character inbetween, e.g. Kyrie-e - lei - son. To achieve this, simply type - (underscore) while creating lyrics to get
an elision character.
You can also use the elision character as a slur in lyrics; for example, at the end of a line of block lyrics in hymns.
Hanging punctuation
If you type the word Oh, as lyrics, then Sibelius will center the letters themselves under the note and ignore the width
occupied by the comma, which hangs to the right. Similarly, if a verse starts with '1. The then the word The is
centered and the '1.' hangs to the left. These are examples of a typographical nicety called hanging punctuation.
If you dont want Sibelius to allow for hanging punctuation, switch off Hanging punctuation on the Text page of
the House Style b Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut UB%E or Ctrl+Shift+E).
Horizontal position
The horizontal position of lyrics is controlled by Sibelius according to complex rules: while you type each syllable in,
Sibelius adjusts its precise horizontal position according to how wide the syllable is and how many notes it lasts for.
Once youve typed lyrics in, you can drag individual syllables left and right like other text if you need to adjust its
position.
Syllables are attached to the notes they are written under, so if you adjust the note spacing they move as well.
Additionally, if you pull two syllables joined by hyphens apart, more hyphens will appear the farther apart they get,
and the hyphens will shift about so as to remain precisely centered between the syllables.
If you want to adjust the horizontal spacing of lyrics yourself, select the bar or passage in question, and use
Gxt/+ or Shift+Alt+t/+ t o n a r r o w o r w i d e n t h e s p a c i n g a c c o r d i n g l y @~%gt/+ or
Ctrl+Shift+Alt+t/+ move in bigger steps) - Q2 layout and formatting.
270

Ve

_____.___-__--___

~_
Lyrics

ylla bles

Sibelius allows extra space for unusually wide lyrics, to prevent them colliding. To reset the spacing to its default,
simply select the relevant passage and choose Layout b Reset Note Spacing (shortcut bB%N or
Ctrl+Shift+N).
Note that the behavior of this function is determined by the Allow space for lyrics option in House Style b

Ian).
vn; for
sound

lphen
jduce
f also
ision
1 get

Note Spacing Rule, which must be switched on for U8%N or Ctrl+Shift+N to take account of lyrics when
resetting spacing. If you switch off this option, Sibelius will completely ignore lyrics when respacing your music, so we
recommend you leave it switched on
Sometimes allowing space for wide lyrics can make the note spacing rather uneven; this is one of the bugbears of
music engraving, and improving it requires something of a compromise between how best to space the lyrics and how
best to space the notes. For examples and advice on this, LQ Note spacing.
Vertical position
Sibelius puts lyrics at a standard vertical position beneath the staff. However, you can move syllables individually up
and down like other text.
To move a line of lyrics, click one of the lyrics and choose Edit b Select b Select More (shortcut &%A or
Ctrl+Shift+A) to select the whole line, then move the lyrics with the arrow keys @-arrow or Ctrl+arrow for big
steps). Alternatively, after selecting a line of lyrics like this you can align them in a row using Layout b Align In a
Row (shortcut b%%R or Ctrl+Shift+R), move them back to their default vertical position using Layout b Reset
Position (b%P or Ctrl+Shift+P), or Delete them.
To change lyrics default vertical position, L!2 Default Positions.

idth
f is

Text style
You can change the appearance of lyrics in a variety of ways:
l

: of

Use House Style b Edit Text Styles (shortcut b~%gT or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+T) to change lyrics text styles
globally (e.g. if you want all lyrics in your score to be in a particular font, or all italic, etc.)
Any change you make to the appearance of lyrics via the Properties window (LQ Properties) while editing
lyrics applies to all subsequent text you create, e.g. if you change to an italic font and then hit space to move
on to the next word, the next word and all subsequent ones will be italic until you explicitly switch it off again or
stop typing lyrics.

in,
3r.
its

If you want to change the appearance of your lyrics back to their default settings (i.e. those set in House Style b

II.
!t,

Blocks of lyrics
Extra verses of a song or hymn can be written as blocks of words at the end of the score. These arent the same as
normal lyrics because they dont align with notes.

Edit Text Styles), select them and choose Layout F Reset Design (shortcut OB%D or Ctrl+Shift+D).

To type a block of lyrics, the Plain text and Small text styles are most suitable. Simply type the lyrics, and hit
Return (on the main keyboard) at the end of each line, or copy the lyrics from elsewhere in the score if you can (see
Copying lyrics from Sibelius above).
271

Reference

Its convenient if you type each verse as a separate text object, so that you can move them around separately. You may
want to create a new text style called something like Block lyrics, which will also let you adjust the font, size and/or
line spacing without affecting other text.
Stem directions
Notes on the middle staff line normally have stems pointing down; however, when there are lyrics the stem is often
drawn pointing up so as to avoid colliding with the words.
By default, Sibelius observes this convention. If you prefer it not to, edit the 5 lines (singers) staff type and switch
off Stems point up for notes on mid-line - LQ Edit Staff Types.
Engraving Rules options
On the Text page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut 4#E or Ctrl+Shift+E) you can set
the position of lyric lines and spacing of hyphens, and some other options besides:
Use text hyphens (not symbols) makes Sibelius draw lyrics hyphens with the font used for creating
lyrics, rather than using a special symbol from the Create ) Symbols dialog. This option is switched on by
default.
One hyphen maximum forces only one lyric hyphen to appear, even if syllables are spaced a long way
apart. This option is switched off by default.
0

272

Hyphens allowed at start of systems controls whether a lyric hyphen can appear at the start of a
system if there is a syllable on the first note. This option is switched on by default.
Hanging punctuation controls whether Sibelius takes account of hanging punctuation when positioning
lyrics (see Hanging punctuation above).

~__-. _---.- ___.


Manuscr~t paper

ou may
! and/or

is often
switch

:an set
-eating
on by
g way
t of a
oning

Manuscript paper
Each time you start a new score you can choose to write it on a particular type of manuscript paper. The preset
manuscript paper choices have various combinations of instruments on standard paper sizes (the US sizes Letter and
Tabloid, plus the European sizes A4 and A3), along with other less obvious settings to improve the look and playback
of your score.
You do not have to use the instruments exactly as provided - feel free to delete instruments or add new ones. A title,
composer name and metronome mark are also provided for you to modify. (The metronome mark in each
manuscript paper might look like its too far left - but in fact its positioned such that it will be correctly aligned with
the time signature when you create one.)
Its better to use a manuscript paper containing instruments than to start with a blank page, even if the
instrumentation isnt exactly right, because various other options are already set for you in the manuscript papers
appropriate for the particular type of music.
Types of manuscript paper
There are more than 130 predefined manuscript papers supplied with Sibelius, including:
Blank paper: blank scores with no preset instruments in many sizes (e.g. Letter, Tabloid, A4, Octave);
!!2!2l Document setup for details of these sizes. Also included are blank manuscript papers using the
Inkpen font (see below) and others using larger than normal noteheads of a design recommended by the
US Music Publishers Association
Piano
Bands: a wide range of manuscript papers suitable for concert band, wind band, marching band, school bands,
brass band, drum corps, military band and other ensembles
Orchesfra: small orchestra, symphony orchestra and film orchestra are all included
Choir: various Choir manuscript papers are included, some (called reduction or red) with the singers
reduced onto two staves (closed score), some with organ accompaniment. These manuscript papers are for
SATB choir, but are easily adapted for other choirs.
Voice and keyboard
Jazz.- a number of suitable templates using the Inkpen handwritten font (see below), including Lead sheet,
Big band, and Jazz quartet
Guitar: various manuscript papers for notation and tab, including Lute tablature
Worksheets: the Worksheet and Treble staff templates are designed to help teachers create exam papers
and classroom materials quickly
Brass and wind groups of various sizes
String quartet and string orchestra (also usable for string quintet)
Various other ensembles such as handbells, percussion corps, salsa band and pop group.
Some manuscript papers containing (title) or (t) also include a title page at the start. If you want to create your own
title page, Q2 Breaks.
273

Reference

Inkpen manuscript papers


The manuscript papers with Inkpen in their name, and some others (such as Lead sheet and Big band), use
Sibeliuss Inkpen fonts, which simulate music handwritten with a pen.

Inkpen fonts are used for all text and almost all music symbols. Some of the less common music symbols (such as
percussion symbols) use the Opus font. The text styles are set with point sizes slightly larger than for other manuscript
papers, because Inkpen is quite condensed and so looks smaller than normal text fonts.
These manuscript papers also have most lines (e.g. barlines, slurs, hairpins, leger lines) set to be much thicker than
normal to simulate drawing with an ink pen.
To get a really authentic look as you work on your score, why not change the paper texture to Paper, white
crumpled in the View ) Textures dialog?
For keyboard music, try printing with Substitute Braces switched off in the File ) Print dialog (shortcut B%P or
Ctrl+P), to make braces look hand-drawn (as they do on the screen). However, this wont work with some printers.
Similarly, for parts, try switching on Draw H-bar using a symbol on the Bar Rests page of the House
Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut &%E or Ctrl+Shift+E) to make multirests look hand-drawn, though
some printer drivers have bugs in which may prevent this printing correctly (and in extreme cases may even cause a
eras h).
Creating your own manuscript paper
If you often need to set up unusual groups of instruments and/or options, you can create your own manuscript paper
to save you time starting new scores. Like real manuscript paper, you can choose different paper sizes, shapes and
staff sizes, and have the manuscript paper pre-printed with particular instruments. However, you can also include
more sophisticated settings, such as the House Style menu. This means you can get a consistent appearance
without having to set up all the options each time.
Create a score with all the settings you want to be included in the manuscript paper - e.g. page size/shape, staff
size, instruments, Engraving Rules options, text styles, music font, noteheads
Save it anywhere you like, using whatever name you want to call the manuscript paper (e.g. Choir, Big
paper, Sketches)
Then choose File ) Save as Manuscript Paper
You can then delete the original file you saved if you like - it will still remain as manuscript paper
Next time you start a new score, your new manuscript paper will appear on the Manuscript Paper dialog.
If you want to create a new manuscript paper to match an existing score (e.g. if youve set up special text styles etc.),
export the house style from that score, create a new score, import the house style you saved, and then save as
manuscript paper. L!2 House Style for details on exporting/importing a house style.
If you ever want to rename or delete manuscript paper, you will find the manuscript paper files in a folder called
Manuscript paper within the Sibelius program folder.

274

Set

MIDI equipment

Jse
as
ipt

MIDI devices
ELII MIDI setup for Mac, MIDI setup for Windows, Mixer.
This section details how to set up playback in Sibelius. This is controlled for the whole program from the Play )
Devices dialog, and the Play ) Mixer dialog (shortcut M) controls the sounds and devices used in a particular
score.
If you have external MIDI devices such as keyboards, sound modules and so on, you should connect these before you
set up playback in Sibelius - I!2 MIDI setup for Mac and MIDI setup for windows.
If youre not familiar with MIDI terminology, read MIDI for beginners before reading this topic.

It-

Setting up for playback


The Play F Devices dialog lets you tell Sibelius what equipment youre using.
The Playback devices section lists all the MIDI devices recognized by Sibelius, whether or not Sibelius should use
it for playback, and what type of sounds it can use. Even if you have not set up any external devices, there may well be
two or more things listed as playback devices - such as QuickTime Music (Mac only) or a number of different
related devices (e.g. A: SB Live! MIDI Synth, B: SB Live! MIDI Synth and Microsoft GS Wavetable
SW synth), and any of them may be used for playback.
On Mac, external MIDI devices will not appear in this list until you have set them up - LLIl MIDI setup for Mac.
On Windows, external MIDI devices are normally named after the port, and so include the words MIDI Out or MPU4Ol- ILLI MIDI setup for Windows.
Click Test on each item in the playback devices list to see how it sounds. You may get no sound if the device is not
properly connected, e.g. if your speakers are not connected to your soundcard or are not switched on.
If you only have a single MIDI device (e.g. an internal soundcard), you should only set the Use column to Yes for
one listed device - choose the one whose sound you like the best. If Test in the Devices dialog works even though
playback doesnt, switch any unused devices to No in the Use column.
If you have external MIDI devices connected to your computer, you may want to set more than one playback device to
Yes in the Use column. For example, some MIDI devices support 32 channels, which are usually represented as two
separate MIDI devices (called e.g. MIDI out A and MIDI out B). In this case, you could set Use to Yes for both
these devices, and then choose which instruments play back via which device via the Device drop-down menu in the
Play ) Mixer dialog (shortcut M) - E!2 Mixer.
The Sound set column tells Sibelius what sounds are available on each of the listed playback devices; by default, it
is set to General MIDI. Internal soundcards (and QuickTime Music) generally will only have General MIDI sounds
available, so theres no need to change this setting.
Many external MIDI devices support a wide range of additional sounds, which are only accessible if you know the bank
and program numbers for each sound. You can type these numbers individually for each staff in the Play F Mixer
dialog if you want, but if an appropriate sound set is available for your device, this will save a lot of time.
275

Reference

Sound sets
Various sound sets are installed by default with Sibelius; if your device isnt listed in the Sound set column of the
Play ) Devices dialog, a sound set file may be available from Sibeliuss online Help Center - choose Help ) Help
Center.
Due to the complexity of the sound set format, its not possible for you to edit or create sound set files yourself.
/Vote for C/&c Mac OS users: if you use OMS or FreeMlDl to connect your external MIDI devices, a sound set is
automatically generated, so you dont need to worry about the Sound Set column in the Play ) Devices dialog.
Mac-specific options
There are two Mac-specific options on the Play ) Devices dialog, as follows:
l

Current MIDI system shows you the active MIDI system; click Change to choose a new one. When you
click Change, the options available will depend on what software is installed on your computer. Classic Mac OS
may list QuickTime (only), OMS, or FreeMIDI; Mac OS X will only list Mac OS X MIDI.
Note that you may only choose one MIDI system to be used by Sibelius, even if you have more than one
available. You may be prompted to close down Sibelius and start it again after changing your MIDI system.

Show other music programs as devices allows Sibelius to send its output to other music programs,
effectively like playing into another program via MIDI input. This should be switched off by default - only switch
it on if you want to send Sibeliuss playback to another program rather than to your playback device.

Windows-specific options
There is one Windows-specific option on the Play ) Devices dialog: Play in Background lets you choose
whether Sibelius can play while youre using other music programs. Some soundcards can make Windows crash when
switching between different music programs. If you find this happens, go into the Play in Background dialog, set
Sibelius owns MIDI devices to Always, and click OK.
If playback doesnt work
By default, Sibelius assumes that your playback device is General MIDI compatible, which almost all soundcards and
many keyboards and sound modules are these days. If you dont know, the easiest way to check is to play back a
score containing different instruments by clicking Play on the toolbar. If this doesnt work, it may be that:
l

You get no sound at all. This means your soundcard or MIDI device isnt working or isnt plugged in properly, or
that your computer can play back through several devices and its set to the wrong one.
You get different sounds but theyre the wrong instruments:
If the right sounds came out, your device probably obeys the General MIDI standard and your life is going to be
all laughter and sunshine from now on.
If the wrong sounds came out, youll have to adjust the sound set used for that device.
If your device isnt compatible with any of the supplied sound sets, youll have to tell Sibelius which program
numbers (sounds) to use - LQ Mixer.

276

MIDI equipment

Setting up for keyboard input


The lower half of the Play ) Devices dialog is concerned with MIDI input; the white box at the bottom lists any
MIDI input devices you have - i.e. MIDI keyboards. In the unlikely event that you have two or more, you can click the
one you want to use.
Try playing notes on your keyboard while the Play ) Devices dialog is open. If everything is working as it should,
the little black indicator should light up green as you play. If the indicator doesnt light up, check your MIDI
connections and ensure that you have the correct input device selected (if more than one is present).
Switch on MIDI Thru if and only if your keyboard has no built-in sounds - this will make Sibelius reproduce notes
played on your keyboard using your soundcard or other playback device.
Find New Devices re-checks your playback and playing-in devices in case a new device has unexpectedly attached
itself to your computer. Note that clicking this button will set the Use column for all the listed playback devices to
Yes, so dont forget to set the ones you dont want to use to No again afterwards.
External MIDI devices are connected to your computer through an adaptor of some kind; on Mac, these tend to be
external adaptors that plug into the modem, printer or USB port, while on PCs, adaptors can be external, but it is more
common to connect MIDI devices through a special cable that plugs into the joystick port (gameport) of your
soundcard.
Problems with MIDI input
If MIDI input doesnt seem to work, check that MIDI OUT on the keyboard is connected to MIDI IN on your computer,
and vice versa - not MIDI OUT to MIDI OUT and MIDI IN to MIDI IN. If your computer has dual MIDI inputs, try also
connecting the keyboard to the other MIDI IN socket.
For further information on setting up your computer for MIDI input, ILLI MIDI setup for Mac and MIDI setup
for windows.
Substitute devices
The Play ) Substitute Devices dialog lets you play scores created for devices different than what you have.
Sibelius automatically adjusts the program and bank numbers to produce the sounds on your playback device which
most closely match those for which the score was originally written.
When you open a score created on a different device to your own, the name of that device is added to the Original
Device list in the Play ) Substitute Devices dialog. You can then choose the playback device on your computer
that most closely matches the original device using the Play Back Using list.
Thereafter, whenever you open a score which is set to play back using that device, Sibelius will automatically substitute
the sounds in the file to play back using the chosen substitute device, without asking you to reset its sounds when you
open it.
Reset sounds
If you open a score which was created on an incompatible MIDI device, Sibelius recognizes this and asks if you want
to reset the sounds. If you click Yes, Sibelius resets the sounds in the file for you.
277

Reference

If you need to reset the sounds yourself (e.g. if youve adjusted the sounds in a score and want to change them back
to the defaults), open the Play h Mixer dialog (shortcut M), and click Reset, which sets the instruments to use the
same default sounds as Sibelius selects when creating new instruments with your current MIDI equipment.
(Alternatively you can use the Play ) Substitute devices dialog to specify playing through a MIDI device which is
compatible with the sounds in the file. This is useful if you have several different MIDI devices and one of them will
suit.)
This warning when you open a score with incompatible sounds can get annoying, so you can switch it off or on from
the File ) Preferences ) General dialog.

278

M/D/ for beginners

rck
he

MIDI for beginners

It.

is
ill

This topic assumes that you know very little about anything at all. (It was originally entitled MIDI for idiots, which
could give offense but does have certain poetic qualities.) Read this topic if you know little or nothing about MIDI. Skip
this topic if you know quite a lot about MIDI.

For information on plugging your MIDI devices into your computer and setting it up, EII MIDI devices and MIDI
setup for Mac/Windows.
Basic question - what is MIDI?
MIDI stands for Musical Instrument Digital Interface. It is a standard, not a thing* - the universal standard for
connecting electronic musical instruments together. MIDI keyboards, synthesizers, sound modules, samplers and other
electronic music gadgets can all be plugged into one another with MIDI cables, and can also be plugged into your
computer. Soundcards and software synthesizers (such as the Macs built-in QuickTime Music) are also MIDI
compatible, and as theyre already in your computer you dont need to attach cables at all in order to play music back.
MIDI is supposed to make your life easy, in the same way that plugging a printer into your computer is now quite
easy. Remember the good old days, when you couldnt even work your printer without a computing degree, and the
manual disconcertingly included a complete circuit diagram in case you needed to solder on extra components? Ah,
those were the days!
Unfortunately, in the sphere of MIDI those days are still with us. People using MIDI devices are still expected to have a
working knowledge of technicalities like MIDI channels, program numbers, banks and worse - knowledge which in
most cases can and should be hidden from everyone except the experts.
(*This superficially obvious point does need spelling out, as we have on a number of occasions been asked questions such as: How big is a MIDI?)

Program numbers and General MIDI


The sounds available from MIDI devices are referred to by numbers, typically in the range 0 to 127. The piano sound
might be number 0, and the flute sound number 73. It would be nice if these were called instrument numbers or
sound numbers, but in practice theyre called program numbers for obscure historical reasons. (They are sometimes
called program changes, patch numbers or voice numbers instead, confusingly.)
Until recently program numbers werent standardized. Though program 0 happens to be a piano sound on most
devices, program 73 might be anything. Before standardization, you used to have to tell computers the program
numbers you wanted for each instrument in each score, which could be very tiresome. Also, if you played the same
score on other MIDI devices, you might get the wrong sounds - not very satisfactory.
Fortunately a standard list of 128 sounds has emerged, called General MIDI (known as GM to its friends). These
sounds start with piano as program number 0, and pass through most of the instruments you can think of, with a very
final gunshot as program number 127. Virtually all soundcards and a lot of new MIDI devices follow this standard,
maybe with extra sounds too. Professional MIDI devices are less likely to be General MIDI compatible.
More recently, the MIDI manufacturers have got together again and ratified some additions to the General MIDI
standard, resulting in General MIDI 2, or GM2 for short. GM2 adds an extra 128 sounds to the standard set, among
other things, but it isnt yet in very widespread usage. You can usually tell if your own MIDI device is GM- or GM2compatible if it includes the appropriate logo on its front panel.
279

Reference

Within Sibelius program numbers works like this: whenever you create a flute staff Sibelius normally sets it to program
number 73, which is the Genera I MIDI program number for a flute sound. When you play back the score on any
General MIDI-based devices, this produces the right sound. Its as simple as that.
Moreover, if you connect a different device and tell Sibelius what type of device it is, Sibelius will alter the program
number to produce that devices best flute sound. Sibelius supports a wide variety of devices.
Counting from 0
A pointless complication of MIDI is that some manuals list program numbers in the range O-127 and others in the
range 1-128. (This is because for obscure technical reasons, computer programmers count from 0, so when designing
the internal workings of MIDI devices they tend to get carried away and forget that normal people count from 1.)
The annoying consequence of this is that sometimes when setting up MIDI devices you find you get the wrong sound
and have to add or subtract 1 from a program number to correct the problem. Sibelius almost always makes the
adjustment for you, so try not to think about this.
Banks: variants of sounds
Some MIDI devices can play back hundreds of different sounds, even though program numbers only go up to 127.
This limitation is overcome by arranging the extra sounds in groups or banks of program numbers. To access these,
you specify the bank number as well as the program number.
A bank number consists of 2 values, though often MIDI devices only specify one of the values (the other one being
implicitly 0).
Channels
If youve had enough of MIDI technicalities, you can skip this bit.
Channels are often the first thing youre told about MIDI, but with Sibelius they are largely irrelevant. Most MIDI
devices can only play back up to 16 different sounds at once (that is, only 16 different timbres), even though the
maximum number of notes that can play at once might be 32 or more. You can think of the MIDI device as containing
16 staves called channels which can only play one timbre at a time. Sibelius, or whatever else is plugged into it,
produces different timbres by saying which channel each note or chord is playing on. Some other effects like the pan
(= stereo) position and piano pedaling also apply to the channel, not to individual notes.
Other MIDI terms
Some other MIDI terms which we wont explain here but are in the Glossary are: aftertouch, control change,
NoteOn, NoteOff, pan position, pitch bend, track, veloc;tK volume.
MIDI files
MIDI files are music files in a standard format - sometimes called the Standard M DI File (SMF) format, in fact. Almost
all music programs and some keyboards can save (export) MIDI files and open (import) them. Nowadays, you can
even buy MIDI files of your favorite music on floppy disk from your local music s lop. The Internet is also full of MIDI
files, but beware that many of these infringe copyright and so are illegal.
You can use MIDI files as one way to transfer music between Sibelius and virtually any other music program. However,
MIDI files are designed for playing music back rather than notating and printing it. Hence they dont include lots of
280

MIDI for beginners

notational information, such as slurs, articulations and page layout. Even the distinction between F# and Gb is
ignored.
These restrictions mean that MIDI files are not a terrific way of transferring music notation from one computer
program to another, though its the only widely-used standard.
Fortunately, however, Sibelius does a good job of turning MIDI files into notation or vice versa in a matter of seconds;
LLI Opening MIDI files and Saving MIDI files. But dont expect miracles: converting a score into MIDI and
back again is rather like converting a complex text document to ASCII (plain text) format and back again - the basic
information is retained but layout and other niceties are lost.
If you want to convert music into Sibelius from Finale, Allegro, PrintMusic or SCORE, Sibelius can open these
programs files directly, which transfers much more information than can be done with MIDI files. To do this,
L&II Opening Finale, Allegro and PrintMusic files, and Opening SCORE files.

Reference

MIDI messages
EQI Playback dictionary
For advanced users only!
Creating MIDI messages in Sibelius
Should I use the dictionary or MIDI messages?
Syntax
Channel messages
Program and bank changes
Control changes
Pitch bend
After-touch
Modulation
Breath
Portamento

Volume
Pan
Expression
Sustain pedal
Soft pedal
Channel mode messages
NoteOn/NoteOff
System messages
Hiding MIDI messages
Further information

MIDI is that most rare of beasts, a standard set by a number of different manufacturers that is universally implemented
and supported. This sounds too good to be true, and it is, because in order to understand exactly how MIDI works,
you need to be able to speak Martian.
MIDI devices (such as your computers soundcard or your MIDI keyboard) send and receive MIDI messages, which
consist of a sfafus byte and one or two data bytes. MIDI bytes can have a decimal value of O-127. In order to be
device-independent, numbers in MIDI messages (including program numbers) always count from 0, even if your MIDI
devices manual counts from 1.

MIDI messages are classified either as channel messages, which affect a single channel (in Sibelius, this translates to
the staff to which they are attached), or system messages, which affect all channels (in Sibelius, all staves).
Channel messages carry the majority of the musical data (e.g. which notes to play, how long they should last, which
sound to use), while system messages are used for more technical things like synchronization with other MIDI devices.
Sibelius supports all MIDI messages (including control changes, pitch bend, SYSEX, and so on).
Creating MIDI messages in Sibelius
Because Sibelius reads almost all markings in your score and automatically turns them into appropriate MIDI
messages when playing back (LQ Playback), youll generally only need to enter channel messages manually in
Sibelius in very specific circumstances. These include changing the sound of a staff mid-way through a score, e.g.
when, say, a clarinetist doubles on saxophone in the same piece, or if you need to use a different sound for different
timbres on the same instrument, e.g. muted and unmuted. One way to do this is to define a new word in the playback
dictionary (ILL! Playback dictionary).
However, you can also tell Sibelius to send any MIDI message you like at any point, by typing it in as text using the
simple MIDI message commands described below. These MIDI messages can be appended to ordinary text and are
282

Cl

MIDI messages

hidden, so if you write 2nd time only -CT,0 in, say, a repeated section of your music, Sibelius will reset
controller 7 (volume) to zero to silence the staff at the exact point where 2nd time only appears on the printout. The
-C7,0 is automatically hidden (and will disappear completely if View ) Hidden Objects is switched off - so its a
good idea to switch this on before working with MIDI messages).
If you need to mute lots of staves, you can of course copy 2nd time only X7,0 using -\I-click or Alt-tclick to
save you retyping, or you can add it to the word menu obtained when you Control-click (Mac) or right-click
(Windows), and assign it a keyboard shortcut at the same time - L!ZN Text.
When you import a MIDI file, you can choose to have MIDI messages in the file written into your score, in which case
any control changes etc. will appear as if youd typed them in yourself.
Should I use the dictionary or MIDI messages?
Many situations are more conveniently dealt with using the playback dictionary. If you want to send a MIDI message
which is always associated with a particular word in your score, then just define it as a new word in the dictionary.
For instance, if you find yourself using 2nd time only a lot, you could just define 2nd time only to send a Velocity of
0, and you wont have to keep typing X7,0 all over the place.

,d
(5
3

:h
)e
II
0

Syntax
You can type MIDI messages into your score using any staff text style - typically Technique or Expression text. MIDI
messages can be written on their own, or put at the end of any other text (such as mute).
Messages take the form: - followed by a single command letter, followed by one or more numbers, which are usually
separated by commas.
E.g. - C64,127
(- is informally called a tilde or swung dash, but the technical term is twiddle.)
Although using decimal (e.g. O-l 27) is the most human-readable way of specifying the values, some manuals for
MIDI devices specify values for MIDI messages in other ways, which can also be entered directly in Sibelius. Values can
be addressed in terms of seven decimal bits (preceded by b, e.g. bO 1 1 1 1010) or hexadecimal up to 7F (preceded
by h, e.g. hA8), but unless youre a computer, you wont want to think about this for too long.
Note that:
l

MIDI messages are case sensitive (i.e. you must type capitals or small letters as indicated) - so - BO,O is correct
but - bo,o wont work
Hex digits themselves (e.g. 9F) are case insensitive, but the h that precedes the digit must always be lower case
You can write multiple messages in the same piece of text, separated by a space ( r Return (on the main
keyboard), and with just one tilde at the start, e.g.: - P43 A65 C64,127
If you like you can also put spaces or Returns around commas and numbers.

Channel messages
Channel messages are split into two types: channel voice messages, which carry the musica data; and channel mode
messages, which affect how the MIDI device responds to the musical data.
283

Reference

Lets examine each of the channel messages in turn:


Program and bank changes
A program change controls which sound is used to play a particular note. Sibelius automatically sends the correct
program change for each staff, as set in the Play b Mixer dialog, when it starts playing. However, if you want to
change the sound a staff uses midway through your score, you can use a program change message.
Sibelius also allows you to change the bank and program in the same MIDI message. If your playback device only
supports General MIDI sounds, youll never need to use a bank and program change together, but if it has a wider
selection of sounds (such as General MIDI 2 or Roland N-1080), you may want to use a sound from a different bank.
There are three kinds of program change message, as follows:
l

Program change only: -P program e.g. - P76


Program and bank change, sending bank number:
-P bank,program e.g. - P24,76
Program and bank change, specifying MSB and LSB for bank number:
- P /MW,N?,program, e.g. - P64,2,36

(For an explanation of MSB and LSB, IEI Bank numbers in Playback dictionary.)
In all of the above cases, the value of program assumes your MIDI device counts program numbers from 0 rather
than 1 (IL!2 MIDI for beginners). If your MIDI device counts from 1, use -p instead of -P.
With a message in the form - P bank,program, only the LSB is sent if bunk is less than 128. If bunk is greater than
128, MSB and LSB are sent according to the formula bunk = (MSB x 128) + LSB.
With a message of the form - P M.SB,LSB,progrum, if you specify a value of -1 for either MSI? or I%, that byte will
not be sent; this allows you to specify sending just the MSB or LSB (if you dont want to send either, just use a simple
program change).

You can find out whether your device counts from 0 or 1 and the values for MSB and I% in its documentation. MSB
and LSB may also be listed as Coarse and Fine, or CC (Control Change) 0 and 32, respectively.
This is quite a lot to get your head around, so lets take a couple of examples:
Lets say that we want to change the sound of one of our staves to that of a dogs bark midway through our score,
using the Roland SC-88 sound module. The SC-88 manual lists Dog, PC = 124, CC00 = 001'. Roland devices count
program numbers from 1 (since their manuals list the first GM sound, Acoustic Grand Piano, as program number 1).
The SC-88 is peculiar in that it can do weird things according to the LSB. It uses this to determine whether Roland SC55 compatibility mode is used (which is mostly the same as the SC-88 but has fewer sounds available). For this
reason, the LSB should not&ally be 0, and the MSB determines the bank to use.
To change to a dog sound mid-score, enter -p 1 ,0,124, -p 128,124 or - Pl ,0,123 - each of these does

exactly the same thing. You could also define a word in the playback dictionary to do the same thing: add an entry
dog, and specify Patch to be 123 and Bank to be 128.

284

MIDI messages

:t
3

By contrast, devices which use Yamahas XC standard keep the MSB constant (at 0) and change the LSB according to
the type of variant of the basic bank 0 sound (e.g. LSB 1 = panned, 3 = stereo, etc.). Program numbers count from 1.
To access the sound PianoStr (bank JO), a variant of the basic piano sound (bank 0 program 1) use -pO,40,1.
Control changes
Control changes are used to control a wide variety of functions in a MIDI device. Although the function of each control
change is clearly defined, not all MIDI devices support every control change. These are split up into groups, including:
l

Control changes O-31 : data from switches, modulation wheels, faders and pedals on the MIDI device (including
modulation, volume, expression, etc.)
Control changes 32-63: optionally send the LSB for control changes O-31 respectively
Control changes 64-67: switched functions (i.e. either on or off) such as portamento, sustain pedal, damper
(soft) pedal, etc.
Control changes 91-95: depth or level of special effects such as reverb, chorus, etc.
Control changes 96-101: used in conjunction with control changes 6 and 38 (Data Entry), these can be used to
edit sounds
Control changes 121-l 27: channel mode messages (see Channel mode messages below).

The syntax for control changes is -CbyteI,byte2, where byte1 is the number of the control change (from O-127) and
byte2 is the control value (also from O-127).
For full details of the control changes supported by your MIDI device, consult the manufacturers manual.
The most commonly used control changes are as follows:
Pitch bend
Pitch bend normally allows you to alter the pitch of a note by up to a whole step (tone) up or down, although there
are a couple of ways to increase this range - see below.
The syntax of pitch bend is - BO,bend-by, e.g. - B0,96.
Bend-by is a number between 0 and 127, where each integer represents 1/32nd of a half-step (semitone). - B0,64
produces a note at its written pitch; values lower than 64 flatten the note, and values higher than 64 sharpen it. To
make a note sound one half-step (semitone) higher than written, use -B0,96; to make it sound one half-step
(semitone) lower, use - B0,32.
You could, for example, use this control change to make a note play back sharp or flat without adding an accidental,
e.g. if you want to make dicta - editorial accidentals above the staff - play back, you can insert the accidental from the
Create h symbol dialog, and then use a MIDI message of e.g. - B0,96 to play the note a semitone sharp. Dont
forget to use - B0,64 to return the channel to its normal tuning on the next note! This is, in fact, what the Add
Ficta Above Note plug-in does for you - l!!ZJ Plug-ins.
You can also use the pitch bend control change to create a portamento or glissando effect by creating a number of
MIDI messages one after another. Note that the pitch bend does not last for just one note - it remains indefinitely, so
you usually put a pitch bend in the opposite direction on the next note to revert to normal pitch.

285

Reference

If you want finer control over the pitch bend, you can change the initial byte, also in the range O-127, to give very
small deviations in temperament (l/l 28 x 32 half-steps) e.g. -B 127,64 will sharpen the written note by a small
amount.
To create a pitch bend effect over an interval wider than a whole step (tone), you can either use the portamento

control change (see Control changes below) to make a pitch bend, or use the following method:
l

First, set up the range over which the pitch bend can operate: insert the MIDI messages -Cl 01,O Cl 00,O
CG,ha/f-steps in your score, where ha/f-steps is the total range of the pitch bend in half-steps (semitones), from
O-l 2. For example, to set up pitch bend with a maximum range of an octave, use X6,1 2. (Its best to put
these messages at the start of your score.)
When you want to add a pitch bend to your score, insert a -BO,bend-by command as usual, except that now
you must divide the bend-by parameter into the number of half-steps (semitones) set up with your 46
command, e.g. if you entered X6,1 2, each half-step (semitone) adds or subtracts 5.3 (64 divided by 12) to
bend-by. So to bend upwards by four half-steps (semitones), you would enter - B0,85.

Note that this method requires that your MIDI device supports standard Registered Parameter Messages (RPMs),
which is common but not universal. If you intend to use other RPMs in the same score, you should remember to
close the parameters, by adding -C 10 1,127 N Cl 00,127 after the - CG,ha/f-steps message.
Aftertouch
After-touch refers to the amount of pressure used when e.g. a key on a MIDI keyboard is pressed. This information can
be used to control some aspects of the sound produced by the synthesizer, e.g. vibrato on a violin sound. The precise
effect of this controller is dependent on the sophistication of the MIDI device used.
After-touch can be applied either to a particular note @o/yphonlc aftertouch), or to all notes on a channel (channel
afierfouch). Polyphonic after-touch is not as widely implemented in MIDI devices as channel aftertouch.
The syntax is as follows:
l

Channel after-touch: -Apressure e.g. -A64


Polyphonic after-touch: -a pitchpressure e.g. - a60,64

Modulation
Control change 1 controls the vibrato wobble generated by a modulation wheel. For lots of wobble, use -Cl, 127;
for no wobble, use -Cl ,O.
Breath
Control change 2 is only recognized by certain MIDI devices, such as wind synthesizers, and corresponds to the
breath pressure used to play a note.
Portamento
Portamento is a smooth glide from one note to another (rather like a glissando played on a trombone). This effect is
actually controlled by two control changes: -C5,0-127 controls the length of time taken to perform the portamento
(0 is fastest, 127 is slowest), and - C84,0-727 determines the distance of the portamento (values below 60 start
below the note, values above 60 start above the note; the precise interval depends on the MIDI device).
266
---

---

---

_-

--

MIDI messages

So you must first set up the portamento effect with a -C5 message, and then attach the - C84 message to the
note on which the portamento occurs.
Note that this control change is not supported by all MIDI devices.
Volume
Control change 7 determines the volume of a given note, e.g. - C7,127 is the loudest and - C7,O is the softest.
Note that, in MIDI, volume is not the same as velocity. Velocity is set when the note is played (part of the NoteOn
message - see above), and is analogous to, for example, how hard you strike a note on the piano. Sophisticated MIDI
devices will play the same pitch with a different timbre depending on the velocity of the note. Volume, on the other
hand, is like an overall volume control knob on an amplifier. So a trumpet playing a fortissimo note (i.e. with a high
velocity) but with low volume still sounds like a trumpet playing fortissimo but with the volume turned down.
The faders in the Play ) Mixer window change the volume controller to balance the volume of staves in the score.
You should only need to enter this MIDI message manually in your score if you want to achieve a change of dynamic
over the course of a held note - the Cresc./Dim. Playback plug-in enters these messages for you (QZ! Plugins).
Pan
Control change 10 determines the pan position of a particular channel, e.g. -Cl 0,O is absolute left, -Cl 0,64 is
center, and -Cl 0,127 is absolute right.
You dont need to use this MID I message unless you need to change the pan position of an instrument during
playback - the initiaI pan position is set in the Play ) Mixer d ialog.
Expression
Control change 11 takes a fraction of the channel volume specified by controller 7, so - Cl 1,127 uses 1000/o of the
channel volume, -Cl 1,64 uses 50% of the channel volume, and so on. Functionally -C7 is intended to act
something like a volume knob and -Cl 1 a way of temporarily tweaking the main volume.
Sustain pedal
Sibelius automatically inserts MIDI messages for the sustain pedal if you use the Ped. lines from the Create h Line
dialog (!!!ZQ lines). However, if you want to make playback of your score sustain without using these lines, use
X64,127. Switch the pedal off again with -C64,0. Values between 0 and 127 produce half-pedaling on some
MIDI devices.
Soft pedal
Control change 67 simulates the effect of using the unu corda pedal on a piano: to switch on the soft pedal, use
X67,127; to switch it off, use - C67,O. Note that this control change does not work on all MIDI devices.
Channel mode messages
Youll probably never need to use control changes 121-127 in Sibelius, but just in case:
l

-Cl 2 1 : reset all controllers

-C 122: Local Control on/off


287

Reference
a

N Cl 24-l 27: Omni mode on/off, Mono/Poly mode

NoteOn/NoteOff
These messages control which pitch is played, how loud the note is, and how long it lasts for. You should never need
to use these messages in Sibelius, because you can make notes play just by inputting notes (and hiding them if
appropriate).
However, for completeness sake, they can be entered in the form: - Nnote, velocity for NoteOn, and - Onofe, ve/ocit!y
for NoteOff. (You must insert a NoteOff message, or your note will sound forever!)
note is the MIDI key number (e.g. 60 is middle C) and velocity is a value between 0 and 127 (127 is the loudest). With
NoteOff, many MIDI devices ignore the velocity but some interpret it as the abruptness with which the note is
released; if in doubt, use (say) 64.
System messages
These dont need a channel, so the staff they are attached to only determines which MIDI device they are sent to.
System messages are split into three types: system common messages, system real-time messages, and system
exclusive messages. Typically, only the latter are useful in Sibelius (the first two are largely connected with
synchronizing MIDI with clock-based MIDI components, which is unsupported by Sibelius).
System exclusive messages are used to send data that is specific to the particular MIDI device you are using, and they
may vary from device to device.
To enter system messages in your score:
l

System common/system real time: use raw data (below)


System exclusive: -X bytes e.g. -Xh40, boo, hf7. Note that normally you should put hf-/ at the end to
terminate the system exclusive, unless youre going to follow it with a D command containing more data.
Raw data (without any command byte): - Dbytes e.g. - Dh40, boo, h7f

Hiding MIDI messages


Any text that begins with a tilde (-) is automatically hidden by Sibelius, so you dont need to worry about hiding MIDI
messages individually. Only the - and the messages after it are hidden, so you can still read preceding instructions to
the players such as mute which are meant to be visible. When you edit the text the - message reappears.
The MIDI messages are displayed in gray if View ) Hidden Objects (shortcut 718fH or Ctrl+Ak+H) is
switched on.
Further information
If this topic hasnt exhausted your appetite for strings of letters and numbers, you can find more information on MIDI
messages at this web site:
http://www.harmony-centraI.com/MIDI/

288

MIDI setup for Mac

MIDI setup for Mac


ler need
them if
velocitty
t). With
note is

).
system
1 with
j they

LB MIDI devices, MIDI for beginners.


Connecting MIDI devices to your Mac
Connecting MIDI devices directly
Connecting MIDI devices via a MIDI interface
Installing OMS or FreeMlDl (Classic Mac OS only)
Deciding what to install
Setting up QuickTime Music
Compatible MIDI interfaces

Using OMS and FreeMlDl in Sibelius


Setting up OMS
Setting up FreeMlDl
Setting up FreeMlDl in OMS compatibility mode
Using FreeMlDl Patch lists in OMS. . .
Setting up FreeMlDl and OMS separately

Because Classic Mac OS doesnt have built-in support for MIDI devices, if you have external MIDI devices (keyboards,
sound modules, etc.), you need to install and configure extra software to tell music programs like Sibelius what MIDI
devices are connected to your Mac and what sounds they can play.
On Classic Mac OS, there are three steps to setting up your MIDI devices: connecting the hardware, installing the
necessary software, and then setting up MIDI in Sibelius. This topic takes you through the first two steps; for the final
step, E!Il MIDI devices.
If youre using Mac OS X, you dont need to install any additional software - so simply connect your MIDI devices as
described below, then LA2 MIDI devices to find out how to set up MIDI in Sibelius.

Id to

Connecting MIDI devices to your Mac


How your MIDI devices connect to your computer depends on a number of factors, including the model of your Mac,
the model of your MIDI devices, and which other hardware you already have connected; but in general there are two
kinds of connection:
l

) is

If you have an iMac, a blue-and-white G3 tower, a G4 tower, G4 cube or PowerBook G4, you connect external
devices via USB.
If you have an older beige PowerMac, or a PowerBook G3, you connect MIDI devices via the modem or printer
ports (also known as serial ports).

In both cases, you have the choice of connecting a MIDI device such as a sound module either directly (to the USB or
serial ports), or via a MIDI interface.
Connecting MIDI devices directly
Many sound modules and MIDI keyboards can be connected directly to your computer without using a separate MIDI
interface.
For example, a Roland SC-88 Pro can be connected to an older PowerMacs modem or printer port via a serial cable,
but if you want to connect an SC-88 Pro to a new iMac or G4 with USB, youll need to use an external MIDI interface.
The newer Roland SC-8820 connects directly via USB or a serial connection, so no MIDI interface is required when
connecting it to any Mac.
289

Reference

The diagram below shows h ow to connect a sound module (shown) or MIDI keyboard to an iMac directly.
B

In Out Thru

audio cable

Note that there is normally a switch on the back of t.he sound module whit:h determines which of the connections it
should send and receive data through, so ensure that this is set correctly (in the above case, it should be set to USS).
You may have to switch your sound module or keyboard off and on again to make it take notice of changing this
setting.
Check your module or keyboards manual for precise connection details. Note that direct connections often require
additional driver software, which will be supplied by your devices manufacturer.
Connecting MIDI devices via a MIDI interface
A MIDI interface is a small box that connects to your Mac via the USB port (or the serial port on older PowerMacs),
providing one or more MIDI inputs and outputs.
Connect a sound module to an iMac using a MIDI interface like this:

Sound module

audio cable

Note that the MIDI cable is connected from the Out socket on the MIDI interface to the In socket on the sound
module.
To add a MIDI keyboard or other input device, you should connect your devices as shown below:

290

MIDI setup for Mac

M/D/ interface

9.
iis

Speakers or
amplifier via
audio cable

In Out

; it

re

i
[.!II\
MIDI keyboard

Note that the second MIDI cable goes from the Out socket on the keyboard to the In socket on the MIDI interface.
MIDI interfaces usually require additional driver software, which will be supplied by your devices manufacturer.
Installing OMS or FreeMID (Classic Mac OS only)
A typical MIDI studio is complicated, with multiple MIDI devices attached to one or more MIDI interfaces - for
example, a sound module and MIDI keyboard connected to a MIDI interface plugged into the printer, modem or USB
ports on your computer.
If you install FreeMlDl or the Open Music System (OMS) then this is made simple: your music programs show a list of
the devices (e.g. in Sibeliuss Play b Devices dialog) and the sounds they can play (in Sibeliuss Play b Mixer
dialog).
Please note that both FreeMlDl and OMS are licensed from other companies, and as such are not a part of Sibelius.
For more information:
l

FreeMlDl - licensed from Mark of the Unicorn, Inc. (www.motu.com)


OMS - licensed from Opcode Systems, Inc. (www.opcode.com)

Deciding what to install


If you dont have any external MIDI devices, you dont need to install OMS or FreeMIDI. Sibelius can play
reasonable quality sounds through your Macs speakers instead using QuickTime - EJJl Setting up
QuickTime Music below.
l

If your MIDI devices are connected to an OMS-compatible MIDI interface, !&!I Setting up OMS below.
If your MIDI devices are connected to a FreeMIDI-compatible MIDI interface, ILL!2 Setting up FreeMlDl
below.
If you are using FreeMIDI-compatible programs and OMS-compatible programs simultaneously, m Setting
up FreeMlDl in OMS compatibility mode below.
If you are using FreeMlDl-compatible programs and OMS-compatible programs but never simultaneously,
L!AI Setting up FreeMlDl and OMS separately below.
291

--

Reference

Setting up QuickTime Music


If you do not have any external devices, Sibelius will use QuickTime Music to play back your scores. QuickTime Music
is a built-in extension of the Mac operating system that synthesizes sound through your Mac speakers, using the
Roland Sound Canvas General MIDI sound set. It should be installed by default, but if it isnt listed as a device under
the Devices dialog in Sibelius, re-enable it from the Extensions Manager (under Control Panels in the
Apple menu).
If you dont have QuickTime or need to update your copy (Sibelius requires version 4 or later), go to
www.apple.com/quicktime to download an update.
Compatible MIDI interfaces
MIDI interfaces that support FreeMlDl include: MOTU 1296, MOTU 24i, MOTU 308, MOTU 1224, MOTU 2408, MTP
AV USB, MIDI Express XT USB, Micro Express USB, Fastlane USB.
MIDI interfaces that only support OMS include: Roland Super MPU64, Roland UM series, and MlDlMan MlDlSport 2x2
USB.
Using OMS and FreeMlDl in Sibelius
OMS and FreeMlDl recommend you switch off virtual memory when using them - choose the Memory
Control Panel from the Apple menu to toggle this. To make sure, Sibelius refuses to use FreeMlDl if virtual
memory is switched on.
l

If you have both OMS and FreeMlDl installed, Sibelius assumes by default that you want to use FreeMlDl
(because you can always use FreeMlDl compatibility mode to use OMS from FreeMIDI).
When using OMS or FreeMlDl a submenu called OMS or FreeMlDl appears in the Play menu. The OMS
menu contains options MIDI Setup, Studio Setup and Panic. The FreeMlDl menu contains Interface
Settings, Edit Configuration and Panic. Panic silences all the sounds, similar to Play b All Notes
Off. The other menu options take you to setup features in OMS and FreeMlDl that are also available in those
programs directly. Note that when using FreeMlDl in OMS compatibility mode, the FreeMlDl options are shown.

Setting up OMS
Install OMS by double-clicking on the Install OMS icon and following the on-screen instructions
l

292

Connect your OMS-compatible MIDI interface to the serial or USB port of your Mac and install any necessary
drivers (refer to the documentation that came with:your MIDI interface for details). Ensure that any MIDI/Thru
switches are in the MIDI position, and that all MIDI devices are switched on.
Locate and open the OMS Setup program
The Create a New Studio Setup dialog appears. Click OK.
Click the checkboxes to select the port (modem and/or printer) to which your MIDI interface is connected. USB
MIDI interfaces will be detected regardless of these settings.
Click Search. OMS will now search for MIDI interfaces connected to your computer.
A list of the MIDI interfaces connected to your computer will be displayed. If this list is correct, click OK. If MIDI
interfaces that you have connected to your computer are not detected, refer to OMSs troubleshooting
information.

MIDI setup for Mac


l

sic
he
er
ie

OMS will now attempt to detect devices (keyboards, modules, samplers, etc.) that are connected to your MIDI
interface. A list of devices or MIDI ports will appear. Click on the checkboxes next to each of the devices or ports
that you wish to use, then click OK.
You will now be presented with a standard Mac OS Save dialog. Name your configuration, choose a
convenient place on your hard drive and click Save.
Your studio configuration will now be displayed. Check that the on-screen MIDI connections are the same as
your studios physical connections. Device information (manufactur E:r, model, name, properties, receive
channel(s) and icon) can be edited by double-clicking on the device/M DI Interfaces icon To connect devices,
drag them to a MIDI interface, and click once on the in/out arrows
When you have completed the setup, choose Save from the File men1
Quit OMS Setup
Run Sibelius
Set up the Devices dialog as detailed in a MIDI devices.

Setting up FreeMlDl
Install FreeMlDl by double clicking on the Install FreeMlDl icon and following the on-screen instructions
Connect your FreeMIDI-compatible MIDI interface to the serial or USB port of your Mac
Locate and open the FreeMlDl Setup program
If you have OMS installed on your computer, you will be asked whether you wish to use OMS or FreeMIDI.
Choose FreeMlDl (this can be changed later from Preferences in the File menu within FreeMlDl
Setup).
The Welcome to FreeMlDl dialog appears. Click Continue.
The FreeMlDl Preferences dialog appears. Ensure that only Allow other applications and Always
load at startup are switched on. Click OK to continue.
The About Quick Setup dialog appears. Click Continue.
You will now see the Quick Setup window. In the New Device section of the Quick Setup dialog
specify the Manufacturer, Model, Studio Location (the name of the MIDI interface to which the device
is connected) and Cable (the port to which the device is connected to if the specified MIDI interface has
multiple ports). Click Add after specifying each device to add it to the Current Configurations list.
When you have specified the relevant information for each of your MIDI devices, click Done. Make sure
Controller is selected in Properties if the device is to be used as an Input Device.
l

Your studio configuration will now be displayed. Check that the on-screen MIDI connections are the same as
your studios physical connections. Device / MIDI Interface information (name, ID, manufacturer, model,
transmit channel(s), receive channel(s), properties and icons) can be edited by double-clicking on the device /
MIDI Interfaces icon.
Choose Save from the File menu. Name your configuration and save it in a convenient place on your hard
drive.
Quit FreeMIDI Setup
Run Sibelius
Set up the Devices dialog as detailed in a MIDI devices.
293

Reference

Setting up FreeMlDl in OMS compatibility mode


Install FreeMlDl by double-clicking on the install FreeMlDl icon and following the on-screen instructions
l

Install OMS by double-clicking on the Install OMS icon and following the on-screen instructions
Connect your FreeMlDl or OMS compatible MIDI interface to the serial or USB port of your Mac
Locate and open the OMS Setup program
The Create a New Studio Setup dialog appears. Click OK.
Click the checkboxes to select the port (modem and/or printer) to which your MIDI interface is connected. USB
MIDI interfaces will be detected regardless of these settings.
Click Search. OMS will now search for MIDI interfaces connected to your computer.
A list of the MIDI interfaces connected to your computer will be displayed. If this list is correct, click OK. If MIDI
interfaces that you have connected to your computer are not detected, refer to FreeMIDls troubleshooting
information.
OMS will now attempt to detect devices (keyboards, modules, samplers, etc.) that are connected to your MIDI
interface. A list of devices or MIDI ports will appear. Click on the checkboxes next to each of the devices or ports
that you wish to use. Click OK
You will now be presented with a standard Mac OS Save dialog. Name your configuration, choose a
convenient place on your hard drive and click Save
Your studio configuration will now be displayed. Check that the on-screen MIDI connections are the same as
your studios physical connections. Device information (manufacturer, model, name, properties, receive
channel(s) and icon) can be edited by double clicking on the device / MIDI Interfaces icon. To connect devices,
drag them to a MIDI interface, and click once on the in/out arrows
When you have completed the setup, choose Save from the File menu
Quit OMS Setup
Locate and open the FreeMlDl Setup program
You will be asked whether you wish to use OMS or FreeMIDI. Choose OMS. To change this later you will
need to quit Sibelius, locate and run the FreeMlDl Setup program, open FreeMlDl Preferences (File
menu) and switch on Use OMS when available. Quit FreeMlDl and run Sibelius.
A dialog will appear informing you that FreeMlDl is in OMS compatibility mode. Click OK to continue. Your
OMS Studio Setup will be displayed. Quit the FreeMlDl Setup program.
Open Sibelius.
Set up the Devices dialog as detailed in I22 MIDI devicks.

Using FreeMlDl Patch lists in OMS when using FreeMlDl in OMS compatibility mode
If you are using FreeMlDl in OMS compatibility mode, no sound names will be listed in Sibelius Play b Mixer dialog
(shortcut M). For the correct patch names to be displayed, OMS must use FreeMlDl patch lists (the equivalent of
Sibeliuss sound set files). To do this, Mark of the Unicorn recommends the following:
l

294

Quit FreeMlDl Setup and OMS Setup


Locate the Factory Names folder found in the OMS Folder within your System folder

MIDI setup for Mac

Open the Factory Names folder, and remove the contents (you may want to back up the contents of this
folder, or simply delete them)
l

Open the OMS Preferences folder (in the OMS Folder) and delete the file OMS Name Manager
Prefs
Launch OMS Setup, delete visible OMS Devices, and reconfigure the OMS Setup following the instructions
in Setting up OMS above
When adding devices in OMS, be sure to choose from the list of Manufacturers and Models. If your device is not
listed, assign a similar device, and modify its name to match your device (e.g. change 'IV-1080' to 'IV-2080').
After completing your OMS Setup, choose Save and Make Current from the File menu
Run FreeMlDl Setup
Open the FreeMlDl Preferences window (File menu), and choose Use OMS when available from
the Software Compatibility section. You may need to quit and launch FreeMlDl again so FreeMlDl opens
using OMS setup.
The same OMS setup above will appear in FreeMIDI. More importantly, the FreeMlDl patch list will remain
intact.
This trick only works when a FreeMlDl program is using the OMS setup. This method does not publish patch
lists directly into OMS to use with software like ProTools, Studio Vision, Cubase and some other OMS
compatible software.

Setting up FreeMlDl and OMS separately


Install FreeMlDl by double-clicking on the Install FreeMlDl icon and following the on-screen instructions
l

Install OMS by double-clicking on the Install OMS icon and following the on-screen instructions
Connect your FreeMIDI- or OMS-compatible MIDI interface to the serial or US6 port of your Mac
Locate and run the OMS Setup program
The Create a New Studio Setup dialog appears. Click OK.
Click the checkboxes to select the port (modem and / or printer) to which your MIDI interface is connected. USB
MIDI interfaces will be detected regardless of these settings.
Click Search. OMS will now search for MIDI interfaces connected to your computer.
A list of the MIDI interfaces connected to your computer will be displayed. If this list is correct, click OK. If MIDI
interfaces that you have connected to your computer are not detected, refer to OMSs troubleshooting
information.
OMS will now attempt to detect devices (keyboards, modules, samplers, etc) that are connected to your MIDI
interface. A list of devices or MIDI ports will appear. Click on the checkboxes next to each of the devices or ports
that you wish to use. Click OK.
You will now be presented with a standard Mac OS Save dialog. Name your configuration, choose a
convenient place on your hard drive and click Save.
Your studio configuration will now be displayed. Check that the on-screen MIDI connections are the same as
your studios physical connections. Device information (manufacturer, model, name, properties, receive
channel(s) and icon) can be edited by double clicking on the device / MIDI Interfaces icon. To connect devices,
drag them to a MIDI interface, and click once on the in/out arrows.
295

Reference

When you have completed the setup, choose Save from the File menu
Quit OMS Setup
Locate and run the FreeMlDl Setup program
You will be asked whether you wish to use OMS or FreeMIDI. Choose FreeMlDl (this can be changed later
from Preferences in the File menu within FreeMlDl Setup).
The Welcome to FreeMlDl dialog appears. Click Continue.
The FreeMlDl Preferences dialog will appear. Ensure that only Allow other applications and
Always load at startup are checked. Click OK to continue.
The About Quick Setup dialog appears. Click Continue.
You will now see the Quick Setup window. In the New Device section of the Quick Setup dialog specify
the Manufacturer, Model, Studio Location (the name of the MIDI interface to which the device is
connected) and Cable (the port to which the device is connected to if the specified MIDI interface has multiple
ports). Click Add after specifying each device to add it to the Current Configurations list.
When you have specified the relevant information for each of your MIDI devices click Done. Make sure
Controller is selected in Properties if the device is to be used as an Input Device.
Your studio configuration will now be displayed. Check that the on-screen MIDI connections are the same as
your studios physical connections. Device / MIDI Interface information (name, ID, manufacturer, model,
transmit channel(s), receive channel(s), properties and icons) can be edited by double clicking on the
device/MIDI Interfaces icon
Choose Save from the File menu. Name your con figuration and save it in a convenient place on your hard
drive
Quit FreeMlDl Setup
Run Sibelius
Set up the Devices dialog as detailed in I!22 MID I devices.

296

MIDI setup for windows

MIDI setup for windows


LQ MIDI devices, MIDI for beginners.
There are three steps to setting up your MIDI devices: connecting the hardware, installing the necessary software, and
then setting up MIDI in Sibelius. This topic takes you through the first two steps; for the final step, IL!2 MIDI
devices.
Connecting MIDI devices to your computer
How your MIDI devices connect to your computer depends on a number of factors, including the model of your
computer, the model of your MIDI devices, and which other hardware you already have connected, but in general
there are two kinds of connection:
l

You can connect an external MIDI device directly to the gameport (or joystick port) on your computers
soundcard
You can connect a separate MIDI interface to either a USB port or a serial port on the back of your computer.

Most Windows computers are supplied with a soundcard, which is capable both of General MIDI playback and also of
connecting your computer to external MIDI devices via the gameport.
Connecting MIDI devices via the gameport
In general, you wont need to buy a separate MIDI interface for your computer, provided you have a soundcard that
supports full duplex operation (check with the manufacturer), and you dont need to use more than 16 MIDI
channels at once.
Using your soundcards gameport also has the advantage of not requiring any further driver software - you can just
plug in your MIDI device, and away you go.
The gameport is usually found next to the sockets used to connect speakers and microphones to your computer.
Typically, it will be on the soundcard, which looks something like this:

The gameport is the rectangular connector at the far left. To connect this to an external MIDI device, youll need a Yshaped MIDI-to-gameport cable, which looks something like this:

297

Reference

Note how the two MIDI plugs are labeled In and Out. To connect this cable to, say, a MIDI keyboard, you should
connect the plug labeled In to the socket on the back of the keyboard marked Out, and the plug labeled Out to the
socket on the keyboard marked In.
Thats all there is to it. Provided you have the In and Out plugs in the right sockets on your MIDI keyboard (or sound
module), you can now finish setting things up - ILLI MIDI devices.
Connecting MIDI devices via a MIDI interface
You might need a separate MIDI interface if:
l

your soundcard doesnt support full duplex operation (e.g. if you find that Sibelius plays back through your
external MIDI device, but youre unable to play music into Sibelius from your external device); or if
you want to send data on more than the standard 16 MIDI channels (e.g. if you have a keyboard or sound
module that supports 32 channels).

A MIDI interface is a small box that sits between your computer and your external MIDI devices, sending MIDI data
back and forth. MIDI interfaces either connect to a serial port (also known as a modem or comms port, addressed by
Windows as e.g. COMl : and COM2:) or to a USB port.
Note that MIDI interfaces usually require additional driver software, which will be supplied by your devices
manufacturer.
Well assume your MIDI interface connects via USB, and show you some common
MIDI setups. Note that connections between MIDI devices all use standard MIDI
cables, pictured on the right.
To plug in just a MIDI keyboard, connect its Out socket to the MIDI interfaces In socket. This means that music
played on the keyboard will go out of the keyboard, along the cable and ;n to the computer.
To make the computer play back music into the keyboard (e.g. if the keyboard has sounds built into it), also connect
the MIDI interfaces Out to the keyboards In.
If your keyboard has two In or Out sockets , it usually doesnt matter which you use - theyre just convenient
duplicates of each other.
So connecting up a keyboard alone looks like this:

OUT IN

L-_

MIDI interface

MIDI keyboard

If you want to connect just, say, a sound module, rather than a keyboard, simply connect the MIDI interfaces Out to
the sound modules In.
Once youve connected your MIDI devices to your computer, you can set up input and playback in Sibelius IL!3 MIDI devices.
298

Mixer

_rtd
he

Mixer
L!2 Playback, MIDI messages, Playback dictionary.
Staff
Device
Sound
Bank Hig h/Bank Low
Program
Channel
Distance

Volume
Pan
Click track
Mute
SoundStage
Improving playback with lots of instruments

For an explanation of MIDI terms used in this topic, E2 MIDI for beginners or the Glossary.
The Play b Mixer window contains the main options you need to modify sounds for playback. From the mixer you
can change the sound used by each staff in your score, adjust the balance of instruments for playback, and control the
SoundStage settings to position your computerized players in 3-D space.
You can leave the Play b Mixer window open while you work on your score and make changes to the playback
even as you listen, so the most realistic sounding performance of your score is only a few clicks away. lust type the
one-key shortcut M to show or hide the Mixer.
The window is split into two sections. The left-hand side of the window contains mixer controls for each staff; controls
for a maximum of five staves can be shown at once, so if your score contains more than that, you can scroll through
them with the arrows to the left and right of the mixer controls, and jump five staves at a time with the double arrow
buttons. The right-hand side of the dialog shows extra settings for the staff whose Edit button you have clicked.
The options in the window are as follows:
I

Solo and Mute control


whether the staff sounds

Fader changes the volume


of the staff in real time

299

m
$_

Reference

Each staff in your score (plus an extra click PO& - see Click track below) has its own set of controls, which work
even \Nhen the staff is not selected:
l

Volume fader: drag this up and down to alter the volume of the channel used by the staff. Like the other
settings, this works in real time, so you can change the volume of instruments while the score is playing back
and hear the difference instantly. If several staves share a MIDI channel, then the selected volume for one staff
will apply to all the staves sharing that channel.
Pan slider: directly above the volume fader, this horizontal slider allows you to change the pan (stereo) position
of the staff.
Mute: this button cycles through three levels of mute: muted, half-muted and unmuted. The button changes
color to show the current mute level: gray means unmuted, light blue means half-muted, and mid-blue means
totally muted. (The exception to this is the click track, which can only be totally muted or unmated.) Muting
staves has all kinds of informative and educational uses - see Mute below. If you change the Mute setting
while Sibelius is playing back your score, it may not take effect for a few bars.
Solo: clicking this button for a particular staff makes sure that the instrument is un-muted. Normally when a
staff is soloed, all the other staves are half-muted (and the click track is muted). Clicking the Solo button again
completely mutes all the other staves (the click track stays muted), and clicking the button once more unmutes
everything. If the other staves are already half-muted or totally muted, the Solo button cycles them onto the
next state in the sequence. If you Solo a track during playback, the change may not take effect for a few bars.

The Edit button at the bottom of the dialog above the short instrument name for the staff lights up blue when
you click it, and the controls on the right-hand side of the dialog are updated to show the settings for that staff.
All of the changes you make in the Play b Mixer window are fully undoable - just choose Edit b Undo (shortcut
XZ or Ctrl+Z) or click the toolbar button.
The controls at the right-hand side of the dialog are as follows:
Staff
Shows the full instrument name of the currently selected staff, so you can be sure you are changing t:he right one.
Device
Allows you to choose the playback device for the selected staff. The items on this list are the playback devices listed in
the Play b Devices dialog (LQ MIDI devices).
If you have more than one device to play back through (e.g. a soundcard and a MIDI keyboard), this specifies which
one the staff is going to use. You can generally leave this at the default setting, unless you specifically want a particular
staff or staves to play back on a different device.
If you are working on a score that was created using a different device than your own, the name of the original
playback device will be listed here. In order to make the score play back with the right sounds, you may t lave to click
a.\_.
Reset Sounds.

300

Prc
,
\

Cha
1
d
tt

___--

--

Mixer

I work

Sound
This gives a description of the sound (bank/program number combination) produced by the playback device youre
using. By default this will probably be similar to the name of the staff.

other
back
! staff

For instance, if your device is General MIDI compatible, then the default sound given to the Piano instrument is called
Acoustic Grand Piano, which describes program number 1 on bank 0. However, there are various other piano sounds
to choose from, such as Honky-Tonk Piano.

iition

To change the sound used by a staff, click the current sound to get a list of sounds available on your device. You can
check the chosen sound by clicking Test.

lges
!ans
ting
rng
a
lin
es
ie

The list of sounds can be formatted in four different ways - to change this, click Display and choose one of the
settings under List Sounds:
l

n
t

By Type: lists the sounds in groups of related sounds


By Bank: lists the sounds grouped by bank number (this isnt useful for General MIDI devices as there is only a
single bank)
By Program: lists the different sounds with the same program numbers in different banks (very useful for
General MIDI 2 devices, which have four banks, each containing variants on the 128 standard GM sounds)
By Instrument: lists the sounds by instrument family (e.g. woodwind, strings, brass, keyboards).

Bank High / Bank Low


In conjunction with Program, these two options allow you to specify the bank and program of any sound on your
MIDI device manually. Youll probably find it easier to adjust the Sound parameter instead, which does the same
thing.
Bank High represents MIDI controller 0 (also known as the MIDI bank select, MSB, or coarse controller), a number
in the range O-l 27. Bank Low represents MIDI controller 32 (also called LSB, or fine controller), also with a
range of O-l 27. If you dont want to set either or both of these MIDI controllers, set these options to Off using the
up/down arrows.
(Should you need to, you can suppress the sending of bank numbers globally, rather than for individual staves, from
the Play ) Playback Options dialog - EQ Playback.)
Program
Sets the program number for the selected staff. On some devices, this is counted from l-l 28; on other devices, it is
counted from O-l 27; this should automatically be set correctly for your device, but you can change how this is
displayed from the Display dialog using the List Program Numbers option.
Channel
This sets the MIDI channel. Sibelius sets MIDI channels to sensible values automatically (giving different staves
different channels). Only change MIDI channels if you know what youre doing, or if you have so many instruments
that you need to double some of them up on the same channel.
You can change which channel a staff is playing on, but the channel numbers are largely irrelevant because:

301

Reference
l

When you create instruments, Sibelius sets up the channels for you, going from 1 to 16 and then back to 1 again
(reserving channel 10 for unpitched percussion on General MIDI devices)
Most MIDI devices dont mind which channels you use for which staves
Even if two staves with different program numbers are set to the same channel, Sibelius resets the channels
sound whenever necessary so that conflicts seldom arise. On a lot of MIDI devices Sibelius will even succeed in
playing different timbres simultaneously on the same channel, which is supposed to be impossible!

Perhaps your only reason for ever changing a channel is if you notice the sounds going wrong when two staves set to
the same channel are playing different sounds at once. This situation could only happen:
l

if you create several staves for one instrument (which would give them the same channel number) and set them
to different sounds; or
if your score has more than 16 instruments, in which case some of the channels would be used by more than
one instrument.

The solution is to find separate staves which use the same sound on different channels (e.g. violin and viola, or two
trumpets), and set them to the same channel. This frees one of the channels. If this isnt possible, try to find two
instruments which never play simultaneously so they cant conflict, and set them to the same channel.
Note that on General MIDI-compatible devices, channel 10 is a special channel used only for unpitched percussion, so
dont use it for other instruments.
Distance
This percentage simply scales the overall reverb setting for each staff, so a staff set to a distance of 200% will have
twice as much reverb as other staves. This, coupled with the staffs volume (set by the volume fader), gives an
impression of distance: distant instruments are soft with lots of reverb, nearby instruments are loud with little reverb
(see Soundstage below).
So set the staffs distance to more or less than lOOo/o if the instrument is further or nearer than the average distance of
the ensemble. Values between about 60% and 140% would be sensible.
The overall reverb setting is controlled by the Play b Performance dialog (shortcut Shift-P) - LQ Playback.
Volume
The Volume control on the right-hand side of the Mixer is a numerical representation of the volume fader on the
left-hand side of the window; changing either the fader position or the numerical control updates the other. It allows
you to adjust the relative volume of each staff without having to write louder dynamics for loud instruments and softer
ones for soft instruments. In combination with Distance (see above), it also affects the apparent relative distance of
instruments from the listener.
Volume goes on a scale of O-127: 90 (furthest/softest) to 127 (nearest/loudest) is a normal range to use for
volumes.
Most devices play all instruments at roughly the same volume by default, so you should give (say) a complete Violin I
section a volume of maybe 127 so that they dominate a solo flute. Remember that 16 violins dont sound 16 times
louder than one!
302
L

____._--

1 again

lannels
teed in
s set to

It them
*e than
or two
Id two
on, so

have
es an
everb
Ice of

k.
the
lows
after
:e of

, for
h

llin I
nes

Try setting the volume of a keyboard left hand about


delicate.

20%

less than the right hand, which makes playback sound more

Although volume adjustments can achieve the same effect as Mute, we recommend you reserve Volume for
making fine adjustments to the volume level and Mute for basically switching instruments on and off.
Pan
Like Volume (see above), the Pan control on the right-hand side of the Mixer is a numerical representation of the
pan slider on the left-hand side of the window; changing either updates the other.
The pan (stereo) position of a staff is represented by a Pan number from -127 (full left) to 127 (full right). Pan
positions from (say) -70 to 70 give subtle and realistic effects - more extreme values can sound crude, because youd
be unlikely to have instruments literally on either side of you.
In keyboard music, setting the pan positions of the right and left hand to (say) 20 and -20 locates the listener
subconsciously in the middle of the keyboard, but you must set the two hands to play on different channels for this
to work. However, if each hand plays back on a different channel, then pedal markings (QZ!! lines) under the lower
staff will only apply to that staff, and not to both. So there is a trade-off between balancing the hands and playback of
pedal markings; decide which is more appropriate for your music.
Click track
Some music programs accompany playback with a metronome click; if you want Sibelius to do this, click Click in the
Play ) Mixer window and switch on the Click when playing option. The Click when recording option
switches the click on and off when using Flexi-time recording (EQ!l Flexi-time).
You can also change the Click when playing settings using the Mute button on the Mixer window itself.
You can also choose the percussion sounds used by the click track on the first beat of the bar and subsequent beats.
By default, Sibelius will play a higher woodblock sound on the first beat of the bar, and mark subsequent beats of the
bar with a low woodblock.
The Subdivide beats option is useful in some time signatures such as 6/8, where it will click lightly on every eighth
note (quaver). Stress irregular beat groups accents beats in the bar depending on the beat groups defined for
irregular time signatures such as 7/8 (LIibl Time signatures).
Note that GM devices require the click track to be set to channel 10 to give a percussion sound, but this is not always
true of other non-GM devices.
Mute
For the purposes of trying out individual instruments or groups of instruments, any staff can play back at full volume,
at half volume or be completely muted (silent). Simply click the Mute button for the staff in question to cycle through
the different mute settings.
A good use of this is to produce music minus one recordings: putting one instrument into the background helps
people learn their part from memory. Making a solo instrument totally silent is useful for practicing your own part
while Sibelius plays the accompaniment, or for playing back music written for bagpipe or accordion.

303

Reference

To play back just some of the instruments in the score, you can alternatively select the required instruments as a
passage before you play (Q2 Selections and passages). Note that if you play back a selection of staves in
your score, the Mute setting of those staves is ignored - so if youre working on a string quartet score and mute the
violin staff, but then select, say, that violin staff and a cello staff to play them both back, they will both sound. Sibelius
assumes that if you specifically select a staff to play it back, you actually want to hear it, even if its muted.
SoundStage
Because you have only two ears (probably), your brain works wonders at conjuring up a three-dimensional image
from just two sound sources. So the fact that your playback device can only play back in stereo is hardly a restriction,
as long as you can recreate the sounds that would go into your ears if live players were really in front of you. The
three-dimensional impression created by well-prepared stereo sound is sometimes called a soundstage - and
Sibeliuss SoundStage feature recreates this automatically.
Imagine you want to recreate the soundstage youd hear when in the audience of a concert hall, with an orchestra
playing on the stage. A number of factors come into play:
l

Each instrument is at a slightly different distance from you, and different parts have varying numbers of players.
This affects the relative volume of the instruments.
Each instrument is at a slightly different left-to-right position relative to you.
The acoustics of the building generate reverb, from which you can hear not only the size but also the shape of
the building.
Instruments which are closer to you produce less reverb than others. This is because more of their sound travels
directly to your ears rather than bouncing off the walls. (You can probably imagine this if you mentally compare
the dead sound of someone speaking on a normal telephone with the rather more echoey sound of a speakerphone.)
An instrument which is a long way off, such as an off-stage trumpet, sounds very reverberant because none of its
sound travels directly to your ears; conversely, however, the instrument sounds soft, so its volume is low.

You dont need to switch SoundStage on or off - its always on. Whenever you create instruments, Sibelius
automatically positions them in SD space for you as they would be on a concert stage - not only in stereo (i.e. with
suitable Pan positions), but also with subtle adjustments to the Volume and Distance settings to imitate how far
or near instruments are.
Sibeliuss SoundStage setting covers standard layouts for orchestra, brass band, choir and string ensemble - and work
well for just about any other combination, in fact.
Improving playback with lots of instruments
Playback can produce an organ-like effect with large numbers of instruments. This is a pain as its a giveaway that the
sound is synthetic instead of live.
There are four main causes of this problem, which are quite easy to avoid:
l

Incorrect balance. For instance, if you set all the volumes in an orchestral score to 100, you may find that some
instruments are too loud and others are swamped.
Not enough expression. Try setting the Espressivo option in the Play b Performance dialog (shortcut

Shift-P) to Espressivo or Molto espressivo. This will introduce gradations of volume which will help separate
304

--____-__-_ _ ~- _ ____ -

Mixer

3s a
s in
the
lius

the different lines of music, even in a large score. In general, the more instruments that are playing, the more
Espressivo you should add (ILL3 Espressivo).
l

ge

Phasing - an annoying badly-tuned-radio sound caused by two identical instruments playing the same sound in
unison. If two staves in your score often double one another, such as Violins I and 2, use hidden MIDI messages
to mute one of the staves while they are doubled. This should produce a significant improvement.
Not enough different pan positions. The ear will find it hard to separate the different instrumental sounds.
Change the pan positions accordingly.

n,
le
Id
a
.

--

305
-_
-i

Reference

Multirests
El Bars and bar rests.
A multirest is an abbreviation for several consecutive bars rest, with the number of bars written above. Multirests are
normally only found in instrumental parts, though they do very occasionally appear in full scores (e.g. Sibeliuss
Taplola, bars 28-29).
Using multirests
Multirests are really just a display option in Sibelius - you can view a file containing bars rest either as individual bar
rests or consolidated into multirests.
To display bar rests instantly as multirests, choose Layout ) Use Multirests (shortcut 4%gM or
Ctrl+Shift+M). Sibelius does this automatically for you when extracting parts.
Sibelius automatically splits multirests at time signatures, rehearsal marks, key changes, clef changes, tempo marks and
so on. If you need to split a multirest manually, see Forcing a multirest to split below.
Creating a multirest
Creating a multirest is the same as creating lots of single bars rest: choose Create ) Bar ) Other; type in the
Number of bars you want, click OK, then click where you want to put the multirest.
Alternatively, you can just copy an existing multirest using -c-click or Alt+click.
Inputting into a multirest
Multirests work just like normal bar rests - you can input notes into them, or copy music into them. As you input notes
into a multirest, Sibelius will strip bars off the front of it to put the notes into, and reduce the length of the multirest
accordingly.
Changing the length of a multirest
To adjust the number of bars in a multirest, switch off Layout ) Use Multirests to turn it back into separate bar
rests, then add or delete bars. Finally, switch on Layout ) Use Multirests again.
Forcing a multirest to split
If you need to force a multirest to split:
l

Switch off Layout ) Use Multirests


Select a barline and choose Layout ) Break ) Split Multirest; a double-slash will appear on the screen
above the barline (you can hide or show these marks by toggling the View ) Breaks and Locks option)
If you switch on Use Multirests again or extract parts, the multirest will now split at the chosen barline.

If after switching off Layout ) Use Multirests you select a passage and choose Layout ) Break ) Split
Multirest, the passage will be split at both ends to become a single multirest (when Use Multirests is switched
back on).
306

Multirests

Note that if there are any notes, text or other objects in the passage, they will split up the multirest anyway. However,
hidden objects will not force a multirest to split, so if a bar contains only hidden objects, it will quite happily disappear
inside a multirest.
are
JSS

Jar
or

Deleting a multirest
To delete a multirest entirely, %-click or Ctrl-click it to make a system passage (surrounded by a double blue box),
then hit Delete.
As with normal rests, just selecting a multirest and hitting Delete simply hides it. This leaves an empty gap which you
can (say) write text over, though Sibelius will still treat the gap as being several bars long.
Engraving Rules options
The Bar Rests page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut 68gE or Ctrl+Shift+E) has
various self-explanatory options.
Most notably, you can choose to notate multirests as H-bars, narrow H-bars (to leave space on either side for lastminute additions in session parts), in the old style of funny little rectangles, or completely blank (for annotations in
jazz parts).

e
H-bar

narrow H-bar

old style

blank

Parts often include a digit above all bar rests, whether they are a single bar or many bars in length. To draw 1 above
all single bar rests, switch on Use one bar multirests in the Bar rests page of the House Style )
Engraving Rules dialog. This option is also available when extracting parts - LI2 Extracting parts.
Another useful option on the Bar rests page is Draw H-bar using a symbol: this uses a stretched symbol
rather than drawing a rectangle to produce the thick bar of an H-bar. This option is switched off by default, but you
may want to switch it on when using the Inkpen font, as it will give multirests a handwritten appearance. (Beware
though that bugs in some printer drivers may make H-bars misprint or even possibly cause a crash when printing if
this option is switched on - so test to see whether it works with your printer before using it routinely.)
You can also edit the text style used to write the numbers above multirests, to change, for example, their vertical
position - LQ Edit Text Styles.

307

Reference

Music engraving
LQ House Style, layout and formatting, Note spacing, Staff spacing.
This topic summarizes the key principles of music engraving, the subtle art which underlies most of what Sibelius
does. Although this is only a very brief introduction to this huge subject, learning a little about it will improve the
appearance of your scores and help you to acquire an eye for good music engraving.
Brief history
Sibelius represents the latest stage of a tradition which is many centuries old. Music notation dates from the 12th
century, and music printing from the 15th century. Various methods that have been used to reproduce (engrave)
music include:
l

Hand copying
Plate engraving: cutting or stamping music directly onto printing plates using special tools. This high-quality but
extraordinarily laborious technique was the leading technology for centuries.
Moveable type: also widely used since the 15th century
Music typewriters, brushing ink through stencils, and Not-a-set - dry transfer symbols on a translucent sheet
(like Letraset) were also in use during the 20th century.

Music engraving technologies changed little in centuries; a hand-copyist writing out music for publication in 1990
would have been easily recognizable to a monk performing the same task in 1190.
But during the 1 Ws, computerization brought about a sudden and total revolution in music engraving, with Sibelius
playing a major part. In just a decade, the old technologies have been almost entirely abandoned (with the exception
of the oldest technology of all - writing out music by hand).
Even printing on paper is no longer an essential end result of music engraving, thanks to electronic publishing via the
Internet (I22 Internet publishing). History is in the making.
what music engraving is
Music engraving is the art of reproducing music notation clearly. It is rather like typography - just as typography is
about the design and positioning of letters and the layout of text on the page, music engraving governs the design and
positioning of musical symbols and the layout of music on the page.
Music engraving is nof the same as music notation - anyone who can read music knows about music notation, but
few musicians know about music engraving. Continuing the analogy with text, music notation is like spelling and
grammar - it says in general how to write music down, but not the specifics of exactly how and where to draw the
symbols; those crucial details are the domain of music engraving.
It takes considerable experience to be able to recognize and gauge the subtleties of music engraving. The trained eye
can easily tell which publisher a score is from, or which computer program or other method was used to produce it whereas to most musicians, the engraving of all scores looks much the same. (This is because good engraving should
be invisible to the untrained eye; engraving only sticks out when its badly done.)

308

Music engraving

This also means that music engraving is a highly refined art, concerned with subtleties many of which may seem
pedantic (and a few of which are). Fortunately Sibelius handles most of these subtleties automatically, so you dont
need to know about them.
1s

te

Engraving rules
There are few books on music engraving - it is a tradition which for centuries has been handed down mainly by word
of mouth, from master to apprentice. It is governed by hundreds of so-called engraving rules, many originating in the
19th century when music publishing attained a really high level of quality.
A set of engraving rules, together with things like music symbol designs, constitute a music publishers house style.
Though called engraving rules, most are actually just conventions, as few are used universally and even the most
respected publishers differ in the rules they adhere to. Nonetheless, engravers and publishers can become very
attached to the particular rules they use themselves, and protest bitterly that theirs are the best or even the only
correct ones.
Sibelius automatically applies hundreds of engraving rules to your score, some of which have never been formulated
before. It uses the most standard rules by default, and advanced users can adjust these to their taste from the House
Style b Engraving Rules dialog. Sibelius reformats your entire score in a tenth of a second whenever you change
it in any way - even if you make a drastic alteration such as changing the page size.
Even so, Sibelius is nof a perfect music engraver.
This is simply because engraving rules themselves are imperfect: some are too vague to computerize, and many dont
deal with all cases, sometime requiring adjustment by eye (i.e. to look right). Sometimes rules conflict, making it
necessary to break one rule in order to avoid breaking a more important one. These situations are best left to human
engravers to resolve; Sibelius can be no better than the engraving rules themselves. We can put this as an Aristotelian
syllogism:
l

Music engraving rules are imperfect (and sometimes need adjustment by eye)
Sibelius uses music engraving rules
Therefore Sibeliuss music engraving is imperfect (and sometimes needs adjustment by eye).

There are however a few universal rules, and one absolutely fundamental one:
Rule 1: Clarity
The music should look as clear as possible.
No other engraving rule can override this one; if something looks unclear, it is incorrect. Because of this, adjustments
to the dictates of engraving rules are often made by eye; and in the various situations for which no specific rule has
been formulated, the fallback is also to go by eye.
When you are more experienced at music engraving, you should expect to make quite a few adjustments to your
score by eye. But for now its sufficient to rely on Sibelius to follow the rules.
Why is clarity the fundamental rule? The purpose of music engraving is to enable you to read a score without
conscious thought, such as having to consider what a particular rhythm or chord is, which note a particular lyric,
dynamic or articulation applies to, and so on. By contrast, a poorly engraved (unclear) score can easily trip you up and
309

Reference

cause mistakes, particularly in sight-reading, without your quite knowing why. We have all come across scores like this
- even published ones.
Rule 2: Avoid collisions
When objects in music notation overlap they become hard to read, and unclear. So to avoid breaching Rule 1, you
should follow this second rule:
Avoid collisions between different objects.
Many engraving rules are effectively ways of avoiding collisions, and fortunately Sibelius incorporates most of these.
For example, when two voices cross, Sibelius displaces one to the left or right to avoid colliding with the other; when
writing long syllables in lyrics, Sibelius allows extra room for them by increasing the gap between the notes.
Even though Sibelius incorporates these rules, it cannot always avoid collisions, because there are not strict rules for
how to resolve all collisions - in tight situations the engraving may have to be reorganized by eye to fit an object in.
For example, if a dynamic collides with the stem of a note, you may want to move the dynamic left or right or possibly
into the staff, depending on how clear these would look; or in a very tight situation you may even decide to leave the
dynamic where it is, and shorten the stem instead.
Such high-level decisions cannot be formulated into rules, and so they are your responsibility to resolve, not Sibeliuss.
Even though you may not be an experienced music engraver, you should nonetheless remove any collisions which
occur.
A few types of collision are permitted as they are almost unavoidable and arent particularly unclear. The main ones
are ties, slurs and hairpins crossing a barline which joins two staves. Slurs are also permitted to go into staves, though
text and most lines and symbols are not (except in very tight situations).
Units
The main unit of music engraving is the space, which is the distance between adjacent staff lines. This unit is relative
rather than absolute because everything in music is in proportion to the staff size; the absolute size of notes, text etc. is
less important. (Sibelius even uses a relative rather than absolute point size for text.) Almost all engraving rules use
spaces as their unit; inches and millimeters are only really relevant when deciding page and margin sizes.
Horizontal layout: note spacing
The horizontal layout of music is basically about note
spacing. There are lots of objects other than notes, but
they are mostly positioned relative to notes; e.g.
and dynamics go
articulations, slurs, lyncs

above/below the notes they apply to.


Notes and rests are spaced depending on their note
values. The spacings Sibelius uses are in its House
Style b Note Spacing Rule dialog. For example,
a quarter note (crotchet) has 4 spaces after it, a half
note (minim) has 6.6 spaces, and a whole note
(semibreve) has 9 spaces. Different publishers use
slightly different spacings.
370

Music engraving

A quick mental calculation will prove to you that the space after a note or rest is not proportional to its note value: if it
were, a whole note (semibreve) would have 4 x 4 spaces (for a quarter note) = 16 spaces after it, rather than 9. The
reason note spacing is not proportional is that, if it were, very short notes would have to be crammed illegibly close
together, and long notes would waste huge amounts of space.
If several simultaneous staves have different rhythms at the same time, which staffs notes are used to set the note
spacing? The answer is that the shortest note or rest at any point determines the spacing: so if a piano right hand is
playing quarter notes (crotchets) while the left hand is playing whole notes (semibreves), its the quarter notes which
determine the spacing, and the whole notes are just positioned in alignment with them. However, it gets much harder
to keep the spacing looking good when there are lots of staves (e.g. orchestral/band scores) and complicated crossrhythms such as tuplets.
Because note spacing is not proportional, bars are not of equal width - bars with shorter notes are wider (perhaps
paradoxically):
I

This means that there is not normally a constant number of bars per system. (Jazz and commercial music is often
written out with e.g. four bars per system, but this is an exception.)
One adjustment made to the basic note spacing is justification: notes need to be spread out somewhat to ensure that
a whole number of bars fills the width of the page. The way this is done is that as many bars as possible are fitted into
the width of the page (using the note spacings above), and then any leftover space is added evenly between all the
notes, spreading them out until they reach the right margin. This is exactly like the justification of words to fill a line in
a word processor.
Various other spacing adjustments are also made: extra room needs to be allowed for things like accidentals, rhythm
dots, barlines, grace notes, back-notes (noteheads on the wrong side of the stem in cluster-y chords), crossing voices,
lyrics, and changes of clef, key and time signature.
Again, Sibelius automates all of this using a complex algorithm called the Double Prism rule - though thats not to say
that you shouldnt sometimes adjust it by eye. In particular, you should consider adjusting the note spacing if it gets
particularly uneven due to widely varying note values or complicated lyrics or tuplets; ILL!! Note spacing for advice
on this.
Vertical layout: staff spacing
Vertical layout is rather less precise than horizontal layout. But just as horizontal layout is basically about where notes
go (other objects being positioned relative to them), vertical layout is basically about staff spacing. The vertical
positions of other objects such as notes, rests, clefs, time signatures, instrument names, titles, bar numbers and
rehearsal marks are determined relative to the staves they belong to.
Broadly speaking, staves should have the same distance between them, with a slightly wider gap between systems,
and often a wider gap between instrumental families in large scores (e.g. for orchestra or band). As it happens,
Sibelius does not automatically add this latter gap, but you can do it easily enough yourself (by selecting the top staff
of a family throughout the score and moving it down).
311

Reference

Scores are often justified vertically to spread staves down to the bottom margin, in a similar fashion to the horizontal
justification of notes. Sibelius does this automatically if the page is more than half full (and, as usual, you can adjust
the specifics from the Engraving Rules dialog).
However, its sometimes necessary to allow extra space between staves or to reposition other objects to avoid
collisions between (say) high or low notes on one staff and objects on an adjacent one. This is a classic case of
adjustment by eye, which you should do yourself.
Another reason to move staves around is to align corresponding staves on facing pages. This is useful for
orchestral/band scores, to make it easier for the conductor to read a particular instruments music across from one
page to another. Sibeliuss Layout b Align Staves dialog automates this for you (L!2 Staff spacing).
Further information
In particular, Q2 Note spacing and Layout and formatting for various ways to improve your scores
appearance in Sibelius.
There are numerous other engraving rules, too many to bore you with here; though many of them are summarized in
other topics in the Reference section, either in boxes (particularly for non-automatic rules) or under the
Engraving Rules options heading at the end of the topic. Most rules are automatically handled by Sibelius, so
you dont need to know much about them.
Should you be slavering for further information on music engraving, a good book on the basics for those new to the
subject is the small, inexpensive but very readable Essential Dictionary of Music /Votation (Alfred Publishing). There
are various large, expensive and not-so-readable books for the more advanced engraver.
If you leave this topic with just two morsels of information, please apply Rules 1 and 2 given above: avoid collisions,
and above all else, make your score look clear.
I

372

Music fonts

lorizontal
m adjust
to avoid
case of
;eful for
om one

scores
rized in
jer the
Gus, so
to the
. There
I

lisions,

Music fonts
LQ Edit Symbols, House StyleTM.
Noteheads, clefs, accidentals and most other objects that appear in Sibelius scores are drawn using a symbol, which
itself is a character or combination of characters from a music font.
There is a rather messy variety of music fonts in the world, which often have a semi-random selection of musical
symbols present (or often woefully absent). Different people have different preferences as to which music fonts they
like; moreover, each font has its strong and weak points, so none is ideal.
Because of this, weve taken extreme care to make Sibeliuss standard font family Opus include just about every
symbol which youre likely to want or which is available in other fonts, and moreover to have symbol designs suitable
for the highest quality publishing.
However, as music font tastes differ wildly (and sometimes violently), weve also sorted out the complex confusion
inherent in other music fonts, and designed Sibelius so that its compatible with any other music font youre likely to
have - including PetrucciTM, SusatoTM, SonataTM, AnastasiaTM, TamburoTM, PiuTM and ChentTM. You can even mix all of
these fonts together in the same score.
Sibelius also includes a font family called InkpenzTM, which simulates neatly handwritten music. This is particularly
intended for use in jazz music, where handwritten (or apparently handwritten) parts are usually preferred. There is
manuscript paper set up with the Inkpen fonts for you. To change the music font of an existing score to Inkpen2, we
recommend you do so by importing one of the Inkpen house styles (LL? House StyleTM), as this also changes
various other related things such as line thicknesses.
Changing music font
If you want to change music font to a font designed for other music notation programs, you dont have to change all
of Sibeliuss symbols. You can change just the clefs, or the percussion symbols, or even just a single symbol.
However, by far the most likely requirement is simply to change the font of the following text styles. Each symbol is
drawn using the font specified by a particular text style. By changing the text style settings you can change the
appearance of whole sets of symbols at once:
Common symbols: this covers pretty much all the symbols normally used - standard notes, accidentals,
clefs, articulations, etc.
You may want to change Common symbols to Inkpen (see above), Petrucci, Susato, Sonata or Anastasia.
Sonata and Anastasia have clefs in non-standard places, but you can easily move them.
Special noteheads etc.: this includes unusual noteheads and microtones. You may want to substitute
Inkpen Special, Tamburo or Piu.
Percussion instruments: weird pictures of mallets, brushes, coins and anything else you can hit things
with. You may want to substitute Ghent.
Special symbols: this contains symbols not found in any other font except Opus Special and Inkpen
Special, so you wont want to substitute any other font (unless you design your own).
313

--

Reference
l

Note flags: you can change between Opus, Inkpen2, and Petrucci - Susato, Sonata, etc. are unsuitable as they
have incompatible flags.

To change the font of one of these sets of symbols:


l

On the House Style ) Edit Symbols dialog, click Music fonts


Click the symbol set you want to modify, and click Edit
Change the font and possibly also size, then click OK and OK again to close the Edit Symbols dialog.

If you intend to change the size, note that the standard size for all symbols is 19.8pt (relative) - if you increase or
decrease this, the symbols get bigger or smaller. You can use this (say) to make noteheads extra-big in beginners
books, or to scale a symbol (by creating its own symbol text style) - LQ Creating a new symbol text style
in Edit Symbols.
(For the cu-&.- changing the music font and size takes place in the House Style ) Edit Text Styles dialog. This
is because the above symbol sets are in fact treated by Sibelius as text styles, even though the font and size are the
only options you can usefully change. Dont think too hard about it.)
For more information about customizing Sibeliuss symbols, ILJZI Symbols.
Music text font
Various musical symbols such asJp and J can be typed into text such as Expression text and metronome marks.
These so-called music text characters are by default drawn using the Opus Text font, as are the numerals O-9 and :
(colon) used in tuplets.
You can change the font used for music text on the Text page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog
(shortcut 4%%E or Ctrl+Shift+E). We recommend you only change it to an italic or bold italic text font, and only
change it to a normal text font if you are not using metronome marks, as text fonts do not contain little pictures of
notes.
(However, if you really want to change the music text font and also really want to use metronome marks, you can
manually change the font of metronome marks back to Opus Text or Inkpen Text as you type them in.)
When you change the music text font, you are asked whether or not you want to apply the change to existing text in
your score. This allows you, for example, to change the font used for dynamics already in the score. (You cant do this
by editing the Expression text style as text styles only define the font used for normal text such as crest., not music text
characters such as mJ)
Installing Type 1 music fonts
The Opus and Inkpen music fonts are supplied in both TrueType and Adobe Type 1 (PostScript) format, and
TrueType fonts are installed by default. Note that you can print to PostScript printers and create EPS files using either
of these font formats.
However, for most publishing purposes, Adobe Type 1 fonts are preferable to TrueType fonts, though you typically
need to install extra software to use them. Type 1 versions of both Opus and Inkpen are included in the PostScript
Fonts folder (in the Extras folder within your Sibelius program folder).
Here is what you need to install to use Type 1 fonts:
314

Music fonts

they

On C/usslcMac 0.9 you need to install Adobe Type Manager (ATM), included on your Mac OS CD-ROM
On Windows 2000/X/?- you do not need to install any other software
On window.. 95/98/Me/NT 4.0: you need to install Adobe Type Manager (ATM); a free version, Adobe Type
Manager Light, is available for download from www.adobe.com/products/atmlight

If you have ATM on Windows, you may find some symbols missing in scores, e.g. keyboard braces. This is because
you need to install Sibeliuss music fonts in ATM for them to work properly. To do this:
or
3-s
4e

7is

Exit Sibelius (if its running) and start the Adobe Type Manager program
Click the Font List tab at the top of the Adobe Type Manager window
If the six Opus and five Inkpen fonts are listed, select them and click Remove
Click the Add Fonts tab at the top of the Adobe Type Manager window
Select Starter Set at the left of the window
If you want to install TrueType music fonts, which we recommend, switch on Add without copying files,
and at the right of the window, open your Windows fonts folder (which is normally C:\Windows\Fonts or
C:\WinNT\Fonts)
If you want to install the PostScript music fonts, switch off Add without copying files, and at the right of
the window, open the PostScript Fonts folder within the Extras folder within your Sibelius program
folder (normally C:\Program Files\Sibelius Software\Sibelius\Extras\PostScript Fonts)
At the right of the window, select the six Opus and five Inkpen fonts (which should be listed), and click Add
Start Sibelius and open a score. If the notes, clefs, and symbols are not there, restart your computer and start
Sibelius again.

If you still have problems, you could try switching off Adobe Type Manager: start the ATM program, click the Settings
tab and set ATM System to Off. Then restart your computer.
Hint for Classic Mac OS users: if you find that notes are not touching stems, keyboard braces are small, the music
symbols are blocky when you zoom in close, etc., you may have installed PostScript Type 1 music fonts but not
switched on Adobe Type Manager. Switch it on from Apple ) Control Panels ) -ATM. You will then need to
restart your computer for the changes to take effect.
Designing your own music font
It is possible to design your own music font, but this is quite an advanced task.
For designing fonts of any kind we recommend the FontLab program (www.fontlab.com); however, font design
is a sophisticated art, so this is not recommended for the faint-hearted.
Please note that the Opus and Inkpen font families are copyright, so you are not permitted to include symbols from
them in any new font you design.

315

Reference

Noteheads
LQ Beams, Percussion, Stems, Edit Noteheads.
Sibelius includes numerous special notehead shapes such as diamond, cross and slash, and you can create your own
custom noteheads, too. You can also control whether or not particular notehead shapes play back, transpose, have
stems or leger lines, and so on (LQ Edit noteheads).
Noteheads are distinct from note values - a cross notehead can be applied equally to an eighth note (quaver), a half
note (minim) or a double whole note (breve), and will slightly change its appearance accordingly.
Choosing a notehead
To choose a notehead, select a note or passage and use the drop-down menu on the Notes panel of the
Properties window. You can also choose the notehead by holding down 4-c or Shift+Alt and typing numbers
from the row along the top of the main keyboard (not the numeric keypad); see below for the notehead numbers. If
the notehead you want is numbered higher than 9 (say, notehead style 13, type both digits quickly one after
another.
You can also change the notehead type as you create notes: simply choose the desired type from the Properties
window or type the shortcut before entering the pitch of the note. The chosen notehead type will be used by all
subsequent notes until you change it again.
Since noteheads are customizable, the shortcuts listed in this topic (and throughout the User Guide) may not be
correct if you have edited existing notehead types.
Common noteheads
Cross noteheads (shortcut a-\r 1 or Shift+Alt+ 1) indicate notes of uncertain pitch, usually for unpitched
percussion. A cross half note (minim) can be written as a normal half note with a cross through it in avant garde
notation, or as a diamond in drum set (kit) notation.
Diamond noteheads (shortcut 4712 or Shift+Alt+2) usually indicate notes which are fingered but not played, such
as a string harmonic, or (in avant garde music) piano keys depressed silently. For guitar harmonics, quarter notes
(crotchets) and shorter notes are written with a black filled-in diamond (shortcut 0x6 or Shift+Alt+6).
Slashes indicate the rhythm of chords improvised to chord symbols in jazz, rock and commercial music. Two types of
slash are provided, one with a stem (shortcut 0714 or Shift+Alt++ and one without (shortcut 4713 or
Shift+Alt+3). These noteheads dont play back, and dont transpose (these noteheads conventionally appear only
on the middle line of the staff).
Headless notes (shortcut 4x7 or Shift+Alt+7) indicate pure rhythms in contemporary music, either because a
previous note or chord is being repeated, or because (like the cross notehead) the pitch is indefinite or is improvised.
Headless whole-notes (semibreves) are hard to see.
Stemless notes (shortcut 6718 or Shift+Alt+8) are useful for arhythmic music such as plainchant.
Silent notes (shortcut 4x9 or Shift+Alt+S) look exactly like normal noteheads, but they dont play back, which
can be useful in certain situations.
376

1
r,
IC
N
SC

wt

Noteheads

/n
/e

0 - normal

1 - cross

4 - beat

5 - cross or diamond

12 - back slashed

13 - arrow down

2 - diamond

3 - beat without stem

6 - black & white diamond 7 - headless

If

14 - arrow up

15 - inverted triangle

16 - 23 - shape notes

Cue-size noteheads (shortcut 6~ 10 or Shift+Alt+ 10) are used to mix normal- and cue-sized noteheads within
the same chord (for normal cue notes, see below). Note that using this notehead type doesnt make associated
objects such as accidentals small too.
Noteheads with slashes through them (shortcuts 4x1 l/l 2 or Shift+Alt+l l/l 2) are used for things like rimshots in percussion notation.
The arrow down (shortcut 0x13 or Shift+Alt+l3) and arrow up (shortcut 4x14 or Shift+Alt+l4)
noteheads, which are only suitable for notes with stems pointing up and down respectively, are used to denote the
lowest or highest possible note on a particular instrument. These noteheads are drawn without leger lines.
Noteheads 16-23 are used for shape note music, also known as sacred harp music, formulated in an American
song book by B.F. White and E.J. King in 1844. The technique is called fasola (i.e. fa - so - la, a kind of solmization),
whereby differently-shaped noteheads are used for different degrees of the scale.

377

Reference

Different sizes of noteheads


You should only create small noteheads with notehead type 10 if normal and small noteheads are needed in the
same chord. To make a single note or whole chord cue-sized, use the cue button (shortcut Enter) on the second
keypad layout (shortcut F9) instead, as this will also make the stem and any accents and articulations small LLII Grace notes and cue notes.
If you prefer a slightly larger notehead design throughout a score, you can use the supplied A4 (larger notes) or
Letter (larger notes) manuscript papers - EL! Manuscript paper - or you can import the Larger notes
(English) house style into an existing score - l!LQ House Style.

318

Note input

the
)nd
I-

Note input
LLJI Accidentals, Articulations, Beams, Flexi-time, Grace notes and cue notes, Note
spacing, Noteheads, Stems, Tremolos, Triplets and other tuplets, Voices.

or
es

There are five ways of creating and editing notes, chords and rests:
Alphabetic and step-time input - see below
Mouse input - see below
Flexi-time input - ILLI Flexi-time
Importing files from other music programs (e.g. MIDI files, Finale and SCORE files, etc.) - IL! Opening
Finale, Allegro and PrintMusic files, Opening SCORE files, Opening MIDI files,
Opening Acorn Sibelius files
Scanning printed music - ILLI Scanning.
Most of these are introduced in the Quick tour. This topic is a detailed summary of mouse, step-time and
alphabetic input.
Alphabetic and step-time input
Alphabetic and step-time input are the most efficient ways of writing your music in Sibelius, because you can create
other objects (such as time signatures, key changes and text) as you go along.
To start off alphabetic or step-time input, select a rest (you can also select anything else, such as a text object or a line,
which will start writing notes at that point).
Then...
l

Choose a note value from the keypad (unless the note value you want is already chosen on the keypad)
If you like, choose other markings on the keypad:
l

Accidentals from the first/fifth layout (not required for step-time input)
Articulations from the first/fourth layout
Ties and I-/@V-II d0t.s from the first/second layout (double dots are on the second layout)
Grace notes and cue notes from the second layout
Tremolos and beaming from the third layout,

Most of these buttons stay pressed down for successive notes until you re-choose them, so that (for instance)
you can input several notes with the same articulation.
You can choose buttons from more than one layout at once - theyll all be applied to the note/chord when you
input it. (Cycle through the different keypad layouts using the + key; - on Mac and F8 on Windows returns you
to the first layout.)
l

Then input the note by:


l

typing A-G or R (which repeats the previous note/chord), or


319

Reference
l

playing a note/chord on your MIDI keyboard

To input a rest of the selected note value, simply hit space. (To keep creating rests of the same note value,
keeping hitting space.)
To build up a chord, either:
l

hold down Shift and type the letter-name of the pitch you want to add, so to add a C#, first type 8 on the
first keypad layout to select the sharp, then type Shift-G to add the note; or
type a number l-9 (from the main keyboard, not the keypad) to add a note of that interval above the
current note, so to add a note a sixth above, type 6; Shift- l-9 adds notes below the current note, so Shift4 adds a note a fourth below the current note. (Usefully, this also works for selected passages, e.g. to create
octaves); or
choose the appropriate option from the Notes b Add Pitch or Notes b Add Interval submenus,
although its much quicker to use the keyboard shortcuts described above.
If you make a mistake, you can adjust the pitch afterwards with /1\ or J/; hold down 8% or Ctrl to change
the pitch by an octave

When you are creating notes and rests, a caret (a vertical line) appears after the note you have just created,
showing you that the next note you add will appear after the current one.
Go back to the first step to input the next note/chord.

Useful keys
There is a number of other useful keypresses at your fingertips when creating notes:
l

If you make a mistake, hit Delete or Backspace, which deletes the note and selects the preceding one.
(What exactly happens when you delete a note is subtly different depending on the context of your music: if you
delete a note, it is converted to a rest of identical duration; if you delete a rest or a bar rest, it is left unchanged; if
you delete all the notes of a tuplet, the tuplet bracket/number is selected - delete that, and it is replaced with a
rest of the duration of the entire tuplet.)

320

You can also use t and + to move between notes (including grace notes) and bar rests (but not tuplets).
You can swap the selected note(s) into another voice by typing Alt+1/2/3/4; so you could select one note of a
chord in voice I and, say, type Alt+2 to move it into voice 2, merging it with any notes that may already be in
that voice
To add a time signature in the course of creating notes, type T and choose it from the dialog, then hit Return
or click OK to create it in your score at the beginning of the next bar
To add a key change, type K and choose the required key signature from the dialog, then hit Return or click
OK to create it in your score directly after the current note
To add text, type the usual shortcut (e.g. #E or Ctrl+E for expression text), then type the required text; type
Esc to go back to creating notes. Text is created at its default position above or below the staff at the same
horizontal position as the note which was selected before creating it.
You can also add any other object from the Create menu during note input Lines, symbols and guitar frames,
for example, all appear at their default position above or below the staff at the same horizontal position as the
selected note
Esc terminates note input (the caret disappears).

Note input

e,

Mouse input
Mouse input is essentially the same as step-time and alphabetic input, except that there should be nothing selected
before you start (hit Esc to deselect).
Click a note value on the first keypad layout; you can also choose accidentals, articulations etc. from other
keypad layouts (see above)
Click in the score to input the note
A caret (a vertical line) appears in the score - if you like, you could now start creating notes in step-time or using
alphabetic input, but to continue adding notes with the mouse, simply continue clicking in the score to create
more notes, changing the note value and other properties of the note on the keypad when necessary
To input a rest, click the rest button (or type 0) on the first keypad layout, then click in the score
You dont have to input strictly from left to right with mouse point - you can hop about the score and click to
input notes anywhere.
Creating a rest
This is just like creating a note/chord, except that:
l

In mouse input, click the rest button (or type 0) from the first keypad layout, then click in the score to place the
rest
In alphabetic and step-time input, just hit space instead of the note name.

Repitching
Its often very useful to be able to change the pitches of a sequence of notes/chords without recreating their rhythm.
This is called repitching the music.
The main use of this is where youre writing for several instruments which have the same rhythm but different notes you can just copy one instruments music across, and then repitch the notes. To do this:
l

Drag the note with the mouse; or


Select a note (either with the mouse, or by reaching it with the arrow keys), then:
l

type /t/+ to move the note up/down; x/l/+ or Ctrl++/& moves by an octave; or
switch off the selected note value on the keypad; a dotted caret appears (rather than the normal solid line),
which tells you that Sibelius will overwrite the existing pitches, but not their rhythms. Type A-G, or play the
new pitch on your MIDI keyboard.

Type or play the next note/chord; after changing the pitch of the note, Sibelius selects the next note (skipping
over any rests which may precede it) so you can repitch it straight away.
If you dont want to repitch a particular note, hit + to move onto the next one, then switch off the note value
on the keypad again
To turn an existing note into a rest instead of repitching it, hit + to select it without repitching it, then hit 0 on
the first keypad layout (shortcut F8)
To turn an existing rest into a note, repitch the note preceding the rest, then use 3 to move onto the rest, then
type (or play on your MIDI keyboard) the pitch you want to write instead of the rest.

321

Referpce

The important thing is that you input the new pitches without choosing any nofe values on the keypad. This tells
Sibelius to use the note values that are already there.
Note that while repitching you can also build chords from existing notes in just the same way as when inputting notes:
select a note and either type Shift-A-G, or type l-9 on the main keyboard - see Alphabetic and step-time
input above.
If you need to change the enharmonic spelling of a note after you have repitched it, just choose Notes b Respell
Accidental (shortcut Return on the main keyboard) to respell it. You can also add accidentals, articulations and so
on to a note after you have repitched it by choosing them on the keypad in the normal way.
Editing note values, accidentals, articulations, etc.
Select a note, chord or rest (either with the mouse, or by reaching it with the arrow keys)
l

To change the note value, just choose the new note value on the first or second keypad layout.
If the new note value is longer than the old one, subsequent notes will be replaced by appropriate rests; if the
new note value is shorter than the old one, rests are created to equal the original note value.

To change other note properties, such as adding accidentals or articulations, just choose the appropriate keypad
button, and it will instantly edit the note (e.g. click # or type 8 to make a note sharp).

Return (on the main keyboard) re-spell:s an accidental - only normally required after step-time/Flexi-time input or
when editing a MIDI file youve imported.
Hiding notes
Select the note(s) you want to hide and choose Edit b Hide or Show b Hide (shortcut U#H or
Ctrl+Shift+H). Note that any accidental I articulation, stem or beam associated with that note is also automatically
hidden. For more information on hiding notes, L!2 Hiding objects.
Turning into rests
To turn a note, chord or passage into rests, simply hit Delete, or choose the rest button (0) on the first keypad
layout.
The subtle difference between Delete and 0 is that when turning a passage into rests, Delete consolidates the rests
(i.e. groups them into conveniently-sized larger rests or bar rests), whereas 0 just turns each note into an individual
rest (which is less useful). For more information on bar rests, LQ Bars and bar rests.
If you end up with one or more bars that contain only rests of various denominations, you can turn them back into a
bar rest by selecting the bar or passage (so it is enclosed in a single blue box) and hitting Delete.
Moving rests
You can move rests up/down with the mouse or arrow keys, just like notes.
For music in one voice you shouldnt have to adjust the vertical position of rests, as the position Sibelius uses is
absolutely standard. However, in multiple voices you should adjust the vertical position as necessary to allow room for
the other voice(s). Sibelius automatically displaces rests up or down a bit when in multiple voices, but feel free to
adjust this.
322

Note input

If you hit Delete when a rest is selected, it becomes hidden; the gap it occupied remains, and the music in other
staves in the system is aligned as if the rest is still there. If View h Hidden Objects is switched on (shortcut
x%%H or Ctrl+Ak+H), the rest will still appear in your score colored light gray.
You can actually delete a rest altogether, by selecting a hidden rest and hitting Delete again, but there is usually no
good reason to do this.
You shouldnt hide rests without a good reason, because it makes the length of the bar look incorrect which can be
confusing if you are careless. However, two good reasons for deleting a rest are:
l

To make a voice disappear before the end of a bar or appear after the start. If you hide unwanted rests in (say)
voice 2, the music will revert to being in one voice (with stems both up and down) - Q2 Voices.
In order to replace it with a symbol or a line representing some effect which cant be indicated with notes. For
instance, you could notate taped sound-effects in a modern score by deleting a rest of the required length and
putting a wiggly line in its place.

323

Reference

Note spacing
IQ2 Layout and formatting, Music engraving, Staff spacing.
Changing the note spacing means, in effect, adjusting the spacing between notes, chords, rests and bat-lines. The
various options open to you are:
l

Move individual notes, rests and barlines left or right with the mouse or by typing 6x+/+ or
Shift+Alt+t/+, with X or Ctrl for big steps
Use Layout b Format b Make Into System/Page to condense or expand the selected passage to fill a
system or page - LQ Layout and formatting
To squash a passage of music closer together or spread it out, select the passage, type 6x+/+ or
Shift+Alt+t/+ a few times. Hold down # or Ctrl at the same time to move in bigger steps.
To alter the note spacing rule, see below
If youve messed up some note spacing and want to reset it to default, select a passage, and choose Layout b
Reset Note Spacing (shortcut 48gN or Ctrl+Shift+N). This takes account of the space required by clefs,
accidentals, lyrics etc.

Leger lines
Leger lines for successive notes
above or below the staff should
never touch, even if the note
values are very short.
To prevent leger lines from
touching, select the affected
passage and increase the
spacing between the notes
slightly

Note spacing rule


Sibelius uses a sophisticated note spacing algorithm called the Double Prism rule. The
Double Prism rule is rather more complex than just a series of spacings for different
note values; however, you can specify these basic spacings in the House Style b
Note Spacing Rule dialog:
For each note value you can specify the unjustified space after it. (Unjustified
because horizontal justification increases the space after notes/rests by an amount
which depends on the context.)
l

You can specify the Minimum space which even the shortest notes must have
after them; spacings are measured from the left-hand side of one note to the left-hand side of the next (i.e.
include notehead width)
l

You can specify the gap at the start of a bar (before the first note/rest), and the space occupied by a bar rest
You can also alter the justification between notes with the Justification tracking option. This defaults to 00/o,
which means that spaces between notes remain in the same proportions when justified as the unjustified values
listed on the dialog; lOOo/o adds a constant extra space between all notes, when justifying, regardless of their
note value.
The Allow space for lyrics option determines whether or not the note spacing rule takes account of the
width of lyrics when you use Layout b Reset Note Spacing. By default, this option is switched on IQ2 Lyrics.

For more details on how these settings control the spacing, LLQ Music engraving.

324

Note spacing

The House Style b Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut O%%E or Ctrl+Shift+E) includes settings for the gap
between objects other than notes and rests.
Notes out of alignment
Sibelius handles the alignment of notes automatically, even in complex cases involving multiple voices. However,
sometimes you might wish to change the horizontal position of an individual note within a bar. To do this, select the
note, open the General panel of the Properties window, and alter the X parameter, which adjusts its horizontal
offset. Negative numbers move the note left, positive numbers move it right. The units are spaces. IQ2 Properties.
Optimizing note spacing
Like so much else in music engraving, note spacing is an esoteric art for which the rules are not hard and fast
&!A Music engraving). So here are some ways you can tweak the default note spacing in your score to make it
look even better:
Unbeamed eighth notes (quavers) or shorter with stems up: extra space is sometimes required after these notes
to allow room for the tail. Adjust this where necessary by moving the following note, rest or barline slightly
rightwards.
Crossing voices: extra space is sometimes required to allow space for these notes which are displaced to avoid
collisions. Again, move the following note, rest or barline slightly rightwards.
Accidentals, rhythm dots and back-notes (noteheads on the wrong side of the stem in chords containing
seconds): normally Sibelius allows extra space for these, but if you edit a note to alter its accidentals, rhythm dots
or back-notes, they may end up colliding with the note, rest or barline before or after. If so, select the whole bar
or just the notes in the vicinity, and choose Layout b Reset Note Spacing (shortcut UXN or
Ctrl+S h ift+N).
Notes are not and should not be spaced proportionally to their note values (Q2 Music engraving), so its normal
for bars to get wider and narrower as the music changes. However, if there is wide variation in note values, particularly
involving cross-rhythms between different staves, the spacing can get quite uneven (particularly the boxed notes):
Default spacing

This requires a compromise between using this uneven default spacing, and using proportional spacing throughout to
make the second half of bar 1 like the first, which would make bar 2 too wide for half notes (minims).
A good strategy is to make the note spacing look even on a beat-by-beat or bar-by-bar basis. Here we can make the
first bar roughly even and the second bar even but narrower, like this:
Better: after manual adjustment

Uneven spaang due to flat

325

, Reference

In fact we have made the second half of bar 1 slightly narrower than the first half, to produce a smoother transition
into the still narrower spacing of bar 2. Note that there is extra space between the G and Bb sixteenth notes
(semiquavers) in the lower staff to allow for the accidental; this is quite acceptable in tight spacing.
You should in particular consider tweaking the spacing of tuplets, which may become uneven when involved in
complex cross-rhythms. To read them fluently, people are more reliant on even spacing for tuplets than for other
more familiar note values.
Optimizing lyric spacing
Music with lyrics presents special note spacing problems, especially if the note values are short and the lyrics are wide.
If you were to space the music just according to the notes, you might get rest Jlts like this:
Spaced according to notes only

the

ca&cratche&xb-etchedm - t i l i t

got

in throughthe mousehole

Fortunately, Sibelius automatically allows extra space between notes for extra-wide syllables, to ensure tha t they dont
collide. However, if some syllables are wide and others arent, this can make the note spacing very uneven, like this:
Sibelius default: wider spacing for wide lyrics (to avoid collisions)
A

the cat scratched and stretched un - til it

got in through the mouse - hole

Note that the lyrics are nicely spaced, but as a result the notes arent and in fact vary wildly in spacing, particularly the
ones in the box. Of course, this is a particularly awkward example. In fact, scratched and stretched are, at nine letters
each, the widest syllables in English (an accolade they share with squelched), but through is almost as troublesome,
and occurs often.
Making both the lyric spacing and the note spacing acceptable requires something of a compromise. As when evening
up note spacing (above), a good strategy is to make the note spacing look even on a beat-by-beat or bar-by-bar basis;
so if you have a beat or a bar with an extra-wide syllable in it, adjust the spacing of all notes in that beat or bar to
match.
In very tight situations, it can also help to move some syllables horizontally a little, in order to take advantage of free
space around earlier or later syllables. Perhaps the best result you can get with the above example is this:
Better: note and lyric spacing evened up

the cat scratched and stretchedun - til

326

it

got in through the mouse-hole

CC

Opening Acorn Sibelius files

Opening Acorn Sibelius files


Sibeliuss built-in Acorn file converter allows you to open files created in the original Acorn Sibelius programs (Sibelius
7, Sibelius 7 Student, Sibelius 6 and Junior Sibelius), version 3.01 or later. With files earlier than version 3.01, the
converter asks you to re-save the file from version 3.01 or later to update it; this enables Sibelius for Mac/Windows to
open them.
The purpose of the file converter is to save you time, not to convert every score so that it is identical to the original. As
with any file converter, this is unrealistic, since the Acorn and the Mac/Windows versions of Sibelius work in different
ways and have different features.
Transferring files from Acorn to PC or Mac
The simplest way to transfer the files is as follows:
l

Format a floppy disk as DOS 1.44Mb format (you can do this on your Acorn or your PC/Mac; new disks are
normally formatted like this anyway). Then just copy the Acorn files onto the floppy disk, click the Menu button
on the floppy drive icon (marked :0) on the icon bar, and choose Dismount, to ensure the files are fully
saved.
Eject the disk and insert it in your PC or Mac
Copy the files from the floppy disk onto your PC or Macs hard disk before converting, as they will then convert
quicker
If you like, you can add .s7 to the filename to show that they are Acorn Sibelius files (use .s7 for Sibelius 6 files
as well). Alternatively, you can rename them when theyre still on your Acorn: add /s7 to the end instead, and
the slash will appear as a dot on your PC/Mac.

Converting an Acorn Sibelius file


In Sibelius for Mac/Windows, click Open (or type 80 or Ctrl+O), find the Acorn Sibelius file (with its .s7
extension) and click Open. We recommend that you dont open a file direct from a floppy disk - copy it to your hard
disk first. After a short delay the file will open. You should then check it and edit it if necessary.
If the file is earlier than Acorn Sibelius version 3.01, you will be asked to re-save the file from version 3.01 or later to
update it, then try again.
Batch conversion
Sibelius includes a plug-in to convert a complete folder full of Acorn Sibelius files at once. To use it, in Sibelius for
Windows/Mac choose File ) Plug-ins ) Batch Processing ) Convert Folder of Acorn Sibelius Files.
You are asked to find the folder to convert; find it and click OK. All Acorn Sibelius files in the folder will be converted
to Sibelius for Windows/Mac files.
Note that if the Acorn Sibelius files were prior to version 3.01 format, you should load them into Acorn Sibelius version
3.01 or later and re-save them prior to converting them.

327

Reference

Mac memory (Classic Mac OS only)


With large files it is possible for the file converter to run out of memory on Mac computers (this is unlikely to be a
problem on Windows). Sibelius may either tell you that there is no more memory, or it may just give up converting a
file.
If so, you should increase Sibeliuss memory allocation. Select the Sibelius 2 program file (in the Sibelius 2
folder) and type %I to see the File Info dialog. Find the Memory area, and increase the Preferred Size (in
extreme cases 50Mb or more may be appropriate). It is also a good idea to switch on virtual memory in the separate
Memory Control Panel. Note that playback in Sibelius through QuickTime music is adversely affected by having
virtual memory switched on.
Limitations
The main limitations are summarized below - some very technical limitations are omitted.
Feature

Limitations

In two voices, an accidental on a note in one voice is not implicitly applied to notes of the same pitch in the other voice; it
must appear in both voices to convert correctly.

cciden tals

Accidentals tied across barlines may convert incorrectly on the second note (see Notes and ties, below)
Articulation

Some pauses on bar rests are not imported

Bar number
changes

Bar number changes are not imported

Clefs

Perhaps some problems with octave clefs in some cases

Erasers

Not imported (no direct equivalent) - can usually be replaced in Sibelius for Mac/Windows with a divided system, ossia,
hidden staff type change, or hidden object

Grace notes

Imported in most cases

Guitar frames

Not currently imported (these were a late addition to Sibelius 7 and are little used)

Guitar tab

This is converted in a basic way by converting the text that makes up Sibelius 7 guitar tab, even though the result is not real
Sibelius for Mac/Windows guitar tab

House Styles

Mostly set to the Sibelius for Mac/Windows default, e.g. page numbers are reset to start at 1

Layout/ Spacing

System/page breaks are converted but otherwise the pagination may change. You can correct this using Sibelius for
Mac/Windows Make Into System/Page features.
Gaps between staves may not be the same
Note spacing uses Sibelius for Mac/Windows standard spacing which is slightly different than on Acorn

Lines

Not all lines are converted to equivalents; ones that are not are converted to simple straight lines

Notes and ties

Slurs and ties are the same in Acorn Sibelius, so the converter guesses which ones to convert to ties in Sibelius for
Mac/Windows.
Occasionally the converter will mistakenly convert a slur to a tie, because it happens to look like one in context. Its easy
enough to edit them back, though the appearance is often correct even if you leave them as ties.

328

Part extraction

If parts are extracted from a converted Acorn Sibelius file, a few transposing instruments may appear in the wrong octave.
These can easily be corrected by transposing the affected parts by an octave

Playback

MIDI playback settings are not imported, so most instruments default to a piano sound. Use Sibeliuss Play b Mixer
window to set up the sounds correctly; clicking Reset will reset the sounds to Sibeliuss usual defaults

Opening Acorn Sibelius files


Feature

Limitations

Rehearsal marks

Not imported

Rests

Double whole note (breve) bar rests are imported as normal bar rests

Staves

Occasional hidden staves may reappear after conversion, and can be suppressed using Layout b Hide Empty Staves

Symbols

Symbols (Transfers) are not imported

Text

Duplicated tempo text is imported as a single text item


Text style definitions are not imported; this means that text fonts are re-defaulted
Player text is not imported (no direct equivalent in Sibelius for Mac/Windows)
Figured bass text is not imported
If the title appears to have disappeared after conversion, it may have been placed off the top of the page: try dragging the
top staff down until it appears, then drag the title down to a suitable distance from the staff and drag the staff back up

Reference
\ 'L_-

Opening Finale, Allegro and


PrintMusic files
Sibeliuss built-in Finale file converter allows you to open files created in Finale (98/2000/2001/2002), Allegro
(98/2000) and PrintMusic l-0, including Finales ETF (Enigma) files. With files earlier than Finale/Allegro 98, the
converter asks you to re-save the file from a newer version of Finale/Allegro to update it; Sibelius can then open it.
The purpose of the file converter is to suve you time, not to convert every score so that it is identical to the original. As
with any file converter, this is unrealistic, since Finale/Allegro/PrintMusic and Sibelius work in different ways and have
different features.

Ma
I

Converting a file
In Sibelius, choose File b Open (shortcut 6t%O or Ctrl+O), find the Finale, Allegro, PrintMusic or Enigma file and
simply click Open. After a short delay the file will open. You should then check it and edit it as necessary.

Note that Sibelius can only open ETF (Enigma) files from Finale 2001/2002, though Sibelius can open standard
(.mus) Finale 98/2000 files too:

g
n
a

Before saving your file in Finale 2001/2oo2, go to the last page and run the update Layout command. Then
save your file as an ETF file.
This file converter can open .mus (binary) and .etf (Enigma) files from Finale 98, Finale 2000, Allegro 98,
Allegro 2000 and PrintMusic 1 .O, and on/y .etf files from Finale 2001 and Finale 2002.

I
f

UPd
SC

If you try to open a .mus file from Finale 2001/2002, you will be prompted by Sibelius to save it as an .etf file
in Finale 2001/2002 and try again.
Note also that files from Finale 2000, 2001 or 2002 will not open in Sibelius unless you have updated their
layout (choose Edit b Update Layout in Finale) before saving them and opening them in Sibelius.
.
Batch conversion
Sibelius includes a plug-in to convert a complete folder full of Finale files at once. It works equally well with Allegro
and PrintMusic files.

Quali
Thl
un

To use it, choose File b Plug-ins b Batch Processing b Convert Folder of Finale Files. You are asked to
find the folder to convert; find it and click OK. All Finale files in the folder (including Enigma .etf files) will be
converted to Sibelius files.
Note that if the files were created by versions of Finale or Allegro prior to Finale/Allegro 98 you should update the files
by opening and re-saving them using a newer version of Finale/Allegro before running the plug-in.
Warning messages
Some Finale files will contain notations that the file converter is aware may not be converted correctly. If so, during
conversion a dialog appears with a list of warnings, giving the severity of each problem and the staff and bar number
where it occurred. Staves are numbered such that the topmost staff is 1 (hidden staves are still counted - for a list of

330

--

-__

Tht
Fin
mir
Fei
ACCI
Arti

~-~-~_----.--- ___-.- -__ ___~

Opening Finale, Allegro and PrintMusic files

all staves you can look in Sibeliuss Layout ) Show Hidden Staves dialog, shortcut Udf?S or
Ctrl+Shift+Alt+S, and click Cancel after looking at it).
The warning list is useful when editing the file after converting it: you may want to use it as a basis for proof-reading
the score.
The warning dialog has a Save button to save the warnings as a text fi le to print out or give to a proof-reader. You can
save the warnings at any point - if converting a series of files, the warnings accumulate so you can wait till the end
before saving.
Mac memory (Classic Mac OS only)
With large files it is possible for the file converter to run out of memory on Mac computers (this is unlikely to be a
problem on Windows). Sibelius may either tell you that there is no more memory, or it may just give up converting a
file.
If so, you should increase Sibeliuss memory allocation. Select the Sibelius 2 program file (in the Sibelius 2
folder) and type %%I to see the File Info dialog. Find the Memory area and increase the Preferred Size (as a
guide, 25Mb is enough to convert a 2.5Mb Finale file of an orchestral score). It is also a good idea to switch on virtual
memory in the separate Memory Control Panel (although be aware that playback in Sibelius through QuickTime is
adversely affected by having virtual memory switched on).
Update Layout error message
Some scores may generate an error message telling you to update the layout. You should do the following:
l

Open the score in Finale/Allegro (98 or later)


Co to the last page of the score
Whilst on the last page, choose Edit ) Update Layout
Save the score and open it again in Sibelius. It should now convert correctly.

Quality of the results


The quality of the results is generally good: standard notations normally convert well, and the converter even
understands various fakes that are commonly used in Finale and turns them into proper notations in Sibelius.
The limitations are summarized below. Most of them dont occur often because they tend to be obscure features in
Finale (and also Allegro and PrintMusic, if they support the feature in question) that are seldom used in practice, e.g.
mirrored notes.
Feature

Limitations

Accidentals

In some obscure situations involving tied notes in multiple voices, or notes tied to nothing, an accidental may be
wrongly converted

Articulations

The following Finale articulations are omitted (some of these are not normally notated as articulations anyway): trill
extension, trill, broken chord, double slash, grace note, diamond, brackets, tenuto + accent (as a single articulation)
Articulations input using the Finale Expression tool are not imported
Articulations that convert to standard Sibelius articulations (accents, tenuto, staccato, etc.) go at Sibeliuss default
position
331

Reference
\- /
Feature

Limitations

Bar numbers

You can choose whether to convert them to Sibelius native bar numbers or to Sibelius text in the Options dialog
when you open a file; converting to text allows more Finale options to work correctly, but may make the score harder
to edit

Bar-lines

Manual horizontal barline adjustments with the Finale Measure Tool are ignored
Graphic barlines are omitted
Thick barlines import as double barlines
Ticks import as regular barlines

Beams

Secondary beam breaks are converted to continuous secondary beams

Brackets and braces

Line brackets import as regular brackets


Brackets that have been manually repositioned in Finale are imported using Sibelius spacing
Second individual placements of brackets are not converted (this is set globally in the Sibelius House Style
Engraving Rules dialog)

Grace notes

Grace note beaming may not always convert accurately

Guitar frames

Guitar frames faked using guitar font characters typed into text are imported correctly. Native Finale guitar frames do
not always currently import.

Guitar tab

Finale stem adjustment options in tab do not convert


Finale TAB clef options are not supported

Key signatures

Independent key signatures on different staves import as default key signatures

fi
Tl.

Non-standard key signatures (e.g. 3 sharps + 2 flats) are omitted. Finale scores that use these key signatures will
import with incorrect enharmonic spellings
Finale key signatures hidden on a per-bar basis are not converted
Layout and spacing

Margins are adjusted to avoid spilling off the page


Finales horizontal note spacing is ignored; Sibeliuss default spacing rules (which are often better) are used instead
Finale systems that overlap vertically will import as two separate systems with 0 separation

Lines

Lines designed using the Finale Shape Designer are not imported
The positioning of trill extensions is not always accurately imported
Lines that begin and end on different staves are omitted
Flipped stem directions can cause slurs to be incorrectly positioned
Finale slur thickness option is ignored
Values specified by the Finale function Avoid Staff Line by at Least x amount are ignored
Slurs created as Finale Shape Expressions are not imported
Slurs attached to grace notes may have inaccurate positions
Custom designed repeats do not convert

Lyrics

Finale lyric alignment (left, right, center) imports as Sibelius default alignment
Lyrics are respaced according to Sibeliuss rules
Formatting of Lyrics may not be automatically updated if you edit the Lyrics text style - so choose Edit ) Filter h
Lyrics and then use Layout ) Reset Design after changing the text style

332

VOl

--.-- -- - -- -. ..- --- .-----.- ---- --

Opening Finale, Allegro and PrintMusic files

Feature

Limitations

Notes and ties

You can set the notehead size (as a percentage of Sibeliuss normal size) in the Options dialog when you open a file
Default Finale stem directions import as Sibelius default stem directions, so in some cases they may point in the other
direction
Cross-staff notes are implemented using Sibeliuss rules, so the following are left on the original staff: notes in a chord
individually crossed to another staff, and notes crossed to a staff in another instrument or in a non-adjacent staff

Part extraction

Some part extraction options are not imported (e.g. markings that are extracted into some parts and not others)

Playback

MIDI playback settings are imported from layer 1 of Finale staves. Settings in other layers are ignored

Rehearsal marks

Rehearsal marks convert as text in the Rehearsal Marks text style. This means they will not automatically
renumber/reletter if subsequently edited

Rests

The vertical position of rests is converted to Sibeliuss default position

Symbols

Staff Expression tool symbols are omitted

Text

Finale text items with embedded current date and time are imported with the date and time of conversion
Certain text characters (e.g. accented letters) will import more accurately if the Finale file is imported on the same
platform (Mac or Windows) as it was originally created on (because the Finale file format is not properly piatformindependent)

Transposition changes

The following features in the Finale Staff Transpositions dialog are ignored: Simplify key; Chromatic transpositions; Set
to clef

Tuplets

The vertical position of tuplet brackets is not imported


Finale tuplets with no bracket by default are imported with a bracket
Finale ratios are imported with the second figure of the ratio
Finale brackets drawn as slurs import as square brackets

Voices

Mirrored notes (rarely used) will not import correctly. This can be worked around by converting all notes to normal
notes before importing the file
Finales 4 layers and 2 voices are mapped onto Sibeliuss 4 voices. This works for all practical cases, but one can
contrive obscure situations where this mapping cannot be done and notes are omitted (e.g. where you are using 5 or
more layer/voice combinations in Finale at once)

333

Reference

Opening MIDI files


If you dont know much about MIDI, ELI MIDI for beginners, which explains what MIDI files are.
Importing a MIDI file
Open a MIDI file just like a normal Sibelius file: simply choose File b Open (shortcut 6t%O or Ctrl+O) or click
Open on the toolbar, locate the file (on Windows, MIDI files usually have the file extension .mid), and click Open.
A dialog appears with importing options you can set (detailed below). Normally, you should just click OK, and then
wait a few seconds for the MIDI file to open.
l

If Sibelius detects that the sounds in the MIDI file are incompatible with your preferred MIDI device, it offers to
reset the sounds. For instance, if you opened a Roland JV1080 MIDI file when you have a General MIDI
soundcard, the sounds will probably not play correctly, so you should reset them.
Some MIDI files contain no program changes (even though they contain instrument names), which means that
the instruments have to be guessed. If so, Sibelius warns you that the instrument names, sounds, clefs, and
other details may be wrong. You should either adjust the instruments clef etc. by hand, or (preferably) make or
obtain a copy of the MIDI file which does contain the necessary program change information, and import that
MIDI file instead.

Sibelius uses the same algorithm as Flexi-time to tidy up the rhythm as it imports it. Sibelius also ingeniously works out
all the instruments and formats the score neatly so that youll often find its ready to print right away. ILLI Technical
details (below) for more about just what Sibelius does when importing.
If you find that the imported MIDI file doesnt look as good as you had hoped, try changing some of the import
settings - see Import options below.
Once the MIDI file is imported you can play back, edit, save, print and extract parts from it just as if youd inputted the
music yourself.
Import options
The following options are available in the Open MIDI file dialog, which appears when you open a MIDI file:
Rhyth
The
not;
on t

334

-----. -_---.-__ _ _ _~ _

A__--

Opening MIDI files

MIDI file uses this sound set allows you to specify whether the program and bank numbers use General
MIDI or another convention. This helps Sibelius guess what the instruments are. Normally you can leave this
option at General MIDI, or switch it off altogether if you simply want to import the MIDI file as is.
Only one staff per track is useful if you open a MIDI file which notates a piano (say) as two separate piano
tracks, one for the left hand and another for the right hand. Switch on this option and each hand will be written
as one staff, not two; you can then clean it up by creating a new piano and copying the two hands into it. Finally,
delete the original two pianos.
Keep track names is switched on by default, so the track names in the MIDI file are used as Sibeliuss
instrument names. Switch this off if the names are garbage, or if you want to see what Sibelius has decided the
instruments are (the track name may just be Strings, but Sibelius will have worked out that its probably, say, a
viola).
Keep track order is switched off by default. With this option switched off, Sibelius will choose the order of
the instruments. Switch it on to keep the instruments in the same order as the tracks in the MIDI file.
Show metronome marks makes all metronome marks visible. If there are lots of changes of tempo (e.g.
rits and accels) then you may want to switch this option off, which will hide the metronome marks in the score,
making it look cleaner but still playing back the same.
Keep program/bank messages imports all program and bank changes using Sibeliuss MIDI message
text format (L!2! MIDI messages), other than program changes at the start which are put in the Mixer
dialog. These messages are automatically hidden in the score.
Keep controller messages similarly imports all controller messages (such as pitch bend, sustain pedal,
channel volume, etc. - ILLI MIDI messages for a complete list) and automatically hides them in the score.
Keep other messages similarly imports any other MIDI messages found in the score.
Rhythm Options lets you adjust rhythm recognition options just as for Flexi-time - see Rhythm options
below.
Manuscript paper sets the paper siz e etc., as for creating a new score. Any instrume nts in the ma nuscript
paper are ignored - Sibelius only creates instruments which are includ ed in the M DI file.
Play using this device allows you to choose the playback device with which to play back the score (this is
the same list as in the Play ) Devices dialog, and defaults to your default playback device).
Rhythm Options
The Rhythm Options dialog allows you to adjust note values, control the complexity of imported tuplets, and
notate/ignore staccatos, tenutos, and tuplet brackets. The dialog is identical to that used by Flexi-time (for more details
on the options on this dialog, ELI Flexi-time):

335

Reference

Good settings to open typical MIDI files well are the default ones, as follows: Adjust rhythms on, Minimum
note value sixteenth note (semiquaver), Staccato and Tenuto on. If you are reading a MIDI file in which the
rhythms are completely exact (if its already quantized, say), switch Adjust rhythms off.
Note that if you set Minimum note value unrealistically long - e.g. if its set to eighth notes (quavers) when the
MIDI file contains long runs of sixteenth notes (semiquavers) - Sibelius obviously cant render the runs properly using
eighth notes and may be forced to produce junk. (Sibelius will have to approximate the runs of sixteenth notes using
tuplets of eighth notes or by joining some pairs of sixteenth notes together to form eighth note chords.)
The tuplet options are up to you:
l

Simple means tuplets are notated only if they contain equal note values
Moderate and Complex for more irregular rhythms.

Remember that if a particular tuplet (say a triplet) is used in a MIDI file, you must set this option to at least Simple,
or it wont be read! Beware however that if, say, you set all the tuplets to Complex, Sibelius may discover elaborate
tuplet rhythms where you werent expecting them, so be cautious.
Recommended import options
The precise combination of options you should choose in the Open MIDI file dialog will depend on a number of
different factors, for example:
l

336

If you are importing a MIDI file to create notation, you should switch off the options in the Notation section,
and try a number of different Rhythm Options settings until you get the cleanest result
If you are importing a MIDI file for playback only, you should keep all the Notation options, and you can set
Rhythm Options to allow maximum flexibility (e.g. choose a 32nd note (demisemiquaver) as the minimum
note value, and set tuplets to Complex)
If you are importing a file created by someone else, probably on a different device (e.g. a MIDI file you have
downloaded from the Internet), you should set the sound set to match your own device
If you are importing a file which you know uses the General MIDI sound set, make sure you have chosen
General MIDI under MIDI file uses this sound set.

____ _

___--

~-------_I-

Opening M/D/ files

Batch conversion
Sibelius includes a plug-in to convert a complete folder full of MIDI files at once. To use it, choose File b Plug-ins b
Batch Processing b Convert Folder of MIDI Files. You are asked to find the folder to convert; find it and
click OK. All MIDI files in the folder will be converted to Sibelius files.
Cleaning up MIDI files
Because MIDI files dont contain any notation data, they can end up looking a little messy after opening them in
Sibelius. Here are some hints for getting better results, both before and after conversion:
l

If the MIDI file uses non-standard program numbers (e.g. if it is set up to play on an unusual MIDI device),
Sibelius will not be able to identify the instruments correctly and they may appear with unexpected
characteristics, such as with the wrong clefs or in the wrong order. Similarly, if the MIDI file uses channel 10 for
pitched instruments, these may be imported by Sibelius as percussion instruments. This depends on whether or
not the MIDI device you select when opening the MIDI file expects to find percussion instruments only on
channel 10.
If this happens, try importing the file again, changing the MIDI file uses this sound set setting.
If the MIDI file is not fully or properly quantized, you may find that the rhythms are not notated as cleanly as you
might expect. If you have access to a sequencer, you could try re-quantizing the file and opening it in Sibelius
again.

The kind of cleaning up that is most commonly required after opening a MIDI file is making unpitched percussion
staves more legible -- ILL! Percussion for more details.
When Sibelius imports unpitched percussion in a MIDI file, each drum sound is converted to the notehead and staff
position (i.e. which line or space) defined in the 5 Line (drum set) staff type. If a drum sound is used where the
notation isnt defined in this staff type, Sibelius makes up a notation using normal, cross and diamond noteheads in
empty positions on the staff. You can control the mapping of drum sounds to noteheads yourself, by editing the 5
Line (drum set) staff type in an empty score, then saving it as manuscript paper. When you import a MIDI file, use
this manuscript paper, and the drum sounds will then use the noteheads and positions you defined.
Technical details
Sibelius imports MIDI files of types 0 and 1. When importing, Sibelius intelligently works out which instruments to use
(using track names if they are present, otherwise using the sounds), and is able to distinguish between, say, Violin and
Viola, Clarinet and Bass Clarinet, or Soprano and Alto by the range of the music in each track. Sibelius cleans up the
rhythm using the Flexi-time algorithm, and retains as much or as little MIDI message data as you specify (e.g.
metronome marks, program changes and so on). Sibelius also automatically reduces the staff size if there are too
many instruments for the page size.

337

_e

\, Reference

Opening SCORE files


Sibeliuss built-in SCORE file converter allows you to open files created in the SCORE music engraving program.
The purpose of the file converter is to save you time, not to convert every score so that it is identical to the original. As
with any file converter, this is unrealistic, since SCORE and Sibelius work in different ways and have different features.
SCORE files are particularly difficult to convert well.
Converting a file
You can either convert a single page (typically with a .mus file extension) or a SCORE file list (with a .tmp
extension), which is a list of separate pages comprising a score. If converting a file list, you must put the .tmp file in
the same folder as the individual files that are the pages of the score, otherwise they cannot be found.
In Sibelius, choose File h Open (shortcut 6t%O or Ctrl+O), find the .tmp or .mus file and simply click Open. (If
the file is not visible in this dialog, make sure that the filename has the correct extension.)
You will be presented with an Options dialog containing a few self-explanatory options; change any settings as
necessary, and then click OK. After a short delay the file will open. As the file is converted, an error log window will
appear if the converter encounters features it is not able to convert, to aid subsequent proofreading of the file.
After the file has opened, you should check it and edit it as necessary.
SCORE file lists
SCORE files normally consist of just a single page. If your score has more than one page, in order to convert it you
should make a SCORE file list, which is a file with a .tmp extension containing a list of other SCORE files. Many scores
should have file lists already, as they are needed for some operations in SCORE (such as extracting parts).
You can create a file list easily with a SCORE utility called FList. Alternatively, you can just list the individual pages in a
text editor (such as Windows Notepad) and save it with a filename ending in the .tmp file extension. For example, if
you have a four-page score made up of files called page01 a.mus, page01 b.mus, page01 c.mus and
page01 d.mus, the file list should read like this:
pageOla.mus
page02a.mus
page03a.mus
page04a.mus

1
1
1
1

Note that after each filename is the number of files that make up the page, which is usua Ily 1. In some cases it can be
more than 1 if the score contains many staves that have to be split between files.
The files listed in a SCORE file list can have any file extension (i.e. they are not limited to the extensions .mus, .pag
and .pge in the same way as files opened directly).
Instrument numbers
If your score is optimized (i.e. not all systems have the same number of staves), Sibelius has to work out which staves
correspond to which instruments. You can indicate this by opening the files in SCORE and setting parameter 9
(instrument number) for every staff; this is what you have to do anyway when extracting parts from SCORE.
338

Opening SCORE files

If you do not set this information, the converter will ask you whether you want the instrument numbers to be filled in
automatically, or you can optionally specify missing instrument numbers yourself.

As
3.

P
in

as
/ill

Kl

Transposing scores
To convert scores containing transposing instruments, switch on the Show transposition dialog option in the
SCORE converters Options dialog, and a further dialog will appear, allowing you to specify the transposition of
instruments in your score before conversion.
Time signatures
Because SCORE does not indicate the lengths of bars, a time signature is necessary at the start of the score so that
Sibelius knows how long to make the bars. If no time signature is present, the converter will display a dialog allowing
you to specify what the implied time signature is; this time signature will not be added to the converted score.
Single-page scores
As well as reading file lists, the converter will read single-page files with the .mus, .pge, and .pag extensions. If the
file does not have one of these extensions, edit its filename so that it does. However, files referred to by a SCORE file
list may use any extension.
Optimizing your score before conversion
Although file conversion generally works quite successfully without adjusting the files in SCORE first, sometimes a few
alterations can substantially improve the quality of the resulting Sibelius score:
Make sure that the beats in every bar add up to the bar duration, and that each bar duration adds up to the
value of the time signature for that bar

?S

Make sure barlines align vertically in each system. The best way to ensure this is to use Scores Line up and
Justify routine (L J)

a
if
Id

Add instrument numbers to all staves by adding a value to parameter 9. This ensures that Sibelius will put music
in the correct instruments
Use SCORE version 3 or later for best results. Open and re-save files created in earlier versions of SCORE using at
least version 3. The file converter cannot open files from SCORE version 1 at all, and files from SCORE version 2
are not as reliably imported as those from version 3.
Limitations
A complete list of the limitations of the SCORE file converter is as follows:

-1 Reference

Feature

Limitation

Beams

Beams sometimes do not convert exactly; complex groupings of partial beams may be interpreted differently by Sibelius

Guitar frames

Some frames convert as a plain grid without a heavy line, or nut at the top

lnstrumen t names

Multi-staff or complex instrument names (e.g. Horns

Key signatures

SCOREs extended key signature parameters 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13 are not converted; their use may produce pitch errors in the
relevant staves

lines

Pedal lines convert as Technique text rather than lines, so they do not affect playback; SCORE version 4 line offsets are not
converted

I yrics

May be incorrectly imported in certain circumstances when a lyric line finishes on the following system at a different vertical
height to the previous system

Notes & rests

Quarter-tones do not convert; staves with three different voices may have stems pointing in the wrong direction

Playback/MIDI

All staves play back with a piano sound; use the Mixer window (shortcut M) to set the correct instrument sound for each
staff after conversion

Slurs

SCORE version 4 slur offsets are not converted

Staves/systems

A Coda appearing on the same staff as the D.S. bar may not convert correctly

Symbols

Some special symbols (especially percussion) may not convert correctly

Text

Subtitle Text usually converted as Title text

T/k

In tied triplets, the tie sometimes overshoots the next note

Tuplets

Triplet number (e.g. 3) may clash with beams; complex tuplets may not convert, giving the error The current duration is not
supported at present: x;yxyx. It is either too small or a tuplet value.

I & II) do not convert

Page numbers

Page numbers
Page numbers are controlled from the Page numbers page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog
(shortcut 6B%E or Ctrl+Shift+E):
l

Show page numbers: you can probably work this one out yourself
First page number: surprisingly, this sets the number of the first page (regardless of whether a page
number is actually drawn on the first page)

Show on first page: usually off, because its normal to omit the page number from the first page

Edit Text Style: use this to change the font, size and position of page numbers; !!LQ Edit Text Styles.

Page numbers should go on the outside edge of double-sided printouts, or the right-hand edge of single-sided
printouts, and normally at the top. This makes the page numbers appear nearest your thumb when you flick through a
score to maximize visibility. Centering page numbers is not considered to be in good taste!

Go to Page
To jump quickly to any page, choose Edit ) Go to Page (6%%G or Ctrl+Shift+G), type in the page number and
click OK.
Hint: to jump to the last page of the score, type a very high number (e.g. 999) - or just use the %%+I or Ctrl+End
keyboard shortcut.
How pages are numbered
By centuries-old convention (in books as well as music), right-hand pages are always odd-numbered and left-hand
page are always even-numbered. So to start with a left-hand page, set the first page number to 2, or leave it at 1 if
your Sibelius file includes a title page (e.g. if it uses one of the manuscript papers with (title) in its name).
If your score has no cover (i.e. the front page has music on), then the front page is page 1.
If your score is self-covering - i.e. the front page is a cover but is made of the same paper as the rest of the score then that cover is treated as page 1 (assuming it starts on the first left-hand page), so set the first page number of your
score to 2.
If your score has a separate cover made of card, then page 1 is normally the first right-hand page inside the cover.
Remember that page 1 normally doesnt have a number printed on it.

341

Reference

Percussion
There is a number of different ways of notating percussion, depending on the nature of the music and ensemble
being written for. For example, in rock, jazz and commercial music, different pitches and noteheads are used to notate
different unpitched instruments on the same staff; this is usually called a drum set (drum kit).
In classical music there are further possibilities:
l

each instrument (or set of instruments) may have a different staff (e.g. cymbal, bass drum, triangle); or
only one staff is used, with text showing where the player switches from one instrument to another; or
each percussion player has their own staff or set of staves; this is useful for extracting separate parts for
individual percussionists to play from.

Sibelius has all the most common percussion instruments built-in, and makes it easy to notate all of the above.
Drum set notation
To create a drum set staff in Sibelius, choose Create b Instruments
(shortcut 6x1 or Ctrl+Shift+l), and select either Drum Set or
Drum Kit from the Percussion/Drums family.
In drum set notation, Sibelius automatically plays particular sounds when particular noteheads appear on particular
lines or spaces in the staff. For instance, a cross notehead on the top line should produce a ride cymbal sound.
Drum mapping
Sibelius default drum set is based on the recommendations of the Percussive Arts Society (in Norman Weinbergs
book, Guide To Standardized Drumset Notation), as follows:

Electric
snare

Pedal
hi-hat

P
I

Bass
drum

Acoustic

I bass drum
0

Low-mid
High
tom-tom wood block

Low floor
tom-tom

A
I

I-

Cowbell

High
Ride
tom-tom cymbal

Low
tom-tom

Acoustic
snare

Low
wood block

Side stick

High-mid
tom-tom

High floor
tom-tom

Closed
hi-hat

Crash
cymbal

Open
triangle

You can modify the noteheads recognized and the sounds they produce from the House Style b Edit Staff
Types dialog:
l

342

From the Category list, choose Percussion


Click 5 lines (drum set) (or any other staff type listed) followed by Edit. You will see this dialog:

Percussion

le
te

The graphical representation of the staff shows the drum mapping - note that you can set different noteheads to
produce different sounds on the same line or space.
To remove an existing notehead, select it (by clicking it) and click Delete
To change a notehead, select the notehead you want to change, and use the drop-down Notehead menu to
choose the desired design
To change the sound used by the selected notehead, choose the desired sound from the drop-down Sound
menu. If your device is GM-compatible (and you are using the General MIDI sound set), this list consists of all
the instruments in the GM Standard Set 1 program.
In the event that the Sound list doesnt include the sound youre looking for, e.g. if your MIDI device has extra
drum sounds, you can also specify the sound by switching on Use MIDI pitch and choosing the correct pitch.
To add a new notehead, click New. The mouse pointer changes color. Choose the notehead and sound you
want from the Notehead and Sound lists, then click on the staff to place the new notehead.
If you create drum set notation using step-time or Flexi-time input, you should check that the setting for each
notehead in the Input using pitch menus corresponds with the key you press on your MIDI keyboard to
produce the same sound (see Step-time and Flexi-time input below).
When you add a new notehead to the drum map, the Input using pitch settings default to the pitch as if
notated on a treble clef staff. If a notehead is already present on the line or space, Sibelius adds a sharp to the
pitch.
MIDI playback
Unpitched percussion sounds, such as those used by drum notation, work in a special way with MIDI. The way you
choose unpitched sounds varies slightly on different MIDI devices, but on General MIDI devices, setting any staff to
MIDI channel 10 makes it use unpitched percussion.
Instead of using program numbers to determine the sound of unpitched percussion, MIDI treats the entire battery of
unpitched percussion as if theyre laid out along a keyboard, with different keys playing different instruments. This
343

Reference

layout is called a drum set (or sometimes a percussion map) because you can play the keys on a MIDI keyboard like
hitting different drums. The whole drum set is treated as one mega-instrument. Sibelius automatica Ily creates drum set
notation when you import a MIDI file with drum tracks in it - IL!2 Importing MIDI files.
MIDI input
When inputting drum set notation using step-time or Flexi-time input, Sibelius automatically maps the pitch of the
notes you play on your MIDI keyboard onto the appropriate pitch, and also chooses the correct notehead. If you play
a pitch for which there is more than one notehead mapped in the staff type, Sibelius will choose the first notehead
listed in the drum map.
You can choose whether to use the pitch mappings determined by the staff type itself (i.e. the Input using pitch
option defined in the drum mapping - see above), or the pitches used by your particular MIDI device (i.e. your
keyboard or sound module). By default, Sibelius expects you to play the pitches set in the staff type; to change this,
choose File b Preferences b General, and change the Input drum notes setting.
In practice, what this means is that if you set the Input drum notes option to Device, you will hear the correct
sound as you input it, and Sibelius will automatically translate the pitch you play into the drum set staff.
Tidying up drum set notation
If you need to change the notehead on a given line or space throughout the score or a passage, use the pitch filter
(Edit b Filter b Advanced Filter dialog, shortcut x6t%F or Ctrl+Ak+F) to select all notes on that line/space and
change them to the desired notehead using the Notehead drop-down menu on the Notes panel of the
Properties window.
The pitch filter treats percussion clefs as treble clef, so:
l

In l-line staves, the pitch of the single staff line is B4


In 2-line staves, the pitches are (from bottom to top) G4 and D5
In s-line staves, the pitches are E4, B4 and F5
In J-line staves, the pitches are F4, A4, C5 and E5
In s-line percussion staves, the middle line is B4

For information on how to use filters - ILL! Filters and Find.


If you played in your drum staff in Flexi-time, or if you import a MIDI file containing a drum staff, the staff may look
untidy because Sibelius only uses one voice by default. In this example, well only examine a single bar, but you could
apply this method to the entire drum staff if you wanted to.
The drum staff on a typical imported MIDI file looks something like this:

All the notes are in a single voice (voice l), and there are lots of unnecessary rests. The first step is to select the bar
and swap everything into voice 2 - choose Edit b Voice b Swap 1 and 2 (shortcut Shift-V). Then use Edit b
344

~I~- .------- _
Percussion

Filter ) Advanced Filter (shortcut x8%F or Ctrl+Ak+F) to filter for the pitch of the hi-hat notes, and choose
Edit h Voice h Voice 1 (shortcut x 1 or Ak+ 1) to split them all into a separate voice. The bar now looks like:

In more complex percussion staves, it may be necessary at this point to split the remaining notes into other voices;
simply use the appropriate filters to select the right notes, then split the selected notes into the desired voice.
In our example, however, were nearly there. At this point you can either:
l

Remove the unnecessary rests with the Remove Rests plug-in (LQ Plug-ins), although youll then have to
restore the cross noteheads on the hi-hat line after copying the drum staff back into the original score; or
Edit the note values of the notes in both voices yourself. Obviously its best to do this for a single bar and then
multi-copy it into the rest of the staff (L!2 Selections and passages).

This leaves us with a much more legible drum staff:

Different staves for different instruments


In orchestral scores, its common to use a different one-line staff for each unpitched percussion instrument used. A
wide range of percussion instruments is accessible from the Create h Instruments dialog.
For example, to notate a bass drum, cymbals and triangle in your score:
l

In the Create h Instruments dialog, choose the Percussion/Drums section and add Cymbals,
Triangle and Bass drum instruments
Note how drums and unpitched percussion are listed in the Percussion/Drums section, and pitched
percussion (e.g. xylophone, marimba, etc.) is listed in the Keyboards section. Dont think too hard about this!

Click Create and the instruments are added to your score.


4

Bass

drum

4 $

crest.
Cymbals

Triangle

--H $

4,

-# $

All of these instruments play back automatically with the correct sound. Note that stems on l-line staves always point
upwards - LQ Edit Staff Types.
345

Reference

Single staff for multiple instruments


Its sometimes desirable to notate the music for a number of unpitched percussion instruments on the same staff,
rather like drum set notation. First, create a Percussion (5 lines) instrument from the Create ) Instruments
dialog. This defaults to using a drum set staff type, which you will need to modify. Using our example bass drum,
cymbals and triangle:
Choose House Style ) Edit Staff Types and choose the Percussion radio button
Click a staff type similar to and with the same number of lines as the one you want to create, e.g. 5 Line
(woodblocks), and click New to create a new staff type based on it
Call it something suitable and then click the Percussion tab
In our example we need only three pitches on the staff to be mapped to particular sounds: well use the top line
for the triangle, the middle line for the cymbals, and the bottom line for the bass drum; select each of the other
unwanted pitches and click Delete to remove them
For each of the remaining pitches, select the notehead, then choose the correct sound from the Sound dropdown menu.
You might also want to change the Notehead for a particular instrument, but this isnt necessary.
When youve set the sounds, click OK to save the staff type
Now select a bar in the percussion staff and choose your new staff type from the list on the Staves panel of the
Properties window.
(You can also change the staff type of a percussion staff in the middle of your score - see Single staff for
each player below.)
Input the music on the staff using the three pitches defined in the staff type; use voices if necessary LQ Voices.
You might also want to change the name of the staff in your score to something more descriptive, like this:
Triangle
Cymbal
Bass drum

Simply double-click the instrument name itself on the first page of your score to edit it, hitting Return (on the main
keyboard) for a new line. Sibelius will automatically right-align the text, and center it on the staff.
(You can also edit the short form of the instrument name by double-clicking it on a subsequent page if you want.)
Single staff for each player
If your score requires more than one percussionist, or if one percussionist is expected to change between instruments,
it is useful to notate all the unpitched percussion on a single staff, with text indicating where the changeover occurs.
Do this by creating a single-line percussion instrument in your score, and use staff type changes to get the correct
sound for playback and (if necessary) to change the number of staff lines. To create a staff type change in the middle
of your score:
l

346

Select the note after which you want the staff type to change

/
I

- -- --

--^PP__
_____~

Percussion
l

f
S

Choose the desired staff type from the Create F Staff Type Change ) Percussion menu; the staff type is
automatically created in the score
You can adjust the exact location of the staff type change using the t/3 keys.

Note that staff type changes are invisible unless View ) Hidden Objects (shortcut 7=B%H or Ctrl+Ak+H) is
switched on. L!2 Staves for more details on staff type changes.
There are many predefined percussion staff types set up with the appropriate sounds; e.g. the 1 Line (cymbal)
staff type plays with a cymbal sound. You can of course create new percussion staff types if required. Create the
changes of instrument indications for the player (e.g. to cymbals or to bass drum) using Technique text (XT or
Ctrl+T) or Boxed text.

Reference

Performance
L!2 Playback.
Sibelius contains such advanced features to improve the playback of your scores that we prefer to think that it doesnt
just play back - it performs!
Options controlling the style of performance are all available from the Play ) Performance dialog (shortcut ShiftP), and are described below.
EspressivoTM
Espressivo (Italian for expressively) is a unique feature which enables Sibelius to play back scores adding its own
expression, like a human performer. Sibelius still obeys the dynamics and articulations you write in the score, but adds
a whole lot of further phrasing and interpretation over and above these.
If you play back a score which uses several instruments - or even a full orchestra - Espressivo produces independent
expression for every single instrument.
In the Play ) Performance dialog, the Espressivo drop-down menu gives five different degrees of expression
for different styles of music:
Meccanico (mechanically) plays the score absolutely literally, with no dynamics or articulations except where
marked
Senza espress. (without expression) adds only tiny fluctuations of volume and slight accents at the start of
bars and note-groups as a human performer will naturally do even when trying to play with no expression
Poco espress. (slightly expressively) has slight dynamics following the contour of the music, suitable for a
fast, fairly mechanical style (such as Baroque music)
Espressivo is the default option, with more dynamics added
Molto espress. (very expressively) produces lots of expression, which can be too over the top for some
kinds of music. It works well for large groups of instruments, as it helps to separate the different lines.
RubatoTM
Rubato is the rhythmic counterpart to Espressivo. Sibelius can subtly vary the tempo of your score to add greater
expression, in much the same way as a human performer would.
In the Play ) Performance dialog, you can choose six different degrees of Rubato from the drop-down list,
which are suitable for different styles of music:
Meccanico: the default option, this plays the score absolutely literally, with no gradations of tempo except
where marked by Tempo text, metronome marks, or ritjaccel. lines
l

348

Senza Rubato: plays the score like a real performer trying to keep the tempo absolutely strict, so there are
some barely perceptible tempo fluctuations
Poco Rubato: adds a small amount of Rubato, so the tempo of your score will vary a little over the course of
a phrase
Rubato: produces moderate gradations of tempo

- -_ -__
Performance
l

Piti Rubato: adds quite a lot of Rubato


Molto Rubato: adds the maximum amount of Rubato, so Sibelius will exaggerate the rhythmic phrasing. This
can sound over the top for some kinds of music.

The recommended setting for rubato in your score is Rubato (the middle setting). Higher settings than this can
produce an extreme effect in which playback may lurch in particularly busy passages.
Rubato may only be slight in music which is repetitive or uniform, as Sibelius bases it on the shapes of phrases. The
effect of rubato is also lessened the greater the number of instruments in your score, as heavy rubato is less
appropriate (and unlikely to be conductable!) for large ensembles.
Rhythmic feel
Sibelius can play back with a wide range of rhythmic feels suitable for different styles of music, from jazz to Viennese
waltz. Some rhythmic feels involve adjusting the notated rhythm, some adjust the beat stresses, and some do both.
The Rhythmic Feel options in the Play ) Performance dialog are as follows:
straight - the default setting
Light / Regula r / Heavy swing - a jazz convention in which two nota ted eighths (quavers) are performed
approximately as a triplet quarter note plus eighth note (triplet crotchet plus quaver),
Triplet swing - swings two eighth notes (quavers) as an exact triplet quarter note plus eighth note (crotchet
plus quaver)
Shuffle - a light sixteenth note (semiquaver) swing
Swung sixteenths - as for Regular swing but swings sixteenth notes (semiquavers) rather than eighth
notes (quavers)
Dotted eighths (quavers) - effectively a very extreme swing; were not quite sure why youd want this, but
here it is anyway
Notes in&gales - triplet quarter note plus eighth note (crotchet plus quaver), similar to Triplet swing, for
an effect used in some early music (although the conventions required for really authentic notes ;&gales are
more complex than this)
Light / Viennese waltz - shortens the first beat of the bar (to a lesser and greater degree respectively), for a
characteristic waltz feel.
Samba - a sixteenth note (semiquaver) feel, stressing the first and fourth beats
Rock / Pop - stresses the first and third beats of a 4/4 bar, lightens the stress on the second and fourth, and
lightens further still on off-beats, Rock more so than Pop
Reggae - a sixteenth note (semiquaver) pattern with a strong emphasis on the 3rd and 4th sixteenths
Funk - similar to Pop, but makes the second beat of the bar (in J/J) slightly early.
You can switch rhythmic feel on or off, or even change from one rhythmic feel to another, for different parts of your
score by adding text indications such as Swing or Straight in Tempo text (which you can hide if necessary) Q2 Playback dictionary.
You might think that you need an option to swing both eighth notes (quavers) and sixteenth notes (semiquavers) at
the same time, but if you think about it, they cant be swung simultaneously - since if you have sixteenths against
349

Reference

eighths, the sixteenths would have to be extra-long in an on-quaver and short in an off-quaver. What you probably
want instead is that in places where the fastest notes are eighths, playback should swing eighths, and where the fastest
notes are sixteenths, it should swing sixteenths. To do this, put suitable hidden text markings where the music changes
between passages of eighths and sixteenths - LQ Playback dictionary.
Incidentally, the option Only change beats on the Play ) Performance dialog should be ignored, since each
of the preset rhythmic feels switches it on or off as appropriate. It controls whether the rhythmic feel only changes the
stress or rhythm of notes which fall on the beat; e.g. Viennese waltz turns this option on, but the swing options
turn it off. Theres no reason to change this, but feel free to experiment if youre particularly bored.
Reverb
Reverb means echo - strictly speaking, the spread-out echo you hear in a room, rather than the delayed one you hear
in the Swiss Alps. Most soundcards and sound modules and some MIDI keyboards can add reverb. Adding reverb can
have a dramatic effect on making your scores sound lifelike, as the human ear is almost as sensitive to the acoustics of
a room as it is to the sound within it.
Sibeliuss Play ) Performance dialog gives six preset degrees of Reverb from Dry to Cathedral. You can also
type an exact percentage into the box at the bottom.
Music for small ensembles may benefit from a small amount of reverb, characteristic of playing in a medium-sized
room, whereas large orchestral works can be given extra depth by greater reverb settings.
Different devices may react differently to the reverb settings - lOOo/o produces an eternal reverb on some equipment
but not on others. Experiment a bit. Some MIDI devices can do a range of other reverb effects, such as plate reverb,
hall reverb and so on; see your MIDI devices manual for details.
Note durations
By default, Sibelius plays both unslurred and slurred notes at full length, so the playback effect is always smooth
(legato). You can change the note durations from the Play ) Performance dialog. To shorten, say, unslurred
notes, reduce the Unslurred notes value.
Note that if you lengthen notes beyond lOOo/o so they overlap, this produces enhanced legato on some MIDI devices
but may cause problems on others where a pitch is repeated - the overlap can cause the second note to play very
short, or you might find that some notes hang (continue playing indefinitely).

350

Playback

Playback
L!Z! Lines, MIDI messages, Mixer, Percussion, Performance, Playback dictionary.
Rit. and accel.
Cliss. and port.
MIDI messages
Instruments with multiple staves
All Notes Off
Playback Options

Design philosophy
What Sibelius reads
Adjusting sounds
Performance options
Dynamics
Hairpins
Trills

To set up Sibelius so it can play back scores, IL!2 MIDI devices.


For an introduction to playing back your score, L!2 Basic playback in the Quick tour.
If you are want to learn the basics of MIDI, which arent required for basic playback but which are worth knowing for
slightly more advanced use, LB MIDI for beginners.
Design philosophy
Our philosophy in designing Sibeliuss playback features is that you should be able to write a score just as you would
on manuscript paper, using normal notation and no special commands, and play it back well without any further
setting up.
The consequences of this philosophy are:
l

Sibelius sets instruments playing characteristics (such as the MIDI program number and channel) to intelligent
defaults
Whenever you play back a score, Sibelius reads more or less anything youve written in the score, in whatever
format you put it. Sibelius even understands markings such as flpizz., accel. or /ego@ and you can add your
own words and phrases to its dictionary.

what Sibelius reads


Almost all of the notation in a score should play back correctly right away. Sibelius reads the following:
Notes, chords, rests, accidentals, ties, grace notes
Clefs, key signatures, time signatures
Instrument names - these determine the sounds used, which you can change if you like
Standard articulations, e.g. accent, staccato, marcato, etc. Tenutos and downbows are treated as a slight accent
Tremolos
Text specifying dynamics such asp,

sfz, loud

Metronome marks such as ? = 108


Other text, e.g. con sord, pizz., legato - LQ Playback dictionary for full details on playback of text
351

Reference

Repeats, including 1st and 2nd endings (1st~/&d-time bars), though not currently codas and segnos
Lines such as slurs, trills, octave (SW) lines, pedaling, ritjaccel., gliss. and hairpins
Guitar notations such as bends and slides
Noteheads used in percussion
Transposing instruments (which always play at their correct sounding pitch)
MIDI messages entered as text commands for advanced playback control - QJI MIDI messages
Hidden objects, e.g. hidden metronome marks, notes or dynamics - l!QZ! Text, Hiding objects.
Adjusting playback
There are various different aspects to playback, which you can adjust in the following ways:
l

Sound..: Mixer window (to set the initial sound - QZ!l Mixer), text such as Flute (to change sound mid-score
- K! Playback dictionary), text such as N P35 (QZII MIDI messages)

0 Dynamics: text such as mf (a Text, Playback dictionary), hairpins (see below), Cresc./Dim.
Playback and Copy Dynamics plug-ins (Q? Plug-ins), overall volume (UJI Mixer), text such as
-C7,64 (ii!ii!I MIDI messages)
0 Tempo. text such as Allegro, Piti mosso, Faster (l!L!2 Playback dictionary), metronome marks and
metric modulations (QZ! Text), rit./acce/. lines (see below), tempo slider (!QZIl Basic playback in the
Quick tour)
l

SomiStageTM: pan position and distance (Q Mixer)


Performance.- EspressivoTM, Ru batoTM, reverb (QZI Performance), rhythmic feel (IQJ Performance,
Playback dictionary)

Dynamics
All staff objects only apply to the staff and voice(s) theyre attached to. For dynamics, its particularly noticeable in
playback if they are attached to the wrong staff (QZI Attachment).
To change the staff to which a dynamic is attached, drag it over the staff you want it to be attached to so that the gray
attachment line jumps onto the new staff, and then reposition it to the correct location.
To change the voice(s) to which a dynamic applies, select it and either use the General panel on the Properties
window (Q Properties), or type x l/2/3/4 or Ah+ l/2/3/4 to assign it to another voice; 715 or Ait+ makes
the dynamic apply to all voices.
When you create a dynamic using Expression text (QZII Text), it derives its playback characteristics from the
appropriate entry in the playback dictionary (IGQ Playback dictionary) - e.g.m equates to a MIDI velocity of
127. But this isnt quite the end of the story - the actual playback velocity of a note also depends on the level of
Espressivo and any articulations (such as accents) present.
Hairpins
When you input a hairpin you can specify its end dynamic, either as an explicit velocity or as a percentage change to
the initial dynamic. In a score you would sometimes write a dynamic after the hairpin, but often you wouldnt and it
would not be clear just how loud or soft you intended the hairpin to go. So Sibelius lets you tell it exactly what the end
dynamic should be without your having to write it in the score.
352
r

-_-_

_ ____-

-----

__--II_

.-- _____ _
Playback

Select the hairpin whose end dynamic you want to change, and open the Lines panel of the Properties window.
By default, hairpins will produce a 20% change from the initial dynamic; you can alter this percentage. Use the dropdown lists to choose a new percentage value, and whether that value is a Change from the initial dynamic or a
percentage of the Maximum volume.
Note that, like Expression text (see Dynamics above), all lines, including hairpins, only apply to the staff and
voice(s) to which they are attached.
(MIDI experts: note that Sibelius implements playback of hairpins by varying velocity at the start of successive notes
rather than by using the volume or expression controller. A side-effect of this is that hairpins will not vary dynamic
along a held note. This is correct for non-sustained instruments such as keyboards and percussion, but not for wind
and strings. If you require controller changes along a hairpin, use the Cresc./Dim. Playback plug-in - !LQ Plugins.)
Trills
By default, trills alternate 12 times per second with an interval of a half-step (semitone), starting on the lower note.
You can write a small accidental as a symbol above the trill to indicate the interval, but Sibelius wont read it directly instead, alter the interval, trill speed, and whether to start on the upper or lower note, from the Line panel of the
Properties window (LQ Properties).
Rit. and accel.
In addition to understanding metronome marks and tempo words such as Allegro (Q2 Playback dictionary),
Sibelius can play rits. and accels. using special lines (LQ Lines) or text objects (iQ2I Text).
We recommend you use rit,/acce/. lines rather than text, because these allow you to specify where the rit/acce/. ends,
namely at the end of the line. The line can be either a visible dashed line or an invisible one (visible as a continuous
gray line when View ) Hidden Objects is switched on). You can also specify the final tempo of the rit/acce/.
from the Line panel of the Properties window (LQ Properties):
l

Final tempo: specified either as an absolute tempo in beats per minute, or a percentage of the initial tempo
(by default it is 75% for any rit. line, and 133% for any accel. line)
You can also specify how the tempo changes during the accel. or if.:
l

Early: changes the tempo most rapidly at the start of the line
Late: changes the tempo most rapidly towards the end of the line
Linear: changes the tempo at a constant rate along the duration of the line.

Note that if you want to return to the original tempo after an accel. or it., you should create a hidden metronome
mark (IZLJI Text). You could also create some tempo text at this point, such as A tempo, but note that this text itself is
ignored by Si belius.
If you write it., m/l. or accel. using text rather than a line (e.g. for singers), Sibelius doesnt know how long it lasts or
what the end tempo is, so Sibelius does a medium rit./accel. lasting for a whole note (semibreve). Note that the
ritjaccel. continues even if a new tempo is marked before the end of the whole note.

353

\. ~~
Reference

Sibelius also understands molto r-it., poco accel., and so on - see the Play ) Dictionary dialog for a complete list of
the words it knows. If you want to make Sibelius play back an instruction that it doesnt understand, either add a new
word to the playback dictionary, or simply hide a rit./accel. line and create some text at the same position.
Gliss. and port.
G/&S. and port. lines (ELI lines) play back, defaulting to an appropriate kind of glissando for the instrument to which
they apply, e.g. passing through chromatic steps for wind instruments, but a continuous slide for strings. If you want to
change the way a line plays back, select it and use the Lines panel of the Properties window:
l

Glissando type provides different kinds of glissando. Normally you can leave this set to Instrument
default.
For the Continuous glissando type (a smooth slide), the speed of the gliss, is expressed as a curve:
l

Early: plays thegliss. quickest at the start of the line


Late: plays thegliss. quickest towards the end of the line
Linear: plays the gliss. at a constant speed from beginning to end.

Instruments with multiple staves


If your instrument normally uses two staves, such as a piano or harp, note that because dynamics can only apply to a
single staff, you will need to create suitable dynamics in, say, the left-hand piano staff and hide them in order to get
the dynamics of the two hands balanced. You can use the Copy Dynamics plug-in to do this for you; it
automatically copies Expression text and hairpin between the selected staves, and hides the duplicates - E!ZI Plugins for more details.
Where the number of staves used for an instrument changes, such as where an instrument divides into staves for
separate players or later rejoins, you may need to put a hidden dynamic and/or playing technique (e.g. plzz., mute) at
the start of the next system to match the dynamic/technique prevailing just before the staves changed. This is because
playback effects are tracked along each staff - Sibelius doesnt know if a player moves from one staff to another.
All Notes Off
Play ) All Notes Off (shortcut Shift-O) switches all notes off. This may be necessary:
l

If your computer, soundcard or MIDI device gets overloaded by fast-forwarding or rewinding (which it may do if
your device is not very fast or if youre fast-forwarding or rewinding through complex music)
If you stop playback while the sustain pedal is depressed.

If you hear a note hanging while the score is playing, you can even type Shift-O during playback - Sibelius will clear
all notes and resume playback.
Playback Options
For advanced users only.
The Play ) Playback Options dialog contains options for specific MIDI devices. Unless you experience problems
with playing back through external MIDI devices (i.e. not your computers soundcard or built-in sounds), theres no
need to change these options.

354

Playback

Sibelius follows the score during playback with a blue line which shows the current position. If, for some reason,
youd rather Sibelius didnt do this, switch off Follow score during playback.
Send reset controllers at start: tells Sibelius whether to reset all the MIDI controllers when it starts
playback; if you use the Proteus 2, switch this option off.
Send bank high (controller 0) and Send bank low (controller 32): these options tell Sibelius
whether to send bank numbers when sending program change messages; if you use the Roland SC-88 or Korg
05RW, you might want to change this option off if you find that sending bank messages changes the mode of
the MIDI device or chooses a non-GM bank. (These settings give global control over whether Sibelius sends
bank messages, but you can also change this on a staff-by-staff basis from the Play ) Mixer dialog LQ Mixer.)
Send program changes: tells Sibelius whether to send program changes when it starts playback. You might
want to switch this option off if you need to specify the patch used by a particular MIDI channel in your score
(e.g. if you are using a package like Cigasampler for playback).
Notes play back as you click them and drag them. If you find this annoying, switch off Play notes as you
edit.

Reference

Playback dictionary
IL!2 Playback, MIDI messages.
Sibelius reads and interprets musical text such as mJ: pizz. and /egato when playing back. Although all the most
standard terms are predefined for you, you can modify exactly what effect they have on playback, or for that matter
add new words and phrases to its dictionary.
Standard words
Although this is not a comprehensive list, here are some of the words that Sibelius plays back:
0 Words Sibelius will understand if you create them in a system text style (such as Tempo or Metronome mark)
include:
0 Metronome marks such as J = 150
l

Tempo text such as Adagio, Allegro, Andante, Grave, Largo, Fast, Faster, Stretto, Bewegt,
Schneller, and even partial words like Allarg (which will also cover Allarg. and Allargando), and
instructions like Poco rit., Molto accel., etc. (though its advisable to use acce/./rit. lines instead l!Q2! Lines)

Rhythmic fee/ instructions like Light swing, Viennese waltz, Reggae, Funk, Swung, etc.

0 Words Sibelius will understand if you create them in a staff text style (such as Technique, Boxed text, or Small
text) include:
0 Playing techniques such as mute (which produces different effects on, say, trumpets and violins), open, solo,
tutti, arco, pizz., co/ legno, detache, non legato, marcato, senza sord, tacet, quiet,p, mJpitif: and so on
l

instrument changes such as to Flute, to Oboe, or just Clarinet, Trumpet, Clock., etc.

Look at the Play b Dictionary dialog itself for a complete list of words that Sibelius understands.
Adding and editing words
To add new words to the dictionary or edit existing ones, choose Play b Dictionary:

Qu3rters/mn

T ampo

356

Adagio

NO

Tempo

60

Quartersimrn

Andante

No

Tempos

80

lluartcrsirnrr~

PIU mc7s50

NO

Tempo scale

Mano mosso

NO

T e m p o s c a l e 80

&

X=

1.1 0

M atronnme

0 3

Quarter;

x=

Nn

Metronome

U 25

Quarterr

X=

No

Metronome

[I 375

Quarters

2il

x =

Metronome

Wuarters

e=

Metronome

Quarter-,

Playback dictionary

From the list at the top you can choose to see either staff text (dynamics, playing techniques, etc.) or system text
(tempo changes).
For any piece of text you can modify various settings:
Text: double-click the text to get an caret so you can edit it
whole word: No means that the word is an abbreviation. For example, Sibelius will change to a pizzicato
string sound when confronted with any word beginning with the letters pizz, so that pizz, pizz. (with a period)
and pizzicato will all produce the same effect. (pizza will also work, but is unlikely to occur in your score.) If
your word is not an abbreviation, set this to Yes instead.
Effect governs the sort of thing the word does:
Velocity sets a specific velocity (expressed conveniently as a percentage - 1 000/o = velocity 127)
Velocity change gets louder or softer by a specified percentage (e.g. - 10% gets loo/o softer)
Duration scale affects the lengths of notes - e.g. stuccuto makes notes

50%

length

Sound changes the bank and program number, such asplzz. N.B. the program number here counts from 0
even if your MIDI devices manual counts from 1; bank numbers have to be entered as a single number see Bank numbers below
Named Sound allows you to change the sound of a particular staff to a named instrument or an effect
such as pizz. or mute. This is preferable to using a Sound change, because bank and program numbers
are often different on different MIDI devices. Moreover, some effects such as mute will automatically
produce a different sound on different instruments (e.g. muted trumpet as opposed to muted strings)
Tempo (for system text) sets a specific tempo, for words such as Allegro
Tempo scale (for system text) instantaneously gets a specified percentage faster or slower
Rhythmic feel (for system text) allows you to switch between any of Sibeliuss predefined rhythmic feels
(ILLI Performance)
Metronome (for system text) defines the meaning of the first half of metronome marks such as J = . . . .
Its hard to make head or tail of these in the dictionary because the music symbols show as funny text
characters, but dont worry about it - you wont need to change these
The first Value is the number required by Effect; for Swing/Groove changes it specifies the rhythmic feel
to be used
The Unit (which cant be edited) is usually O/O; for Sound changes it specifies the Bank
The second Value is only used in two cases. For Sound changes it specifies the Program number. For
Velocity changes it specifies whether the volume changes Gradually (over four quarter note (crotchet)
beats) or Instantaneously - click to change between these.
To add a new word or phrase to the list, click New (which copies the settings of the current word if you have one
selected). Then edit the settings for the new word.
You can also Delete the selected word, or click Move up/down to move the word within the list.
Words in the playback dictionary are case sensitive - so they only play back if you type upper and lower case letters as
shown in the dialog. This is not a problem since, in practice, musical terms are written only in lower case, except for
some tempo text and instrument names. However, if you are adding a word to the dictionary which you want to use in
357

/
Reference

different cases, e.g. whistle or Whistle, you should define it first in (say) lower case, then select it and click New to
create a copy, and finally edit the copy to begin with a capital letter..
Rhythmic feel
You can switch between any of Sibeliuss predefined rhythmic feels at any point in your score. Most are already
defined as words in the dictionary; to use others, simply define a new system text word with Effect set to
Swing/Groove, set Value to the desired rhythmic feel, and then enter the word in your score in a system text
style (e.g. Tempo text). Dont forget that you can hide this text object if you want (Q2l Hiding objects).
Bank numbers
Bank numbers are calculated from two other numbers, known as the Most Significant Byte (MSB) and Least Significant
Byte (LSB). The formula for calculating bank numbers is (MSB x 128) + LSB. These values will be given in the manual
for your MIDI device. For example, your MIDI devices documentation might say something like:
Bank number
Bank 0
Bank 1
Bank 2

MSB

LSB

64
64
64

0
1
2

So to calculate the bank number for bank 2 in the above example, the calculation is (64 x 128) + 2, which gives a bank
number of 8194, which is the number you should use in the Play b Dictionary dialog.
Some manuals will present bank numbers as single values rather than as separate MSB and LSB, in which case you
dont need to get your calculator out.

EC

358

___~____ -.--~-- _____- -__-_______ __ --- .- -.Plug-ins

to

-JY
to
xt

Plug-ins
Sibelius supports plug-ins, which are extra features of which many are included but others can be added on to
Sibelius. A number of very useful plug-ins are provided in the File k Plug-ins submenu, organized into further
submenus by category.
Sibelius also includes an easy-to-use programming language called Manuscript, with which you can write your own
plug-ins,
Note that you cannot undo a plug-in, so be sure to save your score before running any of these plug-ins, in case you
dont like the results. However, you can stop a plug-in while its running: just click the Stop button that appears in the
top left-hand corner of the screen.
Other plug-ins
New plug-ins are constantly being developed for Sibelius. Extra free ones are added to the Sibelius website from time
to time - choose Help ) Help Center and visit the online Sibelius Help Center for details,
If you write a plug-in which you think would be useful to other Sibelius users, please email details to
helpUK@sibelius.com and well consider including it on our web site or with future versions of Sibelius. We pay
good money for good plug-ins!
Alternatively, if you have an original idea for a plug-in but dont feel up to writing it yourself, let us know.
Organizing your plug-ins
If you like, you can change the groupings of the submenus within File ) Plug-ins. You could, for example, group all
the plug-ins you use most frequently in a single sub-menu. Find the Plugins folder inside your Sibelius program
folder, create a new folder called, say, My favorites, then copy (or move) the plug-ins from other folders into this
one.
Installing new plug-ins
To install a new plug-in, copy the plug-in file (with extension .plg) to one of the folders inside the Plugins folder
within your Sibelius program folder. The plug-in will automatically be loaded the next time you run Sibelius.
Edit plug-ins
File ) Plug-ins ) Edit plug-ins lets you unload, reload, delete, edit and create new plug-ins.
Select a plug-in from the list and click the appropriate button:
l

Unloading a plug-in removes it from Sibelius; this doesnt delete it from your hard disk, but does save
memory. Unloaded plug-ins are described as such in the list.
Reloading a plug-in gets it back again after unloading it
Deleting a plug-in removes it from your hard disk
New and Edit are for creating your own plug-ins.

Reference

Creating your own plug-ins


This requires a knowledge of the ManuScript language, which is straightforward enough to learn but beyond the scope
of this manual. Full documentation for Manuscript is included as an Acrobat PDF file in the Extras folder within your
Sibelius program folder.
The File ) Plug-ins ) Trace Plug-ins dialog is useful for debugging plug-ins you are developing yourself. See the
Manuscript documentation for further details.

Apply House Style to Folder of Files


Applies a specified House Style file to all the files in a selected folder.
To use the plug-in, choose File ) Plug-ins ) Batch Processing ) Apply House Style to Folder of Files.
You are prompted to select the House Style library file (.lib) you want to apply, then you are prompted to select the
folder of files to which the house style should be applied.

Fi

A number of predefined house styles are supplied in the House Styles folder in the Extras fol der within your
Sibelius program folder - LQ House Style.
Convert Folder of Acorn Sibelius Files
Batch converts all Acorn Sibelius files found in a specified folder - LQ Opening Acorn Sibelius files.
Convert Folder of Files to Graphics
Batch converts all scores in a folder into graphics files of a specified format - /!LQ Saving graphics files.
To use the plug-in, choose File ) Plug-ins ) Batch Processing ) Convert Folder of Files to Graphics,
and choose the folder you want to convert. You will be prompted to choose the graphics format; you can also choose
whether or not to use the default settings. Generally you can leave Use default settings switched on and simply
click OK to save all the files. If you switch off Use default settings, you will be prompted to choose the settings
for each file in the folder.
Convert Folder of Finale Files
Batch converts all PrintMusic 1 .O, Finale and Allegro 98/2000, and Finale 2001/2002 ETF files in a specified folder
L!2 Opening Finale, Allegro and PrintMusic files.
Convert Folder of MIDI Files
Batch converts all MIDI files in a specified folder. Note that these files should be Standard MIDI Files (with the fi
extension .mid on Windows) rather than in other sequencer formats - L!2 Opening MIDI files.
Print Folder of Files
Prints all Sibelius files in a specified folder. This is particularly useful for printing a set of extracted parts with a single
click!

360

cl
in
Find
Cal
To
Fik

Plug-ins

COMPOSING TOOLS
Double/Halve Note Values
It is sometimes useful to halve or double all the note values in your score, e.g. if you are transcribing early music in
which note values are twice as long as they would be written in modern editions.
To run these plug-ins, select a passage of music and choose Double Note Values or Halve Note Values from
the File ) Plug-ins ) Composing Tools menu. A dialog appears, warning you of the plug-ins limitations.
When you click OK, a new score will be created with the selected passage copied into it in augmented or diminished
form. The plug-ins also copy time signatures (halving them as appropriate), and create ties as appropriate.
These plug-ins have the following limitations:
l

Tuplets are omitted, but the rest of the bars in which they appear are copied correctly
Bars of irregular length (e.g. pick-up or anacrusis bars) may not be copied correctly.

Find Motif
Examines your score for motifs which match either the intervallic relationships or the rhythms (or both) of a selected
passage, and labels each match with a highlight (LU! Highlight). This is very useful for analysis, such as finding all
the occurrences of a fugal subject, or examining how a particular rhythmic pattern is used in a piece.
To use this plug-in, select the motif which you want to match, and choose File ) Plug-ins ) Composing
Tools ) Find Motif. A dialog appears allowing you to set a few options:
Original motif is in voice x: allows you to choose in which voice the plug-in should find the original motif.
(Note that this option only determines where the first instance of the motif is found - the plug-in will always
match all voices throughout the rest of the score.)
Match rhythm: switch this on if you want to find rhythmic matches
Match pitches: switch this on if you want to find intervallic matches. Any exact transposition of the motif is
matched, but diatonic or other inexact transpositions are not; so (for example) in a fugue the plug-in finds real
answers but not tonal ones.
Switch on both Match rhythm and Match pitches to find only occurrences which match both.
Click OK and a progress bar appears, telling you which staff the plug-in is examining. After a few moments, the plugin will tell you how many matches it found, which will be highlighted in yellow.
Find Range
Calculates the range (i.e. lowest and highest notes) and average pitch of a selected passage. This is useful if, for
example, you are writing vocal music and want to know what kinds of demands you are placing on your singers.
To run this plug-in, select a passage (or triple-click a staff to calculate its range throughout the score) and choose
File ) Plug-ins ) Composing Tools ) Find Range.

361

Reference

Invert
Performs an inversion on the selected passage around a specified pitch. Note that this plug-in overwrites the original
music, so make sure you are either working on a copy of the original material, or that you have saved the score before
running the plug-in (since, like all plug-ins, it cannot be undone).
To run the plug-in, select the music you want to invert, and choose File ) Plug-ins ) Composing Tools )
Invert. A dialog appears, in which you can set the pitch around which to invert the material.
pitch Mapping
Sometimes you may want to generate variations on an existing passage, transposing it into, say, the minor mode. This
plug-in allows you to specify new pitches for each degree of the chromatic scale, and changes (maps) the pitches in
the selected passage accordingly.
To use the plug-in, select the passage you want to map, then choose File ) Plug-ins ) Composing Tools )
Pitch Mapping. Choose the desired pitches from the drop-down menus in the plug-in dialog (which also includes
an option to transpose all notes above a certain letter name up an octave), and click OK.
The plug-in examines all the notes in the selection, and calculates the pitch of each note relative to C (so 0 for C, 1 for
C#/Db, and so on). It then alters the pitch of each note according to the settings from the plug-ins dialog. Suppose
you set D to map to A# in the dialog box: any D in the selection will be replaced by A# ln the same octave as the
original (octaves go from C up to B).
So if you set, say, G to map to D, it will map to the D below the original note. This isnt always whats required; if so,
set the Move everything above the following note up to the next octave control. With this option
switched on, if a note is higher than the pitch set here, it will be mapped to the new pitch, and then transposed up an
octave.
Retrograde
Creates a retrograde version of the selected passage - in other words, it turns the music backwards. For example, this
plug-in rewrites the following passage:

as:

To use this plug-in, select the passage you want to retrograde, and choose File ) Plug-ins ) Composing
Tools ) Retrograde. A dialog appears, advising you of the limitations of the plug-in. When you click OK, a new
score will be created containing the resulting music.
This plug-in has the following limitations:
l

362

Lines and key signatures are omitted


Tuplets are omitted, but the rest of the bars in which they appear are reversed correctly
Bars of irregular ength, such as pick-up (upbeat) bars, may not be reversed correctly.

Plug-ins

rnal
ore

NOTATION

Add Brass Fingering


;)

iis
in
)
S

r
3
1

This plug-in adds appropriate fingering for a number of common brass instruments, including trumpets in Bb, C, D
and Eb, horns using F and Bb fingerings, and 3- and J-valve euphoniums.
To use the plug-in, select the passage for which you want to add fingering (e.g. triple-click the staff of the brass
instrument in question) and choose File ) Plug-ins ) Notation ) Add Brass Fingering. Choose the
instrument from the dialog and click OK to add the fingering to your score in the Fingering text style; if you find that it
collides with notes or other markings, select one text object and choose Edit ) Select ) Select More (shortcut
4B%A or Ctrl+Shift+A), and move the whole row together using the /t\/$ keys.
Add Cautionary Accidentals
If a pitch has an accidental in one bar of a score and then reverts to the pitch determined by the key signature in the
following bar, it is normal to place a cautionary accidental before the relevant note in the second bar. This plug-in
performs that operation for you, either on a selected passage or an entire score, with the option to mark each added
cautionary accidental with the text [CA] or a highlight (so you can proof-read the changes).
To apply the plug-in to an entire score, choose Edit ) Select ) Select All (shortcut #A or Ctrl+A) to select the
whole score, then choose File ) Plug-ins ) Notation ) Add Cautionary Accidentals.
However, the plug-in can only be applied to a whole score in a single operation if there are no changes of key in the
piece. When starting the plug-in, you will be required to enter the number of flats or sharps in the key signature;
therefore, if there is a change of key in your score, the plug-in will give you the error message Select a passage
that is in a single key. To avoid this, select the part of your score up to the first key change, run the plug-in, then
select the part of your score from the first key change to the next key change, run the plug-in, and so on.
The plug-in includes a built-in Help function which gives further information on using its other parameters.
If your score is very long, you could use Sibeliuss Edit ) Find feature to find all the [CA] annotations the plug-in
had added to it.
Add Chord Symbols
Analyzes the harmony of your music and automatically adds appropriate chord symbols above the selected staves.
You can choose to analyze any or all of the staves in your score, and choose where the chord symbols will be created.
To run the plug-in, select the staves in which the harmony occurs (e.g. the two piano staves) and then choose File )
Plug-ins ) Notation ) Add Chord Symbols. A dialog will appear, as follows:

363

Reference

You can generally leave these settings at their defaults - simply click OK to add chord symbols to your score.
If you wish to change the settings, there are many options for controlling the results, as follows:
l

Add chord symbols: at the start of every bar or every note value from the start of the bar
(where note value is selected from a drop-down list): this option determines how often the plug-in will add
chord symbols to the score.

How to find root note and Root note analysis options: these options control how the plug-in
determines the root note of the chord, which is the most important step in naming the chord. For instance, C6
and Ami are effectively the same chord (they contain the same notes), but have different root notes.
If the Always try to find root note by analyzing the notes option is selected, the plug-in will
attempt to guess the root note by various methods (controlled by the Root note analysis options). Sibelius
cannot always guess the root note correctly (since any note in a chord is a potential root note, and Sibelius cant
read the composers mind - yet!).
If you dont like the plug-ins guesses for the root notes, try using the Take root note to be the lowest
sounding note option. As its name suggests, this assumes that all chords are in root position, with the root
note at the bottom of the chord. Alternatively, you can use the Take root note to be lowest note in
the following staff number option, which reads the root of the chord from a particular staff.

Root note analysis options:


Prefer 7ths to 2nds: if there is an interval of a 2nd between any of the notes in the chord, the plug-in will
try to place it as 7th - Tonic rather than Tonic - 2nd or any other interval. This option ensures, for example,
that the notes Bb - C - E - G from bottom to top are recognized as C7 rather than B?h 6s) or Erni+(#ll) or
something else equally improbable.
Prefer chords containing a triad: when this checkbox is selected, the plug-in will choose the lowest root
note that gives the chord a major or minor triad (from the root) if possible. If no such note is present, the plug-

364

Plug-ins

in will use other methods to try to find the root note, unless Use bottom note if chord has no triad is
selected, in which case the plug-in uses the lowest note in the chord as the root.
Notation options: these options control whether to write a chord symbol at every position specified by
Add chord symbols (at the top of the dialog) or whether to omit redundant ones:
Insert chord symbol at every specified position always writes a chord symbol, regardless of whether
or not the actual chord has changed.
Only insert chord symbol if the root note has changed: with this option selected, the plug-in will
not create a new chord symbol if the root has not changed since the last chord symbol. Note that the chord
itself could change, e.g. Cto C7, but the chord symbol would still be omitted with this option selected.
Only insert chord symbol if the chord name has changed: with this option selected, the plug-in
will only omit a chord symbol if it would be identical to the last chord symbol created, e.g. the second of two
consecutive C chords wouldnot be created, but a C7 following a C chord would be written.
Put chord symbols on the following staff number: this option determines the number of the staff
in the score where the chord symbols will be created, relative to the top selected staff, i.e. if you select three
staves and want the chord symbols created above the second of these three staves, you would enter 2 here.
Note that, as with all staff numbers in this plug-ins dialog, the numbering counts from the top selected staff
(number 1) downwards, and includes any hidden staves that may be included in the selection. If the plug-in
seems to add no chord symbols to the score, it may be that you have chosen to create the chord symbols onto
a hidden staff.
More notation options:
Use slash inversion marks: when selected, the plug-in will notate different chord inversions in the
standard way, by writing the chord symbol followed by a slash or oblique (/) and the name of the note at the
bottom of the chord. For example, a C major chord in first inversion would be written as C/E.
Only write chords with 3 distinct notes: when selected, only chords with 3 or more different notes
will be notated as chord symbols. This avoids adding ridiculous chord names with lots of omissions at points
where only one or two notes are sounding. However, with this option selected, power chords (e.g. C5) will not
be created.
Notate omissions of: these options control which intervals are marked as omissions if they are missing
from a chord in which they would normally be expected. If, for example, the 5ths option is switched on, the
chord C-E-Bb will produce the chord symbol C7comit?
Note that for 7ths/%hs/l 1 ths/l sths, an interval is expected if the chord name contains a higher-numbered
extension. For example, a Cl3 chord is by default expected also to contain a 7th, a 9th and an 1 lth. Such a
chord is unlikely to be fully-voiced in practice, so it is useful to switch off the omission options for some of these
higher extensions - they are off by default.
Add Ficta Above Note
In early music, accidentals are often implied but are not explicitly written in the original manuscript because of the
performance practices of the day. Modern editions often show these so-called musica ficfa by placing small editorial
accidentals above the notes in question.

365

Reference

This plug-in inserts accidental symbols above the note and also the pitch-bend MIDI messages required to make the
notes sharper or flatter as appropriate.
To use the plug-in, select the note(s) to which you want to add the ficta and choose File ) Plug-ins ) Notation )
Add Ficta Above Note. A dialog appears: choose whether you want to add sharps, flats or natural signs, and then
click OK.
The plug-in inserts a MIDI message above the selected note to alter its pitch, and another message on the next note to
restore the pitch. If you want to add ficta to two (or more) adjacent notes, the second MIDI message should be
removed after running the plug-in - provided View ) Hidden Objects is switched on (shortcut x8%H or
Ctrl+Ait+H), simply select the second MIDI message and hit Delete.
Note that the MIDI messages apply to all notes on that staff, so in music with chords or multiple voices, the effect may
be somewhat strange: in such cases, you may prefer to create the accidental yourself from the Create ) Symbol
dialog, although it will not play back.

Add Note Names


Writes A, C# etc. above every note in the score.
To run the plug-in, simply select a passage (or make sure nothing is selected if you wish to add note names to all
staves throughout your score) and choose File ) Plug-ins ) Notation ) Add Note Names. A simple dialog
appears, allowing you to specify whether the note names are added in upper or lower case, which text style is used,
whether it should use the sounding or written pitch (for transposing instruments), and whether note names should be
added to the selected passage or the whole score.
The text is added in the Technique text style; if you find that it collides with notes or other markings, select one text
object and choose Edit ) Select ) Select More (shortcut &%A or Ctrl+Shift+A), and move the whole row
together using the +/\L keys.
Add String Fingering
This plug-in adds appropriate fingering to music for violin, viola, cello and double bass.
To use the plug-in, select the passage for which you want to add fingering (typically, triple-click the staff of the
instrument in question) and choose File ) Plug-ins ) Notation ) Add String Fingering. Choose the desired
instrument from the dialog; you can also choose the fingering position(s) to be used (the default setting is 1 and 3,
which will add the fingerings for first position and then go back and attempt to fill the gaps with fingerings from third
position). Click OK to add the fingering to your score in the Fingering text style; if you find that it collides with notes or
other markings, select one text object and choose Edit ) Select ) Select More (shortcut 4B%A or
Ctrl+Shift+A), and move the whole row together using the /t/+ keys.

Add Tonic Sol-Fa


Adds tonic sol-fa notation to a selected passage or the entire score. Tonic sol-fa is both a form of musical notation
used in vocal music and a system of teaching sight-singing which depends on it.
Pioneered by John Curwen in 1840s England, and since modified by Kodaly in the twentieth century, tonic sol-fa
notation is based on the moveable doh system of solmization. The notes of the major scale are named (in ascending
order) doh, ray, me, fuh, soh, lab, te, where doh is the tonic, other notes being thus related to the tonic of the
366

.__A_-_ _______

Plug-ins

moment, which changes if the piece modulates. Minor keys are treated as modes of the relative major, the minor scale
being solmized as /ah, te, doh, ray, etc. In notation, the notes are abbreviated as d, r, m, f, s, I, t. Sharps and flats are
indicated by change of vowel, sharps to e, flats to Q (pronounced aw); e.g. doh sharpened is de; me flattened is ma.
Colons (:) separate one beat from the next, single dots (.) are used when a beat is divided into two half-beats, and
commas divide half-beats into quarter-beats. Horizontal lines show that notes are to be held over a beat (or sub-beat)
boundary; blanks indicate rests.
The following example, taken from John Curwens snappily titled The Sfandard Course of Lessons on the Toni Sol-fa
Method of Teaching to sing, shows how the notation looks in practice:

Id

:d (d
:d
Come and sing a

(d :-.r
Irn :mer - ry song,

:s
Irn
:s
jr
Wake the cheer - ful

:-

1:

glee,

To use this plug-in, select a passage and then choose File b Plug-ins b Notation b Add Tonic Sol-Fa. A
dialog appears, in which you should specify the key of the selected passage. You can also specify which voice to
solmize, and various options concerning the way the tonic sol-fa notation will look. When you are ready to proceed,
click OK, and the sol-fa notation will be added to your score.
Note that if your score includes changes in key signature, the plug-in cannot read these automatically, so you should
run the plug-in for each section of your score in different keys. Note also that, by default, the tonic sol-fa notation is
added in the Lyrics text style, so you should either add the real lyrics to your music using the Lyrics Verse 2 text style,
or manually move any existing lyrics before running the plug-in, to prevent the sol-fa notation appearing on top of the
lyrics.
This plug-in has the following limitations:
l

The spacing of barlines may not be correct (these can easily be adjusted by hand afterwards)
Empty pick-up (anacrusis) bars may not be notated correctly
The plug-in uses non-standard bridge note notation for modulation; it is usual to use subscript and superscript
characters, but these cannot be created, so the plug-in instead writes [old note] new note
The plug-in also uses non-standard tuplet markings (> instead of an inverted comma)
Some of the rhythmic markings may be spaced too close (again, this can easily be adjusted by hand afterwards).

Make Layout Uniform


Forces your score to have a specified number of bars per system and systems per page. The default of 4 and 4 is
suitable for voice or solo instrument with keyboard accompaniment. Solo keyboard music typically has 4 bars per
system and 6 systems per page. Music for a single-staff instrument typically has 4 bars per system and 10 systems per
page.
The first page of a score often has fewer systems than subsequent pages, to make room for the title; this plug-in
allows you to set the number of systems on the first page independently from the rest of the score.
If you wish to make your entire score uniform, make sure nothing is selected (hit Esc) and choose File b Plugins b Notation b Make Layout Uniform. You can choose to format only a selected passage instead: simply
make your selection and then run the plug-in.
367

Reference

If you dont like the resulting layout, reselect the passage or your whole score, then choose Layout ) Format )
Unlock Format (or type &I% or Ctrl+Shift+U).
Make Pitches Constant
Sets all the notes in a selection to the same pitch. This is useful for creating a percussion line with the same rhythm as
a pitched instrument, by copying the music and then making the pitches constant.
To use this plug-in, select the passage of pitches to be made constant, then choose File ) Plug-ins ) Notation )
Make Pitches Constant. All the pitches are changed to B4, which is the middle line of a s-line or j-line staff, or
on the line of a single-line staff.
Number Beats
This plug-in numbers the beats in a bar for a selected passage; for example:
1

4+

2+3+4+

To use the plug-in, select the desired passage, and choose File ) Plug-ins ) Notation ) Number Beats. The
beat length is taken from the time signature, e.g. 6/8 has dotted quarter note (crotchet) beats. The text is added in the
Technique text style; if you find that it collides with notes or other markings, select one text object and choose Edit )
Select ) Select More (shortcut 4&A or Ctrl+Shift+A), and move the whole row together using the +/$
keys.
Remove Dangling Ties
Sometimes a note will continue to sound indefinitely during playback if you have inadvertently used a tie when you
meant to use a slur; this plug-in checks your score for notes with ties which are left dangling - in other words, not
tied to a subsequent note.
To use the plug-in, select the passage you want to correct and choose File ) Plug-ins ) Notation ) Remove
Dangling Ties.
Remove Rests
Removes rests in the selected passage of music. If you find that you end up with unwanted rests after Flexi-time input
or importing a MIDI file, you can use this plug-in to clean up the music.
For example, this plug-in rewrites the following music:

as:

368

Plug-ins

To use the plug-in, simply select the passage from which you want to remove rests, and choose File ) Plug-ins )
Notation ) Remove Rests. A dialog appears, reminding you of the plug-ins limitations; when you click OK a
new score is created, containing the cleaned-up music, which you can copy back over the original.
The plug-ins limitations are as follows:
l

Tuplets are omitted, but the rest of the bars in which they appear are copied correctly
Bars of irregular length, such as pick-up (upbeat) bars may not be copied correctly.

Respell Flats as Sharps/Respell Sharps as Flats


Alters the enharmonic spelling of accidentals in the selected passage. Simply select a passage, choose File ) Plugins ) Notation ) Respell Flats as Sharps or File ) Plug-ins ) Notation ) Respell Sharps as Flats,
and all flats/sharps in the selected passage will be respelled.
Split Dotted Quarter Rests
In compound time signatures such as 6/8, Sibelius will notate a beats rest as, say, a dotted quarter note (crotchet),
which is the modern convention. Some musicians find it easier to read these rests if they are split into separate quarter
note (crotchet) and eighth note (quaver) rests, This plug-in automatically replaces such rests, as follows:

To use the plug-in, select the passage in which you want to split the rests, and choose File ) Plug-ins )
Notation ) Split Dotted Quarter Rests. The passage may of course include notes, which are left alone.

Copy Dynamics
Copies all Expression text and hairpins from one staff to another in a single operation. This is especially useful for
making dynamic markings play back on both staves of a keyboard instrument.
To use this plug-in, select the two staves you wish to copy text between - e.g. triple-click the right-hand piano staff
then Shift-click the left-hand staff - and then choose File ) Plug-ins ) Playback ) Copy Expression Text.
Note that because you only need one visible set of dynamics between keyboard staves, the copied text and hairpins
are automatically hidden, so they will not print and will only be visible if you have got View ) Hidden Objects
(shortcut x#H or Ctrl+Alt+H) switched on (L!2 Hiding objects).
Cresc./Dim. Playback
Enables the playback of crescendos and diminuendos over single held notes for appropriate instruments (particularly
wind, strings and singers). Sibelius does not automatically play back hairpin markings over single notes because it uses
MIDI velocities to achieve gradations of dynamic on successive notes. This plug-in inserts a series of MIDI volume
messages in order to change dynamics during a single note.
369

Reference

To run this plug-in, first create hairpins where you want the volume to change, then select a bar or a passage
containing the hairpin(s). If you just want to process one hairpin, the best way to do this is by selecting the hairpin.
Note that you only have to select the bar in which the hairpin starts, not the one in which it ends.
When you have made your selection, choose File ) Plug-ins ) Playback ) Cresc./Dim. Playback. A dialog
will appear, allowing you to choose whether you wish to process every hairpin in the selected passage or just the first
hairpin, and to specify the start and end dynamic of the cresc./dim.
You can also choose whether to use MIDI controller 7 or 11 to produce the dynamic change. By default, the plug-in
uses controller 7 (volume) since this is supported on all MIDI devices, whereas controller 11 (expression) is not so
widely supported. You may find that after creating the series of MIDI messages, you need to insert a further MIDI
message yourself to reset the volume level on that particular staff - LL!/ MIDI messages for further information.
Note that the plug-in will not affect playback unless you put a hairpin in your score before running it, so if you dont
want a hairpin to appear you can temporarily create one and then delete it after you have run the plug-in (which will
not delete the MIDI messages).
The MIDI messages created by the plug-in are automatically hidden, so they will only be visible if you have got
View ) Hidden Objects switched on (shortcut xxH or Ctrl+Alt+H).
Quarter-tone Playback
Inserts MIDI messages to make quarter-tones play back. To use this plug-in, either select a passage or the whole score
(using %A or Ctrl+A), then choose File ) Plug-ins ) Playback ) Quarter-tone Playback.
A dialog appears, allowing you to choose the amount of pitch bend required to produce a quarter-tone. Usually you
should leave this at the default - so just click OK.
Note that the MIDI messages created by this plug-in are automatically hidden, so you will not be able to see them
unless you have got View ) Hidden Objects switched on (shortcut -cgc%H or Ctrl+Alt+H).
This plug-in has a built-in Help dialog which describes its operation and limitations in more detail.

PROOF-READING
Proof-read
This plug-in allows the user to run any combination of four other proof-reading plug-ins which are in the same menu:
l

Check Pizzicatos writes warnings in the score where an arco or pizz. seems to be surplus or missing
Check Repeat Barlines writes warnings in the score where a start or end repeat seems to be surplus or
missing (i.e. the repeat barlines dont match up)

Check Clefs writes warnings in the score where a clef is repeated unnecessarily, e.g. an alto clef would be
repeated if you omitted a change to treble clef in a Viola part.

370

Check Harp Pedaling writes warnings in the score if any notes in the selected passage are unplayable on a
harp with the pedal configuration specified. For best results, you should only select the harp staves before
running this particular plug-in, and specify a passage which contains no pedal changes.

Plug-ins

If your score is very long, you could use Sibeliuss Edit b Find feature to step through the warnings the plug-ins put
In your score.
If you wish, you can run any of these plug-ins individually by choosing them from the File b Plug-ins b Proofreading menu.

Check for Parallel 5ths/8ves


Checks for fifths and octaves between notes in any voice on any staves. The plug-in even checks for hidden fifths and
octaves (i.e. where they occur in contrary motion).
If you want to check the entire score, choose Edit b Select b Select All (shortcut %%A or Ctrl+A), then choose
File b Plug-ins b Proof-reading b Check for Parallel 5ths/8ves. In the dialog, choose to check the entire
score and choose whether you want to check for fifths or octaves, or both. Click OK - and after a few moments of
busy activity, Sibelius tells you how many errors it found, which are marked in the score as text. (The warning text
starts just over the first offending note of the parallel 5th/8ve.)
If your score is very long, you could use Sibeliuss Edit b Find feature to find all the annotations the plug-in has put
In your score.

Reference

Preferences
LQ Keyboard shortcuts, View menu.

The File b Preferences b General dialog contains various options which affect the Sibelius program as a whole.
These options remain permanently set until you change them again, rather than being saved in individual scores.
If Sibelius is used on the same computer at different times by different users, then Sibelius automatically remembers a
different set of preferences for each person if they log on to the computer as a different user.
The preferences are:
Play music when Sibelius starts allows you to switch the splash screen music on or off
Measurement Units determines the units used by the on-screen rulers - EL! View menu
Auto-save controls Sibeliuss auto-save feature - ILQI Files
Undo allows you to set how many changes to your score Sibelius will remember - ELI Undo and Redo
The Opening Scores options allow you to switch on various self-explanatory warnings or updating options
Use Default Zoom Level allows you to determine whether Sibelius opens scores at the zoom level
specified here, or at the zoom level you were using when you last saved the score
Inputting notes contains options used in Flexi-time (L!2 Flexi-time) and percussion notation
(LQI Percussion)
Backups determines how many backups Sibelius retains when you save scores - LLI Files
Middle Mouse Button / Scroll Wheel controls whether the middle mouse button does the same as
Alt+click (Windows only) - IL!2 Basic editing in the Quick tour.

Printing

Printing
For details of standard paper sizes and advice on what page and staff sizes to use for particular types of music,
IL!2 Document Setup.
If you want to produce quantities of high-quality printed scores, ILL! Publishing.
Printing
Choose File h Print (shortcut B%P or Ctrl+P). A standard Print dialog appears, with some extra options on.
If you have more than one printer connected to your computer, you can choose which one you want to use from the
drop-down list at the top of the dialog. On Windows, you can also alter specific driver options by clicking Properties.
On Mac, you should use the pop-up combo control at the top I eft to select the Sibelius page of options, rather than
the default General page.
Set the print options described below as you want them, then click Print (Mac) or OK (Windows) and the printing
will begin.
Hint: you can print Sibelius files without running Sibelius: on Mac, simply drag the files icon to the printer icon on
your desktop; on Windows, right-click on the files icon and choose Print from the menu t :trat appears.
The options in the File ) Print dialog are as follows:
Print range
If you dont want to print the whole score, then (on Mac) on the Sibelius page of the File h Print dialog or (on
Windows) in the Pages box, you can type a list of pages to print (e.g. 1, 3, 8), and/or a range of pages (e.g. 5-9),
which can be backwards to print in reverse order (e.g. 9-5).
You specify pages using the numbering written in the score, so the first page isnt necessarily page 1.
Copies and Collate
By default, one copy will be printed, though you can set any other quantity you want in the Copies box (/I.&c.* this is
on the General page). Multiple copies are done of each page in turn, so if you choose two copies the pages will
come out in the order 1, 1, 2,2,3, 3, etc.
However, if you switch on Collate (/kc.- on the General page, but not present on all printers), each copy of the
score is collated properly, so the pages come out in the order 1,2,3, 4.. 1, 2, 3, 4.. This saves you having to sort the
pages into order yourself, but on laser printers printing may take a little longer.
Border
This option (lilac: on the Sibelius page from the pop-up combo control) prints a thin border around the page.
When printing on outsize paper, this makes the pages easier to visualize, and easier to guillotine, than just using crop
marks. Its also very useful to proof-read scores scaled to (say) 650/o, with Border and Spreads (see below)
switched on.

Reference

Crop marks
These are little cross-hairs used in professional publishing to point to the corners of the page. Crop marks are required
because books are printed on oversized paper which is subsequently trimmed to the required size.
Its only sensible to use crop marks if youre printing on paper which is larger than your scores pages.
Fit to Paper
This scales the score down in size, if necessary, so that the music fits within the print margins of the paper, to avoid
the edges of the music being clipped. This is particularly useful for printing Letter sized scores on A4 paper (and vice
versa), and for reducing Tabloid/A3 scores onto Letter/A4 paper. Fit to Paper does not however expand the music
to fill the paper if it is larger than the page size.
This option automatically adjusts the Scale setting (see below), so if you have Fit to Paper switched on, you
shouldnt change the Scale setting yourself.
Scale
Your music is normally printed at lOOo/o size, though you can set any other scale factor you like. To reduce the music
to fit onto smaller paper, simply switch on Fit to Paper instead of working out the scale factor yourself.
Print View menu options
This prints options switched on in the View menu, such as highlights, hidden objects and note colors - E! View
menu for more details of these options.
Substitute options
These options fix various printer problems and/or may improve the print speed or quality. When you have time to test
them, try various combinations of these options to see if you can gain any improvements.
The options are as follows:
l

Lines: some printer drivers do not print staff lines evenly, and may even fail to print them altogether; some
drivers draw lines such as bat-lines and stems with rounded instead of flat ends. Some PostScript printers may
give out of memory errors when printing many pages at once. Turning this option on may solve these
problems and should increase print speed, but may make staff lines slightly uneven in thickness.
Braces: some printer drivers print braces either in the wrong place or using the wrong symbol. Switch on this
option if you have these problems.
Arpeggios, gliss., etc.: some Windows printer drivers have a bug which makes angled text and wiggly
glissando and arpeggio lines print at the wrong angle or in the wrong place; if you find this happens, switch on
this option.
Symbols: this option affects how symbol fonts - used for e.g. notes, time signatures, clefs and other symbols
in your score - are rendered by your printer, Symbol fonts include Opus, Inkpen2, Opus Percussion, Opus
Special, and so on, and other fonts such as Symbol, Wingdings, and other dingbats fonts. If this option is set
wrongly for your printer, then symbol fonts may not display or print at all. The four choices are as follows:
l

Default: the default and recommended setting; this should work in nearly all cases
Automatic: Sibelius detects whether symbol fonts are in TrueType or PostScript format and renders them
accordingly

374

--- -- ---

Printing
l

lired

PostScript: Sibelius assumes all symbol fonts are in PostScript format


TrueType: Sibelius assumes all symbol fonts are in TrueType format.

Double-sided printing
To print your music double-sided:
l

loid
/ice
lsic
OU

3C

ry

Under Format, select Normal and Odd. Print the score. Only odd-numbered (i.e. right-hand) pages will be
printed.
Feed the pages back into the printer, possibly face up (depending on how your printer feeds it). If the first page
of your score is even-numbered - that is, if it is a left-hand page - you should feed in one extra blank sheet at
the start, since the first page shouldnt end up with anything printed on the front.
Now select Even. Print the score again, to print the even-numbered (i.e. left-hand) pages on the back of the
odd-numbered ones.

If the pages come out of your laser printer face down, you may have to reverse the order of the sheets before printing
the second side, or alternatively just print the second side in reverse order (by typing a backwards page range such as
8-l). You will have to try and see, as this varies from printer to printer.
Laser printers tend to wrinkle paper slightly when printing on it. This can make printers misfeed if you put paper back
in to print on the other side. This problem will be reduced if you leave the paper to settle for an hour or so after
printing the first side, or if you feed the paper manually sheet by sheet for the second side (which is a bore). Some
misfeed problems are also caused by residual static from the corona charge in most laser printers; it may be alleviated
by riffling the paper before re-feeding.
Spreads
This prints two consecutive pages side by side on each sheet of paper. This format is suitable for proofing, or (in
scores without suitable page-turns) for producing a row of pages on a music stand.
With Spreads selected, either:
l

make sure your paper is at least twice the size of your pages in Sibelius (e.g. Tabloid/AZ paper for Letter/A4
pages); or

0 use the same page size as paper size but reduce the Scale accordingly, e.g. print Letter/A4 pages at 70% on
Letter/A4 paper.
Then print as normal, using any other options such as Border.
To print a single double-page spread (e.g. pages 2 and 9, just specify one of the page numbers (e.g. 2) and Sibelius
will know to print the other next to it.
Booklet
A booklet is a small book consisting of double-sided pages stapled in the middle. Booklets are printed with two pages
side-by-side on sheets of paper which are twice the size of the ultimate pages.
The pages have to be numbered strangely when printed so that it all works when the booklet is assembled. For
instance, the outermost sheet of a 16-page booklet would have pages 16 and 1 on the front (in that order) and pages

375

Reference

2 and 15 on the back. Fortunately this complicated layout procedure, known technically as imposition, is done
automatically for you by Sibelius.
To print as a booklet, either:
make sure your paper is twice the size of your music pages in Sibelius (e.g. A3 paper for A4 pages), or

use the same page size as paper size but reduce the Scale accordingly, e.g. print two A4 pages at 70% on A4
paper.

Then:
l

Click Booklet and Outward pages


Print as normal. One side of the paper will be printed.
Click Inward pages
Feed the paper back into the printer, and print again to do the other side.

As with ordinary double-sided printing, if the pages come out of your laser printer face down, you may have to reverse
the order of the sheets before printing the second side, or alternatively just print the second side in reverse order (by
typing a backwards page range such as 8-l). You will have to try and see, as this varies from printer to printer.
You can use all the other options when printing booklets too, e.g. Pages, Crop marks, Odd and Even, etc.
Collate is particularly useful for producing a stack of copies which you only have to fold.
Beware that, as mentioned earlier, US paper sizes such as Letter and Tabloid are not quite the same shape as each
other, so when printing in booklet format the page margins may turn out differently than you expect. No such
problem arises with European paper sizes.
Sibelius assumes that the finished booklets first page is numbered 1, even if your scores first page number is not 1.
Thus if your score starts on page 2, this will appear as the inside left-hand page of the booklet, not on the front. This
lets you leave the front page blank in case you want to add a special cover produced using a different program.
When printing Outward pages Sibelius first prints the double-page containing page 1, then 3, 5, 7 etc. Similarly,
when printing Inward pages, Sibelius starts with the double-page containing page 2, then 4, 6 etc.
For example, the printing order of an 8-page booklet is like this:
l

Outward pages: I & 8 (together, page 1 on the right), 3 & 6


Inward pages: 2 & 7,4 & 5.

Note also that two adjacent page numbers on a sheet always add up to the total number of pages (rounded up to a
multiple of four), plus 1; in the above case, 9.
If you want to print a specific double-page from a booklet - e.g. pages 8 & 1 from an 8-page booklet - just specify one
of the pages (e.g. page 1) and Sibelius will know to print the other next to it.
Other options (Mac only)
Depending on your printer driver, you may be able to select other options from the remaining pages of the File b
Print dialog, accessible from the combo control at the top. These pages may include:
l

Cover page: enables you to print a cover page either at the beginning or end of your score

376
1

r,____-____ _-.

Printing

Color matching: only accessible on color printers, these options affect subtle aspects of printing pitch
spectrum notes, highlights and notes out of range in Sibelius, but are unlikely to be particularly useful to you.
Layout: duplicates some of the imposition techniques described above; you should generally use Sibeliuss
own Spread and Booklet functions instead
Error handling: concerned with the reporting of PostScript errors
Save as file: includes options for creating EPS files; normally you should use Sibeliuss built-in EPS exporting
instead (!I&!! Saving graphics files).
Printing multiple files at once
You can print multiple files at once (e.g. a set of extracted parts) using the Print Folder of Files plug-in;
DZ!I Plug-ins.
Choosing good paper
Investing in very good paper can make your printouts look twice as good. Good paper is bright white, is very opaque
so the music doesnt show through the back, and is reasonably stiff so it doesnt flop on a music stand. Avoid ordinary
thin typing paper or photocopier paper - we recommend paper of about 26lb/ream or 100gsm.
Problems with margins
Some printers may cut off the edges of your music, particularly the bottom edge. This is because most printers need
room to grip the paper.
One solution is to move the music further away from the edge by increasing the musics page margins on the
Layout b Document Setup dialog (shortcut 6t%D or Ctrl+D).
If your musics layout is sensitive to reformatting, and you find that only (say) the bottom of the page is being cropped
off, you can prevent the music reformatting by decreasing the top page margin by (say) 0.2 inches (5mm) when you
increase the bottom margin by 0.2 inches @mm), so that the music just moves up the page a little. Alternatively, use
Lock Format before adjusting the margins (Q2 Layout and formatting).
Problems with double-sided printing
If your printer misfeeds, try any or all of these:
l

Leave the paper to cool for a while after printing the first side
Manual feed the second side
Open the exit flap (if there is one) on the printer, which provides a straighter feed path.

If toner on the first side slips off when printing the second side:
l

Leave the paper to cool for a while after printing the first side
If there are settings to feed the paper faster (e.g. a lower print resolution), try these for the second side.

Reference

Properties
For advanced users only
Almost every object in a score has properties which can be edited in various subtle ways via the Properties window.
For instance, the font and point size of a text object can be changed from the Text panel of the Properties window;
the horizontal offset and voice of a particular note can be changed from the General panel; and so on.
In general these properties are more easily set when you create the object, but it is sometimes useful to see or edit
properties subsequently. Many of the properties can also be viewed/edited from the normal menus, or edited using
shortcuts.
Viewing properties
By default, the Properties window is visible on the screen with all its panels closed, except for
the keypad (which is effectively just another Properties panel).
You can hide the Properties window (and subsequently show it again) by choosing
Window b Properties. If you want to hide the keypad, just click the Keypad bar to close
the panel.
You can also separate the Properties window from the keypad by choosing Window b
Keypad (Separate) and move them to different parts of the screen, which can be a very
useful way to work.
The title of the Properties window reflects the current selection - so with nothing selected it
says Nothing selected; with the title or tempo marking of your piece selected it says Edit Text;
with a single note selected it says Edit Note; with a passage selected it says Edit Passage; and
when the caret is visible it says Create Note/Rest; and rather than try to list all the types of
object in a multiple selection, it will simply read Edit Multiple Selection.
To open and close each of the six panels, click its title bar. You can open each panel independently, so they can be
viewed together in any combination. If you try to open more panels than will fit vertically on your screen, Sibelius will
automatically close one or more panels so that the Properties window always fits on the screen.
The options on each panel are detailed below.
Multiple selections and passages
If you have a multiple selection or selected passage, only those properties which are common to all the selected
objects will be shown. For instance, if you select two notes, only one of which has an accent, the accent button on the
keypad will not light up. If you click the accent button, both notes will end up with an accent, so the accent button will
then light up.
The keypad
The keypad - which mirrors on the screen the arrangement of keys on your computers numeric keypad - shows the
properties of the selected note(s), chord(s) or rest(s), e.g. when you select a quarter note (crotchet) in your score, the
378

- __.~_ .-

_________ ____._

Properties

quarter note (crotchet) on the first keypad layout lights up. Likewise, selecting a dotted quarter note rest will make the
quarter note, rest and rhythm dot buttons on the keypad light up.
If a note has properties that are not visible on the currently selected keypad layout, the tabs for those keypad layouts
will also be illuminated in a lighter shade of blue to show you. For example, if you are looking at the first keypad
layout and select a quarter note with a quarter-flat and a fermata (pause), the fourth and fifth keypad layout tabs will
also be illuminated.
To move between keypad layouts, you can either:
l

click on the tabs at the top of the keypad in the Properties window; or
click
on the keypad to cycle through the layouts in order (shortcut +), and click
keypad layout (shortcut - on Mac, and F8 on Windows); or

to return to the first

type F8-F12 to view the five keypad layouts.

Similarly, to toggle a particular keypad property on or off for the selected object, you can either:
l

click the icon with the mouse; or


hit the corresponding key on your numeric keypad.

If you are, say, looking at the first keypad layout, and want to change the selected note into a half note (minim), you
would simply type 5 on the numeric keypad. To add a tie, you would hit Enter on the numeric keypad, and so on.
Similarly, to remove a tie, select the note on which the tie begins and hit Enter. You can add and remove properties
from any of the keypad layouts in this way - so if you wanted to add a fermata (pause) to your half note (minim), you
could simply hit Fl 1 (to reach the fourth keypad layout), then hit 1 on the numeric keypad to add the fermata.
General panel
The General panel of the Properties window lets you change the voice, position
etc. of the selected object(s), and also gives you a read-out of the current staff and bar
number. This is very useful when you are working at a high zoom level, or on a score
for a large ensemble and cant always see the instrument name for the staff youre
working on.
The options on this panel are as follows:
The first line on the panel tells you the name of the staff to which the object is attached (or says System for
system objects)
Bar x and Pos tell you the bar and rhythmic position within the bar to which the object is attached. The Pos
readout is always in quarter notes (crotchets) regardless of the time signature; for lines and tuplets, this refers to
the position of the left-hand end; if no Pos is stated, the object is attached to the start of a bar. You cant edit
these parameters directly - just move the object with the mouse or arrow keys.
Voice tells you which voice(s) the object is in. You can change this (e.g. you can swap a note in voice 1 into
voice 2) simply by choosing the desired voice from the drop-down menu. Note that text, lines etc. also belong in
particular voices, which can also be changed here. For example, you could make a dynamic marking in
Expression text apply to voices 1 and 3, but not 2 and 4, or make a hairpin apply to all four voices, and so on.
You cannot, however, assign a note or rest to multiple voices.
379

Reference

/ i

There are shortcuts to change voice: K l/2/3/4 or Alt+ l/2/3/4, or for all voices use 7:5 or Alt+5.
l

Show, Hide etc. determine whether or not the object is hidden in the score and/or extracted parts. These
options are the same as in Edit b Hide or Show; D2 Hiding objects.
Flip allows you to change the stem direction of selected notes, and flip certain objects above or below the staff,
such as slurs, tuplet brackets, articulations, and the curvature of ties. To flip an object, use this option, or choose
Edit b Flip (shortcut X), rather than trying to drag it with the mouse.
X tells you the horizontal displacement of the object from the position its attached to. (For example, the end of
a slur can be attached to a note even if its slightly left or right of it.)
You can edit this value, which is particularly useful for positioning notes, rests and chords out of alignment when
using two or more voices, or for displacing rehearsal marks from a barline.

Y means different things for different objects. For notes and chords, this determines the stem length. For lines
and text, it is the distance above the default vertical position.

Text panel
The Text panel allows you to change the text style of the selected text object, and
also alter its font, point size, and whether the text is bold, italic or underlined. The
options are as follows:
The first drop-down menu shows the text style of the selected text object; change
the style simply by choosing another one from the menu. Note that you can only
choose compatible styles - so you cannot change a system text object (e.g. Tempo text) into a staff text object
(e.g. Expression text). L!JI Text for more details.

Si~q=SJ=~I r-u

The second drop-down menu shows the font of the current text object; change the font simply by choosing
another from the menu. To change the font (or size) of all text in that style in your score at once, LQ Edit
Text Styles.
Size is the size of the font (in points).
B, I and U control whether the selected text is bold, italic and/or underlined respectively. The shortcuts for these
are #B/l/U or Ctrl+B/I/U.
Lines panel
The Lines panel allows you to change the properties of the selected line. Note that not all
the options on this panel are appropriate to all kinds of lines, so some may be unavailable.
The options are as follows:
l

Middle controls the curvature of the selected slur


End controls the horizontal (X) and vertical (Y) offset of the right-hand end of the
selected slur. IEQ Slurs for more details.
Gliss./Rit./Accel. allows you to change the playback effect of these types of lines.
ILL!! Playback for more details.
Hairpin allows you to set the final dynamic, or percentage change in dynamic, of a
selected hairpin. LQ Playback for more details.

380

--L--

~~.____ _________

-r

__

_~~

_____

Properties
l

se
ff I

se
If

Trill allows you to set the interval in Half-steps (semitones), Speed, and whether playback should Start
on high note of a selected trill. You can also choose whether a trill should Play straight if playback uses a
rhythmic feel (!LQ Performance).

Bars panel
To change the properties of a bar, select the bar so that it is surrounded by a blue box,
and then change the options on the Bars panel, which are as follows:
Brackets/Initial barline/Clefs/Key signatures determines whether these are
drawn at the start of the bat-preceding the barline when the bar is at the start of a system
or occurs after the gap in a divided system such as a coda or incipit.
l

Section end marks the barline as the end of a section for the purposes of the
instrument name formats chosen in the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog

(shortcut 46t%E or Ctrl+Shift+E). You should create a system or page break at the same point.
The first drop-down menu shows you which breaks (if any) occur at the bat-line - so you can add or remove a
system or page break at the selected barline. This can also be done from the Layout ) Breaks menu (or
using shortcuts). Ignore Middle of system/page, which are used by Lock Format and Make Into
System/Page.
Gap before bar alters the indent before the bar preceding the barline when the bar is at the start of a
system, or the size of the gap just before the bar in a divided system such as a coda.
The second drop-down allows you to change the type of bar rest used in the selected bar; L!2 Bars and bar
rests for more details.
Staves panel
To change the properties of a staff, select a bar so that it is surrounded by a single blue
box. The options on the Staves panel are as follows:
The drop-down menu at the top of the panel shows the (initial) staff type of the
selected staff. To change it, choose another from the menu. Note that this will
change the staff type from the start of the score; if you need to create a staff type
change in the middle of the score, LL! Staves.
Small staff determines, oddly enough, whether the selected staff is small or not; by default, small staves are
25% smaller than normal staves; you can change this from the Staves page of the House Style )

Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut U%%E or Ctrl+Shift+E)


Range displays the Comfortable and Professional note ranges for the staff; the left-hand drop-down
shows the lowest note the instrument can play in that range, and the right-hand drop-down shows the highest.
I!LQl Instruments.

381

Reference

hlotes panel
The Notes panel allows you to change the notehead of the selected note(s), alter the
horizontal position of accidentals, and adjust the position and shape of ties, The options are
as follows:
The drop-down menu at the top of the panel shows the selected notehead; to change
the notehead, choose it from the drop-down menu. To change noteheads using the
keyboard, hold down c)x or Shift+Alt and type the notehead number on the main
keyboard - LQ Noteheads.
l

Act. X controls the horizontal offset of the accidental attached to the selected note. Positive values move the
accidental right, negative values move it left. You can also move accidentals by selecting them and typing
x+/3 or Ait++/+.
Tie middle: Y controls the degree of curvature of the tie. You can also adjust this by selecting the tie and

typing /t/+.
l

382

Tie ends: Y controls the vertical position of the right-hand end of a tie attached to the selected note. L and R
control the horizontal position of the left- and right-hand ends of the tie respectively. You can also adjust this by
selecting the end of the tie and typing U-c+/+ or Shift+Alt+t/+.
Tuplet allows you change the appearance of the selected tuplet, such as whether or not the bracket is
displayed. &!A Triplets and other tuplets for more details,

Publishing

Publishing
LQ Internet publishing.
This tells you how to produce high-quality printed scores in small or large print runs, so that you can do your own
music publishing from start to finish.
Being your own publisher
Most music is never published. Even well-known composers belonging to leading music publishers sometimes find
that much of their music exists only in photocopies of their original manuscript, which only see the light of day if
someone hires it out for a performance. Certainly a lot of the classical music of the last 50 years or so that gets
published is done as a loss-making promotional exercise, in the hope that its presence on a bookshelf might bring it to
the attention of potential performers. This is also sometimes true of more commercial scores such as musicals. So the
situation for lesser-known composers and arrangers can be very frustrating.
Fortunately Sibelius changes all this. If you want to distribute your music quickly and easily, you can publish it via the
Internet - Q2 Internet publishing for details. But Sibelius can also help you to bring a score right from its
gestation in your head to a warehouse-full of scores and parts, printed and bound, as well as any publisher can do it.
This is because even large publishers often have no more equipment than you do. What they do have is a famous
name, a logo and the attendant mystique. All you need is a little know-how and a friendly local printers.
Short print runs
If you only want to produce, say, 100 copies of a score it is probably uneconomic to have it printed. You can either
print out copies on your own printer, or produce a master copy and get it photocopied and bound.
Photocopying, if done professionally, can be hard to distinguish from proper printing - but if you just do it yourself in
your local copy shop it will show. You may be amazed at what you can produce, but frankly that quality may not be
high enough for mass consumption. Even if the music is only going to be photocopied it may bn worth producing a
master copy on a fairly high-resolution printer (see below), or at least printing on large paper and then reducing it
when you photocopy. Doing the reverse - printing on Letter or A4 size and then photocopying up to Tabloid or A3 does work but the quality can be a little embarrassing.
longer print runs
To publish music in quantity it has to be printed by a printing company. This used to be done by giving them a highquality printout which they would photograph; these days, the norm is to provide the artwork as an EPS file on CD-R
or Zip disk. Its easy to produce EPS files from Sibelius - /!Q2 Saving graphics files. Note that you should switch
on Embed fonts when doing this.
The printing company will use an imagesetter (a special high-resolution printer - 2540dpi or more) to output your
music onto transparent film, which can be made into printing plates. Some companies can produce plates straight
from your disk, without producing film first.
The plates then go into the printing press. Printing is done onto large sheets of paper which are then trimmed to size.
Hence printing companies will much prefer your artwork to have crop marks, which are cross-hairs at the corners of

383

Reference

the page showing where the paper should be cut. You can switch on crop marks when you save your score as EPS
files.
The printing company should be able to print, collate and bind as many copies as you want. The cost per copy tends
to drop rapidly as the number of copies increases, because there is quite a significant initial setting-up cost.
Factors affecting print quality
Resolution: when you get above 6OOdpi, the resolutions of printouts are hard to distinguish on large staff sizes,
but with smaller staves the difference is perceptible. For instance, there is a just perceptible difference between
12OOdpi and 254Odpi.
l

IY0te.s: printing plates are made out of various materials. Generally your printer will decide which is best. Metal
plates produce the highest quality, polyester plates are cheaper but nearly as good, and paper plates are of
lesser quality and only suitable for posters and other undetailed documents.
Paper. most books and music are printed on white bond - plain white uncoated (non-glossy). lb/ream (North
America) and glm or gsm (Europe, meaning grams per square meter) indicate the weight and hence the
thickness of the paper. 21 lb/ream or 80 gsm is most common for typing paper, photocopy paper and fairly thick
books. 26lb/ream or 100 gsm is preferable for music because its less translucent and single sheets are less likely
to flop over on music stands.

Summary
To recap, if you want publication-quality artwork suitable for mass-printing you must either:
0

384

Invest in a laser printer of 600dpi or higher quality; or


Create EPS files of your music, with embedded fonts and crop marks, and give it to a printing company on CD-R
or Zip disk for them to print. Also give them a paper printout of the score as a proof. If the printing company
dont have their own imagesetter to output film from your disk, they should be able to recommend a typesetting
company who can do this stage for you. Getting music properly printed like this is more hassle and more
expensive (except for large quantities) than the other option, but will give very high-quality results.

Rehearsal marks

Rehearsal marks are large letters or numbers which pinpoint important places in the music. They are automatically
lettered or numbered in sequence by Sibelius - you only have to indicate where they go. This means that you can
create and delete marks freely without having to worry about re-lettering or renumbering them yourself.
Creating rehearsal marks
Choose Create b Rehearsal Mark
l

Normally, leave Consecutive selected, and click OK


l

If no note is selected, the mouse pointer will change color and you should click above a barline to place the
rehearsal mark
If a note is selected, the rehearsal mark is automatically positioned above the barline at the start of that bar.

#R or Ctrl+R is the shortcut for a (consecutive) rehearsal mark.


As you add further rehearsal marks, Sibelius always keeps them lettered or numbered in sequence. So if you copy
several along a staff, they will appear as A B C D E. If you then delete B, the subsequent marks will be automatically
changed from C D E to B C D to maintain the sequence. Similarly, if you create a new rehearsal mark between two
others, the subsequent marks will be adjusted.
Start at...
If you want to restart rehearsal marks for a new movement, or if youre inputting an excerpt from a score so you dont
want the first rehearsal mark to be called A (or I), or if for any other reason you want an out-of-order rehearsal mark,
when creating the mark choose Start at and type the mark you want into the box.
Sibelius will continue the sequence thereafter for Consecutive rehearsal marks - e.g. if you ask it to start with Y2, it
will follow this with 22, then A3, B3, etc.
To write a weird rehearsal mark that is not in sequence with anything, such as the word START in a box, choose
Create b Text b Special Text b Rehearsal Mark, then click in the score and type your text.
Editing rehearsal marks
You can drag, copy and delete rehearsal marks in the normal ways. As you drag them, they snap to barlines
horizontally.
As with tempo text, large scores often have more than one of each rehearsal mark - say, one above the system and
another above the strings in orchestral music.
If you move or delete the top rehearsal mark, any duplicates lower down the system will move or delete with it.
However, if you move or delete a duplicate rehearsal mark instead of the top one, it will behave independently. This
allows you (say) to move or delete just the rehearsal mark above the strings if there is a high note it would collide
with.
You can alter which staves rehearsal marks and other system objects appear above - @2 layout and
formatting.
385

Reference

If you need to move a rehearsal mark slightly left or right of the barline to avoid an obstacle, select the rehearsa I mark,
edit its X value on the General panel of the Properties window.
Engraving Rules options
You can choose the format in which all rehearsal marks appear from the Rehearsal marks page of the House
Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut 0%gE or Ctrl+Shift+E). The choice is:
l

A-Z, Al -Zl , A2...


A-Z, AA-zz, NW...
1, 2, 3...
Bar number
Hide all

The format changes for all existing rehearsal marks, so after changing to the third format the sequence Y Z AA BB
would become 25 26 27 28.
(.5/;ght fun: set rehearsal marks to Bar number format. Create a rehearsal mark, and watch what happens when you
drag it from bar to bar.)
The font, size, box and so on is controlled by clicking the Edit Text Style button. L!2 Edit Text Styles.
Rehearsal marks are automatically shrunk to a smaller size than the score in extracted parts. You can control the size
they end up at from the Options button in the File ) Extract parts dialog. Q2 Extracting parts.

386

Saving graphics files

nark,

use

Saving graphics files


Sibelius can export (save) a passage or page of music as a picture in various standard graphics file formats. This means
you can include music in other documents, e.g. articles, worksheets, essays, music books cover designs, posters and
program notes.
All music examples in this User Guide were saved directly from Sibelius into Microsoft Word - no scissors and glue
were required!
If your final document will consist mostly of music, you can alternatively use Sibelius itself as the program in which to
assemble music and graphics, e.g. to create worksheets or scores with a graphical cover page. ELI Importing
graphics.

SE3

Save as Graphics
Because most of us prefer not to think about technicalities, Sibelius takes the strain out of exporting graphics files you generally dont even need to know which kind of graphics file you need to export; just which program you want to
use it in.
Sibelius allows you to export the whole score, a single page, or one or more systems just as easily:
l

If you want to export one or more systems, first select the desired systems as a passage, then choose File b
Save as Graphics
If you want to export one or more whole pages, or the whole score, just choose File b Save as Graphics.

TIle Save as Graphics dialog has the following options:


Program/Format: lists the programs Sibelius directly supports, together with the various graphics file formats
that it can save, so if your chosen program isnt listed, you can choose the most appropriate format for your
software
Pages: you can choose to export all the pages of your score, the selected systems only, or a range of pages in
much the same way as choosing which pages to print in the Print dialog, e.g. you can type 1,3,1 O-23.
387

Reference

Filename: determines the name of the file given to the exported graphics file; if you save a multiple pages, the
name entered here forms the basis of the name of each file (which will be preceded by the page number of the
score), and optionally also the name of the folder
Save to folder: allows you to choose where the exported graphics file(s) will be saved; click Browse and
choose the desired folder
Create subfolder: if you choose to export a range of pages or the whole score and you switch this on,
Sibelius will create a folder to put all the graphics files in, by default taking its name from the Filename
specified above and appending the name of the format; so if you specify a filename of, say, Concerto 1 st
movt and export EPS files, the folder will be called Concerto 1 st movt EPS (although you can change this
if you like)
Substitute: these options do the same as for printing (Q2 Printing), namely fix bugs in certain printer
drivers which can make lines and braces draw incorrectly
Scale: this option (only available when exporting BMP, PICT or EMF files) determines the resolution of the
resulting graphics file(s). A bitmap saved at lOOo/o will look as blocky as music does when viewed at lOOo/o
zoom factor in Sibelius. 200% is reasonably smooth, but occupies quite a lot of memory.
Include View menu options: this option specifies whether the current options from the View menu
(such as hidden objects, highlights, note colors and so on) should be included visibly in the graphics file(s). By
default this option is switched off.
Options: these options are for exporting EPS files:
l

Include TIFF preview: allows you to include a monochrome TIFF preview (compressed using the CClll
modified Huffman RLE scheme) in the EPS file, which will enable most graphics programs to show you a lowresolution preview of the EPS file before printing
Smallest bounding box: defines the dimensions of the resulting EPS file. If this option is switched off,
the EPS file will use the page dimensions of the score (including the margins) as the bounding box. With the
option switched on, the EPS will be cropped to the smallest size possible, i.e. just to the edges of the music.
Embed fonts: with this option switched on, Sibelius will embed all the fonts used in the document in the
EPS file. Although embedding fonts increases the size of each EPS file you create, it ensures that the publisher
or printer who wants to use your EPS files can print them correctly without requiring separate copies of the
fonts themselves. It is recommended that you switch on this option, unless you have a good reason not to.

When youve chosen your options, click OK to export the graphics file(s).
Graphics formats
Graphics file formats fall into two kinds: vector graphics and bitmap graphics.
Vector graphics are scalable - in other words, you can make them larger or smaller without any degradation in quality
- and they also tend to be smaller and more compact than bitmap graphics.
Bitmap graphics are not scalable and usually occupy more memory than vector formats, but are supported by a wider
variety of programs.
The specific formats available in Sibelius are as follows:
l

Vecfor: EPS (Mac and Windows), EMF (Windows), PICT (Mac)

388
t

-~-_______.__-_____I___ -___ ~ _

-A_

__ _ _~___

Saving graphics files


l

Biibq~: BMP (Windows).

Each of these formats is detailed below. You can also create PDF files from Sibelius - see Creating PDF files
below.
Encapsulated PostScript (EPS) files
Most publishers and printers prefer to receive music in EPS format for publication, and Sibelius allows you to export
your music directly as an EPS file.
Note that EPS files will not pnnt on non-PostScript printers from most programs. Printing an EPS file to a nonPostScript printer may result either in a blank page, a message informing you that you cannot print EPS files on a nonPostScript printer, or a low-resolution printout of the TIFF preview image embedded in the EPS file.
We recommend that you embed fonts in your EPS files, but if you choose not to, you are licensed by Sibelius to
supply the Opus and Inkpen fonts to your publisher or printer in order to print your EPS files, but you musf ensure
that you have permission to distribute fonts from other companies.
You can create EPS files in Sibelius whether you are using TrueType or Type 1 fonts; the TrueType fonts are installed
by default (you cannot have both TrueType and PostScript Type 1 fonts installed simultaneously) - Q2 Installing
music fonts in Music fonts. There are, however, some limitations on the fonts which may be embedded in
EPS files from Sibelius, as follows:
Type 42 fonts are not supported. The Type 42 font format is PostScripts version of the TrueType standard. All
PostScript Level 3 interpreters (such as printers) can display TrueType fonts as long as they are packaged inside
the PS Type 42 font format.
TrueType font outlines have a different representation to PS font outlines so when they are converted from
TrueType to Type 3 in order to embed them in the EPS file, some information might get lost. There might be
very slight differences in appearance between the embedded font in the EPS file and the original TrueType font,
although in almost all cases these differences will be undetectable.
Only fonts with Latin character sets can be embedded.
OpenType fonts with PostScript outlines cannot be embedded.
Multiple Master fonts can be embedded, but the embedded font wont look exactly the same as the multiple
master instance used.
Some graphics programs on the Mac (e.g. Core1 Draw 8) may give errors when opening EPS files from Sibelius; if you
get an error message, try saving the EPS file from Sibelius again with the TIFF preview option switched off.
If you import EPS files into Adobe Illustrator version 9.0, we recommend that you switch off Smart Punctuation
(Type menu), as this changes certain font characters, causing some of the Opus and Inkpen symbols to disappear.
EMF files (Windows only)
EMF (Enhanced MetaFile) format is fairly standard on Windows programs, but is not generally supported on the Mac.
EMF files can be imported into programs such as Microsoft Word (version 97 or later), and are also editable - up to a
point - in vector drawing programs like Adobe Illustrator and Core1 Draw.
From the File b Save as Graphics dialog you can change the scale factor at which EMF files should be saved. By
default, the scale factor is Actual size. However, due to the inherent inaccuracies in the EMF file format, you may
389

Reference

notice graphical problems, such as beams tapering, when you import the file into your word processor or graphics
program.
70 counteract these effects, you can reduce the scale factor of the EMF file (to, say, SO%), but you may then need to
lenlarge the image in your word processor after importing it.
PKT files (Mac only)
PICT is a vector graphics format similar to EMF, and the resulting image is editable in structured drawing programs
such as Adobe Illustrator. PICT files can also be imported into programs such as Microsoft Word.
BMP files (Windows only)
Dont save a bitmap (.bmp) file unless youre sure you mean it, as bitmap files produce lower print quality than EMF
or EPS format, and use more disk space and memory.
The color depth of the saved bitmap file will be the same as the color depth of your current display settings - so you
can help to keep the file sizes smaller by setting your display to use, say, 256 colors before saving bitmap files.
Inserting exported graphics files into Microsoft Word
To place a graphics file generated by Sibelius into a Word document:
Position the caret in your Word document where you want the picture to go
Choose Insert ) Picture ) From File
Find the graphics file you have saved (as above), and click Insert
This places a miniature view of the whole page of music into your document
Usually youll want a cropped version of part of the page, shown rather larger. First of all, click the crop tool &
which is just after halfway along the Picture toolbar.
Then drag the edges of the picture inwards until they roughly enclose the part of the page you want to show
Click the crop tool again to switch it off
Now, increase the size of the music by dragging any corner of the box. Do not drag an edge, otherwise the
music will stretch and lose the correct aspect ratio. (Type B%Z or Ctrl+Z to undo if you do this by accident.)
When youre happy with the size of the music, you may want to select the crop tool again in order to adjust the
cropping
Beware if you edit the graphics in the imported file from within Word - its graphics editor does not handle music
graphics well and might produce unexpected results. Use a proper graphics program instead.
Creating PDF files
Portable Document Format (PDF) files allow documents generated by programs such as word processors and desktop
publishers to be published electronically, preserving their original appearance, for viewing and printing on any system.
Sibelius supports the creation of PDF files, provided you have a suitable PDF creator installed on your computer. The
official PDF creator is Adobe Acrobat, which is a commercial product available from www.adobe.com for both
Mac and Windows, but there are other options:
l

For Windows, a cheaper commercial alternative is pdffactory, available from www.fineprint.com


For Mac, an alternative package is laws PDF Creator, available from www.hallogram.com

390
c

--

--

~- ------

___________________~~

_--__.__A

-__--~-

Saving graphics files


l

A cost-free alternative is to use Ghostscript, which is a PostScript interpreter capable of creating PDF files. It is
available for both Windows and Mac from www.cs.wisc.edu/-ghost/ and is updated frequently, although
it can be difficult to set up at first.

PDF files are generated by software which installs and behaves like a printer driver. This means that creating a PDF is
as simple as printing a file from Sibelius, choosing the appropriate printer as you do so. For further instructions,
consult the documentation that accompanies your PDF creation software.
To view PDF files, you need to have the free Adobe Acrobat Reader installed on your computer. You are invited to
install the Acrobat Reader when you install Sibelius, since it is required for the on-screen help system, so it is probably
already installed - if not, see Installing Sibelius in the Start here section of this User Guide for instructions
on how to install it.

Reference

Saving MIDI files


T

You can save a score as a MIDI file, so you can easily transfer music into virtually any other music program. You do not
need a MIDI interface or any MIDI devices in order to export a MIDI file.

Saving a MIDI file


Choose File b Save As (shortcut 41~s or Shift+Alt+S), and set Save as type to MIDI
l

Type in the File name you want to use - make it different from your original Sibelius file to avoid confusion!
Find a suitable place to save, then click Save.

When saving MIDI files, Sibelius includes sophisticated options such as Espressivo, Rubato and rhythmic feel. So you
can even use Sibelius as an ingenious MIDI file improver - just open a MIDI file, switch on some interesting playback
settings and save an improved version as a MIDI file in a moment!
Rubato
If Rubato is switched on in the Play ) Performance dialog (shortcut Shift-P), and the score is saved as a MIDI
file, the timing changes made by Rubato will appear in the file, and consequently the notes will be out of alignment
when the file is opened in a MIDI sequencer.
This is because rubato manipulates note start times directly, rather than creating tempo changes. So if you want to
save a MIDI file for use in other programs, and you want it to be correctly quantized, set Rubato to Meccanico
before you save the MIDI file.
Repeats
By default, MIDI files saved from Sibelius will include any repeats present in the original score. If, for some reason, you
would prefer repeats not to be included, switch off Play repeats in the Play ) Performance dialog before
saving the MIDI file.
Scores with more than 15 staves
For advanced users only!
Because Sibelius uses the same code to export MIDI files as for playing back your scores, it is able to incorporate
effects like Espressivo into MIDI files. However, there is a major difference that only comes into play for scores with
more than 15 staves.
A standard MIDI file may only contain 16 channels (but a much larger number of tracks) which means that,
theoretically, only 16 different sounds can be playing at once. Sibelius allows more than one instrument to share the
same MIDI channel thanks to a complex system which inserts appropriate program change messages before notes in
order to make them play back with the correct sound.
However, when exporting MIDI files, each staff corresponds to a different MIDI track in a type 1 MIDI file; in other
words, two staves sharing the same channel in Sibelius occupy two different tracks in the MIDI file, both assigned to
the same channel. This means that if you play back a MIDI file containing more than 15 staves, one or more of the
staves may play back with the wrong sound.

392

Saving MIDI files

The only way to avoid this would be to insert program changes before every note in the score, which is undesirable
since some MIDI devices (e.g. the Roland IV series) respond very slowly to program changes, and the MIDI file would
not play back smoothly. Inserting program changes before every note would also make the MIDI file very difficult to
edit in a sequencer program; so instead, Sibelius simply exports the file with shared channels. You can open the MIDI
file in a sequencer and reallocate some of the channels which are shared to use other playback devices (since it is
fairly normal for MIDI devices to offer 32 channels rather than 16 nowadays).
There is no ideal solution to this problem - since MIDI simply wasnt designed to play back large-scale scores, any
solution is a compromise and an attempt to fit a quart into a pint pot. Sibeliuss method, however, is the most useful
for users who need to edit their music in a sequencer, and provides the best playback possible within the limitations of
MIDI.
Converting MIDI to audio files
You might want to save your Sibelius files to audio CD so that they can be played back through any audio CD player.
This isnt as simple as it sounds; to understand why, you need to know the difference between MIDI data and digital
audio.
Digital audio (usually in .wav format) can be recorded to compact discs and played back through any CD player. In
order to turn your Sibelius files into digital audio, you need to convert the MIDI data used by Sibelius to play back your
score into digital audio.
There is a number of ways of doing this:
iTunes, available in Mac OS 9.1 and Mac OS X, allows drag and drop creation of audio CDs; simply save your
score as a MIDI file from Sibelius and drag it into iTunes
On Windows, provided your soundcard supports full duplex operation (most do), you can set it to record its own
MIDI playback to a .wav file; see your soundcards documentation for full details
QuickTime Pro, available for both Mac and Windows as an upgrade to the free QuickTime software from
www.apple.com/quicktime, can convert MIDI data to digital audio and save a .wav file to your hard
disk, which you can then burn onto a CD
Awave Studio, available for Windows from www.fmjsoft.com, can also convert MIDI to digital audio.
Note that the final audio quality of your CD will depend on the quality of the sounds used by programs which convert
MIDI to audio; as a general rule, the more expensive the program, the better the quality of the MIDI sounds used.

Reference

Scanning
Introduction
Getting going
1. Scanning
\
1 2. Reading
3. Editing
4. Sending to Sibelius
Possible problems
Advanced features

INTRODUCTION
PhotoScore Lite from Neuratron is a music scanning program designed to work with Sibelius - the musical equivalent
of a text OCR (optical character recognition) program.
It is a sophisticated program with many advanced features. If you intend to scan relatively complex scores such as
orchestral/band music, or scores of many pages, we strongly recommend that you start with more simple music until
you are proficient with PhotoScore Lite, and then familiarize yourself with the Advanced features section.
PhotoScore Professional
An advanced version of PhotoScore Lite, called PhotoScore Professional, is available to buy separately, with extra
features and enhancements. PhotoScore Professional reads many more musical markings (including slurs and text),
reads scores with more than 12 staves, and multiple voices.
For details of how to buy PhotoScore Professional, choose Help b PhotoScore Professional, or contact your
local dealer or Sibelius.
Scanning
Scanning text is difficult for computers to do, and has only achieved reasonable accuracy in the last few years. Music
scanning is much harder because of the more complicated range of symbols involved, and because of the complex
two-dimensional grammar of music.
The difficulty with scanning music or text is that by scanning a page, a computer does not understand it. As far as the
computer is concerned, scanning a page merely presents it with a grid of millions of black and white dots, which could
be music, text, a photograph or anything else.
The process of actually reading or interpreting music, text or pictures from this grid of dots is extremely complex and
poorly understood. A large part of the human brain, containing many millions of connections, is devoted solely to
solving this pattern recognition problem.
Installing and uninstalling PhotoScore Lite
Refer to the Start here section at the beginning of this User Guide for installation instructions.
To uninstall PhotoScore Lite, see Uninstalling Sibelius in the Start here section.
394

Scanning

Suitable originals
PhotoScore Lite is designed to read originals which satisfy the following criteria:
Are printed rather than handwritten
Fit on your scanner (i.e. the music itself is typically no larger than Letter/A4 size, though the paper may be
slightly larger)
Have a staff-size of at feast O.l2/3mm
Use no more than 12 staves per page, and 1 voice per staff. (Additional staves or voices will be omitted.)
Are reasonably clear - for example, staff lines should be continuous and not broken or blotchy, half note
(minim) and whole-note (semibreve) noteheads and flats should have a continuous circumference and not be
broken or filled in, beams on sixteenth notes (semiquavers) and shorter notes should have a significant white
gap in between, and objects which are meant to be separate (e.g. noteheads and their preceding accidentals)
should not overlap or be blotched together.
Music which does not match the above will probably work, but with considerably reduced accuracy.
Scanning from photocopies is not particularly recommended unless the photocopier is a particularly good one, as
photocopying tends to degrade the quality of an original significantly. You may be obliged to scan from a reduced
photocopy if your original is bigger than your scanner, but you should expect lower accuracy.
copyright music
You should be aware that if you scan someone elses music without permission you are likely to infringe copyright.
Copyright infringement by scanning is illegal, and in any case is forbidden by the Sibelius license agreement.
Most music states if it is copyright and who the copyright owner is. If you have a piece of music which you want to
scan and you are not sure about its copyright status, please contact the musics publisher, composer or arranger.

GETTING GOING
Like Sibelius, PhotoScore Lite functions in exactly the same way on Mac and Windows. You can start PhotoScore Lite
either by clicking the Scan icon on the Sibelius toolbar, or by double-clicking its icon (Mac) or running it from the
Start menu (Windows). Sibelius doesnt need to be running when you use PhotoScore Lite.
The four stages
There are four stages when using PhotoScore Lite:
1. Scanning the pages
2. Reading the pages
3. Editing the resulting music
4. Sending the music to Sibelius.
Scunnlng a page simply makes PhotoScore Lite take a photograph of your original.
Reading is the clever bit - this is where PhotoScore Lite reads the scanned pages to work out what the notes
and other markings are.
395

Reference
l

Editing is where you correct mistakes that PhotoScore Lite has made. Editing within PhotoScore Lite works in
much the same way as editing music in Sibelius.
Almost any marking can be corrected or input in PhotoScore Lite, but it is only essential at this stage to correct
rhythmic mistakes - other corrections can be made after sending the score to Sibelius if you prefer.

Sending the music to Sibelius is done simply by clicking on a button. After a moment the music pops up as a
Sibelius score just as if youd inputted it all yourself.

You can then play the music back, re-arrange it, transpose it, extract parts, or print it out.
Quick start
Before we examine how to use PhotoScore Lite in detail, lets run through the process quickly to introduce the four
stages.
Although it is more useful to have a scanner connected to your computer when using PhotoScore, it is possib e to
read music without using a scanner. You will need each page of music stored as a graphics file on your computer In
.bmp (bitmap) format on Windows, or PICT (Picture file) format on Mac.
The first step is either to scan some music, or to open a page you have already scanned:
l

To scan a page, choose File ) Scan pages (shortcut XW or Ctrl+W); your scanner interface will load. Scan
a page and it is added to PhotoScores list of scanned pages
To open a graphics file, choose File ) Open; when prompted for the resolution the image was scanned at,
choose the appropriate setting and click OK. The graphics file is then added to the list of scanned pages.

PhotoScore Lite will show you the scanned image, with blue lines marking the staves it has found, and red lines
denoting that staves are bracketed together. Just click Read pages to turn the scanned image into a music file (if
another dialog appears with options in it, just click Read). Reading the page will take a little while (depending on the
speed of your computer) and a progress bar will show you how long you will have to wait.
When PhotoScore Lite has finished reading the image, the main editing window will appear (see left). From this
window you can edit any errors in the music.
When you are satisfied with the corrections you have made, choose File ) Send to Sibelius (shortcut %%D or
Ctrl+D) to send the music to Sibelius.
If Sibelius is not already running, it will start up, and the Open PhotoScore File dialog will appear, which allows
you to choose various options concerning which instruments will be used in the Sibelius score. Dont worry about
these now - just click OK. Moments later, the Sibelius score will appear, ready for editing, just as if you had inputted it
yourself.

396

_ __ __~_ _ __ -. -.

___--..--

~-

- Scanning

1. SCANNING

Choose File b Scan pages (shortcut B%W or Ctrl+W) in the menu to produce a dialog, which will vary depending
on your scanner.
Before you scan, measure the height of staves in the page you want to scan and choose a resolution using the
following table, and scan in black & white or gray - not color:
Staff height

Resolution

0.25"/6mm or more

2OOdpi

0.15-0.25"/4-6mm

300dpi

0.12-0.15"/3-4mm

400dpi

Reading accuracy and speed will be considerably reduced if you scan at too low or too high a resolution. So, for
example, do not scan at 400dpi unless the staves really are small.
Usually, you can choose whether to scan in black & white or grayscale (shades of gray). Scanning in gray produce
significantly more accurate results - if the option is not available in your scanning dialog, consult your scanners
documentation.
Now you can scan your first page - try a page or two of simple keyboard music or something similar:
Put the page of music (the original) into your scanner, face-down and with the top of the page pointing away
from you.
Put one edge of the original flush against the raised edge of the glass.
You can put the page on its side if it fits better. PhotoScore Lite will automatically rotate the page by 90 degrees
if necessary. However you should normally align the top of the page with the left edge of the scanner to ensure
it does not turn out upside down. Dont worry though if it is scanned upside down, as it is easy to correct later
on.
If you are scanning in gray, then the page does not need to be completely straight, providing that it is not more
than 8 degrees off - PhotoScore Lite will automatically make the page level (to within 0.1 degrees) without loss
of detail. It will still be rotated if scanning in black & white, but there will be loss of detail, and thus less accurate
results.
Click the button marked Scan.
After a moment, the scanner will whirr into life and transfer the page to your computer. (If this doesnt happen,
E221 Possible problems.)
If you are scanning from a fairly thick book, gent/y press down the lid (or the book if easier) during scanning to
keep the page flat on the glass.
A window will appear for you to enter a name for the page, which will be Page 1 by default. You can change
this to any name you like (although to avoid any unexpected results it should end with a number) - something
like Piano pl would do - then hit Return (on the main keyboard).
Subsequent pages you scan will be automatically numbered e.g. Piano p2, but you can change these names if
you like.
397

Reference

Wait a few seconds while PhotoScore Lite makes the image level, chooses the best brightness, and locates the
staves.
A scan of the whole original page will then appear. The buff paper color indicates that you are looking at a
scanned image (a scan) of the original page.
Check that all the staves are highlighted in blue - this shows that PhotoScore Lite has detected where they are.
If the page has systems of two or more staves, check also that the staves within each system are joined at the
left-hand end by a thick vertical (or near-vertical) red line.
If not all staves are blue, or not all staves within systems are joined with a red line, you can manually tell
PhotoScore Lite where they are (Q2 Advanced features).
(Ignore the other buttons at the top of this window, which are also explained in Advanced features.)
Put the second page of music in the scanner, choose File b Scan pages, and proceed as for the first page
Continue until you have scanned all the pages you want to scan.
Scanning summarized
Once youve scanned a few pages youll rapidly get into the routine of it. The procedure can be summarized as
follows:
Place page in scanner
Click the scanner button or choose File b Scan pages
Choose the resolution, and whether to scan in black & white or gray
Click Scan
Enter page name (or leave the default name)
Check staves and systems have been detected, and adjust if necessary
Go on to next page.
Catalog of scanned pages
Its important for you to understand that whenever you scan a page, PhotoScore Lite adds it to a single list or catalog
of scanned pages to be read later. You do not need to save scanned pages or the catalog - it is stored on your hard
disk automatically.
This means that whenever you start using PhotoScore, it still remembers any pages you scanned previously. (You can
delete pages which you no longer need to keep.)
Well tell you more about the catalog later.
Hints on scanning
0 If you want to read a page of music smaller than the size of your scanner, you should make sure that only that
portion is scanned.
Most scanner interfaces allow you to scan part of a page, usually by clicking a Preview button to produce a
thumbnail image, which may seem a little blocky. You can then adjust the required area by dragging from the
edges of the thumbnail.
Then click Scan to scan the selected area at high resolution. Every time you click Scan after this, only the
selected area will be scanned, until you change it.
398

_ _.--_

Scanning

Ensure that all of the music on the page you are scanning is on the glass of the scanner.

the

It doesnt matter if your original is larger than Letter/A4, so long as the music itself will fit onto Letter/A4
9a

If you are scanning a page which is smaller than Letter/A4 size, it doesnt matter where on the glass you position
the original. However, it helps if you put the edge of the page flush against the edge of the glass, to ensure that
its straight.

:he

If you are scanning a small music book then you may be able to fit a double-page spread (two facing pages sideby-side) on the scanner glass, but dont try this - PhotoScore Lite can only read one page at a time. Scan each
page separately.

ell

For simplicity, we recommend that you scan all the pages in a piece of music before reading them all. You are
allowed to scan a page, then read it, then scan another and so on (KQ Advanced features), but we dont
suggest you try anything like this until you are proficient with PhotoScore Lite.

2. READING
As mentioned earlier, just scanning a page simply presents the computer with a grid of millions of black and white
dots, which as far as its concerned could be anything from text to a photograph.
Reading the music is the clever bit, where PhotoScore Lite works out from the scan where and what the notes and
other markings on the page are.
Starting reading
Once you have scanned every page of the piece of music in question, choose File b Read pages (shortcut B%R or
Ctrl+R).
PhotoScore Lite will start to think, and a small progress window will appear. This shows the name of t :he current page
being read, and the progress made through it. This window can be minimized (collapsed) or moved out of the way,
so that you can continue with other work.
what Photoscore Lite reads
PhotoScore Lite reads the following musical markings:
l

Notes & chords (including tail direction, beams & flags), rests
Flats, sharps and naturals
Treble and bass clefs, key signatures, time signatures
5-line staves (normal and small), standard barlines
The format of the page, including the page size, staff-size, margins, and where systems end.

PhotoScore Professional, available separately, also reads text, a wider variety of clefs and accidentals, and has
improved accuracy.
Hints on reading
You should not need to interrupt reading, but you can normally do so if necessary by hitting %. or Esc, or by
clicking Cancel on the progress window. PhotoScore Lite will show the part of the page it has already read. You
should delete this page by clicking Delete page at the top before re-scanning or re-reading the page.
l

399

Reference
l

If the computer gives a warning message while reading a page, or if a page seems to be taking a very long time
to read, Q2 Possible problems.
If you like, you can ask PhotoScore Lite to read just a single scan or a choice of scans instead of the whole score;
LQ Advanced features.

3. EDITING
When PhotoScore Lite has finished reading the music, its interpretation of the first page pops up in a window called
the output window. Here you can edit mistakes PhotoScore Lite has made.

The top part of the window (with a buff-colored background) shows you the original page.
The large bottom part of the window (with a light gray background) shows PhotoScore Lites interpretation of the first
scan - that is, what PhotoScore Lite thinks the first page of the original says. Hence this part of the window is where
PhotoScore Lites mistakes can occur.
At the top left of the window it says (e.g.) Page 1 of 2, and by clicking on the arrows you can move through all of
the pages which have been read (the output score). It makes sense to edit the first page completely, then advance to
the second page and so on until the whole output score has been edited.
To the bottom right of the window is the keypad, similar in function to Sibeliuss keypad. This can be repositioned by
clicking its title bar, and dragging.
There is a Create menu at the top of the window, which is also similar in function to Sibeliuss Create menu,
though features not appropriate for PhotoScore Lite have been omitted.

400

Scanning

what to correct
The minimum level of correction recommended before sending the output score to Sibelius is to correct key
signatures and time signatures. Other mistakes such as pitch can be corrected in Sibelius, but correcting key signatures
and time signatures is much easier in PhotoScore Lite, so we recommend you do that.
In particular, if the score you are scanning is a transposing score, you will need to correct the key signatures of the
transposed instruments - to delete a single key signature, select it and type #Delete or Ctrl+Delete. Then add
the correct key signature to that staff alone: choose Create b Key Signature (shortcut K), and #-click or
Ctrl+click the staff to which you want to add the key signature.
To correct rhythmic mistakes, add the appropriate time signature if its not already present: choose Create b Time
Signature (shortcut T) and click in one of the staves to add the time signature. Once PhotoScore Lite knows the
time signature, any rhythmic inaccuracies are indicated by small red notes over the barline, showing the number of
missing or extra beats. As you correct the mistakes, these red notes disappear - and once your score is free of red
notes, you can send it to Sibelius.
Once you are more proficient with PhotoScore Lite, you can correct the music completely in PhotoScore Lite before
sending it to Sibelius. The advantage of this is that you can spot errors by looking at the scanned original on the screen
instead of having to refer to it on paper.
Checking for mistakes
Check for mistakes by comparing the bottom part of the window with the original scan at the top. The top and bottom
parts move about to show the region of the page the mouse is pointing at.
Avoid the temptation to compare the output page with the original music on paper - it is almost always quicker to
compare with the scan on the screen.
At the top right of the output window is the full detail view window, which shows in close-up the part of the original
which the pointer is over. #-clicking or Ctrl+clicking on this window makes the view larger or smaller. This window
can be repositioned by clicking its title bar and dragging.
MIDI playback
Another way to check for mistakes is to have the output played back to you. Your computer will need a MIDI device
attached to make use of this feature (if you have more than one attached, the default one will be used).
To play the whole page from the start, ensure that nothing is selected by clicking on an area of the page with no
notation. Then choose Play b Play/Stop (shortcut P), or click Play on the toolbar. Do the same to stop the music.
To play from a particular point on the page, select an object in each of the staves you want playback from. It will
commence from the start of the bar with the earliest selection.
By default, all the staves will play back with a piano sound, but you can change this: x-click or right-click the names at
the start of the first system (e.g. Staff 1) and choose Rename. You will see a dialog that looks similar to Sibeliuss
Create b Instruments dialog, from which you can choose the correct name (and therefore the sound) used by

that staff.
While the music is playing, the currently played bars will be highlighted in gray.
401

Reference
4. SENDING TO SIBELIUS

Once you have edited all the pages in the score, you should send them to
Sibelius. Choose File ) Send to Sibelius (shortcut B%D or Ctrl+D), or
simply click the little a! icon next to Save at the top of the output window.
If Sibelius isnt already running, it wil I start, and the Open PhotoScore File
dialog will appear:
l

Manuscript Paper: allows you to choose the manuscript paper Sibelius should use; note that any
instruments in the chosen manuscript paper are not used in your new score, but things like document setup and
so on are used.
Play using this device: choose the playback device Sibelius should use for the new score
This is a transposing score: switch on this option if your score contains transposing instruments, and you
will be prompted to choose the correct instruments when you click OK
Use default instruments: opens the file without trying to work out which instruments are used in the score
Choose instruments: allows the user to choose an instrument for each staff in the score from a dialog
similar to the usual Instruments dialog; choose the staff in the scanned music that you want to replace with a
Sibelius instrument, then click Add as normal. Note that if you add an instrument that normally uses two staves
(such as a piano), this will use up two of the staves in the left-most list on the dialog.
Let Sibelius choose instruments: with this option switched on, Sibelius will attempt to work out which
instruments are used in the score; it does this by checking the names of the staves that are set in PhotoScore - if
a staffs name doesnt match an instrument Sibelius knows, it opens the file with the default piano sound.

Once your music has been opened in Sibelius you can do anything you like to it, just as if you had inputted it yourself
- but see Multi-staff instruments below for some clarification.
Editing rhythmic mistakes
If you send a score from PhotoScore Lite to Sibelius which has bars which dont add up, Sibelius will lengt :hen bars
which are too short, and shorten bars which are too long.
To do this, Sibelius compares the length of the bars with the prevailing time signature. If a bar is too short, Sibelius
simply inserts rests at the end. If a bar is too long, Sibelius shortens it by omitting one or more notes/rests at the end
of the bar.
Although Sibelius adjusts the lengths of bars like this, you are strongly advised to correct faulty rhythms in PhotoScore
Lite in the first place rather than trying to fix them in Sibelius afterwards, as it will save you extra work.
Format
Sibelius uses Make Into System and Make Into Page to ensure that the format of the music is the same as
the original. However, if the notes seem uncomfortably close together or far apart in the end result, try changing the
staff size in the Layout ) Document Setup dialog (shortcut B%D or Ctrl+D). Alternatively, if you dont need the
format of the music to match the original, select the whole score @A or Ctrl+A) and unlock the format (&% or
Ctrl+Shift+u).

402

A _~___..__ - -- -___

Scanning

Multi-staff instruments
For instruments which use two staves by default, such as a piano, you may find that it isnt possible to use cross-staff
beaming in music you have scanned. This is because PhotoScore Lite treats all staves as separate instruments, which
means that, by default, multi-staff instruments such as keyboards will be sent to Sibelius as two separately-named
staves without a brace.
When you send a PhotoScore file to Sibelius, you can use the Open PhotoScore File dialog to tell Sibelius that,
say, staves 1 and 2 are actually the right- and left-hand staves of a piano - either choose the instruments yourself, or
click Let Sibelius choose
For multi-staff instruments such as Flutes 1+2, if you want them to be written as two sub-bracketed staves with a single
name, you could either import each staff as a flute and then change the name and add a brace in Sibelius, or import
both staves as a piano, and then change the name and the sound (IEQ Mixer).
If your original contains instruments which have a different number of staves on different systems - e.g. strings which
are sometimes divisi - EQ Advanced features.
Deleting the output score
If you have finished scanning a score and have sent it to Sibelius, and are satisfied with the result, then you will want
to delete the score in PhotoScore Lite if you want to start scanning a new one.
To do this, simply click the Delete score button at the top of the output window. Note that for safety the scans are
not deleted when you delete the output score, and so the scans should be deleted separately (see below).
If you forget to delete the output score before scanning the next piece of music, the new pages you scan and read will
be appended to the end of the previous output score. However, you can delete the old pages individually from the
output score by clicking on the Delete page button for each one.
Deleting unwanted scans
PhotoScore Lite automatically saves each page you scan as a scanned image. This occupies a not insignificant amount
of hard disk space, so you should regularly delete scans which have been read. You do not, however, have to delete
the scans before scanning the next piece of music.
To delete unwanted scans:
l

Choose View b Scanned pages (shortcut %gE or Ctrl+E)


A catalog of all scanned pages appears (which has various advanced uses - i!QZ!! Advanced features). For
each scan it says whether or not it has been read.
Click the Select Read button at the bottom to select all scans which have been read, then click Remove

After a warning, all these scans will be deleted.


Saving MIDI files
In addition to being able to send the output score to Sibelius, you can also save the score in standard MIDI format.
MIDI files were developed to store musical playback information, as opposed to printed notation, and as a result have
a few limitations when it comes to storing scanned music. However, they are still very useful since virtually every
music-editing product can read this type of file.
403

Reference

Please note the following when saving MIDI files:


Slurs, note stem and beam direction, end of staff & page positioning, staff size, and multiple-voice-per-staff
separation cannot be stored. If a file is to end up in a separate notation package, then the final results are
dependent on how that program interprets the music.
Musical features such as clef changes, rests, articulation marks, dotted notes, tuplets, dynamics, and ties also
cannot be stored as objects in a MIDI file. However, if they are present PhotoScore Lite will emulate them for
playback. To clarify: if the MIDI file is played back from a MIDI editing/playback program, the features should be
heard, but the features will not necessarily be present if loaded and displayed in a music notation program.
Although featur s such as time signatures, key signatures, and text (like lyrics and title, but not dynamics as
1
these are used to emulate changes in playback volume), are saved in the MIDI file, not all music software will
necessarily use or display them. You may find there is an option in your music software to ignore or use such
information.
Instruments allocated to each staff are stored according to the General MIDI standard. PhotoScore Lite
intelligently works out what MIDI instruments should be used from the names to the left of each staff in the
PhotoScore Lite output. These can of course be altered with a separate music program.
Due to MIDI file constraints, only the first 15 instruments in the score can be saved.
The tempo is always set to 100 beats per minute (BPM). This can be altered with a separate music program.

Scanning takes a long time


If there are no signs of scanning happening - i.e. if after clicking on the Scan or Preview button the scanner
remains silent with no lights moving or flashing - communication between the computer and the scanner has
probably been interrupted.
Check that the scanner is switched on and that the cable between it and the computer is firmly connected at both
ends. If this doesnt help, try reinstalling your TWAIN scanner driver software.
Note that some scanners need to be switched on before the computer is turned on, otherwise they are not detected.
Not all staves/systems are detected
If after scanning a page you find that not all staves are highlighted in blue, or the staves are not correctly joined into
systems by a thick red vertical line, this may be because:
l

404

The original has 13 or more staves on CI page: only PhotoScore Professional can scan scores with more than 12
staves.
The onglnal WQS nof flat on the scanner glass: always close the lid when scanning, unless scanning a thick book.
It may also help if you gently press down on the scanner lid during scanning.
The page wus scanned at too low u rem/don (i.e. the staves m-e smaller than you think): check the staff size,
alter the scanner setting accordingly, and re-scan.
You fried scumlng u do&/e-page spread. PhotoScore Lite cannot read both pages of a double-page spread
(e.g. from a miniature score) at once. Re-scan each of the pages separately. Ensure that the music on the facing

Scanning

page is completely off the glass, or not scanned - if any of it impinges on the scan, PhotoScore Lite will not read
the music correctly.
l

The staves m-e nof clear enough in the origimd fo be detected in this case, you can tell PhotoScore Lite where
any missing staves are located on the page - !I2 Advanced features.

Reading takes a long time


If the page was scanned without being flat on the glass or with the lid open: you will get a black border around
the page which may spread across and obliterate some of the music. This can make PhotoScore Lite take an
extremely long time to read the page. If this happens, interrupt reading (see below), then re-scan the page.
l

If not all staves were detected after scanning (i.e. some were not highlighted in blue): this can slow reading
down. EQ Not all staves/systems are detected, above.

Music reads inaccurately


If you find music seems to be read ing very inaccurately, this may be because:
the original is of poor quality, e.g. a photocopy or an old edition;
the original is hand-written: PhotoScore Lite is not designed to read hand-written music;
the music uses two or more voices, which can only be read by PhotoScore Professional: PhotoScore Lite will
regard all notes as being in a single voice;
the music was scanned in black & white and was not straight enough: it is recommended that you scan in shades
of gray;
the music was not straight enough when scanned and Make image level was not selected in the
preferences (MA2 Advanced features). Having Rotate more quickly selected in the preferences will
also result in lower accuracy, if the page is not exactly level when scanned;
the music symbol designs used in the original are of a non-standard shape or size;
you have the Read faster with lower accuracy option switched on - it is recommended that you only
use this option to speed up the reading of simple music which PhotoScore Lite could read very accurately.

ADVANCED FEATURES
PhotoScore Lite has many features and options for more advanced use.
You are strongly recommended to familiarize yourself with this whole section before embarking on any intensive
scanning, such as orchestral/band scores or scores with many pages.
Choosing between scanners
In the unlikely event that you have more than one scanner connected to your computer, you can choose between
multiple scanner drivers by choosing File b Select Scanner.
Adjusting detected staves/systems
When you scan a page, PhotoScore Lite highlights staves it detects in blue, and joins them into systems with vertical
red lines.

Reference

However, if the original is of poor quality, PhotoScore Lite may not detect some of the staves/systems, and you should
tell PhotoScore Lite where they are.
The easiest method is to select the nearest blue staff (by clicking on it) and copy it by x-clicking or Alt+clicking over
the center line of the missing staff (the horizontal position is not important).
You can create a blue staff from scratch by clicking and dragging it out with the left mouse button.
After creating the staff, ensure that it is joined to any other staves in the same system (see below).
PhotoScore Lite will automatically clip the staff in place, by adjusting the position and size of it, if it finds an
appropriate sta underneath. If it fails to position/size the staff correctly, scale the image to full size (by clicking on the
button at the op
? marked 100) and adjust it using the blue handles.
l

You can drag any blue staff up and down with the left mouse button. This also causes the staff to automatically

clip in place.
l

You can drag the ends of blue staves around, and can even put blue staves at an angle.
You can alter the size of any blue staff - pull the handles in the middle of the staff up or down. PhotoScore Lite

can read pages which have a mixture of staff-sizes, and each blue staff can have a different size. The top circular
handle allows you to change the curvature of the staff. This is useful when scanning pages from thick books,
where it is not possible to prevent the page from being curved at the edges.
l

If any scanned staff is left with no blue staff on top of it, the scanned staff and any music on it will be ignored
when the page is read. This can slow reading down, but is otherwise harmless.
To join two adjacent staves together into the same system, click one staff so it goes red, then x-click or
Alt+click the other staff. They will be joined near the left-hand end by a thick vertical (or near-vertical) red line.
To separate two joined staves into two separate systems, do exactly the same as for joining two staves.
Note that PhotoScore Lite automatically guesses whether staves should be joined together or not when you
create new ones, or move existing ones.

If youve messed up the blue staves and want to start again, %double-click or Ctrl+double-click the scan, and
PhotoScore Lite will reset the blue staves to their original positions.
When you have finished editing the staves/systems, check carefully that the staves are all joined into systems
correctly, as you cannot alter this once the page has been read.

Scan window options


There are various further options and buttons available on the scan window:
l

406

The Read this page button reads just this scan. Clicking the arrowed part of the button opens a menu which
lets you choose where in the output score to insert this page once it has been read.
Scale produces a dialog which lets you zoom in and out of the scan. The button to the right of Scale zooms
the image to fit the main window; 50 zooms to 50%; 100 zooms to lOOo/o.
Upside down quickly rotates the image by 180 degrees, in case it was scanned the wrong way up.
Re-scan re-scans the page.
On side quickly rotates the image by 90 degrees, in case it was scanned on its side.

Scanning

List of scanned images


If you choose View h Scanned pages (shortcut #E or Ctrl+E), a catalog of scanned pages appears, looking
something like this:

The second column (Status) says whether a scan has been read or not.
The Read next? column says whether scans will be read when you next click Read pages - you can select
or deselect this option for each scanned page. Do this by selecting the scan, and clicking the Read next or
Dont read button at the right. This allows you to compile an arbitrary choice of scans into a score, rather than
using all unread ones.
The four buttons at the bottom select (respectively) all scans, only scans whict I have been read, only those which
have not been read, and no scans.
Clicking on Remove at the right deletes the selected scans;
Clicking on Display, or double-clicking on one of the scan names, displays the scan in the same way as if you
had just scanned it.
The yellow arrow buttons at the left can be used to move a selected scan up and down in the list (thereby
changing the order in which they are read).
Omitted staves
In scores for many instruments, particularly orchestral scores, unused staves are often omitted.
If you replace the default instrument names (e.g. Staff 1) at the start with proper names, then on subsequent systems
PhotoScore Lite will allocate instruments to staves in order from the top down. Hence, if the original page omits an
instrument from one system, then in the output window some of the staves will have the wrong names. To correct a
name in this situation, Control-click or right-click over the existing instrument name against the staff in question, and
choose the correct instrument from the list of current instruments.
On any system which has staves omitted you will probably have to correct several instrument names like this. Do it
with care, otherwise confusion will arise.
Multi-staff instruments
For multi-staff instruments such as keyboards and divided wind and strings, PhotoScore Lite treats each staff as a
separately-named instrument.
If the number of staves for a multi-staff instrument varies at all in the original, e.g. where strings are divisi, then to
avoid any confusion between the staves its best to give them slightly different names, e.g. Viola a and Viola b. You
can change the names back once the score has been sent to Sibelius.

Reference

Wherever any of the instruments staves are omitted, follow Omitted staves (above).
N.B. If the number of staves for the instrument increases (say from 1 to 2) during the score, and the second staff has
not occurred before, treat it by following Instruments/staves introduced after the start (below).
Instruments/staves introduced after the start
Some scores include instruments or staves which are not shown on the first system.
When this happens, on the system where the instrument/staff is first introduced you should do the following:
l

First, correct the names of each of the other staves:


Control-click (Mac) or right-click (Windows) each name, and choose the correct name from the list of current
instruments

0 Pfen tell PhotoScore Lite the name of the newly-introduced instrument/staff


Point over whatever name it has filled in (which may say e.g. Staff 5, or the name of an omitted instrument).
Control-click (Mac) or right-click (Windows), click New, and click a name from the list of instruments
displayed (similar to Sibeliuss Instrument dialog.) If you want a non-standard name, you can edit the name
at the bottom.
l

You must do this with care - or else a lot of confusion can arise.
Small staves
In the output window, small staves are displayed at full size to make them legible, but they are indicated by the
following symbol at the end of the staff:

Other preferences
The File ) Preferences dialog contains various other options, as follows.
l

On the Accuracy page, on which most options are disabled (since they are only available in PhotoScore
Professional):
l

Display these preferences before reading: if this is switched on (as per the default setting), you
will get an opportunity to update certain preferences concerning accuracy and speed before reading begins.
Click Read at the bottom right of the dialog that appears to stat-t reading.

On the Scanning page:


l

408

Read faster with lower accuracy: this approximately doubles the speed of reading, but also doubles
the number of errors. We recommend you use this option only for simple music which PhotoScore Lite
would read with high accuracy.

Automatically make grayscale scans level: with this switched on, PhotoScore Lite wil I work out
how rotated a scan is, and then rotate it so that the staves are level. It is recommended that this is left
selected.

Scanning

Rotate page more quickly: with this selected, scanned images are rotated more quickly when making
the image level. However, this has the effect of distorting the image slightly (adversely affecting reading
accuracy), so is not recommended.
Use standard TWAIN dialog box: (Windows only) with this switched off, PhotoScore Lite will use its
own (easier to use) scanning interface. Otherwise the standard TWAIN interface (which works with all
scanning programs) will be used when you choose File ) Scan pages.
Prompt user before scanning next page: with this switched on, PhotoScore will prompt you before,
oddly enough, scanning the next page.
l

On the Display page:


Attach scanned staff panel to current staff: on the output window, this puts the original scan just
above the highlighted staff instead of at the top of the window. This means you have to move your eyes less
when comparing the output with the original, but the effect can be confusing.
Drag paper by: allows you to choose whether you drag the paper either by clicking and dragging, or
holding Shift and dragging (in a similar way to the option in Sibeliuss File ) Preferences ) General
dialog).
Display anti-aliased when scaled (more details): this anti-aliases scans (shows them more
clearly by using gray shades), though it takes slightly longer to display them.
Display splash screen at start-up: allows you to switch off the PhotoScore Lite splash screen when
you run the program.

If you change any of these options, they will remain in the new setting until you change them again.

Reference

Selections and passages


When objects in the score are selected, they go colored (usually blue), which shows that you can do things to them
using the mouse and keyboard. Most operations in Sibelius involve selections.
There are three kinds of selections:
l

a s&g/e selection, where just one object is selected


a multiple selection, where several separate objects are selected
a selected passage, where a continuous stretch of music is selected, shown with a blue box (staff passage) or
double-box (system passage) round it.

You can do pretty much the same things to all three kinds of selection. The main difference is how you select the
objects in the first place.
s ingle selections
To make a single selection, click an object - its as simple as that.
You can also select an object without using the mouse - with nothing selected, type Tab to select the first visible
note on the screen
You can select the next object on the staff using the arrow keys or Tab (to select the previous item, type ShiftTab)
If you want to select a particular notehead in a chord, use x+/$ or AIt++/& to select the next notehead
above or below the currently selected one
If there are no chords, XI\/& or AIt++/& selects the note ai t the nearest rhythmic position on the staff
above or below
You can also move between the different parts of objects - such as I ines - using x +/+ or AIt++/+.
Another way of making a single selection is to use the Edit ) Find (shortcut 6tgF or Ctrl+F) feature L!2 Filters and Find.
If you have trouble selecting an object with the mouse, because theres another object very close which you keep
selecting instead: first, zoom in very close and try selecting it again; if this fails, move the other object out of the way
temporarily.
Multiple selections
Click an object, then #-click or Ctrl-click one or more other objects to add them to the selection. #-click or
Ctrl-click an object again if you want to remove it from the selection.
l

Alternatively, x-click or Shift-click on the paper and drag the light gray box around the objects you want to
select (sometimes called a marquee or lasso selection). Note that if you drag across a whole staff, youll get a
selected passage instead. You can then add/remove objects from the selection using &?-click or Ctrl-click. If you
use this function a lot, changing the Drag Paper setting in the File ) Preferences ) General dialog
allows you to select a passage simply by clicking and dragging (without holding down # or Shift).

410

Selections and passages


l

With multi$e text selections, you can also extend a single selection by choosing Edit b Select b Select
More (type b%%A or Ctrl+Shift+A), which selects all similar text objects (i.e. in the same style) attached to
the same staff within that system. This is a quick way of selecting a whole row of, say, chord symbols, lyrics,
fingerings or expression marks.

If you have a single note of a chord selected, Edit b Select b Select More selects all the notes in that chord;
similarly, if you have a single note, rest or a whole chord selected, Edit b Select b Select More will select
the whole bar.
You can also use filters to make a multiple selection - ILL! Filters and Find.

Multiple selections are mainly useful for objects other than notes, chords and rests - e.g. to delete several articulations
or bits of text.
Selected passages
A passage is a continuous stretch of music - of any length from a couple of notes to the whole score, and for any
number of staves from one to a complete orchestra. You can think of it as a rectangle of music - though this
rectangle can run between systems and pages, and you can even include non-adjacent staves in a passage.
In contrast to multiple selections, selected passages are mainly useful for doing things to several notes, chords and
rests.
There are two kinds of passages: normally, passages are surrounded by a single blue box and can include any
combination of staves in your score; system passages, by contrast, are surrounded by a blue double-box and include
all the staves in your score.
To select a passage by clicking:
l

Click the note/chord/rest at the top left-hand corner of the rectangle you want to select. If youre selecting from
the start of a bar, its quicker just to click an empty part of the bar
Shift-click the note/chord/rest at the bottom right-hand corner of the rectangle. Again, if youre selecting to the
end of a bar, just click an empty part of the bar
All selected objects will go colored and a blue box will appear around the selection. The selection will also
appear on the navigator, which is useful for viewing passages that span multiple pages
To add further staves to the selection, hold down # or Ctrl and click further staves; this can be used to add
non-adjacent staves to the selection
You can also exclude certain staves from a passage selection by holding down # or Ctrl and clicking in turn on
the staves you want to remove from the selection.

IO select a system passage, do the same but start by #-clicking or Ctrl+clicking a note/chord/rest, and hold X or
Ctrl as you click on other notes/chords/rests in other staves to extend the passage.

-I-

Naturally, you can also select a passage using just the keyboard:
With a note selected, type Shift-t/+ to extend the selection horizontally a note at a time, or UB%t/+ or
Ctrl+Shift+t/+ to extend it a bar at a time. This is similar to word processors (as are various other uses of
the arrow keys).
To select multiple staves, type Shift-+/+ to include another staff in the passage

--

Reference
l

To turn the current selection into a system passage, choose Edit b Select b Select System Passage
(shortcut &xA or Shift+Alt+A).

To select a passage by dragging the mouse: hold down dt% or Shift and drag out a rectangle starting from above the
top staff at the start of the desired passage and finishing below the bottom staff at the end. This is only practical for
short passages.
Quick cases
There are various ways to select certain types of passage quickly:
Clicking an empty part of a bar selects that bar on one staff (e.g. to copy a bar)
Double-clicking an empty part of a bar selects that staff for the duration of the system (e.g. to copy those bars)
Triple-clicking an empty part of a bar selects that staff throughout the score (e.g. to delete a whole instrument)
After single-, double- or triple-clicking, you can Shift-click another staff to add all staves in between to the
selection
If you hold x or Ctrl while single-, double- or triple-clicking, a system passage is selected (enclosed in a blue
double-box)
You can even select the entire score at once by choosing Edit b Select b Select All (shortcut XA or
Ctrl+A). This is particularly useful for transposing the whole score, altering the format of the whole score, or for
selecting particular types of object throughout the score (see below).
(If you think hard about it, Edit b Select b Select All does the same as 8%-triple-click or Ctrl+triple-c :lick.
See?)
what can you do with multiple selections and selected passages?
You can do virtually anything to a multiple selection or selected passage that you can do to a single note, and more:
Copy it elsewhere with x-click or Alt+click - very, very handy for arranging or orchestrating. (Copying
overwrites unless you select a passage of bars with X or Ctrl, in which case it inserts)
Copy it multiple times along the same staff or across multiple staves - see Multicopying below
Repeat it with R - see Repeating selections below

Produce chords by adding notes above or below - type l-9 to add an interval above, or Shift-1 -9 to add an
interval below
Control-click (Mac) or right-click (Windows) to access a cut-down Edit menu which lets you cut, copy, paste,
hide or show, and change voice.
Move notes along in the bar using Edit b Cut (shortcut B%X or Ctrl+X) and Edit b Paste (shortcut B%V or
Ctrl+V)
Move the selection with the mouse or arrow keys - useful for aligning staves or moving a row of text objects
(such as chord symbols or lyrics)
Turn all notes and chords into rests by hitting Delete. This also deletes all other staff objects. If the passage was
selected with %% or Ctrl (and so had a double-box round it), the bars themselves will be deleted, too.
Play it back by clicking on the play toolbar button or typing P

Selections and passages

Transpose it (EL? Transposing)


Arrange the music for a different combination of instruments, explode the passage onto a larger number of
staves, or reduce it onto a smaller number - L!2 ArrangeTM
Filter the selection to find objects with particular characteristics - ELLJl Filters and Find
Run a plug-in to check, edit or add things to the selection - EL! Plug-ins
Shift all notes/chords diatonically by typing +/&. a%+/& or Ctrl++/+ shift by an octave.
Add articulations to all notes/chords using the first or fourth keypad layout
Change all accidentals using the first or fifth keypad layout, or respell the notes using Notes b Respell
Accidental (shortcut Return on the main keyboard) - useful if you first filter notes of a particular pitch - see
L!ZI Filters and Find
Change all noteheads - ELJ Noteheads
Change the beaming, using the third keypad layout (useful if you first select notes by their position in the bar see below)
Shorten all notes/chords, using the first or second keypad layout; the notes/chords will end up with a rest after
each. (You cant lengthen the notes as they wouldnt then fit in the bars.)
Cross the notes to the staff above/below using &%+/\L or Ctrl+Shift+I\/&
Condense or expand the note spacing by typing a~+/+ or Shift+Alt+t/+. Hold 8% or Ctrl at the same
time for bigger steps,
Align objects (Layout b Align in a Row/Column) in multiple selections
Reset objects to their default positions with Layout b Reset Position (shortcut b%gP OI- Ctrl+Shift+P)
Reset the note spacing to default by choosing Layout b Reset Note Spacing (shortcut UB%N or
Ctrl+Shift+N)
Notes b Reset Stems and Beam Angles
Notes b Reset Beam Groups
Make Into System/Page from the Layout b Format menu
Remove format modifications such as system and page breaks throughout the passage by clicking Layout b
Format b Unlock Format (or type &I% or Ctrl+Shift+U).
Multicopying
Multicopying allows you quickly to copy a single selection, multiple selection or passage several times either
horizontally (along the same staff), vertically (onto more than one staff), or both at once.
Multicopying a single object
You can copy a single object, such as a note or some text, vertically across any number of staves. This is perhaps most
useful for copying dynamic markings (e.g. mf) across multiple staves at once:
l

Select a single object and choose Edit b Copy (shortcut XC or Ctrl+C) to copy it to the clipboard
Select a passage in one or more staves and choose Edit b Paste (shortcut %gV or Ctrl+V) to copy the item fo
the sfurf of the passage only, one copy on each staff.
413
_

Reference

Mukicopying a multiple selection


As an extension of the above, you can select more than one object and copy them vertically across any number of
staves. This is particularly useful for copying a row of dynamics:
l

Make a multiple selection - #-click or Ctrl+click the objects you want to copy or select them with a filter (e.g.
Edit ) Filter ) Dynamics), then choose Edit ) Copy (shortcut XC or Ctrl+C) to copy them to the
clipboard
Select a passage in one or more staves and choose Edit ) Paste (shortcut XV or Ctrl+V) to copy the
selection fo the sturf of the passage only, one copy for every staff, with relative distances between the original
objects retained in the new copies.

Multicopying a passage
To multicopy a passage:
Select a passage in one or more staves and choose Edit ) Copy (shortcut XC or Ctrl+C) to copy it to the
clipboard
Select another passage and choose Edit b Paste (shortcut 6rgV or Ctrl+V) to fill the new passage with
multiple copies of the original passage The new passage is filled in the following way:
l

Ho~;z~nfa//y: if the destination passage is longer than the original, a whole number of copies is pasted into
the new passage (with any leftover bars at the end left unchanged). If the destination passage is shorter than
the original, only one copy is made.
Vertically: if the destination passage contains more staves than the original, a whole number of copies is
made from the top downwards (with any leftover staves at the bottom left unchanged). If the destination
passage has fewer staves than the original, only one copy is made.

Note that multicopying overwrites the original contents of the destination passage.
Repeating selections
You can also use Edit b Repeat (shortcut R) to make multiple copies of any selection, as follows:
l

474

Select a note, chord, passage, line, text object, symbol, guitar frame, imported graphic, staff type change, clef, key
signature or barline and type R.
The passage is repeated once along the same staff; to repeat it again, keep typing R.

Slurs

slurs
l!Lb lines.
Slurs and phrase-marks
Sibelius treats slurs and phrase-marks alike. Phrase-marks are pretty much just big slurs so the word slur is used to
cover both. This terminology is also quite standard in music engraving.
Magnetic slurs
In Sibelius, slurs snap to notes, so that if you change the pitch of notes or add
articulations, the slur moves: meet the magnetic sIurITM. (Some other objects are also
magnetic, such as tuplets.)
To create a magnetic slur, either:
l

select a note (or grace note) and type S. This draws a slur to the next note; or
select the passage of notes (on a single staff) you want to be slurred and type S, which draws a slur over all the
selected notes.

You can then extend the slur to the following note by hitting space (by analogy with creating lyrics), or contract it
back again with Shift-space. These keys move the right-hand end because it is selected. Look for the small blue
handle - slurs have handles when selected; if one end of the slur is selected, only that end gets a handle). This use of
space and Shift-space also works for other lines. space/Shift-space can be used to move either end of a slur,
as can dragging with the mouse, or nudging with the arrow keys.
You can also select and move the left-hand end in the same way, either with the arrows, mouse or by hitting space /
Shift-space; to select either end of the line, type it/+ or AIt++/+.
Finally, you can change the shape of a slur and even make it asymmetrical by dragging the middle with the mouse.
Magnetic slurs follow some complex positioning rules, but Sibelius takes care of all this for you. You only need to
know a few simple things about how they are positioned. Typing S puts the slur starting at the notehead end of the
first note in one-voice music, or at the S&R end in two or more voices. Shift-S puts the slur at the opposite end.
Edit b Flip (shortcut X) flips a slur to the other side of a note.
Note that magnetic slurs do not attach to cross-staff notes. The slur will naturally go to where the note would be on
the original staff, but you can drag the slurs end to the notes actual position.
Non-magnetic slurs
Although we dont recommend it except for special circumstances, you can also create less intelligent non-magnetic
slurs by creating a slur with the mouse from the Create b Line dialog. Non-magnetic slurs dont snap to notes, and
nor do they avoid beams and articulations, but they can be useful in some situations.
Non-magnetic slurs appear in red when selected, as a hint that you should probably use a magnetic one instead.
If you use Layout b Reset Position (shortcut 48%P or Ctrl+Shift+P) to reset the position of a slur, this also
turns it into a magnetic slur if it was non-magnetic.
415

Reference

In addition to standard non-magnetic slurs, the Create b Line dialog also includes dotted and dashed slurs, which
are used as editorial markings and to indicate non-legato string bowing. These are also non-magnetic unless you use
Reset Position to make them magnetic.
Positioning slurs
Slurs typically go at the notehead end of
notes and chords in one voice, and at the
stem end in two or more voices.
However, in one-voice music if the slurred
notes have a mixture of stem directions, or if
the slur is long (say four or more bars),
then the slur goes above the notes.

Slurs over two or more systems


When split between systems, it is conventional to draw each half of the slur
as a separate arc rather than cutting the slur into two half-arcs. This makes
it possible for a slur split between two systems to collide with notes at the
end of the first system or the start of the second.
You can adjust this in two ways:
adjust the vertical position of the ends of the two slur halves: simply
click on the end of the half-slur you wish to adjust, and a blue handle will
appear; now drag the half-slur to the desired position. If you want to reset
the two halves of the slur back to their default positions, choose Layout b
l

When a slur starts on a tied note, the slur


s ould start at the first of the notes that are
ted
r together. Similarly, if a slur ends on a
tied note, the slur should end on the last of
the tied notes.
To make slurs more visible, the very ends
and the highest or lowest point of the arch
should avoid touching a staff line.
~,.~<.,y. .,., .,::,~.% ,.,_,: : $. ,.+~ *yY,
.J%, , :, .,*I, i>,A. ,)I~. ,%.~.>.cm*nrr
~., .:+ : I * ,<? , + .,> .;> .:I , : :. , % , :* :- 2.m

Reset Design (shortcut 48%D or Ctrl+Shift+D); or


l

on the Slurs page of the House Style b Engraving Rules dialog

(shortcut &%E or Ctrl+Shift+E), switch on Clip at end of


systems, which produces the non-standard cut-in-half slur design.

\ : ; : .:1, , ; < > I ( : :. , z , : :


Note that magnetic slurs over page breaks can sometimes change direction from above to below the notes. If you
want to ensure that a slur doesnt change direction over a page break, use a non-magnetic slur instead (see above).

Multi-arc slurs
Sometimes in keyboard music you need to write a slur with several arcs which flow
above and below the notes.
To draw this, input a normal slur, click either end, and choose Create b Extra Slur
Arc. This adds an extra arc to the slur. Youll find you can drag either half of the slur to
change its shape, or drag the mid-point of the slur to skew it asymmetrically. You can
add further arcs to the slur in the same way, to make it as long and wiggly as you like.
The behavior of multi-arc slurs is non-obvious, so its worth dwelling on this for a moment longer:
l

416

With either end of downward-pointing slur selected, choosing Create b Extra Slur Arc adds another
downward slur arc to that end. Repeating this adds more downward slurs.
With either end of an upward-pointing slur selected, choosing Create b Extra Slur Arc adds a slur arc in the
opposite direction to that end. Repeating this adds a new arc in each direction.
If you flip the slur at any point the direction of further slur arcs (either all down, all up or alternate up and down)
depends on the direction of the original slur arc and the direction of the end of the slur arc you have selected. If
the original slur is downward-pointing, the new slur arcs will all be in the same direction as the slur arc you have
selected. If the original slur is upward-pointing, the new slur arcs will be in alternate directions starting in the
opposite direction of the slur arc you have selected.

S/U/3

Slurs in lyrics
If you want to print a tiny slur after a word in lyrics (e.g. at the end of a line of block lyrics in hymns), dont use a real
slur - instead, use the elision character. 1&!2 Lyrics for more details.
Engraving Rules options
The Slurs page of the House Style b Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut U%E or Ctrl+Shift+E) has various
reassuringly obscure options concerning slurs:
l

Minimum distance x spaces from staff line prevents the ends of slurs touching staff lines
The Avoiding articulation options specify the distance between ends of slurs and articulations on the same
note.

The Shape options allow you to change the appearance of slurs:


l

Shoulder: lets you set the degree of shouldering of slurs. When there is more shoulder, slurs are flatter in the
middle and have more pronounced corners near the ends; with less shoulder, they are more rounded in the
middle and the shape is more controllable by dragging. Sensible values are between about 60% and 90%.
Clip at end of systems: produces a chopped-off slur, which looks non-standard but has the advantage that
it is less likely to collide with notes.

Finally, various subtle options control how slurs snap to notes. These dont affect slurs youve already input, unless you
select existing slurs and then choose Layout b Reset Position (shortcut b%P or Ctrl+Shift+P).

Reference

Staff spacing
E!2 Breaks, Document Setup, Layout and formatting, Music engraving, View menu, Staves.

This topic explains how to alter the vertical position of staves in your score. Other layout and formatting tools are
detailed in L!2 Breaks (e.g. system breaks), Document Setup (e.g. page and staff size), and Layout and
formatting (e.g. horizontal spacing).
You can alter the vertical spacing of staves and systems as follows:
Change the settings on the Staves page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut UB%E
or Ctrl+Shift+E) to alter the default staff and system spacing and justification throughout your score
Move staves manually to adjust the space above and below them; if necessary, Sibelius will squash the other
staves together slightly to allow room as you do this
Move staves manually to alter the intra-system spacing, i.e. change the distance between staves within a system
but leave the distance between the top and bottom staves of the system unchanged
Apply the position of staves on a particular page to the rest of a score using the Layout ) Align Staves
dialog
Reset the spacing back to the default.
I nese

are detailed below.

Staff and system spacing


Staves and systems are often spread out (justified) to fill a page right down to the bottom. You can alter the rules
governing this from the Staves page on the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut 46tgE or
Ctrl+Shift+E):
spaces between staves/systems: these numbers control the standard
distance between staves and systems. You may want to increase the staves number
if your score has lots of leger lines or multiple verses of lyrics. Decreasing the
systems number saves space in parts. On pages where the music is vertically
justified, the distance between staves and systems will be larger than the numbers
specified.
l

Caps between staves


Gaps between staves need
not be constant throughout a
score - ac)ust them wherever
necessary to allow room for
low/high notes etc.
In larger scores for many
instruments, an extra gap is
usually
between
left
instrumental families such as
woodwind, brass and strings.

Justify staves when page is at least . . . o/o fullm controls how inclined
Sibelius is to justify. Smaller values make Sibelius spread out just a few staves and
systems to fill a page, which can look silly. Larger values make Sibelius more inclined
to put staves and systems at the top rather than spread them out. The default value is
50% i .e . the staves are justified if the page is at least half-full of music. Set the
number to 100% to switch off justification entirely.
l

Staff spacing

Moving staves
Most staff operations, including moving them, require that you first select which staff or staves you want to work with:
l

Click (or double-click) on a blank part of a bar to select that bar


Triple-click on a blank part of a bar to select a staff throughout the score
Select a passage to work on several staves (useful for altering gaps between keyboard staves or instrumental
families throughout).

For more information on selections, L!3 Selections and passages.


You might also find it useful to switch on View b Staff Rulers (shortcut b+%R or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+R) before
moving staves - LQI View menu.
The basic ways of moving staves are:
/Vormalmove - select a staff or staves and drag with the mouse (shortcut &XI\/& or Shift+Alt++/&, with
8% or Ctrl for larger steps): changes the distance between the selected staff/staves and the staff above (or the
top page margin if the top staff is selected) and retains the spacing between all other staves. Sibelius may have
to squash up other staves to allow room if the page is full.
independent move - select a staff or staves and use Shift-drag (shortcut x+/+ or AIt++/&, with 8% or
Ctrl for larger steps): moves only the selected staff/staves, leaving all other staves in the same place on the
page. Although you can use this to move staves almost on top of one another, you cannot move one staff
beyond another staff in either direction and thus change the order of the staves in your score (to do this,
ILQI Instruments).
Note that precisely which staves and systems you move is determined by the extent of your initial selection. This
means that you can alter staff spacing between staves on the same system, the same page, or any number of pages,
simply by selecting the passage for which you want to change the spacing. (You can even select a passage containing
multiple staves and move it up and down, which changes the gap above the top selected staff and/or below the
bottom selected staff .)
For example:
l

to allow extra space between the woodwind and brass families throughout an entire score, triple-click the
topmost brass staff and drag it down
to alter the spacing between the bottom staff on a page and the page margin, e.g. to make space for a footnote
or copyright line, click the bottom staff and move it independently
to change the distance between the alto and tenor staves on a single system of a choral score, in order to
accommodate lyrics in a particularly low passage for the altos, double-click a tenor bar and then drag it down.

Align Staves
To apply the staff and system spacing on one page in your score to other pages, select a passage extending across the
pages you want to format and choose Layout b Align Staves.

419

Reference

Any changes made from this dialog apply to all pages which the selected passage appears on, so you can select from
any bar on any staff of the first page to any bar on any staff of the last page. The options are as allows:
Lock format before making changes: locks the format of all bars in the selected pages, thus keeping
the same bars on the same pages after staves have been aligned
Reset position of staves: these options restore the default gap above the top staff, or below the bottom
staff on a page
Align staves on selected pages: when switched on, you can choose between any one of the four
available options:
l

with first selected page: aligns all subsequent pages with the first page of the selection
with last selected page: aligns all preceding pages with the last page of the selection
Right pages with facing left pages: aligns each right-hand page with the left page it is facing
Left pages with facing right pages: aligns each left-hand page with the right page it is facing

To use these options, you must select more than one page.
Note that aligning staves via this dialog is only possible if the pages being aligned with each other have the same
number of systems and the same number of staves on each system. If not, then only the top and bottom staves are
aligned. If one or both of the pages have only one system, then only the top staff is aligned.
Restoring default staff spacing
To restore the default staff spacing (i.e. the settings on the Staves page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules
dialog) to a staff or staves, select the desired passage and choose Layout ) Reset Space Above Staff or
Layout ) Reset Space Below Staff.
If you need to reset the space above or below the top or bottom staves on a number of pages at once, its quickest to
use the Layout ) Align Staves dialog (see above).

420

Staves

Staves
LQ Edit Staff Types, Guitar tab, Instruments, Percussion, Staff spacing.
Multi-staff instruments
Ossias
Indented systems
Save trees - hide empty staves
Show hidden staves
Deleting staves permanently
Staff size

Small staves
Changing the number of staff lines etc.
Creating a staff type change
Staves with gaps in or stopping early
Other staff types
System separators

To move or align staves, IL!2 Staff spacing.


Multi-staff instruments
Many instruments can have more than one staff:
Keyboard instruments - left hand and right hand
Wind instruments - when there are several players
Percussion - e.g. celesta, complicated marimba writing
Singers - sometimes when divided
Strings - often when divisi.
To add another staff to an instrument:
l

Click one of its existing staves


Choose Create h Extra Staff ) Above / Below.

You can add further staves in the same way. A single instrument can have any number of staves (even 5, or
47391082), though you will seldom need more than two or three. Note that if the number of staves used for an
instrument changes throughout your score, you may need to adjust some playback settings - LLJ Playback.
All of an instruments staves share its name, which is vertically centered on the staves.
Ossias
An ossia is a small bar or so of music above a normal-sized staff to show an alternative way of playing something.
Ossias are incredibly easy to create with Sibelius. Simply:
l

Select the passage you want to create an ossia above, e.g. click a bar
From Create h Extra Staff, choose Ossia Above, or Ossia Below.
The ossia bar(s) automatically appear, already made small for you. Now you can copy the music from the
original (with x-click or Alt-click) and amend as necessary to make your ossia.

What creating an ossia really does is to create a small staff above/below the selected one, with staff type changes
427

Reference

before and after the ossia to hide the staff lines on either side of it. You can drag these staff type changes to adjust the
width of the ossia.
Creating an ossia this way always creates an extra staff, If you create two ossias on the same system using the method
described above, you will find it difficult to line them up, because Sibelius will have created a second extra staff above
the selected one. Instead, create the second ossia using Create b Staff Type Change b Pitched b 5 lines and
then back to Hidden (no lines) at the end.
Indented systems
Systems are automatically indented as necessary to fit in full instrument names, e.g. at the start and at new sections.
To indent any system manually, simply drag the initial barline (to the left of the clef) or the leftmost end of the staff
rightwards.
The inb ent is set for that particular barline only, so to keep the format the same youre recommended to put a system
or page break at the end of the preceding system, if there is one. (If you dont do this, then if that barline ends up in
the middle of a system Sibelius will put a gap before it to produce a divided system, like a coda - which is ingenious
but may come as a surprise.)
To reset the indentation of a staff which you have dragged, select the initial barline or the leftmost end of the staff and
choose Layout b Reset Position (shortcut 08gP or Ctrl+Shift+P)
Save trees - hide empty staves
If a staff only contains bars rest, you can hide it from that particular system, as is done in large scores:
l

Double-click the staff to select it all (or select several staves as a passage)
Choose Layout b Hide Empty Staves (shortcut 4x%%H or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+H), or if youre sure that
the passage has no music in it, just hit Delete (though beware that if there was any music, Delete will delete
it!)

You can also do this to several staves, or a passage lasting as many bars as you like, or even to the whole score. Staves
will be hidden only on systems where they have no music.
To hide empty staves throughout the score, simply choose Edit b Select b Select All (shortcut %A or Ctrl+A)
and choose Layout b Hide Empty Staves - all unused staves throughout the score will disappear and the whole
score will instantly reformat to fit on fewer pages, possibly saving several grateful trees.
When using Layout b Hide Empty Staves, note that if you include keyboard staves then you may end up with
just one hand hidden, which looks odd. So either check the keyboard part afterwards and re-show the hidden
keyboard staff if this occurs, or (if, say, youre hiding staves throughout a score and cant be bothered to check the
keyboard staves afterwards) dont include keyboard staves when hiding staves.
You cant, of course, hide the only staff in a system, since there has to be at least one staff to show that theres a
system there at all. If you want actually to delete all the bars from a single staff, you should instead select the bars as a
system passage and hit Delete.
Show hidden staves
To re-show staves which youve previously hidden:
422

Staves

the

lad
ove
jnd

taff
2rn
in
US
nd

Click a bar where you want to show the staves


Choose Layout b Show Empty Staves (shortcut 0~6t%S or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+S)
In the dialog which appears, click OK to show all hidden staves, or select the particular staves you want to show.

Note that this shows staves that were hidden using Layout b Hide Empty Staves (because they contain no
music), but it doesnt show staves that were hidden using Create b Staff Type Change b Pitched b Hidden
(no lines) - to make these reappear, change the staff type back to 5 lines.
Deleting staves permanently
If you want to get rid of a staff (and any music on it) permanently, triple-click the staff to select it throughout the score,
hit Delete, and click Yes.
To delete an instrument which has more than one staff (e.g. a piano), or several instruments, you can select several
staves at the same time (!LLI Selections and passages) and then delete them in the same way.
Staff size
The staff size determines the size of everything in the score. If you double the staff size, all text, lines and so on will
double too. If your score looks too cramped or spaced out, you can alleviate this by changing the staff size;
II&II Document Setup.
I-, 2-, 3- and &line staves
These are most often used in percussion
- l!LLl Percussion.

at
te
3

h
n

However, they are also occasionally


used on non-percussion instruments in
contemporary music when the notated
pitches are imprecise or when the
instrument is being used percussively.
On a Vine staff the lines might vaguely
represent high range: middle range
and low range: You could also write
notes along a l-line staff to indicate that
a player (such as a guitarist) should tap
his instrument in a specified rhythm.

Small staves
To make a staff go smaller than ot her staves, select the staff in question and
switch on the Small staff option in the Staves panel of the Properties
window.
Small staves are not handled like a staff type change, because any type of staff
can go small - even percussion staves and guitar tab.
By default, small staves are 75% of normal size, but you can adjust this on the
Staves page of the House Style b Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut
Ug%E or Ctrl+Shift+E).

Changing the number of staff lines etc.


Every staff has a number of characteristics such as the number of staff lines,
whether it should use clefs, whether barlines should extend above or below the
staff (as they do for l-line staves), and so on; all together these characteristics make up a staff type. You can edit
existing staff types or create new ones if you like - IZL! Edit Staff Types.
Sibelius chooses the appropriate staff type for each staff in your score when you create the instruments, but you can
change this if you like:
l

Select a bar in the staff whose staff type you want to change so that it is surrounded by a blue box
Open the Staves panel of the Properties window and choose a new staff type from the list.

This changes the staff type for that staff throughout the score, but you can also create a staff type change at any point
In your score.
423

Reference

Creating a staff type change


Changing the staff type of a staff in mid-score allows you to, say, go from a single-line staff to a s-line staff, or to hide
the barlines in a single staff for a few bars, and so on.
To create a staff type change:
l

Select the note after which you want the staff type change to appear
Choose Create ) Staff Type Change and choose the desired staff type from one of the three submenus,
Pitched, Tab or Percussion
The staff type change is created in your score.

Staff type changes are invisible by default, but appear as gray rectangles when View ) Hidden Objects (shortcut
XXI-I or Ctrl+Alt+H) is switched on, so you will probably find it useful to switch this on when working with staff
type changes. They can be copied, dragged around and deleted just like ot :her objects - try dragging a staff type
chang e left or right, or even onto another staff!
To change a staff back to normal, either select and delete the changeover point (if it changed mid-score), or else put a
5-line staff type on that staff at the start of the score.
You may have noticed that various guitar tunings are also staff types which can be created similarly. If this intrigues
you, ILL!/ Guitar tab.
To edit the characteristics of guitar tab and drum set (kit) staves, LQ Guitar tab and Percussion.
Staves with gaps in or stopping early
Penderecki, Stockhausen and some other contemporary composers like to have no staff lines in bars where an
instrument isnt playing. This gives scores a scrap-book (sometimes called cut-away) look, with passages of music
dotted about on the page.
In choral music, preces and responses are often written similarly.
It is also occasionally useful to be able to make a staff stop short of the right margin, e.g. for music examples.
To achieve any of these notations:
Leave one or more bar rests at the right of the staff
Choose Create ) Staff Type Change ) Pitched ) No Lines (hidden)
Click where you want the staff to disappear
Make it reappear later (e.g. later on in that staff, or at the start of the next system) by placing a 5 lines staff type
change there.
Other staff types
In addition to the many standard staff types, Sibelius includes a number of special staff types in the Create ) Staff
Type Change k Pitched submenu:
l

424

No lines (bat-lines shown) is suitable for writing plain rhythms in music examples
No lines (bar rests shown) doesnt show barlines, but does show bar rests. Were not quite sure what
you could use this for, but here it is anyway!

-- -.- - .-

~.--Staves

System separators
System separators are thick double lines drawn between systems, normally at the left-hand side, to make the format
clearer. Right system separators (drawn at the right margin) are very rarely required, but true to Sibeliuss unrelenting
comprehensiveness are nonetheless available should you hanker after them.

You can switch system separators on or off using Draw left/right separator on the Instruments page of the
House Style b Engraving Rules dialog. You can also set the minimum number of a system should have before
the separators will appear, and the distance of the separators from the margin.
Because this option is copied into parts when you extract them, you can also use it to automatically control which parts
have separators; e.g. if you want them to appear only in complex percussion parts containing (say) 3 or more staves,
you can set the minimum number of staves to 3 ;II the score before extraction and all the parts will inherit this option.

1
C

425

Reference

Stems
Stem directions

It is a common fallacy among


musicians that single notes on the
middle staff line can have a stem in
either direction. In fact the stem
should point down unless the context
makes it look particularly out of
place. In vocal music however,
middle-line stems often point up, to
avoid colliding with the lyrics. On Iline staves, stems always point up.
ith pitches on a chord or notes
b1 amed together, the stem-direction
is determined by the average pitch.
In multiple voices, all notes have
stems up in voices I & 3 and stems
down in voices 2 & 4, regardless of
pitch.

Flipping stem direction


The rule for stem-directions (see box) is almost completely rigid. About the only
stem direction you should ever reverse is for notes on the middle staff line.
To reverse a notes stem, select it and choose Edit b Flip (shortcut X). This also
flips any ties as necessary (although you can also flip ties independently if you
wish).
Dont confuse flipping stems with writing ordinary music in two voices. If you write
in two voices the stems are automatically reversed for you (LQ Voices).
To flip the stems of all notes joined by a beam, you need only flip the stem of one
of the notes.
Stems on the middle line
Stems on the middle line of the staff usually point downwards (see Stem
directions box on the left), but the exceptions to this are vocal and choral
music, where stems on the middle line often point upwards, and percussion music
written on 1 -line staves, on which stems always point up.

Sibelius automatically does this using the option Stems point up for notes on mid-line which is switched on
for appropriate staff types, including the staff type 5 lines (singers), which singers use by default. To change this
throughout an instrument or the score, change which staff type that instrument uses, or edit this option in the staff
type itself; LQ Edit Staff Types.
Adjusting stem-lengths
Normally you should never change the lengths of stems, as the rules for stem-lengths are almost totally rigid and so
are followed religiously by Sibelius. But there are occasions when a stem has to be lengthened in order, for instance,
to avoid a collision between a beam and a grace note, or to allow room in avant-garde music for a special symbol to
go on the stem; or shortened to avoid collisions in tight situations, particularly when using multiple voices.
To adjust a stems length, simply drag the end of the stem, or click the end and adjust it with the arrow keys. %?P/+
or Ctrl++/$ adjusts in steps of 0.25 spaces. It often helps to zoom in close on the stem so you can see what youre
doing better.
You can drag individual stems towards the notehead, resulting in a stemless note. However, its preferable to use
proper stemless notes instead - L!2 Noteheads.
You can even drag a stem past the notehead to go backwards, which makes the stem end up on the wrong side of the
note - though this is not very useful.
Stemless notes
To create stemless notes, use notehead 8 - select the passage you want to make stemless and type 4x8 or
Shift+Alt+8 (on the main keyboard).
426

__ _____- ~~ ~--

Stems

Stem symbols
In contemporary music, symbols are sometimes added to stems to indicate special playing techniques.
EQ Symbols.
Engraving Rules options
On the Notes 2 page of the House Style b Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut UB%E or Ctrl+Shift+E) you
will find these exciting options:
l

Stemsx spaces thick allows you to change the thickness of stems; the default is 0.1 spaces
Minimum length x spaces allows you to specify a minimum length for all stems, enabling you to override
(say) the short stems on high/low notes in 2 voices. By default it is set to 0, so it has no effect.
New stem length rule makes the stems of notes on or either side of the middle staff line 0.25 spaces
longer than with the option off, which many engravers and publishers prefer. This option is switched on by
default.

427

Reference

symbols
L!2 Edit Symbols.
All of Sibeliuss standard music symbols are available not only from the keypad and menus, but also from the large
Create b Symbol dialog, which also includes many extra symbols.
The difference between symbols and other objects is that you can position symbols anywhere you like. This enables
you to override any of Sibeliuss positioning rules by putting a symbol such as a sharp exactly where you want it, even
in weird places where sharps shouldnt go.
The disadvantage of symbols is that their IQ is not as high as that of other objects. For instance, if you put a sharp
symbol next to a note, it wont move vertically if the note is dragged up or down, nor will the note play as a sharp, and
/ nor will it change to a natural (or whatever) if the music is transposed. The moral of this is: dont use a symbol where
a normal object will do equally well.
Symbols are still smart in other ways, though - they attach to staves and rhythmic positions, so that they stay in the
right place when the music reformats or when you extract parts (ILLI Attachment).

Creating a symbol
Select the note next to which you want to add a symbol, then choose Create b Symbol (shortcut Z for
zym bol)
l

428

Select a symbol from the dialog and, if necessary, adjust the size of the symbol using the four size options.
(Symbols automatically shrink when attached to a small staff, so you should normally leave the size at Normal
when putting a symbol on a small staff.)
Click OK, and the symbol is created in the score next to the selected note. (Double-clicking the symbol in the
dialog does the same as clicking OK.)

Symbols

Use the arrow keys to move the symbol around (with # or Ctrl for larger steps).

Alternatively, you can place symbols with the mouse. To do this:


l

Ensure that nothing is selected, then choose Create ) symbol


Select a symbol and click OK
The mouse pointer changes color, and you click in the score to position the symbol.

Symbols can be copied and deleted just like other objects.


Moving symbols
Its often useful to nudge symbols around in tiny steps using the arrow keys; holding down 8% or Ctrl moves in
bigger steps, exactly 1 space in size. Layout ) Reset Position (shortcut U%%P or Ctrl+Shift+P) returns a
symbol to its default position.
Editing symbols
For details on editing existing symbols and creating new ones, LQ Edit Symbols.
Notable symbols
The Create ) Symbol dialog is grouped according to categories. Some of the less obvious symbols are as follows:
Cafegoty
Repeats

1 Symbols
/;/r ;//!

Meaning
Repeat the last groups of eighths (quavers), usually found in handwritten music; repeat last bar; repeat last
two bars. Also includes various bar-line symbols, useful for scores where some staves have independent
barlines.
Brackets for placing around symbols (e.g. accidentals, &a, trills); keyboard brace

General

A\
Includes mordents, turns, and so on, but these do not play back; to create trills that play back, LQ Lines

Ornaments

Keyboard

!-f?eh.bU A

These rows include most symbols provided in the well-known GhentTM font. The first row includes symbols for
various (mainly pitched) percussion instruments.

Percussion

. . . beaters

Pedal symbols which you can use to change the appearance of the pedal line (ED Lines); heel and toe
symbols for organ pedals (left and right foot)

wTlEl

Includes sticks for various instruments (pictured left are soft, medium and hard beaters)
Includes frames for various numbers of strings; vibrato bar scoop; vibrato bar dip

Guitar
I

J V

429

Reference

The first two rows are ordered according to relative proximity to the notehead (e.g. a staccato dot goes nearer
to a notehead than a down-bow symbol); the symbols on the first row go above the note, and those on the
second row, below the note.
The third row contains other articulations:
Articulation

0.0

Multiple staccatos, for use on repeated notes written as a one-note tremolo; snap pizzicato for stringed
instruments, mainly used by Bartok, and sometimes drawn the other way up

Comma and tick, indicating a breath, usually in choral music (the comma also indicates a short silence on
instruments like the piano which cant literally breathe); caesuras in two different thicknesses

,J//
1 U

Stress and unstress marks (above and below), used by Schoenberg; notch staccato, sometimes used in early
music.
The first nine symbols in both rows (unbracketed and bracketed) are ordered from flattest to sharpest,
including microtones; remember that as these are symbols theyre not automatically transposed, nor do they
play back, so use a normal accidental if possible.

db 1112 half-steps (semitones) flat

Accidentals

(1 d ~2 of a half-step (semitone) flat

P 1 l/4 half-steps (semitones) flat, or occasionally 1 l/2 half-steps flat


1 ~4 of a half-step (semitone) flat or ~2 half-step flat
lq ~4 or ~2 of a half-step (semitone) sharp

$ ~2 of a half-step (semitone) sharp


# 1 VI or 1 l/2 half-steps (semitones) sharp
# 1 l/2 half-steps (semitones) sharp
These notes are not used by Sibelius to draw ordinary notes; they are provided purely in case you want to
write notes in totally weird places. Sibelius draws notes using a notehead (from the Noteheads row), with
tails (from the Notes row) for short notes.
Tail aficionados might like to examine closely how weve constructed the tails of sixteenth notes
(semiquavers) and shorter notes, such that the tail nearest the notehead is of slightly greater curvature. (Tail
non-aficionados will have no idea what were talking about.).

Notes

-0.

Grace note slash for acciaccatura stem; laissez vibrer tie symbol (preferable to using a real tie in some
circumstances) which can also be used for ties going into 2nd endings Qnd-time bars) and codas; tremolo
stroke; rhythm dot
Cluster symbol; by stacking several of them vertically you can make a cluster chord of any size

Noteheads

To change noteheads, dont use symbols - LLJ! Noteheads. Also contains stalk symbols for altered
unisons - LQ Accidentals.

Rests

All standard rests, including old-style multirests; also includes constituent parts of H-bars - LLJ Multirests

Conductor

HN 1

Haupstimme: place it above an instruments melody to show that its the most prominent instrument in that
passage; Nebenstimme: denotes the second most prominent instrument; the rightmost corner-piece shows
where either passage ends. Used mostly by Schoenberg, Berg and Webern.

Put these at the right-hand end of a staff (e.g. in choral music) to show its going to divide on the next system.
They can stick out into the right margin of the page. You can also use the arrows individually, pointing the
other way around to show that two staves are going to join together again.

430

_ ~__~___. .__-_---_-

Symbols
category

Meuning
Beat, left-hand beat, right-hand beat, long beat. The leftmost symbol is the only standard one; the others are
used occasionally (e.g. by Lutoslawski), but their meanings vary somewhat. Beat marks appear in the full
score to tell the conductor how to beat in tricky circumstances; they also sometimes appear in parts so the
performers know when to wait for a beat.

rln
IFlA

Double and triple beats (for a single beat, use one of the above arrows or a simple vertical line). They appear
over sequences of music to indicate how the conductor will group them; they are schematic drawings of the
shape outlined by the conductors baton. Used e.g. in Boulezs le Marteau suns ma&e. The lower set is for
compound beats

Clefs

Contains all standard clefs - LLI Clefs. Note that the 8 and 15 are separate symbols (at the right of the
second row) which you can alter in order to change all appropriate clefs at once.

Octaves

Used in 8vu etc. lines - LLI Lines

Breaks &
Locks

Used by Sibelius to show page/system breaks etc. - its unlikely youll want to use these as symbols in your
musrc
This row contains a myriad exciting and unusual symbols:
d\rn
000

Techniques
*/YVt

22

7-Y
Accordion

Lift (doit) and fall for jazz notation; mute, for stringed instruments
Wind instrument fingerings: open hole, half-hole and closed hole
Attach to the stem of a note or chord. They mean: whispered or sprechstimme; swished (or some similar
action on percussion instruments); sulponticello (played on the bridge); harp buzz (when the pedal is
changed while the respective string is still vibrating), also used in drum notation to specify a buzz roll (as
opposed to an open roll), and by Penderecki to notate an unmeasured string tremolo played as fast as
possible

Exponential crescendo curves which fit onto narrow and wide crescendo hairpins
I 5 treble coupler diagrams and I 3 bass coupler diagrams for accordion music, plus an empty diagram and a
blob which you can superimpose to produce further combinations

tm.

431

Reference

Text
LL! Edit Text Styles, Chord symbols, Lyrics, Page numbers, Bar numbers, Rehearsal marks,
Filters and Find, Hiding objects.
Creating text fast
Word menus
Text editing
Standard text styles
Expression
Technique
Metronome mark
etric modulations
Tempo
Lyrics and Chord symbol
Title, Subtitle, Composer, Lyric:rst, Dedication
Figured bass
Fingering
Small text and Boxed text
Copyright
Footnote
Header and Header (after first page)

Footer
Plain text
Roman numerals
Reset Position
Reset Design
Changing the text style of existing text
Selecting a line of text
Copying lines of text and text between programs
Text at the left of the system
Text between staves
Multiple pieces of text
Hiding text
Special characters
Creating special objects with text
Creating and modifying word menus
Font equivalents

For an introduction to creating and editing text, Q2 Alphabetic input in the Quick tour.
Creating text fast
There are five quick ways to create text:
Type the keyboard shortcuts #E or Ctrl+E, B%T or Ctrl+T and %%L or Ctrl+L to get the three most common
text styles, namely Expression, Technique and Lyrics.
Other text styles with shortcuts are: Lyrics verse 2 (shortcut Y#L or Ctrl+Alt+L); Chord symbols
(%K or Ctrl+K for kord); T e m p o (xB%T or Ctrl+Alt+T); and Metronome mark (x%M or
Ctrl+Alt+M).
If you have a note or other object selected, Sibelius will automatically create the text at that point in the score; if
you have nothing selected, the mouse pointer will change color to show that it contains an object, and you can
click in the score to place the text.
For standard words like crest., use the menus of useful words - see word menus below
l

If the same text is used over and over again, just copy it with x-click or Alt+click, or multicopy it (e.g. to put
the same dynamics on every instrument) - KI Selections and passages
You can copy text to the clipboard and then paste it elsewhere in the same score, into another score, or even
to/from another program - see Copying lines of text and text between programs below

432

_._-

__.__

__ __ _

-_

. --Text

ks

You can also copy the caret itself to start a new piece of text. Find some text on the screen in the style you
require, double-click it to make the caret appear, then x-click or Alt+click somewhere else to start some new
text in the same style.

Word menus
To save you time, Sibelius has built-in menus of useful words to type when creating text. Each text style has its own
appropriate word menu. For instance, Expression produces a menu of dynamics (etc.), and Chord symbols gives
various bits from which you can make up any chord symbol.
To obtain the word menu, simply Control-click (Mac) or right-click (Windows) while creating or editing text. Note
that some of the words and characters on the menus have keyboard shortcuts; Q2 Keyboard shortcuts or the
menus themselves for a full list.
You can edit the word menus, or create your own new ones, and also assign your own keyboard shortcuts to the
words - see Creating and modifying word menus below.
Text editing
The text editing keys are similar to other programs, plus a few extra keys. The main ones are as follows:
To edit an existing text object, double-click it, or hit Return (on the main keyboard)
To stop editing text, hit Esc
To select all text in the current text object, type %gA or Ctd+A
For a new line while editing, hit Return (on the main keyboard)
To make text bold/non-bold, click B (shortcut 6r%B or Ctrl+B) in the Text panel of the Properties window.
This (and italic/underlining) affects text you are about to type, a chunk of text you have selected, or the whole
text object (or text objects) if its selected
To make text italic/non-italic, click I (shortcut 8%l or Ctrl+l) in the Text panel of the Properties window
To make text underlined/non-underlined, click U (shortcut B%U or Ctrl+U) in the Text panel of the
Properties window. Underlining text is very rare in music.
on

To change the point size of text, change the value in the Text panel of the Properties window (although you
should normally edit the text style instead)

IIS
or

There are various other editing shortcuts: L!2 Keyboard shortcuts for full details.

; if
an

HA
en

You can also change the formatting of text (such as bold or italic) after you have created it: simply select the text and
change the options on the Text panel of the Properties window.
If you just want to change the font/bold/italic/underlining/point size of a small amount of text, its fine to use the
options on the Text panel of the Properties window. However, if you want to change all the text throughout the
score (in that text style), you should edit the text style itself instead (L!ZI Edit Text Styles), because this will
automatically change all existing text and also all new text you create in that style thereafter. For example, if you decide
you want your lyrics in a different font, you should edit the text style rather than changing all the existing words
manually.
If you want to change quite a lot of text, but not all of it, e.g. to have a chorus in italics, edit a different text style that
youre not using in your score, and then use that text style instead (see Changing the text style of existing
433

Reference

text below if you have already entered t .he text in your score). Alternatively, define a new text style based on the most
similar existing one and use that.
Standard text styles
Sibelius includes many text styles for use in your score, listed in the table below.
Each of these styles is discussed in more detail below. The difference between staff and system text is simple: staff text
applies only to a single staff, and system text applies to all staves in the score (and though it may only be displayed
above one or two staves in the full score, it will automatically extracted into all parts).
Of course, you can also edit any of these existing styles and create new ones - I!LQl Edit Text Styles.
Name

Used for.

.,

Expression

. . . writing dynamics and expressive markings such as mp, crest. and legato

Technique

Shortcut: #E or Ctrl+E
. . . writing playing techniques such as mute, pizz., etc.
Shortcut: XT or Ctrl+T

Chord symbol

. . .writing lyrics in vocal music - IUI Lyrics


Shortcut: B%L or Ctrl+L
. . . writing e.g. Cm7 - UI Chord symbols

Plain text

Shortcut: %gK or Ctrl+K


. . . writing blocks of lyrics, editorial commentaries, etc.

Lyrics, Lyrics verse 2 etc.

Figured bass
Fingering
Boxed text
Small text
Nashville chord numbers
Footnote
Title
Subtitle
Composer

. . . figuring continua instruments in Baroque music


. . . writing fingerings in e.g. keyboard, brass or string music
. . . writing certain playing techniques, e.g. in percussion
. . . writing certain playing techniques
. . .writing e.g. 6/3 - 1U Chord symbols
. . . writing editorial commentaries at the bottom of the page (not the same as Footer)
. . . writing the title of the piece or movement
. . . writing subtitles (e.g. for a particular movement)
. . . writing the name of the composer (usually all in CAPITALS) or arranger/orchestrater (not in
capitals)

Lyricist
Dedication
Tempo
Metronome mark
Copyright
Header etc..
Footer etc.
Rit./Accel.

434

. . . writing the name of the lyricist, poet, or other source of text


. . . writing a dedication (e.g. To the choir of St. Johns)
. . . writing
Shortcut:
. . . writing
Shortcut:
. . . writing

tempo markings such as Andante


&%T or Ctrl+Alt+T
metronome marks and metric modulations
x#M or Ctrl+Alt+M
copyright lines in your score

. . . writing a header on every page


. . . writing a footer on every page (not the same as Footnote)
. . . writing particular tempo instructions

Text

Expression
This text style is for writing dynamics and other instructions to players, e.g. /egolo, live/y, marcafo. These are written in
italics. You can create expression text by choosing Create b Text b Expression (shortcut %?E or Ctrl+E).
Dynamics such as mfor S$ are special bold italic characters which use a special font (EL!! Music fonts), normally
Opus Text. You can create these characters from the word menu (Control-click or right-click), or by holding down 8%
or Ctrl and typing the dynamic, e.g. %9MF or Ctrl+MF to produce mJ: The exception is Z, for which you must type
Positioning Expression and
Technique text
Expression text goes below the staff it
applies to, but above in staves with
lyrics. Technique text goes above the
staff For music in two voices, both
Expression and Technique text goes
above the staff for Voice I and below
for Voice 2. If Expression or Technique
text applies to both hands of a
keyboard instrument it should go
between the staves.
The left-hand side of Expression text
normally goes just to the left of the
note to which it applies.

-c,%%Z or Ctrl+Shift+Z (because 8gZ or Ctrl+Z is the st lortcut for Edit b


Undo).
All common expression markings can be created quickly from the word menu, to
save you typing them.
There are a few dynamic markings, such as crest., which are usually written as
words. Although nearly all dynamics you create in your score are played back
automatically, note that the words crest. and dim. do not play back - if you need
them to, create hairpins as appropriate and hide them (LQ Lines). A couple of
special effects, e.g.fp, dont play back quite correctly, but you can achieve the
right effect using MIDI messages if playback of this particular marking is very
important to you.
Dynamics only apply to a single staff, but you can quickly add dynamics to other
staves in a number of ways:

If f has to be written on a staff (which


is best avoided), the cross-bar should
be positioned over a staff line for
clarity Similarly, p on a staff should
be centered on a space.

Copy the dynamic with Edit b Copy (shortcut XC or Ctrl+C), then select

the staves you want to copy the dynamic to and type XV or Ctrl+V to paste it
to all selected staves. This is called multicopying - LQ Selections and
passages

Select the dynamic and use x-click or Alt+click to copy it onto other staves;
to align them, select the bar in \tihich they occur, then choose Edit b Filter b Dynamics and use Layout b
l

Align in a Column (shortcut U%%C or Ctrl+Shift+C)


In keyboard music, dynamics usually apply to both staves, but Sibelius wont automatically play back dynamics
on both staves. Use the Copy Dynamics plug-in to make dynamics affect both staves - L!2 Plug-ins.

Technique
This is for writing technical instructions which are not normally written in italics, e.g. mute, pizz., a 2, solo, tremolo. You
can also type musical symbols such as accidentals in Technique text, which is useful for things like harp music.
Technique text is created by choosing Create b Text b Technique (or typing XT or Ctrl+T); you can then use
the word menu - Control-click (Mac) or right-click (Windows) - to create the text you want.
Metronome mark
Metronome marks look something like J = 72, and are often accompanied by a tempo marking (see Tempo
below). To write a metronome mark:

Reference
l

Select an object (e.g. a note or rest) in your score where you want the metronome mark to go, normally the first
note of a bar, and choose Create b Text b Metronome mark (shortcut x~%M or Ctrl+Alt+M); a

Typography of tempo and


metronome text
Sudden changes of tempo should begin
with a capital letter to startle you: Molto
vivace, Tempo I, Pilj mosso. Gradual
changes of tempo begin with a lower-case
letter: poco rit., accel.
Extended tempo changes are often written
in separate syllables: ac - ccl - er - an do. Type each syllable as a separate piece
of texf, and draw dashed lines instead of
using hyphens. This will ensure that the
entire word can stretch or contract if the
/ayout changes.
If tempo text or a metronome mark is
above a time signature, the left-hand sides
of both should be aligned.
m
%. , :y* . : ~y;;:; .; ;. :~ ; ~: :; . ; 11, .,v

flashing caret appears. (If nothing is selected in your score, type -c%fM or
Ctrl+Alt+M, then click in your score to place the text.)
Write notes in metronome marks by Control-clicking (Mac) or rightclicking (Windows) to get the word menu. You can alternatively use the %g or
Ctrl key in conjunction with the l-6 keys on the numeric keypad.
l

You can then type = 60 or whatever in the normal way. Hit space on
either side of the = sign.
l

When typing a metronome mark after a tempo mark, e.g. Allegro J = 60,
you are not advised to input it using two separate bits of text (Tempo text plus
Metronome mark text), or the two separate text objects could collide if the
notes in the bar get too close together. Instead, write all the text in the Tempo
text style, and when you get to the metronome mark, switch off Bold and
preferably choose a smaller point size on the Text panel of the Properties
window.
Metric modulations
Metric modulations are used to illustrate the relationship between note values

in different tempos, e.g.:

Metric modulations are also frequently used to show a swing feel, e.g.
-3-7

fl=J J
Use the Metronome mark text style (shortcut x%%M or Ctrl+Alt+M) for metric modulations. To input beamed
notes or triplets in text, Control-click (Mac) or right-click (Windows) to display the word menu containing the various
symbols available. For instance, to get two beamed eighth notes (quavers), use a beamed eighth note followed by a
quarter note (crotchet), which will appear as the final eighth note. To get a triplet quarter note plus eighth note, type
the notes as normal, then add the triplet bracket separately: create another text object, choose the tuplet bracket from
the word menu, hit Esc to stop editing text, then drag the bracket into place using the mouse.
Tempo
To create tempo text, choose Create b Text b Tempo (shortcut xB%T or Ctrl+Alt+T). Tempo text usually
appears at the start of the score, e.g. Allegro non troppo, and is often accompanied by a metronome mark (see
above).
Sibelius knows the meaning of a wide variety of tempo markings and will play them back even if you dont create a
metronome mark - LQI Playback dictionary. As usual, x-clicking or right-clicking while creating Tempo text
gives a menu of useful words. .
436
-

_ .~

___

___ ._ _.-. --- __

~- ___-

~-

Text

To create rits. and accels., we recommend you dont type them as text, but use ritjaccel. lines instead (!!I22 lines), as
these play back. Note that A tempo and Tempo 1 dont play back, so create a metronome mark (which you can
hide if you want) to revert to the original tempo.
In large scores, text in the Tempo and Metronome mark styles automatically appears not just at the top, but duplicated
lower down as well (normally above the keyboard or strings). The two copies mimic each other whenever you edit
one of them - for instance, if you edit one piece of tempo text, both will change simultaneously.
However, each piece of text can be dragged up and down or deleted independently. This is useful to avoid collisions
with a high note above the top staff which does not occur lower down the score. To drag or delete both pieces of text
together, do it to the top one. To delete one of the lower pieces of text, simply select it and hit Delete; to bring it
back, select the top one and choose Layout ) Reset Design (shortcut b#D or Ctrl+Shift+D).
You can alter how many copies of the text you would like to appear, and above which staves - ILLI Edit Text
Styles and Layout and formatting. Other system objects behave similarly, such as rehearsal marks.
Lyrics and Chord symbol
These text styles are a bit special. LL3 Lyrics and Chord symbols.
Title, Subtitle, Composer, Lyricist, Dedication
By default, these text styles are left-, center- or right-aligned on the page, which means you can only drag text in these
styles up and down, not left or right.
You can put titles above any system in your score, not just at the stat-t - you might want a new title at the start of a

new section, song or movement, say - though if you do this it is best to put a system or page break at the end of the
previous system to keep the sections separated.
Occasionally (e.g. for high-volume copying work) you may want these text styles to go at a fixed position on the page
rather than relative to the top staff. To achieve this, set the Vertical Posn tab for each style in the House Style b
Edit Text Styles (shortcut GwB%T or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+T) dialog to a fixed mm from top margin.
Figured bass
Input the notes onto the bass or continua staff
Click Create ) Text ) Other staff text ) Figured bass, then click
below the first note
Type the numbers from the keyboard in the normal way. Type % or Ctrl
and the accidentals on the keypad to get accidentals. Other special
characters such as slashed numerals are available from the word menu
(Control-click (Mac) or right-click (Windows) the text youre creating),
which also lists further keyboard shortcuts
Hit space to advance to the next note or beat, whichever comes first.

Rules for fingering


In keyboard music fingerings for the
right hand go above the notes, and
for the left hand go below the notes.
Triplets and other tuplets should be
moved to the other side of the notes
if necessary, to avoid collisions.
Fingerings are ten tered horizon tally
on the notes. Successive fingerings
dont need to line up in a row - they
should go up and down following
the pitch of the notes, so that they
are fairly near each note.

Fingering
(In Create ) Text ) Other staff text.) This is for keyboard, brass and string fingerings. Hit Return (on the main
keyboard) after each number. Hitting space advances to the next note.
437

Reference

Sibelius can add brass and string fingering automatically - IZIJ Plug-ins.
Small text and Boxed text
These are for other technique-like instructions. Boxed text is useful for important instructions such as changes of
instrument.
Copyright
A copyright line is normally written on the first page of a score. This text style (choose Create b Text b Other staff
text b Copyright) goes at the bottom of the page, centered, and is extracted into all parts. The 0 symbol is
available from the word menu.
When placing the text you should place it on the first bar of the score - though it will appear at the bottom of the
page, it will in fact be attached to the first bar, which will ensure it always remains on the first page even if the score
reformats, and it will not split multirests in extracted parts.
You can edit the position and other characteristics of copyright lines with House Style b Edit Text Styles
(shortcut ~x%T or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+T).
Footnote
This positions text at the bottom of the page.
To create a footnote, select a note in the staff and bar you want the footnote to refer to, then choose Create b
Text b Other staff text b Footnote. The caret will nonetheless appear at the foot of the page.
You can refer to the footnote with an asterisk or numeral using (say) Technique text above the staff. The footnote you
type will always stay on the same page as the bar its referring to. It will also extract only into the part of the staff in
question.
You can modify exactly where the footnote is positioned at the bottom of the page - 1!!22 Edit Text Styles.
Header and Header (after first page)
Headers are text which goes at the top of every page - e.g. the name of the piece, or instrument in an extracted part.
Header (within Other System Text) produces the same text on every page; if you change the header on any
page, it automatically changes on all other pages. Headers and footers appear on the page where you place them and
all subsequent pages, but not previous pages. So you should normally place the header/footer on the first page, so
they appear throughout. Header (after first page) works the same but is omitted from the first page, to avoid
colliding with the title. Headers are system text and so are extracted into all parts.
These text styles are centered by default, but you can edit the positions and other characteristics with House Style b
Edit Text Styles.
Footer
Footers are text which goes at the bottom of every page. Create b Text b Other staff text b Footer (outside
edge) goes, surprisingly, on the outside edge - i.e. on the right of right-hand pages and the left of left-hand pages;
Footer (inside edge) goes on the inside edge. You can edit the positions and other characteristics with House
Style b Edit Text Styles.

~~ ______.~ ._ _

----

ic__--

Text

As with headers, you should normally create the footer on the first or perhaps the second page; it will automatically
appear on all subsequent pages. If you change the footer on any page, it automatically changes on all other pages.
Footers are system text and so are extracted into all parts.
Plain text
To create plain text in your score, for example to type miscellaneous performance instructions or blocks of lyrics, use
Create b Text b Other Staff Text b Plain text.
Roman numerals
To type Roman numerals for, say, instrument names (e.g. Violin II), simply use the normal text letters I, V and X.
Reset Position
Layout b Reset Position (shortcut O%%P or Ctrl+Shift+P) resets text to its default vertical position if it has
one.
Reset Design
If you want to change a text object back to its default font or size (set in House Style b Edit Text Styles), for
example if you have changed the font or made some text italic, select it and choose Layout b Reset Design
(shortcut bdt%D or Ctrl+Shift+D).
Changing the text style of existing text
You can change the text style of an existing text object. Select the text and open the Text panel of the Properties
dialog, where you can change the text style from a drop-down menu.
Note that only similar text styles are shown: for instance, if you select some Title text, Subtitle appears on the text style
list, but not Expression (since you can only change existing system text to another system text style). Note also that you
cannot change text in the Lyrics text style into any other text style.
Selecting a line of text
To select all text in that style along that staff, select a single text item and then choose Edit b Select b Select
More (type 4&A or Ctrl+Shift+A). This allows you to:
l

move all the items together with the mouse or arrow keys
copy the text to the clipboard for pasting elsewhere in the score, or into another program (see below)
line them up if you accidentally move one, e.g. lyrics and chord symbols: use Layout b Align In a Row
(shortcut O%gR or Ctrl+Shift+R) or Layout b Reset Position (shortcut 48%P or Ctrl+Shift+P) Q2 Layout and formatting.

Copying lines of text and text between programs


You can copy text objects in Sibelius in a variety of ways:
within the same score or different scores, either using x-click or Alt+click or using Edit b Copy and Edit b
Paste - the latter method is especially useful with lyrics (Q2 Lyrics)

439

into another program (e.g. Microsoft Word): simply select the text to be copied, use Edit h Copy (type %C or
Ctrl+C) to copy it to the clipboard, switch to the other program, and use Edit b Paste (type XV or Ctrl+V)
to paste the text.

If you copy several text objects into another program at once, they will be pasted one after another, with a space in
between each; for lyrics, separate syllables of the same word are pasted with hyphens in between - L!2 lyrics. Note
that when text is copied into another program, it is copied as plain text, so dynamics and notes in metronome mark
(which use the Music Text font) will not appear as such when pasted into, say, a Word document.
To copy text into Sibelius from other programs:
l

Select the text and copy it to the clipboard with Edit b Copy (shortcut normally 8gC or Ctrl+C)
Switch to Sibelius and create a suitable text caret, e.g. select a note and type B%T or Ctrl+T for Technique text
Choose Edit b Paste (shortcut 6t%V or Ctrl+V) to paste the text.

Pasting lyrics into Sibelius from other programs is slightly different - L!2 Lyrics.
Text at the left of the system
If you want to put text to the left of a system, youre probably specifying which players are playing an instrument, in
which case, ELI Instruments.
However, if you have a special reason to write text to the left of the system, its fine to do so but you should put a
system break at the end of the preceding system, to ensure that the text remains where it is if the music reformats.
EI Breaks.
Text between staves
When you create text between staves using the mouse, such as for keyboard dynamics, Sibelius guesses which staff
you intend to attach it to depending on the default vertical position of the text style (L!2 Default positions). This
usually produces the right result - for example, if you create lyrics between staves, Sibelius decides to attach them to
the upper staff, because lyrics normally belong to the staff above. But if you put text between two staves, make sure
that its attached to the correct one, otherwise the text will misbehave if you move the staff or extract a part.
Avoid putting one piece of text between two separate instruments but applying to both (which is in any case not good
notation). Otherwise, if you extract the instruments separately, only one of them will get the text. Its fine to write one
piece of text between the two hands of a keyboard instrument, though, because both hands will end up in the same
Pan .
Multiple pieces of text
You often need pieces of text side by side over different notes, such as fingerings or syllables of long-drawn-out words
like cre - seen - do. In all cases like this you must use separate pieces of text: dont just type it all in a line with
spaces in between. The reason is, of course, that if the music reformats youll want the separate bits to move closer
together or further apart.
When typing a long word as separate syllables over several bars, use a dashed line from the Create b Line dialog
instead of hyphens. Then as the spacing between syllables changes, more or fewer dashes will appear. (This is how
hyphens in lyrics work, in fact.)

Text

or

v>
in
:e
Sk

Hiding text
To hide text, which is mainly used for hidden dynamics and other playback markings, select the text you want to hide
and choose Edit ) Hide or Show ) Hide (shortcut 08%H or Ctrl+Shift+H). For more details, L!2 Hiding
objects.
Any text following a tilde character (-) is automatically hidden by Sibelius and will not print. This is normally only
used to write MIDI messages (LL! MIDI messages).
Special characters
In addition to words, many of the word menus also include special characters which you cant easily type from the
keyboard, such asf, J, , and 94.
Most of these characters are taken from the Opus Text font, regardless of the font youre using for standard characters.
You can change the font used - L!2 Music fonts. Chord symbol characters are taken from the Opus Chords font;
you can change this by editing the Chord symbol text style.
When creating text in foreign languages, you may need to use accented letters, some of which are available on the
word menus. LQ! Keyboard shortcuts for a full list of accented letter shortcuts. Sibelius uses the Unicode
standard character set, which means that special characters like accented letters are automatically translated between
Mac and Windows.
Creating special objects with text
One of Sibeliuss obscure but occasionally useful features is the ability to create special cases of objects such as
rehearsal marks, time signatures and bar numbers for special cases, using special text styles.
This otherwise incomprehensible concept is best illustrated by example:
Supposing you want your score to start with a special rehearsal mark called START. Sibelius wont let you input this as
a normal rehearsal mark because its not in alphabetical or numerical sequence. The complicated way round this
would be to create a whole new text style for large boxed text, and use it to type the word START.
But in fact, all you have to do is use Create ) Text F Special Text F Rehearsal mark. This creates a piece of
text which is not a real rehearsal mark, but uses the same text style as rehearsal marks and so will look (and in many
ways behave) just like a rehearsal mark. When you type START with the Rehearsal mark style, the text will appear
big and bold in a box, will be duplicated lower down the score (e.g. above the strings), and will also automatically
extract into all parts. Neat, huh?
There are various text styles which can be used to create peculiar objects in this way:
l

Bar numbers: for writing weird bar numbers with letters in, such as 78b in 2nd endings Qnd-time bars) and
show music
Time signatures: for creating weird Ferneyhoughesque time signatures such as 5/6
Rehearsal marks: for writing special rehearsal marks which are not in sequence (though there is automatic
provision for restarting the rehearsal mark sequence).

From here on it gets more tenuous:


l

Multirests: maybe for writing things like TACET in parts


441

Reference
l

Page numbers: for obscure things like writing folio numbers in an edition of early music
Tab letters/numbers: not all that useful as its not clear why youd want peculiar ones
Tuplets: for unusual formats such as 3 in 2.

Creating and modifying word menus


Choose File b Preferences b Word Menus
Click an existing word menu and Edit, or click New to create a new word menu (which you can give a name
at the top)
To add a new word to the menu, click New, and then type it into the Text box
To change a word in the menu, select it in the list, and edit it in the Text box
When creating/changing words you can also assign a keyboard shortcut: click in the Shortcut box and type the
shortcut. You should only use shortcuts of the form X-letter or Ctrl+letter, &#-letter or Ctrl+Shift+letter,
xx-letter or Ctrl+Alt+letter, 0vletter or Shift.+Alt+letter, or UK%%-letter or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+letter.
Click Use music text font in the unlikely event that youre typing music characters from the music text font
(as defined on the Text page of the House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog - ILL4 Music fonts). This is
for things likemf. Note that when editing a word menu the characters are shown in a text font, so they may not
look how they will when you create them from the word menu (e.g. in the Chord symbols or Figured
bass word menus)
To delete a word from the list, select it, then click Delete
When youre finished, click OK.
If youve created a new word menu and you want to assign it to a text style, go to the General tab of that text styles
Edit Text Style dialog (ILL! Edit Text Styles) and set Word menu to the menu you created.
To customize shortcuts other than for word menus, LU Keyboard shortcuts.
Font equivalents
For advanced users only
The file Font equivalents in the Resources folder within your Sibelius 2 program folder contains lists of
equivalent fonts, which Sibelius will substitute if a required font is missing (e.g. Times = Times Roman = Times
New Roman). You can edit this file yourself.
If a font used in a score is not available on your computer, the font equivalents file is scanned for the first mention of
this font. The missing font is then replaced by the first available font listed on the same line of the equivalents file. If
no replacements are available, the file is scanned for the next mention of the font, and so on. This means that when
editing the file you should put preferred fonts earlier in each line of equivalents.

442

Timecode

Timecode
Timecode means the position in time of a point in the score. It is usually measured from the start of the score, or in
film/TV scoring from the start of the reel or some other convenient point.
When you play back a score, a timecode readout is displayed on the toolbar, together with a readout of the current
tempo in beats per minute.
Sibelius can also display timecode automatically as text above every barline in your score. It calculates the temporal
position of barlines based on the number of bars, bar lengths and metronome marks up to that point. Timecode is
particularly useful for working out precise timings of particular passages of music, or for synchronizing musical events
with hit-points (events in a film).
Sibelius does not display or synchronize playback with an incoming SMPTE or MTC data stream. This functionality is
provided by professional sequencers, which can be used to play back music in this way if you export it from Sibelius as
a MIDI file (IL&I Saving MIDI files).
Timecode readout
During playback, timecode and tempo readouts appear on the toolbar:

The timecode display (on the left) shows the time elapsed since the start of the score (rather than the time elapsed
since playback started) - in other words, it shows the absolute score time values as displayed in your score by the
House Style b Timecode dialog (see below), rather than real time.
The tempo display is in beats per minute, where a beat is a quarter note (crotchet) for time signatures of the form
N/4, half note (minim) for N/2, dotted quarter note for 6/8, etc. Irregular time signatures like 5/8 are treated as 5
eighth note (quaver) beats.
Note that this tempo is affected by dragging the tempo slider, so you could, say, drag the tempo slider to find the right
tempo for your score, and then read it directly off the display for insertion into the score as a metronome mark
(LQ Text). When the tempo slider is in its central position (which is sticky), it represents the current tempo
specified in the score; at its leftmost position, it is loo/o, and at the rightmost, 175% of the current tempo.
Timecode dialog
The House Style b Timecode dialog contains various options relating to time, which are saved in the score (i.e.
they are not global program settings - they apply only to the score you are working on at the time).

-443

Reference

Notating timecode
To display timecode in your score, switch on Above every bar in House Style h Timecode. This automatically
displays timecode as boxed text over every barline in your score; you can change the Distance above staff
parameter to move the timecode higher or lower.
Timecode can be displayed in several formats:
l

Frames (e.g. 01:23:04:13), which is the standard format used for film/TV scoring
0.1 seconds (e.g. 1:23'4.5"), which is more legible but not quite as precise

Seconds (e.g. 1:234), which is rather imprecise but useful for rough timings.

Timecodes are printed when you print your score, and are extracted into parts. The latter is very handy for film/TV
recording sessions - you can just tell the musicians to play from 10 minutes 23 seconds.
Timecodes may slow down Sibelius considerably because of the complex calculations involved, particularly for long
scores, so we recommend you switch timecode off when you dont need it.
All timecodes are instantly updated whenever you input or edit metronome marks, add pauses, or add new bars. Try it
and see!
Frames per second
Because film and video can run at different speeds, timecode can be calculated based on the number of frames per
second. 24, 25, 29.97 and 30 (non-drop) are all used in various kinds of film or video, and 1 0 0
(centiseconds), while not a standard film or video speed, is included for the sake of convenience.
Start time
This specifies the timecode of the start of the score (in the format Hours:Minutes:Seconds:Frames).
This is used as an offset for all displayed times (i.e. both for the timecode readout during playback on the toolbar, and
any timecode text in the score). If you are using a frames-based timecode format, the frames value of the start time is
interpreted according to the current frames per second set in the dialog.
Changing the Start Time has two uses:
l

444

If your score is intended for film/TV work, the start time is often required to specify the location of a particular
cue in the film

Timecode
l

If your score is part of a larger work, such as one movement of a symphony, set the start time of the score to the
end time of the previous movement (given as the duration on the last page of the previous movement). Then all
timecodes will be relative to the start of the symphony rather than the start of this movement.

Duration at end of score


This calculates and writes the duration of your score in a box on the last page rounded to whole seconds, e.g. 433.
As with timecode, the duration is instantly updated whenever you input or edit metronome marks or add new bars.
Try it and see!
If you set a start time for the score, it is added to the duration - so if you split a work into two files and set the start
time of the second to the duration of the first, then the duration of the second tells you the cumulative time up to that
point, (see Start time above.)
Note that writing the duration at the end of the score may slow down Sibelius considerably because of the complex
calculations involved, particularly for long scores, so we recommend you switch this option off when you dont need it.
Text style
Timecodes are written using the Boxed text text style. Their height above the staff is determined by the value of
Distance above staff in the House Style h Timecode dialog, rather than the default height of the Boxed
text text style.
How timecode and duration are calculated
The timecode and duration of score values take account of tempo text (e.g. Allegro) and metronome marks
(LQ Text), fermatas (pauses) and rit./acce/. lines (/!L!J!l Lines).
However, timecode values do not take account of repeats, in that the timecode is calculated as if playing every bar in
the score exactly once from start to finish. 1st and 2nd endings (1 st/lnd-time bars) are treated as if both are played
straight through, ignoring repeats. Timecode also intentionally ignores the tempo slider.

Reference

Time signatures
Creating time signatures
l

Select a note, rest, line or other object in your score

Choose Create ) Time Signature (shortcut T) and click the time


signature you want; click Other and use the drop-down lists to create more
complex time signatures.
l

Click OK or hit Return; the time signature is created at the beginni ng of


the following bar.
l

To create a time signature at the start of your score, make sure that nothing is selected (hit Esc), then choose
Create ) Time Signature, select the time signature you want and click OK. The mouse pointer turns blue to
show that it contains an object - click at the start of the score to place the initial time signature.
Pick-up (upbeat) bars
If your score starts with a pick-up (upbeat) bar, its easiest to specify this at the same time as creating the initial time
signature. Click Start with bar of length in the Create ) Time Signature dialog, and choose the length of
the bar from the list, or type it on the numeric keypad (with Num Lock on). You can choose more than one note
value if you want a pick-up (upbeat) bar with a peculiar length such as a half note (minim) and a eighth note
(quaver).
You will notice that pick-up (upbeat) bars at first contain a whole bar rest; create a rest of the correct length in the
pick-up bar to make it look correct.
Should you forget to create a pick-up bar at this stage, you can create an irregular bar later - LLI Bars and bar
rests.
When music starts with a pick-up bar, its normal to number the first complete bar as bar 1, rather than bar 2 as it
would otherwise be. To do this, use a bar number change - LQ Bar numbers.
Rebarring music
If you put a time signature into some existing music, Sibelius asks if you want to rewrite the following music in the new
time signature. If you do so, Sibelius splits the existing music up into new bar-lengths, with ties across barlines where
necessary.
Note that Sibelius only rebar the music up to the next time signature change in your score, if there is one. This is very
useful when you want to change the barring of a few bars in the middle of the score. Put a copy of the prevailing time
signature at the beginning of the bar following the passage you want to rebar, and then put the new time signature at
the beginning of the passage to be changed. Click Yes when Sibelius asks if you want the following music rewritten.
In the unlikely event that you have copied some bars into a score which dont match the prevailing time signature and
you would like to rebar them accordingly, select the time signature and delete it. When asked if the bars following
should be rewritten, click No, then reinsert the same time signature, and this time when asked if the bars following
should be rewritten, click Yes.
446

Time signatures

Cautionary time signatures


Allow cautionary allows a cautionary time signature to appear at the end of the preceding system if the time
signature is being put (or subsequently ends up) at the end of a system. Youd normally want to switch off this box if
putting a time signature at the start of a new piece, song or movement within a larger score. (The same goes for
cautionary key signatures and clefs.)
Complex time signatures
To create a time signature other than the most common ones illustrated on the Create b Time Signature dialog,
click Other and pick the numbers you want from the lists provided.
If you want the groups shown as an additive time signature, such as 3+2+2/8, simply type 3+2+2 into the box for
the top of the time signature instead of picking a number from the list.
Alternatively, if you want the time signature written as 7/8 but to have 2+2+3 (or any other text) written above the
time signature in the same font, create a new text style that looks like a time signature - see Multiple time
signatures below.
Beat groups
You can also specify the Beat groups for complex time signatures as groups of 2 and 3 beats: for 7/8 grouped as
3+2+2, type 322. These groups specify how beams and rests are grouped by default. You can override them just by
creating your own rests or by altering the beaming manually.
If you want to change the beat groups of notes you have already created, , you can reinput the time signature,
specifying different beam groups, select the following music as a passage and choose Notes b Reset Beam

Irregular bars and free rhythm


To create a bar of irregular length (i.e. length different to that specified by the prevailing time signature), LQ Bars
and bar rests.
For other cases of music with free rhythm, E_Q Free rhythm.
Multiple time signatures
Occasionally scores have two simultaneous time signatures with the same bar-length, such as 2/4 against 6/8. To input
this sort of case:
l

Create a 2/4 time signature and input the 2/4 music as normal
Input the 6/8 music as triplet eighths (quavers), but use the Create b Tuplet dialog at least for the first tuplet,
switching on None and switching off Bracket, so it wont show that theyre triplets
You can copy the first 6/8 bar as a quick way to get the triplet rhythm for subsequent bars
When all of the music has been inputted, delete the 2/4 time signature and drag the first note rightwards until
theres enough space for a replacement time signature
Type the 2/4 and 6/8 using text - to do this youll need to create a new text style as follows:
l

Choose House Style b Edit Text Styles (shortcut 7=B%T or Ctrl+Alt+T)


Select Technique from the list of text styles, and click New.
447

//

Reference
l

On the General tab, give the new text style a name (like Other time signature) and set the font to
Opus and the size to 19.8 points relative (this is the default size for time signatures).
On the Vertical Posn tab, set Line spacing to 25%, and Snap to -1 above staff.

Click OK to finish creating the new text style.


0 Now choose Create b Text b Other staff text b Other time signature, and click where you want to put the
time signature to type it in as text, with a Return (on the main keyboard) after the top number.
l

In cases where two or more time signatures with different bar lengths are required, for example 4/4 and 5/4:
l

Calculate the lowest common multiple between the two time signatures -in this case, 20/4 - and create that as
the time signature

a When all of the music has been inputted, delete the 20/4 time signature and drag the first note rightwards until
theres enough space for a replacement time signature
l

Type the 4/4 and 74 using text - to do this youll need to create a new text style (see above)
Draw the extra barlines using the vertical line from the Staff lines pane in the Create b Line dialog.

This method has the advantage of ensuring that systems end at coinciding barlines.
If simultaneous time signatures always have barlines in different places, adopt the same procedure, but remove the
barlines in one staff (IQ2 Barlines on some staves only in Barlines), then use the vertical line from the
Staff lines pane in the Create b Line dialog to draw in suitable barlines where you want them.
Alternating time signatures
To write music in e.g. alternating 2/4 and 3/4 time, signaled by a 2/4 3/4 composite time signature:
l

Input a 2/4 time signature and copy it to alternate bars


Do the same for a 3/4 time signature in the remaining bars

Input the music


0 Then delete all the time signatures except the initial 2/4 (saying No when asked if you want to rewrite the
music)
0 Finally write a 3/4 time signature immediately after the initial 2/4 using text, as described% Multiple time
l

signatures above.
Modifying time signatures
You can copy and delete time signatures like other objects. You can also drag time signatures left and right to move
them - even to quite silly places. We dont recommend you drag time signatures out of the bar they belong to.
Big time signatures etc.
Big time signatures between staves are often used in large modern scores where the meter changes frequently.
On the Time signatures page of the House Style b Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut 0g%E or
Ctrl+Shift+E), click either Time signatures (large) or the even larger Time signatures (huge). These are
actually text styles which time signatures can use instead. These affect all time signatures throughout the score.

448

Time signatures

To alter the size, font and positioning of big time signatures, click Edit Text Style; LQ Edit Text Styles. This
also lets you adjust which staves big time signatures go above.
The other exciting House Style b Engraving Rules option confers upon you the ability to adjust the default gap
before time signatures.
Text style of time signatures
Time signatures are written as text in their own text style. You can edit the font they use by clicking Edit Text Style
on the Time signatures page of the House Style b Engraving Rules dialog.
You can change time signatures to any standard text font, or to music fonts such as Inkpen or Petrucci. However, you
may have to adjust the point size, or line spacing and default vertical position (Vertical Posn tab) to ensure that the
numbers sit nicely on the staff.

449

Reference

Transposing
For details of transposing instruments, E!2 Instruments.

To transpose music:
l

Select whatever you want to transpose - usually a passage or the whole score @A or Ctrl+A)
Choose Notes ) Transpose (shortcut Shift-T)
Set the interval by which you want to transpose:
Click Up or Down.
From the second box, choose the main interval.
In the first box, Major/Perfect leaves the main interval unaltered, Augmented adds a half-step (semitone),
Minor/Diminished subtracts a half-step.
Diatonic moves the notes within the key specified by the current key signature; so transposing up a diatonic
2nd makes the third note of the key into the fourth, makes the flattened fifth into the flattened sixth, etc.

Set the two other options if you like:


Transpose keys (available when transposing a system passage or the whole score) transposes any key
changes within the selected passage. Normally leave this on. If switched off, transposed notes acquire accidentals
which would otherwise be specified in the key signature.
Double sharps/flats makes Sibelius notate remote keys using double sharps and flats rather than naturals.
Switch this off for atonal music. Leave it on if youre Rachmaninov, or Alban Berg in his youth.

Click OK, and Sibelius instantly transposes the music.

Shifting without accidentals


To shift notes which you dont want to end up with accidentals, simply select the music and type &/+ one or more
times.
Transposing by one or more octaves
The quick method is to select the music and type x&//t or Ctrl+&/+.
Transposing by more than two octaves
For brevity, the Notes ) Transpose dialog (shortcut Shift-T) only lists intervals up to two octaves. For bigger
intervals, transpose by further octaves by typing a%&/+ or Ctrl+\L/+ before or after transposing from the dialog.
450

Transposing by a half-step (semitone)


Although most transpositions are straightforward, this particular case merits a little explanation. If you have a score in,
say, D major, and want to transpose it into D flat major, you should not transpose it down by a minor 2nd, which
produces C# major - instead, transpose it down by an augmented unison.
Extreme transpositions
To do extreme transpositions, e.g. B to D flat (up a doubly-augmented third), split it into two less extreme
transpositions: first transpose up a minor third to D, then down an augmented unison to D flat.
Chord symbols
These automatically transpose (except when in guitar frames).
Guitar frames
These do not transpose.
Moving other objects
When transposing, Sibelius will move other objects as it sees fit. For instance, ties and slurs need to be moved to
follow the notes. If music is transposed so far that lots of notes stem-directions change, some slurs may need to be
flipped with Edit b Flip (shortcut X) so as to fit over the notes smoothly.

451

Reference

Tremolos
One-note tremolos
Adding one tremolo stroke to a
quarter note (crotchet) or longer
note indicates that it is to be played
as two eighth notes (quavers).
Adding two strokes means it should
be played as four sixteenth notes
(semiquavers), and so on. Three
and four strokes are also used to
mean that the note should be
reiterated as fast as possible (an
unmeasured tremolo), e.g. to
indicate a drum-roll.
On an eighth (quaver) or shorter
note, one tremolo stroke means it
should be divided into two, two
strokes means it should be divided
into four, and so on.

Tremolos are an abbreviation rapidly repeated notes. A one-note tremolo is for a


single repeated note; a two-note tremolo represents two alternating notes.
One-note
One-note tremolos are notated as strokes on the stem of a note or chord, e.g.
3=m
To write this, choose the number of strokes you want the note to have from the
third keypad layout (either before or after you create the note).
To add tremolos to a note or chord after creating it, select the note/chord and
choose the number of strokes from the third keypad layout (type l/2/3/4/5 for
l/2/3/4/5 strokes).
You can remove the tremolos by choosing the same keypad button.
The number of divisions per note in a one-note tremolo is sometimes indicated by
placing multiple staccatos above the note, in addition to strokes through the stem.
You can add multiple staccatos as symbols - LIJ Symbols.

Two-note
Two-note tremolos are notated as beam-like strokes between two notes or chords, e.g.

J=J = Jm
On the first note/chord, simply choose the number of strokes you want from the third keypad layout (type
l/2/3/4/5 for l/2/3/4/5 strokes), then click the two-note tremolo button shown on the left (shortcut Enter)
You can do this before or after creating the second note.
Each of the notes is written as if it lasted for the whole length of the tremolo, i.e.
it looks as if the note-lengths are doubled. Sibelius automatically doubles the
note values for you. So to write a two-note tremolo that lasts for a half note
(minim) you would write two quarter notes (crotchets) and then use the third
keypad layout to add the tremolo:
Before

After

Two-note tremolos
These are beams between two
notes or chords which indicate that
they should be repeatedly played
alternately. Multiple strokes mean
exactly the same as for one-note
tremolos.

You can switch off the tremolos by choosing the same buttons from the keypad again.
Two-note tremolos can be written between staves (by crossing one or other note onto the other staff - LQ Beams)
and across barlines.
452

Tremolos

To adjust the angle of a two-note tremolo, drag the stems of the notes at either side. If the two-note tremolo is
between two whole-notes (semibreves), drag the tremolo line itself (this has the same effect as dragging the stem of
the first note - were it to have one!).
The Notes 2 page of the House Style b Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut 4xE or Ctrl+Shift+E) contains
three options governing the appearance of two-note tremolos, should you be struck by a desire to change them:
e
Between stems

Touching stems

Outer tremolo
touching stems

The tribulations of tremolo notations


With two-note tremolos, the odd convention of writing each note with the total length of the tremolo produces various
anomalies.
In the 19th century, a barmy convention was in operation whereby the note values were only doubled if the tremolo
lasted for a quarter note (crotchet) or more. Thus you could find pairs of eighths (quavers) tremoloing, and also half
notes (minims), but never quarter notes (crotchets). This was bananas.
However, another idiosyncrasy which survives to the present day is as follows: if you want to notate a two-note
tremolo lasting for two 4/4 bars, you write two whole-notes (semibreves) with a tremolo across the barline, rather
than doubling the note values to two double whole notes (breves). Most people go a lifetime without noticing this
weird exception - what sheltered lives they lead.

453

Reference

Triplets and other tuplets


L!2 Filters and Find, Hiding objects.
Tuplets with a single number
The simplest case is the triplet, 3 over
I

J J means 3 quarter notes (crotchets)

compressed into the time of 2 quarter


notes. The quarter note is the unit of
the tuplet in this case.
Where numbers other than 3 are used,
the tendency is to squash into the next
lowest power of 2 units - so 5 means 5
in the time of 4, 15 means 15 in the time
of 8, and so on. The exceptions to this
rule are 2 and 4, which normally mean
2 in the time of 3 and 4 in the time of 6.
When triplets are being used a lof, 3 is
offen written over the first few and left
off after that. If your whole score is
written like this, you should probably use
a different time signature!

Tuplets are rhythms like triplets, which are played at some fraction of their
normal speed. (Tuplet is not a nice word, though alternatives like irrational
rhythm arent too terrific either. Opinion is divided as to whether tuplet
rhymes with duplet or with couplet.)
Creating tuplets quickly
Input or select the first note (only) of the tuplet, which must be of the unit
length of the tuplet (see box).
l

For instance, if you want a triplet with a total length of a half note (minim), the
first note you input must be a quarter note (crotchet).
Type x3 or Ctrl+3 for a triplet - which, lets face it, is what youre
probably after - or x2-9 or Ctrl+2-9 for anything from a duplet to a
nontuplet (which means a 9-tuplet, rather than something which isnt a tuplet)
l

The tuplet will appear, with the correct number of rests. Add the other
notes in the normal way.
l

The tuplet has the format and bracket options last set on the Create h
Tuplet dialog (see Creating tuplets slowly below).

Creating tuplets slowly


Input or select the first note (only) of the tuplet, which must be of the
unit length of the tuplet
l

E Far,,,& __.. .__-__- . . .I __~..II-I..-.._--

Choose Create h Tuplet


Type in any number or ratio, as complex as you like (e.g. 13, or
99:64)
Click Number to write just a single number (or the first number of the
ratio), Ratio to write a ratio (e.g. 5:3), Ratio+note to write e.g.
5:3& and None to write no number at all

ftlstaad xsf using this &91ag ywu cm just salt&


d nrrtts and type Ctrl + a nurrtbw.

By default, Sibelius creates tuplets with Auto Bracket switched on;


this means that the triplet bracket disappears if there is a beam joining exactly the same notes as the bracket
would join, and if the tuplet is at the beam end of the notes. If you want explicitly to specify that your tuplet
should or should not be bracketed, choose one of the other options.
Switch on Full duration if you want the bracket to extend up to the next note/rest (see box)

Triplets and other tuplets


l

Click OK; the tuplet will appear and you can input the remaining notes.

Tuplet brackets
A bracket is often written over the notes
within the tuplet. The number used to be
written above or below the bracket but
to conserve space it goes in a gap in the
center of the bracket nowadays.
In older scores you will often find a slur
used instead of a bracket, even when the
notes are not meant to be played
smoothly, nowadays a slur is only used
when slurring is specifically intended
A few composers write just a bracket on
its own to mean a triplet.
In modern scores tuplet brackets are
often extended rightwards, nearly up to
the start of the note/rest following the
tuplet. This looks cleaner when notating,
say, simultaneous triplet quarter notes
(crotchets) and sextuplet eighth notes
(quavers), because it means the brackets
will all end in the same place.

Setting the unit length


Sometimes the first note of the tuplet is not the same as the unit length: a
triplet which is three quarter notes (crotchets) long may start with an eighth
note (quaver), for instance. If this is the case, you should input a first note
with the unit length you want (here, a quarter note) so Sibelius knows how
long the rhythm lasts, then input the tuplet, then change the note value of the
first note afterwards.
Tuplet units cant be dotted, so if you put a tuplet onto a dotted note the dot
is ignored.
Special tuplets
There are cases where you would write a tuplet with a single digit that
denotes something other than what it would ordinarily mean; for exampile, in
6/8, you might see this:

This is actually a 7:6 ratio tuplet. To obtain this, use the Create h Tuplet
dialog, type 7:6 (to tell Sibelius what the tuplet really is), and set Format to
Number (which tells Sibelius only to write the 7 in the score).

Elliott Carter and a few other composers write 7 meaning 7:8 and 15:16, since this way the note values are much
closer to how they sound than in the standard notation, so to write this you would choose a ratio of (say) 7:8 and set
Format to Number.
Moving tuplets
Tuplets are magnetic - that is, automatically positioned - like slurs (ILLI Lines). Sibelius decides whether the tuplet
should go above or below the notes, and at what angle. The tuplet number and bracket move automatically to avoid
collisions with notes at either end of the tuplet, and articulations on notes in the tuplet. Try dragging the first note in a
tuplet up and down and see what happens! This means that if you transpose your music, the tuplet number and
bracket move automatically to ensure they do not collide with the notes.
If you disagree with where Sibelius puts the tuplet by default, you can flip it to the other side of the notes by selecting
the number (or bracket) and choosing Edit h Flip (shortcut X).
You can also move the whole tuplet up and down by dragging the number (or the middle of the bracket if there is no
number) or using the arrow keys. Note that you shouldnt try to drag a tuplet to the other side of the notes - use
Edit h Flip (shortcut X) instead.
You can adjust the angle of the bracket and number by dragging either tip of the bracket.

455

?cI
tp

Reference

To restore the default position of a tuplet if you move it, select it and choose Layout b Reset Position (shortcut
4&P or Ctrl+Shift+P).
Copying tuplets
You can select a tuplets bracket or number and copy it onto another note to
turn that note into a tuplet.
You can also of course copy passages containing tuplets. The only thing you
cant copy is part of a tuplet, such as the first note of a tuplet, as that would
produce a chunk of fractional rhythm which wouldnt make much sense. If
you get an unexpected warning that youre copying part of a tuplet, make sure
youve selected the tuplet number or bracket as well as the notes within it.

Ratio tuplets
In modern notation you can write
things like 5.4 meaning 5 in the time
of 4: You can use this to make simple
tuplets more explicit - e.g. writing 3:2
for a triplet - or to speciQ m o r e
unusual rhythms like 5.3. The second
number must be more than half and
less than twice the first number.

Deleting tuplets
To delete a tuplet, select the number or bracket and hit Delete. This deletes not only the number and bracket, but
also the notes. This is because without the tuplet, the notes would no longer add up.
\Tuplet spacing
Sibelius automatically aligns tuplets correctly with other simultaneous notes. To make tuplets easy to read, it is
advisable to make their spacing as even as possible when involved in complex cross-rhythms. For advice on this,
IL!2 Note spacing.
Nested tuplets
'

Nested tuplets (meaning tuplets within tuplets) are much beloved of


contemporary composers such as Bryan Ferneyhough, and can be a little
tricky to sight-read. Sibelius automatically notates nested tuplets of just
about any depth or complexity, and they even play back correctly.

Input nested tuplets just like normal tuplets, but input the outermost (i.e. widest) tuplet first, and work your way in.
Hidden tuplets
You can write hidden tuplets either by hiding the bracket and number (LX2 Hiding objects), or by switching off
the bracket and the number from the Create b Tuplet dialog when you create them. This makes the notes end up
spaced in a different proportion from other staves in the score without anything else to indicate that a tuplet was
present. This is useful for quick flourishes of notes and other examples of free rhythm where it would be tedious to
notate an exact rhythm in the score. You can also use it to write mixed time signatures such as 4/4 against 6/8.
I
EL! Free rhythm, Time signatures.
Changing the appearance of tuplets already in your score
If, after creating a number of tuplets, you decide that you would like to change the way they are printed, you can do so
using filters and the Properties window.
For example, to hide the brackets and numbers of tuplets already in your score:
l

Choose Edit b Filter b Tuplets


All the tuplet brackets and numbers in your score will now be selected. Now:

456
_______

_.___________~_ ________-- --.----- ___-_-.--p-

Triplets and other tuplets


l

To hide all the tuplet brackets and numbers, simply click Hide in Score on the General panel of the
Properties window.
To change the appearance of the tuplet, use the options on the Notes panel of the Properties window.

Filters are an extremely powerful way of changing lots of objects in your score in a single operation - ELII Filters
and Find.
Tuplets over barlines
Although Sibelius cannot automatically notate tuplets over barlines, the effect can be achieved easily enough, as
follows:

1I

L
.
I

ll

urn

I
I

L
II
!

II

II

II

II
I

Create an irregular bar of twice the length of the prevailing time signature: choose Create ) Bar ) Other
(shortcut XB or Ak+B)
Write the music for the two bars which contain the tuplet which crosses the barline
Add a suitable barline - in the example above you would choose Create ) Barline ) Normal and click in
the appropriate place.
Note that if you are using bar numbers you should also create a bar number change in the next bar to
compensate for the missing real bar; choose Create ) Bar Number Change.
Tuplet design and Engraving Rules options
You can change the design of tuplet numbers and brackets from the House Style k Edit Text Styles (shortcut
~xXT or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+T) and House Style ) Edit Lines dialogs. If youre changing the font of tuplet
numbers, its normal to use a medium italic serif font. EL!! Edit Text Styles, Lines.
There is a number of options concerning the appearance and positioning of tuplets on the Tuplets page of the
House Style ) Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut G%%E or Ctrl+Shift+E):
Rotate single digits controls whether the single-digit tuplet numbers (e.g. triplets) should be drawn at the
same angle as the bracket; single digits can look better drawn upright, so this option is switched off by default.
Tuplet text consisting of multiple digits (e.g. 12 or 3:2) has to be drawn at the same angle as the bracket to
align with it, and are unaffected by this option.
The Position on Notes options allow you to choose the default position of tuplets with and without brackets
Vertical Distance from Notes controls the default distance tuplets are drawn from notes.

457

Reference

Undo and Redo


Undo
CIIC k the toolbar button shown on the right or choose Edit b Undo (shortcut B%Z or Ctrl+Z) to undo
the last thing you did. The Edit menu tells you what the last thing you did was, in case you have a very
short memory. (Well, it tells you the last thing you did in Sibelius - it wont say Undo Sneeze,
entertaining though that might be.)
Undo is multi-level - you can carry on undoing steps a lmost indefinitely far back. Edit b Undo History (see below)
jumps back to a particular earlier point.
Redo
Redo undoes undos (or rather, Redo redoes undos). To redo an operation you didnt mean to undo, click
the toolbar button shown on the left or choose Edit b Redo (shortcut B%Y or Ctrl+Y). Again, the Edit
menu tells you what it was you just undid.
Undo History
Edit b Undo History (shortcut U#Z or Ctrl+Shift+Z) lists all the recent operations youve done, and lets you
hop back to a particular earlier point in time.
The most recent operation is at the top of the list, so click the top item to undo one step, the second item to undo two
steps and the bottom item to undo as far back as you can go. The antiquity of the undo history is customizable - see
Undo level below.
Redo History
Edit b Redo History (shortcut 4&Y or Ctrl+Shift+Y) is like Undo History, but lists all the things you can
redo after youve done a load of undoing.
The most recent operation you undid is at the top of the list, so (as with Undo History) click the top item to redo
one step, the second item to redo two steps and the bottom item to redo everything you undid and get back to where
you were. (If you see what I mean.)
Undo level
To set how far back you can undo, go into File b Preferences b General and drag the slider. The default level is
approximately 10000 changes to notes.
.--_
If you set the undo level large enough you can undo right back to when you started writing the current score.
If you set it larger still, you can even undo back to before you bought Sibelius.

458

view menu

LLl window menu.


The View menu has various options controlling how scores and the Sibelius interface look on the screen.
If you want to, you can print your score with the options from the View menu included (with, for example, hidden
objects in gray, highlights in yellow or notes colored) - Ii&i Printing.
Attachment
This draws a dotted gray line to show which staff and rhythmic position the selected object is attached to. For clarity,
no attachment line appears for certain objects such as notes, rests and system objects. LL! Attachment.
Breaks and Locks
This shows system and page breaks as blue icons in the score, and also draws padlocks to show where the format has
been locked. LA2 Breaks.
Hidden Objects
With this option switched on, hidden objects are displayed on your score in light gray and are editable; with it
switched off, they are invisible and uneditable. Its quicker to use keyboard shortcuts than menus, so memorize
x%?H or Ctrl+Ak+H. Ul Hiding objects.
Highlights
If you have created any highlights in your score, use this option to toggle whether they are displayed on the screen.
LLI Highlight.
Note Colors
The View b Note Colors menu contains four options which affect the on-screen display of your score:
Pitch Spectrum (shortcut x8gP or Ctrl+Ak+P): colors each note according to its sounding pitch relative
to the cycle of 5ths; see the inside back cover of this User Guide for the color scheme. When this option is
switched on, selected notes are colored gray to avoid confusing them with the colored noteheads. Quarter-tones
are colored the same as adjacent half-steps (semitones).
Voices: colors all notes in a dark shade of their voice color, so voice 1 notes are blue, voice 2 notes are green,
and so on (EL4 Voices); selected notes are shown in their normal color
Notes out of Range (shortcut 7189N or Ctrl+Ak+N): the default setting; automatically reddens notes
which are too high or low for an instrument to play. Notes which are uncomfortable but playable by
professionals are shown in dark red. This means you can see tricky or impossible notes at a glance and correct
them before rehearsals (IL!2 Instruments)
None: shows notes in black; selected notes are colored according to their voice (i.e. voice 1 is blue, voice 2 is
green, etc.).
I ne Pitch Spectrum option is surprisingly useful for professionals as well as beginners. The color scheme is
determined according to the circle of fifths, so:

459

Reference
l

Similar key areas have similar colors; for example, a piece which is in C major with a G major middle section
uses a consistent color scheme
Close pitches are not confusable when viewing a score zoomed out; for example, C and G are similar colors but
far apart on the staff, while C and C# are close on the staff but very different colors.

The intention is that you should be able to zoom out and get an overview of your score. For example, instruments
playing the same sounding pitch will be marked with the same color, so its possible to see doublings very easily especially for instruments with different clefs or transpositions. Conversely, a chromatic scale looks literally chromatic
(multi-colored, from Greek chroma for color) because each note is not harmonically related to those on either side,
and so has a starkly different color.
For an example of how well this works, open the Organ solo example score from the Other folder within your
Scores folder - the modulations (e.g. at bars 24, 26, 27 and so on) become immediately visible.
We recommend that you try using Sibelius with Pitch Spectrum switched on for a few hours and learn the colors,
which are shown on the bookmark at the back of this User Guide. As soon as youre used to them, youll find this a
very useful way of working.
Interestingly, some composers, such as Messiaen and Skryabin, associate sounds with particular colors; this mingling
of the senses is known as synesthesia. The Pitch Spectrum option might just bring you one step closer to an
understanding of this phenomenon!
For further information about synesthesia, point your web browser at:
http://web.mit.edu/synesthesia/wsynesthesia.html
Page Margins
This option draws a blue rectangle to show where the margins set in Layout ) Document Setup are.
L!LN Document Setup.
Textures
The View ) Textures dialog allows you to choose different textures and colors
for the paper, the background, and the dialogs in Sibelius.
All textures suitable for use as paper start Paper (e.g. Paper, white cotton).
On Windows, all textures suitable for dialogs start Dialogs (e.g. Dialogs,
brushed steel) All other textures are suitable for the desk which the pages of
music lie on, and their names start with Wood, Marble, Leather, and so on.
The little preview windows should prevent you from inadvertantly choosing particularly horrible combinations, but you
can, of course, try using unsuitable textures, e.g. try using wood as your paper texture, but it will make the music hard
to read.
Some of our favorite paper textures are:
l

460

Paper, brown
Paper, white crumpled
Paper, white coarse laid

View menu
l

Paper, white fine laid (note the vertical roller lines in the paper)

Our favorite desk textures:


l

Marble, Bordeaux
Slate, red/blue
Washi - these are Japanese hand-made papers, though only suitable for use as a desk texture as they are too
colorful to write music on!
Wood, Redwood burl
Wood, Tamo ash
Wood, lacewood

You can create your own custom textures or colors by dropping files into the Textures folder - on Mac, use PICT
files; on Windows, use BMP files.
Using textures can slow Sibelius down significantly. If you find dragging the paper is sluggish, first try switching on
Alternative texture drawing in the View ) Textures dialog, This option makes no difference to the speed of
Sibelius if youre not using textures. On some computers, and/or at some colour depths, it may be slower instead of
faster. If Sibelius still seems slow, set both Paper and Desk to Use color not texture, which will speed things
UP.
Staff Rulers/Object Rulers/Selection Rulers
These options switch on and off Sibeliuss three kinds of rulers:
Selection Rulers: displays a ruler between the selected object(s) and the staff to which it is attached.
Object Rulers (shortcut UXR OI- Shift+Alt+R): displays a ruler for all objects that support them (i.e.
objects that are attached to staves, e.g. text, symbols, lines, etc.).

?El

Staff Rulers (shortcut Gx%%R or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+R): displays rulers between staves and page edges, and
between adjacent staves.
Note that object and staff rulers can slow screen redrawing down significantly, so switch these off if Sibelius seems to
be running slow.
Staff rulers - show the distance
between aQacent staves, and the
distance between staves and the
page edges

.
I

OfJ;3vTotrnn~

fib

I
Selection rulers - show the distance
between selected objects and the
staff to which they are attached

461

Reference

Set the units of measurement used for Staff rulers and Selection & object rulers from the File )
Preferences ) General dialog. You can choose between inches, points (1 point = l/72 inch), millimeters and
spaces.
Full screen (Windows only)
Choosing this (shortcut Ctrl+U) makes menus and the taskbar (the bar at the bottom showing which programs
youre running) disappear to save space.
You can still get at the menus by moving your mouse to the very top of the screen, and the menus reappear.
Scroll Bars
This adds vertical and horizontal scroll bars to the main score editing window. Its preferable not to use these, as
scrolling around your score using the navigator is far quicker and easier. However, with scroll bars switched on, you
can use the wheel button found on many Windows mice (such as the Microsoft Intellimouse) to scroll up and down
the page.
Toolbar
1 Perhaps surprisingly, this makes the toolbar disappear or reappear.
Zoom
The options in the View ) Zoom menu duplicate the behavior of the Zoom tool on the toolbar. Memorize the
shortcuts %g+ or Ctrl++ (zoom in) and #- or Ctrl+- (zoom out). You can either use the + and - keys on your
keypad or on the main keyboard.
Note that a zoom factor of lOOo/o does not display the music at the size it will actually print; it shows it at a convenient
average size for editing. The Actual size option (in the list on the toolbar) does show the music supposedly at the
size it will print, though this depends on the exact size of your monitor.
The options such as Fit page width do what they say. However, its best to stick to the numerical zoom factors as
these have been chosen to display notes as clearly as possible. You can type in your own zoom factor onto the
toolbar, in which case Sibelius will round it up or down to the nearest factor which displays well.
The File ) Preferences ) General dialog includes an option to set the default zoom factor used when opening
scores; LLII Preferences.

462

Voices

Voices
what voices are
Music usually has a single voice (or layer) of notes, chords and rests on each staff. The stems point up or down
according to the pitch of the note:
lust one voice

When music is in two voices, however, the staff has two independent streams of music which can have different
rhythms. The two voices are distinguished by drawing the stems upwards in voice I and downwards in voice 2:
Voice 7
w

Voice 2

Notice that there are also two different sets of rests, the higher ones belonging to voice 1 and the lower ones to voice
2. Usually, for simplicity, people only write one rest where two identical ones occur in both voices.
In guitar and organ music and occasionally elsewhere, you can also have a third voice (with stems up again) and a
fourth (with stems down again).
Getting voices
Sibelius allows four independent voices per staff, which are color-coded: voice 1 is blue, voice 2 is green, voice 3 is
yellow and voice 4 is purple.
You can change the voice of the selected object, or, if you are creating new objects, choose the voice of a new object,
from the General panel of the Properties window, which contains a drop-down menu called Voice. You can also
change the voice of an object via the Edit b Voice submenu The shortcuts for changing voice are x1/2/3/4 or
Ak+ l/2/3/4, with ~5 or Ah+5 for putting objects such as dynamics into all voices.
Buttons chosen on the keypad are highlighted in the current voice color, so youre in no doubt what voice youre
using. When you create an object with the mouse, the pointer has the current voice color too.
Notes, chords, rests, accidentals, articulations, grace notes, tuplets, and some lines (e.g. trills, hairpins) and text (e.g.
dynamics) are in specific voices, and so you should choose the correct voice before you create these objects, primarily
to ensure that they play back correctly. These objects can also be in multiple voices, e.g. a dynamic above the staff
might apply to all voices (rather than just voice 1), or possibly just to voices 1 and 3. When selected, these objects are
in the color of their voice.
Other objects such as clefs, key signatures, system text (e.g. title, tempo markings) and system lines (e.g. rit./accel.
lines, lst- and Znd-endings) are not voice-specific and so are always blue when selected. It doesnt matter which voice
is chosen when you create these objects.
463

Reference

Viewing voice colors


It is often useful to see to which voice a note belongs at all times, not just when it is selected. To see this, switch on
View b Note Colors b Voice Colors.
Starting off an extra voice of notes
To start off an extra voice with the keyboard, or using step-time input:
l

Select a note, rest or other object (such as text or a line) at the point where you want the new voice to start

Type V followed by 712 or AIt+2 for voice 2; the caret goes green
Choose the notes properties as normal: select a note value, and add any articulations, accidentals etc. that are
required

Type the notes letter name, or play the pitch on your MIDI keyboard

The note is created, and the rest of the bar is filled with the appropriate rests

Now you can continue adding notes in voice 2 as normal.

Io

start off an extra voice with the mouse:


I

With nothing in your score selected, choose the note value and any other note properties from the keypad, then
choose the desired Voice from the drop-down menu on the General panel of the Properties window (or
type x2/3/4 or Ak+2/3/4)
Click in the score where you want the new voice to begin; Sibelius inputs the note, and fills up the rest of the bar
with rests in the new voice.
Now you can continue to input notes with in the new voice as normal.

To start off Flexi-time recording in an extra voice, choose the desired voice in the Notes b Flexi-time Options
dialog (shortcut 6x0 or Ctrl+Shift+O). If the voice already exists in the score, you can just select a rest in that
voice and then start Flexi-time as normal - L!LIl Flexi-time
Bars partially in two voices
If you dont want two voices right to the end of a bar, Delete any unwanted rests at the end, to hide them.
If you want voice 2 to start part-way through a bar that already contains notes in another voice, simply input the voice
2 note at the point where you want it to start; Sibelius will pad out the bar on either side of the note with the
appropriate rests.
In either case, the notes in voice 1 will revert to having stems both up and down where you deleted the rests.
Deleting voice 2
You can remove parts of bars of voice 2 by deleting rests, as described above. However, if you want to delete a whole
bar of voice 2, you should just put a bar rest into voice 2 from the second keypad layout, then Delete it.
You can also use filters to remove a passage in a particular voice - LLJ Filters and Find.
/

464

Voices

Merging voices
If you want to merge all the notes in a passage in multiple voices into a single voice, simply select the passage and
choose the desired voice from the Voice list on the General panel of the Properties window (shortcut
~-l/2/3/4 orAlt+1/2/3/4):
Before

After

Splitting voices
Sometimes it is useful to split a passage written in a single voice into two or more voices, for example if you have
played in polyphonic mus Iic using Flexi-time, or imported a MIDI file.
Figure 1

Figure 2

Figure 3

To split the music in F(gure 1 above into two voices (to prod1Ice Figure 3, do the following:
Select the music you want to split as a passage
Choose Edit b Filter b Bottom Note or Single Notes (shortcut xg%B or Ctrl+Alt+B), then choose
Edit b Voice b 2 (shortcut ~2 or Alt+2) or use the Voice list on the General panel of the Properties
window; your music will now look like Figure 2
Finally, change the note values to consolidate redundant tied notes; you should end up with Figure 3.
Voices 3 and 4
Add voices 3 and 4 just like voice 2. If you want three voices, you can use voices 1+2+3 or 1+2+4 depending on the
stern directions you want the voices to have. The stems of voices I and 3 point upwards, and those of voices 2 and 4
point downwards.
There are no particular rules for how to position three or more voices, so you may need to move notes horizontally to
avoid collisions. See Crossing voices below.
Swapping voices
If you start creating music into the wrong voice, then instead of scrapping it and starting again you can just select the
music as a passage and swap the voices round.
The various options are in Edit b Voice. Youre only likely to want to swap voices 1 and 2, for which you can type
the shortcut Shift-V.
465

Reference

Copying voices
To copy a single voice from a staff containing notes in more than one voice, select the passage you want to copy and
use, say, Edit ) Filter ) Voice 2 (shortcut 6x%82 or Ctrl+Shift+Alt+2) to filter only the notes in voice 2. Now
you can x-click or Alt+click them into another staff as normal.
Sibelius copies notes and rests &to fhe SOme voice CIS fhe voice they come from. However, if you want to copy from
one voice to another...
Copying from one voice to another
Do this by swapping voices. For instance, suppose you want to copy some voice 1 notes into voice 2 elsewhere:
l

Swap voices 1 and 2 in the original youre copying, so that the notes youre copying end up in voice 2. Do this
by selecting the music as a passage and choosing Edit ) Voice ) Swap 1 and 2 (shortcut Shift-V)
Select the voice 2 notes to be copied by selecting a passage and filtering to get voice 2, as described in
Copying voices above

Copy the notes, which will end up in voice 2 as thats the voice they came from

Swap voices I and 2 back again in the original passage.

Rests
When rests appear in multiple voices, Sibelius automatically draws them above or below their normal positions so its
clear which voice they belong to. You can drag the rests up or down further or move them with the arrow keys if they
start getting in the way of other voices.
A subtlety: when you delete rests (e.g. in voice 2) they are hidden but not completely removed, and so can cause the
note spacing to be wider than normal if the hidden rests are shorter than other simultaneous note values. This is
unlikely to cause any problems, but if you are concerned about it, switch on View ) Hidden Objects and
Delete the hidden rests (shown in gray).
Hiding voices
In some situations you might wish to hide notes in one or more voices, e.g. if you want your score only to show a
written tune but want it, say, to play back with hidden harmonies. To do this, add the harmonies in a different voice
than the melody, then use filters (LQ Filters and Find) to select all the notes in the extra voice(s), and choose
Edit ) Hide or Show ) Hide (shortcut 4Y%%H or Ctrl+Shift+H) to hide them.
Crossing voices
Although voice l's notes are usually higher than voice 2s, this is not obligatory; the voices can cross - and if they
contain chords they can even interlock. Sibelius automatically tries to position the two voices so that no collisions
occur. However, with three or more voices, collisions are likely as there are no hard-and-fast rules regarding where to
put the third or fourth voice.
Should you want to adjust the horizontal position of notes, rests and chords in these cases:
l

466

Select the note, chord or rest you want to move


Open the General tab of the Properties window

Voices
l

Type the distance (in spaces) you want to move the note into the X box - positive numbers for rightwards,
negative for leftwards
If you need to move only the rhythm dots attached to a note, you can select them and drag them left or right
with the mouse.

Engraving Rules options


The rules for positioning notes in multiple voices are very complex and best not contemplated by humans. Sibelius,
however, includes three alternative rules for voice positioning, available on the Notes 2 page of the House
Style b Engraving Rules dialog (shortcut U#E or Ctrl+Shift+E). The default Version 2 rule is
recommended, but should you feel the urge to use one of the older rules, you can choose them from this dialog.

467

Reference

window menu
l2.J View menu.
New window
New Window creates a new view of the current score. This allows you to look at different parts of the same score
at once, or look at the same part of the score at different zoom factors, For instance, you could have one view at 25%
to keep an eye on the overall layout of the page, and another view at 200% for close-up work. This is particularly
useful if your computer has multiple monitors.
windows on/y: The Window menu also has all the standard Windows options for tiling scores, e.g. if you have more
than one score open, Tile Horizontally allows you to see them both at once, split horizontally.
Keypad
It should come as no revelation that this makes the keypad disappear and reappear.
Youd have to be quite adept at Sibelius to know what all the keys on all the keypad layouts are without looking, but
when youve used Sibelius for a bit you can try switching the keypad off to see how much you can remember. Its a
good idea to learn at least the first keypad layout this way.
Mix\k r
It will probably come as no surprise t hat this option makes the Mixer appear and disappear - its much easier to
simply type M to toggle the Mixer on or off; 1LJJ Mixer.
Navigator
Astonishingly, this makes the navigator disappear or reappear.
If you know the shortcuts for moving the navigator ($ or Page Up, $ or Page Down, etc.,) you should be able to
survive quite happily without the navigator.
You can move the navigator around - just drag its edge.
Properties
Well leave it to you to guess what this option does. Usefully, you can also type 8%l or Ctrl+l to show or hide the
Properties window. You can move Properties around the screen by dragging the top of it.
Keypad Separated from Properties
This option allows you to split the Properties window from the keypad and drag them around independently.
Translucent windows (Windows 2OOO/XP only)
This option makes the navigator, Properties window, keypad and Mixer translucent, so that you can see the pages
of music through them.
This option is on by default in the supported operating systems, but if you dont like the effect, switch it off by
choosing View b Translucent Windows.
468

Glossary
This explains musical and computer terms used in this User Guide which are uncommon, technical or have a special
meaning in Sibelius. Also included are a few relevant temls not used in this User Guide but which you may come
across elsewhere. Cross-references are in bold.

acciaccatura a short grace note normally played before the beat, drawn with a line through its stem.
accidental a symbol (e.g. flat, sharp) indicating that a pitch is to be adjusted up or down by a small interval usually by a half-step (semitone), but occasionally by a whole-step (tone) or a microtone.
aftertouch in MIDI, the degree of pressure exerted on a key after you press it, normally used to control modulation
(vibrato).
alphabetic input creating music with the computer keyboard, mainly using the letters A-G and the keypad.
iL1 step-time input, mouse input, Flexi-time.
appoggiatura a long grace note normally played on the beat; unlike an acciaccatura, it is drawn without a line
through its stern.
articulation a symbol appearing above or below a note or chord which indicates how it should be played - e.g.
staccato, tenuto, up-bow, accent, fermata (pause).
attachment notes, text, lines, symbols, etc. are said to be attached to particular staves and rhythmic positions in
the music. This means that they belong to that staff/position and move with it when the music is reformatted. When
you select most objects, a dotted gray line shows what the object is attached to.
bank a set of up to 128 program numbers. MIDI devices which have more than 128 sounds group them into
banks.
beams the thick lines connecting groups of eighth notes (quavers) and shorter note values. A fractional beam is
another word for a flag.
BMP (bitmap) file a standard Windows bitrnap graphics format.
brace the ( to the left of keyboard instruments (also used in place of a sub-bracket in older orchestral scores,
particularly to group horns.)
bracket (a) the thick vertical [ which groups together the staves of instruments in the same family. The thin
vertical [ which groups divided instruments is a sub-bracket.
(b) The horizontal [ which sometimes groups notes in tuplets.

break /C-J page break, system break.


-

469

Glossary

caret the vertical line which shows where you are when youre creating notes or typing text; sometimes called a
cursor or insertion point.
channel the MIDI equivalent of a staff, usually specified by a number from 1 to 16. Most MIDI devices only allow 16
channels. Each channel can only be set to one specific program number, pan position, etc. at a time.
chord in this User Guide, chord means specifically two or more noteheads on a single stem (or, in the case of
double whole notes (breves) and whole-notes (semibreves), in the same voice). Noteheads in different voices or
staves count as being in different chords.
chord symbol text above a staff specifying a chord for the performer to play or improvise around, e.g. B&I-I
(meaning B flat minor)
control change a MIDI message which controls effects such as reverb, pan position and sustain.
controller a MIDI input device, such as a keyboard, sustain pedal, modulation or pitch bend wheel, etc.
convert to change the format of a file.
crop marks (crops) thin cross-hairs used in professio nal printing to pinpoint the corners of a page appearing
on a larger sheet of paper. The paper is then trimmed along t he lines indicated by the crop marks. Film and bromide
almost always have crop marks on.
cue note a small (cue-size) note, so named because it is most often used for writing cues in instrumental parts.
U like grace notes, cue notes have a real duration - that is, they take up rhythmic space in the bar. Any note, rest
orn;N
b rest can be made cue-size - whether its a normal note, special notehead or grace note. You can even write
cue notes on a small staff, which makes them go smaller still.
default whatever an option is provisionally set to until you change it. Sibelius is designed to have intelligent defaults,
so you dont often need to change things it does automatically.
dialog a window with buttons on.
diatonic a diatonic scale is a major or minor scale. To transpose diatonically means to shift notes up or down the
scale, so in the scale of C major, transposing a G major triad up a diatonic 2nd produces A minor, or up a diatonic 3rd
produces a B diminished triad.
dpi (dots per inch) the unit of printing and scanning resolution. The more dpi you print or scan at, the
higher the resolution is, and the more detailed the resulting printout or scan.
When printing, 12OOdpi or higher produces publishing quality print in which the dots are invisible. 600dpi (the
standard resolution of most laser printers) is almost as good and is often good enough for publishing music. 3OOdpi
printouts are fine for everyday use, though the dots are visible and diagonal beams look blocky.
For scanning music, 2OOdpi to 4OOdpi is a normal range of resolutions. Higher resolutions such as 600dpi are used for
scanning photos and graphics at high quality.
dynamics text (e.g. mf) or hairpins specifying loudness or changes of loudness.
EMF (Enhanced MetaFile) a standard Windows vector graphics format.
470

G/ossary

engraving rules rules used for music engraving. Sibelius incorporates all of the standard engraving rules,
which you can choose between using the many options provided in the House Style b Engraving Rules dialog
and elsewhere.
EPS (Encapsulated PostScript) a standard vector graphics file format very similar to the PostScript file
format. But unlike a PostScript file, an EPS file is used to place a single page of text or graphics as an illustration into a
page layout program such as Quark XPress or PageMaker. EPS files are mainly used in professional publishing.
explode to split the notes of a chord or passage of chords from one or two staves onto a larger number of staves.
Opposite of reduce.
export to save in a file format used by a different program. Opposite of import.
extract to create a part automatically from a full score.
fader a sliding knob used in audio equipment such as mixers, which controls (e.g.) the volume of a particular audio
channel. Sibeliuss Mixer window has faders for controlling the volume and pan position of individual staves.
family instruments of a similar kind which appear together in a score, such as woodwind, brass, percussion and
strings. Also called an instrumental section.
film a transparent plastic sheet bearing an image in black from which printing plates are made, produced by an
imagesetter.
filter a feature in Sibelius which selects objects of a particular kind (e.g. hairpins, text) or which have pa ,-ticular
characteristics (e.g. three-note chords).
flag the short bit of beam which appears in dotted rhythms; also called a fractional beam.
Flexi-time Sibeliuss intelligent real-time MIDI input feature. L!2 step-time input, alphabetic input,
mouse input.
formatting spreading out music to fill systems and pages. Sibelius instantly reformats the whole score whenever
you make any change, so you always see it as it will be when finally printed.
FreeMlDl a system extension for the Mac that simplifies communications between MIDI devices and your
computer. IS U1 OMS.
full score a score which contains every instrument playing a piece of music, as opposed to a part. (Sometimes
also used loosely to mean an orchestral or band score.)
General MIDI (GM) the name of the most widely-used sound set
grace note a small note which (unlike a cue note) does not subtract from the duration of a bar - in
performance it is crushed into the previous or following note. Grace notes with a diagonal ine through the stem are
called acciaccaturas; ones without lines are appoggiaturas.
grayscale (scanning) shades of gray, as opposed to just black and white.

IPUP a list of instruments into which Sibelius will copy similar lines of notes as part of its Arrange feature.
H-bar the thick horizontal line normal ly used for multirests.

Glossary

hairpin a crescendo or diminuendo written as a hairpin-shaped double-line.


house style the overall look of a score, as defined by a publisher; in Sibelius, the house style is mostly
determined by the items in the House Style menu, including engraving rules, text styles, line and notehead
types, etc.
imagesetter a high-resolution (typically 2540dpi or higher) printer used to produce film for making printing
plates. Imagesetters use PostScript, usually go by the brand name Linotronic, and can output very large pages.
import to open or incorporate a file which is in a format used by a different program. Opposite of export.
initial barline the barline at the very left-hand end of each system that joins all the staves together; Sibelius
automatically adds these. The initial barline is normally omitted in single-staff systems.
instrument as far as Sibelius is concerned, anything which has its own name at the left of a system, so the terrn
includes singers, electronic tape, etc. Instruments can have more than one staff (e.g. keyboards), and can also have
more than one player (e.g. wind instruments in orchestral/band music).
justified spread out horizontally or vertically to fill a page up to the margins. E.g. most of the text in this User Guide
is justified horizontally so that it reaches the right margin; bars of music are almost always justified horizontally in the
same way. Staves are often justified vertically so they spread down to the bottom rnargin of the page instead of leaving
a gap at the bottom.
keypad the bottom panel of the Properties window, from which you can pick notes, articulations, accidentals, etc.
u ing the mouse or numeric keys. By clicking the five little buttons at the top underneath the numbers (or typing + on
h;
the keypad, or F8-F12) you can choose between five different keypad layouts, called the first keypad layout,
second keypad layout, etc.
line spacing (technical term leading) the distance between successive lines of text. A standard line spacing in
books is 1200/o, meaning that the separation between lines of text is 1.2 times the point size; in music, lOOo/o is
often preferable.
line a hairpin, slur, 8va, glissando or any other object in the Create b Line dialog.
line of notes a succession of single notes and rests taken from the source passage as part of the Arrange features
processing, e.g. a series of three-note chords is turned into three separate lines of notes.
lyric line the horizontal line which follows any word whose final syllable is sung to more than one note.
magnetic describes the intelligent behavior of slurs, tuplets, accidentals, articulations, ties etc., which stick to notes
and reposition themselves if the notes change pitch.
manuscript paper whenever you create a score it is written on a particular type of manuscript paper which you
choose at the start. Manuscript paper specifies the size of the paper and staves, plus other options such as house style
settings, and may also be preset with particular instruments.
microtone a fraction of a half-step (semitone), used in some avant garde and ethnic music. The most common
microtone is the quarter-tone, which is half of a half-step (semitone). Microtones are indicdted by a wide range of
odd-looking accidentals, generally made from sharps, flatsand naturals cut up or with extra bits stuck on. In order to
produce microtones, some instruments need to be cut up or have extra bits stuck on.
472

Glossary

MIDI (rhymes with giddy) Musical Instrument Digital Interface - the worldwide standard for electronic musical
instruments and computer soundcards. .C 1 1~ MIDI file (below).
MIDI file a file in Standard MIDI File format, which is understood by virtually every music program. Unfortunately
MIDI files are not ideal for transferring music ~&~lior~ between programs, as MIDI files consist almost exclusively of
playback information.

MIDI messages commands sent to MIDI devices used to achieve particular playback effects such as program
number changes and pitch bend; Sibelius generates these automatically during playback and you can also add
explicit ones to your score using slightly arcane text objects.

mouse input creating music with the mouse. This is generally the slowest way of inputting. LA alphabetic
input, step-time input, Flexi-time.
multirest the marking for several bar rests, used in parts; longer multirests are usually drawn as a number above an
H-bar.
music engraving the art of drawing music notation, covering topics such as the design of music symbols, the
positioning and spacing of notes and other objects, the layout of pages, and the use of particular text fonts and sizes.
Much (but not all) of music engraving has been formulated into engraving rules.

navigator the miniature view of the score in the bottom left-hand corner. You can drag the white rectangle with the
mouse to move through the score.

note a single notehead with a stem (unless the note is a whole-note (semibreve) or double whole note
(breve)). Notes can also have accidentals, articulations, rhythm dots, beams, leger lines and tremolos. Individual
pitches on a chord are properly called noteheads, not notes.

note value the length of a single note, chord or rest, e.g. eighth note (quaver), half note (minim).
notehead a blob or other shape (e.g. cross or diamond) in a note or chord which specifies the pitch, note value
and sometimes the playing technique.

NoteOn / NoteOff the MIDI messages which start or end a note.


object anything you can put in a score -- a note, accidental, clef, piece of text, slur, etc. Li31 staff object, system
object.
OCR (scanning) optical character recognition; usually applied to scanning text, but also to music.
OMS (Open Music System) a systern extension for the Mac that simplifies communications between MIDI
devices and your computer. 1 1 !I FreeMIDI.
original (scanning) the page or score you are scanning from.
ossia a small bar or so of music above a normal--sized staff to show an alternative way of playing something.
output (scanning) music which has been read from scans,
page (d) one side of a sheet of music as it appears when finally published. T -he page size 1s not necessarily the same
as thepalper size, as you can print a small page on a large sheet of paper.
473

n
0

Glossary

(b) a complete set of options within a dialog (e.g. House Style b Engraving Rules) accessible either by clicking
a tab (Windows) or an item in a list or combo box (Mac).
page break the forced termination of a page at a particular barline, often made at the end of a section, or to
avoid inconvenient page-turns in parts. LB system break.
pan position (or pan) the left-to-right direction of a sound, specified for the purposes of stereo playback.
part the music of one or more instruments extracted from a full score, sometimes called an instrumental, orchestral
or band part. Performers read off parts so that they only have to see the music they play.
passage a continuous stretch of music along one staff or along several simultaneous staves, which may or may not
be adjacent vertically (e.g. Flute and Cello in an orchestral score). In its simplest form, you can think of it as a
rectangle of music. A passage can extend over several systems, or even an entire score. Usually passages are
enclosed by a blue box; there is also a special kind of passage called a system passage that contains all
instruments and is drawn with a double blue box.
PDF (Portable Document Format) a common file format that allows documents generated by programs
such as word processors and desktop publishers to be published electronically, preserving their original appearance,
for viewing and printing on any computer.
PICT file a standard Mac vector graphics format.
pitch bend in MIDI, the effect of bending a pitch up and down, achieved by operating a lever or wheel, or by
s 4 ding a pitch bend MIDI message.
players several performers sharing the same staves but distinguished usually by a number. For instance, horn
players usually share one or two staves and are often numbered 1,2,3 and 4.
point size the height of a font, measured from the top of the capital letters to the bottom of the lower-case
descender letters (such as p). This height is specified in points (1 point or pt = l/72 inch = about 0.353mm).
PostScript a vector graphics file format used by many laser printers (particularly when used with Mats or for
professional publishing) and imagesetters. See also EPS.
program number (or patch number, or voice number) a number specifying an instrument sound on a MIDI
device. Program numbers go from 0 to 127 or from 1 to 128. If more than 128 program numbers are available, these
are grouped into extra banks.
properties the characteristics of objects in your score - such as which voice(s) they belong to, the font and size,
and so on - accessible from the Properties window.
read (scanning) to work out what all the notes and other objects in the scan are.
real-time input inputting music on a MIDI keyboard in time to a click in order to specify rhythms as well as
pitches. Sibeliuss real-time input method is Flexi-time.
reduce (or implode) to put the notes of several instruments onto one or two staves, e.g. to create a keyboard
accompaniment or reduction. Opposite of explode. reformat iILL formatting.
474
--- ---

A_------

Glossary

rehearsal mark a big letter and/or number, normally in a box, used in long scores to aid rehearsing.
resolution the level of detail at which a page is printed or scanned, measured in dpi; or the number of pixels
displayed on a computer screen, e.g. 1024 x 768.
reverb (pronounced ree-verb) an effect like a blurred echo within a room. Bigger rooms produce more reverb. The
amount of reverb is sometimes specified by the reverb time, which is the time it takes a sound to die away (by 60
decibels).
roman font (or Roman font) any medium-weight non-italic serif font.
sans serif font (or sanserif font. Pronounced sun-ser[I, but without a French accent) a font without serifs,
generally considered suitable for short pieces of text such as titles.
scan (a) to get a page of music, text or graphics into a computer program using a scanner.
(b) the image produced when a page has been scanned. In PhotoScore Lite, scans arc always displayed with a buff
background to distinguish them from music which has been read, and from music in Sibelius.
scanner driver the program which tells the computer what type of scanner you have; analogous to a printer
driver.
score any music notation document (sometimes used loosely to mean a full score, though not in this User
Guide). 11101 full score, part, transposing score.
section a subdivision of a score, such as a song from an album or a movement from a symphony. New sections
often start with a new title and with full instrument names, and sometimes bar numbers restart at I and rehearsal
marks restart at A or 1.
select to click an object you want to edit, copy, move or delete, and thereby turn it colored. The color indicates
which voice the object is in.
selection anything which is selected. A single selecfion consists of one selected object; a mu/@/e selection
consists of two or more selected objects. 10 1 ai passage
sequencer a computer program designed primarily for recording, editing and playing back music using MIDI. Most
sequencers can also print notation to some extent, but as they are designed around MIDI rather than notation, they
are quite distinct from music notation programs. Many sequencers also perform hard disk recording (HDR), which
means they can record and edit audio (such as singing) in addition to MIDI.
serif the spike on corners and tips of letters in certain fonts, known as serif fonts. Serif fonts are considered more
legible than sans serif fonts for large quantities of text, such as books,
shortcut menu (Windows only) slightly confusing term for the menu you get when you right-click. (Nothing to do
with keyboard shortcuts.) Sometimes called a context-sensitive menu, because the menu contents depend on what
you right-click on.
sound set the complete set of sounds available on a MIDI device. Thus Sibelius lets you choose between a General
MIDI sound set, a Roland N-1080 sound set, and so on.

475

Glossary

space the distance between two staff lines, used as the main unit of measurement in music engraving. For
instance, beams are normally 0.5 spaces thick, and a staff size is four spaces by definition.
spelling the way in which a pitch is written as a note-name with an accidental. Most pitches have three spellings,
e.g. C natural can also be spelled as B# or as Dbb.
spreads the printing format in which pairs of consecutive pages are printed side-by-side on the same sheet of paper
to show how the finished score will look when opened flat.
staff the British word for this is stave.
staff objects objects which are attached to (and refer to) a particular staff. These include notes, chords, rests, clef
changes and symbols, and most lines and text styles. LL! system objects.
staff size the height of a five-line staff, measured between the middle of the top and bottom lines. The size of
everything in a score - notes, lines, text and all other objects - is proportional to the staff size. The staff size equals 4
spaces by definition.
stem the vertical line, sometimes known loosely but inaccurately as a tail, on notes and chords. i ; 111 tail.
step-time input inputting notes and chords by specifying pitches on a MIDI keyboard and note values etc. on the
keypad. !EL& Flexi-timeTM, alphabetic input, mouse input.
sub-bracket LA bracket.
symbol an object of fixed shape which you can put anywhere in the score; used for miscellaneous objects such as
\ornaments and percussion symbols. Symbols are customizable: they can be any character from any font, or a
composite of any number of existing symbols.
system a group of staves which are played simultaneously and joined at the left-hand side by an initial barline.
Music for a solo instrument is often written on one staff, in which case the words system and staff refer to the same
thing.
system break the forced termination of a system at a particular barline, often at the end of a musical section.
$2 page break.
system objects objects which apply to all instruments rather than to just one staff, such as time signatures, key
signatures, tempo and title text, rehearsal marks and some lines. Most system objects are drawn just above the system,
and sometimes in the middle as well. System objects are not attached to any particular staff, and are extracted into all
parts. L2 staff objects.
system passage a selected passage surrounded by a double blue box. The main differences between a systern
passage and a normal passage are: copying a system passage inserts into the score rather than overwriting existing
music; copying a system passage copies system objects in addition to staff objects; and deleting a system
passage deletes the bars themselves, rather than turning them into bar rests.
system separators double diagonal lines drawn between systems in large scores to emphasize where there is
more than one system per page.
/

476
*

-_--~--

Glossary

tab (a) guitur tub is a notation in which staff lines represent the guitar strings, and fret numbers indicate where to
position the fingers.
(b) One of several buttons along the top of a dialog which flick between different pages of options. The keypad also
has five tabs which choose different keypad layouts.
tail the curved hook of an individual eighth note (quaver) or shorter note.
text style the text style of each piece of text in a score specifies the font, size, positioning, etc. Different uses of text
have different styles; for instance, dynamics (e.g. mp) are in the Expression style.
toggle (a) to turn an option on and off by performing the same action.
(b) An option or key which toggles.
track the MIDI file equivalent of a staff. (MIDI channels served this purpose in older (type 0) MIDI files but had
the drawback of being limited to 16, whereas the number of tracks is unlimited in type 1 MIDI files.)
transposing instrument an instrument which sounds at a different pitch from how its music is written, such as
a clarinet, horn or piccolo. The transposition (or key) of the instrument is specified by the pitch produced when the
performer reads a C; for instance, when a trumpet in Bb reads a C, it produces a Bb.
transposing score a score in which the music of transposing instruments is not written at the pitch at
which it sounds. A non-transposing score is said to be a score in C, or written at sounding pitch or concert pitch.
tuplet (most people rhyme it with duplet, some with couplet) a rhythm which is played at a fraction of its normal
speed, such as a triplet. It is drawn as a single number or a ratio above or below the notes, often with a bracket to
show which notes it applies to, occasionally with a little note to indicate the rhythmic unit referred to by the
number(s).
Tuplet is actually music software jargon - in the real world of music, tuplets are usually called irrational rhythms or
occasionally polyrhythms or countermetric rhythms.
TWAIN the communications standard used between programs and scanners; analogous to MIDI.
USB (stands for Universal Serial Bus) most modern computers have two or more USB ports, allowing the connection
of a wide range of peripheral hardware, including MIDI devices.
velocity in MIDI, the speed (and hence force) with which you press a key on a MIDI keyboard, which determines
the loudness of that note. The word is also used for the speed with which you lift a key, which controls how quickly
the note dies away.
voice a series of notes, chords and rests ;II rhythmic succession on a staff (sometimes known as a layer, or more
loosely as a part or line). Normally there is just one voice on a staff, in which case the stems can point up or down
depending on the pitch of the notes.
Two voices are written on the same staff when two independent rhythms need to be shown. The voices are
distinguished by stem direction - the voice IS notes and chords have stems up, and voice 2 has stems down.
In guitar and (occasionally) keyboard music, third and fourth voices can be used. These also have stems up and down,
so can sometimes be confused with the first and second voices.
477

Glossary

When you select a note or other object, the selection color tells you which voice its in.
volume in MIDI, the general loudness of a MIDI channel, as opposed to velocity which determines the
loudness of individual notes.

478
_----

-..

__--

-.

Index
1 5va .......................................................................................... see octave lines
1 st and 2nd endings (1 st-/2nd-time bars). ............................................ 263
Bva ............................................................................................ see octave lines

a tempo.. ....................................................................................................... .437


A3 ............................................................................................. see paper sizes
A4 ............................................................................................. see paper sizes
A5 ............................................................................................. see paper sizes
accelerando
beams.. ..................................................................... see feathered beams
playback of.. .................................................................................. .262, 353
accent ........................................................ see articulations, accented letters
accented letters ........................................................................................... .441
acciaccaturas ................................................................................................. 205
defined ................................................................................................... .469
accidentals.. ............................................................................................ 47, 1 18
above notes.. .......................................................................................... 365
Add Cautionary Accidentals plug-in .................................................. 363
bracketed ................................................................................................ 1 18
cautionary ............................................................................................... 1 18
defined .................................................................................................... 469
double sharps/flats .............................................................................. .450
editing.. .................................................................................................... 322
editorial.. ......................................................................................... 1 18, 365
microtonal.. .................................................................................... 1 19, 430
playback of.. ..................................................................................... 370
moving. .................................................................................................... 120
spelling of ...................................................................................... 119,369
spelling of (Flexi-time) ......................................................................... 202
typing in text.. ......................................................................................... 120
Acorn Sibelius fifes.. ..................................................................................... 327
Actual size.. .................................................................................................... 462
acute accent ..................................................................... see accented letters
adding bars.. ........................................................................................... 42, 142
Adobe Acrobat.. ............................................................................................ 390
Adobe Type Manager (ATM) ................................................................... .3 15
after-touch.. ..................................................................................................... 286
defined .................................................................................................... 469
afeatory music.. ............................................................................................. 203
Align in a Column ........................................................................................ 259
Align in a Row.. ................. ............................................................................ 259
align objects .................................................................................................. 259
All Notes Off.. ................................................................................................ 354
a//ofavu lines ........................................................................ see octave lines
Allegro files.. .................................................................................................. 330
alphabetic input.. ................................................................................... 50, 3 19

defined.. .................................................................................................. .469


altered unisons ............................................................................................. 1 19
alternating instruments.. .................................... see instruments, doubling
anacrusis ................................................................ see pick-up (upbeat) bars
analysis
.... ....................................................................................... 103
Schenkerian
Anastasia font.. ............................................................................................. .3 13
angle
text at an.. ................................................................................................ 180
apostrophe ............................................................................ see smart quotes
Append Score ............................................................................................... 191
appoggiaturas .............................................................................................. .205
defined.. .................................................................................................. .469
arpeggio .............................................................................. 264. See a/so fines
problems printing. ................................................................................. 374
Arrange ..... ...................................................................................................... 121
styles .... ..................................................................................................... 123
editing.. .............................................................................................. 167
arranging.. ............................................................................................... 70, 121
articulations ........................................................................................... .47, 129
above the staff.. ...................................................................................... 130
adding.. .................................................................................................... 129
copying .................................................................................................... 130
defined.. .................................................................................................. .469
editing.. ................................................................................................... .322
moving.. ................................................................................................... 129
on rests.. .................................................................................................. 130
redefining ................................................................................................ 130
removing ................................................................................................. 129
symbols.. ................................................................................................. .430
atonal music.. ...................................................................................... .255, 450
attachment.. ............. ...................................................................... 54, 133,379
defined.. ...................... ............................................................................. 469
text between staves.. ............................................................................ .440
viewing.. .......................................................................................... 133, 461
augment.. ...................................................................................................... .361
augmentation dot.. ................................................................. see rhythm dot
auto-backup.. ................................................................................................. 190
auto-save.. .......... ..................................................................................... 50, 189

sizes
. . . . . . . .paper
..
64 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . see
190
backup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . see
balkan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .beam
sizes
. . . . . . . paper
.
Band . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .see
..........
band music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86
2 17. See also guitar frames, guitar tab
banjo . . .._.......................................
479

Index
banks ........... ...... ......... .......................................................... .279, 380, 301
defined ................... ......................................................... ....... ............ 469
bar numbers.. ................................................
.... . . ................. 135
i?d0v,: the staff ...................................... ........ . . .......... ...... 1 .bCJ
centered on the bar ............... ............................ . . ....... ... ...... ......... 1.37
changing .............................................................................................
135
frequency.. ................................. ........................................................ 135
hiding.. ..................................................................................................... 1 3 6
moving.. ................. ................................................................................ 136
on every staff.. ..................................... ................... .... ........... .... ..... 136
recommended fonts. ................ ......... ..................... .......... ............... I&\
removing ......................................... .............................................. ... ... 136
text style.. ................. ........ ............................ ._.. ................. ..... ...... 136
bar rests ............................. ..................................................... ............. . . 142
blank ................................................... .................................................... 144
breve .......................... ............................ .............. ................................. 144
double whole note.. ............................................. ................................ 144
moving.. ................................................................................................... 144
bat-lines.. .................................................................... .......... ...................... 138
early music . ........................................................................................... 139
final ............................................................................. ............................. 139
hiding.. ......... ... ....... .............................................................................. 1 4 0
initial.. ................. ......................... ................................ ................. 1 0 0 , 3 8 1
defined. ............................................................................................ 412
invisible.. ................... .............................................................................. 140
joins between.. ..................................................................................... 140
moving.. ................................................................................................... 138
on some staves only.. .......................................................................... 141
other.. ....................................................................................................... 1 38
repeat.. ..................................................................................................... 139
symbols ................................................................................................... 429
systemic.. ...................................................................... see barlines, initial
bars ................................................................................. ........... ................... 142
adding ............................................................................................... 42, 141
changing length.. ........................................................... ...................... 142
deleting ............................................................................................ 69, 142
deleting contents.. ................................................................................. 142
irregular.. ............................................ ................................................... 143
multiple ................................................................................. see passages
pick-up (upbeat) .......................................................................... 143, 446
Properties.. ................................................................ ........................... 38 1
rebarring.. ................................................................................................ 446
repeat.. ................................................. .............................. ................... 144
selecting parts of ................................................ ... ............................... .7 I
split. .....................................................................................................
14 I
bass guitar.. ....................................................... see guitar frames, guitar tab
beams.. ....................................................................... ................................... 145
across bat-lines.. ................ ................................................... ................ 145
across rests ............................................................................................. 14 5
angles.. .................................................................................................... 145
beam line ................................... ..... ..................................................... 264
between notes ........................................... ........................................... 147
changing grouping.. .............................................................................. 447
cross-staff ................................................................................................ 146
480

clefmcd ........ .................... ...... ...................................... .469


httif red ....... ....... ..... ....... ................. 148, 264
Ilrtilng . . . . . . . . . . . .
..... ............................. 148
ro<c! groups ........... ........ .................... ........ ....... I 45
revel sing.. ........... ............................................................................ 1%
beat groups- ......................................................................
,447
beats,
number ........................ ................ .........................................3G8
bend ........ .... ................. _ _ _. .... .....................................,213
bend and tr?lCW~ ................. ... ...................................................
.2 14

big IKm ................

....... ............................................ ......... )08

hind .......................................................................................
see ties
b~rds eye.. ..................... ..... ... ....................................... ree fermata
bitmap graphics. ...........................................................................
.388
blnn k pager ............. ................... ..... ....................... .............................. 1 53
block copying ............................................................... see passages
F3MP files .................... .......................................................................
.39O
defined ................. ..........................................................................
,469
exporting ................................................................................... ,390
booklet pnntlng ............... . ............. ........ ...................... ...................... .375
bowing mark5 ........................... ...... ........ ................. see artlculatrons, slurs
box.. ....................... ....... ........... ...... ........... ............. ..... .......................... 364
boxed tpxt ., ............. ..... ...................... ............. ...... ............................ ,438
brms. .... ... ......................... .... ................. ............................... ................ 1 50
defl nt>d .................................... ........ .................................................... ,469
hldlng.. ................... ... ................... .................................................... 1 so
problems printing.. ................................ ............................................ ,374
bracketed accidentals ..........................................................................1 18
brackets ...............................................................................................150
defined.. ................................................................................................. ,469
Propertlec.. .....................................................................................
.381
Brandt Koemer notation ......................................................................
155
brea k5 ..................................... ..... ......
...... ......................... 66, 152
tleflned.. ........................ ...... ............... ........... ........ ..................... , 4 6 9
page .......................................................................................
152, 257
system ..........................................................................................
91, 1 52
defined ........................... ............................................................ 476
viewing ..........................................................................................
459
breath marks ................... ... ........ ......... ............... ....... ........................... ,430
breve ..... ......... ............ ... .......... ..... . .............................. ...... set note values

C, scores In .................... .............................. see transposing scol es


cadenzas . . ..... ....................................................... ............... ......... 204
caesurd ......... ....... ........................ ............... ......................................... 430
capture, real-time ............................................................ see Flexi-time
caret ................................................................................................... 46
defined ............. .............. .............................................................. 470
cd+ng off.. ................................................................... see formdtting
catalog Information.. ............................................... see score ~nformdtlon
cautionary markings.. ................... ..sc e accidentals, clefs, key signatures,
time signatures

Index
CDs
making.. ................................................................................................... 3%
cedilla.. ............................................................................... see accented letters
channels.. ............................................................................................. .280, 301
defined .................................................................................................... 470
characters
accented ..................................................................... see accented letters
special ...................................................................................................... 44 1
check
clefs .......................................................................................................... 370
harp pedal diagrams ........................................................................... .370
parallel 5ths/8ves .................................................................................. 371
pizzicato.. ................................................................................................. 370
range.. ...................................................................................................... 361
repeat barlines.. .................................................................................... .370
choir.. ................................................................................................................ .88
double ....................................................................................................... .90
choral music.. .................................................................................................. .88
breath marks ......................................................................................... .430
divide symbols.. ..................................................................................... 430
elision.. ..................................................................................................... 266
short score ................................................................................................ .88
chord names.. .................................................................... see chord symbols
chord symbols.. ................................................................ .154, 163, 210, 433
add automatically.. ................................................................................ 363
aligning.. .................................................................................................. 156
Brandt Roemer notation.. .................................................................... 155
defined .................................................................................................... 470
frequency.. .............................................................................................. 156
hiding ....................................................................................................... 157
no superscript ........................................................................................ 155
plain ......................................................................................................... 155
recommended fonts.. ........................................................................... 183
text style.. ................................................................................................. 157
transposing.. ........................................................................................... 156
chords.. ......................................................... .5 1, 3 19. See also notes, voices
creating.. ........................................................................................... 51, 3 19
defined ................................................................................................... .470
explode.. .................................................................................................. 123
out of alignment.. .................................................................................. 379
rolled ........................................................................................ see arpeggio
split between staves.. ............................................................................ 147
chorus hooks ................................................................................. see brackets
circumflex.. ........................................................................ see accented letters
clefs .......................................................................................................... 73, 1 58
cautionary ............................................................................................... 159
hiding .............................................................................................. 159,381
octave ....................................................................................................... 1 59
symbols ................................................................................................... 43 1
click .......................................................................................................... 62, 199
during Flexi-time.. ........................................................................... 62, 200
click track.. ...................................................................................................... 303
clusters ........................................................................................................... 430
codas ..................................................................................................... 1 1 1, 381

inserting symbol .................................................................................... I I I


collisions .......................................................................... see music engraving
color.. ..................................................................................... see a/so highlight
notes.. ...................................................................................................... .459
common time.. ................................................................. see time signatures
Composer text.. ............................................................................................ .437
Concert.. .................................................................................... see paper sizes
concert pitch.. .............................................................. see transposing scores
concertina format.. ........................................................................ see spreads
conductor symbols ..................................................................................... .43 1
contrametric rhythms.. ................................................................... see tuplets
control changes
defined.. .................................................................................................. .470
controllers (MIDI). ....................................................................................... .282
defined.. .................................................................................................. .470
convert

defined.. .................................................................................................. .470


converting
Acorn Sibelius files ............................................................................... .327
Finale, Allegro and PrintMusic files.. ................................................. .330
MIDI files ................................................................................................. 334
SCORE files ............................................................................................ .338
copying.. ................................................................................................. .38, 410
between scores.. .................................................................................... I 91
multiple objects ............................................................. see multicopying
copyright lines.. .................................................................................... 182, 438
countermetric rhythms .................................................................. see tuplets
counterpoint on one staff.. ............................................................. see voices
courtesy markings.. ................................................. see cautionary markings
Create menu ................................................................................................... 3 1
Bar ............................................................................................................ 142
Bar Number Change.. ........................................................................... 135
Barline ...................................................................................................... 138
Bracket.. ................................................................................................... 150
Clef............................................................................................................

Extra Staff.. ..............................................................................................


Guitar Frame.. ........................................................................................
Highlight.. ...............................................................................................
Instruments.. ..........................................................................................
Key Signature ........................................................................................

158
.42 1

.210
.223
.230
.254

Line ........................................................................................................... 260

Rehearsal Mark ..................................................................................... .385


Staff Type Change submenu.. ................................. 153, 2 17, 423, 424
Symbol .................................................................................................... .428
Text ......................................................................................................... ..43 2

Time Signature.. .................................................................................... ,446


Transposition Change.. ................................................................ 160, 235
Tuplet ...................................................................................................... .454
creating.. ............................ see also the name of the object to be created
chords ........................................................................................................ 51
instruments.. ............................................................................................. 41
lines ............................................................................................................ 52
manuscript paper.. .................................................................................. 41
notes...........................................................................................................

46

481

Index
text .............................................................................................................. .52
credits.. .......................................................................................... .437. see text
crescendo ...................................................................................................... 26 1
exponential ............................................................................................. 43 1
playback on held notes.. ...................................................................... 369
crop marks.. ................................................................................................... 383
defined .................................................................................................... 470
cross-staff beaming.. ................................................... see beams, cross-staff
crotchet ..................................................................................... see note values
cue notes ....................................................................................................... 205
defined .................................................................................................... 470
cues in parts.. ................................................................................................ 207
cursor.. ................................................................................................... see caret
cut-away scores.. .......................................................................................... 424

D
da cape (D.C.) .............................................................................................. 1 1 1
dal segno (D.S.) ........................................................................................... 1 1 1
decrescendo.. ......................................................................... see diminuendo
Dedication text.. ........................................................................................... .437
default
defined ................................................................................................... .470
default positions.. ......................................................................................... 161
changing existing objects.. ................................................................... 163
eleting ......... .37. See also under the name of the object to be deleted
d selecting objects ........................................................................................ .36
%
device ............................................................................ see a/so MIDI devices
diacritics ............................................................................ see accented letters
dialog
defined ................................................................................................... .470
diatonic
defined ................................................................................................... .470
transposition.. ........................................................................................ .450
dictionary, playback.. ................................................................... see playback
dieresis .............................................................................. see accented letters
diminish ......................................................................................................... 361
diminuendo ................................................................................................... 261
playback on held notes.. ...................................................................... 369
directional quotes ................................................................ see smart quotes
disks.. ........................................................ see backups, files, loading, saving
display settings ................................................................................................ 32
distance .......................................................................................................... 302
divisi ................................................................................................................ 233
divisi dots ....................................................................................... see tremolos
dobro.. ................................................................ see guitar frames, guitar tab
Document Setup.. ........................................................................................ 164
doit symbol .................................................................................................. .43 I
dot ............................................................................ see staccato, rhythm dot
dotted rhythms.. ...................................................................... see rhythm dot
double dots.. ................................................................................................. 3 19
double whole note ................................................................. see note values
double-sided printing.. ....................................................................... I 81, 375
482

doubling instruments.. ....................................... see instruments, doubling


down-bow.. .............................................................................. see articulations
dPl

defined.. .................................................................................................. .470


drag.. ......................................................................................... see grace notes
dragging
objects.. ...................................................................................................... 36
paper.. ........................................................................................................ 29
drum mapping.. ........................................................................ see percussion
drum notation ........................................................................... see percussion
drum roll ....................................................................................... see tremolos
drum set (drum kit). ................................................................ see percussion
duplets.. ............................................................................................. see tuplets
duplex printing.. .................................................... see double-sided printing
dynamics.. ................................................... 54, 69. see Expression, hairpins
apply to multiple staves ...................................................................... .369
defined.. .................................................................................................. .470
playback of.. ........................................................................................... .352

early music.. ........................... 92. see barlines, incipits, figured bass, clefs
barlines .................................................................................................... 139
ficta .......................................................................................................... .365
notch staccato symbol.. ....................................................................... ,430
Edit
Arrange Styles.. ....................................................................................... 167
Lines ......................................................................................................... 171
Noteheads.. ............................................................................................. 173
Staff Types.. ............................................................................................. 175
Symbols ................................................................................................... 177
Text Styles.. .............................................................................................. 179
Edit menu
Copy.. ......................................................................................................... 38
cut .............................................................................................................. 37
Delete (Clear). .......................................................................................... 37
Filter submenu.. ..................................................................................... 194
Find.. ......................................................................................................... 194
Find Next.. ............................................................................................... 194
Flip ........................................................................................... .97, 426, 455
Go to Bar.. ............................................................................................... 135
Go to Page.. ........................................................................................... .341
Hide or Show.. ....................................................................................... .22 1
Paste.. ......................................................................................................... 37
Redo .................................................................................................. 38, 458
Redo History.. ........................................................................................ .458
Repeat.. ............................................................................................ .38, 4 14
Select submenu .................................................................................... .4lO
Select More ..................................................................................... .439
Undo ................................................................................................ .38, 458
Undo History.. ....................................................................................... .458
Voice submenu ..................................................................................... .465
Edit Text Styles.. ............................................................................................ 179

Index

g
s
0

6
9

n
n
s
n
s
g

Border tab.. ............................................................................................. 181


General tab.. ........................................................................................... 180
Horizontal Position tab.. ....................................................................... 181
Repeat tab.. ............................................................................................. 182
Vertical Position tab .............................................................................. 182
editing
basic ........................................................................................................... .36
eighth note.. .............................................................. see note values, beams
electric guitar.. ................................................... see guitar frames, guitar tab
elided syllables ............................................................................................. 270
emailing files.. ............................................................................................... 19 1
EMF files.. ....................................................................................................... 389
defined .................................................................................................... 470
endings
first.. .......................................................................................................... 263
second ..................................................................................................... 263
Engraving Rules.. ........................................ .225. See a/so music engraving
accidentals .............................................................................................. I 20
articulations ............................................................................................ 13 1
bar numbers.. ......................................................................................... 136
barlines.. .................................................................................................. 141
beams ...................................................................................................... 148
brackets and braces.. ............................................................................ 150
defined .................................................................................................... 471
fonts ......................................................................................................... 3 14
grace notes and cue notes.. ................................................................ 207
guitar frames .......................................................................................... 21 1
key signatures ........................................................................................ 256
lyrics ......................................................................................................... 272
multirests ................................................................................................. 307
note spacing.. ......................................................................................... 324
rehearsal marks ..................................................................................... 386
slurs.. ........................................................................................................ 417
staves and systems ...................................................................... 418, 423
stems.. ...................................................................................................... 427
system separators ................................................................................. 425
ties ............................................................................................................ 261
time signatures ...................................................................................... 448
tuplets ...................................................................................................... 457
voices ....................................................................................................... 467
Enhanced MetaFile format.. ....................................................................... 389
enharmonic spellings.. ....................................... see accidentals, spelling of
Enigma fifes.. .............................................................................. see Finale files
EPS files
defined ................................................................................................... .47 I
exporting.. ............................................................................................... 389
erase background ........................................................................................ 181
erasers ..................... see erase background, ossias, codas, incipits, staves
errors ...................................................................................................... see help
Espressivo.. .......................................................................... .34, 304, 348, 392
exam paper .......................................................................................... 1 14, 273
excerpts.. .......................................................................... see music examples
Executive ................................................................................... see paper sizes
explode.. ......................................................................................................... 123

defined.. .................................................................................................. .47 1


exporting
audio (.wav) files.. ................................................................................ .393
BMP files .................................................................................................. 390
defined .................................................................................................... .471
EMF fifes ................................................................................................. .389
EPS files.................................................................................................... 389
graphics fifes.. ........................................................................................ .387
house styles.. ......................................................................................... .225
MIDI files ................................................................................................ .392
music examples .................................................................................... .387
PDF files.. ................................................................................................ .390
PICT files .................................................................................................. 390
Expression text.. ........................................................................................... .435
recommended fonts.. ........................................................................... 183
extension lines ........................................................................... see lyrics lines
extract
defined.. .................................................................................................. .47 I
extracting parts.. .............................................................................. 74, 94, 185
cue notes.. ...................................................................................... 187, 206
Extract Parts dialog ................................................................................ 185
individual players.. ................................................................................. 187
eyebrow.. .......................................................................................... see tie, slur

fader
defined ..................................................................................................... 471
fall symbol .................................................................................................... .43 I
family
defined.. .................................................................................................. .471
fasola music.. .............................................................................................. .3 17
feathered beams ................................................................................. 148, 264
fermata ........................................................................................................... 129
over a barline ......................................................................................... 130
ficta .................................................................................................................. 365
figured bass.. ................................................................................................ .437
file conversion
Acorn Sibelius fifes ................................................................................ 327
Finale, Allegro & PrintMusic files.. ..................................................... ,330
MIDI files ................................................................................................. 392
SCORE fifes ............................................................................................ .338
File menu
Append Score......................................................................................... I 91
Close.. ......................................................................................................... 41
Extract Parts.. .................................................................................... 74, 185
New ............................................................................................................ 41
Open ..................................................................................................... .8, 28
Preferences submenu.. ................................................................. .25, 372
Keyboard Shortcuts.. ..................................................................... .245
Print.. ....................................................................................................... .373
Publish on SibeliusMusic.com ........................................................... .240
Register/Transfer.. .................................................................................... 18
483

Index
Save.. .......................................................................................................... .50
Save as.. ................................................................................................... 392
Save as Manuscript Paper ................................................................... 274
Score Info.. .............................................................................................. 240
files.. ........................... 189. See a/so exporting, importing, fife conversion
auto-backup.. .......................................................................................... 190
auto-save.. ........................................................................................ 50, 1 89
converting to audio.. ............................................................................. 393
graphics fifes.. ......................................................................................... 387
new .............................................................................................................. 41
opening ...................................................................................................... 28
opening Mac files in Windows.. ......................................................... 192
opening Windows files on Mac.. ........................................................ 192
printing.. .................................................................................................... .40
saving ................................................................................................ 50, 189
sending by email.. ................................................................................. 191
sharing ..................................................................................................... 191
film
defined .................................................................................................... 47 I
filters ............................................................................................................... 194
defined .................................................................................................... 47 I
Finale files.. .................................................................................................... 330
find .................................................................................................................. 194
Fine ................................................................................................................. 1 1 1
fingering.. ....................................................................................................... 437
brass i struments .................................................................................. 363
string it struments ................................................................................. 366
symbols ................................................................................................... 43 1
first ending.. ............................................................. see 1 st and 2nd endings
first-time bar.. .......................................................... see I st and 2nd endings
Fit page width ............................................................................................... 462
flags
defined .................................................................................................... 471
hiding.. ..................................................................................................... 148
flam ............................................................................................ see grace notes
flat .................................................................................................................. 1 1 8
Flexi-time.. ............................................................................................... 62, 199
defined .................................................................................................... 47 1
Flexi-time Options.. ............................................................................... 201
inputting into two instruments.. ......................................................... 200
recording ................................................................................................. 199
recording transposing pitch ............................................................... .202
split point ................................................................................................ 201
voices ....................................................................................................... 202
flip .................................................................... 426. See a/so Edit menu, Flip
Folio ........................................................................................... see paper sizes
fonts.. ..................................................................................................... 180, 428
Adobe Type 1 ......................................................................................... 3 14
changing.. ................................................................................................ 179
equivalents.. ............................................................................................ 442
installing .................................................................................................. 3 14
point size.. ............................................................................................... 180
PostScript ................................................................................................ 3 14
recommended ....................................................................................... 183
484

sans serif.. ................................................................................................ 183


serif ........................................................................................................... 183
substitution ............................................................................................. 442
TrueType ................................................................................................ .3 14
footers.. .................................................................................................. 182, 438
footnotes.. ..................................................................................................... ,438
foreign languages.. .......................................................... see accented letters
formatting ............................................................................................... 64, 257
defined.. .................................................................................................. .471
tips .............................................................................................................. 67
fractional beams.. ................................................................................... see tail
frame notation ............................................................................................. .264
frames, guitar.. ..................................................................... see guitar frames
free rhythm.. ................................................................................................. .203
FreeMlDl ....................................................................................................... .291
defined ..................................................................................................... 471
French notes.. .......................................................................... see grace notes
fret instruments ........................................................................................... .2 13
full score
defined.. .................................................................................................. .47 1
Full Screen .................................................................................................... .462
fun .................................................................................................. .73, 2 17, 386

G.P.. ....................................................................................... see general pause


General MIDI (GM) ........................................................................... .276, 279
defined ..................................................................................................... 471
general pause.. ............................................................................................ .306
Chent font .................................................................................................... .3 I 3
glissando ....................................................................................................... .263
GM.. ........................................................................................ see General MIDI
Go to Bar.. ...................................................................................................... 135
Go to Page .................................................................................................... .341
grace notes ................................................................................................... .205
bends (guitar tab) ................................................................................ .2 14
defined.. .................................................................................................. .47 1
grand pause.. ....................................................................... see general pause
grand staff.. ............................................................ see keyboard instruments
graphics files ......................................... .387. See a/so exporting, importing
importing.. .............................................................................................. .228
PDF files ................................................................................................... 390
grave accent ..................................................................... see accented letters
gray objects ....................................................................................... see hiding
grayscale
defined.. .................................................................................................. .47 I
grids, guitar.. ......................................................................... see guitar frames
group
defined.. .................................................................................................. .47 I
groups of notes .................................................................. see also passages
selecting ..................................................................................................... 71
guitar frames ................................................................................................ .2 10
hiding ....................................................................................................... 211

Index
guitar music.. ................................................................................................... .96
guitar tab.. ............................................................................................... 96, 2 12
arpeggio .................................................................................................. 2 1 6
bend.. ....................................................................................................... 2 I 3
bend and release .................................................................................. 2 14
creating a tab instrument ................................................................... .212
customizing ............................................................................................ 2 18
defined .................................................................................................... 477
hammer-on ............................................................................................ 2 16
harmonics.. ............................................................................................. 2 16
inputting and editing.. ......................................................................... .213
muff led strings.. ..................................................................................... 2 16
notation and tab.. .................................................................................. 2 12
pick scrape.. ............................................................................................ 21 6
pop ........................................................................................................... 2 16
pre-bend ................................................................................................ .2 I 4
pre-bend and release.. ........................................................................ .214
pull-off ..................................................................................................... 2 16
rake.. ......................................................................................................... 2 16
shake.. ...................................................................................................... 21 6
slap ........................................................................................................... 2 16
slide.. ........................................................................................................ 2 15
symbols ................................................................................................... 429
tapping.. ................................................................................................... 2 16
tunings.. ................................................................................................... 2 18
unison bend .......................................................................................... .2 15
vibrato.. .................................................................................................... 2 16
vibrato bar dip ....................................................................................... 2 16
vibrato bar dive.. ................................................................................... .2 I 5
vi brato bar scoop .................................................................................. 2 16

H
hairpins.. ......................................................................................................... 2 6 1
defined .................................................................................................... 472
playback of.. ............................................................................................ 352
half note.. .................................................................................. see note values
hammer-on ................................................................................................... 2 16
hanging punctuation.. ................................................................................. 270
harmonics.. .......................................................................................... .2 16, 3 16
harp
pedal diagrams.. .................................................................................... 1 1 0
Haupstimme ................................................................................................. 430
hat ........................................................................................... see articulations
H-bar.. .................................................................................. see also multirests
defined ................................................................................................... .47 I
headers ................................................................................................. 1 8 2 , 4 3 8
headless notes.. ..................................................................................... 97, 316
help ................................................................................................................. 2 I 9
arpeggio lines not printing.. ................................................................ 3 7 4
balloon.. .................................................................................................. .2 I 9
braces not printing.. ............................................................................. .374
crashing when switching between running programs.. ................ 2 7 6

edges cut off music when printing.. ................................................. .377


Internet publishing.. ............................................................................. .242
MIDI devices .......................................................................................... .354
notes hanging in playback .......................................................... 354, 368
notes or symbols not printing ........................................................... .374
on-screen.. .............................................................................................. .2 19
printing double-sided causes printer jams ...................................... 377
speeding up Sibelius ............................................................................... 3 2
staff lines not printing.. ........................................................................ .374
technical help ........................................................................................ .219
ToolTip .................................................................................................... .2 19
web links.. ............................................................................................... .2 19
Help Center .................................................................................................. .2 19
Help menu
About Sibelius ....................................................................................... .220
Show Balloons.. ..................................................................................... .2 19
Sibelius Help.. ........................................................................................ .2 19
Tip of the Day.. ......................................................................................... 2 7
hiding
empty staves.. ........................................................................................ .422
MIDI messages.. .................................................................................... .288
objects.. ................................................................................................... .22 I
rests .......................................................................................................... 1 4 3
text ........................................................................................................... .44 1
highlight ........................................................................................................ .223
creating.. ................................................................................................. .223
deleting.. ................................................................................................. .223
moving.. .................................................................................................. .223
hook .......................................................................................................... see tail
horizontal
alignment ................................................................................................ 259
attachment.. ............................................................................................ I 33
beams ...................................................................................................... 1 4 8
lyrics positioning.. ................................................................................. ,270
note spacing .......................................................................................... .324
off set ......................................................................................................... 3 2 5
text positioning.. ..................................................................................... 1 8 1

House Style menu


Default Positions.. ..................................................................................
Edit Lines .................................................................................................
Edit Noteheads .......................................................................................
Edit Staff Types.. .....................................................................................
Edit Symbols.. .........................................................................................
Engraving Rules ......................................................................................
Export House Styles .............................................................................
Import House Style ..............................................................................
Note Spacing Rule.. ..............................................................................
System Object Positions.. ....................................................................
Timecode.. ..............................................................................................
house styles.. .................................................................................................
defined .....................................................................................................
exporting.. ...............................................................................................
importing.. ..............................................................................................
HTML .............................................................................................................

161
171
173
175
177
225

.226
.226
,324
.227
.443
225
472

.225
.226
.241
485

Index

I
imagesetters
defined .................................................................................................... 472
implode.. ...................................................................................... see reduction
importing
Acorn Sibelius files.. .............................................................................. 327
defined .................................................................................................... 472
Finale, Allegro & PrintMusic files ........................................................ 330
graphics ................................................................................................... 228
house styles ............................................................................................ 226
MIDI files ................................................................................................. 334
SCORE files.. .......................................................................................... .338
Sibelius scores into Word documents .............................................. 390
imposition ...................................................................................................... 376
improvements ................................................................................................... 9
incipits ..................................................................................................... 90, 381
indented systems.. ....................................................................................... 422
initial barlines.. ................................................................... see barlines, initial
Inkpen font ........................................................................................... 98,313
inputting.. ........................ see also the name of the object to be inputted
alphabetic input .............................................................................. 50,319
file conversion ............................................................. see file conversion
Flexi-time input.. ............................................................................. 62, 199
keystroke nput ............................................................................... 50, 3 19
260
lines.. .......................................................................................................
.
lyrics ......................................................................................................... 266
mouse input .................................................................................... 46,319
scanning .................................................................................................. 394
step-time input ............................................................................... 60,319
text ............................................................................................................ 432
insertion point ..................................................................................... see caret
installing
music fonts ............................................................................................. 3 14
PhotoScore Lite
Mac.. .................................................................................................... .12
Windows .............................................................................................. 16
Scorch
Mac ....................................................................................................... 12
Windows.. .................................................................................... .16, 17
Sibelius
Mac ....................................................................................................... 11
Windows .............................................................................................. 14
instrument names.. ........................................................................................ .68
at new sections ...................................................................................... 235
changing.. ................................................................................................ 23 1
recommended styles.. .......................................................................... 232
instrumental parts ............................................................ see extracting parts
instruments ................................................................................................... 230
adding ......................................................................................................... 70
changing order in a score ................................................................... 230
creating ............................................................................................. 41,230
defined .................................................................................................... 472
486

deleting.. ................................................................................................. .23 1


doubling ................................................................................................. .234
ranges ..................................................................................................... .233
selecting throughout a score .............................................................. 231
transposing ................................................. 71, 186,202,235,254,255
Internet publishing ................................................................................ 73,238
inversion.. ...................................................................................................... .362
retrograde .............................................................................................. .362
inverted commas ................................................................. see smart quotes
irrational rhythms ............................................................................ see tuplets
irregular bars ................................................................................................. 143

J
jazz ..................................................................................................................... 98
fall ........................................................................................................... .431
lift (doit) ................................................................................................... 431
join scores.. .................................................................................................... 191
justification.. .................................................................................................. .418
defined ..................................................................................................... 472
staves ............................................................................................... 418,424
text.. .............................................................................. see Edit Text Styles

K
key signatures ................................................................................................. 43
cautionary ................................................................................................ 254
cautionary naturals.. ..... ......................................................................... 256
creating .................................................................................................... 254
deleting.. ................................................................................................. .254
Engraving Rules options.. .................................................................... .256
en harmonic ............................................................................................ .255
hiding.. ........................................................................................... .254, 381
multiple.. ................................................................................................. .255
keyboard beams.. ........................................................ see beams, cross-staff
keyboard input.. ............................................ see Flexi-time, step-time input
keyboard instruments ........................................................................ 108,230
symbols .................................................................................................... 429
keyboard shortcuts ............................................................................... 29,244
customizing.. .......................................................................................... .245
Mac/Windows differences ................................................................... 244
one-key ...................................................................................................... 36
restoring defaults.. ................................................................................ .245
keypad .................................................................................................... .30, 378
defined ..................................................................................................... 472
if your keyboard has no keypad.. ...................................................... .245
layouts
1 st .................................................................................... .38, 1 18, 129
2nd ............................................................................................ 205,319
3rd ..................................................................................................... 145
4th ..................................................................................................... 129
5th ...................................................................................... ............... 118

_.--___
r

Index
viewing .................................................................................................... 468
keystroke input.. ............................................................. see alphabetic input
kit notation ................................................................................... see drum set

. . . . . ..~..................................

118

laissez vibrer tie.. ................................................................................ .261, 430


landscape format.. ....................................................................................... 165
laptop
accessing keypad functions.. ............................................................... 245
lasso ................................................................................................................ 410
laundry sheets ................................................................................ see spreads
layers.. .................................................................................................. see voices
layout.. .................................................... 65, 257. See a/so music engraving
document setup .................................................................................... 164
Make Layout Uniform plug-in ........................................................... .367
page breaks ............................................................................................ 1 52
page size ................................................................................................. 257
staff justification.. .................................................................................. .418
staff size.. ................................................................................................. 257
system breaks ........................................................................................ 1 52
vertical spacing ...................................................................................... 257
Layout menu
Align in a Column ................................................................................. 259
Align in a Row.. ...................................................................................... 259
Break submenu
Page Break ....................................................................................... 152
Split Multirest.. ................................................................................. 306
Split System ...................................................................................... 1 1 1
System Break.. ................................................................................. 152
Document Setup ................................................................... 64, 164, 257
Format submenu
Lock Format.. ................................................................................... 258
Make Into Page ............................................................................... 258
Make Into System ........................................................................... 258
Unlock Format.. ............................................................................... 258
Hide Empty Staves.. .............................................................................. 422
Reset Design.. ............................................................................... .259, 439
Reset Note Spacing.. ................................................. .226, 27 1, 324, 413
Reset Position.. ............................................................................. ,258, 439
Show Empty Staves.. ............................................................................. 423
Use Multirests ........................................................................................ 306
layouts, keypad.. .............................................................. see keypad, layouts
lead sheets.. ................................................................................................... 100
leading.. .................................................................................... see line spacing
defined .................................................................................................... 472
leadsheet symbols.. .......................................................... see chord symbols
Legal .......................................................................................... see paper sizes
leger lines ........................................................................................................ .37
avoiding ................................................................................................... 263
let ring tie ........................................................................ see laissez vibrer tie
Letter.. ........................................................................................ see paper sizes
lift symbol ..................................................................................................... .43 I

ligatures.. ........................................................................ see beams, slurs, ties


line of music ...................................................................... see systems, voices
line of notes
defined.. .................................................................................................. .472
line spacing
defined.. .................................................................................................. .472
lines ................................................................................................................. 260
8va ...................................................................................... see octave lines
creating.. .................................................................................................... 52
dashed .................................................................................................... .264
defined ..................................................................................................... 472
editing.. .................................................................................................... 171
introduced.. ............................................................................................... 55
octave.. ............................................................................... see octave lines
problems printing.. ............................................................................... .374
Properties ............................................................................................... .380
slurs ............................................................................................................ 55
Lock Format.. ................................................................................................ .258
longa .......................................................................................... see note values
longs.. ......................................................................................... see note values
lute tablature.. ........................................................................................ 96, 2 12
lyric lines
defined.. .................................................................................................. ,472
Lyricist text .................................................................................................... .437
lyrics ....................................................................................................... 163, 266
above the staff.. ..................................................................................... ,269
aligning.. ................................................................................................. .259
blocks ...................................................................................................... .27 1
copying from Sibelius.. ........................................................................ .269
copying into Sibelius.. .......................................................................... .267
defined.. .................................................................................................. .472
editing.. ................................................................................................... .267
hanging punctuation.. .......................................................................... .270
inputting ................................................................................................. ,266
inputting in voice 2 .............................................................................. .269
recommended fonts ............................................................................. 183
sharing .................................................................................................... ,269
spacing.. .................................................................................................. .270
stem direction ....................................................................................... ,272
text style.. ................................................................................................ .27 1
translations.. ........................................................................................... ,267
verses ...................................................................................................... .267

M
magnetic
defined ..................................................................................................... 472
slurs ......................................................................................................... .415
tuplets ...................................................................................................... 455
Make Into Page.. .......................................................................................... .258
Make Into System.. ...................................................................................... .258
mandolin.. .......................................................... see guitar frames, guitar tab
Manuscript language.. ................................................................................ .360
487

Index
manuscript paper.. ....... 41, 86, 88, 97, 98, 100, 104, 110, 111, 114, 273
defined .................................................................................................... 472
marcato .................................................................................... see articulations
margins ............................................................................... 102,164,257,377
page ......................................................................................................... 166
staff ........................................................................................................... 166
viewing .................................................................................................... 460
marquee ........................................................................................................ 410
measures ............................................................................................... see bars
melisma lines ............................................................................... see lyric lines
mensurstrich ............................... .................................................................. 139
menus .............................................................................................................. .3 1
meters ................................................................................ see time signatures
metric modulations ..................................................................................... 436
metronome click .................................................................................. see click
metronome marks.. ....................................................................................... .52
creating .................................................................................................... 435
MIDI import.. .......................................................................................... 335
playback ......................................................................................... 351,353
Microsoft Word ............................................................................................. 390
microtones ........................................................................ see also accidentals
defined .................................................................................................... 472
playback .................................................................................................. 370
MIDI
banks.. ...................................................................................................... 280
channels .................................................................................................. 280
defined .................................................................................................... 473
patches .................................................................. see program numbers
real-time input ..................................................................... see Flexi-time
step-time input .......................................................... see step-time input
summarized.. .......................................................................................... 279
MIDI devices
Devices dialog.. ...................................................................................... 275
setting up ................................................................................................ 275
MIDI fifes.. ............................................................................................ ,280, 334
cleaning up ............................................................................................. 337
converting to audio.. ............................................................................. 393
defined .................................................................................................... 473
exporting ................................................................................................. 392
importing ................................................................................................ 334
MIDI messages.. ................................................................................. .282, 354
after-touch.. .............................................................................................. 286
defined .................................................................................................... 473
hiding ....................................................................................................... 288
modulation ............................................................................................. 286
pan ........................................................................................................... 287
pitch bend.. ............................................................................................. 285
portamento.. ........................................................................................... 286
program and bank change .................................................................. 284
sustain pedal .......................................................................................... 287
syntax ....................................................................................................... 283
volume.. ................................................................................................... 287
MIDI Thru ...................................................................................................... 277
mixer
488

p_-__ ____~ __

_ _~ _~ _ _l_

viewing ..................................................................................................... 468


Mixer window. ........................................................................................ 35,299
monitors ........................................................................................................... 32
multiple ...................................................................................................... 32
mordent ......................................................................................................... 429
mouse
using the wheel button ........................................................................ 462
mouse input ........................................................................................... 46,319
defined ..................................................................................................... 473
movements .................................................................................................... 190
moving music ............................................................................................... 412
moving objects ..... .......................................................................................... 36
muffled strings ............................................................................................. .216
multi-arc slurs ................................................................................................ 416
multicopying .................................................................................................. 413
multiple selections ...............................................................................
414
\
passages.. .... ..........................................................................................
.414
1
single objects.. ....................................................................................... .413
multimeasure rests .................................................................... see multirests
multiple
key signatures ......................................................................................... 255
monitors ...................................................................................... .............. 32
pieces of text ........................................................................................... 440
players ...................................................................................................... 233
text positions.. ......................................................................................... 182
time signatures.. .................................................................................... .203
voices ....................................................................................................... 463
multiple endings.. ................................................... see 1 st and 2nd endings
multirests ........................................................................................................ 306
defined.. .................................................................................................. .473
deleting .................................................................................................... 307
inputting into .......................................................................................... 306
showing .................................................................................................. .306
splitting . . ................................................................................................. 306
style.. ......................................................................................................... 307
music engraving.. ........................................................................................ .308
defined ..................................................................................................... 473
music examples.. ...................................... 102, 387. See a/so graphics files
music fonts ................................................................................................... .428
mute.. .................................................................................................... .300, 303
symbol ..................................................................................................... 431

N
nachschlagen .......................................................................... see grace notes
Nashville chord numbers ........................................................................... 156
natural ............................................................................................................. 118
navigator .......................................................................................................... 29
defined ..................................................................................................... 473
viewing.. .................................................................................................. .468
Nebenstimme .............................................................................................. .43O
Neuratron PhotoScore Lite ........................................................................ 394
non-breaking space .................................................................................... .270

Index
notation
advanced.. ................................................................................................. .84
basic ........................................................................................................... .82
note clusters.. ................................................................................................ 430
note spacing rule ....................................... .324. See a/so music engraving
note values
defined .................................................................................................... 473
doubling .................................................................................................. 361
editing ..................................................................................................... .322
halving ..................................................................................................... 361
noteheads.. .................................................................................................... 3 16
defined .................................................................................................... 473
editing ...................................................................................................... 173

366
466

.38

octave lines..................................................................................263

318
473

473
3 19

208
459

.48
46

473
.58
123
194
354
3 16

322
in text ....................................................................................................... 436
inputting.. ......................................................................................... 45, 3 19

mouse input.. ........................................................................................... .46


out of alignment.. ........................................................................ .325, 379
out of range.. ................................................................................ .233, 459
playback durations.. .............................................................................. 350
Properties.. .............................................................................................. 382

repitching.. ................................................................................................ .58


selecting groups of.. ................................................................................ .7 1
silent .........................................................................................................

31 6

small.. .............................................................. see cue notes, grace notes


spacing ............................................. 66, 324. See a/so music engraving
stemless .......................................................................................... 3 16, 426

with no noteheads ..................................................................................


without stems.. .........................................................................................
Notes menu
Add Interval submenu.. ........................................................................
Add Pitch submenu ..............................................................................

0
objects
aligning .................................................................................................... 259
copying ...................................................................................................... 38
defined ..................................................................................................... 473
deleting ...................................................................................................... 37
deselecting.. .............................................................................................. 36
dragging ..................................................................................................... 36
hidden ..................................................................................................... .22 1
moving ....................................................................................................... 36
selecting ..................................................................................................... 36
OCR ................................................................................................ see scanning

larger ............................................................................................... 273, 3 18


mixing sizes in a chord.. ...................................................................... .3 18
slash ......................................................................................................... 3 16

smaller .....................................................................................................
NoteOff
defined . ...................................................................................................
NoteOn
defined ....................................................................................................
notes ...............................................................................................................
Add Note Names plug-in.. ...................................................................
adjust position.. ......................................................................................
basic editing of.. .......................................................................................
big ............................................................................................................
coloring.. ..................................................................................................
copying.. ....................................................................................................
creating .......................................................................................................
defined ....................................................................................................
editing ........................................................................................................
explode ....................................................................................................
filtering.. ...................................................................................................
hanging ....................................................................................................
headless ..................................................................................................
hiding .......................................................................................................

Arrange ............................................................................................ .72, 12 1


Edit Arrange Styles.. ............................................................................... 167
Flexi-time ................................................................................................. 199
Flexi-time Options.. .............................................................................. .201
Reset Beam Groups.. ............................................................................ 145
Reset Stems and Beam Angles.. ......................................................... 146
Respell Accidental.. ................................................................................ 1 19
Transpose.. .............................................................................................. 450
Transposing Score.. ................................................................................. 71

.97
.9 1

, 265, 43 1

OMS ........................................................................... see Open Music System


open key .............................................................................. see key signatures
Open Music System .................................................................................... .29 1
defined ..................................................................................................... 473
opening
Acorn Sibelius files ............................................................................... .327
Finale, Allegro 8 PrintMusic files.. ..................................................... .33O
MIDI files ................................................................................................ .334
scanned files in PhotoScore Lite ....................................................... .394
SCORE files ............................................................................................ .338
optimize ...................................................................... see Hide Empty Staves
Opus font ....................................................................................................... 31 3
orchestral music ........................................................................................... I 04
orchestral parts ................................................................. see extracting parts
organ music.. ................................................................................................. 108
pedal symbols ....................................................................................... .A29
original
defined.. .................................................................................................. .473
ornaments ...................................................................................................... 429
trills .......................................................................................................... .262
ossias............................................................................................................. ..42 1

defined.. ..................................................................................................
ottava ........................................................................................ see octave
output
defined.. ..................................................................................................
overdubbing.. ...............................................................................................

.473
lines
.473
.200

320
320

489

Index

P
page ...................................... see Document Setup, page size, paper sizes
blank ........................................................................................................ 1 5 3
defined .................................................................................................... 473
numbers.. ................................................................................................ 341
starting with left-hand ................................................... see breaks, page
page breaks ............................................................................ see breaks, page
page margins.. .............................................................................................. 166
viewing .................................................................................................... 460
page numbers .............................................................................................. 3 4 1
recommended fonts ............................................................................. 184
page size ........................................................................................................ 257
page-turns .............................................................................. see breaks, page
pan position ................................. 280,300,303. See a/so MIDI messages
defined .................................................................................................... 474
paper
choosing good ....................................................................................... 377
paper sizes................................................................................... 164,273,373
A3 ............................................................................................................ 165
A4 ............................................................................................................ 165
165
A5 ,.....,................................,.,..................................................................
84 ............................................................................................................ 165
B5 ............................................................................................................ 165
Band.. ....................................................................................................... 165
Concert.. .................................................................................................. 165
Executive ................................................................................................. 165
Folio ......................................................................................................... 165
Hymn ....................................................................................................... 165
Legal.. ....................................................................................................... 165
Letter.. ...................................................................................................... 1 65
Octave ..................................................................................................... 165
Quart0 ..................................................................................................... 165
Statement.. .............................................................................................. 165
Tabloid .......................................................................................... ........... 165
parallel 5ths/8ves
check for .................................................................................................. 371
Par-t

defined .................................................................................................... 474


part extraction ................................................................... see extracting parts
parts.. .................................................................................. see extracting parts
passages.. ...................................................................................... .71, 410, 41 1
defined .................................................................................................... 474
system
defined .............................................................................................. 476
patch numbers ........................................................... see program numbers
patches ......................................................................... see program numbers
pause ................................................................................................ see fermata
PDF files.. ....................................................................................................... 390
defined ................................................................................................... .474
pearls of wisdom ........................................................................... see wisdom
pedaling ........ .262, 429. See a/so harp pedal diagrams, MIDI messages
percussion ................................................................ 106, 158,234,342,42 1
490

buzz roll symbol .................................................................................. 431


drum mapping.. .................................................................................... .342
drums ....................................................................................................... 345
General MIDI percussion ..................................................................... 302
noteheads ............................................................................................... 316
pitched .................................................................................................... .345
symbols.. ................................................................................................. .429
tidying up after Flexi-time input/MIDI import.. .............................. .337
performance.. ............................................................... 33. See also playback
Petrucci font ................................................................................................. .3 13
PhotoScore Lite.. .......................................................................................... .394
phrase-marks ........................................................................................ see slurs
piano ....................................................................... see keyboard instruments
piano beams ................................................................ see beams, cross-staff
pick scrape.. .................................................................................................. .2 1 6
see articulations
picking .....................................................................................
\
pick-up (upbeat) bars. ....................................................................... 143,446
PICT files.. ....................................................................................................... 390
defined.. .................................................................................................. .474
pitch ............................................................................................. see also notes
editing without changing rhythms ..................................................... 321
mapping ................................................................................................. .362
pitch spectrum .................................................................. see notes, coloring
pitch-bend.. ................................................................................................... .285
defined.. .................................................................................................. .474
Piu font ........................................................................................................... 313
pizzicato.. ................................................................................................. see text
playback.. ................................................................................................ .35 1
plain text.. ...................................................................................................... .439
plainchant ..................................................................................... .9 1, 139, 203
plainsong.. ................................................................................... see plainchant
Play menu
All Notes Off ........................................................................................... 354
Devices.. ........................................................................................... .26, 275
Dictionary.. ............................................................................................. .356
Mixer .................................................................................................. 35,299
Performance.. ........................................................................................ .348
Play or Pause.. .......................................................................................... 33
Playback Options
Play notes as you edit .................................................................... 355
Substitute Devices.. .............................................................................. .277
playback ................................................................................................. .33, 35 1
crescjdim. on held notes.. ................................................................. .369
dictionary ........................................................................................ 351,356
dynamics ..................................................................... see Expression text
Espressivo.. ............................................................................................. .348
hairpins.. ................................................................................... see hairpins
improving.. ............................................................................................. .304
note durations.. ..................................................................................... .350
ornaments.. ..................................................................................... see trills
reverb.. ......................................................................................... see reverb
Ru bato ...................................................................................................... 348
specifying what to play ........................................................................... 35
. . . . . . . .swmg
..
swing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . see

Index
playback dictionary.. ........................................................ see under playback
players ...................................................... 233. See a/so instruments, staves
defined .................................................................................................... 474
playing keyboard without inputting notes.. .............................................. .63
plug-ins .......................................................................................................... .359
point size ..... ................................................................................................... 180
defined ........... ......................................................................................... 474
polyrhythms ...................................................................................... see tuplets
pop.. ................................................................................................................ 216
pop chord symbols.. ......................................................... see chord symbols
portamento ................................................................................................... 263
portrait format .............................................................................................. 165
positioning
defaults.. ........... ....................................................................................... 161
lines ................................................................................................. see lines
notes .............................................................................................. see notes
textsee text
PostScript files.. .......................................... ................................................... 389
defined .................................................................................................... 474
PostScript fonts.. .................................................................................. see fonts
pre-bend ........................................................................................................ 2 14
pre-bend and release.. ............................................................................... .2 14
prefatory staves .............................................................. .92. See a/so incipits
preferences .................................................................................................... 372
textures .............. ...................................................................................... 460
prima volta .............................................................. see 1 st and 2nd endings
printing .................................................................................................... 40,373
all scores in a folder.. ........... ................................................................. 360
booklets.. ................................................................................................. 375
borders .................................................................................................... 373
crop marks .............................................................................................. 374
double-sided ................................................................................. 18 1, 375
Fit to Paper ............................................................................................. 374
PDF files .................................................................................................. 390
scale factor. . ........................................................................................... 374
spreads .................................................................................................... 375
Substitute options ................................................................................. 374
View menu options.. ............................................................................. 374
PrintMusic files .............................................................................................. 330
program changes.. ..................................................... see program numbers
program numbers.. ................................................. 280, 301, 335, 337, 351
defined .................................................................................................... 474
prolation ............................................................................................................ 92
Properties ....................................................................................................... 378
defined .................................................................................................... 474
viewing ...................................................... .............................................. 468
protraction lines .......................................................................... see lyric lines
pull-off ............................................................................................................ 216

Q
quantization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .199
.........
quarter note . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ._.........,
. . . . . . . see note values

quarter-tones ............................................................................. see accidentals


playback .................................................................................................. .370
Quart0 ....................................................................................... see paper sizes
quaver.. ....................................................................... see note values, beams
quotes ........................................................................... see characters, special

R
rake .................................................................................................................. 216
rallsee rit.
range
notes out of ......................................... 37. See also notes out of range
read
defined .................................................................................................... .474
real-time input ............................................................................ see Flexi-time
defined ..................................................................................................... 474
rebarring music............................................................................................. 446
recitative ................................................................................................ 203,270
recording ...................................................................................... see Flexi-time
onto CD .................................................................................................. .393
recovering files.. ................................................. see auto-save, auto-backup
rectangle ........................................................................................................ .264
Redo ......................................................................................................... 38,458
Redo History ........................................................................................... 458
reduction ........................................................................................................ 124
piano .......................................................................................................... 88
reformat
defined ..................................................................................................... 474
reformatting ................................................................................ see formatting
registering .................................................................................................. 18,25
rehearsal marks .............................................. 134, 181, 182, 186, 380, 385
defined ..................................................................................................... 475
editing ...................................................................................................... 385
Engraving Rules options.. .................................................................... .386
recommended fonts.. ........................................................................... 184
reinstalling Sibelius
Mac ............................................................................................................. 13
Windows .................................................................................................... 17
repeat bars ............................................................................................ 144,263
repeat last bar symbol.. ....................................................................... .429
repeat last two bars symbol.. ............................................................. .429
winged repeats ....................................................................................... 139
repeat signs .............................................................................. see repeat bars
repitching ................................................................................................ 58, 321
Reset Beam Groups ..................................................................................... 145
Reset Design .................................................................................................. 259
Reset Note Spacing.. ........................................................ 226, 271, 324, 413
Reset Position ................................................................................................ 258
reset sounds .................................................................................................. 277
resolution
defined ..................................................................................................... 475
respelling.. ............................................................ see accidentals, spelling of
rests.. ................................................... 47, 319. See also bar rests, multirest
491

Index
beam across ........................................................................................... 145
deleting.. .................................................................................................. 322
hidden ..................................................................................................... 323
inputting.. ................................................................................................ 32 1
out of alignment .................................................................................... 379
Remove Rests plug-in ........................................................................... 368
splitting dotted quarter note rests ..................................................... 369
symbols ................................................................................................... 430
retrograde.. .................................................................................................... 362
reverb .................................................................................................... 302,350
defined .................................................................................................... 475
rhythm.. ..................................................................................... see note values
augment .................................................................................................. 361
diminish.. ................................................................................................. 361
slashes ..................................................................................................... 3 16
rhythm dot............................................................................................ 118, 129
moving..................................................................................................... 467
rhythmic feel ................................................................................ .35, 349, 358
rit.
playback of..................................................................................... 262,353
roll, drum ............................................................................. see tremolos, trills
rolled chords ................................................................................. see arpeggio
roman font
defined .................................................................................................... 475
Roman numerals .......................................................................................... 439
Rubato ..................................................................................................... 34, 348
ruff ............................................................................................. see grace notes
rulers ........................................................................................................ 66, 461

sacred harp music.. ..................................................................................... .3 I 7


sans serif font
defined .................................................................................................... 475
saving ................................................. 189. See a/so auto-backup, auto-save
changing default location .................................................................... 189
graphics files.. ......................................................................................... 387
MIDI files.. ............................................................................................... 392
Sibelius files as CD audio .................................................................... 393
trees.. ........................................................................................................ 422
scanner driver
defined .................................................................................................... 475
scanning.. ....................................................................................................... 394
defined .................................................................................................... 475
Schenkerian analysis ................................................................................... 103
Scorch ............................................................................................................. 238
Scorch web page
Save as ..................................................................................................... 240
SCORE files.. .................................................................................................. 338
score in C ..................................................................... see transposing scores
score information ......................................................................................... 241
scores
calculating duration .............................................................................. 445
492

defined . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 475
...........
join . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
new ............................................................................................................. 41
short ........................................................................................................... 88
screen modes .................................................................................................. 32
scroll bars
viewing ..................................................................................................... 462
second ending ........................................................ see 1st and 2nd endings
Second Viennese School
Haupstimme ........................................................................................... 430
Nebenstimme... . ..................................................................................... 430
sprechstimme.. ...................................................................................... .43 1
stress and unstress symbols ................................................................ 430
second-time bar ..................................................... see 1 st and 2nd endings
Section end.. ................................................................................................. .38 1
sections .................................................................................................. 152,235
defined ..................................................................................................... 475
segno
inserting symbol .................................................................................... 1 1 1
select
defined.. .................................................................................................. .475
selecting objects ............................................................................................. 36
selections ...................................................................................................... .410
defined.. .................................................................................................. .475
multiple.. ................................................................................................. .410
single.. ..................................................................................................... ,410
septuplets.. ........................................................................................ see tuplets
sequencer
defined ..................................................................................................... 475
serif
defined.. .................................................................................................. .475
sextuplets .......................................................................................... see tuplets
shake ............................................................................................................... 2 1 6
shape notes.. ................................................................................................ .3 17
sharp ............................................................................................................... 1 1 8
shortcut menu ........................................................... see keyboard shortcuts
defined.. .................................................................................................. .475
shortcuts, keyboard .................................................. see keyboard shortcuts
Show Empty Staves.. ................................................................................... .423
Sibelius 7.. ..................................................................................................... .327
SibeliusMusic.com ....................................................................................... 238
singing ............................................................. see lyrics, choir, choral music
size.. .............................. see page sizes, paper sizes, point sizes, staff sizes
size of music .................................................................................. see staff size
slap .................................................................................................................. 2 1 6
slashes ............................................................................................................ 3 1 6
slide.. .............................................................................................................. .2 15
slurs.. ........................................................................................................ 55, 41 5
in lyrics.. .................................................................................................. .417
magnetic .. ................................................................................................ 415
multi-arc.. ................................................................................................ .416
small notes .......................................................... see grace notes, cue notes
smart quotes ............................................................... see characters, special
SMF ............................................................................................... see MIDI files

index
sol-fa notation
adding automatically ............................................................................ 366
solo.. ................................................................................................................ 300
Sonata font.. .................................................................................................. 3 13
sostenuto ........................................................................................... see tenuto
sound module..................................................................................... see MIDI
sound sets ..................................................................................................... 276
defined .................................................................................................... 475
sounding pitch.. .......................................................... see transposing scores
Sounds dialog
Reset.. ....................................................................................................... 277
SoundStage.. ................................................................................................. 304
spacing .................................................................... see u/so music engraving
defined .................................................................................................... 476
horizontal ................................................................................................ 324
vertical.. .................................................................................................... 4 18
special characters.. .......................................................... see accented letters
spectrum.. ........................................................................... see notes, coloring
speed tips ........................................................................................................ .32
spelling.. ....................................................... see also accidentals, spelling of
defined .................................................................................................... 476
split point.. ..................................................................................................... 201
Split System.. .......................................................................................... 92, 1 1 1
spread chord line ......................................................................... see arpeggio
spreads.. ......................................................................................................... 375
defined .................................................................................................... 476
sprechstimme ............................................................................................... 43 1
staccato.. ................................................................................... see articulations
staff margins.. ................................................................................................ 166
staff objects ................................................................................................... 133
defined .................................................................................................... 476
staff size.. ...................................................................................... 165, 257, 423
defined .................................................................................................... 476
staff system ....................................................................................... see system
staff types
changing.. ................................................................................................ 423
editing.. .................................................................................................... 175
Standard MIDI files (SMF). ....................................................... see MIDI files
Statement ................................................................................. see paper sizes
staves.. ............................................................................................................ 42 1
changing staff type.. .............................................................................. 423
chords split between ............................................................................ 147
deleting.. .................................................................................................. 423
dragging ........................................................................................... 37, 419
hide empty ............................................................................................. 422
justification.. ............................................................................................ 418
left justified ............................................................................................ .424
ossias ........................................................................................................

I
--

42 1

prefatory.. .................................................................................................. .92


problems printing.. ............................................................................... .374
Properties.. .............................................................................................. 38 1
removing gaps.. ..................................................................................... 424
restore default spacing.. ....................................................................... 420
selecting .................................................................................................. 419

show empty.. ......................................................................................... .422


small ....................................................................................................... ..42 3
spacing.. ........................................................................................... .66, 418

stopping early.. ...................................................................................... .424


without barlines .................................................................................... .424
without rests .......................................................................................... .424
stemless notes ................................................................................................ 91
stems ............................................................................................................... 426

defined.. .................................................................................................. .476


flipping.. .................................................................................................. .426
on middle line.. ............................................................................ .272, 426
on single-fine staves.. ........................................................................... .426
symbols.. ................................................................................................. .431
step-time input ...................................................................................... 60, 3 19
defined.. .................................................................................................. .476
stereo .............................................................................................................. 303

strands ................................................................................................ see voices


stress ................................................................................................... see tenuto
styles.. ............................................................. ,225. See a/so Edit Text Styles,
Edit Arrange Styles, Engraving Rules
sub-brackets ................................................................................... see brackets
defined ..................................................................................................... 476
substitute devices.. ...................................................................................... .277
Substitute options ....................................................................................... .374
arpeggios, gliss., etc. ............................................................................ .374
braces.. .................................................................................................... .374
lines .......................................................................................................... 374
symbols.. ................................................................................................. .374
subtitles ......................................................................................................... .437
suggestions.. ...................................................................................................... .9
Susato font.. .................................................................................................. .3 13
swap voices .................................................................................................. .465

swing.. ............................................................................................................ .349


symbols ......................................................................................................... .428
defined.. .................................................................................................. .476
editing.. .................................................................................................... 177
synesthesia ................................................................................................... .460
system breaks .................................................................... see breaks, system
system exclusive (SYSEX) messages ...................................................... ..28 8
system objects .............................................................................................. 134

defined.. .................................................................................................. .476


system passage

defined.. .................................................................................................. .476


system separators ....................................................................................... .425
defined ..................................................................................................... 476
systemic barline.. ............................................................... see barlines, initial
systems.. ..................................................................................... see also staves
defined.. .................................................................................................. .476
indented ................................................................................................. .422

T
. . . see tab
tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . guitar
493

Index
tablature.. ..................................................................... see guitar tab, lute tab
Tabloid.. ..................................................................................... see paper sizes
tail
defined .................................................................................................... 477
tails ....................................................................................................... see stems
Tamburo font.. .............................................................................................. 3 13
tapping ........................................................................................................... 216
Technique text.. ............................................................................................ 435
recommended fonts.. ........................................................................... 183
templates ...................................................................... see manuscript paper
tempo
toolbar readout.. .................................................................................... 443
tempo slider.. ................................................................................................ 443
Tempo text .................................................................................................... 436
tenuto ............................................................................................................... .58
terminology.. ..................................................................................................... .8
text .................................................................................................................. 432
at an angle.. ............................................................................................ 180
between staves ...................................................................................... 440
boxed ....................................................................................................... 438
changing style ........................................................................................ 439
copying between programs.. .............................................................. 439
creating ............................................................................................. 52,432
creating notes in.. .................................................................................. 436
editing ...................................................................................................... 433
hiding ....................................................................................................... 441
introduced ................................................................................................ .53
plain ......................................................................................................... 439
positioning.. .............................................................................................. .68
Properties.. .............................................................................................. 380
reset design ............................................................................................ 439
reset position .......................................................................................... 439
Roman numerals.. ................................................................................. 439
selecting .................................................................................................. 439
styles
defined.. ............................................................................................ 477
editing ............................................................................................... 179
text styles.. ............................................... see also Edit Text Styles, fonts
word menus.. ......................................................................................... 433
textures
changing .................................................................................................. 460
ties ........................................................................................................... 39,260
deleting .................................................................................................... 368
into 2nd-time bars ................................................................................ 261
time signatures.. .................................................................................... 43, 446
alternating.. ............................................................................................. 448
beat groups ............................................................................................ 447
cautionary ............................................................................................... 447
complex ................................................................................................... 447
multiple ................................................................................................... 447
recommended fonts.. ........................................................................... 184
style .......................................................................................................... 449
timecode.. ...................................................................................................... 443
frames per second ................................................................................ 444
494

notating .................................................................................................... 444


score duration ....................................................................................... .445
start time.. ............................................................................................... .444
style.. ........................................................................................................ .445
toolbar readout.. ................................................................................... .443
title pages.. ..................................................................................................... 153
Title text.. ............................................................................................... 134, 437
toggle
defined ..................................................................................................... 477
tonic sol-fa notation
adding automatically.. .......................................................................... .366
tool bar .............................................................................................................. 30
during playback.. ...................................................................................... 33
viewing.. .................................................................................................. .462
track
defined.. .................................................................................................. .477
transferring Sibelius.. ..................................................................................... 2 I
transposing ................. . .................................................................................. 450
8va lines ..................... ~......................................................................se e 8va
by a half-step (semitone) ................................................................... .451
by octaves .............................................................................................. .450
chord symbols.. ............................................................................. 156, 451
instruments.. ..................................................................... see instruments
modal ...................................................................................................... .362
score.. ..................................................................... see transposing scores
transposing instruments
changing transpositions of.. ............................................................... .235
defined.. .................................................................................................. .477
transposing scores ...................................................................................... .255
defined.. .................................................................................................. ,477
tremolos ........................................................................................................ ,452
trills ................................................................................................................. .262
playback of.. ........................................................................................... .353
triplets.. .................................................................... .57, 454. See also tuplets
troubleshooting .................................................................................... see help
TrueType fonts.. ................................................................................... see fonts
tunings
guitar ........................................................................................................ 218
tuplets.. .................................................................................................... 57, 454
copying .................................................................................................... 456
creating ................................................................................................... .454
default settings.. .................................................................................... .454
defined.. .................................................................................................. .477
deleting .................................................................................................... 456
Engraving Rules options.. .................................................................... .457
hidden.. ................................................................................................... .456
magnetic.. ............................................................................................... .455
moving ..................................................................................................... 455
nested ..................................................................................................... .456
over barlines.. ........................................................................................ .457
ratio ........................................................................................................... 455
recommended fonts.. ........................................................................... 184
removing brackets ................................................................................. 203
unit length.. ............................................................................................ .455

turn..
TWA1
dl
Type

umlat
under
Undo
Ut
uninst
M;
Wi
unlsor
altt
Unlock
upbeat
up-bob
USB
def

variatio
vector l
velocity
defi
verses..
version
Sibe
vertical
aligr
attac
lyric:
staff
text 1
vibrato . .
vibrato t
vibrato t
vibrato t:
View me
Attac
Break
Full s
Hiddf
High1
High11
Note
N(
N(

Index
turn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 429
.......
TWAIN
defined . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 477
..........
Type 1 fonts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . fonts
. . . see

U
umlaut.. ............................................................................. see accented letters
underlay.. .............................................................................................. see lyrics
Undo.. ...................................................................................................... 38, 458
Undo History.. ........................................................................................ 458
uninstalling Sibelius
Mac.. ........................................................................................................... .13
Windows ................................................................................................... .17
unison bend.. ................................................................................................ 2 15
unrsons
1 19
altered . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Unlock Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
(upbeat) bars
upbeats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . pick-up
see
up-bow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . seearticulations
USB
defined . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 477
..........

V
variations.. ...................................................................................................... 362
vector graphics ............................................................................................. 388
velocity
defined ................................................................................................... .477
verses.. ............................................................................................................ 267
version number
Sibelius .................................................................................................... 220
vertical
alignment.. .............................................................................................. 259
attachment .............................................................................................. 133
lyrics position ......................................................................................... 271
staff spacing.. .......................................................................................... 257
text position ............................................................................................ 182
vibrato ............................................................................................................ 2 16
vibrato bar dip .............................................................................................. 2 16
vibrato bar dive ............................................................................................ 2 15
vibrato bar scoop.. ....................................................................................... 2 16
View menu .................................................................................................... 459
Attachment ............................................................................................. 459
Breaks and Locks.. ........................................................................ 153, 459
Full Screen ....................................................................................... 3 1, 462
Hidden Objects.. .................................................................................... 459
Highlight.. ................................................................................................ 223
Highlights.. .............................................................................................. 459
Note Colors submenu.. ....................................................................... .459
None.. ................................................................................................ 459
Notes out of Range ....................................................................... .459

Pitch Spectrum ............................................................................... ,459


Voice Colors.. .................................................................................. .464
Voices ............................................................................................... .459
Object Rulers.. ....................................................................................... .461
Page Margins.. ............................................................................... 166, 460
Selection Rulers.. ........................................................................... 133, 461
Staff Rulers ............................................................................................. .461
Textures ........................................................................................... .3 1, 460
Toolbar.. ........................................................................................... .3 1, 462
Translucent Windows.. ........................................................................ .468
Zoom submenu .................................................................................... .462
virgules .............................................................................................. see slashes
vocal music.. ................................. 1 1 1. see a/so choir, choral music, lyrics
voices.. ..................................................................................................... 56, 463
copying .................................................................................................... 466
creating ................................................................................................... .464
creating bar rest in ................................................................................ 143
crossing .................................................................................................... 466
defined.. .................................................................................................. .477
deleting .................................................................................................... 464
hiding.. .................................................................................................... ,466
merging .................................................................................................. .465
splitting ................................................................................................... .465
swapping ................................................................................................. 465
voices (singers). ............................................. see choir, choral music, lyrics
volume ................................................................................................... 300,302
defined ..................................................................................................... 478

W
web links.. ..................................................................................................... .2 19
web page
save as .................................................................................................... .240
wedge.. ....................................................................... see articulation, hairpin
wheel mouse.. .............................................................................................. .462
whole rest ...................................................................................................... 143
whole-note.. .............................................................................. see note values
Window menu.. ........................................................................................... .468
Keypad .................................................................................................... .468
Keypad Separated from Properties .................................................. .468
Mixer ......................................................................................................... 468
Navigator ................................................................................... 29,31,468
New Window.. ....................................................................................... .468
Properties.. ............................................................................. .3 1, 378, 468
Scroll Bars................................................................................................ 462
Translucent Windows ............................................................................. 31
Windows-specific options.. ................................................................. .468
winged repeats ............................................................................................. 139
wisdom.. ............................................................................... .29, 39, 43, 61, 71
Word .................................................................................. see Microsoft Word
word menus.. ............................................................................................... .433
modifying.. ............................................................................................. .442
words (for singing) ............................................................................. see lyrics
495

Index
worksheet.. ........................................................................................... 1 14, 273
written pitch ................................................................ see transposing scores
www.sibeliusmusic.com ............................................................................. 238

496

Z
zoom ...................................................................................... 30,388,406,462
default level ............................................................................................ 189

j
;

Anda mungkin juga menyukai